summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes4
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
-rw-r--r--old/56196-0.txt12690
-rw-r--r--old/56196-0.zipbin282022 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/56196-h.zipbin1187674 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/56196-h/56196-h.htm17016
-rw-r--r--old/56196-h/images/cover.jpgbin131495 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/56196-h/images/frontis.jpgbin48698 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/56196-h/images/il1_01.jpgbin102404 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/56196-h/images/il1_01l.jpgbin198465 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/56196-h/images/il1_02.jpgbin66578 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/56196-h/images/il1_03.jpgbin84135 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/56196-h/images/il1_04.jpgbin89493 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/56196-h/images/il1_05.jpgbin100171 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/56196-h/images/il1_06.jpgbin67875 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/56196-h/images/il222.jpgbin3729 -> 0 bytes
17 files changed, 17 insertions, 29706 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d7b82bc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+*.txt text eol=lf
+*.htm text eol=lf
+*.html text eol=lf
+*.md text eol=lf
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..90dee47
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #56196 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/56196)
diff --git a/old/56196-0.txt b/old/56196-0.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index b2d9a8c..0000000
--- a/old/56196-0.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,12690 +0,0 @@
-The Project Gutenberg EBook of The Three Voyages of Captain Cook Round the
-World. Vol. I. Being the First of the First, by James Cook and Joseph Banks and Dr. Hawkesworth
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
-other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms of
-the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
-www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you'll have
-to check the laws of the country where you are located before using this ebook.
-
-Title: The Three Voyages of Captain Cook Round the World. Vol. I. Being the First of the First Voyage.
-
-Author: James Cook
- Joseph Banks
- Dr. Hawkesworth
-
-Release Date: December 17, 2017 [EBook #56196]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THREE VOYAGES OF CAPTAIN COOK, VOL 1 ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by Sonya Schermann and the Online Distributed
-Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was
-produced from images generously made available by The
-Internet Archive)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- Transcriber’s Note
-
-
-When italics were used in the original book, the corresponding text has
-been surrounded by _underscores_. Superscripted characters are preceded
-by ^ and when more than one character is superscripted, they are
-surrounded by {}.
-
-Some corrections have been made to the printed text. These are listed in
-a second transcriber’s note at the end of the text.
-
-[Illustration:
-
- _Captain Cook._
-
- _Drawn & Engraved by W. Bond, from the large Picture by George Dance
- R.A._
-
- _Published by Longman & C^o. London Sept^r. 6^{th}. 1821._
-]
-
-
-
-
- THE
-
- THREE
-
- VOYAGES
-
- OF
-
- CAPTAIN JAMES COOK
-
- ROUND THE WORLD.
-
- COMPLETE
-
- In Seven Volumes.
-
- --------------
-
- _WITH MAP AND OTHER PLATES._
-
- --------------
-
- VOL. I.
-
- BEING THE FIRST OF THE FIRST VOYAGE.
-
- --------------
-
- LONDON:
-
- PRINTED FOR
- LONGMAN, HURST, REES, ORME, AND BROWN,
- PATERNOSTER-ROW.
-
- 1821.
-
-
-
-
- LIFE
-
- OF
-
- CAPTAIN JAMES COOK.
-
- --------------
-
-
-THIS celebrated navigator was the son of a day-labourer, and born at
-Marton, a village in Yorkshire, Nov. 3. 1728. At the age of thirteen he
-was put to a school, where he learnt writing and arithmetic; after which
-he was bound apprentice to a shopkeeper at Snaith, but on discovering an
-inclination for the sea, his master gave up his indentures, and he
-articled himself for three years to a ship-owner at Whitby. After
-serving out his time diligently, he entered in 1755 on board the Eagle
-sixty gun ship; and in 1759 he obtained a warrant as master of the
-Mercury, in which ship he was present at the taking of Quebec, where he
-made a complete draught of the channel and river of St. Laurence, which
-chart was published. Mr. Cook was next appointed to the Northumberland,
-then employed in the recapture of Newfoundland; and there also he made a
-survey of the harbour and coasts. At the latter end of 1762 he returned
-to England, and married a young woman of Barking; but early in the next
-year he went again to Newfoundland, as surveyor, with Captain Graves,
-and he afterwards acted in the same capacity under Sir Hugh Palliser.
-While thus employed, he made an observation of an eclipse of the sun,
-which he communicated to the Royal Society. It being determined to send
-out astronomers to observe the transit of Venus in some part of the
-South Sea, Mr. Cook was selected to command the Endeavour, a ship taken
-up for that service; and accordingly he was promoted to the rank of
-lieutenant, May 25. 1768. Our limits will not allow of giving the
-details of this interesting voyage; and therefore we shall content
-ourselves with stating, that the transit was observed to great advantage
-at Otaheite; after which lieutenant Cook explored the neighbouring
-islands, and then shaped his course for New Zealand, which he
-circumnavigated, and thus ascertained that it was not a continent. From
-thence he sailed to New Holland, or, as it is now called, New South
-Wales, where he anchored in Botany Bay, April 28. 1770, an epoch of
-great importance in the history of that part of the world. From hence he
-sailed to New Guinea, and next to Batavia, where the ship being
-refitted, he returned to Europe, and arrived in the Downs, June 12.
-1771. For his services on this occasion, Mr. Cook was promoted to the
-rank of commander, and an account of his voyage was soon after published
-by Dr. Hawkesworth. The interest excited hereby induced government to
-send Captain Cook on another voyage of discovery to the southern
-hemisphere, and he accordingly sailed with two ships, the Resolution,
-commanded by himself, and the Adventure, by Captain Furneaux, April 9.
-1772. After proceeding as far as 71° 10ʹ of south latitude, amidst
-mountains of ice, and discovering some new islands, our voyagers
-returned to England, July 30. 1775. The Resolution in this enterprize
-lost only one man out of her whole complement, for which Captain Cook
-was elected a member of the Royal Society, and afterwards the gold medal
-was voted to him by the same learned body. He was also appointed a
-post-captain, and promoted to a valuable situation in Greenwich
-hospital. As the narrative of the former voyage had not given
-satisfaction, the history of the second was drawn almost wholly from the
-captain’s journals, and digested by Dr. Douglas, late bishop of
-Salisbury. But the labours of Cook were not to end here. In July 1776 he
-sailed again, to decide the long agitated question of a northern passage
-to the Pacific Ocean. In this voyage he had two ships, the Resolution
-and the Discovery; but after sailing as high as 74° 44ʹ N. the object
-was considered impracticable; and on Nov. 26. 1778, the ships arrived at
-the Sandwich islands. Here at first they were well received, but at
-length the people of Owhyhee stole one of the boats, to recover which
-Captain Cook went on shore, with the intention of getting into his
-possession the person of the king; but in doing this a crowd assembled,
-and the brave commander fell by a club, after which he was dispatched by
-a dagger; and his body was carried off in triumph and devoured. This
-melancholy event occurred in the morning of the 14th February, 1779.
-Captain Cook left a widow and family; on the former a pension of 200_l._
-a year was settled by the king, and 25_l._ a-year on each of the
-children.
-
-
-
-
- CONTENTS
-
- OF
-
- _THE FIRST VOLUME._
-
- --------------
-
- FIRST VOYAGE.
-
- Page
-
- INTRODUCTION to the first Voyage 3
-
- BOOK I.
-
- CHAP. I.
-
- The Passage from Plymouth to Madeira, with some Account of that 7
- Island
-
- CHAP. II.
-
- The Passage from Madeira to Rio de Janeiro, with some Account of 18
- the Country, and the Incidents that happened there
-
- CHAP. III.
-
- The Passage from Rio de Janeiro to the Entrance of the Strait of 44
- Le Maire, with a Description of some of the Inhabitants of
- Terra del Fuego
-
- CHAP. IV.
-
- An Account of what happened in ascending a Mountain to search for 51
- Plants
-
- CHAP. V.
-
- The Passage through the Strait of Le Maire, and a further 59
- Description of the Inhabitants of Terra del Fuego, and its
- Productions
-
- CHAP. VI.
-
- A general Description of the south-east Part of Terra del Fuego, 67
- and the Strait of Le Maire; with some Remarks on Lord Anson’s
- Account of them, and Directions for the Passage westward, round
- this Part of America, into the South Seas
-
- CHAP. VII.
-
- The Sequel of the Passage from Cape Horn to the newly discovered 74
- Islands in the South Seas, with a Description of their Figure
- and Appearance.—Some Account of the Inhabitants, and several
- Incidents that happened during the Course, and at the Ship’s
- arrival among them
-
- CHAP. VIII.
-
- The Arrival of the Endeavour at Otaheite, called by Captain 84
- Wallis, King George the III.’s Island.—Rules established for
- Traffic with the Natives, and an Account of several Incidents
- which happened in a Visit to Tootahah and Toubourai Tamaide,
- two Chiefs
-
- CHAP. IX.
-
- A Place fixed upon for an Observatory and Fort.—An Excursion into 93
- the Woods, and its Consequences.—The Fort erected.—A Visit from
- several Chiefs on Board and at the Fort, with some Account of
- the Music of the Natives, and the Manner in which they dispose
- of their Dead
-
- CHAP. X.
-
- An Excursion to the eastward, an Account of several Incidents 102
- that happened both on Board and on Shore, and of the first
- Interview with Oberea, the Person who, when the Dolphin was
- here, was supposed to be Queen of the Island, with a
- Description of the Fort
-
- CHAP. XI.
-
- The Observatory set up.—The Quadrant stolen, and Consequences of 113
- the Theft.—A Visit to Tootahah.—Description of a wrestling
- Match.—European seeds sown.—Names given to our People by the
- Indians
-
- CHAP. XII.
-
- Some Ladies visit the Fort with very uncommon Ceremonies.—The 126
- Indians attend Divine Service, and in the Evening exhibit a
- most extraordinary spectacle.—Toubourai Tamaide falls into
- Temptation
-
- CHAP. XIII.
-
- Another Visit to Tootahah, with various Adventures.—Extraordinary 134
- Amusement of the Indians, with Remarks upon it.—Preparations to
- observe the Transit of Venus, and what happened in the mean
- time at the Fort
-
- CHAP. XIV.
-
- The Ceremonies of an Indian Funeral particularly 144
- described.—General Observations on the Subject.—A Character
- found among the Indians to which the Ancients paid great
- Veneration.—A Robbery at the Fort, and its Consequences; with a
- Specimen of Indian Cookery, and various Incidents
-
- CHAP. XV.
-
- An Account of the Circumnavigation of the Island, and various 157
- Incidents that happened during the Expedition; with a
- Description of a Burying-place and Place of Worship, called a
- Morai
-
- CHAP. XVI.
-
- An Expedition of Mr. Banks to trace the River.—Marks of 173
- subterraneous Fire.—Preparations for leaving the Island.—An
- Account of Tupia
-
- CHAP. XVII.
-
- A particular Description of the Island; its Produce and 184
- Inhabitants; their Dress, Habitations, Food, Domestic Life and
- Amusements
-
- CHAP. XVIII.
-
- Of the Manufactures, Boats, and Navigation of Otaheite 209
-
- CHAP. XIX.
-
- Of the Division of Time in Otaheite; Numeration, Computation of 225
- Distance, Language, Diseases, Disposal of the Dead, Religion,
- War, Weapons, and Government; with some general Observations
- for the Use of future Navigators
-
- CHAP. XX.
-
- A Description of several other Islands in the Neighbourhood of 245
- Otaheite, with various Incidents; a Dramatic Entertainment; and
- many Particulars relative to the Customs and Manners of the
- Inhabitants
-
- BOOK II.
-
- CHAP. I.
-
- The Passage from Oteroah to New Zealand; Incidents which happened 274
- on going ashore there, and while the Ship lay in Poverty Bay
-
- CHAP. II.
-
- A Description of Poverty Bay, and the Face of the adjacent 289
- Country.—The Range from thence to Cape Turnagain, and back to
- Tolaga; with some Account of the People and the Country, and
- several Incidents that happened on that Part of the Coast
-
- CHAP. III.
-
- The Range from Tolaga to Mercury Bay, with an Account of many 314
- Incidents that happened both on board and ashore.—A Description
- of several Views exhibited by the Country, and of the Heppahs,
- or fortified Villages of the Inhabitants
-
- CHAP. IV.
-
- The Range from Mercury Bay to the Bay of Islands.—An Expedition 339
- up the River Thames.—Some Account of the Indians who inhabit
- its Banks, and the fine Timber that grows there.—Several
- Interviews with the Natives on different Parts of the Coast,
- and a Skirmish with them upon an Island
-
- CHAP. V.
-
- Range from the Bay of Islands round North Cape to Queen 360
- Charlotte’s Sound; and a Description of that part of the Coast
-
- CHAP. VI.
-
- Transactions in Queen Charlotte’s Sound.—Passage through the 374
- Strait which divides the two Islands, and back to Cape
- Turnagain.—Horrid Custom of the Inhabitants.—Remarkable Melody
- of Birds.—A Visit to a Heppah, and many other Particulars
-
-
-
-
- DIRECTIONS FOR PLACING
- THE PLATES.
-
-
- --------------
-
- VOL. I.
-
- Portrait _to face the Title_.
-
- Map of the World _Page_ 1
-
- Island of Otaheite 84
-
- Harbour of Oopoa 254
-
- A fortified Town at Tolaga 331
-
- A natural Arch, or perforated Rock 331
-
- Inside of a Hippah in New Zealand 332
-
- VOL. II.
-
- Canoe of New Zealand _to face the Title_.
-
- VOL. III.
-
- Landing at Middleburgh, Friendly Isles _to face the Title_.
-
- Boats of the Friendly Isles 222
-
- Resolution Bay, in the Marquesas 299
-
- The Fleet of Otaheite at Opárre 318
-
- VOL. IV.
-
- A View in the Island of Rotterdam _to face the Title_.
-
- View in the Island of New Caledonia 98
-
- Christmas Sound Terra del Fuego 178
-
- VOL. V.
-
- Christmas Harbour in Kerguelen’s Land _to face the Title_.
-
- View at Anamooka 301
-
- VOL. VI.
-
- Canoe of the Sandwich Islands _to face the Title_.
-
- A Morai, at Otaheite 31
-
- View at Huaheine 85
-
- A Morai in Atooi 185
-
- Inland View in Atooi 206
-
- Natives of Oonolashka 466
-
- VOL. VII.
-
- Summer and Winter Habitations at Kamtschatka _to face the Title_.
-
- Karakakooa, Owyhee 3
-
- Town and Harbour of St. Peter, Kamtschatka 168
-
-[Illustration:
-
- THE WORLD,
- on
- _MERCATOR’S PROJECTION_,
- _Shewing_ the Courses _of_
- CAPTAIN COOK’S THREE VOYAGES.
-]
-
-
-
-
- AN
-
- ACCOUNT
-
- OF A
-
- VOYAGE ROUND THE WORLD,
-
- IN THE YEARS 1768, 1769, 1770, and 1771.
-
- BY
-
- LIEUTENANT JAMES COOK,
-
- COMMANDER OF HIS MAJESTY’S BARK THE ENDEAVOUR.
-
-
- Drawn up from his Journal,
- And from the Papers of Sir JOSEPH BANKS, Bart
-
- BY
-
- DR. HAWKESWORTH.
-
-
-
-
- INTRODUCTION
-
- TO
-
- THE FIRST VOYAGE.
-
-
-WITH Lieutenant Cook, in this voyage, embarked Joseph Banks, Esquire, a
-gentleman possessed of considerable landed property in Lincolnshire. He
-received the education of a scholar rather to qualify him for the
-enjoyments than the labours of life; yet an ardent desire to know more
-of Nature than could be learnt from books determined him, at a very
-early age, to forego what are generally thought to be the principal
-advantages of a liberal fortune, and to apply his revenue not in
-procuring the pleasures of leisure and ease, but in the pursuit of his
-favourite study, through a series of fatigue and danger, which, in such
-circumstances, have very seldom been voluntarily incurred, except to
-gratify the restless and insatiable desires of avarice or ambition.
-
-Upon his leaving the university of Oxford, in the year 1763, he crossed
-the Atlantic, and visited the coasts of Newfoundland and Labradore. The
-danger, difficulty, and inconvenience that attend long voyages are very
-different in idea and experience; Mr. Banks, however, returned,
-undiscouraged, from his first expedition; and when he found that the
-Endeavour was equipping for a voyage to the South Seas, in order to
-observe the Transit of Venus, and afterwards attempt farther
-discoveries, he determined to embark in the expedition, that he might
-enrich his native country with a tribute of knowledge from those which
-have been hitherto unknown, and not without hope of leaving among the
-rude and uncultivated nations that he might discover, something that
-would render life of more value, and enrich them, perhaps, in a certain
-degree, with the knowledge, or at least with the productions, of Europe.
-
-As he was determined to spare no expense in the execution of his plan,
-he engaged Dr. Solander to accompany him in the voyage. This Gentleman,
-by birth a Swede, was educated under the celebrated Linnæus, from whom
-he brought letters of recommendation into England, and his merit being
-soon known, he obtained an appointment in the British Museum, a public
-institution, which was then just established; such a companion Mr. Banks
-considered as an acquisition of no small importance, and, to his great
-satisfaction, the event abundantly proved that he was not mistaken. He
-also took with him two draftsmen, one to delineate views and figures,
-the other to paint such subjects of natural history as might offer;
-together with a secretary and four servants, two of whom were negroes.
-
-Mr. Banks kept an accurate and circumstantial journal of the voyage,
-and, soon after I had received that of Captain Cook from the Admiralty,
-was so obliging as to put it into my hands, with permission to take out
-of it whatever I thought would improve or embellish the narrative. This
-was an offer of which I gladly and thankfully accepted: I knew the
-advantage would be great, for few philosophers have furnished materials
-for accounts of voyages undertaken to discover new countries. The
-adventurers in such expeditions have generally looked only upon the
-great outline of Nature, without attending to the variety of shades
-within, which give life and beauty to the piece.
-
-The papers of Captain Cook contained a very particular account of all
-the nautical incidents of the voyage, and a very minute description of
-the figure and extent of the countries he had visited, with the bearings
-of the headlands and bays that diversify the coasts, the situation of
-the harbours in which shipping may obtain refreshments, with the depth
-of water wherever there were soundings; the latitudes, longitudes,
-variation of the needle, and such other particulars as lay in his
-department; and abundantly showed him to be an excellent officer, and
-skilful navigator. But in the papers which were communicated to me by
-Mr. Banks, I found a great variety of incidents which had not come under
-the notice of Captain Cook, with descriptions of countries and people,
-their productions, manners, customs, religion, policy, and language,
-much more full and particular than were expected from a Gentleman whose
-station and office naturally turned his principal attention to other
-objects; for these particulars, therefore, besides many practical
-observations, the Public is indebted to Mr. Banks. To Mr. Banks also the
-Public is indebted for the designs of the engravings which illustrate
-and adorn the account of this voyage, all of them, except the maps,
-charts, and views of the coasts as they appear at sea, being copied from
-his valuable drawings, and some of them from such as were made for the
-use of the artists at his expense.
-
-As the materials furnished by Mr. Banks were so interesting and copious,
-there arose an objection against writing an account of this voyage in
-the person of the Commander, which could have no place with respect to
-the others; the descriptions and observations of Mr. Banks would be
-absorbed without any distinction, in a general narrative given under
-another name: but this objection he generously over-ruled, and it,
-therefore, became necessary to give some account of the obligations
-which he has laid upon the Public and myself in this place. It is,
-indeed, fortunate for mankind, when wealth and science, and a strong
-inclination to exert the powers of both for purposes of public benefit,
-unite in the same person; and I cannot but congratulate my country upon
-the prospect of further pleasure and advantage from the same Gentleman,
-to whom we are indebted for so considerable a part of this narrative.
-
-
-
-
- AN
-
- ACCOUNT
-
- OF A
-
- VOYAGE ROUND THE WORLD,
-
- IN 1768, 1769, 1770, AND 1771.
-
- BOOK I.
-
- CHAP. I.
-
-THE PASSAGE FROM PLYMOUTH TO MADEIRA, WITH SOME ACCOUNT OF THAT ISLAND.
-
-
-HAVING received my commission, which was dated the 25th of May, 1768, I
-went on board on the 27th, hoisted the pennant, and took charge of the
-ship, which then lay in the basin in Deptford Yard. She was fitted for
-sea with all expedition; and stores and provisions being taken on board,
-sailed down the river on the 30th of July, and on the 13th of August
-anchored in Plymouth Sound.
-
-While we lay here waiting for a wind, the articles of war and the act of
-parliament were read to the ship’s company, who were paid two months’
-wages in advance, and told that they were to expect no additional pay
-for the performance of the voyage.
-
-On Friday, the 26th of August, the wind becoming fair, we got under
-sail, and put to sea. On the 31st, we saw several of the birds which the
-sailors call Mother Carey’s Chickens, and which they suppose to be the
-forerunners of a storm; and on the next day we had a very hard gale,
-which brought us under our courses, washed over-board a small boat
-belonging to the boatswain, and drowned three or four dozen of our
-poultry, which we regretted still more.
-
-On Friday, the 2d of September, we saw land between Cape Finister and
-Cape Ortegal, on the coast of Gallicia, in Spain; and on the 5th, by an
-observation of the sun and moon, we found the latitude of Cape Finister
-to be 42° 53ʹ North, and its longitude 8° 46ʹ West, our first meridian
-being always supposed to pass through Greenwich; variation of the needle
-21° 4ʹ W.
-
-During this course, Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander had an opportunity of
-observing many marine animals, of which no naturalist has hitherto taken
-notice; particularly a new species of the _Oniscus_, which was found
-adhering to the _Medusa Pelagica_; and an animal of an angular figure,
-about three inches long, and one thick, with a hollow passing quite
-through it, and a brown spot on one end, which they conjectured might be
-its stomach; four of these adhered together by their sides when they
-were taken, so that at first they were thought to be one animal, but
-upon being put into a glass of water they soon separated, and swam about
-very briskly. These animals are of a new genus, to which Mr. Banks and
-Dr. Solander gave the name of _Dagysa_, from the likeness of one species
-of them to a gem: several specimens of them were taken, adhering
-together sometimes to the length of a yard or more, and shining in the
-water with very beautiful colours. Another animal, of a new genus, they
-also discovered, which shone in the water with colours still more
-beautiful and vivid, and which indeed exceeded in variety and brightness
-any thing that we had ever seen: the colouring and splendour of these
-animals were equal to those of an Opal, and from their resemblance to
-that gem, the genus was called _Carcinium Opalinum_. One of them lived
-several hours in a glass of salt water, swimming about with great
-agility, and at every motion displaying a change of colours almost
-infinitely various. We caught also among the rigging of the ship, when
-we were at the distance of about ten leagues from Cape Finister, several
-birds which have not been described by Linnæus; they were supposed to
-have come from Spain, and our gentlemen called the species _Motacilla
-velificans_, as they said none but sailors would venture themselves on
-board a ship that was going round the world: one of them was so
-exhausted, that it died in Mr. Banks’s hand, almost as soon as it was
-brought to him.
-
-It was thought extraordinary that no naturalist had hitherto taken
-notice of the _Dagysa_, as the sea abounds with them not twenty leagues
-from the coast of Spain; but, unfortunately for the cause of science,
-there are but very few of those who traverse the sea, that are either
-disposed or qualified to remark the curiosities of which Nature has made
-it the repository.
-
-On the 12th we discovered the islands of Porto Santo and Madeira, and on
-the next day anchored in Funchiale road, and moored with the
-stream-anchor: but, in the night, the bend of the hawser of the
-stream-anchor slipped, owing to the negligence of the person who had
-been employed to make it fast. In the morning the anchor was heaved up
-into the boat, and carried out to the southward; but in heaving it
-again, Mr. Weir, the master’s mate, was carried overboard by the
-buoy-rope, and went to the bottom with the anchor; the people in the
-ship saw the accident, and got the anchor up with all possible
-expedition; it was, however, too late; the body came up intangled in the
-buoy-rope, but it was dead.
-
-When the island of Madeira is first approached from the sea, it has a
-very beautiful appearance; the sides of the hills being entirely covered
-with vines almost as high as the eye can distinguish; and the vines are
-green when every kind of herbage, except where they shade the ground,
-and here and there by the sides of a rill, is entirely burnt up, which
-was the case at this time.
-
-On the 13th, about eleven o’clock in the forenoon, a boat, which our
-sailors call the product boat, came on board from the officers of
-health, without whose permission no person is suffered to land from on
-board a ship. As soon as this permission was obtained, we went on shore
-at Funchiale, the capital of the island, and proceeded directly to the
-house of Mr. Cheap, who is the English consul there, and one of the most
-considerable merchants of the place. This gentleman received us with the
-kindness of a brother, and the liberality of a prince; he insisted upon
-our taking possession of his house, in which he furnished us with every
-possible accommodation during our stay upon the island; he procured
-leave for Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander to search the island for such
-natural curiosities as they should think worth their notice; employed
-persons to take fish and gather shells, which time would not have
-permitted them to collect for themselves; and he provided horses and
-guides to take them to any part of the country which they should choose
-to visit. With all these advantages, however, their excursions were
-seldom pushed farther than three miles from the town, as they were only
-five days on shore; one of which they spent at home, in receiving the
-honour of a visit from the governor. The season was the worst in the
-year for their purpose, as it was neither that of plants nor insects; a
-few of the plants, however, were procured in flower, by the kind
-attention of Dr. Heberden, the chief physician of the island, and
-brother to Dr. Heberden of London, who also gave them such specimens as
-he had in his possession, and a copy of his Botanical Observations;
-containing, among other things, a particular description of the trees of
-the island. Mr. Banks inquired after the wood which has been imported
-into England for cabinet work, and is here called Madeira mahogany: he
-learnt that no wood was exported from the island under that name, but he
-found a tree called by the natives Vigniatico, the _Laurus indicus_ of
-Linnæus, the wood of which cannot easily be distinguished from mahogany.
-Dr. Heberden has a book-case, in which the vigniatico and mahogany are
-mixed, and they are no otherwise to be known from each other than by the
-colour, which, upon a nice examination, appears to be somewhat less
-brown in the vigniatico than the mahogany; it is, therefore, in the
-highest degree probable, that the wood known in England by the name of
-Madeira mahogany, is the vigniatico.
-
-There is great reason to suppose that this whole island was, at some
-remote period, thrown up by the explosion of subterraneous fire, as
-every stone, whether whole or in fragments, that we saw upon it,
-appeared to have been burnt, and even the sand itself to be nothing more
-than ashes: we did not, indeed, see much of the country, but the people
-informed us that what we did see was a very exact specimen of the rest.
-
-The only article of trade in this island is wine, and the manner in
-which it is made is so simple, that it might have been used by Noah, who
-is said to have planted the first vineyard after the flood: the grapes
-are put into a square wooden vessel, the dimensions of which are
-proportioned to the size of the vineyard to which it belongs; the
-servants then, having taken off their stockings and jackets, get into
-it, and with their feet and elbows press out as much of the juice as
-they can: the stalks are afterwards collected, and being tied together
-with a rope, are put under a square piece of wood, which is pressed down
-upon them by a lever with a stone tied to the end of it. The inhabitants
-have made so little improvement in knowledge or art, that they have but
-very lately brought all the fruit of a vineyard to be of one sort, by
-engrafting their vines: there seems to be in mind as there is in matter,
-a kind of _vis inertiæ_, which resists the first impulse to change. He
-who proposes to assist the artificer or the husbandman by a new
-application of the principles of philosophy, or the powers of mechanism,
-will find, that his having hitherto done without them will be a stronger
-motive for continuing to do without them still, than any advantage,
-however manifest and considerable, for adopting the improvement.
-Wherever there is ignorance there is prejudice; and the common people of
-all nations are, with respect to improvements, like the parish poor of
-England with respect to a maintenance, for whom the law must not only
-make a provision, but compel them to accept it, or else they will be
-still found begging in the streets. It was, therefore, with great
-difficulty that the people of Madeira were persuaded to engraft their
-vines, and some of them still obstinately refuse to adopt the practice,
-though a whole vintage is very often spoiled by the number of bad grapes
-which are mixed in the vat, and which they will not throw out, because
-they increase the quantity of the wine: an instance of the force of
-habit, which is the more extraordinary, as they have adopted the
-practice of engrafting with respect to their chesnut-trees, an object of
-much less importance, which, however, are thus brought to bear sooner
-than they would otherwise have done.
-
-We saw no wheel-carriages of any sort in the place, which, perhaps, is
-not more owing to the want of ingenuity to invent them than to the want
-of industry to mend the roads, which, at present, it is impossible that
-any wheel-carriage should pass: the inhabitants have horses and mules,
-indeed, excellently adapted to such ways; but their wine is,
-notwithstanding, brought to town from the vineyards where it is made in
-vessels of goat-skins, which are carried by men upon their heads. The
-only imitation of a carriage among these people is a board, made
-somewhat hollow in the middle, to one end of which a pole is tied, by a
-strap of whit-leather: this wretched sledge approaches about as near to
-an English cart as an Indian canoe to a ship’s long-boat; and even this
-would probably never have been thought of, if the English had not
-introduced wine-vessels, which are too big to be carried by hand, and
-which, therefore, are dragged about the town upon these machines.
-
-One reason, perhaps, why art and industry have done so little for
-Madeira, is, Nature’s having done so much. The soil is very rich, and
-there is such a difference of climate between the plains and the hills,
-that there is scarcely a single object of luxury that grows either in
-Europe or the Indies that might not be produced here. When we went to
-visit Dr. Heberden, who lives upon a considerable ascent, about two
-miles from town, we left the thermometer at 74, and when we arrived at
-his house, we found it at 66. The hills produce, almost spontaneously,
-walnuts, chesnuts, and apples in great abundance; and in the town there
-are many plants which are the natives both of the East and West Indies,
-particularly the banana, the guava, the pine-apple or anana, and the
-mango, which flourish almost without culture. The corn of this country
-is of a most excellent quality, large grained and very fine, and the
-island would produce it in great plenty; yet most of what is consumed by
-the inhabitants is imported. The mutton, pork, and beef, are also very
-good; the beef, in particular, which we took on board here, was
-universally allowed to be scarcely inferior to our own; the lean part
-was very like it, both in colour and grain, though the beasts are much
-smaller, but the fat is as white as the fat of mutton.
-
-The town of Funchiale derives its name from _Funcho_, the Portuguese
-name for fennel, which grows in great plenty upon the neighbouring
-rocks, and by the observation of Dr. Heberden, lies in the latitude of
-32° 33ʹ 33ʺ N. and longitude 16° 49ʹ W. It is situated in the bottom of
-a bay, and though larger than the extent of the island seems to deserve,
-is very ill built; the houses of the principal inhabitants are large,
-those of the common people are small, the streets are narrow, and worse
-paved than any I ever saw. The churches are loaded with ornaments, among
-which are many pictures, and images of favourite saints; but the
-pictures are in general wretchedly painted, and the saints are dressed
-in laced clothes. Some of the convents are in a better taste, especially
-that of the Franciscans, which is plain, simple, and neat in the highest
-degree. The infirmary in particular drew our attention as a model which
-might be adopted in other countries with great advantage. It consists of
-a long room, on one side of which are the windows, and an altar for the
-convenience of administering the sacrament to the sick: the other side
-is divided into wards, each of which is just big enough to contain a
-bed, and neatly lined with gally-tiles; behind these wards, and parallel
-to the room in which they stand, there runs a long gallery, with which
-each ward communicates by a door, so that the sick may be separately
-supplied with whatever they want without disturbing their neighbours. In
-this convent there is also a singular curiosity of another kind; a small
-chapel, the whole lining of which, both sides and ceiling, is composed
-of human sculls and thigh-bones; the thigh-bones are laid across each
-other, and a scull is placed in each of the four angles. Among the
-sculls one is very remarkable; the upper and the lower jaw, on one side,
-perfectly and firmly cohere; how the ossification which unites them was
-formed, it is not, perhaps, very easy to conceive, but it is certain
-that the patient must have lived some time without opening his mouth:
-what nourishment he received was conveyed through a hole, which we
-discovered to have been made on the other side, by forcing out some of
-the teeth, in doing which the jaw also seems to have been injured.
-
-We visited the good Fathers of this convent on a Thursday evening, just
-before supper-time, and they received us with great politeness: “We will
-not ask you,” said they, “to sup with us, because we are not prepared;
-but if you will come to-morrow, though it is a fast with us, we will
-have a turkey roasted for you.” This invitation, which showed a
-liberality of sentiment not to have been expected in a convent of
-Portuguese friars at this place, gratified us much, though it was not in
-our power to accept it.
-
-We visited also a convent of nuns, dedicated to _Santa Clara_, and the
-ladies did us the honour to express a particular pleasure in seeing us
-there: they had heard that there were great philosophers among us, and
-not at all knowing what were the objects of philosophical knowledge,
-they asked us several questions that were absurd and extravagant in the
-highest degree; one was, when it would thunder; and another, whether a
-spring of fresh water was to be found any where within the walls of
-their convent, of which it seems they were in great want. It will
-naturally be supposed that our answers to such questions were neither
-satisfactory to the ladies, nor, in their estimation, honourable to us;
-yet their disappointment did not in the least lessen their civility, and
-they talked, without ceasing, during the whole of our visit, which
-lasted about half an hour.
-
-The hills of this country are very high; the highest, Pico Ruivo, rises
-5068 feet, near an English mile, perpendicularly from its base, which is
-much higher than any land that has been measured in Great Britain. The
-sides of these hills are covered with vines to a certain height, above
-which there are woods of chesnut and pine of immense extent, and above
-them forests of wild timber of various kinds not known in Europe;
-particularly two, called by the Portuguese _Mirmulano_ and _Paobranco_,
-the leaves of both which, particularly the _Paobranco_, are so
-beautiful, that these trees would be a great ornament to the gardens of
-Europe.
-
-The number of inhabitants in this island is supposed to be about 80,000,
-and the custom-house duties produce a revenue to the King of Portugal of
-20,000 pounds a-year, clear of all expenses, which might easily be
-doubled by the product of the island, exclusive of the vines, if
-advantage was taken of the excellence of the climate, and the amazing
-fertility of the soil; but this object is utterly neglected by the
-Portuguese. In the trade of the inhabitants of Madeira with Lisbon the
-balance is against them, so that all the Portuguese money naturally
-going thither, the currency of the island is Spanish; there are, indeed,
-a few Portuguese pieces of copper, but they are so scarce that we did
-not see one of them: the Spanish coin is of three denominations;
-Pistereens, worth about a shilling; Bitts, worth about sixpence; and
-Half-bitts, three-pence.
-
-The tides at this place flow at the full and change of the moon, north
-and south; the spring tides rise seven feet perpendicular, and the neap
-tides four. By Dr. Heberden’s observation, the variation of the compass
-here is now 15° 30ʹ West, and decreasing; but I have some doubt whether
-he is not mistaken with respect to its decrease: we found that the North
-point of the dipping needle belonging to the Royal Society dipped 77°
-18ʺ.
-
-The refreshments to be had here are water, wine, fruit of several sorts,
-onions in plenty, and some sweetmeats; fresh meat and poultry are not to
-be had without leave from the governor, and the payment of a very high
-price.
-
-We took in 270 lb. of fresh beef, and a live bullock, charged at 613 lb.
-3032 gallons of water, and ten tons of wine; and in the night, between
-Sunday the 18th and Monday the 19th of September, we set sail in
-prosecution of our voyage.
-
-When Funchiale bore North, 13 East, at the distance of 76 miles, the
-variation appeared by several azimuths to be 16° 30ʹ West.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. II.
-
- THE PASSAGE FROM MADEIRA TO RIO DE JANEIRO, WITH SOME ACCOUNT OF THE
- COUNTRY, AND THE INCIDENTS THAT HAPPENED THERE.
-
-
-ON the 21st of September we saw the islands called the Salvages, to the
-north of the Canaries; when the principal of these bore S. ½ W. at the
-distance of about five leagues, we found the variation of the compass by
-an azimuth to be 17° 50ʹ. I make these islands to lie in latitude 30°
-11ʹ North, and distant 58 leagues from Funchiale in Madeira, in the
-direction of S. 16 E.
-
-On Friday the 23d we saw the Peak of Teneriffe bearing W. by S. ½ S. and
-found the variation of the compass to be from 17° 22ʹ to 16° 30ʹ. The
-height of this mountain, from which I took a new departure, has been
-determined by Dr. Heberden, who has been upon it, to be 15,396 feet,
-which is but 148 yards less than three miles, reckoning the mile at 1760
-yards. Its appearance at sunset was very striking; when the sun was
-below the horizon, and the rest of the island appeared of a deep black,
-the mountain still reflected his rays, and glowed with a warmth of
-colour which no painting can express. There is no eruption of visible
-fire from it, but a heat issues from the chinks near the top, too strong
-to be borne by the hand when it is held near them. We had received from
-Dr. Heberden, among other favours, some salt which he collected on the
-top of the mountain, where it is found in large quantities, and which he
-supposes to be the true _natrum_, or _nitrum_ of the ancients: he gave
-us also some native sulphur exceedingly pure, which he had likewise
-found upon the surface in great plenty.
-
-On the next day, Saturday the 24th, we came into the north-east trade
-wind, and on Friday the 30th saw Bona Vista, one of the Cape de Verd
-islands; we ranged the east side of it, at the distance of three or four
-miles from the shore, till we were obliged to haul off to avoid a ledge
-of rocks which stretch out S. W. by W. from the body, or S. E. point of
-the island, to the extent of a league and a half. Bona Vista, by our
-observation, lies in latitude 16 N. and longitude 21° 5ʹ West.
-
-On the 1st of October, in latitude 14° 6ʹ N. and longitude 22° 10ʹ W. we
-found the variation by a very good azimuth to be 10° 37ʹ W. and the next
-morning it appeared to be 10°. This day we found the ship five miles a
-head of the log, and the next day seven. On the third, hoisted out the
-boat to discover whether there was a current, and found one to the
-eastward, at the rate of three quarters of a mile an hour.
-
-During our course from Teneriffe to Bona Vista we saw great numbers of
-flying fish, which from the cabin windows appear beautiful beyond
-imagination, their sides having the colour and brightness of burnished
-silver; when they are seen from the deck they do not appear to so much
-advantage, because their backs are of a dark colour. We also took a
-shark, which proved to be the _Squalus Carcharias_ of Linnæus.
-
-Having lost the trade wind on the 3d, in latitude 12° 14ʹ, and longitude
-22° 10ʹ, the wind became somewhat variable, and we had light airs and
-calms by turns.
-
-On the 7th, Mr. Banks went out in the boat and took what the seamen call
-a Portuguese man of war; it is the _Holuthuria Physalis_ of Linnæus, and
-a species of the _Mollusca_. It consisted of a small bladder about seven
-inches long, very much resembling the air-bladder of fishes, from the
-bottom of which descended a number of strings, of a bright blue and red,
-some of them three or four feet in length, which, upon being touched,
-sting like a nettle, but with much more force. On the top of the bladder
-is a membrane which is used as a sail, and turned so as to receive the
-wind which way soever it blows: this membrane is marked in fine
-pink-coloured veins, and the animal is in every respect an object
-exquisitely curious and beautiful.
-
-We also took several of the shell-fishes, or testaceous animals, which
-are always found floating upon the water, particularly the _Helix
-Janthina_ and _Violacea_; they are about the size of a snail, and are
-supported upon the surface of the water by a small cluster of bubbles,
-which are filled with air, and consist of a tenacious slimy substance
-that will not easily part with its contents; the animal is oviparous,
-and these bubbles serve also as a _nidus_ for its eggs. It is probable
-that it never goes down to the bottom, nor willingly approaches any
-shore; for the shell is exceedingly brittle, and that of few fresh water
-snails is so thin: every shell contains about a teaspoonful of liquor,
-which it easily discharges upon being touched, and which is of the most
-beautiful red purple that can be conceived. It dies linen cloth, and it
-may perhaps be worth enquiry, as the shell is certainly found in the
-Mediterranean, whether it be not the _Purpura_ of the ancients.
-
-On the 8th, in latitude 8° 25ʹ North, longitude 22° 4ʹ West, we found a
-current setting to the southward, which the next day in latitude 7° 58ʹ,
-longitude 22° 13ʹ, shifted to the N. N. W. ¾ W., at the rate of one mile
-and a furlong an hour. The variation here, by the mean of several
-azimuths, appeared to be 8° 39ʹ W.
-
-On the 10th, Mr. Banks shot the black-toed gull, not yet described
-according to Linnæus’s system; he gave it the name of _Larus
-crepidatus_: it is remarkable that the dung of this bird is of a lively
-red, somewhat like that of the liquor procured from the shells, only not
-so full; its principal food therefore is probably the _Helix_ just
-mentioned. A current to the N. W. prevailed more or less till Monday the
-24th, when we were in latitude 1° 7ʹ N., and longitude 28° 50ʹ.
-
-On the 25th we crossed the line with the usual ceremonies, in longitude
-29° 30ʹ, when, by the result of several very good azimuths, the
-variation was 2° 24ʹ.
-
-On the 28th, at noon, being in the latitude of Ferdinand _Noronha_, and,
-by the mean of several observations by Mr. Green and myself in longitude
-32° 5ʹ 16ʺ W., which is to the westward of it by some charts, and to the
-eastward by others, we expected to see the island, or some of the shoals
-that are laid down in the charts between it and the main, but we saw
-neither one nor the other.
-
-In the evening of the 29th, we observed that luminous appearance of the
-sea which has been so often mentioned by navigators, and of which such
-various causes have been assigned; some supposing it to be occasioned by
-fish, which agitated the water by darting at their prey, some by the
-putrefaction of fish and other marine animals, some by electricity, and
-others referring it into a great variety of different causes. It
-appeared to emit flashes of light exactly resembling those of lightning,
-only not so considerable; but they were so frequent, that sometimes
-eight or ten were visible almost at the same moment. We were of opinion
-that they proceeded from some luminous animal, and upon throwing out the
-casting net our opinion was confirmed: it brought up a species of the
-_Medusa_, which, when it came on board, had the appearance of metal
-violently heated, and emitted a white light: with these animals were
-taken some very small crabs, of three different species, each of which
-gave as much light as a glow-worm, though the creature was not so large
-by nine-tenths: upon examination of these animals Mr. Banks had the
-satisfaction to find that they were all entirely new.
-
-On Wednesday, the 2d of November, about noon, being in the latitude of
-10° 38ʹ S., and longitude 32° 13ʹ 43ʺ W., we passed the line in which
-the needle at this time would have pointed due north and south, without
-any variation: for in the morning, having decreased gradually in its
-deviation for some days, it was no more than 18ʹ W., and in the
-afternoon it was 34ʹ East.
-
-On the 6th, being in latitude 19° 3ʹ South, longitude 35° 50ʹ West, the
-colour of the water was observed to change, upon which we sounded, and
-found ground at the depth of 32 fathoms: the lead was cast three times
-within about four hours, without a foot difference in the depth or
-quality of the bottom, which was coral rock, fine sand, and shells; we
-therefore supposed that we had passed over the tail of the great shoal
-which is laid down in all our charts by the name of _Abrothos_, on which
-Lord Anson struck soundings in his passage outwards: at four the next
-morning we had no ground with 100 fathom.
-
-As several articles of our stock and provisions now began to fall short,
-I determined to put into Rio de Janeiro, rather than at any port in
-Brazil or Falkland’s Islands, knowing that it could better supply us
-with what we wanted, and making no doubt but that we should be well
-received.
-
-On the 8th, at day-break, we saw the coast of Brazil, and about ten
-o’clock we brought to, and spoke with a fishing boat: the people on
-board told us that the land which we saw lay to the southward of _Sancto
-Espirito_, but belonging to the captainship of that place.
-
-Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander went on board this vessel, in which they
-found eleven men, nine of whom were blacks: they all fished with lines;
-and their fresh cargo, the chief part of which Mr. Banks bought,
-consisted of dolphins, large pelagic scombers of two kinds, sea-bream,
-and some of the fish which, in the West Indies, are called Welshmen. Mr.
-Banks had taken Spanish silver with him, which he imagined to be the
-currency of the Continent, but to his great surprise the people asked
-him for English shillings; he gave them two, which he happened to have
-about him, and it was not without some dispute that they took the rest
-of the money in pistereens. Their business seemed to be to catch large
-fish at a good distance from the shore, which they salted in bulk, in a
-place made for that purpose in the middle of their boat: of this
-merchandize they had about two quintals on board, which they offered for
-about 16 shillings, and would probably have sold for half the money. The
-fresh fish, which was bought for about nineteen shillings and sixpence,
-served the whole ship’s company: the salt was not wanted.
-
-The sea-provision of these fishermen consisted of nothing more than a
-cask of water, and a bag of Cassada flour, which they called _Farinha de
-Pao_, or wooden flour; which, indeed, is a name which very well suits
-its taste and appearance. Their water-cask was large, as wide as their
-boat, and exactly fitted a place that was made for it in the ballast; it
-was impossible therefore to draw out any of its contents by a tap, the
-sides being, from the bottom to the top, wholly inaccessible; neither
-could any be taken out by dipping a vessel in at the head, for an
-opening sufficiently wide for that purpose would have endangered the
-loss of great part of it by the rolling of the vessel: their expedient
-to get at their water, so situated, was curious; when one of them wanted
-to drink, he applied to his neighbour, who accompanied him to the
-water-cask with a hollow cane about three feet long, which was open at
-both ends; this he thrust into the cask through a small hole in the top,
-and then, stopping the upper end with the palm of his hand, drew it out;
-the pressure of the air against the other end keeping in the water which
-it contained; to this end the person who wanted to drink applied his
-mouth, and the assistant then taking his hand from the other, and
-admitting the air above, the cane immediately parted with its contents,
-which the drinker drew off till he was satisfied.
-
-We stood off and on along the shore till the 12th, and successively saw
-a remarkable hill near Santo Espirito, then Cape St. Thomas, and then an
-island just without Cape Frio, which in some maps is called the Island
-of Frio, and which being high, with a hollow in the middle, has the
-appearance of two islands when seen at a distance. On this day we stood
-along the shore for Rio de Janeiro, and at nine the next morning made
-sail for the harbour. I then sent Mr. Hicks, my first lieutenant, before
-us in the pinnace, up to the city, to acquaint the Governor, that we put
-in there to procure water and refreshments; and to desire the assistance
-of a pilot to bring us into proper anchoring-ground. I continued to
-stand up the river, trusting to Mr. Bellisle’s draught, published in the
-_Petit Atlas Maritime_, Vol. II. No. 54., which we found very good, till
-five o’clock in the evening, expecting the return of my lieutenant; and
-just as I was about to anchor, above the island of Cobras, which lies
-before the city, the pinnace came back without him, having on board a
-Portuguese officer, but no pilot. The people in the boat told me, that
-my lieutenant was detained by the Viceroy till I should go on shore. We
-came immediately to an anchor; and, almost at the same time, a ten-oared
-boat, full of soldiers, came up and kept rowing round the ship, without
-exchanging a word: in less than a quarter of an hour, another boat came
-on board with several of the Viceroy’s officers, who asked whence we
-came; what was our cargo; the number of men and guns on board; the
-object of our voyage, and several other questions, which we directly and
-truly answered: they then told me, as a kind of apology for detaining my
-lieutenant, and putting an officer on board my pinnace, that it was the
-invariable custom of the place, to detain the first officer who came on
-shore from any ship on her arrival, till a boat from the Viceroy had
-visited her, and to suffer no boat to go either from or to a ship, while
-she lay there, without having a soldier on board. They said that I might
-go on shore when I pleased; but wished that every other person might
-remain on board till the paper which they should draw up had been
-delivered to the Viceroy, promising that, immediately upon their return,
-the lieutenant should be sent on board.
-
-This promise was performed; and on the next morning, the 14th, I went on
-shore, and obtained leave of the Viceroy to purchase provisions and
-refreshments for the ship, provided I would employ one of their own
-people as a factor, but not otherwise. I made some objections to this,
-but he insisted upon it as the custom of the place. I objected also
-against the putting a soldier into the boat every time she went between
-the ship and the shore; but he told me, that this was done by the
-express orders of his court, with which he could in no case dispense. I
-then requested, that the gentlemen whom I had on board might reside on
-shore during our stay, and that Mr. Banks might go up the country to
-gather plants; but this he absolutely refused. I judged from his extreme
-caution, and the severity of these restrictions, that he suspected we
-were come to trade; I therefore took some pains to convince him of the
-contrary. I told him, that we were bound to the southward, by the order
-of His Britannic Majesty, to observe a transit of the planet Venus over
-the sun, an astronomical phænomenon of great importance to navigation.
-Of the transit of Venus, however, he could form no other conception,
-than that it was the passing of the North star through the South Pole;
-for these are the very words of his interpreter, who was a Swede, and
-spoke English very well. I did not think it necessary to ask permission
-for the gentlemen to come on shore during the day, or that, when I was
-on shore myself, I might be at liberty, taking for granted that nothing
-was intended to the contrary; but in this I was unfortunately mistaken.
-As soon as I took leave of His Excellency, I found an officer who had
-orders to attend me wherever I went: of this I desired an explanation,
-and was told that it was meant as a compliment. I earnestly desired to
-be excused from accepting such an honour, but the good Viceroy would by
-no means suffer it to be dispensed with.
-
-With this officer, therefore, I returned on board about twelve o’clock,
-where I was impatiently expected by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, who made
-no doubt but that a fair account of us having been given by the officers
-who had been on board the evening before, in their paper called a
-_Practica_, and every scruple of the Viceroy removed in my conference
-with His Excellency, they should immediately be at liberty to go on
-shore, and dispose of themselves as they pleased. Their disappointment
-at receiving my report may easily be conceived; and it was still
-increased by an account, that it had been resolved, not only to prevent
-their residing on shore, and going up the country, but even their
-leaving the ship; orders having been given that no person, except the
-captain, and such common sailors as were required to be upon duty,
-should be permitted to land; and that there was probably a particular
-view to the passengers in this prohibition, as they were reported to be
-gentlemen sent abroad to make observations and discoveries, and were
-uncommonly qualified for that purpose. In the evening, however, Mr.
-Banks and Dr. Solander dressed themselves, and attempted to go on shore,
-in order to make a visit to the Viceroy; but they were stopped by the
-guard-boat which had come off with our pinnace, and which kept hovering
-round the ship all the while she lay here, for that purpose; the officer
-on board saying, that he had particular orders, which he could not
-disobey, to suffer no passenger, nor any officer, except the captain, to
-pass the boat. After much expostulation to no purpose, they were
-obliged, with whatever reluctance and mortification, to return on board.
-I then went on shore myself, but found the Viceroy inflexible; he had
-one answer ready for every thing I could say, that the restrictions
-under which he had laid us were in obedience to the King of Portugal’s
-commands, and therefore indispensable.
-
-In this situation I determined, rather than be made a prisoner in my own
-boat, to go on shore no more; for the officer who, under pretence of a
-compliment, attended me when I was ashore, insisted also upon going with
-me to and from the ship: but still imagining, that the scrupulous
-vigilance of the Viceroy must proceed from some mistaken notion about
-us, which might more easily be removed by writing than in conversation,
-I drew up a memorial, and Mr. Banks drew up another, which we sent on
-shore. These memorials were both answered, but by no means to our
-satisfaction; we therefore replied: in consequence of which, several
-other papers were interchanged between us and the Viceroy, but still
-without effect. However, as I thought some degree of force, on the part
-of the Viceroy, to enforce these restrictions, necessary to justify my
-acquiescence in them to the Admiralty, I gave orders to my lieutenant,
-Mr. Hicks, when I sent him with our last reply on Sunday the 20th, in
-the evening, not to suffer a guard to be put into his boat. When the
-officer on board the guard-boat found that Mr. Hicks was determined to
-obey my orders, he did not proceed to force, but attended him to the
-landing-place, and reported the matter to the Viceroy. Upon this His
-Excellency refused to receive the memorial, and ordered Mr. Hicks to
-return to the ship; when he came back to the boat, he found that a guard
-had been put on board in his absence, but he absolutely refused to
-return till the soldier was removed: the officer then proceeded to
-enforce the Viceroy’s orders; he seized all the boat’s crew, and sent
-them under an armed force to prison, putting Mr. Hicks, at the same
-time, into one of their own boats, and sending him under a guard back to
-the ship. As soon as he had reported these particulars, I wrote again to
-the Viceroy, demanding my boat and crew, and in my letter inclosed the
-memorial which he had refused to receive from Mr. Hicks: these papers I
-sent by a petty officer, that I might wave the dispute about a guard,
-against which I had never objected except when there was a commissioned
-officer on board the boat. The petty officer was permitted to go on
-shore with his guard, and, having delivered his letter, was told that an
-answer would be sent the next day.
-
-About eight o’clock this evening it began to blow very hard in sudden
-gusts from the south, and our long-boat coming on board just at this
-time with four pipes of rum, the rope which was thrown to her from the
-ship, and which was taken hold of by the people on board, unfortunately
-broke, and the boat, which had come to the ship before the wind, went
-adrift to windward of her, with a small skiff of Mr. Banks’s that was
-fastened to her stern. This was a great misfortune, as the pinnace being
-detained on shore, we had no boat on board but a four-oared yawl: the
-yawl, however, was immediately manned and sent to her assistance; but,
-notwithstanding the utmost effort of the people in both boats, they were
-very soon out of sight: far, indeed, we could not see at that time in
-the evening, but the distance was enough to convince us that they were
-not under command, which gave us great uneasiness, as we knew they must
-drive directly upon a reef of rocks which ran out just to leeward of
-where we lay: after waiting some hours in the utmost anxiety, we gave
-them over for lost, but, about three o’clock the next morning, had the
-satisfaction to see all the people come on board in the yawl. From them
-we learnt, that the long-boat having filled with water they had brought
-her to a grappling, and left her; and that, having fallen in with the
-reef of rocks in their return to the ship, they had been obliged to cut
-Mr. Banks’s little boat adrift. As the loss of our long-boat, which we
-had now too much reason to apprehend, would have been an unspeakable
-disadvantage to us, considering the nature of our expedition, I sent
-another letter to the Viceroy, as soon as I thought he could be seen,
-acquainting him with our misfortune, and requesting the assistance of a
-boat from the shore for the recovery of our own; I also renewed my
-demand that the pinnace and her crew should be no longer detained: after
-some delay, His Excellency thought fit to comply both with my request
-and demand; and the same day we happily recovered both the long-boat and
-skiff, with the rum, but every thing else that was on board was lost. On
-the 23d, the Viceroy, in his answer to my remonstrance against seizing
-my men and detaining the boat, acknowledged that I had been treated with
-some incivility, but said that the resistance of my officers to what he
-had declared to be the King’s orders made it absolutely necessary; he
-also expressed some doubts whether the Endeavour, considering her
-structure and other circumstances, was in the service of His Majesty,
-though I had before showed him my commission: to this I answered in
-writing, that, to remove all scruples, I was ready to produce my
-commission again. His Excellency’s scruples, however, still remained,
-and in his reply to my letter he not only expressed them in still
-plainer terms, but accused my people of smuggling. This charge, I am
-confident, was without the least foundation in truth. Mr. Banks’s
-servants had indeed found means to go on shore on the 22d at day-break,
-and stay till it was dark in the evening, but they brought on board only
-plants and insects, having been sent for no other purpose. And I had the
-greatest reason to believe that not a single article was smuggled by any
-of our people who were admitted on shore, though many artful means were
-used to tempt them, even by the very officers that were under His
-Excellency’s roof, which made the charge still more injurious and
-provoking. I have indeed some reason to suspect that one poor fellow
-bought a single bottle of rum with some of the clothes upon his back;
-and in my answer I requested of His Excellency, that, if such an attempt
-at illicit trade should be repeated, he would without scruple order the
-offender to be taken into custody. And thus ended our altercation, both
-by conference and writing, with the Viceroy of Rio de Janeiro.
-
-A friar in the town having requested the assistance of our surgeon, Dr.
-Solander easily got admittance in that character on the 25th, and
-received many marks of civility from the people. On the 26th, before
-day-break, Mr. Banks also found means to elude the vigilance of the
-people in the guard-boat, and got on shore; he did not, however, go into
-the town, for the principal objects of his curiosity were to be found in
-the fields: to him also the people behaved with great civility, many of
-them invited him to their houses, and he bought a porker and some other
-things of them for the ship’s company; the porker, which was by no means
-lean, cost him eleven shillings, and he paid something less than two for
-a Muscovy duck.
-
-On the 27th, when the boats returned from watering, the people told us
-there was a report in town, that search was making after some persons
-who had been on shore from the ship without the Viceroy’s permission:
-these persons we conjectured to be Dr. Solander and Mr. Banks, and
-therefore they determined to go on shore no more.
-
-On the first of December, having got our water and other necessaries on
-board, I sent to the Viceroy for a pilot to carry us to sea, who came
-off to us; but the wind preventing us from getting out, we took on board
-a plentiful supply of fresh beef, yams, and greens for the ship’s
-company. On the 2d, a Spanish packet arrived, with letters from Buenos
-Ayres for Spain, commanded by Don Antonio de Monte Negro y Velasco, who
-with great politeness offered to take our letters to Europe: I accepted
-the favour, and gave him a packet for the secretary of the Admiralty,
-containing copies of all the papers that had passed between me and the
-Viceroy; leaving also duplicates with the Viceroy, to be by him
-forwarded to Lisbon.
-
-On Monday, the 5th, it being a dead calm, we weighed anchor and towed
-down the bay; but, to our great astonishment, when we got abreast of
-Santa Cruz, the principal fortification, two shot were fired at us. We
-immediately cast anchor, and sent to the fort to enquire the reason of
-what had happened; our people brought us word, that the commandant had
-received no order from the Viceroy to let us pass; and that, without
-such an order, no vessel was ever suffered to go below the fort. It was
-now, therefore, become necessary, that we should send to the Viceroy, to
-enquire why the necessary order had not been given, as he had notice of
-our departure, and had thought fit to write me a polite letter, wishing
-me a good voyage. Our messenger soon returned with an account, that the
-order had been written some days, but, by an unaccountable negligence,
-not sent.
-
-We did not get under sail till the 7th; and, when we had passed the
-fort, the pilot desired to be discharged. As soon as he was dismissed,
-we were left by our guard-boat, which had hovered about us from the
-first hour of our being in this place to the last; and Mr. Banks, having
-been prevented from going ashore at Rio de Janeiro, availed himself of
-her departure to examine the neighbouring islands, where, particularly
-on one in the mouth of the harbour, called Raza, he gathered many
-species of plants, and caught a variety of insects.
-
-It is remarkable, that, during the last three or four days of our
-staying in this harbour, the air was loaded with butterflies: they were
-chiefly of one sort, but in such numbers that thousands were in view in
-every direction, and the greatest part of them above our mast-head.
-
-We lay here from the 14th of November to the 7th of December, something
-more than three weeks, during which time Mr. Monkhouse, our surgeon, was
-on shore every day to buy our provisions; Dr. Solander was on shore
-once; I was several times on shore myself, and Mr. Banks also found
-means to get into the country, notwithstanding the watch that was set
-over us. I shall, therefore, with the intelligence obtained from these
-gentlemen, and my own observations, give some account of the town, and
-the country adjacent.
-
-Rio de Janeiro, or the river of Januarius, was probably so called from
-its having been discovered on the feast-day of that saint; and the town,
-which is the capital of the Portuguese dominions in America, derives its
-name from the river, which, indeed, is rather an arm of the sea, for it
-did not appear to receive any considerable stream of fresh water: it
-stands on a plain, close to the shore, on the west side of the bay, at
-the foot of several high mountains which rise behind it. It is neither
-ill designed nor ill built: the houses, in general, are of stone, and
-two stories high; every house having, after the manner of the
-Portuguese, a little balcony before its windows, and a lattice of wood
-before the balcony. I computed its circuit to be about three miles; for
-it appears to be equal in size to the largest country towns in England,
-Bristol and Liverpool not excepted: the streets are straight, and of a
-convenient breadth, intersecting each other at right angles; the greater
-part, however, lie in a line with the citadel called St. Sebastian,
-which stands on the top of a hill that commands the town.
-
-It is supplied with water from the neighbouring hills, by an aqueduct,
-which is raised upon two stories of arches, and is said in some places
-to be at a great height from the ground, from which the water is
-conveyed by pipes into a fountain in the great square that exactly
-fronts the Viceroy’s palace. At this fountain great numbers of people
-are continually waiting for their turn to draw water; and the soldiers,
-who are posted at the governor’s door, find it very difficult to
-maintain any regularity among them. The water at this fountain, however,
-is so bad, that we, who had been two months at sea, confined to that in
-our casks, which was almost always foul, could not drink it with
-pleasure. Water of a better quality is laid into some other part of the
-town, but I could not learn by what means.
-
-The churches are very fine, and there is more religious parade in this
-place than in any of the Popish countries in Europe: there is a
-procession of some parish every day, with various insignia, all splendid
-and costly in the highest degree: they beg money, and say prayers in
-great form, at the corner of every street.
-
-While we lay here, one of the churches was rebuilding; and to defray the
-expense, the parish to which it belonged had leave to beg in procession
-through the whole city once a week, by which very considerable sums were
-collected. At this ceremony, which was performed by night, all the boys
-of a certain age were obliged to assist, the sons of gentlemen not being
-excused. Each of these boys was dressed in a black cassock, with a short
-red cloak, hanging about as low as the waist, and carried in his hand a
-pole about six or seven feet long, at the end of which was tied a
-lantern: the number of lanterns was generally above two hundred, and the
-light they gave was so great, that the people who saw it from the cabin
-windows thought the town had been on fire.
-
-The inhabitants, however, may pay their devotions at the shrine of any
-saint in the calendar, without waiting till there is a procession; for
-before almost every house there is a little cupboard, furnished with a
-glass window, in which one of these tutelary powers is waiting to be
-gracious; and to prevent his being out of mind, by being out of sight, a
-lamp is kept constantly burning before the window of his tabernacle in
-the night. The people, indeed, are by no means remiss in their
-devotions, for before these saints they pray and sing hymns with such
-vehemence, that in the night they were very distinctly heard on board
-the ship, though she lay at the distance of at least half a mile from
-the town.
-
-The government here, as to its form, is mixed; it is notwithstanding
-very despotic in fact. It consists of the Viceroy, the governor of the
-town, and a council, the number of which I could not learn: without the
-consent of this council, in which the Viceroy has a casting vote, no
-judicial act should be performed; yet both the Viceroy and Governor
-frequently commit persons to prison at their own pleasure, and sometimes
-send them to Lisbon, without acquainting their friends or family with
-what is laid to their charge, or where they may be found.
-
-To restrain the people from travelling into the country, and getting
-into any district where gold or diamonds may be found, of both which
-there is much more than the government can otherwise secure, certain
-bounds are prescribed them, at the discretion of the Viceroy, sometimes
-at a few, and sometimes at many miles’ distance from the city. On the
-verge of these limits a guard constantly patroles, and whoever is found
-beyond it, is immediately seized and thrown into prison; and if a man
-is, upon any pretence, taken up by the guard without the limits, he will
-be sent to prison, though it should appear that he did not know their
-extent.
-
-The inhabitants, which are very numerous, consist of Portuguese,
-negroes, and Indians, the original natives of the country. The township
-of Rio, which, as I was told, is but a small part of the Capitanea, or
-province, is said to contain 37,000 white persons, and 629,000 blacks,
-many of whom are free; making together 666,000 in the proportion of
-seventeen to one. The Indians, who are employed to do the King’s work in
-this neighbourhood, can scarcely be considered as inhabitants; their
-residence is at a distance, from whence they come by turns to their
-task, which they are obliged to perform for a small pay. The guard-boat
-was constantly rowed by these people, who are of a light copper colour,
-and have long black hair.
-
-The military establishment here consists of twelve regiments of regular
-troops, six of which are Portuguese and six Creoles; and twelve other
-regiments of provincial militia. To the regulars the inhabitants behave
-with the utmost humility and submission; and I was told, that if any of
-them should neglect to take off his hat upon meeting an officer, he
-would immediately be knocked down. These haughty severities render the
-people extremely civil to any stranger who has the appearance of a
-gentleman. But the subordination of the officers themselves to the
-Viceroy is enforced with circumstances equally mortifying, for they are
-obliged to attend in his hall three times every day to ask his commands;
-the answer constantly is, “There is nothing new.” I have been told, that
-this servile attendance is exacted to prevent their going into the
-country; and if so, it effectually answers the purpose.
-
-It is, I believe, universally allowed, that the women, both of the
-Spanish and Portuguese settlements in South America, make less
-difficulty of granting personal favours, than those of any other
-civilized country in the world. Of the ladies of this town some have
-formed so unfavourable an opinion as to declare, that they did not
-believe there was a modest one among them. This censure is certainly too
-general; but what Dr. Solander saw of them when he was on shore, gave
-him no very exalted idea of their chastity: he told me, that as soon as
-it was dark, one or more of them appeared in every window, and
-distinguished those whom they liked, among the gentlemen that walked
-past them, by giving them nosegays; that he, and two gentlemen who were
-with him, received so many of these favours, that, at the end of their
-walk, which was not a long one, they threw whole hatfuls of them away.
-Great allowance must certainly be made for local customs; that which in
-one country would be an indecent familiarity, is a mere act of general
-courtesy in another; of the fact, therefore, which I have related, I
-shall say nothing, but that I am confident it is true.
-
-Neither will I take upon me to affirm, that murders are frequently
-committed here; but the churches afford an asylum to the criminal: and
-as our cockswain was one day looking at two men, who appeared to be
-talking together in a friendly manner, one of them suddenly drew a
-knife, and stabbed the other; who not instantly falling, the murderer
-withdrew the weapon, and stabbed him a second time. He then ran away,
-and was pursued by some negroes who were also witnesses of the fact; but
-whether he escaped or was taken I never heard.
-
-The country, at a small distance round the town, which is all that any
-of us saw, is beautiful in the highest degree; the wildest spots being
-varied with a greater luxuriance of flowers, both as to number and
-beauty, than the best gardens in England.
-
-Upon the trees and bushes sat an almost endless variety of birds,
-especially small ones, many of them covered with the most elegant
-plumage; among which were the humming-bird. Of insects, too, there was a
-great variety, and some of them very beautiful; but they were much more
-nimble than those of Europe, especially the butterflies, most of which
-flew near the tops of the trees, and were, therefore, very difficult to
-be caught, except when the sea breeze blew fresh, which kept them nearer
-to the ground.
-
-The banks of the sea, and of the small brooks which water this part of
-the country, are almost covered with the small crabs called _Cancer
-vocans_; some of these had one of the claws called by naturalists the
-hand, very large; others had them both remarkably small, and of equal
-size, a difference which is said to distinguish the sexes, that with the
-large claw being the male.
-
-There is the appearance of but little cultivation; the greater part of
-the land is wholly uncultivated, and very little care and labour seem to
-have been bestowed upon the rest; there are, indeed, little patches or
-gardens, in which many kinds of European garden stuff are produced,
-particularly cabbages, peas, beans, kidney beans, turnips, and white
-radishes, but all much inferior to our own: water-melons and pine-apples
-are also produced in these spots, and they are the only fruits that we
-saw cultivated, though the country produces musk, melons, oranges,
-limes, lemons, sweet lemons, citrons, plantains, bananas, mangos, mamane
-apples, acajou or cashou apples and nuts; jamboira of two kinds, one of
-which bears a small black fruit; cocoa-nuts, mangos, palm-nuts of two
-kinds, one long, the other round; and palm-berries; all which were in
-season while we were there.
-
-Of these fruits the water-melons and oranges are the best in their kind;
-the pine-apples are much inferior to those that I have eaten in England;
-they are, indeed, more juicy and sweet, but have no flavour: I believe
-them to be natives of this country, though we heard of none that at this
-time grow wild; they have, however, very little care bestowed upon them,
-the plants being set between beds of any kind of garden-stuff, and
-suffered to take the chance of the season. The melons are still worse,
-at least those that we tasted, which were mealy and insipid; but the
-water-melons are excellent; they have a flavour, at least a degree of
-acidity which ours have not. We saw also several species of the prickle
-pear, and some European fruits, particularly the apple and peach, both
-which were very mealy and insipid. In these gardens also grow yams and
-mandihoca, which in the West Indies is called Cassada or Cassava, and to
-the flower of which the people here, as I have before observed, give the
-name of _Farinha de Pao_, which may not improperly be translated, Powder
-of Post. The soil, though it produces tobacco and sugar, will not
-produce bread-corn; so that the people here have no wheat-flour, but
-what is brought from Portugal, and sold at the rate of a shilling a
-pound, though it is generally spoiled by being heated in its passage.
-Mr. Banks is of opinion, that all the products of our West Indian
-islands would grow here; notwithstanding which, the inhabitants import
-their coffee and chocolate from Lisbon.
-
-Most of the land, as far we saw of the country, is laid down in grass,
-upon which cattle are pastured in great plenty; but they are so lean,
-that an Englishman will scarcely eat of their flesh: the herbage of
-these pastures consists principally of cresses, and consequently is so
-short, that though it may afford a bite for horses and sheep, it can
-scarcely be grazed by horned cattle in a sufficient quantity to keep
-them alive.
-
-This country may possibly produce many valuable drugs; but we could not
-find any in the apothecaries’ shops, except pariera brava, and balsam
-capivi; both of which were excellent in their kind, and sold at a very
-low price. The drug trade is probably carried on to the northward, as
-well as that of the dying woods, for we could get no intelligence of
-either of them here.
-
-As to manufactures, we neither saw nor heard of any except that of
-cotton hammocks, in which people are carried about here, as they are
-with us in sedan chairs; and these are principally, if not wholly,
-fabricated by the Indians.
-
-The riches of the place consist chiefly in the mines, which we supposed
-to lie far up the country, though we could never learn where, or at what
-distance; for the situation is concealed as much as possible, and troops
-are continually employed in guarding the roads that lead to them: it is
-almost impossible for any man to get a sight of them, except those who
-are employed there; and, indeed, the strongest curiosity would scarcely
-induce any man to attempt it, for whoever is found upon the road to
-them, if he cannot give undeniable evidence of his having business
-there, is immediately hanged up upon the next tree.
-
-Much gold is certainly brought from these mines, but at an expense of
-life that must strike every man, to whom custom has not made it
-familiar, with horror. No less than forty thousand negroes are annually
-imported on the king’s account, to dig the mines; and we were credibly
-informed, that the last year but one before we arrived here this number
-fell so short, probably from some epidemic disease that twenty thousand
-more were draughted from the town of Rio.
-
-Precious stones are also found here in such plenty, that a certain
-quantity only is allowed to be collected in a year; to collect this
-quantity, a number of people are sent into the country where they are
-found, and when it is got together, which sometimes happens in a month,
-sometimes in less, and sometimes in more, they return; and after that,
-whoever is found in these precious districts, on any pretence, before
-the next year, is immediately put to death.
-
-The jewels found here are diamonds, topazes of several kinds, and
-amethysts. We did not see any of the diamonds, but were informed that
-the Viceroy had a large quantity by him, which he would sell on the King
-of Portugal’s account, but not at a less price than they are sold for in
-Europe. Mr. Banks bought a few topazes and amethysts as specimens: of
-the topazes there are three sorts, of very different value, which are
-distinguished here by the names of Pinga d’agua qualidade primeiro,
-Pinga d’agua qualidade secundo, and Chrystallos armerillos: they are
-sold, large and small, good and bad together, by octavos, or the eighth
-part of an ounce; the best at 4s. 9d. All dealing, however, in these
-stones is prohibited to the subject under the severest penalties: there
-were jewellers here formerly, who purchased and worked them on their own
-account; but about fourteen months before our arrival, orders came from
-the court of Portugal, that no more stones should be wrought here,
-except on the King’s account: the jewellers were ordered to bring all
-their tools to the Viceroy, and left without any means of subsistence.
-The persons employed here to work stones for the King are slaves.
-
-The coin that is current here, is either that of Portugal, consisting
-chiefly of thirty-six shillings pieces; or pieces, both of gold and
-silver, which are struck at this place: the pieces of silver, which are
-very much debased, are called Petacks, and are of different value, and
-easily distinguished by the number of rees that is marked on the
-outside. Here is also a copper coin, like that in Portugal, of five and
-ten ree pieces. A ree is a nominal coin of Portugal, ten of which are
-equal in value to about three farthings sterling.
-
-The harbour of Rio de Janeiro is situated W. by N. 18 leagues from Cape
-Frio, and may be known by a remarkable hill, in the form of a
-sugar-loaf, at the west point of the bay; but as all the coast is very
-high, and rises in many peaks, the entrance of this harbour may be more
-certainly distinguished by the islands that lie before it; one of which,
-called Rodonda, is high and round, like a hay-stack, and lies at the
-distance of two leagues and a half from the entrance of the bay, in the
-direction of S. by W.; but the first islands which are met with, coming
-from the east, or Cape Frio, are two that have a rocky appearance, lying
-near to each other, and at the distance of about four miles from the
-shore: there are also at the distance of three leagues to the westward
-of these two other islands, which lie near to each other, a little
-without the bay on the east side, and very near the shore. This harbour
-is certainly a good one; the entrance, indeed, is not wide, but the
-sea-breeze, which blows every day from ten or twelve o’clock till sunset
-makes it easy for any ship to go in before the wind; and it grows wider
-as the town is approached, so that abreast of it there is room for the
-largest fleet, in five or six fathom water, with an oozy bottom. At the
-narrow part, the entrance is defended by two forts. The principal is
-Santa Cruz, which stands on the east point of the bay, and has been
-mentioned before; that on the west side is called fort Lozia, and is
-built upon a rock that lies close to the main; the distance between them
-is about ¾ of a mile, but the channel is not quite so broad, because
-there are sunken rocks which lie off each fort, and in this part alone
-there is danger: the narrowness of the channel causes the tides, both
-flood and ebb, to run with considerable strength, so that they cannot be
-stemmed without a fresh breeze. The rockiness of the bottom makes it
-also unsafe to anchor here; but all danger may be avoided by keeping in
-the middle of the channel. Within the entrance, the course up the bay is
-first N. by W. ½ W., and N. N. W., something more than a league; this
-will bring the vessel the length of the great road; and N. W. and W. N.
-W. one league more will carry her to the Isle dos Cobras, which lies
-before the city: she should then keep the north side of this island
-close on board, and anchor above it, before a monastery of Benedictines,
-which stands upon a hill at the N. W. end of the city.
-
-The river, and, indeed, the whole coast, abounds with a greater variety
-of fish than we had ever seen; a day seldom passed in which one or more
-of a new species were not brought to Mr. Banks: the bay also is as well
-adapted for catching these fish as can be conceived; for it is full of
-small islands, between which there is shallow water, and proper beaches
-for drawing the seine. The sea, without the bay, abounds with dolphins,
-and large mackarel of different kinds, which readily bite at a hook, and
-the inhabitants always tow one after their boats for that purpose.
-
-Though the climate is hot, the situation of this place is certainly
-wholesome; while we stayed here the thermometer never rose higher than
-83 degrees.
-
-We had frequent rains, and once a very hard gale of wind.
-
-Ships water here at the fountain in the great square, though, as I have
-observed, the water is not good: they land their casks upon a smooth
-sandy beach, which is not more than a hundred yards distant from the
-fountain; and, upon application to the Viceroy, a sentinel will be
-appointed to look after them, and clear the way to the fountain where
-they are to be filled.
-
-Upon the whole, Rio de Janeiro is a very good place for ships to put in
-at that want refreshment: the harbour is safe and commodious; and
-provisions, except wheaten bread and flour, may be easily procured: as a
-succedaneum for bread, there are yams and cassada in plenty; beef, both
-fresh and jerked, may be bought at about two-pence farthing a pound;
-though, as I have before remarked, it is very lean. The people here jerk
-their beef by taking out the bones, cutting it into large but thin
-slices, then curing it with salt, and drying it in the shade: it eats
-very well, and, if kept dry, will remain good a long time at sea. Mutton
-is scarcely to be procured, and hogs and poultry are dear; of
-garden-stuff and fruit-trees there is abundance, of which, however, none
-can be preserved at sea but the pumpkin; rum, sugar, and molasses, all
-excellent in their kind, may be had at a reasonable price; tobacco also
-is cheap, but it is not good. Here is a yard for building shipping, and
-a small hulk to heave down by; for as the tide never rises above six or
-seven feet, there is no other way of coming at a ship’s bottom.
-
-When the boat which had been sent on shore returned, we hoisted her on
-board, and stood out to sea.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. III.
-
- THE PASSAGE FROM RIO DE JANEIRO TO THE ENTRANCE OF THE STREIGHT OF LE
-MAIRE, WITH A DESCRIPTION OF SOME OF THE INHABITANTS OF TERRA DEL FUEGO.
-
-
-ON the 9th of December we observed the sea to be covered with broad
-streaks of a yellowish colour, several of them a mile long, and three or
-four hundred yards wide; some of the water thus coloured was taken up,
-and found to be full of innumerable atoms, pointed at the end, of a
-yellowish colour, and none more than a quarter of a line, or the
-fortieth part of an inch long; in the microscope they appeared to be
-_Fasciculi_ of small fibres interwoven with each other, not unlike the
-nidus of some of the _Phyganeas_, called Caddices; but whether they were
-animal or vegetable substances, whence they came, or for what they were
-designed, neither Mr. Banks nor Dr. Solander could guess. The same
-appearance had been observed before, when we first discovered the
-Continent of South America.
-
-On the 11th we hooked a shark, and while we were playing it under the
-cabin window, it threw out, and drew in again, several times, what
-appeared to be its stomach: it proved to be a female, and upon being
-opened six young ones were taken out of it; five of them were alive, and
-swam briskly in a tub of water, but the sixth appeared to have been dead
-some time.
-
-Nothing remarkable happened till the 30th, except that we prepared for
-the bad weather, which we were shortly to expect, by bending a new suit
-of sails; but on this day we ran a course of one hundred and sixty miles
-by the log, through innumerable land insects of various kinds, some upon
-the wing, and more upon the water, many of which were alive; they
-appeared to be exactly the same with the _Carabi_, the _Grylli_, the
-_Phalanæ_, _Aranea_, and other flies that are seen in England, though at
-this time we could not be less than thirty leagues from land; and some
-of these insects, particularly the _Grylli Aranea_, never voluntarily
-leave it at a greater distance than twenty yards. We judged ourselves to
-be now nearly opposite to _Baye sans fond_, where Mr. Dalrymple supposes
-there is a passage quite through the continent of America; and we
-thought from the insects that there might be at least a very large
-river, and that it had overflowed its banks.
-
-On the 3d of January, 1769, being in latitude 47° 17ʹ S. and longitude
-61° 29ʹ 45ʺ W., we were all looking out for Pepys’ island, and for some
-time an appearance was seen in the east which so much resembled land,
-that we bore away for it; and it was more than two hours and a half
-before we were convinced that it was nothing but what sailors call a
-fog-bank.
-
-The people now beginning to complain of cold, each of them received what
-is called a Magellanic jacket, and a pair of trowsers. The jacket is
-made of a thick woollen stuff, called _Fearnought_, which is provided by
-the government. We saw, from time to time, a great number of penguins,
-albatrosses, and sheerwaters, seals, whales, and porpoises; and on the
-11th, having passed Falkland’s islands, we discovered the coast of Terra
-del Fuego, at the distance of about four leagues, extending from the W.
-to S. E. by S. We had here five-and-thirty fathom, the ground soft,
-small slate stones. As we ranged along the shore to the S. E., at the
-distance of two or three leagues, we perceived smoke in several places,
-which was made by the natives, probably as a signal, for they did not
-continue it after we had passed by. This day we discovered that the ship
-had got near a degree of longitude to the westward of the log, which, in
-this latitude, is 35 minutes of a degree on the equator: probably there
-is a small current setting to the westward, which may be caused by the
-westerly current coming round Cape Horn, and through the Streight of Le
-Maire, and the indraught of the Streight of Magellan.[1]
-
-Having continued to range the coast, on the 14th we entered the Streight
-of Le Maire; but the tide turning against us, drove us out with great
-violence, and raised such a sea off Cape St. Deigo, that the waves had
-exactly the same appearance as they would have had if they had broke
-over a ledge of rocks; and when the ship was in this torrent, she
-frequently pitched, so that the bowsprit was under water. About noon, we
-got under the land between Cape St. Deigo and Cape St. Vincent, where I
-intended to have anchored; but finding the ground every where hard and
-rocky, and shallowing from thirty to twelve fathoms, I sent the master
-to examine a little cove which lay at a small distance to the eastward
-of Cape St. Vincent. When he returned, he reported that there was
-anchorage in four fathom, and a good bottom, close to the eastward, of
-the first bluff point, on the east of Cape St. Vincent, at the very
-entrance of the cove, to which I gave the name of VINCENT’s Bay: before
-this anchoring ground, however, lay several rocky ledges, that were
-covered with sea-weed; but I was told that there was not less than eight
-and nine fathom over all of them. It will probably be thought strange,
-that where weeds, which grow at the bottom, appear above the surface,
-there should be this depth of water; but the weeds which grow upon rocky
-ground in these countries, and which always distinguish it from sand and
-ooze, are of an enormous size. The leaves are four feet long, and some
-of the stalks, though not thicker than a man’s thumb, above one hundred
-and twenty. Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander examined some of them, over which
-we sounded and had fourteen fathom, which is eighty-four feet; and, as
-they made a very acute angle with the bottom, they were thought to be at
-least one half longer: the foot-stalks were swelled into an air vessel,
-and Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander called this plant _Fucus giganteus_. Upon
-the report of the master, I stood in with the ship; but not trusting
-implicitly to his intelligence, I continued to sound, and found but four
-fathom upon the first ledge that I went over; concluding, therefore,
-that I could not anchor here without risk, I determined to seek some
-port in the Streight, where I might get on board such wood and water as
-we wanted.
-
-Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, however, being very desirous to go on shore,
-I sent a boat with them and their people, while I kept plying as near as
-possible with the ship.
-
-Having been on shore four hours, they returned about nine in the
-evening, with above an hundred different plants and flowers, all of them
-wholly unknown to the botanists of Europe. They found the country about
-the bay to be in general flat, the bottom of it in particular was a
-plain covered with grass, which might easily have been made into a large
-quantity of hay; they found also abundance of good wood and water, and
-fowl in great plenty. Among other things, of which nature has been
-liberal in this place, is Winter’s bark, _Winteranea aromatica_; which
-may easily be known by its broad leaf, shaped like the laurel, of a
-light green colour without, and inclining to blue within; the bark is
-easily stripped with a bone or a stick, and its virtues are well known;
-it may be used for culinary purposes as a spice, and is not less
-pleasant than wholesome: here is also plenty of wild celery and
-scurvy-grass. The trees are chiefly of one kind, a species of the birch,
-called _Betula antarctica_; the stem is from thirty to forty feet long,
-and from two to three feet in diameter, so that in a case of necessity
-they might possibly supply a ship with top-masts; they are a light white
-wood, bear a small leaf, and cleave very straight. Cranberries were also
-found here in great plenty, both white and red.
-
-The persons who landed saw none of the inhabitants, but fell in with two
-of their deserted huts, one in a thick wood, and the other close by the
-beach.
-
-Having taken the boat on board, I made sail into the Streight, and at
-three in the morning of the 15th I anchored in twelve fathom and a half,
-upon coral rocks, before a small cove, which we took for Port Maurice,
-at the distance of about half a mile from the shore. Two of the natives
-came down to the beach, expecting us to land; but this spot afforded so
-little shelter, that I at length determined not to examine it; I
-therefore got under sail again about ten o’clock, and the savages
-retired into the woods.
-
-At two o’clock, we anchored in the bay of Good Success; and after dinner
-I went on shore, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, to look for
-a watering-place, and speak to the Indians, several of whom had come in
-sight. We landed on the starboard side of the bay near some rocks, which
-made smooth water and good landing: thirty or forty of the Indians soon
-made their appearance at the end of a sandy beach on the other side of
-the bay, but seeing our number, which was ten or twelve, they retreated.
-Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander then advanced about one hundred yards before
-us, upon which two of the Indians returned, and, having advanced some
-paces towards them, sat down: as soon as they came up, the Indians rose,
-and each of them having a small stick in his hand threw it away, in a
-direction both from themselves and the strangers, which was considered
-as the renunciation of weapons in token of peace: they then walked
-briskly towards their companions, who had halted at about fifty yards
-behind them, and beckoned the gentlemen to follow, which they did. They
-were received with many uncouth signs of friendship; and, in return,
-they distributed among them some beads and ribbons, which had been
-brought on shore for that purpose, and with which they were greatly
-delighted. A mutual confidence and good-will being thus produced, our
-parties joined: the conversation, such as it was, became general; and
-three of them accompanied us back to the ship. When they came on board,
-one of them, whom we took to be a priest, performed much the same
-ceremonies which M. Bougainville describes, and supposes to be an
-exorcism. When he was introduced into a new part of the ship, or when
-any thing that he had not seen before caught his attention, he shouted
-with all his force for some minutes, without directing his voice either
-to us or his companions.
-
-They eat some bread and some beef, but not apparently with much
-pleasure, though such part of what was given them as they did not eat
-they took away with them; but they would not swallow a drop either of
-wine or spirits: they put the glass to their lips, but, having tasted
-the liquor, they returned it, with strong expressions of disgust.
-Curiosity seems to be one of the few passions which distinguish men from
-brutes; and of this our guests appeared to have very little. They went
-from one part of the ship to another, and looked at the vast variety of
-new objects that every moment presented themselves, without any
-expression either of wonder or pleasure; for the vociferation of our
-exorcist seemed to be neither.
-
-After having been on board about two hours, they expressed a desire to
-go ashore. A boat was immediately ordered, and Mr. Banks thought fit to
-accompany them: he landed them in safety, and conducted them to their
-companions, among whom he remarked the same vacant indifference, as in
-those who had been on board; for as on one side there appeared no
-eagerness to relate, so on the other there seemed to be no curiosity to
-hear, how they had been received, or what they had seen. In about half
-an hour, Mr. Banks returned to the ship, and the Indians retired from
-the shore.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. IV.
-
- AN ACCOUNT OF WHAT HAPPENED IN ASCENDING A MOUNTAIN TO SEARCH FOR
- PLANTS.
-
-
-ON the 16th, early in the morning, Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, with
-their attendants and servants, and two seamen to assist in carrying the
-baggage, accompanied by Mr. Monkhouse the surgeon, and Mr. Green the
-astronomer, set out from the ship, with a view to penetrate as far as
-they could into the country, and return at night. The hills, when viewed
-at a distance, seemed to be partly a wood, partly a plain, and above
-them a bare rock. Mr. Banks hoped to get through the wood, and made no
-doubt but that, beyond it, he should, in a country which no botanist had
-ever yet visited, find alpine plants which would abundantly compensate
-his labour. They entered the wood at a small sandy beach, a little to
-the westward of the watering-place, and continued to ascend the hill,
-through the pathless wilderness, till three o’clock, before they got a
-near view of the places which they intended to visit. Soon after they
-reached what they had taken for a plain; but, to their great
-disappointment, found it a swamp, covered with low bushes of birch,
-about three feet high, interwoven with each other, and so stubborn that
-they could not be bent out of the way; it was therefore necessary to
-lift the leg over them, which at every step was buried, ancle deep, in
-the soil. To aggravate the pain and difficulty of such travelling, the
-weather, which had hitherto been very fine, much like one of our bright
-days in May, became gloomy and cold, with sudden blasts of a most
-piercing wind, accompanied with snow. They pushed forward, however, in
-good spirits, notwithstanding their fatigue, hoping the worst of the way
-was past, and that the bare rock which they had seen from the tops of
-the lower hills was not more than a mile before them: but when they had
-got about two-thirds over this woody swamp, Mr. Buchan, one of Mr.
-Banks’s draughtsmen, was unhappily seized with a fit. This made it
-necessary for the whole company to halt, and as it was impossible that
-he should go any farther, a fire was kindled, and those who were most
-fatigued were left behind to take care of him. Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander,
-Mr. Green, and Mr. Monkhouse went on, and in a short time reached the
-summit. As botanists, their expectations were here abundantly gratified;
-for they found a great variety of plants, which, with respect to the
-alpine plants in Europe, are exactly what those plants are with respect
-to such as grow in the plain.
-
-The cold was now become more severe, and the snow-blasts more frequent;
-the day also was so far spent, that it was found impossible to get back
-to the ship before the next morning: to pass the night upon such a
-mountain, in such a climate, was not only comfortless, but dreadful; it
-was impossible, however, to be avoided, and they were to provide for it
-as well as they could.
-
-Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, while they were improving an opportunity
-which they had, with so much danger and difficulty, procured, by
-gathering the plants which they found upon the mountain, sent Mr. Green
-and Mr. Monkhouse back to Mr. Buchan and the people that were with him,
-with directions to bring them to a hill, which they thought lay in a
-better rout for returning to the wood, and which was therefore appointed
-as a general rendezvous. It was proposed, that from this hill they
-should push through the swamp, which seemed by the new rout not to be
-more than half a mile over, into the shelter of the wood and there build
-their wigwam, and make a fire: this, as their way was all down hill, it
-seemed easy to accomplish. Their whole company assembled at the
-rendezvous, and, though pinched with the cold, were in health and
-spirits, Mr. Buchan himself having recovered his strength in a much
-greater degree than could have been expected. It was now near eight
-o’clock in the evening, but still good daylight, and they set forward
-for the nearest valley, Mr. Banks himself undertaking to bring up the
-rear, and see that no straggler was left behind: this may, perhaps, be
-thought a superfluous caution, but it will soon appear to be otherwise.
-Dr. Solander, who had more than once crossed the mountains which divide
-Sweden from Norway, well knew that extreme cold, especially when joined
-with fatigue, produces a torpor and sleepiness that are almost
-irresistible: he therefore conjured the company to keep moving, whatever
-pain it might cost them, and whatever relief they might be promised by
-an inclination to rest. Whoever sits down, says he, will sleep; and
-whoever sleeps, will wake no more. Thus, at once admonished and alarmed,
-they set forward; but while they were still upon the naked rock, and
-before they had got among the bushes, the cold became suddenly so
-intense, as to produce the effects that had been most dreaded. Dr.
-Solander himself was the first who found the inclination, against which
-he had warned others, irresistible; and insisted upon being suffered to
-lie down. Mr. Banks entreated and remonstrated in vain: down he lay upon
-the ground, though it was covered with snow; and it was with great
-difficulty that his friend kept him from sleeping. Richmond also, one of
-the black servants, began to linger, having suffered from the cold in
-the same manner as the Doctor. Mr. Banks, therefore, sent five of the
-company, among whom was Mr. Buchan, forward to get a fire ready at the
-first convenient place they could find; and himself, with four others,
-remained with the Doctor and Richmond, whom, partly by persuasion and
-entreaty, and partly by force, they brought on; but when they had got
-through the greatest part of the birch and swamp, they both declared
-they could go no farther. Mr. Banks had recourse again to entreaty and
-expostulation, but they produced no effect: when Richmond was told, that
-if he did not go on he would in a short time be frozen to death, he
-answered, that he desired nothing but to lie down and die: the Doctor
-did not so explicitly renounce his life; he said he was willing to go
-on, but that he must first take some sleep, though he had before told
-the company that to sleep was to perish. Mr. Banks and the rest found it
-impossible to carry them, and there being no remedy, they were both
-suffered to sit down, being partly supported by the bushes, and in a few
-minutes they fell into a profound sleep: soon after, some of the people
-who had been sent forward, returned, with the welcome news that a fire
-was kindled about a quarter of a mile farther on the way. Mr. Banks then
-endeavoured to wake Dr. Solander, and happily succeeded: but, though he
-had not slept five minutes, he had almost lost the use of his limbs, and
-the muscles were so shrunk that his shoes fell from his feet: he
-consented to go forward with such assistance as could be given him, but
-no attempts to relieve poor Richmond were successful. It being found
-impossible to make him stir, after some time had been lost in the
-attempt, Mr. Banks left his other black servant and a seaman, who seemed
-to have suffered least by the cold, to look after him; promising, that
-as soon as two others should be sufficiently warmed, they should be
-relieved. Mr. Banks, with much difficulty, at length got the Doctor to
-the fire; and soon after sent two of the people who had been refreshed,
-in hopes that, with the assistance of those who had been left behind,
-they would be able to bring Richmond, even though it should still be
-found impossible to wake him. In about half an hour, however, they had
-the mortification to see these two men return alone: they said, that
-they had been all round the place to which they had been directed, but
-could neither find Richmond nor those who had been left with him; and
-that though they had shouted many times, no voice had replied. This was
-matter of equal surprise and concern, particularly to Mr. Banks, who,
-while he was wondering how it could happen, missed a bottle of rum, the
-company’s whole stock, which they now concluded to be in the knapsack of
-one of the absentees. It was conjectured, that with this Richmond had
-been roused by the two persons who had been left with him, and that,
-having perhaps drank too freely of it themselves, they had all rambled
-from the place where they had been left, in search of the fire, instead
-of waiting for those who should have been their assistants and guides.
-Another fall of snow now came on, and continued incessantly for two
-hours, so that all hope of seeing them again, at least alive, were given
-up; but about twelve o’clock, to the great joy of those at the fire, a
-shouting was heard at some distance. Mr. Banks, with four more,
-immediately went out, and found the seaman with just strength enough
-left to stagger along, and call out for assistance: Mr. Banks sent him
-immediately to the fire, and, by his direction, proceeded in search of
-the other two, whom he soon after found. Richmond was upon his legs, but
-not able to put one before the other: his companion was lying upon the
-ground, as insensible as a stone. All hands were now called from the
-fire, and an attempt was made to carry them to it; but this,
-notwithstanding the united efforts of the whole company, was found to be
-impossible. The night was extremely dark, the snow was now very deep,
-and, under these additional disadvantages, they found it very difficult
-to make way through the bushes and the bog for themselves, all of them
-getting many falls in the attempt. The only alternative was to make a
-fire upon the spot; but the snow which had fallen, and was still
-falling, besides what was every moment shaken in flakes from the trees,
-rendered it equally impracticable to kindle one there and to bring any
-part of that which had been kindled in the wood thither: they were,
-therefore, reduced to the sad necessity of leaving the unhappy wretches
-to their fate; having first made them a bed of boughs from the trees,
-and spread a covering of the same kind over them, to a considerable
-height.
-
-Having now been exposed to the cold and the snow near an hour and a
-half, some of the rest began to lose their sensibility; and one,
-Briscoe, another of Mr. Banks’s servants, was so ill, that it was
-thought he must die before he could be got to the fire.
-
-At the fire, however, at length they arrived; and passed the night in a
-situation, which however dreadful in itself, was rendered more
-afflicting by the remembrance of what was past, and the uncertainty of
-what was to come. Of twelve, the number that set out together in health
-and spirits, two were supposed to be already dead; a third was so ill,
-that it was very doubtful whether he would be able to go forward in the
-morning; and a fourth, Mr. Buchan, was in danger of a return of his
-fits, by fresh fatigue, after so uncomfortable a night: they were
-distant from the ship a long day’s journey, through pathless woods, in
-which it was too probable they might be bewildered till they were
-overtaken by the next night; and, not having prepared for a journey of
-more than eight or ten hours, they were wholly destitute of provisions,
-except a vulture, which they happened to shoot while they were out, and
-which, if equally divided, would not afford each of them half a meal;
-and they knew not how much more they might suffer from the cold, as the
-snow still continued to fall. A dreadful testimony of the severity of
-the climate, as it was now the midst of summer in this part of the
-world, the twenty-first of December being here the longest day; and
-every thing might justly be dreaded from a phænomenon which, in the
-corresponding season, is unknown even in Norway and Lapland.
-
-When the morning dawned, they saw nothing round them, as far as the eye
-could reach, but snow, which seemed to lie as thick upon the trees as
-upon the ground; and the blasts returned so frequently, and with such
-violence, that they found it impossible for them to set out: how long
-this might last they knew not, and they had but too much reason to
-apprehend that it would confine them in that desolate forest till they
-perished with hunger and cold.
-
-After having suffered the misery and terror of this situation till six
-o’clock in the morning, they conceived some hope of deliverance by
-discovering the place of the sun through the clouds, which were become
-thinner, and began to break away. Their first care was to see whether
-the poor wretches whom they had been obliged to leave among the bushes
-were yet alive; three of the company were dispatched for that purpose,
-and very soon afterwards returned with the melancholy news, that they
-were dead.
-
-Notwithstanding the flattering appearance of the sky, the snow still
-continued to fall so thick, that they could not venture out on their
-journey to the ship; but about eight o’clock a small regular breeze
-sprung up, which, with the prevailing influence of the sun, at length
-cleared the air; and they soon after, with great joy, saw the snow fall
-in large flakes from the trees, a certain sign of an approaching thaw:
-they now examined more critically the state of their invalids: Briscoe
-was still very ill, but said, that he thought himself able to walk; and
-Mr. Buchan was much better than either he or his friends had any reason
-to expect. They were now, however, pressed by the calls of hunger; to
-which, after long fasting, every consideration of future good or evil
-immediately gives way. Before they set forward, therefore, it was
-unanimously agreed, that they should eat their vulture: the bird was
-accordingly skinned; and, it being thought best to divide it before it
-was fit to be eaten, it was cut into ten portions, and every man cooked
-his own as he thought fit. After this repast, which furnished each of
-them with about three mouthfuls, they prepared to set out; but it was
-ten o’clock before the snow was sufficiently gone off, to render a march
-practicable. After a walk of about three hours, they were very agreeably
-surprised to find themselves upon the beach, and much nearer to the ship
-than they had any reason to expect. Upon reviewing their track from the
-vessel, they perceived that, instead of ascending the hill in a line, so
-as to penetrate into the country, they had made almost a circle round
-it. When they came on board, they congratulated each other upon their
-safety, with a joy that no man can feel who has not been exposed to
-equal danger; and as I had suffered great anxiety at their not returning
-in the evening of the day on which they set out, I was not wholly
-without my share.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. V.
-
-THE PASSAGE THROUGH THE STREIGHT OF LE MAIRE, AND A FURTHER DESCRIPTION
- OF THE INHABITANTS OF TERRA DEL FUEGO, AND ITS PRODUCTIONS.
-
-
-ON the 18th and 19th, we were delayed in getting on board our wood and
-water by a swell: but on the 20th, the weather being more moderate, we
-again sent the boat on shore, and Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander went in it.
-They landed in the bottom of the bay; and while my people were employed
-in cutting brooms, they pursued their great object, the improvement of
-natural knowledge, with success, collecting many shells and plants which
-hitherto have been altogether unknown: they came on board to dinner, and
-afterwards went again on shore to visit an Indian town, which some of
-the people had reported to lie about two miles up the country. They
-found the distance not more than by the account, and they approached it
-by what appeared to be the common road, yet they were above an hour in
-getting thither, for they were frequently up to their knees in mud. When
-they got within a small distance, two of the people came out to meet
-them, with such state as they could assume: when they joined them, they
-began to hollow as they had done on board the ship, without addressing
-themselves either to the strangers or their companions; and having
-continued this strange vociferation some time, they conducted them to
-the town. It was situated on a dry knoll, or small hill, covered with
-wood, none of which seemed to have been cleared away, and consisted of
-about twelve or fourteen hovels, of the most rude and inartificial
-structure that can be imagined. They were nothing more than a few poles
-set up so as to incline towards each other, and meet at the top, forming
-a kind of a cone, like some of our bee-hives: on the weather-side they
-were covered with a few boughs, and a little grass; and on the lee-side
-about one-eighth of the circle was left open, both for a door and a
-fire-place; and of this kind were the huts that had been seen in St.
-Vincent’s bay, in one of which the embers of a fire were still
-remaining. Furniture they had none: a little grass, which lay round the
-inside of the hovel, served both for chairs and beds; and of all the
-utensils which necessity and ingenuity have concurred to produce among
-other savage nations, they saw only a basket to carry in the hand, a
-satchel to hang at the back, and the bladder of some beast to hold
-water, which the natives drink through a hole that is made near the top
-for that purpose.
-
-The inhabitants of this town were a small tribe, not more than fifty in
-number, of both sexes and of every age. Their colour resembles that of
-the rust of iron mixed with oil, and they have long black hair: the men
-are large, but clumsily built: their stature is from five feet eight to
-five feet ten: the women are much less, few of them being more than five
-feet high. Their whole apparel consists of the skin of a guanicoe, or
-seal, which is thrown over their shoulders, exactly in the state in
-which it came from the animal’s back; a piece of the same skin, which is
-drawn over their feet, and gathered about the ancles like a purse, and a
-small flap, which is worn by the women as a succedaneum for a fig-leaf.
-The men wear their cloak open, the women tie it about their waist with a
-thong. But although they are content to be naked, they are very
-ambitious to be fine. Their faces were painted in various forms: the
-region of the eye was in general white, and the rest of the face adorned
-with horizontal streaks of red and black; yet scarcely any two were
-exactly alike. This decoration seems to be more profuse and elaborate
-upon particular occasions; for the two gentlemen who introduced Mr.
-Banks and the Doctor into the town were almost covered with streaks of
-black in all directions, so as to make a very striking appearance. Both
-men and women wore bracelets of such beads as they could make themselves
-of small shells or bones; the women both upon their wrists and ancles,
-the men upon their wrists only: but to compensate for the want of
-bracelets on their legs, they wore a kind of fillet of brown worsted
-round their heads. They seemed to set a particular value upon any thing
-that was red, and preferred beads even to a knife or a hatchet.
-
-Their language in general is guttural, and they express some of their
-words by a sound exactly like that which we make to clear the throat
-when any thing happens to obstruct it; yet they have words that would be
-deemed soft in the better languages of Europe. Mr. Banks learnt what he
-supposes to be their name for beads and water. When they wanted beads,
-instead of ribbons or other trifles, they said _hallĕcă_; and when they
-were taken on shore from the ship, and by signs asked where water might
-be found, they made the sign of drinking, and pointing as well to the
-casks as the watering-place, cried _Oodâ_.
-
-We saw no appearance of their having any food but shell-fish; for though
-seals were frequently seen near the shore, they seemed to have no
-implements for taking them. The shell-fish is collected by the women,
-whose business it seems to be to attend at low water, with a basket in
-one hand, and a stick, pointed and barbed, in the other, and a satchel
-at their backs: they loosen the limpets, and other fish that adhere to
-the rocks with the stick, and put them into the basket, which, when
-full, they empty into the satchel.
-
-The only things that we found among them in which there was the least
-appearance of neatness or ingenuity were their weapons, which consisted
-of a bow and arrows. The bow was not inelegantly made, and the arrows
-were the neatest that we had ever seen: they were of wood, polished to
-the highest degree; and the point, which was of glass or flint, and
-barbed, was formed and fitted with wonderful dexterity. We saw also some
-pieces of glass and flint among them unwrought, besides rings, buttons,
-cloth, and canvass, with other European commodities; they must,
-therefore, sometimes travel to the northward, for it is many years since
-any ship has been so far south as this part of Terra del Fuego. We
-observed, also, that they showed no surprise at our fire-arms, with the
-use of which they appeared to be well acquainted; for they made signs to
-Mr. Banks to shoot a seal which followed the boat, as they were going on
-shore from the ship.
-
-M. de Bougainville, who, in January, 1768, just one year before us, had
-been on shore upon this coast in latitude 53° 40ʹ 41ʺ, had, among other
-things, given glass to the people whom he found here; for he says, that
-a boy about twelve years old took it into his head to eat some of it: by
-this unhappy accident he died in great misery; but the endeavours of the
-good father, the French _aumonier_, were more successful than those of
-the surgeon; for though the surgeon could not save his life, the
-charitable priest found means to steal a Christian baptism upon him so
-secretly, that none of his Pagan relations knew any thing of the matter.
-These people might probably have some of the very glass which
-Bougainville left behind him, either from other natives, or perhaps from
-himself; for they appeared rather to be a travelling horde than to have
-any fixed habitation. Their houses are built to stand but for a short
-time. They have no utensil or furniture but the basket and satchel,
-which have been mentioned before, and which have handles adapted to the
-carrying them about, in the hand and upon the back. The only clothing
-they had here was scarcely sufficient to prevent their perishing with
-cold in the summer of this country, much less in the extreme severity of
-winter. The shell-fish, which seems to be their only food, must soon be
-exhausted at any one place; and we had seen houses upon what appeared to
-be a deserted station in St. Vincent’s Bay.
-
-It is also probable that the place where we found them was only a
-temporary residence, from their having here nothing like a boat or
-canoe, of which it can scarcely be supposed that they were wholly
-destitute, especially as they were not sea-sick, or particularly
-affected, either in our boat or on board the ship. We conjectured that
-there might be a streight or inlet, running from the sea through great
-part of this island, from the Streight of Magellan, whence these people
-might come, leaving their canoes where such inlet terminated.
-
-They did not appear to have among them any government or subordination:
-none was more respected than another; yet they seemed to live together
-in the utmost harmony and good fellowship. Neither did we discover any
-appearance of religion among them, except the noises which have been
-mentioned, and which we supposed to be a superstitious ceremony, merely
-because we could refer them to nothing else: they were used only by one
-of those who came on board the ship, and the two who conducted Mr. Banks
-and Dr. Solander to the town, whom we therefore conjectured to be
-priests. Upon the whole, these people appeared to be the most destitute
-and forlorn, as well as the most stupid, of all human beings; the
-outcasts of nature, who spent their lives in wandering about the dreary
-wastes, where two of our people perished with cold in the midst of
-summer; with no dwelling but a wretched hovel of sticks and grass, which
-would not only admit the wind, but the snow and the rain; almost naked;
-and destitute of every convenience that is furnished by the rudest art,
-having no implement even to dress their food: yet they were content.
-They seemed to have no wish for any thing more than they possessed, nor
-did any thing that we offered them appear acceptable but beads, as an
-ornamental superfluity of life. What bodily pain they might suffer from
-the severities of their winter we could not know; but it is certain that
-they suffered nothing from the want of the innumerable articles which we
-consider not as the luxuries and conveniencies only but the necessaries
-of life: as their desires are few, they probably enjoy them all; and how
-much they may be gainers by an exemption from the care, labour, and
-solicitude, which arise from a perpetual and unsuccessful effort to
-gratify that infinite variety of desires which the refinements of
-artificial life have produced among us, is not very easy to determine:
-possibly this may counterbalance all the real disadvantages of their
-situation in comparison with ours, and make the scales by which good and
-evil are distributed to man hang even between us.
-
-In this place we saw no quadruped except seals, sea-lions, and dogs: of
-the dogs it is remarkable that they bark, which those that are
-originally bred in America do not. And this is a further proof, that the
-people we saw here had, either immediately or remotely, communicated
-with the inhabitants of Europe. There are, however, other quadrupeds in
-this part of the country; for when Mr. Banks was at the top of the
-highest hill that he ascended in his expedition through the woods, he
-saw the footsteps of a large beast imprinted upon the surface of a bog,
-though he could not with any probability guess of what kind it might be.
-
-Of land-birds there are but few: Mr. Banks saw none larger than an
-English blackbird, except some hawks and a vulture; but of water-fowl
-there is great plenty, particularly ducks. Of fish we saw scarce any,
-and with our hooks could catch none that was fit to eat; but shell-fish,
-limpets, clams, and mussels, were to be found in abundance.
-
-Among the insects, which were not numerous, there was neither gnat nor
-musquito, nor any other species that was either hurtful or troublesome,
-which perhaps is more than can be said of any other uncleared country.
-During the snow-blasts, which happened every day while we were here,
-they hide themselves; and the moment it is fair they appear again, as
-nimble and vigorous as the warmest weather could make them.
-
-Of plants, Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander found a vast variety; the far
-greater part wholly different from any that have been hitherto
-described. Besides the birch and winter’s bark, which have been
-mentioned already; there is the beach, _Fagus antarcticus_, which, as
-well as the birch, may be used for timber. The plants cannot be
-enumerated here; but as the scurvy-grass, _Cardamine antiscorbutica_,
-and the wild celery, _Apium antarcticum_, probably contain antiscorbutic
-qualities, which may be of great benefit to the crews of such ships as
-shall hereafter touch at this place, the following short description is
-inserted:
-
-The scurvy-grass will be found in plenty in damp places, near springs of
-water, and, in general, in all places that lie near the beach,
-especially at the watering-place in the Bay of Good Success: when it is
-young, the state of its greatest perfection, it lies flat upon the
-ground, having many leaves of a bright green, standing in pairs opposite
-to each other, with a single one at the end, which generally makes the
-fifth upon a foot-stalk. The plant, passing from this state, shoots up
-in stalks that are sometimes two feet high, at the top of which are
-small white blossoms, and these are succeeded by long pods: the whole
-plant greatly resembles that which in England is called Lady’s smock, or
-Cuckow-flower. The wild celery is very like the celery in our gardens,
-the flowers are white, and stand in the same manner, in small tufts at
-the top of the branches, but the leaves are of a deeper green. It grows
-in great abundance near the beach, and generally upon the soil that lies
-next above the spring tides. It may, indeed, easily be known by the
-taste, which is between that of celery and parsley. We used the celery
-in large quantities, particularly in our soup, which, thus medicated,
-produced the same good effects which seamen generally derive from a
-vegetable diet, after having been long confined to salt provisions.
-
-On Sunday the 22d of January, about two o’clock in the morning, having
-got our wood and water on board, we sailed out of the bay, and continued
-our course through the Streight.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. VI.
-
- A GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF THE S. E. PART OF TERRA DEL FUEGO, AND THE
-STREIGHT OF LE MAIRE; WITH SOME REMARKS ON LORD ANSON’S ACCOUNT OF THEM,
- AND DIRECTIONS FOR THE PASSAGE WESTWARD, ROUND THIS PART OF AMERICA,
- INTO THE SOUTH SEAS.
-
-
-ALMOST all writers who have mentioned the island of Terra del Fuego,
-describe it as destitute of wood, and covered with snow. In the winter
-it may possibly be covered with snow, and those who saw it at that
-season might, perhaps, be easily deceived, by its appearance, into an
-opinion that it was destitute of wood. Lord Anson was there in the
-beginning of March, which answers to our September, and we were there
-the beginning of January, which answers to our July; which may account
-for the difference of his description of it from ours. We fell in with
-it about twenty-one leagues to the westward of the Streight of Le Maire,
-and from the time that we first saw it, trees were plainly to be
-distinguished with our glasses: and as we came nearer, though here and
-there we discovered patches of snow, the sides of the hills and the sea
-coast appeared to be covered with a beautiful verdure. The hills are
-lofty, but not mountainous, though the summits of them are quite naked.
-The soil in the valleys is rich, and of a considerable depth: and at the
-foot of almost every hill there is a brook, the water of which has a
-reddish hue, like that which runs through our turf bogs in England; but
-it is by no means ill tasted, and, upon the whole, proved to be the best
-that we took in during our voyage. We ranged the coast to the Streight,
-and had soundings all the way from forty to twenty fathom upon a
-gravelly and sandy bottom. The most remarkable land on Terra del Fuego
-is a hill in the form of a sugar-loaf, which stands on the west side not
-far from the sea; and the three hills, called the Three Brothers, about
-nine miles to the westward of Cape St. Diego, the low point that forms
-the north entrance of the Streight of Le Maire.
-
-It is said in the account of Lord Anson’s voyage, that it is difficult
-to determine exactly where the Streight lies, though the appearance of
-Terra del Fuego be well known, without knowing also the appearance of
-Staten Land; and that some navigators have been deceived by three hills
-on Staten Land, which have been mistaken for the Three Brothers on Terra
-del Fuego, and so over-shot the Streight. But no ship can possibly miss
-the Streight that coasts Terra del Fuego within sight of land, for it
-will then of itself be sufficiently conspicuous; and Staten Land, which
-forms the east side, will be still more manifestly distinguished, for
-there is no land on Terra del Fuego like it. The Streight of Le Maire
-can be missed only by standing too far to the eastward, without keeping
-the land of Terra del Fuego in sight: if this is done, it may be missed,
-however accurately the appearance of the coast of Staten Land may have
-been exhibited; and if this is not done, it cannot be missed, though the
-appearance of that coast be not known. The entrance of the Streight
-should not be attempted but with a fair wind and moderate weather, and
-upon the very beginning of the tide of flood, which happens here at the
-full and change of the moon, about one or two o’clock; it is also best
-to keep as near to the Terra del Fuego shore as the winds will admit. By
-attending to these particulars, a ship may be got quite through the
-Streight in one tide; or, at least, to the southward of Success Bay,
-into which it will be more prudent to put, if the wind should be
-southerly, than to attempt the weathering of Staten Land with a lee wind
-and a current, which may endanger her being driven on that island.
-
-The Streight itself, which is bounded on the west by Terra del Fuego,
-and on the east by the west end of Staten Land, is about five leagues
-long, and as many broad. The Bay of Good Success lies about the middle
-of it, on the Terra del Fuego side, and is discovered immediately upon
-entering the Streight from the northward: and the south head of it may
-be distinguished by a mark on the land, that has the appearance of a
-broad road, leading up from the sea into the country: at the entrance it
-is half a league wide, and runs in westward about two miles and a half.
-There is good anchorage in every part of it, in from ten to seven
-fathom, clear ground; and it affords plenty of exceeding good wood and
-water. The tides flow in the Bay, at the full and change of the moon,
-about four or five o’clock, and rise about five or six feet
-perpendicular. But the flood runs two or three hours longer in the
-Streight than in the Bay; and the ebb, or northerly current, runs with
-near double the strength of the flood.
-
-In the appearance of Staten Land, we did not discover the wildness and
-horror that is ascribed to it in the account of Lord Anson’s voyage. On
-the north side are the appearances of bays or harbours; and the land,
-when we saw it, was neither destitute of wood nor verdure, nor covered
-with snow. The island seems to be about twelve leagues in length, and
-five broad.
-
-On the west side of the Cape of Good Success, which forms the S. W.
-entrance of the Streight, lies Valentine’s Bay, of which we only saw the
-entrance; from this bay the land trends away to the W. S. W. for twenty
-or thirty leagues; it appears to be high and mountainous, and forms
-several bays and inlets.
-
-At the distance of fourteen leagues from the Bay of Good Success, in the
-direction of S. W. ½ W. and between two and three leagues from the
-shore, lies New Island. It is about two leagues in length from N. E. to
-S. W. and terminates to the N. E. in a remarkable hillock. At the
-distance of seven leagues from New Island, in the direction of S. W.
-lies the Isle _Evouts_; and a little to the W. of the south of this
-island lie Barnevelt’s two small flat islands, close to each other; they
-are partly surrounded with rocks, which rise to different heights above
-the water, and lie twenty-four leagues from the Streight of Le Maire. At
-the distance of three leagues from Barnevelt’s islands, in the direction
-of S. W. by S. lies the S. E. point of Hermit’s islands: these islands
-lie S. E. and N. W., and are pretty high: from most points of view they
-will be taken for one island, or a part of the main.
-
-From the S. E. point of Hermit’s islands to Cape Horn the course is S.
-W. by S., distance three leagues.
-
-The appearance of this Cape and Hermit’s islands is represented in the
-chart of this coast, from our first making land to the Cape, which
-includes the Streight of Le Maire, and part of Staten Land. In this
-chart I have laid down no land, nor traced out any shore but what I saw
-myself, and thus far it may be depended upon: the bays and inlets, of
-which we saw only the openings, are not traced; it can, however,
-scarcely be doubted, but that most, if not all of them, afford
-anchorage, wood, and water. The Dutch squadron, commanded by Hermit,
-certainly put into some of them in the year 1624. And it was Chapenham,
-the Vice-Admiral of this squadron, who first discovered that the land of
-Cape Horn consisted of a number of islands. The account, however, which
-those who sailed in Hermit’s fleet have given of these parts is
-extremely defective; and those of Schouton and Le Maire are still worse.
-It is therefore no wonder that the charts hitherto published should be
-erroneous, not only in laying down the land, but in the latitude and
-longitude of the places they contain. I will, however, venture to
-assert, that the longitude of few parts of the world is better
-ascertained than that of the Streight of Le Maire, and Cape Horn, in the
-chart now offered to the public, as it was laid down by several
-observations of the sun and moon, that were made both by myself and Mr.
-Green.
-
-The variation of the compass on this coast I found to be from 23° to 25°
-E. except near Barnevelt’s islands and Cape Horn, where we found it
-less, and unsettled: probably it is disturbed here by the land, as
-Hermit’s squadron, in this very place, found all their compasses differ
-from each other. The declination of the dipping-needle, when set upon
-shore in Success Bay, was 68° 15ʹ below the horizon.
-
-Between Streight Le Maire and Cape Horn we found a current setting,
-generally very strong, to the N. E. when we were in with the shore; but
-lost it when we were at the distance of fifteen or twenty leagues.
-
-On the 26th January, we took our departure from Cape Horn, which lies in
-latitude 55° 53ʹ S. longitude, 68° 13ʹ W. The farthest southern latitude
-that we made was 60° 10ʹ, our longitude was then 74° 30ʹ W.; and we
-found the variation of the compass, by the mean of eighteen azimuths, to
-be 27° 9ʹ E. As the weather was frequently calm, Mr. Banks went out in a
-small boat to shoot birds, among which were some albatrosses and
-sheerwaters. The albatrosses were observed to be larger than those which
-had been taken northward of the Streight; one of them measured ten feet
-two inches from the tip of one wing to that of the other, when they were
-extended: the sheerwater, on the contrary, is less, and darker coloured
-on the back. The albatrosses we skinned, and having soaked them in
-salt-water till the morning, we parboiled them, then throwing away the
-liquor, stewed them in a very little fresh water till they were tender,
-and had them served up with savoury sauce; thus dressed, the dish was
-universally commended, and we eat of it very heartily even when there
-was fresh pork upon the table.
-
-From a variety of observations which were made with great care, it
-appeared probable in the highest degree, that, from the time of our
-leaving the land to the 13th of February, when we were in latitude 49°
-32ʹ, and longitude 90° 37ʹ, we had no current to the west.
-
-At this time we had advanced about 12° to the westward, and 3 and ½ to
-the northward of the Streight of Magellan; having been just three and
-thirty days in coming round the land of Terra del Fuego, or Cape Horn,
-from the east entrance of the Streight to this situation. And though the
-doubling of Cape Horn is so much dreaded, that, in the general opinion,
-it is more eligible to pass through the Streight of Magellan, we were
-not once brought under our close-reef’d topsails after we left the
-Streight of Le Maire. The Dolphin, in her last voyage, which she
-performed at the same season of the year with ours, was three months in
-getting through the Streight of Magellan, exclusive of the time that she
-lay in Port Famine; and I am persuaded, from the winds we had, that if
-we had come by that passage, we should not at this time have been in
-these seas; that our people would have been fatigued, and our anchors,
-cables, sails and rigging much damaged; neither of which inconveniencies
-we had now suffered. But supposing it more eligible to go round the
-Cape, than through the Streight of Magellan; it may still be questioned,
-whether it is better to go through the Streight of Le Maire, or stand to
-the eastward, and go round Staten Land. The advice given in the Account
-of Lord Anson’s voyage is, “That all ships bound to the South Seas,
-instead of passing through the Streight of Le Maire, should constantly
-pass to the eastward of Staten Land, and should be invariably bent on
-running to the southward as far as the latitude of 61 or 62 degrees,
-before they endeavour to stand to the westward.” But, in my opinion,
-different circumstances may at one time render it eligible to pass
-through the Streight, and to keep to the eastward of Staten Land at
-another. If the land is fallen in with to the westward of the Streight,
-and the wind is favourable for going through, I think it would be very
-injudicious to lose time by going round Staten Land, as I am confident
-that, by attending to the directions which I have given, the Streight
-may be passed with the utmost safety and convenience. But if, on the
-contrary, the land is fallen in with to the eastward of the Streight,
-and the wind should prove tempestuous or unfavourable, I think it would
-be best to go round Staten Land. But I cannot in any case concur in
-recommending the running into the latitude of 61 or 62, before any
-endeavour is made to stand to the westward. We found neither the current
-nor the storms which the running so far to the southward is supposed
-necessary to avoid; and, indeed, as the winds almost constantly blow
-from that quarter, it is scarcely possible to pursue the advice. The
-navigator has no choice but to stand to the southward, close upon a
-wind, and by keeping upon that tack, he will not only make southing, but
-westing; and, if the wind varies towards the north of the west, his
-westing will be considerable. It will, indeed, be highly proper to make
-sure of a westing sufficient to double all the lands, before an attempt
-is made to stand to the northward, and to this every man’s own prudence
-will of necessity direct him.
-
-We now began to have strong gales and heavy seas, with irregular
-intervals of calm and fine weather.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. VII.
-
-THE SEQUEL OF THE PASSAGE FROM CAPE HORN TO THE NEWLY DISCOVERED ISLANDS
- IN THE SOUTH SEAS, WITH A DESCRIPTION OF THEIR FIGURE AND APPEARANCE;
- SOME ACCOUNT OF THE INHABITANTS, AND SEVERAL INCIDENTS THAT HAPPENED
- DURING THE COURSE, AND AT THE SHIP’S ARRIVAL AMONG THEM.
-
-
-ON the first of March, we were in latitude 38° 44ʹ S. and longitude 110°
-33ʹ W. both by observation and by the log. This agreement, after a run
-of 660 leagues, was thought to be very extraordinary; and is a
-demonstration, that after we left the land of Cape Horn we had no
-current that affected the ship. It renders it also highly probable, that
-we had been near no land of any considerable extent; for currents are
-always found when land is not remote, and sometimes, particularly on the
-east side of the continent in the North Sea, when land has been distant
-100 leagues.
-
-Many birds, as usual, were constantly about the ship, so that Mr. Banks
-killed no less than 62 in one day; and what is more remarkable, he
-caught two forest flies, both of them of the same species, but different
-from any that have hitherto been described; these probably belonged to
-the birds, and came with them from the land, which we judged to be at a
-great distance. Mr. Banks also, about this time, found a large
-cuttle-fish, which had just been killed by the birds, floating in a
-mangled condition upon the water; it is very different from the
-cuttle-fishes that are found in the European seas; for its arms, instead
-of suckers, were furnished with a double row of very sharp talons, which
-resemble those of a cat, and, like them, were retractable into a sheath
-of skin, from which they might be thrust at pleasure. Of this
-cuttle-fish we made one of the best soups we had ever tasted.
-
-The albatrosses now began to leave us, and after the 8th there was not
-one to be seen. We continued our course without any memorable event till
-the 24th, when some of the people who were upon the watch in the night,
-reported that they saw a log of wood pass by the ship; and that the sea,
-which was rather rough, became suddenly as smooth as a mill pond. It was
-a general opinion that there was land to windward; but I did not think
-myself at liberty to search for what I was not sure to find; though I
-judged we were not far from the islands that were discovered by Quiros
-in 1606. Our latitude was 22° 11ʹ S. and longitude 127° 55ʹ W.
-
-On the 25th, about noon, one of the marines, a young fellow about
-twenty, was placed as centry at the cabin-door; while he was upon this
-duty, one of my servants was at the same place preparing to cut a piece
-of seal-skin into tobacco pouches: he had promised one to several of the
-men, but had refused one to this young fellow, though he had asked him
-several times; upon which he jocularly threatened to steal one, if it
-should be in his power. It happened that the servant being called
-hastily away, gave the skin in charge to the centinel, without regarding
-what had passed between them. The centinel immediately secured a piece
-of the skin, which the other missing at his return, grew angry; but
-after some altercation, contented himself with taking it away, declaring
-that, for so trifling an affair, he would not complain of him to the
-officers. But it happened that one of his fellow-soldiers, over-hearing
-the dispute, came to the knowledge of what had happened, and told it to
-the rest; who, taking it into their heads to stand up for the honour of
-their corps, reproached the offender with great bitterness, and reviled
-him in the most opprobrious terms; they exaggerated his offence into a
-crime of the deepest dye; they said it was a theft by a centry when he
-was upon duty, and of a thing that had been committed to his trust; they
-declared it a disgrace to associate with him; and the serjeant, in
-particular, said that, if the person from whom the skin had been stolen
-would not complain, he would complain himself; for that his honour would
-suffer if the offender was not punished. From the scoffs and reproaches
-of these men of honour, the poor young fellow retired to his hammock in
-an agony of confusion and shame. The serjeant soon after went to him,
-and ordered him to follow him to the deck: he obeyed without reply; but
-it being in the dusk of the evening, he slipped from the serjeant and
-went forward: he was seen by some of the people, who thought he was gone
-to the head; but a search being made for him afterwards, it was found
-that he had thrown himself overboard; and I was then first made
-acquainted with the theft and its circumstances.
-
-The loss of this man was the more regretted as he was remarkably quiet
-and industrious, and as the very action that put an end to his life was
-a proof of an ingenuous mind; for to such only disgrace is
-insupportable.
-
-On Tuesday the 4th of April, about ten o’clock in the morning, Mr.
-Banks’s servant, Peter Briscoe, discovered land, bearing south, at the
-distance of about three or four leagues. I immediately hauled up for it,
-and found it to be an island of an oval form, with a lagoon in the
-middle, which occupied much the larger part of it; the border of land
-which circumscribes the lagoon is in many places very low and narrow,
-particularly on the south side, where it consists principally of a beach
-or reef of rocks. It has the same appearance also in three places on the
-north side; so that the firm land being disjoined, the whole looks like
-many islands covered with wood. On the west end of the island is a large
-tree, or clump of trees, that in appearance resembles a tower; and about
-the middle are two cocoa-nut trees, which rise above all the rest, and,
-as we came near to the island, appeared like a flag. We approached it on
-the north side, and though we came within a mile, we found no bottom
-with 130 fathom of line, nor did there appear to be any anchorage about
-it. The whole is covered with trees of different verdure, but we could
-distinguish none, even with our glasses, except cocoa-nuts and
-palm-nuts. We saw several of the natives upon the shore, and counted
-four and twenty. They appeared to be tall, and to have heads remarkably
-large; perhaps they had something wound round them which we could not
-distinguish; they were of a copper colour, and had long black hair.
-Eleven of them walked along the beach abreast of the ship, with poles or
-pikes in their hands which reached twice as high as themselves. While
-they walked on the beach they seemed to be naked; but soon after they
-retired, which they did as soon as the ship had passed the island, they
-covered themselves with something that made them appear of a light
-colour. Their habitations were under some clumps of palm-nut trees,
-which at a distance appeared like high ground; and to us, who for a long
-time had seen nothing but water and sky, except the dreary hills of
-Terra del Fuego, these groves seemed a terrestrial paradise. To this
-spot, which lies in latitude 18° 47ʺ S., and longitude 139° 28ʹ W. we
-gave the name of LAGOON ISLAND. The variation of the needle here is 2°
-54ʹ E.
-
-About one o’clock we made sail to the westward, and about half an hour
-after three we saw land again to the N. W. We got up with it at sunset,
-and it proved to be a low woody island, of a circular form, and not much
-above a mile in compass. We discovered no inhabitants, nor could we
-distinguish any cocoa-nut trees, though we were within half a mile of
-the shore. The land, however, was covered with verdure of many hues. It
-lies in latitude 18° 35ʹ S., and longitude 139° 48ʹ W., and is distant
-from Lagoon Island, in the direction of N. 62 W., about seven leagues.
-We called it THRUMB-CAP. I discovered by the appearance of the shore,
-that at this place it was low water; and I had observed at Lagoon
-Island, that it was either high water, or that the sea neither ebbed nor
-flowed. I infer, therefore, that a S. by E. or S. moon makes high water.
-
-We went on with a fine trade-wind and pleasant weather, and on the 5th,
-about three in the afternoon, we discovered land to the westward. It
-proved to be a low island of much greater extent than either of those
-that we had seen before, being about ten or twelve leagues in compass.
-Several of us remained at the mast-head the whole evening, admiring its
-extraordinary figure: it was shaped exactly like a bow, the arch and
-cord of which were land, and the space between them water: the cord was
-a flat beach, without any signs of vegetation, having nothing upon it
-but heaps of sea-weed, which lay in different ridges, as higher or lower
-tides had left them. It appeared to be about three or four leagues long,
-and not more than two hundred yards wide; but as a horizontal plane is
-always seen in perspective, and greatly foreshortened, it is certainly
-much wider than it appeared: the horns, or extremities of the bow, were
-two large tufts of cocoa-nut trees; and much the greater part of the
-arch was covered with trees of different height, figure, and hue; in
-some parts, however, it was naked and low, like the cord. Some of us
-thought they discovered openings through the cord, into the pool or
-lake, that was included between that and the bow; but whether there were
-or were not such openings is uncertain. We sailed abreast of the low
-beach or bow-string, within less than a league of the shore, till
-sunset, and we then judged ourselves to be about half-way between the
-two horns. Here we brought to, and sounded, but found no bottom with one
-hundred and thirty fathom; and, as it is dark almost instantly after
-sunset in these latitudes, we suddenly lost sight of the land, and
-making sail again, before the line was well hauled in, we steered by the
-sound of the breakers, which were distinctly heard till we got clear of
-the coast.
-
-We knew this island to be inhabited, by smoke which we saw in different
-parts of it, and we gave it the name of BOW ISLAND. Mr. Gore, my second
-lieutenant, said, after we had sailed by the island, that he had seen
-several of the natives, under the first clump of trees, from the deck;
-that he had distinguished their houses, and seen several canoes hauled
-up under the shade; but in this he was more fortunate than any other
-person on board. The east end of this island, which, from its figure, we
-called the Bow, lies in latitude 18° 23ʹ S., and longitude 141° 12ʹ W.;
-we observed the variation of the compass to be 5° 38ʹ E.
-
-On the next day, Thursday the 6th, about noon, we saw land again to the
-westward, and came up with it about three. It appeared to be two
-islands, or rather groups of islands, extending from N. W. by N. to S.
-E. by S. about nine leagues. Of these, the two largest were separated
-from each other by a channel of about half a mile broad, and were
-severally surrounded by smaller islands, to which they were joined by
-reefs that lay under water.
-
-These islands were long narrow strips of land, ranging in all
-directions, some of them ten miles or upwards in length, but none more
-than a quarter of a mile broad, and upon all of them there were trees of
-various kinds, particularly the cocoa-nut. The south-eastermost of them
-lies in the latitude of 18° 12ʹ S. and longitude 142° 42ʹ W., and at the
-distance of twenty-five leagues in the direction of W. ½ N. from the
-west end of Bow Island. We ranged along the S. W. side of this island,
-and hauled into a bay which lies to the N. W. of the southermost point
-of the Group, where there was a smooth sea, and the appearance of
-anchorage, without much surf on the shore. We sounded, but we found no
-bottom with one hundred fathom, at the distance of no more than three
-quarters of a mile from the beach; and I did not think it prudent to go
-nearer.
-
-While this was doing, several of the inhabitants assembled upon the
-shore, and some came out in their canoes as far as the reefs, but would
-not pass them. When we saw this, we ranged, with an easy sail, along the
-shore; but just as we were passing the end of the island, six men, who
-had for some time kept abreast of the ship, suddenly launched two canoes
-with great quickness and dexterity, and three of them getting into each,
-they put off, as we imagined, with a design to come on board us; the
-ship was therefore brought to, but they, like their fellows, stopped at
-the reef. We did not, however, immediately make sail, as we observed two
-messengers dispatched to them from the other canoes, which were of a
-much larger size. We perceived that these messengers made great
-expedition, wading and swimming along the reef; at length they met, and
-the men on board the canoes making no dispositions to pass the reef,
-after having received the message, we judged that they had resolved to
-come no farther. After waiting, therefore, some little time longer, we
-stood off; but when we were got about two or three miles from the shore,
-we perceived some of the natives following us in a canoe with a sail. We
-did not, however, think it worth while to wait for her, and though she
-had passed the reef, she soon after gave over the chace.
-
-According to the best judgment that we could form of the people when we
-were nearest the shore, they were about our size, and well-made. They
-were of a brown-complexion, and appeared to be naked; their hair, which
-was black, was confined by a fillet that went round the head, and stuck
-out behind like a bush. The greater part of them carried in their hands
-two weapons; one of them was a slender pole, from ten to fourteen feet
-long, on one end of which was a small knob, not unlike the point of a
-spear; the other was about four feet long, and shaped like a paddle, and
-possibly might be so, for some of their canoes were very small: those
-which we saw them launch seemed not intended to carry more than the
-three men that got into them: we saw others that had on board six or
-seven men, and one of them hoisted a sail which did not seem to reach
-more than six feet above the gun-wale of the boat, and which, upon the
-falling of a slight shower, was taken down and converted into an awning
-or tilt. The canoe which followed us to sea hoisted a sail not unlike an
-English lug-sail, and almost as lofty as an English boat of the same
-size would have carried.
-
-The people, who kept abreast of the ship on the beach, made many
-signals; but whether they were intended to frighten us away, or invite
-us on shore, it is not easy to determine: we returned them by waving our
-hats and shouting, and they replied by shouting again. We did not put
-their disposition to the test, by attempting to land; because, as the
-island was inconsiderable, and as we wanted nothing that it could
-afford, we thought it imprudent as well as cruel to risk a contest, in
-which the natives must have suffered by our superiority, merely to
-gratify an idle curiosity; especially as we expected soon to fall in
-with the island where we had been directed to make our astronomical
-observation, the inhabitants of which would probably admit us without
-opposition, as they were already acquainted with our strength, and might
-also procure us a ready and peaceable reception among the neighbouring
-people, if we should desire it.
-
-To these islands we gave the name of THE GROUPS.
-
-On the 7th, about half an hour after six in the morning, being just at
-day-break, we discovered another island to the northward, which we
-judged to be about four miles in circumference. The land lay very low,
-and there was a piece of water in the middle of it; there seemed to be
-some wood upon it, and it looked green and pleasant; but we saw neither
-cocoa-trees nor inhabitants: it abounded, however, with birds, and we
-therefore gave it the name of BIRD ISLAND.
-
-It lies in latitude 17° 48ʹ S. and longitude 143° 35ʹ W. at the distance
-of ten leagues, in the direction W. ½ N. from the west end of the
-Groups. The variation here was 6° 32ʹ E.
-
-On the 8th, about two o’clock in the afternoon, we saw land to the
-northward, and about sunset came abreast of it, at about the distance of
-two leagues. It appeared to be a double range of low woody islands
-joined together by reefs, so as to form one island, in the form of an
-ellipsis or oval, with a lake in the middle of it. The small islands and
-reefs that circumscribe the lake have the appearance of a chain, and we
-therefore gave it the name of CHAIN ISLAND. Its length seemed to be
-about five leagues, in the direction of N. W. and S. E., and its breadth
-about five miles. The trees upon it appeared to be large, and we saw
-smoke rising in different parts of it from among them, a certain sign
-that it was inhabited. The middle of it lies in latitude 17° 23ʹ S. and
-longitude 145° 54ʹ W., and is distant from Bird Island forty-five
-leagues, in the direction of W. by N. The variation here was, by several
-azimuths, found to be 4° 54ʹ E.
-
-On the 10th, having had a tempestuous night with thunder and rain, the
-weather was hazy till about nine o’clock in the morning, when it cleared
-up, and we saw the island to which Captain Wallis, who first discovered
-it, gave the name of Osnaburgh Island, called by the natives _Maitea_,
-bearing N. W. by W. distant about five leagues. It is a high round
-island, not above a league in circuit; in some parts it is covered with
-trees, and in others a naked rock. In this direction it looked like a
-high-crowned hat; but when it bears north, the top of it has more the
-appearance of the roof of a house. We made its latitude to be 17° 48ʹ S.
-its longitude 148° 10ʹ W., and its distance from Chain Island forty-four
-leagues, in the direction of W. by S.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. VIII.
-
-THE ARRIVAL OF THE ENDEAVOUR AT OTAHEITE, CALLED BY CAPTAIN WALLIS KING
- GEORGE THE THIRD’S ISLAND.—RULES ESTABLISHED FOR TRAFFIC WITH THE
- NATIVES, AND AN ACCOUNT OF SEVERAL INCIDENTS WHICH HAPPENED IN A VISIT
- TO TOOTAHAH AND TOUBOURAI TAMAIDA, TWO CHIEFS.
-
-
-ABOUT one o’clock, on Monday the 10th of April, some of the people who
-were looking out for the island to which we were bound, said they saw
-land a-head, in that part of the horizon where it was expected to
-appear; but it was so faint that whether there was land in sight or not,
-remained a matter of dispute till sunset. The next morning, however, at
-six o’clock, we were convinced that those who said they had discovered
-land were not mistaken; it appeared to be very high and mountainous,
-extending from W. by S. ½ S. to W. by N. ½ N., and we knew it to be the
-same that Captain Wallis had called King George the Third’s Island. We
-were delayed in our approach to it by light airs and calms, so that in
-the morning of the 12th we were but little nearer than we had been the
-night before; but about seven a breeze sprung up, and before eleven
-several canoes were seen making towards the ship: there were but few of
-them, however, that would come near; and the people in those that did
-could not be persuaded to come on board. In every canoe there were young
-plantains, and branches of a tree which the Indians call _E’ Midho_:
-these, as we afterwards learnt, were brought as tokens of peace and
-amity; and the people in one of the canoes handed them up the ship’s
-side, making signals at the same time with great earnestness, which we
-did not immediately understand; at length we guessed that they wished
-these symbols should be placed in some conspicuous part of the ship; we,
-therefore, immediately stuck them among the rigging, at which they
-expressed the greatest satisfaction. We then purchased their cargoes,
-consisting of cocoa-nuts, and various kinds of fruit, which, after our
-long voyage, were very acceptable.
-
-[Illustration: _The Island of Otaheite._]
-
-We stood on with an easy sail all night, with soundings from twenty-two
-fathom to twelve, and about seven o’clock in the morning we came to an
-anchor in thirteen fathom, in Port-royal Bay, called by the natives
-_Matavai_. We were immediately surrounded by the natives in their
-canoes, who gave us cocoa-nuts, fruit resembling apples, bread-fruit,
-and some small fishes, in exchange for beads and other trifles. They had
-with them a pig, which they would not part with for any thing but a
-hatchet, and therefore we refused to purchase it; because if we gave
-them a hatchet for a pig now, we knew they would never afterwards sell
-one for less, and we could not afford to buy as many as it was probable
-we should want at that price. The bread-fruit grows on a tree that is
-about the size of a middling oak: its leaves are frequently a foot and a
-half long, of an oblong shape, deeply sinuated like those of the
-fig-tree, which they resemble in consistence and colour, and in the
-exuding of a white milky juice upon being broken. The fruit is about the
-size and shape of a child’s head, and the surface is reticulated, not
-much unlike a truffle: it is covered with a thin skin, and has a core
-about as big as the handle of a small knife: the eatable part lies
-between the skin and the core: it is as white as snow, and somewhat of
-the consistence of new bread: it must be roasted before it is eaten,
-being first divided into three or four parts: its taste is insipid, with
-a slight sweetness, somewhat resembling that of the crumb of
-wheaten-bread mixed with a Jerusalem artichoke.
-
-Among others who came off to the ship was an elderly man, whose name, as
-we learnt afterwards, was OWHAW and who was immediately known to Mr.
-Gore, and several others who had been here with Captain Wallis. As I was
-informed that he had been very useful to them, I took him on board the
-ship with some others, and was particularly attentive to gratify him, as
-I hoped he might also be useful to us.
-
-As our stay here was not likely to be very short, and as it was
-necessary that the merchandize which we had brought for traffic with the
-natives should not diminish in its value, which it would certainly have
-done if every person had been left at liberty to give what he pleased
-for such things as he should purchase; at the same time, that confusion
-and quarrels must necessarily have arisen from there being no standard
-at market, I drew up the following rules, and ordered that they should
-be punctually observed:—
-
-
-_Rules to be observed by every Person in or belonging to His Majesty’s
- Bark the Endeavour, for the better establishing a regular and uniform
- Trade for Provision, &c. with the Inhabitants of George’s Island._
-
-“I. To endeavour, by every fair means, to cultivate a friendship with
-the natives; and to treat them with all imaginable humanity.
-
-“II. A proper person or persons will be appointed to trade with the
-natives for all manner of provisions, fruit, and other productions of
-the earth; and no officer or seaman, or other person belonging to the
-ship, excepting such as are so appointed, shall trade or offer to trade
-for any sort of provision, fruit, or other productions of the earth,
-unless they have leave so to do.
-
-“III. Every person employed on shore, on any duty whatsoever, is
-strictly to attend to the same; and if by any neglect he loseth any of
-his arms, or working tools, or suffers them to be stolen, the full value
-thereof will be charged against his pay, according to the custom of the
-navy in such cases; and he shall receive such farther punishment as the
-nature of the offence may deserve.
-
-“IV. The same penalty will be inflicted on every person who is found to
-embezzle, trade, or offer to trade, with any part of the ship’s stores
-of what nature soever.
-
-“V. No sort of iron, or any thing that is made of iron, or any sort of
-cloth, or other useful or necessary articles, are to be given in
-exchange for any thing but provision.
-
- “J. COOK.”
-
-As soon as the ship was properly secured, I went on shore with Mr. Banks
-and Dr. Solander, a party of men under arms, and our friend Owhaw. We
-were received from the boat by some hundreds of the inhabitants, whose
-looks at least gave us welcome, though they were struck with such awe,
-that the first who approached us crouched so low that he almost crept
-upon his hands and knees. It is remarkable that he, like the people in
-the canoes, presented to us the same symbol of peace that is known to
-have been in use among the ancient and mighty nations of the northern
-hemisphere, the green branch of a tree. We received it with looks and
-gestures of kindness and satisfaction; and observing that each of them
-held one in his hand, we immediately gathered every one a bough, and
-carried it in our hands in the same manner.
-
-They marched with us about half a mile towards the place where the
-Dolphin had watered, conducted by Owhaw; they then made a full stop, and
-having laid the ground bare, by clearing away all the plants that grew
-upon it, the principal persons among them threw their green branches
-upon the naked spot, and made signs that we should do the same; we
-immediately showed our readiness to comply, and to give a greater
-solemnity to the rite, the marines were drawn up, and marching in order,
-each dropped his bough upon those of the Indians, and we followed their
-example. We then proceeded, and when we came to the watering-place it
-was intimated to us by signs, that we might occupy that ground, but it
-happened not to be fit for our purpose. During our walk, they had shaken
-off their first timid sense of our superiority, and were become
-familiar: they went with us from the watering-place and took a circuit
-through the woods; as we went along, we distributed beads and other
-small presents among them, and had the satisfaction to see that they
-were much gratified. Our circuit was not less than four or five miles,
-through groves of trees, which were loaded with cocoa-nuts and
-bread-fruit, and afforded the most grateful shade. Under these trees
-were the habitations of the people, most of them being only a roof
-without walls, and the whole scene realised the poetical fables of
-Arcadia. We remarked, however, not without some regret, that in all our
-walk we had seen only two hogs, and not a single fowl. Those of our
-company who had been here with the Dolphin told us, that none of the
-people whom we had yet seen were of the first class: they suspected that
-the chiefs had removed; and upon carrying us to the place where what
-they called the Queen’s palace had stood, we found that no traces of it
-were left. We determined therefore to return in the morning, and
-endeavour to find out the _noblesse_ in their retreats.
-
-In the morning, however, before we could leave the ship, several canoes
-came about us, most of them from the westward, and two of them were
-filled with people, who, by their dress and deportment, appeared to be
-of a superior rank: two of these came on board, and each singled out his
-friend; one of them, whose name we found to be MATAHAH, fixed upon Mr.
-Banks, and the other upon me: this ceremony consisted in taking off
-great part of their clothes and putting them upon us. In return for
-this, we presented each of them with a hatchet and some beads. Soon
-after they made signs for us to go with them to the places where they
-lived, pointing to the S. W.; and as I was desirous of finding a more
-commodious harbour, and making farther trial of the disposition of the
-people, I consented.
-
-I ordered out two boats, and with Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, the other
-gentlemen, and our two Indian friends, we embarked for our expedition.
-After rowing about a league, they made signs that we should go on shore,
-and gave us to understand that this was the place of their residence. We
-accordingly landed, among several hundreds of the natives, who conducted
-us into a house of much greater length than any we had seen. When we
-entered, we saw a middle-aged man, whose name was afterwards discovered
-to be TOOTAHAH: mats were immediately spread, and we were desired to sit
-down over against him. Soon after we were seated, he ordered a cock and
-hen to be brought out, which he presented to Mr. Banks and me: we
-accepted the present; and in a short time each of us received a piece of
-cloth, perfumed after their manner, by no means disagreeably, which they
-took great pains to make us remark. The piece presented to Mr. Banks was
-eleven yards long and two wide; in return for which, he gave a laced
-silk neckcloth, which he happened to have on, and a linen pocket
-handkerchief: Tootahah immediately dressed himself in this new finery,
-with an air of perfect complacency and satisfaction. But it is now time
-that I should take some notice of the ladies.
-
-Soon after the interchanging of our presents with Tootahah, they
-attended us to several large houses, in which we walked about with great
-freedom: they showed us all the civility of which, in our situation, we
-could accept; and, on their part, seemed to have no scruple that would
-have prevented its being carried farther. The houses, which, as I have
-observed before, are all open, except a roof, afforded no place of
-retirement; but the ladies, by frequently pointing to the mats upon the
-ground, and sometimes seating themselves and drawing us down upon them,
-left us no room to doubt of their being much less jealous of observation
-than we were.
-
-We now took leave of our friendly chief, and directed our course along
-the shore. When we had walked about a mile, we met, at the head of a
-great number of people, another chief, whose name was TOUBOURAI TAMAIDE,
-with whom we were also to ratify a treaty of peace, with the ceremony of
-which we were now become better acquainted. Having received the branch
-which he presented to us, and given another in return, we laid our hands
-upon our left breasts, and pronounced the word _Taio_, which we supposed
-to signify friend; the chief then gave us to understand, that if we
-chose to eat, he had victuals ready for us. We accepted his offer, and
-dined very heartily upon fish, bread-fruit, cocoa-nuts, and plantains,
-dressed after their manner: they eat some of their fish raw; and raw
-fish was offered to us, but we declined that part of the entertainment.
-
-During this visit a wife of our noble host, whose name was TOMIO, did
-Mr. Banks the honour to place herself upon the same mat, close by him.
-Tomio was not in the first bloom of her youth, nor did she appear to
-have been ever remarkable for her beauty; he did not, therefore, I
-believe, pay her the most flattering attention: it happened, too, as a
-farther mortification to this lady, that seeing a very pretty girl among
-the crowd, he, not adverting to the dignity of his companion, beckoned
-her to come to him: the girl, after some entreaty, complied, and sat
-down on the other side of him: he loaded her with beads, and every showy
-trifle that would please her: his princess, though she was somewhat
-mortified at the preference that was given to her rival, did not
-discontinue her civilities, but still assiduously supplied him with the
-milk of the cocoa-nut, and such other dainties as were in her reach.
-This scene might possibly have become more curious and interesting, if
-it had not been suddenly interrupted by an interlude of a more serious
-kind. Just at this time, Dr. Solander and Mr. Monkhouse complained that
-their pockets had been picked. Dr. Solander had lost an opera-glass in a
-shagreen case, and Mr. Monkhouse his snuff-box. This incident
-unfortunately put an end to the good humour of the company. Complaint of
-the injury was made to the chief; and, to give it weight, Mr. Banks
-started up, and hastily struck the but-end of his firelock upon the
-ground: this action, and the noise that accompanied it, struck the whole
-assembly with a panic; and every one of the natives ran out of the house
-with the utmost precipitation, except the chief, three women, and two or
-three others, who appeared by their dress to be of a superior rank.
-
-The chief, with a mixture of confusion and concern, took Mr. Banks by
-the hand, and led him to a large quantity of cloth, which lay at the
-other end of the house: this he offered to him piece by piece,
-intimating by signs, that if that would atone for the wrong which had
-been done, he might take any part of it, or, if he pleased, the whole.
-Mr. Banks put it by, and gave him to understand, that he wanted nothing
-but what had been dishonestly taken away. Toubourai Tamaide then went
-hastily out, leaving Mr. Banks with his wife Tomio, who, during the
-whole scene of terror and confusion, had kept constantly at his side,
-and intimating his desire that he should wait there till his return. Mr.
-Banks accordingly sat down, and conversed with her, as well as he could
-by signs, about half an hour. The chief then came back with the
-snuff-box and the case of the opera-glass in his hand, and, with a joy
-in his countenance that was painted with a strength of expression which
-distinguishes these people from all others, delivered them to the
-owners. The case of the opera-glass, however, upon being opened, was
-found to be empty; upon this discovery, his countenance changed in a
-moment; and catching Mr. Banks again by the hand, he rushed out of the
-house, without uttering any sound, and led him along the shore, walking
-with great rapidity: when they had got about a mile from the house, a
-woman met him and gave him a piece of cloth, which he hastily took from
-her, and continued to press forward with it in his hand. Dr. Solander
-and Mr. Monkhouse had followed them, and they came at length to a house
-where they were received by a woman, to whom he gave the cloth, and
-intimated to the gentlemen that they should give her some beads. They
-immediately complied; and the beads and cloth being deposited upon the
-floor, the woman went out, and in about half an hour returned with the
-opera-glass, expressing the same joy upon the occasion that had before
-been expressed by the chief. The beads were now returned, with an
-inflexible resolution not to accept them; and the cloth was, with the
-same pertinacity, forced upon Dr. Solander, as a recompence for the
-injury that had been done him. He could not avoid accepting the cloth,
-but insisted in his turn upon giving a new present of beads to the
-woman. It will not, perhaps, be easy to account for all the steps that
-were taken in the recovery of this glass and snuff-box; but this cannot
-be thought strange, considering that the scene of action was among a
-people whose language, policy, and connections, are even now but
-imperfectly known; upon the whole, however, they show an intelligence
-and influence which would do honour to any system of government, however
-regular and improved. In the evening, about six o’clock, we returned to
-the ship.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. IX.
-
- A PLACE FIXED UPON FOR AN OBSERVATORY AND FORT: AN EXCURSION INTO THE
- WOODS, AND ITS CONSEQUENCES.—THE FORT ERECTED: A VISIT FROM SEVERAL
- CHIEFS ON BOARD AND AT THE FORT, WITH SOME ACCOUNT OF THE MUSIC OF THE
- NATIVES, AND THE MANNER IN WHICH THEY DISPOSE OF THEIR DEAD.
-
-
-ON the next morning, Saturday the 15th, several of the chiefs whom we
-had seen the day before came on board, and brought with them hogs,
-bread-fruit, and other refreshments, for which we gave them hatchets and
-linen, and such things as seemed to be most acceptable.
-
-As in my excursion to the westward, I had not found any more convenient
-harbour than that in which we lay, I determined to go on shore and fix
-upon some spot, commanded by the ship’s guns, where I might throw up a
-small fort for our defence, and prepare for making our astronomical
-observation.
-
-I therefore took a party of men, and landed without delay, accompanied
-by Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and the astronomer, Mr. Green. We soon fixed
-upon a part of the sandy beach, on the N. E. point of the bay, which was
-in every respect convenient for our purpose, and not near any habitation
-of the natives. Having marked out the ground that we intended to occupy,
-a small tent belonging to Mr. Banks was set up, which had been brought
-on shore for that purpose: by this time a great number of the people had
-gathered about us; but, as it appeared, only to look on, there not being
-a single weapon of any kind among them. I intimated, however, that none
-of them were to come within the line I had drawn, except one who
-appeared to be a chief, and Owhaw. To these two persons I addressed
-myself by signs, and endeavoured to make them understand, that we wanted
-the ground which we had marked out to sleep upon for a certain number of
-nights, and that then we should go away. Whether I was understood I
-cannot certainly determine; but the people behaved with a deference and
-respect that at once pleased and surprised us: they sat down peaceably
-without the circle, and looked on, without giving us any interruption
-till we had done, which was upwards of two hours. As we had seen no
-poultry, and but two hogs, in our walk when we were last on shore at
-this place, we suspected that, upon our arrival, they had been driven
-farther up the country; and the rather, as Owhaw was very importunate
-with us, by signs, not to go into the woods, which, however, and partly
-for these reasons, we were determined to do. Having therefore appointed
-the thirteen marines and a petty officer to guard the tent, we set out,
-and a great number of the natives joined our party. As we were crossing
-a little river that lay in our way we saw some ducks, and Mr. Banks, as
-soon as he had got over, fired at them, and happened to kill three at
-one shot: this struck them with the utmost terror, so that most of them
-fell suddenly to the ground, as if they also had been shot at the same
-discharge: it was not long, however, before they recovered from their
-fright, and we continued our route; but we had not gone far before we
-were alarmed by the report of two pieces, which were fired by the guard
-at the tent. We had then straggled a little distance from each other,
-but Owhaw immediately called us together, and by waving his hand sent
-away every Indian who followed us except three each of whom, as a pledge
-of peace on their part, and an entreaty that there might be peace on
-ours, hastily broke a branch from the trees, and came to us with it in
-their hands. As we had too much reason to fear that some mischief had
-happened, we hasted back to the tent, which was not distant above half a
-mile, and when we came up, we found it entirely deserted, except by our
-own people.
-
-It appeared that one of the Indians who remained about the tent after we
-left it had watched his opportunity, and, taking the sentry unawares,
-had snatched away his musket. Upon this, the petty officer, a
-midshipman, who commanded the party, perhaps from a sudden fear of
-farther violence, perhaps from the natural petulance of power newly
-acquired, and perhaps from a brutality in his nature, ordered the
-marines to fire: the men, with as little consideration or humanity as
-the officer, immediately discharged their pieces among the thickest of
-the flying crowd, consisting of more than a hundred; and observing that
-the thief did not fall, pursued him, and shot him dead. We afterwards
-learnt that none of the others were either killed or wounded.
-
-Owhaw, who had never left us, observing that we were now totally
-deserted, got together a few of those who had fled, though not without
-some difficulty, and ranged them about us: we endeavoured to justify our
-people as well as we could, and to convince the Indians that if they did
-no wrong to us, we should do no wrong to them: they went away without
-any appearance of distrust or resentment; and having struck our tent, we
-returned to the ship, but by no means satisfied with the transactions of
-the day.
-
-Upon questioning our people more particularly, whose conduct they soon
-perceived we could not approve, they alleged that the sentinel whose
-musket was taken away was violently assaulted and thrown down, and that
-a push was afterwards made at him by the man who took the musket, before
-any command was given to fire. It was also suggested, that Owhaw had
-suspicions, at least, if not certain knowledge, that something would be
-attempted against our people at the tent, which made him so very earnest
-in his endeavours to prevent our leaving it; others imputed his
-importunity to his desire that we should confine ourselves to the beach;
-and it was remarked that neither Owhaw nor the chiefs who remained with
-us after he had sent the rest of the people away would have inferred the
-breach of peace from the firing at the tent, if they had had no reason
-to suspect that some injury had been offered by their countrymen;
-especially as Mr. Banks had just fired at the ducks: and yet that they
-did infer a breach of peace from that incident was manifest from their
-waving their hands for the people to disperse, and instantly pulling
-green branches from the trees. But what were the real circumstances of
-this unhappy affair, and whether either and which of these conjectures
-were true, can never certainly be known.
-
-The next morning but few of the natives were seen upon the beach, and
-not one of them came off to the ship. This convinced us that our
-endeavours to quiet their apprehensions had not been effectual; and we
-remarked with particular regret, that we were deserted even by Owhaw,
-who had hitherto been so constant in his attachment, and so active in
-renewing the peace that had been broken.
-
-Appearances being thus unfavourable, I warped the ship nearer to the
-shore, and moored her in such a manner as to command all the N. E. part
-of the bay, particularly the place which I had marked out for the
-building a fort. In the evening, however, I went on shore with only a
-boat’s crew, and some of the gentlemen: the natives gathered about us,
-but not in the same number as before: there were, I believe, between
-thirty and forty, and they trafficked with us for cocoa-nuts and other
-fruit, to all appearance as friendly as ever.
-
-On the 17th, early in the morning, we had the misfortune to lose Mr.
-Buchan, the person whom Mr. Banks had brought out as a painter of
-landscapes and figures. He was a sober, diligent, and ingenious young
-man, and greatly regretted by Mr. Banks; who hoped, by his means, to
-have gratified his friends in England with representations of this
-country and its inhabitants, which no other person on board could
-delineate with the same accuracy and elegance. He had always been
-subject to epileptic fits, one of which seized him on the mountains of
-Terra del Fuego, and this disorder being aggravated by a bilious
-complaint which he contracted on board the ship, at length put an end to
-his life. It was at first proposed to bury him on shore, but Mr. Banks
-thinking that it might perhaps give offence to the natives, with whose
-customs we were then wholly unacquainted, we committed his body to the
-sea, with as much decency and solemnity as our circumstances and
-situation would admit.
-
-In the forenoon of this day we received a visit from Tubourai Tamaide
-and Tootahah, our chiefs, from the west: they brought with them, as
-emblems of peace, not branches of plantain, but two young trees, and
-would not venture on board till these had been received, having probably
-been alarmed by the mischief which had been done at the tent. Each of
-them also brought, as propitiatory gifts, some bread-fruit, and a hog
-ready dressed: this was a most acceptable present, as we perceived that
-hogs were not always to be got; and in return we gave to each of our
-noble benefactors a hatchet and a nail. In the evening we went on shore
-and set up a tent, in which Mr. Green and myself spent the night, in
-order to observe an eclipse of the first satellite of Jupiter; but the
-weather becoming cloudy, we were disappointed.
-
-On the 18th, at day-break, I went on shore, with as many people as could
-possibly be spared from the ship, and began to erect our fort. While
-some were employed in throwing up intrenchments, others were busy in
-cutting pickets and fascines, which the natives, who soon gathered round
-us as they had been used to do, were so far from hindering, that many of
-them voluntarily assisted us, bringing the pickets and fascines from the
-wood where they had been cut, with great alacrity: we had, indeed, been
-so scrupulous of invading their property, that we purchased every stake
-which was used upon this occasion, and cut down no tree till we had
-first obtained their consent. The soil where we constructed our fort was
-sandy, and this made it necessary to strengthen the intrenchments with
-wood; three sides were to be fortified in this manner; the fourth was
-bounded by a river, upon the banks of which I proposed to place a proper
-number of water-casks. This day we served pork to the ship’s company for
-the first time, and the Indians brought down so much bread-fruit and
-cocoa-nuts, that we found it necessary to send away part of them
-unbought, and to acquaint them by signs, that we should want no more for
-two days to come. Every thing was purchased this day with beads: a
-single bead, as big as a pea, being the purchase of five or six
-cocoa-nuts, and as many of the bread-fruit. Mr. Banks’s tent was got up
-before night within the works, and he slept on shore for the first time.
-Proper sentries were placed round it, but no Indian attempted to
-approach it the whole night.
-
-The next morning, our friend Tubourai Tamaide made Mr. Banks a visit at
-the tent, and brought with him not only his wife and family, but the
-roof of a house, and several materials for setting it up, with furniture
-and implements of various kinds, intending, as we understood him, to
-take up his residence in our neighbourhood: this instance of his
-confidence and good-will gave us great pleasure, and we determined to
-strengthen his attachment to us by every means in our power. Soon after
-his arrival, he took Mr. Banks by the hand, and leading him out of the
-line, signified that he should accompany him into the woods. Mr. Banks
-readily consented, and having walked with him about a quarter of a mile,
-they arrived at a kind of awning which he had already set up, and which
-seemed to be his occasional habitation. Here he unfolded a bundle of his
-country cloth, and taking out two garments, one of red cloth, and the
-other of very neat matting, he clothed Mr. Banks in them, and without
-any other ceremony, immediately conducted him back to the tent. His
-attendants soon after brought him some pork and bread-fruit, which he
-ate, dipping his meat into salt water instead of sauce: after his meal
-he retired to Mr. Banks’s bed, and slept about an hour. In the
-afternoon, his wife Tomio brought to the tent a young man about
-two-and-twenty years of age, of a very comely appearance, whom they both
-seemed to acknowledge as their son, though we afterwards discovered that
-he was not so. In the evening, this young man and another chief, who had
-also paid us a visit, went away to the westward, but Tubourai Tamaide
-and his wife returned to the awning in the skirts of the wood.
-
-Our surgeon, Mr. Monkhouse, having walked out this evening, reported,
-that he had seen the body of the man who had been shot at the tents,
-which he said was wrapped in cloth, and placed on a kind of bier,
-supported by stakes, under a roof that seemed to have been set up for
-the purpose: that near it were deposited some instruments of war and
-other things, which he would particularly have examined but for the
-stench of the body, which was intolerable. He said, that he saw also two
-more sheds of the same kind, in one of which were the bones of a human
-body that had lain till they were quite dry. We discovered afterwards,
-that this was the way in which they usually disposed of their dead.
-
-A kind of market now began to be kept just without the lines, and was
-plentifully supplied with every thing but pork. Tubourai Tamaide was our
-constant guest, imitating our manners, even to the using of a knife and
-fork, which he did very handily.
-
-As my curiosity was excited by Mr. Monkhouse’s account of the situation
-of the man who had been shot, I took an opportunity to go with some
-others to see it. I found the shed under which his body lay, close by
-the house in which he resided when he was alive, some others being not
-more than ten yards distant; it was about 15 feet long, and 11 broad,
-and of a proportionable height: one end was wholly open, and the other
-end, and the two sides, were partly enclosed with a kind of wicker work.
-The bier on which the corpse was deposited, was a frame of wood like
-that in which the sea-beds, called cotts, are placed, with a matted
-bottom, and supported by four posts, at the height of about five feet
-from the ground. The body was covered first with a mat, and then with
-white cloth; by the side of it lay a wooden mace, one of their weapons
-of war, and near the head of it, which lay next to the close end of the
-shed, lay two cocoa-nut shells, such as are sometimes used to carry
-water in; at the other end a bunch of green leaves, with some dried
-twigs, all tied together, were stuck in the ground, by which lay a stone
-about as big as a cocoa-nut: near these lay one of the young plantain
-trees, which are used for emblems of peace, and close by it a stone axe.
-At the open end of the shed also hung, in several strings, a great
-number of palm-nuts, and without the shed was stuck upright in the
-ground the stem of a plantain tree about five feet high, upon the top of
-which was placed a cocoa-nut shell full of fresh water: against the side
-of one of the posts hung a small bag, containing a few pieces of
-bread-fruit ready roasted, which were not all put in at the same time,
-for some of them were fresh, and others stale. I took notice that
-several of the natives observed us with a mixture of solicitude and
-jealousy in their countenances, and by their gestures expressed
-uneasiness when we went near the body, standing themselves at a little
-distance while we were making our examination, and appearing to be
-pleased when we came away.
-
-Our residence on shore would by no means have been disagreeable if we
-had not been incessantly tormented by the flies, which, among other
-mischief, made it almost impossible for Mr. Parkinson, Mr. Banks’s
-natural-history painter, to work; for they not only covered his subject
-so as that no part of its surface could be seen, but even ate the colour
-off the paper as fast as he could lay it on. We had recourse to
-musquito-nets and fly-traps, which, though they made the inconvenience
-tolerable, were very far from removing it.
-
-On the 22d, Tootahah gave us a specimen of the music of this country:
-four persons performed upon flutes, which had only two stops, and
-therefore could not sound more than four notes, by half tones: they were
-sounded like our German flutes, except that the performer, instead of
-applying it to his mouth, blew into it with one nostril, while he
-stopped the other with his thumb: to these instruments four other
-persons sung, and kept very good time; but only one tune was played
-during the whole concert.
-
-Several of the natives brought us axes, which they had received from on
-board the Dolphin, to grind and repair; but among others there was one
-which became the subject of much speculation, as it appeared to be
-French: after much enquiry, we learnt that a ship had been here between
-our arrival and the departure of the Dolphin, which we then conjectured
-to have been a Spaniard, but now know to have been the Boudeuse,
-commanded by M. Bougainville.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. X.
-
- AN EXCURSION TO THE EASTWARD, AN ACCOUNT OF SEVERAL INCIDENTS THAT
- HAPPENED BOTH ON BOARD AND ON SHORE, AND OF THE FIRST INTERVIEW WITH
- OBEREA, THE PERSON WHO, WHEN THE DOLPHIN WAS HERE, WAS SUPPOSED TO BE
- QUEEN OF THE ISLAND, WITH A DESCRIPTION OF THE FORT.
-
-
-ON the 24th, Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander examined the country for several
-miles along the shore to the eastward: for about two miles it was flat
-and fertile; after that, the hills stretched quite to the water’s edge,
-and a little farther ran out into the sea, so that they were obliged to
-climb over them. These hills, which were barren, continued for about
-three miles more, and then terminated in a large plain, which was full
-of good houses, and people who appeared to live in great affluence. In
-this place there was a river, much more considerable than that at our
-fort, which issued from a deep and beautiful valley, and, where our
-travellers crossed it, though at some distance from the sea, was near
-one hundred yards wide. About a mile beyond this river the country
-became again barren, the rocks every where projecting into the sea, for
-which reason they resolved to return. Just as they had formed this
-resolution, one of the natives offered them refreshment, which they
-accepted. They found this man to be of a kind that has been described by
-various authors, as mixed with many nations, but distinct from them all.
-His skin was of a dead white, without the least appearance of what is
-called complexion, though some parts of his body were in a small degree
-less white than others: his hair, eye-brows, and beard, were as white as
-his skin; his eyes appeared as if they were bloodshot, and he seemed to
-be very short-sighted.
-
-At their return they were met by Tubourai Tamaide, and his women, who,
-at seeing them, felt a joy which, not being able to express, they burst
-into tears, and wept some time before their passion could be restrained.
-
-This evening Dr. Solander lent his knife to one of these women, who
-neglected to return it, and the next morning Mr. Banks’s also was
-missing; upon this occasion I must bear my testimony, that the people of
-this country, of all ranks, men and women, are the errantest thieves
-upon the face of the earth. The very day after we arrived here, when
-they came on board us, the chiefs were employed in stealing what they
-could in the cabin, and their dependents were no less industrious in
-other parts of the ship: they snatched up every thing that it was
-possible for them to secrete till they got on shore, even to the glass
-ports, two of which they carried off undetected. Tubourai Tamaide was
-the only one except Tootahah who had not been found guilty; and the
-presumption, arising from this circumstance, that he was exempt from a
-vice, of which the whole nation besides were guilty, cannot be supposed
-to outweigh strong appearances to the contrary. Mr. Banks, therefore,
-though not without some reluctance, accused him of having stolen his
-knife: he solemnly and steadily denied that he knew any thing of it;
-upon which Mr. Banks made him understand, that whoever had taken it, he
-was determined to have it returned: upon this resolute declaration, one
-of the natives who was present produced a rag, in which three knives
-were very carefully tied up. One was that which Dr. Solander had lent to
-the woman, another was a table-knife belonging to me, and the owner of
-the third was not known. With these the chief immediately set out, in
-order to make restitution of them to their owners at the tents. Mr.
-Banks remained with the women, who expressed great apprehensions that
-some mischief was designed against their lord. When he came to the
-tents, he restored one of the knives to Dr. Solander, and another to me,
-the third not being owned, and then began to search for Mr. Banks’s in
-all the places where he had ever seen it. After some time, one of Mr.
-Banks’s servants, understanding what he was about, immediately fetched
-his master’s knife, which it seems he had laid by the day before, and
-till now knew nothing of its having been missed. Tubourai Tamaide, upon
-this demonstration of his innocence, expressed the strongest emotions of
-mind, both in his looks and gestures: the tears started from his eyes;
-and he made signs with the knife, that, if he was ever guilty of such an
-action as had been imputed to him, he would submit to have his throat
-cut. He then rushed out of the lines, and returned hastily to Mr. Banks,
-with a countenance that severely reproached him with his suspicions. Mr.
-Banks soon understood that the knife had been received from his servant,
-and was scarcely less affected at what had happened than the chief: he
-felt himself to be the guilty person, and was very desirous to atone for
-his fault. The poor Indian, however violent his passions, was a stranger
-to sullen resentment; and upon Mr. Banks’s spending a little time
-familiarly with him, and making him a few trifling presents, he forgot
-the wrongs that had been done him, and was perfectly reconciled.
-
-Upon this occasion it may be observed, that these people have a
-knowledge of right and wrong from the mere dictates of natural
-conscience; and involuntarily condemn themselves when they do that to
-others which they would condemn others for doing to them. That Tubourai
-Tamaide felt the force of moral obligation is certain; for the
-imputation of an action which he considered as indifferent would not,
-when it appeared to be groundless, have moved him with such excess of
-passion. We must indeed estimate the virtue of these people by the only
-standard of morality, the conformity of their conduct to what in their
-opinion is right; but we must not hastily conclude that theft is a
-testimony of the same depravity in them that it is in us, in the
-instances in which our people were sufferers by their dishonesty; for
-their temptation was such as to surmount would be considered as a proof
-of uncommon integrity among those who have more knowledge, better
-principles, and stronger motives to resist the temptations of illicit
-advantage: an Indian among penny knives, and beads, or even nails and
-broken glass, is in the same state of trial with the meanest servant in
-Europe among unlocked coffers of jewels and gold.
-
-On the 26th, I mounted six swivel guns upon the fort, which I was sorry
-to see struck the natives with dread: some fishermen who lived upon the
-point removed farther off, and Owhaw told us, by signs, that in four
-days we should fire great guns.
-
-On the 27th, Tubourai Tamaide, with a friend, who ate with a voracity
-that I never saw before, and the three women that usually attended him,
-whose names were TERAPO, TIRAO, and OMIE, dined at the fort: in the
-evening they took their leave, and set out for the house which Tubourai
-Tamaide had set up in the skirts of the wood; but in less than a quarter
-of an hour he returned in great emotion, and hastily seizing Mr. Banks’s
-arm, made signs that he should follow him. Mr. Banks immediately
-complied, and they soon came up to a place where they found the ship’s
-butcher, with a reaping-hook in his hand: here the chief stopped, and,
-in a transport of rage which rendered his signs scarcely intelligible,
-intimated that the butcher had threatened, or attempted, to cut his
-wife’s throat with the reaping-hook. Mr. Banks then signified to him,
-that if he could fully explain the offence, the man should be punished.
-Upon this he became more calm, and made Mr. Banks understand that the
-offender, having taken a fancy to a stone-hatchet which lay in his
-house, had offered to purchase it of his wife for a nail: that she
-having refused to part with it upon any terms, he had catched it up, and
-throwing down the nail, threatened to cut her throat if she made any
-resistance: to prove this charge the hatchet and the nail were produced,
-and the butcher had so little to say in his defence, that there was not
-the least reason to doubt of its truth.
-
-Mr. Banks having reported this matter to me, I took an opportunity, when
-the chief and his women, with other Indians, were on board the ship, to
-call up the butcher, and after a recapitulation of the charge and the
-proof, I gave orders that he should be punished, as well to prevent
-other offences of the same kind, as to acquit Mr. Banks of his promise:
-the Indians saw him stripped and tied up to the rigging with a fixed
-attention, waiting in silent suspense for the event; but as soon as the
-first stroke was given, they interfered with great agitation, earnestly
-intreating that the rest of the punishment might be remitted: to this,
-however, for many reasons, I could not consent, and when they found that
-they could not prevail by their intercession, they gave vent to their
-pity by tears.
-
-Their tears, indeed, like those of children, were always ready to
-express any passion that was strongly excited, and like those of
-children they also appeared to be forgotten as soon as shed; of which
-the following, among many others, is a remarkable instance. Very early
-in the morning of the 28th, even before it was day, a great number of
-them came down to the fort, and Terapo being observed among the women on
-the outside of the gate, Mr. Banks went out and brought her in; he saw
-that the tears then stood in her eyes, and as soon as she entered they
-began to flow in great abundance: he enquired earnestly the cause, but
-instead of answering she took from under her garment a shark’s tooth,
-and struck it six or seven times into her head with great force; a
-profusion of blood followed, and she talked loud, but in a most
-melancholy tone, for some minutes, without at all regarding his
-enquiries, which he repeated with still more impatience and concern,
-while the other Indians, to his great surprise, talked and laughed,
-without taking the least notice of her distress. But her own behaviour
-was still more extraordinary. As soon as the bleeding was over, she
-looked up with a smile, and began to collect some small pieces of cloth,
-which during her bleeding she had thrown down to catch the blood; as
-soon as she had picked them all up, she carried them out of the tent,
-and threw them into the sea, carefully dispersing them abroad, as if she
-wished to prevent the sight of them from reviving the remembrance of
-what she had done. She then plunged into the river, and after having
-washed her whole body returned to the tents with the same gaiety and
-cheerfulness as if nothing had happened.
-
-It is not, indeed, strange, that the sorrows of these artless people
-should be transient, any more than that their passions should be
-suddenly and strongly expressed: what they feel they have never been
-taught either to disguise or suppress, and having no habits of thinking
-which perpetually recall the past, and anticipate the future, they are
-affected by all the changes of the passing hour, and reflect the colour
-of the time, however frequently it may vary: they have no project which
-is to be pursued from day to day, the subject of unremitted anxiety and
-solicitude, that first rushes into the mind when they awake in the
-morning, and is last dismissed when they sleep at the night. Yet if we
-admit that they are upon the whole happier than we, we must admit that
-the child is happier than the man, and that we are losers by the
-perfection of our nature, the increase of our knowledge, and the
-enlargement of our views.
-
-Canoes were continually coming in during all this forenoon, and the
-tents at the fort were crowded with people of both sexes from different
-parts of the island. I was myself busy on board the ship, but Mr.
-Mollineux, our master, who was one of those that made the last voyage in
-the Dolphin, went on shore. As soon as he entered Mr. Banks’s tent he
-fixed his eyes upon one of the women, who was sitting there with great
-composure among the rest, and immediately declared her to be the person
-who at that time was supposed to be the queen of the island; she also,
-at the same time, acknowledging him to be one of the strangers whom she
-had seen before. The attention of all present was now diverted from
-every other object, and wholly engaged in considering a person who had
-made so distinguished a figure in the accounts that had been given of
-this island by its first discoverers; and we soon learnt that her name
-was OBEREA. She seemed to be about forty years of age, and was not only
-tall, but of a large make; her skin was white, and there was an uncommon
-intelligence and sensibility in her eyes: she appeared to have been
-handsome when she was young, but at this time little more than memorials
-of her beauty were left.
-
-As soon as her quality was known, an offer was made to conduct her to
-the ship. Of this she readily accepted, and came on board with two men
-and several women, who seemed to be all of her family: I received her
-with such marks of distinction as I thought would gratify her most, and
-was not sparing of my presents, among which this august personage seemed
-particularly delighted with a child’s doll. After some time spent on
-board, I attended her back to the shore; and as soon as we landed, she
-presented me with a hog, and several bunches of plantains, which she
-caused to be carried from her canoes up to the fort in a kind of
-procession, of which she and myself brought up the rear. In our way to
-the fort we met Tootahah, who, though not king, appeared to be at this
-time invested with the sovereign authority; he seemed not to be well
-pleased with the distinction that was showed to the lady, and became so
-jealous when she produced her doll, that to propitiate him it was
-thought proper to compliment him with another. At this time he thought
-fit to prefer a doll to a hatchet; but this preference arose only from a
-childish jealousy, which could not be soothed but by a gift of exactly
-the same kind with that which had been presented to Oberea; for dolls in
-a very short time were universally considered as trifles of no value.
-
-The men who had visited us from time to time had, without scruple, eaten
-of our provisions; but the women had never yet been prevailed upon to
-taste a morsel. To day, however, though they refused the most pressing
-solicitations to dine with the gentlemen, they afterwards retired to the
-servants’ apartment, and ate of plantains very heartily; a mystery of
-female economy here, which none of us could explain.
-
-On the 29th, not very early in the forenoon, Mr. Banks went to pay his
-court to Oberea, and was told that she was still asleep under the awning
-of her canoe: thither therefore he went, intending to call her up, a
-liberty which he thought he might take, without any danger of giving
-offence: but, upon looking into her chamber, to his great astonishment
-he found her in bed with a handsome young fellow about five-and-twenty,
-whose name was OBADÉE: he retreated with some haste and confusion, but
-was soon made to understand, that such amours gave no occasion to
-scandal, and that Obadée was universally known to have been selected by
-her as the object of her private favours. The lady being too polite to
-suffer Mr. Banks to wait long in her antichamber, dressed herself with
-more than usual expedition; and, as a token of special grace, clothed
-him in a suit of fine cloth and proceeded with him to the tents. In the
-evening Mr. Banks paid a visit to Tubourai Tamaide, as he had often done
-before, by candle-light, and was equally grieved and surprised to find
-him and his family in a melancholy mood, and most of them in tears: he
-endeavoured in vain to discover the cause, and therefore his stay among
-them was but short. When he reported this circumstance to the officers
-at the fort, they recollected that Owhaw had foretold, that in four days
-we should fire our great guns; and as this was the eve of the third day,
-the situation in which Tubourai Tamaide and his family had been found
-alarmed them. The sentries therefore were doubled at the fort, and the
-gentlemen slept under arms. At two in the morning, Mr. Banks himself
-went round the point, but found every thing so quiet, that he gave up
-all suspicions of mischief intended by the natives as groundless. We
-had, however, another source of security,—our little fortification was
-now complete. The north and south sides consisted of a bank of earth
-four feet and a half high on the inside, and a ditch without ten feet
-broad and six deep: on the west side, facing the bay, there was a bank
-of earth four feet high, and palisadoes upon that, but no ditch, the
-works here being at high-water mark: on the east side, upon the bank of
-the river, was placed a double row of water-casks, filled with water;
-and as this was the weakest side, the two four pounders were planted
-there, and six swivel guns were mounted so as to command the only two
-avenues from the woods. Our garrison consisted of about five-and-forty
-men with small arms, including the officers and the gentlemen who
-resided on shore; and our sentries were as well relieved as in the best
-regulated frontier in Europe.
-
-We continued our vigilance the next day, though we had no particular
-reason to think it necessary; but about ten o’clock in the morning,
-Tomio came running to the tents, with a mixture of grief and fear in her
-countenance, and taking Mr. Banks, to whom they applied in every
-emergency and distress, by the arm, intimated that Tubourai Tamaide was
-dying, in consequence of something which our people had given him to
-eat, and that he must instantly go with her to his house. Mr. Banks set
-out without delay, and found his Indian friend leaning his head against
-a post, in an attitude of the utmost languor and despondency: the people
-about him intimated that he had been vomiting, and brought out a leaf
-folded up with great care, which they said contained some of the poison,
-by the deleterious effects of which he was now dying. Mr. Banks hastily
-opened the leaf, and upon examining its contents found them to be no
-other than a chew of tobacco, which the chief had begged of some of our
-people, and which they had indiscreetly given him: he had observed that
-they kept it long in the mouth, and being desirous of doing the same, he
-had chewed it to powder, and swallowed the spittle. During the
-examination of the leaf and its contents, he looked up at Mr. Banks with
-the most piteous aspect, and intimated that he had but a very short time
-to live. Mr. Banks, however, being now master of his disease, directed
-him to drink plentifully of cocoa-nut milk, which in a short time put an
-end to his sickness and apprehensions; and he spent the day at the fort
-with that uncommon flow of cheerfulness and good humour which is always
-produced by a sudden and unexpected relief from pain either of body or
-mind.
-
-Captain Wallis having brought home one of the adzes which these people,
-having no metal of any kind, make of stone, Mr. Stevens, the secretary
-to the Admiralty, procured one to be made of iron in imitation of it,
-which I brought out with me, to show how much we excelled in making
-tools after their own fashion: this I had not yet produced, as it never
-happened to come into my mind. But on the first of May Tootahah coming
-on board about ten o’clock in the forenoon, expressed a great curiosity
-to see the contents of every chest and drawer that was in my cabin: as I
-always made a point of gratifying him, I opened them immediately; and
-having taken a fancy to many things that he saw, and collected them
-together, he at last happened to cast his eye upon this adze: he
-instantly snatched it up with the greatest eagerness, and putting away
-every thing which he had before selected, he asked me whether I would
-let him have that: I readily consented; and, as if he was afraid I
-should repent, he carried it off immediately in a transport of joy,
-without making any other request, which, whatever had been our
-liberality, was seldom the case.
-
-About noon, a chief, who had dined with me a few days before,
-accompanied by some of his women, came on board alone: I had observed
-that he was fed by his women, but I made no doubt that upon occasion he
-would condescend to feed himself: in this, however, I found myself
-mistaken. When my noble guest was seated, and the dinner upon the table,
-I helped him to some victuals: as I observed that he did not immediately
-begin his meal, I pressed him to eat; but he still continued to sit
-motionless like a statue, without attempting to put a single morsel into
-his mouth, and would certainly have gone without his dinner, if one of
-the servants had not fed him.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. XI.
-
- THE OBSERVATORY SET UP; THE QUADRANT STOLEN, AND CONSEQUENCES OF THE
- THEFT: A VISIT TO TOOTAHAH: DESCRIPTION OF A WRESTLING-MATCH: EUROPEAN
- SEEDS SOWN: NAMES GIVEN TO OUR PEOPLE BY THE INDIANS.
-
-
-IN the afternoon of Monday the first of May, we set up the observatory,
-and took the astronomical quadrant, with some other instruments, on
-shore, for the first time.
-
-The next morning, about nine o’clock, I went on shore with Mr. Green to
-fix the quadrant in a situation for use, when to our inexpressible
-surprise and concern it was not to be found. It had been deposited in
-the tent which was reserved for my use, where, as I passed the night on
-board, nobody slept: it had never been taken out of the packing-case,
-which was eighteen inches square, and the whole was of considerable
-weight; a sentinel had been posted the whole night within five yards of
-the tent door, and none of the other instruments were missing. We at
-first suspected that it might have been stolen by some of our own
-people, who seeing a deal box, and not knowing the contents, might think
-it contained nails, or some other subjects of traffic with the natives.
-A large reward was therefore offered to any one who could find it, as,
-without this, we could not perform the service for which our voyage was
-principally undertaken. Our search in the mean time was not confined to
-the fort and places adjacent, but as the case might possibly have been
-carried back to the ship, if any of our own people had been the thieves,
-the most diligent search was made for it on board; all the parties,
-however, returned without any news of the quadrant. Mr. Banks,
-therefore, who upon such occasions declined neither labour nor risk, and
-who had more influence over the Indians than any of us, determined to go
-in search of it into the woods; he hoped, that if it had been stolen by
-the natives, he should find it wherever they had opened the box, as they
-would immediately discover that to them it would be wholly useless: or,
-if in this expectation he should be disappointed, that he might recover
-it by the ascendancy he had acquired over the chiefs. He set out,
-accompanied by a midshipman and Mr. Green, and as he was crossing the
-river he was met by Tubourai Tamaide, who immediately made the figure of
-a triangle with three bits of straw upon his hand. By this Mr. Banks
-knew that the Indians were the thieves; and that, although they had
-opened the case, they were not disposed to part with the contents. No
-time was therefore to be lost, and Mr. Banks made Tubourai Tamaide
-understand, that he must instantly go with him to the place whither the
-quadrant had been carried; he consented, and they set out together to
-the eastward, the chief enquiring at every house which they passed after
-the thief by name: the people readily told him which way he was gone,
-and how long it was since he had been there: the hope which this gave
-them that they should overtake him, supported them under their fatigue,
-and they pressed forward, sometimes walking, sometimes running, though
-the weather was intolerably hot; when they had climbed a hill at the
-distance of about four miles, their conductor showed them a point full
-three miles farther, and gave them to understand that they were not to
-expect the instrument till they had got thither. Here they paused; they
-had no arms, except a pair of pistols, which Mr. Banks always carried in
-his pocket; they were going to a place that was at least seven miles
-distant from the fort, where the Indians might be less submissive than
-at home, and to take from them what they had ventured their lives to
-get; and what, notwithstanding our conjectures, they appeared desirous
-to keep: these were discouraging circumstances, and their situation
-would become more critical at every step. They determined, however, not
-to relinquish their enterprise, nor to pursue it without taking the best
-measures for their security that were in their power. It was therefore
-determined, that Mr. Banks and Mr. Green should go on, and that the
-midshipman should return to me, and desire that I would send a party of
-men after them, acquainting me at the same time, that it was impossible
-they should return till it was dark. Upon receiving this message, I set
-out, with such a party as I thought sufficient for the occasion; leaving
-orders, both at the ship and at the fort, that no canoe should be
-suffered to go out of the bay, but that none of the natives should be
-seized or detained.
-
-In the mean time, Mr. Banks and Mr. Green pursued their journey, under
-the auspices of Tubourai Tamaide, and in the very spot which he had
-specified, they met one of his own people, with part of the quadrant in
-his hand. At this most welcome sight they stopped; and a great number of
-Indians immediately came up, some of whom pressing rather rudely upon
-them, Mr. Banks thought it necessary to show one of his pistols, the
-sight of which reduced them instantly to order: as the crowd that
-gathered round them was every moment increasing, he marked out a circle
-in the grass, and they ranged themselves on the outside of it to the
-number of several hundreds with great quietness and decorum. Into the
-middle of this circle, the box, which was now arrived, was ordered to be
-brought, with several reading-glasses, and other small matters, which in
-their hurry they had put into a pistol-case, that Mr. Banks knew to be
-his property, it having been some time before stolen from the tents,
-with a horse pistol in it, which he immediately demanded, and which was
-also restored.
-
-Mr. Green was impatient to see whether all that had been taken away was
-returned, and upon examining the box found the stand, and a few small
-things of less consequence, wanting; several persons were sent in search
-of these, and most of the small things were returned: but it was
-signified that the thief had not brought the stand so far, and that it
-would be delivered to our friends as they went back; this being
-confirmed by Tubourai Tamaide, they prepared to return, as nothing would
-then be wanting but what might easily be supplied; and after they had
-advanced about two miles, I met them with my party, to our mutual
-satisfaction, congratulating each other upon the recovery of the
-quadrant, with a pleasure proportionate to the importance of the event.
-
-About eight o’clock, Mr. Banks with Tubourai Tamaide got back to the
-fort; when to his great surprise, he found Tootahah in custody, and many
-of the natives in the utmost terror and distress, crowding about the
-gate. He went hastily in, some of the Indians were suffered to follow
-him, and the scene was extremely affecting. Tubourai Tamaide pressing
-forward, ran up to Tootahah, and catching him in his arms, they both
-burst into tears, and wept over each other, without being able to speak:
-the other Indians were also in tears for their chief, both he and they
-being strongly possessed with the notion that he was to be put to death.
-In this situation they continued till I entered the fort, which was
-about a quarter of an hour afterwards. I was equally surprised and
-concerned at what had happened, the confining Tootahah being contrary to
-my orders, and therefore instantly set him at liberty. Upon inquiring
-into the affair, I was told, that my going into the woods with a party
-of men under arms, at a time when a robbery had been committed, which it
-was supposed I should resent, in proportion to our apparent injury by
-the loss, had so alarmed the natives, that in the evening they began to
-leave the neighbourhood of the fort with their effects: that a double
-canoe having been seen to put off from the bottom of the bay by Mr.
-Gore, the second lieutenant, who was left in command on board the ship,
-and who had received orders not to suffer any canoe to go out, he sent
-the boatswain with a boat after her to bring her back: that as soon as
-the boat came up, the Indians being alarmed, leaped into the sea; and
-that Tootahah, being unfortunately one of the number, the boatswain took
-him up, and brought him to the ship, suffering the rest of the people to
-swim on shore: that Mr. Gore, not sufficiently attending to the order
-that none of the people should be confined, had sent him to the fort,
-and Mr. Hicks, the first lieutenant, who commanded there, receiving him
-in charge from Mr. Gore, did not think himself at liberty to dismiss
-him.
-
-The notion that we intended to put him to death had possessed him so
-strongly, that he could not be persuaded to the contrary till by my
-orders he was led out of the fort. The people received him as they would
-have done a father in the same circumstances, and every one pressed
-forward to embrace him. Sudden joy is commonly liberal, without a
-scrupulous regard to merit: and Tootahah, in the first expansion of his
-heart, upon being unexpectedly restored to liberty and life, insisted
-upon our receiving a present of two hogs; though, being conscious that
-upon this occasion we had no claim to favours, we refused them many
-times.
-
-Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander attended the next morning in their usual
-capacity of marketmen, but very few Indians appeared, and those who came
-brought no provisions. Tootahah, however, sent some of his people for
-the canoe that had been detained, which they took away. A canoe having
-also been detained that belonged to Oberea, TUPIA, the person who
-managed her affairs when the Dolphin was here, was sent to examine
-whether any thing on board had been taken away: and he was so well
-satisfied of the contrary, that he left the canoe where he found it, and
-joined us at the fort, where he spent the day, and slept on board the
-canoe at night. About noon, some fishing boats came abreast of the
-tents, but would part with very little of what they had on board; and we
-felt the want of cocoa-nuts and bread-fruit very severely. In the course
-of the day, Mr. Banks walked out into the woods, that by conversing with
-the people he might recover their confidence and good-will: he found
-them civil, but they all complained of the ill-treatment of their Chief;
-who, they said, had been beaten and pulled by the hair. Mr. Banks
-endeavoured to convince them, that he had suffered no personal violence,
-which to the best of our knowledge was true; yet, perhaps the boatswain
-had behaved with a brutality which he was afraid or ashamed to
-acknowledge. The Chief himself being probably, upon recollection, of
-opinion that we had ill deserved the hogs, which he had left with us as
-a present, sent a messenger in the afternoon to demand an axe, and a
-shirt, in return: but as I was told that he did not intend to come down
-to the fort for ten days, I excused myself from giving them till I
-should see him, hoping that his impatience might induce him to fetch
-them, and knowing that absence would probably continue the coolness
-between us, to which the first interview might put an end.
-
-The next day we were still more sensible of the inconvenience we had
-incurred by giving offence to the people in the person of their chief,
-for the market was so ill-supplied that we were in want of necessaries.
-Mr. Banks therefore went into the woods to Tubourai Tamaide, and with
-some difficulty persuaded him to let us have five baskets of
-bread-fruit; a very seasonable supply, as they contained above one
-hundred and twenty. In the afternoon another messenger arrived from
-Tootahah for the axe and shirt; as it was now become absolutely
-necessary to recover the friendship of this man, without which it would
-be scarcely possible to procure provisions, I sent word that Mr. Banks
-and myself would visit him on the morrow, and bring what he wanted with
-us.
-
-Early the next morning he sent again to remind me of my promise, and his
-people seemed to wait till we should set out with great impatience: I
-therefore ordered the pinnace, in which I embarked with Mr. Banks and
-Dr. Solander about ten o’clock: we took one of Tootahah’s people in the
-boat with us, and in about an hour we arrived at his place of residence
-which is called EPARRE, and is about four miles to the westward of the
-tents.
-
-We found the people waiting for us in great numbers upon the shore, so
-that it would have been impossible for us to have proceeded, if way had
-not been made for us by a tall well-looking man, who had something like
-a turban about his head, and a long white stick in his hand, with which
-he laid about him at an unmerciful rate. This man conducted us to the
-chief, while the people shouted round us, _Taio Tootahah_, “Tootahah is
-your friend.” We found him, like an ancient Patriarch, sitting under a
-tree, with a number of venerable old men standing round him; he made a
-sign to us to sit down, and immediately asked for his axe: this I
-presented to him, with an upper garment of broad cloth, made after the
-country fashion, and trimmed with tape, to which I also added a shirt:
-he received them with great satisfaction, and immediately put on the
-garment; but the shirt he gave to the person who had cleared the way for
-us upon our landing, who was now seated by us, and of whom he seemed
-desirous that we should take particular notice. In a short time, Oberea,
-and several other women whom we knew, came and sat down among us:
-Tootahah left us several times, but after a short absence returned; we
-thought it had been to shew himself in his new finery to the people, but
-we wronged him, for it was to give directions for our refreshment and
-entertainment. While we were waiting for his return the last time he
-left us, very impatient to be dismissed, as we were almost suffocated in
-the crowd, word was brought us, that he expected us elsewhere: we found
-him sitting under the awning of our own boat, and making signs that we
-should come to him: as many of us therefore went on board as the boat
-would hold, and he then ordered bread-fruit and cocoa-nuts to be
-brought, of both which we tasted, rather to gratify him than because we
-had a desire to eat. A message was soon after brought him, upon which he
-went out of the boat, and we were in a short time desired to follow. We
-were conducted to a large area or court-yard, which was railed round
-with bamboos about three feet high, on one side of his house, where an
-entertainment was provided for us, entirely new: this was a
-wrestling-match. At the upper end of the area sat the chief, and several
-of his principal men were ranged on each side of him, so as to form a
-semicircle; these were the judges, by whom the victor was to be
-applauded; seats were also left for us at each end of the line; but we
-chose rather to be at liberty among the rest of the spectators.
-
-When all was ready, ten or twelve persons, whom we understood to be the
-combatants, and who were naked, except a cloth that was fastened about
-the waist, entered the area, and walked slowly round it, in a stooping
-posture, with their left hands on their right breasts, and their right
-hands open, with which they frequently struck the left fore-arm so as to
-produce a quick smart sound: this was a general challenge to the
-combatants whom they were to engage, or any other person present: after
-these followed others in the same manner, and then a particular
-challenge was given, by which each man singled out his antagonist: this
-was done by joining the finger ends of both hands, and bringing them to
-the breast, at the same time moving the elbows up and down with a quick
-motion: if the person to whom this was addressed accepted the challenge,
-he repeated the signs, and immediately each put himself into an attitude
-to engage; the next minute they closed; but, except in first seizing
-each other, it was a mere contest of strength: each endeavoured to lay
-hold of the other, first by the thigh, and if that failed by the hand,
-the hair, the cloth, or elsewhere as he could: when this was done they
-grappled, without the least dexterity or skill, till one of them, by
-having a more advantageous hold, or greater muscular force, threw the
-other on his back. When the contest was over, the old men gave their
-plaudits to the victor in a few words, which they repeated together in a
-kind of tune: his conquest was also generally celebrated by three
-huzzas. The entertainment was then suspended for a few minutes, after
-which another couple of wrestlers came forward and engaged in the same
-manner: if it happened that neither was thrown, after the contest had
-continued about a minute, they parted, either by consent or the
-intervention of their friends, and in this case each slapped his arm, as
-a challenge to a new engagement, either with the same antagonist or some
-other. While the wrestlers were engaged, another party of men performed
-a dance which lasted also about a minute; but neither of these parties
-took the least notice of each other, their attention being wholly fixed
-on what they were doing. We observed with pleasure, that the conqueror
-never exulted over the vanquished, and that the vanquished never repined
-at the success of the conqueror; the whole contest was carried on with
-perfect good-will and good-humour, though in the presence of at least
-five hundred spectators, of whom some were women. The number of women
-indeed was comparatively small, none but those of rank were present, and
-we had reason to believe that they would not have been spectators of
-this exercise but in compliment to us.
-
-This lasted about two hours; during all which time the man who had made
-way for us when we landed, kept the people at a proper distance, by
-striking those who pressed forward very severely with his stick: upon
-inquiry we learnt, that he was an officer belonging to Tootahah, acting
-as a master of the ceremonies.
-
-It is scarcely possible for those who are acquainted with the athletic
-sports of very remote antiquity, not to remark a rude resemblance of
-them in this wrestling-match among the natives of a little island in the
-midst of the Pacific Ocean: and even our female readers may recollect
-the account given of them by Fenelon in his Telemachus, where, though
-the events are fictitious, the manners of the age are faithfully
-transcribed from authors by whom they are supposed to have been truly
-related.
-
-When the wrestling was over, we were given to understand that two hogs,
-and a large quantity of bread-fruit, were preparing for our dinner,
-which, as our appetites were now keen, was very agreeable intelligence.
-Our host, however, seemed to repent of his liberality; for, instead of
-setting his two hogs before us, he ordered one of them to be carried
-into our boat; at first we were not sorry for this new disposition of
-matters, thinking that we should dine more comfortably in the boat than
-on shore, as the crowd would more easily be kept at a distance: but when
-we came on board, he ordered us to proceed with his hog to the ship:
-this was mortifying, as we were now to row four miles while our dinner
-was growing cold; however, we thought fit to comply, and were at last
-gratified with the cheer that he had provided, of which he and Tubourai
-Tamaide had a liberal share.
-
-Our reconciliation with this man operated upon the people like a charm;
-for he was no sooner known to be on board, than bread-fruit, cocoa-nuts,
-and other provisions were brought to the fort in great plenty.
-
-Affairs now went on in the usual channel; but pork being still a scarce
-commodity, our master, Mr. Mollineux, and Mr. Green, went in the pinnace
-to the eastward, on the 8th, early in the morning to see whether they
-could procure any hogs or poultry in that part of the country: they
-proceeded in that direction twenty miles; but though they saw many hogs,
-and one turtle, they could not purchase either at any price: the people
-every where told them, that they all belonged to Tootahah, and that they
-could sell none of them without his permission. We now began to think
-that this man was indeed a great prince; for an influence so extensive
-and absolute could be acquired by no other. And we afterwards found that
-he administered the government of this part of the island, as sovereign,
-for a minor whom we never saw all the time that we were upon it. When
-Mr. Green returned from this expedition, he said he had seen a tree of a
-size which he was afraid to relate, it being no less than sixty yards in
-circumference; but Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander soon explained to him,
-that it was a species of the fig, the branches of which, bending down,
-take fresh root in the earth, and thus form a congeries of trunks, which
-being very close to each other, and all joined by a common vegetation,
-might easily be mistaken for one.
-
-Though the market at the fort was now tolerably supplied, provisions
-were brought more slowly; a sufficient quantity used to be purchased
-between sunrise and eight o’clock, but it was now become necessary to
-attend the greatest part of the day. Mr. Banks, therefore, fixed his
-little boat up before the door of the fort, which was of great use as a
-place to trade in: hitherto we had purchased cocoa-nuts and bread-fruit
-for beads; but the market becoming rather slack in these articles, we
-were now, for the first time, forced to bring out our nails: one of our
-smallest size, which was about four inches long, procured us twenty
-cocoa-nuts, and bread-fruit in proportion, so that in a short time our
-first plenty was restored.
-
-On the 9th, soon after breakfast, we received a visit from Oberea, being
-the first that she had made us after the loss of our quadrant, and the
-unfortunate confinement of Tootahah; with her came her present
-favourite, Obadée, and Tupia: they brought us a hog and some
-bread-fruit, in return for which we gave her a hatchet. We had now
-afforded our Indian friends a new and interesting object of curiosity,
-our forge, which having been set up some time, was almost constantly at
-work. It was now common for them to bring pieces of iron, which we
-suppose they must have got from the Dolphin, to be made into tools of
-various kinds; and as I was very desirous to gratify them, they were
-indulged except when the smith’s time was too precious to be spared.
-Oberea having received her hatchet, produced as much old iron as would
-have made another, with a request that another might be made of it; in
-this, however, I could not gratify her, upon which she brought out a
-broken axe, and desired it might be mended: I was glad of an opportunity
-to compromise the difference between us: her axe was mended, and she
-appeared to be content. They went away at night, and took with them the
-canoe, which had been a considerable time at the point, but promised to
-return in three days.
-
-On the 10th, I put some seeds of melons and other plants into a spot of
-ground which had been turned up for the purpose; they had all been
-sealed up by the person of whom they were bought, in small bottles with
-rosin; but none of them came up except mustard; even the cucumbers and
-melons failed, and Mr. Banks is of opinion that they were spoiled by the
-total exclusion of fresh air.
-
-This day we learnt the Indian name of the island, which is OTAHEITE, and
-by that name I shall hereafter distinguish it: but after great pains
-taken we found it utterly impossible to teach the Indians to pronounce
-our names; we had, therefore, new names, consisting of such sounds as
-they produced in the attempt. They called me _Toote_; Mr. Hicks, _Hete_;
-Mollineux they renounced in absolute despair, and called the Master
-_Boba_, from his Christian name Robert; Mr. Gore was _Toarro_; Dr.
-Solander, _Torano_; and Mr. Banks, _Tapane_; Mr. Green, _Eteree_; Mr.
-Parkinson, _Patini_; Mr. Sporing, _Polini_; Petersgill, _Petrodero_; and
-in this manner they had now formed names for almost every man in the
-ship: in some, however, it was not easy to find any traces of the
-original, and they were perhaps not mere arbitrary sounds formed upon
-the occasion, but significant words in their own language. Monkhouse,
-the Midshipman, who commanded the party that killed the man for stealing
-the musket, they called _Matte_; not merely by an attempt to imitate in
-sound the first syllable of Monkhouse, but because _Matte_ signifies
-_dead_; and this probably might be the case with others.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. XII.
-
- SOME LADIES VISIT THE FORT WITH VERY UNCOMMON CEREMONIES: THE INDIANS
- ATTEND DIVINE SERVICE, AND IN THE EVENING EXHIBIT A MOST EXTRAORDINARY
- SPECTACLE: TUBOURAI TAMAIDE FALLS INTO TEMPTATION.
-
-
-FRIDAY, the 12th of May, was distinguished by a visit from some ladies
-whom we had never seen before, and who introduced themselves with some
-very singular ceremonies. Mr. Banks was trading in his boat at the gate
-of the fort as usual, in company with Tootahah, who had that morning
-paid him a visit, and some other of the natives; between nine and ten
-o’clock, a double canoe came to the landing-place, under the awning of
-which sat a man and two women: the Indians that were about Mr. Banks
-made signs that he should go out to meet them, which he hastened to do;
-but by the time he could get out of the boat, they had advanced within
-ten yards of him; they then stopped, and made signs that he should do so
-too, laying down about a dozen young plantain trees, and some other
-small plants: he complied, and the people having made a lane between
-them, the man, who appeared to be a servant, brought six of them to Mr.
-Banks by one of each at a time, passing and repassing six times, and
-always pronouncing a short sentence when he delivered them. Tupia, who
-stood by Mr. Banks, acted as his master of the ceremonies, and receiving
-the branches as they were brought, laid them down in the boat. When this
-was done, another man brought a large bundle of cloth, which having
-opened, he spread piece by piece upon the ground, in the space between
-Mr. Banks and his visitors; there were nine pieces, and having laid
-three pieces one upon another, the foremost of the women, who seemed to
-be the principal, and who was called OORATTOOA, stepped upon them, and
-taking up her garments all round her to the waist, turned about, with
-great composure and deliberation, and with an air of perfect innocence
-and simplicity, three times; when this was done, she dropped the veil,
-and stepping off the cloth, three more pieces were laid on, and she
-repeated the ceremony, then stepping off as before, the last three were
-laid on, and the ceremony was repeated in the same manner the third
-time. Immediately after this the cloth was rolled up, and given to Mr.
-Banks as a present from the lady, who, with her friend, came up and
-saluted him. He made such presents to them both, as he thought would be
-most acceptable, and after having staid about an hour they went away. In
-the evening the Gentlemen at the fort had a visit from Oberea, and her
-favourite female attendant, whose name was OTHEOTHEA, an agreeable girl,
-whom they were the more pleased to see, because, having been some days
-absent, it had been reported she was either sick or dead.
-
-On the 13th, the market being over about ten o’clock, Mr. Banks walked
-into the woods with his gun, as he generally did, for the benefit of the
-shade in the heat of the day: as he was returning back, he met Tubourai
-Tamaide, near his occasional dwelling, and stopping to spend a little
-time with him, he suddenly took the gun out of Mr. Banks’s hand, cocked
-it, and, holding it up in the air, drew the trigger: fortunately for him
-it flashed in the pan: Mr. Banks immediately took it from him, not a
-little surprised how he had acquired sufficient knowledge of a gun to
-discharge it, and reproved him with great severity for what he had done.
-As it was of infinite importance to keep the Indians totally ignorant of
-the management of fire-arms, he had taken every opportunity of
-intimating that they could never offend him so highly as by even
-touching his piece; it was now proper to enforce this prohibition, and
-he therefore added threats to his reproof: the Indian bore all
-patiently; but the moment Mr. Banks crossed the river, he set off with
-all his family and furniture for his house at Eparre. This being quickly
-known from the Indians at the fort, and great inconvenience being
-apprehended from the displeasure of this man, who upon all occasions had
-been particularly useful, Mr. Banks determined to follow him without
-delay, and solicit his return: he set out the same evening accompanied
-by Mr. Mollineux, and found him sitting in the middle of a large circle
-of people, to whom he had probably related what had happened, and his
-fears of the consequences; he was himself the very picture of grief and
-dejection, and the same passions were strongly marked in the
-countenances of all the people that surrounded him. When Mr. Banks and
-Mr. Mollineux went into the circle, one of the women expressed her
-trouble, as Terapo had done upon another occasion, and struck a shark’s
-tooth into her head several times, till it was covered with blood. Mr.
-Banks lost no time in putting an end to this universal distress; he
-assured the Chief, that every thing which had passed should be
-forgotten, that there was not the least animosity remaining on one side,
-nor any thing to be feared on the other. The Chief was soon soothed into
-confidence and complacency, a double canoe was ordered to be got ready,
-they all returned together to the fort before supper, and as a pledge of
-perfect reconciliation, both he and his wife slept all night in Mr.
-Banks’s tent: their presence, however, was no palladium; for, between
-eleven and twelve o’clock, one of the natives attempted to get into the
-fort by scaling the walls, with a design, no doubt, to steal whatever he
-should happen to find; he was discovered by the sentinel, who happily
-did not fire, and he ran away much faster than any of our people could
-follow him. The iron, and iron-tools, which were in continual use at the
-armourer’s forge, that was set up within the works, were temptations to
-theft which none of these people could withstand.
-
-On the 14th, which was Sunday, I directed that Divine service should be
-performed at the fort: we were desirous that some of the principal
-Indians should be present, but when the hour came, most of them were
-returned home. Mr. Banks, however, crossed the river, and brought back
-Tubourai Tamaide and his wife Tomio, hoping that it would give occasion
-to some enquiries on their part, and some instruction on ours: having
-seated them, he placed himself between them, and during the whole
-service, they very attentively observed his behaviour, and very exactly
-imitated it; standing, sitting, or kneeling, as they saw him do: they
-were conscious that we were employed about somewhat serious and
-important, as appeared by their calling to the Indians without the fort
-to be silent; yet when the service was over, neither of them asked any
-questions, nor would they attend to any attempt that was made to explain
-what had been done.
-
-Such were our matins; our Indians thought fit to perform vespers of a
-very different kind. A young man, near six feet high, performed the
-rites of Venus with a little girl about eleven or twelve years of age,
-before several of our people, and a great number of the natives, without
-the least sense of its being indecent or improper, but, as appeared, in
-perfect conformity to the custom of the place. Among the spectators were
-several women of superior rank, particularly Oberea, who may properly be
-said to have assisted at the ceremony; for they gave instructions to the
-girl how to perform her part, which, young as she was, she did not seem
-much to stand in need of.
-
-This incident is not mentioned as an object of idle curiosity, but as it
-deserves consideration in determining a question which has been long
-debated in philosophy; Whether the shame attending certain actions,
-which are allowed on all sides to be in themselves innocent, is
-implanted in nature, or superinduced by custom? If it has its origin in
-custom, it will, perhaps, be found difficult to trace that custom,
-however general, to its source; if in instinct, it will be equally
-difficult to discover from what cause it is subdued, or at least
-over-ruled among these people, in whose manners not the least trace of
-it is to be found.
-
-On the 14th and 15th, we had another opportunity of observing the
-general knowledge which these people had of any design that was formed
-among them. In the night between the 13th and 14th, one of the
-water-casks was stolen from the outside of the fort: in the morning,
-there was not an Indian to be seen who did not know that it was gone;
-yet they appeared not to have been trusted, or not to have been worthy
-of trust; for they seemed all of them disposed to give intelligence
-where it might be found. Mr. Banks traced it to a part of the bay where
-he was told it had been put into a canoe, but as it was not of great
-consequence he did not complete the discovery. When he returned, he was
-told by Tubourai Tamaide, that another cask would be stolen before the
-morning: how he came by this knowledge it is not easy to imagine; that
-he was not a party in the design is certain, for he came with his wife
-and his family to the place where the water-casks stood, and placing
-their beds near them, he said he would himself be a pledge for their
-safety, in despight of the thief: of this, however, we would not admit;
-and making them understand that a sentry would be placed to watch the
-casks till the morning, he removed the beds into Mr. Banks’s tent, where
-he and his family spent the night, making signs to the sentry when he
-retired, that he should keep his eyes open. In the night this
-intelligence appeared to be true; about twelve o’clock the thief came,
-but discovering that a watch had been set, he went away without his
-booty.
-
-Mr. Banks’s confidence in Tubourai Tamaide had greatly increased since
-the affair of the knife, in consequence of which he was at length
-exposed to temptations which neither his integrity nor his honour was
-able to resist. They had withstood many allurements, but were at length
-ensnared by the fascinating charms of a basket of nails: these nails
-were much larger than any that had yet been brought into trade, and had,
-with perhaps some degree of criminal negligence, been left in a corner
-of Mr. Banks’s tent, to which the chief had always free access. One of
-these nails Mr. Banks’s servant happened to see in his possession, upon
-his having inadvertently thrown back that part of his garment under
-which it was concealed. Mr. Banks being told of this, and knowing that
-no such thing had been given him, either as a present or in barter,
-immediately examined the basket, and discovered, that out of seven nails
-five were missing. He then, though not without great reluctance, charged
-him with the fact, which he immediately confessed, and however he might
-suffer, was probably not more hurt than his accuser. A demand was
-immediately made of restitution; but this he declined, saying, that the
-nails were at Eparre: however, Mr. Banks appearing to be much in
-earnest, and using some threatening signs, he thought fit to produce one
-of them. He was then taken to the fort, to receive such judgment as
-should be given against him by the general voice.
-
-After some deliberation, that we might not appear to think too lightly
-of his offence, he was told, that if he would bring the other four nails
-to the fort, it should be forgotten. To this condition he agreed; but I
-am sorry to say he did not fulfil it. Instead of fetching the nails, he
-removed with his family before night, and took all his furniture with
-him.
-
-As our long-boat had appeared to be leaky, I thought it necessary to
-examine her bottom, and to my great surprise found it so much eaten by
-the worms, that it was necessary to give her a new one; no such accident
-had happened to the Dolphin’s boats, as I was informed by the officers
-on board, and therefore it was a misfortune that I did not expect: I
-feared that the pinnace also might be nearly in the same condition; but,
-upon examining her, I had the satisfaction to find that not a worm had
-touched her, though she was built of the same wood, and had been as much
-in the water; the reason of this difference I imagine to be, that the
-long-boat was paid with varnish of pine, and the pinnace painted with
-white lead and oil; the bottoms of all boats, therefore, which are sent
-into this country, should be painted like that of the pinnace, and the
-ships should be supplied with a good stock, in order to give them a new
-coating when it should be found necessary.
-
-Having received repeated messages from Tootahah, that if we would pay
-him a visit he would acknowledge the favour by a present of four hogs, I
-sent Mr. Hicks, my first lieutenant, to try if he could not procure the
-hogs upon easier terms, with orders to show him every civility in his
-power. Mr. Hicks found that he was removed from Eparre to a place called
-TETTAHAH, five miles farther to the westward. He was received with great
-cordiality; one hog was immediately produced, and he was told that the
-other three, which were at some distance, should be brought in the
-morning. Mr. Hicks readily consented to stay; but the morning came
-without the hogs, and it not being convenient to stay longer, he
-returned in the evening with the one he had got.
-
-On the 25th, Tubourai Tamaide and his wife Tomio made their appearance
-at the tent, for the first time since he had been detected in stealing
-the nails; he seemed to be under some discontent and apprehension, yet
-he did not think fit to purchase our countenance and good will by
-restoring the four which he had sent away. As Mr. Banks and the other
-gentlemen treated him with a coolness and reserve which did not at all
-tend to restore his peace or good humour, his stay was short, and his
-departure abrupt. Mr. Monkhouse, the surgeon, went the next morning in
-order to effect a reconciliation, by persuading him to bring down the
-nails, but he could not succeed.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. XIII.
-
- ANOTHER VISIT TO TOOTAHAH, WITH VARIOUS ADVENTURES: EXTRAORDINARY
-AMUSEMENT OF THE INDIANS, WITH REMARKS UPON IT: PREPARATIONS TO OBSERVE
- THE TRANSIT OF VENUS, AND WHAT HAPPENED IN THE MEAN TIME AT THE FORT.
-
-
-ON the 27th, it was determined that we should pay our visit to Tootahah,
-though we were not very confident that we should receive the hogs for
-our pains. I therefore set out early in the morning, with Mr. Banks and
-Dr. Solander, and three others, in the pinnace. He was now removed from
-Tettahah, where Mr. Hicks had seen him, to a place called ATAHOUROU,
-about six miles farther, and as we could not go above half-way thither
-in the boat, it was almost evening before we arrived: we found him in
-his usual state, sitting under a tree, with a great crowd about him. We
-made our presents in due form, consisting of a yellow stuff petticoat,
-and some other trifling articles, which were graciously received; a hog
-was immediately ordered to be killed and dressed for supper, with a
-promise of more in the morning: however, as we were less desirous of
-feasting upon our journey than of carrying back with us provisions,
-which would be more welcome at the fort, we procured a reprieve for the
-hog, and supped upon the fruits of the country. As night now came on,
-and the place was crowded with many more than the houses and canoes
-would contain; there being Oberea with her attendants, and many other
-travellers whom we knew, we began to look out for lodgings. Our party
-consisted of six: Mr. Banks thought himself fortunate in being offered a
-place by Oberea in her canoe, and wishing his friends a good night, took
-his leave. He went to rest early, according to the custom of the
-country, and taking off his clothes, as was his constant practice, the
-nights being hot, Oberea kindly insisted upon taking them into her own
-custody, for otherwise she said they would certainly be stolen. Mr.
-Banks having such a safeguard, resigned himself to sleep with all
-imaginable tranquillity: but waking about eleven o’clock, and wanting to
-get up, he searched for his clothes where he had seen them deposited by
-Oberea when he lay down to sleep, and soon perceived that they were
-missing. He immediately awakened Oberea, who starting up, and hearing
-his complaint, ordered lights, and prepared in great haste to recover
-what he had lost: Tootahah himself slept in the next canoe, and being
-soon alarmed, he came to them, and set out with Oberea in search of the
-thief. Mr. Banks was not in a condition to go with them, for of his
-apparel scarce any thing was left him but his breeches; his coat, and
-his waistcoat, with his pistols, powder-horn, and many other things that
-were in the pockets, were gone. In about half an hour his two noble
-friends returned, but without having obtained any intelligence of his
-clothes or of the thief. At first he began to be alarmed, his musket had
-not indeed been taken away, but he had neglected to load it; where I and
-Dr. Solander had disposed of ourselves he did not know; and therefore,
-whatever might happen, he could not have recourse to us for assistance.
-He thought it best, however, to express neither fear nor suspicion of
-those about him, and giving his musket to Tupia, who had been waked in
-the confusion and stood by him, with a charge not to suffer it to be
-stolen, he betook himself again to rest, declaring himself perfectly
-satisfied with the pains that Tootahah and Oberea had taken to recover
-his things, though they had not been successful. As it cannot be
-supposed that in such a situation his sleep was very sound, he soon
-after heard music, and saw lights at a little distance on shore: this
-was a concert or assembly, which they call a HEIVA, a common name for
-every public exhibition; and as it would necessarily bring many people
-together, and there was a chance of my being among them with his other
-friends, he rose, and made the best of his way towards it: he was soon
-led by the lights and the sound to the hut where I lay, with three other
-gentlemen of our party; and easily distinguishing us from the rest, he
-made up to us more than half naked, and told us his melancholy story. We
-gave him such comfort as the unfortunate generally give to each other,
-by telling him that we were fellow-sufferers; I showed him that I was
-myself without stockings, they having been stolen from under my head,
-though I was sure I had never been asleep, and each of my associates
-convinced him, by his appearance, that he had lost a jacket. We
-determined, however, to hear out the concert, however deficient we might
-appear in our dress; it consisted of three drums, four flutes, and
-several voices: when this entertainment, which lasted about an hour, was
-over, we retired again to our sleeping-places; having agreed, that
-nothing could be done toward the recovery of our things till the
-morning.
-
-We rose at day-break, according to the custom of the country: the first
-man that Mr. Banks saw was Tupia, faithfully attending with his musket;
-and soon after, Oberea brought him some of her country clothes, as a
-succedaneum for his own, so that when he came to us he made a most
-motley appearance, half Indian and half English. Our party soon got
-together, except Dr. Solander, whose quarters we did not know, and who
-had not assisted at the concert: in a short time Tootahah made his
-appearance, and we pressed him to recover our clothes; but neither he
-nor Oberea could be persuaded to take any measure for that purpose, so
-that we began to suspect that they had been parties in the theft. About
-eight o’clock, we were joined by Dr. Solander, who had fallen into
-honester hands, at a house about a mile distant, and had lost nothing.
-
-Having given up all hope of recovering our clothes, which, indeed, were
-never afterwards heard of, we spent all the morning in soliciting the
-hogs which we had been promised; but in this we had no better success:
-we, therefore, in no very good humour, set out for the boat about twelve
-o’clock, with only that which we had redeemed from the butcher and the
-cook the night before.
-
-As we were returning to the boat, however, we were entertained with a
-sight that in some measure compensated for our fatigue and
-disappointment. In our way we came to one of the few places where access
-to the island is not guarded by a reef, and, consequently, a high surf
-breaks upon the shore; a more dreadful one, indeed, I had seldom seen;
-it was impossible for any European boat to have lived in it; and if the
-best swimmer in Europe had, by any accident, been exposed to its fury, I
-am confident that he would not have been able to preserve himself from
-drowning, especially as the shore was covered with pebbles and large
-stones; yet, in the midst of these breakers, were ten or twelve Indians
-swimming for their amusement: whenever a surf broke near them, they
-dived under it, and, to all appearance with infinite facility, rose
-again on the other side. This diversion was greatly improved by the
-stern of an old canoe, which they happened to find upon the spot: they
-took this before them, and swam out with it as far as the outermost
-breach, then two or three of them getting into it, and turning the
-square end to the breaking wave, were driven in towards the shore with
-incredible rapidity, sometimes almost to the beach; but generally the
-wave broke over them before they got half way, in which case they dived,
-and rose on the other side with the canoe in their hands: they then swam
-out with it again, and were again driven back, just as our holiday youth
-climb the hill in Greenwich-park for the pleasure of rolling down it. At
-this wonderful scene we stood gazing for more than half an hour, during
-which time none of the swimmers attempted to come on shore, but seemed
-to enjoy their sport in the highest degree; we then proceeded in our
-journey, and late in the evening got back to the fort.
-
-Upon this occasion it may be observed, that human nature is endued with
-powers which are only accidentally exerted to the utmost; and that all
-men are capable of what no man attains, except he is stimulated to the
-effort by some uncommon circumstances or situation. These Indians
-effected what to us appeared to be supernatural, merely by the
-application of such powers as they possessed in common with us, and all
-other men who have no particular infirmity or defect. The truth of the
-observation is also manifest from more familiar instances. The
-rope-dancer and balance-master owe their art, not to any peculiar
-liberality of nature, but to an accidental improvement of her common
-gifts; and though equal diligence and application would not always
-produce equal excellence in these, any more than in other arts, yet
-there is no doubt but that a certain degree of proficiency in them might
-be universally attained. Another proof of the existence of abilities in
-mankind, that are almost universally dormant, is furnished by the
-attainments of blind men. It cannot be supposed that the loss of one
-sense, like the amputation of a branch from a tree, gives new vigour to
-those that remain. Every man’s hearing and touch, therefore, are capable
-of the nice distinctions which astonish us in those that have lost their
-sight, and if they do not give the same intelligence to the mind, it is
-merely because the same intelligence is not required of them: he that
-can see may do from choice what the blind do by necessity, and by the
-same diligent attention to the other senses may receive the same notices
-from them; let it, therefore, be remembered, as an encouragement to
-persevering diligence, and a principle of general use to mankind, that
-he who does all he can will ever effect much more than is generally
-thought to be possible.
-
-Among other Indians that had visited us, there were some from a
-neighbouring island which they called EIMEO or IMAO, the same to which
-Captain Wallis had given the name of the Duke of York’s island, and they
-gave us an account of no less than two-and-twenty islands that lay in
-the neighbourhood of Otaheite.
-
-As the day of observation now approached, I determined, in consequence
-of some hints which had been given me by Lord Morton, to send out two
-parties to observe the transit from other situations; hoping, that if we
-should fail at Otaheite, they might have better success. We were,
-therefore, now busily employed in preparing our instruments, and
-instructing such gentlemen in the use of them as I intended to send out.
-
-On Thursday the 1st of June, the Saturday following being the day of the
-transit, I dispatched Mr. Gore in the long boat to Imao, with Mr.
-Monkhouse and Mr. Sporing, a gentleman belonging to Mr. Banks, Mr. Green
-having furnished them with proper instruments. Mr. Banks himself thought
-fit to go upon this expedition, and several natives, particularly
-Tubourai Tamaide and Tomio, were also of the party. Very early on the
-Friday morning, I sent Mr. Hicks with Mr. Clerk and Mr. Petersgill, the
-master’s mates, and Mr. Saunders, one of the midshipmen, in the pinnace
-to the eastward, with orders to fix on some convenient spot, at a
-distance from our principal observatory, where they also might employ
-the instruments with which they had been furnished for the same purpose.
-
-The long-boat not having been got ready till Thursday in the afternoon,
-though all possible expedition was used to fit her out; the people on
-board, after having rowed most part of the night, brought her to a
-grappling just under the land of Imao. Soon after day-break, they saw an
-Indian canoe, which they hailed, and the people on board shewed them an
-inlet through the reef into which they pulled, and soon fixed upon a
-coral rock, which rose out of the water about one hundred and fifty
-yards from the shore, as a proper situation for their observatory: it
-was about eighty yards long and twenty broad, and in the middle of it
-was a bed of white sand, large enough for the tents to stand upon. Mr.
-Gore and his assistants immediately began to set them up, and make other
-necessary preparations for the important business of the next day. While
-this was doing, Mr. Banks, with the Indians of Otaheite, and the people
-whom they had met in the canoe, went ashore upon the main island, to buy
-provisions; of which he procured a sufficient supply before night. When
-he returned to the rock, he found the observatory in order, and the
-telescopes all fixed and tried. The evening was very fine, yet their
-solicitude did not permit them to take much rest in the night: one or
-other of them was up every half hour, who satisfied the impatience of
-the rest by reporting the changes of the sky, now encouraging their
-hope, by telling them that it was clear, and now alarming their fears,
-by an account that it was hazy.
-
-At day-break they got up, and had the satisfaction to see the sun rise
-without a cloud. Mr. Banks then wishing the observers, Mr. Gore and Mr.
-Monkhouse, success, repaired again to the island, that he might examine
-its produce, and get a fresh supply of provisions: he began by trading
-with the natives, for which purpose he took his station under a tree;
-and to keep them from pressing upon him in a crowd, he drew a circle
-round him, which he suffered none of them to enter.
-
-About eight o’clock, he saw two canoes coming towards the place, and was
-given to understand by the people about him, that they belonged to
-TARRAO, the King of the island, who was coming to make him a visit. As
-soon as the canoes came near the shore, the people made a lane from the
-beach to the trading-place, and his Majesty landed, with his sister,
-whose name was NUNA; as they advanced towards the tree where Mr. Banks
-stood, he went out to meet them, and, with great formality, introduced
-them into the circle from which the other natives had been excluded. As
-it is the custom of these people to sit during all their conferences,
-Mr. Banks unwrapped a kind of turban of Indian cloth, which he wore upon
-his head instead of a hat, and spreading it upon the ground, they all
-sat down upon it together. The royal present was then brought, which
-consisted of a hog and a dog, some bread-fruit, cocoa-nuts, and other
-articles of the like kind. Mr. Banks then dispatched a canoe to the
-observatory for his present, and the messengers soon returned with an
-adze, a shirt, and some beads, which were presented to his Majesty, and
-received with great satisfaction.
-
-By this time, Tubourai Tamaide and Tomio joined them, from the
-observatory. Tomio said, that she was related to Tarrao, and brought him
-a present of a long nail, at the same time complimenting Nuna with a
-shirt.
-
-The first internal contact of the planet with the sun being over, Mr.
-Banks returned to the observatory, taking Tarrao, Nuna, and some of
-their principal attendants, among whom were three very handsome young
-women, with him: he showed them the planet upon the sun, and endeavoured
-to make them understand that he and his companions had come from their
-own country on purpose to see it. Soon after, Mr. Banks returned with
-them to the island, where he spent the rest of the day in examining its
-produce, which he found to be much the same with that of Otaheite. The
-people whom he saw there also exactly resembled the inhabitants of that
-island, and many of them were persons whom he had seen upon it; so that
-all those whom he had dealt with knew of what his trading articles
-consisted, and the value they bore.
-
-The next morning, having struck the tents, they set out on their return,
-and arrived at the fort before night.
-
-The observation was made with equal success by the persons whom I had
-sent to the eastward, and at the fort, there not being a cloud in the
-sky from the rising to the setting of the sun, the whole passage of the
-planet Venus over the sun’s disk was observed with great advantage by
-Mr. Green, Dr. Solander, and myself: Mr. Green’s telescope and mine were
-of the same magnifying power, but that of Dr. Solander was greater. We
-all saw an atmosphere or dusky cloud round the body of the planet, which
-very much disturbed the times of contact, especially of the internal
-ones; and we differed from each other in our accounts of the times of
-the contacts much more than might have been expected. According to Mr.
-Green,
-
- Hours. Min. Sec.
-
- The first external contact, or first appearance }
- of Venus on the sun, was 9 25 42 }
- } Morning
- The first internal contact, or total immersion, }
- was 9 44 4 }
-
- The second internal contact, or beginning of }
- the emersion, 3 14 8 } Afternoon
- }
- The second external contact, or total emersion, 3 32 10 }
-
-The latitude of the observatory was found to be 17° 29ʹ 15ʺ, and the
-longitude 149° 32ʹ 30ʺ W. of Greenwich. A more particular account will
-appear by the tables, for which the reader is referred to the
-Transactions of the Royal Society, vol. lxi. part 2. page 39. _et seq._,
-where they are illustrated by a cut.
-
-But if we had reason to congratulate ourselves upon the success of our
-observation, we had scarce less cause to regret the diligence with which
-that time had been improved by some of our people to another purpose.
-While the attention of the officers was engrossed by the transit of
-Venus, some of the ship’s company broke into one of the store-rooms, and
-stole a quantity of spike-nails, amounting to no less than one hundred
-weight: this was a matter of public and serious concern; for these
-nails, if circulated by the people among the Indians, would do us
-irreparable injury, by reducing the value of iron, our staple commodity.
-One of the thieves was detected, but only seven nails were found in his
-custody. He was punished with two dozen lashes, but would impeach none
-of his accomplices.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. XIV.
-
- THE CEREMONIES OF AN INDIAN FUNERAL PARTICULARLY DESCRIBED: GENERAL
- OBSERVATIONS ON THE SUBJECT: A CHARACTER FOUND AMONG THE INDIANS TO
-WHICH THE ANCIENTS PAID GREAT VENERATION: A ROBBERY AT THE FORT, AND ITS
-CONSEQUENCES: WITH A SPECIMEN OF INDIAN COOKERY, AND VARIOUS INCIDENTS.
-
-
-ON the 5th, we kept his Majesty’s birth-day; for though it is the 4th,
-we were unwilling to celebrate it during the absence of the two parties
-who had been sent out to observe the transit. We had several of the
-Indian chiefs at our entertainment, who drank his Majesty’s health by
-the name of Kihiargo, which was the nearest imitation they could produce
-of King George.
-
-About this time died an old woman of some rank, who was related to
-Tomio, which gave us an opportunity to see how they disposed of the
-body, and confirmed us in our opinion that these people, contrary to the
-present custom of all other nations now known, never bury their dead. In
-the middle of a small square, neatly railed in with bamboo, the awning
-of a canoe was raised upon two posts, and under this the body was
-deposited upon such a frame as has before been described: it was covered
-with fine cloth, and near it was placed bread-fruit, fish, and other
-provisions: we supposed that the food was placed there for the spirit of
-the deceased, and, consequently, that these Indians had some confused
-notion of a separate state; but upon our applying for further
-information to Tubourai Tamaide, he told us, that the food was placed
-there as an offering to their gods. They do not, however, suppose that
-the gods eat, any more than the Jews suppose that Jehovah could dwell in
-a house: the offering is made here upon the same principle as the temple
-was built at Jerusalem, as an expression of reverence and gratitude, and
-a solicitation of the more immediate presence of the Deity. In the front
-of the area was a kind of stile, where the relations of the deceased
-stood, to pay the tribute of their sorrow; and under the awning were
-innumerable small pieces of cloth, on which the tears and blood of the
-mourners had been shed; for in their paroxysms of grief it is a
-universal custom to wound themselves with the shark’s tooth. Within a
-few yards two occasional houses were set up, in one of which some
-relations of the deceased constantly resided, and in the other the chief
-mourner, who is always a man, and who keeps there a very singular dress
-in which a ceremony is performed that will be described in its turn.
-Near the place where the dead are thus set up to rot the bones are
-afterwards buried.
-
-What can have introduced among these people the custom of exposing their
-dead above ground till the flesh is consumed by putrefaction, and then
-burying the bones, it is, perhaps, impossible to guess; but it is
-remarkable, that Ælian and Apollonius Rhodius impute a similar practice
-to the ancient inhabitants of Colchis, a country near Pontus, in Asia,
-now called Mingrelia; except that among them this manner of disposing of
-the dead did not extend to both sexes: the women they buried; but the
-men they wrapped in a hide, and hung up in the air by a chain. This
-practice among the Colchians is referred to a religious cause. The
-principal objects of their worship were the earth and the air; and it is
-supposed that, in consequence of some superstitious notion, they devoted
-their dead to both. Whether the natives of Otaheite had any notion of
-the same kind, we were never able certainly to determine; but we soon
-discovered, that the repositories of their dead were also places of
-worship. Upon this occasion it may be observed, that nothing can be more
-absurd than the notion that the happiness or misery of a future life
-depends, in any degree, upon the disposition of the body when the state
-of probation is past; yet that nothing is more general than a solicitude
-about it. However cheap we may hold any funeral rites which custom has
-not familiarized, or superstition rendered sacred, most men gravely
-deliberate how to prevent their body from being broken by the mattock
-and devoured by the worm, when it is no longer capable of sensation; and
-purchase a place for it in holy ground, when they believe the lot of its
-future existence to be irrevocably determined. So strong is the
-association of pleasing or painful ideas with certain opinions and
-actions which affect us while we live, that we involuntarily act as if
-it was equally certain that they would affect us in the same manner when
-we are dead, though this is an opinion that nobody will maintain. Thus
-it happens, that the desire of preserving from reproach even the name
-that we leave behind us, or of procuring it honour, is one of the most
-powerful principles of action, among the inhabitants of the most
-speculative and enlightened nations. Posthumous reputation, upon every
-principle, must be acknowledged to have no influence upon the dead; yet
-the desire of obtaining and securing it, no force of reason, no habits
-of thinking, can subdue, except in those whom habitual baseness and
-guilt have rendered indifferent to honour and shame while they lived.
-This, indeed, seems to be among the happy imperfections of our nature,
-upon which the general good of society in a certain measure depends; for
-as some crimes are supposed to be prevented by hanging the body of the
-criminal in chains after he is dead, so in consequence of the same
-association of ideas, much good is procured to society, and much evil
-prevented, by a desire of preventing disgrace or procuring honour to a
-name, when nothing but a name remains.
-
-Perhaps no better use can be made of reading an account of manners
-altogether new, by which the follies and absurdities of mankind are
-taken out of that particular connection in which habit has reconciled
-them to us, than to consider in how many instances they are essentially
-the same. When an honest devotee of the church of Rome reads, that there
-are Indians on the banks of the Ganges who believe that they shall
-secure the happiness of a future state by dying with a cow’s tail in
-their hands, he laughs at their folly and superstition; and if these
-Indians were to be told, that there are people upon the continent of
-Europe, who imagine that they shall derive the same advantage from dying
-with the slipper of St. Francis upon their foot, they would laugh in
-their turn. But if, when the Indian heard the account of the Catholic,
-and the Catholic that of the Indian, each was to reflect, that there was
-no difference between the absurdity of the slipper and of the tail; but
-that the veil of prejudice and custom, which covered it in their own
-case, was withdrawn in the other, they would turn their knowledge to a
-profitable purpose.
-
-Having observed that bread-fruit had for some days been brought in less
-quantities than usual, we enquired the reason; and were told, that there
-being a great show of fruit upon the trees, they had been thinned all at
-once, in order to make a kind of sour paste, which the natives call
-_Mahie_, and which, in consequence of having undergone a fermentation,
-will keep a considerable time, and supply them with food when no ripe
-fruit is to be had.
-
-On the 10th the ceremony was to be performed, in honour of the old woman
-whose sepulchral tabernacle has just been described, by the chief
-mourner; and Mr. Banks had so great a curiosity to see all the mysteries
-of the solemnity, that he determined to take a part in it, being told,
-that he could be present upon no other condition. In the evening,
-therefore, he repaired to the place where the body lay, and was received
-by the daughter of the deceased, and several other persons, among whom
-was a boy about fourteen years old, who were to assist in the ceremony.
-Tubourai Tamaide was to be the principal mourner; and his dress, which
-was extremely fantastical, though not unbecoming, is represented by a
-figure in one of the plates. Mr. Banks was stripped of his European
-clothes, and a small piece of cloth being tied round his middle, his
-body was smeared with charcoal and water, as low as the shoulders, till
-it was as black as that of a negro: the same operation was performed
-upon several others, among whom were some women, who were reduced to a
-state as near to nakedness as himself; the boy was blacked all over, and
-then the procession set forward. Tubourai Tamaide uttered something,
-which was supposed to be a prayer, near the body; and did the same when
-he came up to his own house: when this was done, the procession was
-continued towards the fort, permission having been obtained to approach
-it upon this occasion. It is the custom of the Indians to fly from these
-processions with the utmost precipitation, so that as soon as those who
-were about the fort saw it at a distance they hid themselves in the
-woods. It proceeded from the fort along the shore, and put to flight
-another body of Indians, consisting of more than a hundred, every one
-hiding himself under the first shelter that he could find: it then
-crossed the river, and entered the woods, passing several houses, all
-which were deserted, and not a single Indian could be seen during the
-rest of the procession, which continued more than half an hour. The
-office that Mr. Banks performed, was called that of the _Nineveh_, of
-which there were two besides himself; and the natives having all
-disappeared, they came to the chief mourner, and said, _Imatata_, there
-are no people; after which the company was dismissed to wash themselves
-in the river, and put on their customary apparel.
-
-On the 12th, complaint being made to me, by some of the natives, that
-two of the seamen had taken from them several bows and arrows, and some
-strings of plaited hair, I examined the matter, and finding the charge
-well supported, I punished each of the criminals with two-dozen lashes.
-
-Their bows and arrows have not been mentioned before, nor were they
-often brought down to the fort. This day, however, Tubourai Tamaide
-brought down his, in consequence of a challenge which he had received
-from Mr. Gore. The chief supposed it was to try who could send the arrow
-farthest; Mr. Gore, who best could hit a mark; and as Mr. Gore did not
-value himself upon shooting to a great distance, nor the chief upon
-hitting a mark, there was no trial of skill between them. Tubourai
-Tamaide, however, to show us what he could do, drew his bow, and sent an
-arrow, none of which are feathered, two hundred and seventy-four yards,
-which is something more than a seventh, and something less than a sixth
-part of a mile. Their manner of shooting is somewhat singular; they
-kneel down, and the moment the arrow is discharged drop the bow.
-
-Mr. Banks, in his morning walk this day, met a number of the natives,
-whom, upon enquiry, he found to be travelling musicians; and having
-learnt where they were to be at night, we all repaired to the place. The
-band consisted of two flutes and three drums, and we found a great
-number of people assembled upon the occasion. The drummers accompanied
-the music with their voices, and, to our great surprise, we discovered
-that we were generally the subject of the song. We did not expect to
-have found among the uncivilized inhabitants of this sequestered spot a
-character, which has been the subject of such praise and veneration
-where genius and knowledge have been most conspicuous; yet these were
-the bards or minstrels of Otaheite. Their song was unpremeditated, and
-accompanied with music; they were continually going about from place to
-place, and they were rewarded by the master of the house, and the
-audience, with such things as one wanted and the other could spare.
-
-On the 14th, we were brought into new difficulties and inconvenience by
-another robbery at the fort. In the middle of the night, one of the
-natives contrived to steal an iron coal-rake, that was made use of for
-the oven. It happened to be set up against the inside of the wall, so
-that the top of the handle was visible from without; and we were
-informed that the thief, who had been seen lurking there in the evening,
-came secretly about three o’clock in the morning, and, watching his
-opportunity when the sentinel’s back was turned, very dexterously laid
-hold of it with a long crooked stick, and drew it over the wall. I
-thought it of some consequence, if possible, to put an end to these
-practices at once, by doing something that should make it the common
-interest of the natives themselves to prevent them. I had given strict
-orders that they should not be fired upon, even when detected in these
-attempts, for which I had many reasons: the common sentinels were by no
-means fit to be intrusted with a power of life and death, to be exerted
-whenever they should think fit, and I had already experienced that they
-were ready to take away the lives that were in their power upon the
-slightest occasion; neither, indeed, did I think that the thefts which
-these people committed against us were, in them, crimes worthy of death:
-that thieves are hanged in England, I thought no reason why they should
-be shot in Otaheite; because, with respect to the natives, it would have
-been an execution by a law _ex post facto_. They had no such law among
-themselves, and it did not appear to me that we had any right to make
-such a law for them. That they should abstain from theft, or be punished
-with death, was not one of the conditions under which they claimed the
-advantages of civil society, as it is among us; and as I was not willing
-to expose them to fire-arms, loaded with shot, neither could I perfectly
-approve of firing only with powder. At first, indeed, the noise and the
-smoke would alarm them, but when they found that no mischief followed,
-they would be led to despise the weapons themselves, and proceed to
-insults, which would make it necessary to put them to the test, and from
-which they would be deterred by the very sight of a gun, if it was never
-used but with effect. At this time an accident furnished me with what I
-thought a happy expedient. It happened that above twenty of their
-sailing canoes were just come in with a supply of fish: upon these I
-immediately seized, and bringing them into the river behind the fort,
-gave public notice, that except the rake, and all the rest of the things
-which from time to time had been stolen, were returned, the canoes
-should be burnt. This menace I ventured to publish, though I had no
-design to put it into execution, making no doubt but that it was well
-known in whose possession the stolen goods were, and that as restitution
-was thus made a common cause, they would all of them in a short time be
-brought back. A list of the things was made out, consisting principally
-of the rake, the musket which had been taken from the marine when the
-Indian was shot; the pistols which Mr. Banks lost with his clothes at
-Atahourou; a sword belonging to one of the petty officers, and the
-water-cask. About noon, the rake was restored, and great solicitation
-was made for the release of the canoes; but I still insisted upon my
-original condition. The next day came, and nothing farther was restored,
-at which I was much surprised, for the people were in the utmost
-distress for the fish, which in a short time would be spoilt; I was,
-therefore, reduced to a disagreeable situation, either of releasing the
-canoes, contrary to what I had solemnly and publicly declared, or to
-detain them, to the great injury of those who were innocent, without
-answering any good purpose to ourselves: as a temporary expedient, I
-permitted them to take the fish; but still detained the canoes. This
-very licence, however, was productive of new confusion and injury; for,
-it not being easy at once to distinguish to what particular persons the
-several lots of fish belonged, the canoes were plundered, under favour
-of this circumstance, by those who had no right to any part of their
-cargo. Most pressing instances were still made that the canoes might be
-restored; and I having now the greatest reason to believe, either that
-the things for which I detained them were not in the island, or that
-those who suffered by their detention had not sufficient influence over
-the thieves to prevail upon them to relinquish their booty, determined
-at length to give them up, not a little mortified at the bad success of
-my project.
-
-Another accident also about this time was, notwithstanding all our
-caution, very near embroiling us with the Indians. I sent the boat on
-shore with an officer to get ballast for the ship, and not immediately
-finding stones convenient for the purpose, he began to pull down some
-part of an enclosure where they deposited the bones of their dead. This
-the Indians violently opposed, and a messenger came down to the tents to
-acquaint the officers that they would not suffer it. Mr. Banks
-immediately repaired to the place, and an amicable end was soon put to
-the dispute by sending the boat’s crew to the river, where stones enough
-were to be gathered without a possibility of giving offence. It is very
-remarkable, that these Indians appeared to be much more jealous of what
-was done to the dead than the living. This was the only measure in which
-they ventured to oppose us, and the only insult that was offered to any
-individual among us was upon a similar occasion. Mr. Monkhouse,
-happening one day to pull a flower from a tree which grew in one of
-their sepulchral enclosures, an Indian, whose jealousy had probably been
-upon the watch, came suddenly behind him, and struck him. Mr. Monkhouse
-laid hold of him, but he was instantly rescued by two more, who took
-hold of Mr. Monkhouse’s hair, and forced him to quit his hold of their
-companion, and then ran away without offering him any farther violence.
-
-In the evening of the 19th, while the canoes were still detained, we
-received a visit from Oberea, which surprised us not a little, as she
-brought with her none of the things that had been stolen, and knew that
-she was suspected of having some of them in her custody. She said,
-indeed, that her favourite Obadee, whom she had beaten and dismissed,
-had taken them away; but she seemed conscious, that she had no right to
-be believed. She discovered the strongest signs of fear, yet she
-surmounted it with astonishing resolution; and was very pressing to
-sleep with her attendants in Mr. Banks’s tent. In this, however, she was
-not gratified; the affair of the jacket was too recent, and the tent was
-besides filled with other people. Nobody else seemed willing to
-entertain her, and she, therefore, with great appearance of
-mortification and disappointment, spent the night in her canoe.
-
-The next morning early, she returned to the fort with her canoe, and
-every thing that it contained, putting herself wholly into our power,
-with something like greatness of mind, which excited our wonder and
-admiration. As the most effectual means to bring about a reconciliation,
-she presented us with a hog, and several other things, among which was a
-dog. We had lately learnt, that these animals were esteemed by the
-Indians as more delicate food than their pork; and upon this occasion we
-determined to try the experiment. The dog, which was very fat, we
-consigned over to Tupia, who undertook to perform the double office of
-butcher and cook. He killed him by holding his hands close over his
-mouth and nose, an operation which continued above a quarter of an hour.
-While this was doing, a hole was made in the ground about a foot deep,
-in which a fire was kindled, and some small stones placed in layers
-alternately with the wood to heat; the dog was then singed, by holding
-him over the fire, and, by scraping him with a shell, the hair taken off
-as clean as if he had been scalded in hot water: he was then cut up with
-the same instrument, and his entrails, being taken out, were sent to the
-sea, where, being carefully washed, they were put into cocoa-nut shells,
-with what blood had come from the body. When the hole was sufficiently
-heated, the fire was taken out, and some of the stones, which were not
-so hot as to discolour any thing that they touched, being placed at the
-bottom, were covered with green leaves. The dog, with the entrails, was
-then placed upon the leaves, and other leaves being laid upon them, the
-whole was covered with the rest of the hot stones, and the mouth of the
-hole close stopped with mould. In somewhat less than four hours it was
-again opened, and the dog taken out excellently baked, and we all agreed
-that he made a very good dish. The dogs which are here bred to be eaten
-taste no animal food, but are kept wholly upon bread-fruit, cocoa-nuts,
-yams, and other vegetables of the like kind: all the flesh and fish
-eaten by the inhabitants is dressed in the same way.
-
-On the 21st we were visited at the fort by a chief, called OAMO, whom we
-had never seen before, and who was treated by the natives with uncommon
-respect; he brought with him a boy about seven years old, and a young
-woman about sixteen: the boy was carried upon a man’s back, which we
-considered as a piece of state, for he was as well able to walk as any
-present. As soon as they were in sight, Oberea, and several other
-natives who were in the fort, went out to meet them, having first
-uncovered their heads and bodies as low as the waist: as they came on,
-the same ceremony was performed by all the natives who were without the
-fort. Uncovering the body, therefore, is in this country probably a mark
-of respect; and as all parts are here exposed with equal indifference,
-the ceremony of uncovering it from the waist downwards, which was
-performed by Oorattooa, might be nothing more than a different mode of
-compliment, adapted to persons of a different rank. The chief came into
-the tent, but no entreaty could prevail upon the young woman to follow
-him, though she seemed to refuse contrary to her inclination. The
-natives without were, indeed, all very solicitous to prevent her,
-sometimes, when her resolution seemed to fail, almost using force: the
-boy also they restrained in the same manner; but Dr. Solander, happening
-to meet him at the gate, took him by the hand, and led him in before the
-people were aware of it. As soon, however, as those that were within saw
-him, they took care to have him sent out.
-
-These circumstances having strongly excited our curiosity, we inquired
-who they were, and were informed, that Oamo was the husband of Oberea,
-though they had been a long time separated by mutual consent; and that
-the young woman and the boy were their children. We learnt also, that
-the boy, whose name was TERRIDIRI, was heir-apparent to the sovereignty
-of the island, and that his sister was intended for his wife, the
-marriage being deferred only till he should arrive at a proper age. The
-sovereign at this time was a son of WHAPPAI, whose name was OUTOU, and
-who, as before has been observed, was a minor. Whappai, Oamo, and
-Tootahah, were brothers: Whappai was the eldest, and Oamo the second; so
-that, Whappai having no child but Outou, Terridiri, the son of his next
-brother Oamo, was heir to the sovereignty. It will, perhaps, seem
-strange that a boy should be sovereign during the life of his father;
-but, according to the custom of the country, a child succeeds to a
-father’s title and authority as soon as it is born: a regent is then
-elected, and the father of the new sovereign is generally continued in
-his authority, under that title, till his child is of age; but, at this
-time, the choice had fallen upon Tootahah, the uncle, in consequence of
-his having distinguished himself in a war. Oamo asked many questions
-concerning England and its inhabitants, by which he appeared to have
-great shrewdness and understanding.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. XV.
-
-AN ACCOUNT OF THE CIRCUMNAVIGATION OF THE ISLAND, AND VARIOUS INCIDENTS
- THAT HAPPENED DURING THE EXPEDITION; WITH A DESCRIPTION OF A
- BURYING-PLACE AND PLACE OF WORSHIP, CALLED A MORAI.
-
-
-ON Monday, the 26th, about three o’clock in the morning, I set out in
-the pinnace, accompanied by Mr. Banks, to make the circuit of the
-island, with a view to sketch out the coast and harbours. We took our
-route to the eastward, and about eight in the forenoon we went on shore,
-in a district called OAHOUNUE, which is governed by AHIO, a young chief,
-whom we had often seen at the tents, and who favoured us with his
-company to breakfast. Here also we found two other natives of our old
-acquaintance, TITUBOALO and HOONA, who carried us to their houses, near
-which we saw the body of the old woman, at whose funeral rites Mr. Banks
-had assisted, and which had been removed hither from the spot where it
-was first deposited, this place having descended from her by inheritance
-to Hoona, and it being necessary on that account that it should lie
-here. We then proceeded on foot, the boat attending within call, to the
-harbour in which Mr. Bougainville lay, called OHIDEA, where the natives
-showed us the ground upon which his people pitched their tent, and the
-brook at which they watered, though no trace of them remained, except
-the holes where the poles of the tent had been fixed, and a small piece
-of potsheard, which Mr. Banks found in looking narrowly about the spot.
-We met, however, with ORETTE, a chief who was their principal friend,
-and whose brother, OUTORROU, went away with them.
-
-This harbour lies on the west side of a great bay, under shelter of a
-small island called Boourou, near which is another called TAAWIRRII; the
-breach in the reefs is here very large, but the shelter for the ships is
-not the best.
-
-Soon after we had examined this place, we took boat, and asked Tituboalo
-to go with us to the other side of the bay; but he refused, and advised
-us not to go, for he said the country there was inhabited by people who
-were not subject to Tootahah, and who would kill both him and us. Upon
-receiving this intelligence, we did not, as may be imagined, relinquish
-our enterprise; but we immediately loaded our pieces with ball: this was
-so well understood by Tituboalo as a precaution which rendered us
-formidable, that he now consented to be of our party.
-
-Having rowed till it was dark, we reached a low neck of land, or
-isthmus, at the bottom of the bay, that divides the island into two
-peninsulas, each of which is a district or government wholly independent
-of the other. From Port-Royal, where the ship was at anchor, the coast
-trends E. by S. and E. S. E. ten miles, then S. by E. and S. eleven
-miles to the isthmus. In the first direction, the shore is in general
-open to the sea; but in the last it is covered by reefs of rocks, which
-form several good harbours, with safe anchorage, in 16, 18, 20, and 24
-fathom of water, with other conveniences. As we had not yet got into our
-enemy’s country, we determined to sleep on shore. We landed, and though
-we found but few houses, we saw several double canoes, whose owners were
-well known to us, and who provided us with supper and lodging; of which
-Mr. Banks was indebted for his share to Ooratooa, the lady who had paid
-him her compliments in so singular a manner at the fort.
-
-In the morning we looked about the country, and found it to be a marshy
-flat, about two miles over, across which the natives haul their canoes
-to the corresponding bay on the other side. We then prepared to continue
-our route for what Tituboalo called the other kingdom; he said that the
-name of it was TIARRABOU, or OTAHEITE ETE; and that of the chief who
-governed it WAHEATUA. Upon this occasion, also, we learnt that the name
-of the peninsula where we had taken our station was OPOUREONU, or
-OTAHEITE NUE. Our new associate seemed to be now in better spirits than
-he had been the day before: the people in Tiarrabou would not kill us,
-he said; but he assured us that we should be able to procure no victuals
-among them; and, indeed, we had seen no bread-fruit since we set out.
-
-After rowing a few miles, we landed in a district, which was the
-dominion of a chief called MARAITATA, the burying-place of men, whose
-father’s name was PAHAIREDO, the stealer of boats. Though these names
-seemed to favour the account that had been given by Tituboalo, we soon
-found that it was not true. Both the father and the son received us with
-the greatest civility, gave us provisions, and, after some delay, sold
-us a very large hog for a hatchet. A crowd soon gathered round us, but
-we saw only two people that we knew; neither did we observe a single
-bead or ornament among them that had come from our ship, though we saw
-several things which had been brought from Europe. In one of the houses
-lay two twelve-pound shot, one of which was marked with the broad arrow
-of England, though the people said they had them from the ships that lay
-in Bougainville’s harbour.
-
-We proceeded on foot till we came to the district which was immediately
-under the government of the principal chief, or king of the peninsula,
-Waheatua. Waheatua had a son, but whether, according to the custom of
-Opoureonu, he administered the government as regent, or in his own
-right, is uncertain. This district consists of a large and fertile
-plain, watered by a river so wide, that we were obliged to ferry over it
-in a canoe: our Indian train, however, chose to swim, and took to the
-water with the same facility as a pack of hounds. In this place we saw
-no house that appeared to be inhabited, but the ruins of many that had
-been very large. We proceeded along the shore, which forms a bay, called
-OAITIPEHA, and at last we found the chief sitting near some pretty canoe
-awnings, under which, we supposed, he and his attendants slept. He was a
-thin old man, with a very white head and beard, and had with him a
-comely woman, about five-and-twenty years old, whose name was TOUDIDDE.
-We had often heard the name of this woman, and, from report and
-observation, we had reason to think that she was the OBEREA of this
-peninsula. From this place, between which and the isthmus there are
-other harbours, formed by the reefs that lie along the shore, where
-shipping may lie in perfect security, and from whence the land trends S.
-S. E. and S. to the S. E. part of the island, we were accompanied by
-TEAREE, the son of Waheatua, of whom we had purchased a hog, and the
-country we passed through appeared to be more cultivated than any we had
-seen in other parts of the island: the brooks were every where banked
-into narrow channels with stone, and the shore had also a facing of
-stone, where it was washed by the sea. The houses were neither large nor
-numerous, but the canoes that were hauled up along the shore were almost
-innumerable, and superior to any that we had seen before, both in size
-and make; they were longer, the sterns were higher, and the awnings were
-supported by pillars. At almost every point there was a sepulchral
-building, and there were many of them also inland. They were of the same
-figure as those in Opoureonu, but they were cleaner and better kept, and
-decorated with many carved boards, which were set upright, and on the
-top of which were various figures of birds and men. On one in
-particular, there was the representation of a cock, which was painted
-red and yellow, to imitate the feathers of that animal, and rude images
-of men were, in some of them, placed one upon the head of another. But
-in this part of the country, however fertile and cultivated, we did not
-see a single bread-fruit: the trees were entirely bare; and the
-inhabitants seemed to subsist principally upon nuts, which are not
-unlike a chesnut, and which they call _Ahee_.
-
-When we had walked till we were weary, we called up the boat, but both
-our Indians, Tituboalo and Tuahow, were missing: they had, it seems,
-stayed behind at Waheatua’s, expecting us to return thither, in
-consequence of a promise which had been extorted from us, and which we
-had it not in our power to fulfil.
-
-Tearee, however, and another, embarked with us, and we proceeded till we
-came abreast of a small island called OTOOAREITE; it being then dark, we
-determined to land, and our Indians conducted us to a place where they
-said we might sleep: it was a deserted house, and near it was a little
-cove, in which the boat might lie with great safety and convenience. We
-were, however, in want of provisions, having been very sparingly
-supplied since we set out; and Mr. Banks immediately went into the woods
-to see whether any could be procured. As it was dark, he met with no
-people, and could find but one house that was inhabited: a bread-fruit
-and a half, a few ahees, and some fire, were all that it afforded; upon
-which, with a duck or two, and a few curlieus, we made our supper,
-which, if not scanty, was disagreeable, by the want of bread, with which
-we had neglected to furnish ourselves, as we depended upon meeting with
-bread-fruit, and took up our lodging under the awning of a canoe
-belonging to Tearee, which followed us.
-
-The next morning, after having spent some time in another fruitless
-attempt to procure a supply of provisions, we proceeded round the
-south-east point, part of which is not covered by any reef, but lies
-open to the sea; and here the hill rises directly from the shore. At the
-southernmost part of the island, the shore is again covered by a reef,
-which forms a good harbour; and the land about it is very fertile. We
-made this rout partly on foot, and partly in the boat: when we had
-walked about three miles, we arrived at a place where we saw several
-large canoes, and a number of people with them, whom we were agreeably
-surprised to find were of our intimate acquaintance. Here, with much
-difficulty, we procured some cocoa-nuts, and then embarked, taking with
-us Tuahow, one of the Indians who had waited for us at Waheatua’s, and
-had returned the night before, long after it was dark.
-
-When we came abreast of the south-east end of the island, we went
-ashore, by the advice of our Indian guide, who told us that the country
-was rich and good. The chief, whose name was MATHIABO, soon came down to
-us, but seemed to be a total stranger both to us and to our trade: his
-subjects, however, brought us plenty of cocoa-nuts, and about twenty
-bread-fruit. The bread-fruit we bought at a very dear rate, but his
-excellency sold us a pig for a glass-bottle, which he preferred to every
-thing else that we could give him. We found in his possession a goose
-and a turkey-cock, which, we were informed, had been left upon the
-island by the Dolphin: they were both enormously fat, and so tame that
-they followed the Indians, who were fond of them to excess, wherever
-they went.
-
-In a long house in this neighbourhood, we saw what was altogether new to
-us. At one end of it, fastened to a semicircular board, hung fifteen
-human jaw-bones: they appeared to be fresh; and there was not one of
-them that wanted a single tooth. A sight so extraordinary, strongly
-excited our curiosity, and we made many enquiries about it; but at this
-time could get no information, for the people either could not, or would
-not, understand us.
-
-When we left this place, the chief, Mathiabo, desired leave to accompany
-us, which was readily granted. He continued with us the remainder of the
-day, and proved very useful, by piloting us over the shoals. In the
-evening, we opened the bay on the north-west side of the island, which
-answered to that on the south-east, so as at the isthmus, or carrying
-place, almost to intersect the island, as I have observed before; and
-when we had coasted about two-thirds of it, we determined to go on shore
-for the night. We saw a large house at some distance, which Mathiabo
-informed us belonged to one of his friends; and soon after several
-canoes came off to meet us, having on board some very handsome women,
-who, by their behaviour, seemed to have been sent to entice us on shore.
-As we had before resolved to take up our residence here for the night,
-little invitation was necessary. We found that the house belonged to the
-chief of the district, whose name was WIVEROU: he received us in a very
-friendly manner, and ordered his people to assist us in dressing our
-provision, of which we had now got a tolerable stock. When our supper
-was ready, we were conducted into that part of the house where Wiverou
-was sitting, in order to eat it: Mathiabo supped with us; and Wiverou
-calling for his supper at the same time, we ate our meal very sociably,
-and with great good humour. When it was over, we began to enquire where
-we were to sleep, and a part of the house was shown us, of which we were
-told we might take possession for that purpose. We then sent for our
-cloaks, and Mr. Banks began to undress, as his custom was, and, with a
-precaution which he had been taught by the loss of the jackets at
-Atahourou, sent his clothes aboard the boat, proposing to cover himself
-with a piece of Indian cloth. When Mathiabo perceived what was doing, he
-also pretended to want a cloak; and, as he had behaved very well, and
-done us some service, a cloak was ordered for him. We lay down, and
-observed that Mathiabo was not with us; but we supposed that he was gone
-to bathe, as the Indians always do before they sleep. We had not waited
-long, however, when an Indian, who was a stranger to us, came and told
-Mr. Banks, that the cloak and Mathiabo had disappeared together. This
-man had so far gained our confidence, that we did not at first believe
-the report; but it being soon after confirmed by Tuahow, our own Indian,
-we knew no time was to be lost. As it was impossible for us to pursue
-the thief with any hope of success, without the assistance of the people
-about us, Mr. Banks started up, and telling our case, required them to
-recover the cloak; and to enforce this requisition, showed one of his
-pocket-pistols, which he always kept about him. Upon the sight of the
-pistol, the whole company took the alarm, and, instead of assisting to
-catch the thief, or recover what had been stolen, began with great
-precipitation to leave the place: one of them, however, was seized; upon
-which he immediately offered to direct the chase: I set out, therefore,
-with Mr. Banks; and though we ran all the way, the alarm had got before
-us; for in about ten minutes we met a man bringing back the cloak, which
-the thief had relinquished in great terror; and as we did not then think
-fit to continue the pursuit, he made his escape. When we returned, we
-found the house, in which there had been between two and three hundred
-people, entirely deserted. It being, however, soon known that we had no
-resentment against any body but Mathiabo, the chief, Wiverou, our host,
-with his wife, and many others, returned, and took up their lodgings
-with us for the night. In this place, however, we were destined to more
-confusion and trouble; for about five o’clock in the morning our sentry
-alarmed us, with an account that the boat was missing: he had seen her,
-he said, about half an hour before, at her grappling, which was not
-above fifty yards from the shore; but, upon hearing the sound of oars,
-he had looked out again, and could see nothing of her. At this account
-we started up greatly alarmed, and ran to the water-side: the morning
-was clear and star light, so that we could see to a considerable
-distance, but there was no appearance of the boat. Our situation was now
-such as might justify the most terrifying apprehensions: as it was a
-dead calm, and we could not therefore suppose her to have broken from
-her grappling, we had great reason to fear that the Indians had attacked
-her, and finding the people asleep, had succeeded in their enterprise:
-we were but four, with only one musket and two pocket pistols, without a
-spare ball or charge of powder for either. In this state of anxiety and
-distress we remained a considerable time, expecting the Indians every
-moment to improve their advantage, when, to our unspeakable
-satisfaction, we saw the boat return, which had been driven from her
-grappling by the tide; a circumstance to which, in our confusion and
-surprise, we did not advert.
-
-As soon as the boat returned, we got our breakfast, and were impatient
-to leave the place, lest some other vexatious accident should befall us.
-It is situated on the north side of Tiarrabou, the south-east peninsula,
-or division, of the island, and at the distance of about five miles
-south-east from the isthmus, having a large and commodious harbour,
-inferior to none in the island, about which the land is very rich in
-produce.
-
-Notwithstanding we had had little communication with this division, the
-inhabitants every where received us in a friendly manner: we found the
-whole of it fertile and populous, and, to all appearance, in a more
-flourishing state than Opoureonu, though it is not above one-fourth part
-as large.
-
-The next district in which we landed was the last in Tiarrabou, and
-governed by a chief, whose name we understood to be OMOE. Omoe was
-building a house, and being therefore very desirous of procuring a
-hatchet, he would have been glad to have purchased one with any thing
-that he had in his possession; it happened, however, rather
-unfortunately for him and us, that we had not one hatchet left in the
-boat. We offered to trade with nails, but he would not part with any
-thing in exchange for them; we therefore reimbarked, and put off our
-boat, but the chief being unwilling to relinquish all hope of obtaining
-something from us that would be of use to him, embarked in a canoe, with
-his wife WHANNOOUDA, and followed us. After some time, we took them into
-the boat, and when we had rowed about a league, they desired we would
-put ashore: we immediately complied with his request, and found some of
-his people, who had brought down a very large hog. We were as unwilling
-to lose the hog, as the chief was to part with us, and it was indeed
-worth the best axe we had in the ship; we therefore hit upon an
-expedient, and told him, that if he would bring his hog to the fort at
-MATAVAI, the Indian name for Port Royal bay, he should have a large axe,
-and a nail into the bargain for his trouble. To this proposal, after
-having consulted with his wife, he agreed, and gave us a large piece of
-his country cloth as a pledge that he would perform his agreement,
-which, however, he never did.
-
-At this place we saw a very singular curiosity: it was the figure of a
-man, constructed of basket-work, rudely made, but not ill designed; it
-was something more than seven feet high, and rather too bulky in
-proportion to its height. The wicker skeleton was completely covered
-with feathers, which were white where the skin was to appear, and black
-in the parts which it is their custom to paint or stain, and upon the
-head, where there was to be a representation of hair: upon the head also
-were four protuberances, three in front and one behind, which we should
-have called horns, but which the Indians dignified with the name of TATE
-ETE, little men. The image was called MANIOE, and was said to be the
-only one of the kind in Otaheite. They attempted to give us an
-explanation of its use and design, but we had not then acquired enough
-of their language to understand them. We learnt, however, afterwards,
-that it was a representation of Mauwe, one of their Eatuas, or gods of
-the second class.
-
-After having settled our affairs with Omoe, we proceeded on our return,
-and soon reached Opoureonu, the north-west peninsula. After rowing a few
-miles, we went on shore again, but the only thing we saw worth notice
-was a repository for the dead, uncommonly decorated: the pavement was
-extremely neat, and upon it was raised a pyramid, about five feet high,
-which was entirely covered with the fruits of two plants, peculiar to
-the country. Near the pyramid was a small image of stone, of very rude
-workmanship, and the first instance of carving in stone that we had seen
-among these people. They appeared to set a high value upon it, for it
-was covered from the weather by a shed, that had been erected on
-purpose.
-
-We proceeded in the boat, and passed through the only harbour, on the
-south side of Opoureonu, that is fit for shipping. It is situated about
-five miles to the westward of the isthmus, between two small islands
-that lie near the shore, and about a mile distant from each other, and
-affords good anchorage in eleven and twelve fathom water. We were now
-not far from the district called PAPARRA, which belonged to our friends
-Oamo and Oberea, where we proposed to sleep. We went on shore about an
-hour before night, and found that they were both absent, having left
-their habitations to pay us a visit at Matavai: this, however, did not
-alter our purpose, we took up our quarters at the house of Oberea,
-which, though small, was very neat, and at this time had no inhabitant
-but her father, who received us with looks that bid us welcome. Having
-taken possession, we were willing to improve the little day-light that
-was left us, and therefore walked out to a point, upon which we had
-seen, at a distance, trees that are here called _Etoa_, which generally
-distinguish the places where these people bury the bones of their dead:
-their name for such burying-grounds, which are also places of worship,
-is MORAI. We were soon struck with the sight of an enormous pile, which,
-we were told, was the morai of Oamo and Oberea, and the principal piece
-of Indian architecture in the island. It was a pile of stone work,
-raised pyramidically, upon an oblong base, or square, two hundred and
-sixty-seven feet long, and eighty-seven wide. It was built like the
-small pyramidal mounts upon which we sometimes fix the pillar of a
-sun-dial, where each side is a flight of steps; the steps, however, at
-the sides, were broader than those at the ends, so that it terminated,
-not in a square of the same figure with the base but in a ridge, like
-the roof of a house: there were eleven of these steps, each of which was
-four feet high, so that the height of the pile was forty-four feet; each
-step was formed of one course of white coral stone, which was neatly
-squared and polished; the rest of the mass, for there was no hollow
-within, consisted of round pebbles, which, from the regularity of their
-figure, seemed to have been wrought. Some of the coral stones were very
-large; we measured one of them, and found it three feet and a half by
-two feet and a half. The foundation was of rock stones, which were also
-squared; and one of them measured four feet seven inches by two feet
-four. Such a structure, raised without the assistance of iron tools to
-shape the stones, or mortar to join them, struck us with astonishment:
-it seemed to be as compact and firm as it could have been made by any
-workman in Europe, except that the steps, which range along its greatest
-length, are not perfectly strait, but sink in a kind of hollow in the
-middle, so that the whole surface, from end to end, is not a right line,
-but a curve. The quarry stones, as we saw no quarry in the
-neighbourhood, must have been brought from a considerable distance; and
-there is no method of conveyance here but by hand: the coral must also
-have been fished from under the water, where, though it may be found in
-plenty, it lies at a considerable depth, never less than three feet.
-Both the rock stone and the coral could be squared only by tools made of
-the same substance, which must have been a work of incredible labour;
-but the polishing was more easily effected by means of the sharp coral
-sand, which is found every where upon the sea-shore in great abundance.
-In the middle of the top stood the image of a bird, carved in wood; and
-near it lay the broken one of a fish, carved in stone. The whole of this
-pyramid made part of one side of a spacious area or square, nearly of
-equal sides, being three hundred and sixty feet by three hundred and
-fifty-four, which was walled in with stone, and paved with flat stones
-in its whole extent; though there were growing in it, notwithstanding
-the pavement, several of the trees which they call _Etoa_, and
-plantains. About an hundred yards to the west of this building was
-another paved area or court, in which were several small stages raised
-on wooden pillars, about seven feet high, which are called by the
-Indians _Ewattas_, and seem to be a kind of altars, as upon these are
-placed provisions of all kinds as offerings to their gods: we have since
-seen whole hogs placed upon them, and we found here the skulls of above
-fifty, besides the skulls of a great number of dogs.
-
-The principal object of ambition among these people is to have a
-magnificent morai, and this was a striking memorial of the rank and
-power of Oberea. It has been remarked, that we did not find her invested
-with the same authority that she exercised when the Dolphin was at this
-place, and we now learnt the reason of it. Our way from her house to the
-morai lay along the sea-side, and we observed every where under our feet
-a great number of human bones, chiefly ribs and vertebræ. Upon enquiring
-into the cause of so singular an appearance, we were told, that in the
-then last month of _Owarahew_, which answered to our December, 1768,
-about four or five months before our arrival, the people of Tiarrabou,
-the S. E. peninsula which we had just visited, made a descent at this
-place, and killed a great number of people, whose bones were those that
-we saw upon the shore: that, upon this occasion, Oberea, and Oamo, who
-then administered the government for his son, had fled to the mountains;
-and that the conquerors burnt all the houses, which were very large, and
-carried away the hogs, and what other animals they found. We learnt
-also, that the turkey and goose, which we had seen when we were with
-Mathiabo, the stealer of cloaks, were among the spoils: this accounted
-for their being found among people with whom the Dolphin had little or
-no communication; and upon mentioning the jaw-bones, which we had seen
-hanging from a board in a long house, we were told, that they also had
-been carried away as trophies, the people here carrying away the
-jaw-bones of their enemies, as the Indians of North America do the
-scalps.
-
-After having thus gratified our curiosity, we returned to our quarters,
-where we passed the night in perfect security and quiet. By the next
-evening we arrived at Atahourou, the residence of our friend Tootahah,
-where, the last time we passed the night under his protection, we had
-been obliged to leave the best part of our clothes behind us. This
-adventure, however, seemed now to be forgotten on both sides. Our
-friends received us with great pleasure, and gave us a good supper and a
-good lodging, where we suffered neither loss nor disturbance.
-
-The next day, Saturday, July the 1st, we got back to our fort at
-Matavai, having found the circuit of the island, including both
-peninsulas, to be about thirty leagues. Upon our complaining of the want
-of bread-fruit, we were told, that the produce of the last season was
-nearly exhausted; and that what was seen sprouting upon the trees, would
-not be fit to use in less than three months: this accounted for our
-having been able to procure so little of it in our route.
-
-While the bread-fruit is ripening upon the flats, the inhabitants are
-supplied in some measure from the trees which they have planted upon the
-hills to preserve a succession; but the quantity is not sufficient to
-prevent scarcity: they live therefore upon the sour paste, which they
-call _Mahie_, upon wild plantains, and ahee-nuts, which at this time are
-in perfection. How it happened that the Dolphin, which was here at this
-season, found such plenty of bread-fruit upon the trees I cannot tell,
-except the season in which they ripen varies.
-
-At our return, our Indian friends crowded about us, and none of them
-came empty-handed. Though I had determined to restore the canoes which
-had been detained to their owners, it had not yet been done; but I now
-released them as they were applied for. Upon this occasion I could not
-but remark with concern, that these people were capable of practising
-petty frauds against each other, with a deliberate dishonesty, which
-gave me a much worse opinion of them than I had ever entertained from
-the robberies they committed, under the strong temptation to which a
-sudden opportunity of enriching themselves with the inestimable metal
-and manufactures of Europe exposed them.
-
-Among others who applied to me for the release of a canoe, was one
-POTATTOW, a man of some consequence, well known to us all. I consented,
-supposing the vessel to be his own, or that he applied on the behalf of
-a friend: he went immediately to the beach, and took possession of one
-of the boats, which, with the assistance of his people, he began to
-carry off. Upon this, however, it was eagerly claimed by the right
-owners, who, supported by the other Indians, clamorously reproached him
-for invading their property, and prepared to take the canoe from him by
-force. Upon this, he desired to be heard, and told them, that the canoe
-did, indeed, once belong to those who claimed it; but that I, having
-seized it as a forfeit, had sold it to him for a pig. This silenced the
-clamour: the owners, knowing that from my power there was no appeal,
-acquiesced; and Potattow would have carried off his prize, if the
-dispute had not fortunately been overheard by some of our people, who
-reported it to me. I gave orders immediately that the Indians should be
-undeceived; upon which the right owners took possession of their canoe,
-and Potattow was so conscious of his guilt, that neither he nor his
-wife, who was privy to his knavery, could look us in the face for some
-time afterwards.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. XVI.
-
- AN EXPEDITION OF MR. BANKS TO TRACE THE RIVER: MARKS OF SUBTERRANEOUS
- FIRE: PREPARATIONS FOR LEAVING THE ISLAND: AN ACCOUNT OF TUPIA.
-
-
-ON the 3d, Mr. Banks set out early in the morning with some Indian
-guides, to trace our river up the valley from which it issues, and
-examine how far its banks were inhabited. For about six miles they met
-with houses, not far distant from each other, on each side of the river,
-and the valley was every where about four hundred yards wide from the
-foot of the hill on one side to the foot of that on the other; but they
-were now shown a house which they were told was the last that they would
-see. When they came up to it, the master of it offered them refreshments
-of cocoa-nuts and other fruits, of which they accepted. After a short
-stay, they walked forward for a considerable time: in bad way it is not
-easy to compute distances, but they imagined that they had walked about
-six miles farther, following the course of the river, when they
-frequently passed under vaults, formed by fragments of the rock, in
-which they were told people who were benighted frequently passed the
-night. Soon after they found the river banked by steep rocks, from which
-a cascade, falling with great violence, formed a pool, so steep, that
-the Indians said they could not pass it. They seemed, indeed, not much
-to be acquainted with the valley beyond this place, their business lying
-chiefly upon the declivity of the rocks on each side, and the plains
-which extended on their summits, where they found plenty of wild
-plantain, which they called _Vae_. The way up these rocks from the banks
-of the river was in every respect dreadful: the sides were nearly
-perpendicular, and in some places one hundred feet high: they were also
-rendered exceedingly slippery by the water of innumerable springs which
-issued from the fissures on the surface: yet up these precipices a way
-was to be traced by a succession of long pieces of the bark of the
-_Hibiscus tiliaceus_, which served as a rope for the climber to take
-hold of, and assisted him in scrambling from one ledge to another,
-though upon these ledges there was footing only for an Indian or a goat.
-One of these ropes was nearly thirty feet in length, and their guides
-offered to assist them in mounting this pass, but recommended another at
-a little distance lower down, as less difficult and dangerous. They took
-a view of this “better way,” but found it so bad that they did not
-choose to attempt it, as there was nothing at the top to reward their
-toil and hazard, but a grove of the wild plantain or vae tree, which
-they had often seen before.
-
-During this excursion, Mr. Banks had an excellent opportunity to examine
-the rocks, which were almost every where naked, for minerals; but he
-found not the least appearance of any. The stones every where, like
-those of Madeira, showed manifest tokens of having been burnt; nor is
-there a single specimen of any stone, among all those that were
-collected in the island, upon which there are not manifest and
-indubitable marks of fire; except, perhaps, some small pieces of the
-hatchet-stone, and even of that, other fragments were collected which
-were burnt almost to a pumice. Traces of fire are also manifest in the
-very clay upon the hills; and it may, therefore, not unreasonably be
-supposed, that this and the neighbouring islands are either shattered
-remains of a continent, which some have supposed to be necessary in this
-part of the globe, to preserve an equilibrium of its parts, which were
-left behind when the rest sunk by the mining of a subterraneous fire, so
-as to give a passage to the sea over it; or were torn from rocks, which,
-from the creation of the world, had been the bed of the sea, and thrown
-up in heaps, to a height which the waters never reach. One or other of
-these suppositions will perhaps be thought the more probable, as the
-water does not gradually grow shallow as the shore is approached, and
-the islands are almost every where surrounded by reefs, which appear to
-be rude and broken, as some violent concussion would naturally leave the
-solid substance of the earth. It may also be remarked upon this
-occasion, that the most probable cause of earthquakes seems to be the
-sudden rushing in of water upon some vast mass of subterraneous fire, by
-the instantaneous rarefaction of which into vapour the mine is sprung,
-and various substances, in all stages of vitrification, with shells, and
-other marine productions, that are now found fossil, and the strata that
-covered the furnace, are thrown up; while those parts of the land which
-were supported upon the broken shell give way, and sink into the gulf.
-With this theory the phænomena of all earthquakes seem to agree: pools
-of water are frequently left where land has subsided; and various
-substances, which manifestly appear to have suffered by the action of
-fire, are thrown up. It is indeed true, that fire cannot subsist without
-air; but this cannot be urged against there being fire below that part
-of the earth which forms the bed of the sea; because there may be
-innumerable fissures by which a communication between those parts and
-the external air may be kept up, even upon the highest mountains, and at
-the greatest distance from the sea-shore.
-
-On the 4th, Mr. Banks employed himself in planting a great quantity of
-the seeds of water melons, oranges, lemons, limes, and other plants and
-trees which he had collected at Rio de Janeiro. For these he prepared
-ground on each side of the fort, with as many varieties of soil as he
-could choose; and there is little doubt but that they will succeed. He
-also gave liberally of these seeds to the Indians, and planted many of
-them in the woods: some of the melon seeds having been planted soon
-after our arrival, the natives showed him several of the plants which
-appeared to be in the most flourishing condition, and were continually
-asking him for more.
-
-We now began to prepare for our departure, by bending the sails and
-performing other necessary operations on board the ship, our water being
-already on board, and the provisions examined. In the mean time we had
-another visit from Oamo, Oberea, and their son and daughter; the Indians
-expressing their respect by uncovering the upper parts of their body as
-they had done before. The daughter, whose name we understood to be
-TOIMATA, was very desirous to see the fort, but her father would by no
-means suffer her to come in. Tearee, the son of Waheatua, the sovereign
-of Tiarrabou, the south-east peninsula, was also with us at this time;
-and we received intelligence of the landing of another guest, whose
-company was neither expected nor desired: this was no other than the
-ingenious gentleman who contrived to steal our quadrant. We were told,
-that he intended to try his fortune again in the night; but the Indians
-all offered very zealously to assist us against him, desiring that, for
-this purpose, they might be permitted to lie in the fort. This had so
-good an effect, that the thief relinquished his enterprise in despair.
-
-On the 7th, the carpenters were employed in taking down the gates and
-pallisadoes of our little fortification, for firewood on board the ship;
-and one of the Indians had dexterity enough to steal the staple and hook
-upon which the gate turned: he was immediately pursued, and after a
-chace of six miles, he appeared to have been passed, having concealed
-himself among some rushes in the brook; the rushes were searched, and
-though the thief had escaped, a scraper was found which had been stolen
-from the ship some time before; and soon after our old friend Tubourai
-Tamaide brought us the staple.
-
-On the 8th and 9th, we continued to dismantle our fort, and our friends
-still flocked about us; some, I believe, sorry at the approach of our
-departure, and others desirous to make as much as they could of us while
-we staid.
-
-We were in hopes that we should now leave the island, without giving or
-receiving any other offence; but it unfortunately happened otherwise.
-Two foreign seamen having been out with my permission, one of them was
-robbed of his knife, and endeavouring to recover it, probably with
-circumstances of great provocation, the Indians attacked him, and
-dangerously wounded him with a stone; they wounded his companion also
-slightly in the head, and then fled into the mountains. As I should have
-been sorry to take any farther notice of the affair, I was not
-displeased that the offenders had escaped; but I was immediately
-involved in a quarrel which I very much regretted, and which yet it was
-not possible to avoid.
-
-In the middle of the night between the 8th and 9th, Clement Webb and
-Samuel Gibson, two of the marines, both young men, went privately from
-the fort, and in the morning were not to be found. As public notice had
-been given, that all hands were to go on board on the next day, and that
-the ship would sail on the morrow of that day or the day following, I
-began to fear that the absentees intended to stay behind. I knew that I
-could take no effectual steps to recover them, without endangering the
-harmony and good-will which at present subsisted among us; and therefore
-determined to wait a day for the chance of their return.
-
-On Monday morning the 10th, the marines, to my great concern, not being
-returned, an enquiry was made after them of the Indians, who frankly
-told us, that they did not intend to return, and had taken refuge in the
-mountains, where it was impossible for our people to find them. They
-were then requested to assist in the search, and after some
-deliberation, two of them undertook to conduct such persons as I should
-think proper to send after them to the place of their retreat. As they
-were known to be without arms, I thought two would be sufficient, and
-accordingly dispatched a petty officer, and the corporal of the marines,
-with the Indian guides, to fetch them back. As the recovery of these men
-was a matter of great importance, as I had no time to lose, and as the
-Indians spoke doubtfully of their return, telling us, that they had each
-of them taken a wife, and were become inhabitants of the country, it was
-intimated to several of the chiefs who were in the fort with their
-women, among whom were Tubourai Tamaide, Tomio, and Oberea, that they
-would not be permitted to leave it till our deserters were brought back.
-This precaution I thought the more necessary, as, by concealing them a
-few days, they might compel me to go without them; and I had the
-pleasure to observe, that they received the intimation with very little
-signs either of fear or discontent; assuring me that my people should be
-secured and sent back as soon as possible. While this was doing at the
-fort, I sent Mr. Hicks in the pinnace to fetch Tootahah on board the
-ship, which he did, without alarming either him or his people. If the
-Indian guides proved faithful and in earnest, I had reason to expect the
-return of my people with the deserters before evening. Being
-disappointed, my suspicions increased; and night coming on, I thought it
-was not safe to let the people whom I had detained as hostages continue
-at the fort, and I therefore ordered Tubourai Tamaide, Oberea, and some
-others, to be taken on board the ship. This spread a general alarm, and
-several of them, especially the women, expressed their apprehensions
-with great emotion and many tears when they were put into the boat. I
-went on board with them, and Mr. Banks remained on shore, with some
-others whom I thought it of less consequence to secure.
-
-About nine o’clock, Webb was brought back by some of the natives, who
-declared, that Gibson, and the petty officer and corporal, would be
-detained till Tootahah should be set at liberty. The tables were now
-turned upon me; but I had proceeded too far to retreat. I immediately
-dispatched Mr. Hicks in the long-boat, with a strong party of men, to
-rescue the prisoners, and told Tootahah that it behoved him to send some
-of his people with them, with orders to afford them effectual
-assistance, and to demand the release of my men in his name, for that I
-should expect him to answer for the contrary. He readily complied: this
-party recovered my men without the least opposition; and about seven
-o’clock in the morning returned with them to the ship, though they had
-not been able to recover the arms which had been taken from them when
-they were seized: these, however, were brought on board in less than
-half an hour, and the chiefs were immediately set at liberty.
-
-When I questioned the petty officer concerning what had happened on
-shore, he told me, that neither the natives who went with him, nor those
-whom they met in their way, would give them any intelligence of the
-deserters; but, on the contrary, became very troublesome: that, as he
-was returning for further orders to the ship, he and his comrade were
-suddenly seized by a number of armed men, who having learnt that
-Tootahah was confined, had concealed themselves in a wood for that
-purpose, and who, having taken them at a disadvantage, forced their
-weapons out of their hands, and declared, that they would detain them
-till their chief should be set at liberty. He said, however, that the
-Indians were not unanimous in this measure; that some were for setting
-them at liberty, and others for detaining them; that an eager dispute
-ensued, and that from words they came to blows, but that the party for
-detaining them at length prevailed; that soon after Webb and Gibson were
-brought in by a party of the natives, as prisoners, that they also might
-be secured as hostages for the chief; but that it was, after some
-debate, resolved to send Webb to inform me of their resolution, to
-assure me that his companions were safe, and direct me where I might
-send my answer. Thus it appears, that, whatever were the disadvantages
-of seizing the chiefs, I should never have recovered my men by any other
-method. When the chiefs were set on shore from the ship, those at the
-fort were also set at liberty, and, after staying with Mr. Banks about
-an hour, they all went away. Upon this occasion, as they had done upon
-another of the same kind, they expressed their joy by an undeserved
-liberality, strongly urging us to accept of four hogs. These we
-absolutely refused as a present, and they as absolutely refusing to be
-paid for them, the hogs did not change masters. Upon examining the
-deserters, we found that the account which the Indians had given of them
-was true: they had strongly attached themselves to two girls, and it was
-their intention to conceal themselves till the ship had sailed, and take
-up their residence upon the island. This night every thing was got off
-from the shore, and every body slept on board.
-
-Among the natives who were almost constantly with us, was Tupia, whose
-name has been often mentioned in this narrative. He had been, as I have
-before observed, the first minister of Oberea, when she was in the
-height of her power: he was also the chief Tahowa or priest of the
-island, consequently well acquainted with the religion of the country,
-as well with respect to its ceremonies as principles. He had also great
-experience and knowledge in navigation, and was particularly acquainted
-with the number and situation of the neighbouring islands. This man had
-often expressed a desire to go with us, and on the 12th in the morning,
-having, with the other natives, left us the day before, he came on
-board, with a boy about thirteen years of age, his servant, and urged us
-to let him proceed with us on our voyage. To have such a person on board
-was certainly desirable for many reasons; by learning his language, and
-teaching him ours, we should be able to acquire a much better knowledge
-of the customs, policy, and religion of the people, than our short stay
-among them could give us, I therefore gladly agreed to receive them on
-board. As we were prevented from sailing to-day, by having found it
-necessary to make new stocks to our small and best bower anchors, the
-old ones having been totally destroyed by the worms, Tupia said, he
-would go once more on shore, and make a signal for the boat to fetch him
-off in the evening. He went accordingly, and took with him a miniature
-picture of Mr. Banks, to shew his friends, and several little things to
-give them as parting presents.
-
-After dinner, Mr. Banks being desirous to procure a drawing of the Morai
-belonging to Tootahah at Eparré, I attended him thither, accompanied by
-Dr. Solander, in the pinnace. As soon as we landed, many of our friends
-came to meet us, though some absented themselves in resentment of what
-had happened the day before. We immediately proceeded to Tootahah’s
-house, where we were joined by Oberea, with several others who had not
-come out to meet us, and a perfect reconciliation was soon brought
-about; in consequence of which they promised to visit us early the next
-day, to take a last farewell of us, as we told them we should certainly
-set sail in the afternoon. At this place also we found Tupia, who
-returned with us, and slept this night on board the ship for the first
-time.
-
-On the next morning, Thursday the 13th of July, the ship was very early
-crowded with our friends, and surrounded by a multitude of canoes, which
-were filled with the natives of an inferior class. Between eleven and
-twelve we weighed anchor, and as soon as the ship was under sail, the
-Indians on board took their leaves, and wept, with a decent and silent
-sorrow, in which there was something very striking and tender: the
-people in the canoes, on the contrary, seemed to vie with each other in
-the loudness of their lamentations, which we considered rather as
-affectation than grief. Tupia sustained himself in this scene with a
-firmness and resolution truly admirable: he wept, indeed, but the effort
-that he made to conceal his tears, concurred, with them, to do him
-honour. He sent his last present, a shirt, by Otheothea, to Potomai,
-Tootahah’s favourite mistress, and then went with Mr. Banks to the
-mast-head, waving to the canoes as long as they continued in sight.
-
-Thus we took leave of Otaheite, and its inhabitants, after a stay of
-just three months; for much the greater part of the time we lived
-together in the most cordial friendship, and a perpetual reciprocation
-of good offices. The accidental differences which now and then happened,
-could not be more sincerely regretted on their part than they were on
-ours: the principal causes were such as necessarily resulted from our
-situation and circumstances, in conjunction with the infirmities of
-human nature, from our not being able perfectly to understand each
-other, and from the disposition of the inhabitants to theft, which we
-could not at all times bear with or prevent. They had not, however,
-except in one instance, been attended with any fatal consequence; and to
-that accident were owing the measures that I took to prevent others of
-the same kind. I hoped, indeed, to have availed myself of the impression
-which had been made upon them by the lives that had been sacrificed in
-their contest with the Dolphin, so as that the intercourse between us
-should have been carried on wholly without bloodshed; and by this hope
-all my measures were directed during the whole of my continuance at the
-island; and I sincerely wish, that whoever shall next visit it, may be
-still more fortunate. Our traffic here was carried on with as much order
-as in the best regulated market in Europe. It was managed principally by
-Mr. Banks, who was indefatigable in procuring provisions and
-refreshments while they were to be had; but during the latter part of
-our time they became scarce, partly by the increased consumption at the
-fort and ship, and partly by the coming on of the season in which
-cocoa-nuts and bread-fruit fail. All kind of fruit we purchased for
-beads and nails; but no nails less than fortypenny were current: after a
-very short time we could never get a pig of more than ten or twelve
-pounds for less than a hatchet; because, though these people set a high
-value upon spike-nails, yet these being an article with which many
-people in the ship were provided, the women found a much more easy way
-of procuring them than by bringing down provisions.
-
-The best articles for traffic here are axes, hatches, spikes, large
-nails, looking-glasses, knives, and beads; for some of which, every
-thing that the natives have may be procured. They are indeed fond of
-fine linen cloth, both white and printed; but an axe worth half-a-crown
-will fetch more than a piece of cloth worth twenty shillings.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. XVII.
-
- A PARTICULAR DESCRIPTION OF THE ISLAND; ITS PRODUCE AND INHABITANTS;
- THEIR DRESS, HABITATIONS, FOOD, DOMESTIC LIFE, AND AMUSEMENTS.
-
-
-WE found the longitude of Port-Royal bay, in this island, as settled by
-Captain Wallis, who discovered it on the 9th of June, 1767, to be within
-half a degree of the truth. We found Point Venus, the northern extremity
-of the island, and the eastern point of the bay, to lie in the longitude
-of 149° 13ʹ, this being the mean result of a great number of
-observations made upon the spot. The island is surrounded by a reef of
-coral rock, which forms several excellent bays and harbours, some of
-which have been particularly described, where there is room and depth of
-water for any number of the largest ships. Port-Royal bay, called by the
-natives Matavai, which is not inferior to any in Otaheite, may easily be
-known by a very high mountain in the middle of the island, which bears
-due south from Point Venus. To sail into it, either keep the west point
-of the reef that lies before Point Venus close on board, or give it a
-birth of near half a mile, in order to avoid a small shoal of coral
-rocks, on which there is but two fathom and a half of water. The best
-anchoring is on the eastern side of the bay, where there is sixteen and
-fourteen fathom upon an ousey bottom. The shore of the bay is a fine
-sandy beach, behind which runs a river of fresh water, so that any
-number of ships may water here without incommoding each other; but the
-only wood for firing, upon the whole island, is that of fruit trees,
-which must be purchased of the natives, or all hope of living upon good
-terms with them given up. There are some harbours to the westward of
-this bay which have not been mentioned; but, as they are contiguous to
-it, and laid down in the plan, a description of them is unnecessary.
-
-The face of the country, except that part of it which borders upon the
-sea, is very uneven; it rises in ridges that run up into the middle of
-the island, and there form mountains, which may be seen at the distance
-of sixty miles: between the foot of these ridges and the sea is a border
-of low land, surrounding the whole island, except in a few places where
-the ridges rise directly from the sea: the border of low land is in
-different parts of different breadths, but no where more than a mile and
-a half. The soil, except upon the very tops of the ridges, is extremely
-rich and fertile, watered by a great number of rivulets of excellent
-water, and covered with fruit trees of various kinds, some of which are
-of a stately growth and thick foliage, so as to form one continued wood;
-and even the tops of the ridges, though in general they are bare, and
-burnt up by the sun, are, in some parts, not without their produce.
-
-The low land that lies between the foot of the ridges and the sea, and
-some of the valleys, are the only parts of the island that are
-inhabited, and here it is populous: the houses do not form villages or
-towns, but are ranged along the whole border at the distance of about
-fifty yards from each other, with little plantations of plantains, the
-tree which furnishes them with cloth. The whole island, according to
-Tupia’s account, who certainly knew, could furnish six thousand seven
-hundred and eighty fighting men, from which the number of inhabitants
-may easily be computed.
-
-The produce of this island is bread-fruit, cocoa-nuts, bananas, of
-thirteen sorts, the best we had ever eaten; plantains; a fruit not
-unlike an apple, which, when ripe, is very pleasant; sweet potatoes,
-yams, cocoas, a kind of _Arum_; a fruit known here by the name of
-_Jambu_, and reckoned most delicious; sugar-cane, which the inhabitants
-eat raw; a root of the salop kind, called by the inhabitants _Pea_; a
-plant called _Ethee_, of which the root only is eaten; a fruit that
-grows in a pod, like that of a large kidney-bean, which, when it is
-roasted, eats very much like a chesnut, by the natives called _Ahee_; a
-tree called _Wharra_, called in the East Indies _Pandanes_, which
-produces fruit, something like the pine-apple; a shrub called _Nono_;
-the _Morinda_, which also produces fruit; a species of fern, of which
-the root is eaten, and sometimes the leaves; and a plant called _Theve_,
-of which the root also is eaten: but the fruits of the _Nono_, the fern,
-and the _Theve_, are eaten only by the inferior people, and in times of
-scarcity. All these, which serve the inhabitants for food, the earth
-produces spontaneously, or with so little culture, that they seem to be
-exempted from the first general curse, that “man should eat his bread in
-the sweat of his brow.” They have also the Chinese paper mulberry,
-_morus papyrifera_, which they call _Aouta_; a tree resembling the wild
-fig-tree of the West Indies; another species of fig, which they call
-_Matte_; the _cordia sebestina orientalis_, which they call _Etou_; a
-kind of Cyperus grass, which they call _Moo_; a species of
-_tournefortia_, which they call _Taheinoo_; another of the _convolvulus
-poluce_, which they call _Eurhe_; the _solanum centifolium_, which they
-call _Ebooa_; the _calophyllum mophylum_, which they call _Tamannu_; the
-_hibiscus tiliaceus_, called _Poerou_, a frutescent nettle; the _urtica
-argentea_, called _Erowa_; with many other plants which cannot here be
-particularly mentioned: those that have been named already will be
-referred to in the subsequent part of this work.
-
-They have no European fruit, garden stuff, pulse, or legumes, nor grain
-of any kind.
-
-Of tame animals they have only hogs, dogs, and poultry; neither is there
-a wild animal in the island, except ducks, pigeons, paroquets, with a
-few other birds, and rats, there being no other quadruped, nor any
-serpent. But the sea supplies them with great variety of most excellent
-fish, to eat which is their chief luxury, and to catch it their
-principal labour.
-
-As to the people they are of the largest size of Europeans. The men are
-tall, strong, well-limbed, and finely shaped. The tallest that we saw
-was a man upon a neighbouring island, called HUAHEINE, who measured six
-feet three inches and a half. The women of the superior rank are also in
-general above our middle stature, but those of the inferior class are
-rather below it, and some of them are very small. This defect in size
-probably proceeds from their early commerce with men, the only thing in
-which they differ from their superiors, that could possibly affect their
-growth.
-
-Their natural complexion is that kind of clear olive, or _brunette_,
-which many people in Europe prefer to the finest white and red. In those
-that are exposed to the wind and sun, it is considerably deepened, but
-in others that live under shelter, especially the superior class of
-women, it continues of its native hue, and the skin is most delicately
-smooth and soft: they have no tint in their cheeks, which we distinguish
-by the name of colour. The shape of the face is comely, the cheek-bones
-are not high, neither are the eyes hollow, nor the brow prominent: the
-only feature that does not correspond with our ideas of beauty is the
-nose, which, in general, is somewhat flat; but their eyes, especially
-those of the women, are full of expression, sometimes sparkling with
-fire, and sometimes melting with softness; their teeth also are, almost
-without exception, most beautifully even and white, and their breath
-perfectly without taint.
-
-The hair is almost universally black, and rather coarse: the men have
-beards, which they wear in many fashions, always, however, plucking out
-great part of them, and keeping the rest perfectly clean and neat. Both
-sexes also eradicate every hair from under their arms, and accused us of
-great uncleanliness for not doing the same. In their motions there is at
-once vigour and ease; their walk is graceful, their deportment liberal,
-and their behaviour to strangers and to each other affable and
-courteous. In their dispositions, also, they seemed to be brave, open,
-and candid, without either suspicion or treachery, cruelty or revenge;
-so that we placed the same confidence in them as in our best friends,
-many of us, particularly Mr. Banks, sleeping frequently in their houses
-in the woods, without a companion, and consequently wholly in their
-power. They were, however, all thieves; and when that is allowed, they
-need not much fear a competition with the people of any other nation
-upon earth. During our stay in this island, we saw about five or six
-persons, like one that was met by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander on the 24th
-of April, in their walk to the eastward, whose skins were of a dead
-white, like the nose of a white horse; with white hair, beard, brows,
-and eye-lashes; red, tender eyes; a short sight, and scurfy skins,
-covered with a kind of white down; but we found that no two of these
-belonged to the same family, and therefore concluded, that they were not
-a species, but unhappy individuals, rendered anomalous by disease.
-
-It is a custom in most countries where the inhabitants have long hair,
-for the men to cut it short, and the women to pride themselves in its
-length. Here, however, the contrary custom prevails; the women always
-cut it short round their ears, and the men, except the fishers, who are
-almost continually in the water, suffer it to flow in large waves over
-their shoulders, or tie it up in a bunch on the top of their heads.
-
-They have a custom, also, of anointing their heads, with what they call
-_Monoe_, an oil expressed from the cocoa-nut, in which some sweet herbs
-or flowers have been infused: as the oil is generally rancid, the smell
-is at first very disagreeable to a European; and as they live in a hot
-country, and have no such thing as a comb, they are not able to keep
-their heads free from lice, which the children and common people
-sometimes pick out and eat; a hateful custom, wholly different from
-their manners in every other particular; for they are delicate and
-cleanly almost without example; and those to whom we distributed combs
-soon delivered themselves from vermin, with a diligence which showed
-that they were not more odious to us than to them.
-
-They have a custom of staining their bodies, nearly in the same manner
-as is practised in many other parts of the world, which they call
-_Tattowing_. They prick the skin, so as just not to fetch blood, with a
-small instrument, something in the form of a hoe; that part which
-answers to the blade is made of a bone or shell, scraped very thin, and
-is from a quarter of an inch to an inch and a half wide; the edge is cut
-into sharp teeth or points, from the number of three to twenty,
-according to its size: when this is to be used, they dip the teeth into
-a mixture of a kind of lamp-black, formed of the smoke that rises from
-an oily nut which they burn instead of candles, and water; the teeth,
-thus prepared, are placed upon the skin, and the handle to which they
-are fastened being struck, by quick smart blows, with a stick fitted to
-the purpose, they pierce it, and at the same time carry into the
-puncture the black composition, which leaves an indelible stain. The
-operation is painful, and it is some days before the wounds are healed.
-It is performed upon the youth of both sexes when they are about twelve
-or fourteen years of age, on several parts of the body, and in various
-figures, according to the fancy of the parent, or perhaps the rank of
-the party. The women are generally marked with this stain, in the form
-of a Z, on every joint of their fingers and toes, and frequently round
-the outside of their feet: the men are also marked with the same figure,
-and both men and women have squares, circles, crescents, and
-ill-designed representations of men, birds, or dogs, and various other
-devices impressed upon their legs, and arms, some of which, we were
-told, had significations, though we could never learn what they were.
-But the part on which these ornaments are lavished with the greatest
-profusion is the breech: this, in both sexes, is covered with a deep
-black; above which, arches are drawn one over another as high as the
-short ribs. They are often a quarter of an inch broad, and the edges are
-not straight lines, but indented. These arches are their pride, and are
-shown both by men and women with a mixture of ostentation and pleasure;
-whether as an ornament, or a proof of their fortitude and resolution in
-bearing pain, we could not determine. The face in general is left
-unmarked: for we saw but one instance to the contrary. Some old men had
-the greatest part of their bodies covered with large patches of black,
-deeply indented at the edges, like a rude imitation of flame; but we
-were told, that they came from a low island, called NOOUOORA, and were
-not natives of Otaheite.
-
-Mr. Banks saw the operation of _tattowing_ performed upon the backside
-of a girl about thirteen years old. The instrument used upon this
-occasion had thirty teeth, and every stroke, of which at least a hundred
-were made in a minute, drew an ichor or serum a little tinged with
-blood. The girl bore it with most stoical resolution for about a quarter
-of an hour; but the pain of so many hundred punctures as she had
-received in that time then became intolerable: she first complained in
-murmurs, then wept, and at last burst into loud lamentations, earnestly
-imploring the operator to desist. He was, however, inexorable; and when
-she began to struggle, she was held down by two women, who sometimes
-soothed and sometimes chid her, and now and then, when she was most
-unruly, gave her a smart blow. Mr. Banks staid in a neighbouring house
-an hour, and the operation was not over when he went away; yet it was
-performed but upon one side, the other having been done some time
-before; and the arches upon the loins, in which they most pride
-themselves, and which give more pain than all the rest, were still to be
-done.
-
-It is strange that these people should value themselves upon what is no
-distinction; for I never saw a native of this island, either man or
-woman, in a state of maturity, in whom these marks were wanting:
-possibly they may have their rise in superstition, especially as they
-produce no visible advantage, and are not made without great pain; but
-though we enquired of many hundreds, we could never get any account of
-the matter.
-
-Their clothing consists of cloth or matting of different kinds, which
-will be described among their other manufactures. The cloth which will
-not bear wetting they wear in dry weather, and the matting when it
-rains: they are put on in many different ways, just as their fancy leads
-them; for in their garments nothing is cut into shape, nor are any two
-pieces sewed together. The dress of the better sort of women consists of
-three or four pieces: one piece, about two yards wide, and eleven yards
-long, they wrap several times round their waist, so as to hang down like
-a petticoat as low as the middle of the leg, and this they call _Parou_:
-two or three other pieces, about two yards and a half long, and one
-wide, each having a hole cut in the middle, they place one upon another,
-and then putting the head through the holes, they bring the long ends
-down before and behind; the others remain open at the sides, and give
-liberty to the arms: this, which they call the _Tebuta_, is gathered
-round the waist, and confined with a girdle or sash of thinner cloth,
-which is long enough to go many times round them, and exactly resembles
-the garment worn by the inhabitants of Peru and Chili, which the
-Spaniards call _Poncho_. The dress of the men is the same, except that,
-instead of suffering the cloth that is wound about the hips to hang down
-like a petticoat, they bring it between their legs so as to have some
-resemblance to breeches, and it is then called _Maro_. This is the dress
-of all ranks of people, and being universally the same as to form, the
-gentlemen and ladies distinguish themselves from the lower people by the
-quantity; some of them will wrap round them several pieces of cloth,
-eight or ten yards long, and two or three broad; and some throw a large
-piece loosely over their shoulders, in the manner of a cloak; or perhaps
-two pieces, if they are very great personages, and are desirous to
-appear in state. The inferior sort, who have only a small allowance of
-cloth from the tribes or families to which they belong, are obliged to
-be more thinly clad. In the heat of the day, they appear almost naked,
-the women having only a scanty petticoat, and the men nothing but the
-sash that is passed between their legs and fastened round the waist. As
-finery is always troublesome, and particularly in a hot country, where
-it consists in putting one covering upon another, the women of rank
-always uncover themselves as low as the waist in the evening, throwing
-off all that they wear on the upper part of the body, with the same
-negligence and ease as our ladies would lay by a cardinal or double
-handkerchief. And the chiefs, even when they visited us, though they had
-as much cloth round their middle as would clothe a dozen people, had
-frequently the rest of the body quite naked.
-
-Upon their legs and feet, they wear no covering; but they shade their
-faces from the sun with little bonnets, either of matting or of
-cocoa-nut leaves, which they make occasionally in a few minutes. This,
-however, is not all their head-dress; the women sometimes wear little
-turbans, and sometimes a dress which they value much more, and which,
-indeed, is much more becoming, called _Tomou_: the _tomou_ consists of
-human hair, plaited in threads, scarcely thicker than sewing silk. Mr.
-Banks has pieces of it above a mile in length, without a knot. These
-they wind round the head in such a manner as produces a very pretty
-effect, and in a very great quantity; for I have seen five or six such
-pieces wound about the head of one woman: among these threads they stick
-flowers of various kinds, particularly the Cape-jessamine, of which they
-have great plenty, as it is always planted near their houses. The men
-sometimes stick the tail-feather of the Tropic-bird upright in their
-hair, which, as I have observed before, is often tied in a bunch upon
-the top of their heads: sometimes they wear a kind of whimsical garland,
-made of flowers of various kinds, stuck into a piece of the rind of a
-plantain; or of scarlet peas, stuck with gum upon a piece of wood: and
-sometimes they wear a kind of wig, made of the hair of men or dogs, or
-perhaps of cocoa-nut strings, woven upon one thread, which is tied under
-their hair, so that these artificial honours of their head may hang down
-behind. Their personal ornaments, besides flowers, are few; both sexes
-wear ear-rings but they are placed only on one side: when we came they
-consisted of small pieces of shell, stone, berries, red peas, or some
-small pearls, three in a string; but our beads very soon supplanted them
-all.
-
-The children go quite naked: the girls till they are three or four years
-old; and the boys till they are six or seven.
-
-The houses, or rather dwellings, of these people, have been occasionally
-mentioned before: they are all built in the wood, between the sea and
-the mountains, and no more ground is cleared for each house than just
-sufficient to prevent the dropping of the branches from rotting the
-thatch with which they are covered; from the house, therefore, the
-inhabitant steps immediately under the shade, which is the most
-delightful that can be imagined. It consists of groves of bread-fruit
-and cocoa-nuts, without underwood, which are intersected, in all
-directions, by the paths that lead from one house to the other. Nothing
-can be more grateful than this shade in so warm a climate, nor any thing
-more beautiful than these walks. As there is no underwood, the shade
-cools without impeding the air; and the houses, having no walls, receive
-the gale from whatever point it blows. I shall now give a particular
-description of a house of a middling size, from which, as the structure
-is universally the same, a perfect idea may be formed both of those that
-are bigger and those that are less.
-
-The ground which it covers is an oblong square, four-and-twenty feet
-long, and eleven wide; over this a roof is raised, upon three rows of
-pillars or posts, parallel to each other, one on each side, and the
-other in the middle. This roof consists of two flat sides inclining to
-each other, and terminating in a ridge, exactly like the roofs of our
-thatched houses in England. The utmost height within is about nine feet,
-and the eaves on each side reach to within about three feet and a half
-of the ground: below this, and through the whole height, at each end, it
-is open, no part of it being inclosed with a wall. The roof is thatched
-with palm-leaves, and the floor is covered, some inches deep, with soft
-hay; over this are laid mats, so that the whole is one cushion, upon
-which they sit in the day, and sleep in the night. In some houses,
-however, there is one stool, which is wholly appropriated to the master
-of the family; besides this, they have no furniture, except a few little
-blocks of wood, the upper side of which is hollowed into a curve, and
-which serves them for pillows.
-
-The house is indeed principally used as a dormitory; for, except it
-rains, they eat in the open air, under the shade of the next tree. The
-clothes that they wear in the day serve them for covering in the night:
-the floor is the common bed of the whole household, and is not divided
-by any partition. The master of the house and his wife sleep in the
-middle, next to them the married people, next to them the unmarried
-women, and next to them, at a little distance, the unmarried men: the
-servants, or _Toutous_, as they are called, sleep in the open air,
-except it rains, and in that case they come just within the shade.
-
-There are, however, houses of another kind belonging to the chiefs, in
-which there is some degree of privacy. These are much smaller, and so
-constructed as to be carried about in their canoes from place to place,
-and set up occasionally like a tent: they are enclosed on the sides with
-cocoa-nut leaves, but not so close as to exclude the air, and the chief
-and his wife sleep in them alone.
-
-There are houses also of a much larger size, not built either for the
-accommodation of a single chief, or a single family; but as common
-receptacles for all the people of a district. Some of them are two
-hundred feet long, thirty broad, and, under the ridge, twenty feet high:
-these are built and maintained at the common expence of the district,
-for the accommodation of which they are intended; and have on one side
-of them a large area, inclosed with low pallisadoes.
-
-These houses, like those of separate families, have no walls. Privacy,
-indeed, is little wanted among people who have not even the idea of
-indecency, and who gratify every appetite and passion before witnesses,
-with no more sense of impropriety than we feel when we satisfy our
-hunger at a social board with our family or friends. Those who have no
-idea of indecency with respect to actions, can have none with respect to
-words; it is, therefore, scarcely necessary to observe, that, in the
-conversation of these people, that which is the principal source of
-their pleasure is always the principal topic; and that every thing is
-mentioned without any restraint or emotion, and in the most direct
-terms, by both sexes.
-
-Of the food eaten here the greater part is vegetable. Here are no tame
-animals except hogs, dogs, and poultry, as I have observed before, and
-these are by no means plenty. When a chief kills a hog, it is almost
-equally divided among his dependants; and, as they are very numerous,
-the share of each individual at these feasts, which are not frequent,
-must necessarily be small. Dogs and fowls fall somewhat more frequently
-to the share of the common people. I cannot much commend the flavour of
-their fowls; but we all agreed, that a South-sea dog was little inferior
-to an English lamb: their excellence is probably owing to their being
-kept up, and fed wholly upon vegetables. The sea affords them a great
-variety of fish. The smaller fish, when they catch any, are generally
-eaten raw, as we eat oysters; and nothing that the sea produces comes
-amiss to them: they are fond of lobsters, crabs, and other shell-fish,
-which are found upon the coast; and they will eat not only sea-insects,
-but what the seamen call _Blubbers_, though some of them are so tough,
-that they are obliged to suffer them to become putrid before they can be
-chewed. Of the many vegetables that have been mentioned already as
-serving them for food, the principal is the bread-fruit, to procure
-which costs them no trouble or labour but climbing a tree: the tree
-which produces it does not indeed shoot up spontaneously: but if a man
-plants ten of them in his lifetime, which he may do in about an hour, he
-will as completely fulfil his duty to his own and future generations as
-the natives of our less temperate climate can do by ploughing in the
-cold of winter, and reaping in the summer’s heat, as often as these
-seasons return; even if, after he has procured bread for his present
-household, he should convert a surplus into money, and lay it up for his
-children.
-
-It is true, indeed, that the bread-fruit is not always in season; but
-cocoa-nuts, bananas, plantains, and a great variety of other fruits,
-supply the deficiency.
-
-It may well be supposed, that cookery is but little studied by these
-people as an art; and, indeed, they have but two ways of applying fire
-to dress their food, broiling and baking; the operation of broiling is
-so simple that it requires no description, and their baking has been
-described already, (page 154.) in the account of an entertainment
-prepared for us by Tupia. Hogs, and large fish, are extremely well
-dressed in the same manner; and, in our opinion, were more juicy and
-more equally done than by any art of cookery now practised in Europe.
-Bread-fruit is also cooked in an oven of the same kind, which renders it
-soft, and something like a boiled potatoe; not quite so farinaceous as a
-good one, but more so than those of the middling sort.
-
-Of the bread-fruit they also make three dishes, by putting either water
-or the milk of the cocoa-nut to it, then beating it to a paste with a
-stone pestle, and afterwards mixing it with ripe plantains, bananas, or
-the sour paste which they call _Mahie_.
-
-The mahie, which has been mentioned as a succedaneum for ripe
-bread-fruit, before the season for gathering a fresh crop comes on, is
-thus made:
-
-The fruit is gathered just before it is perfectly ripe, and being laid
-in heaps, is closely covered with leaves; in this state it undergoes a
-fermentation, and becomes disagreeably sweet: the core is then taken out
-entire, which is done by gently pulling the stalk, and the rest of the
-fruit is thrown into a hole which is dug for that purpose, generally in
-the houses, and neatly lined in the bottom and sides with grass; the
-whole is then covered with leaves, and heavy stones laid upon them: in
-this state it undergoes a second fermentation, and becomes sour, after
-which it will suffer no change for many months: it is taken out of the
-hole as it is wanted for use, and being made into balls, it is wrapped
-up in leaves and baked; after it is dressed, it will keep five or six
-weeks. It is eaten both cold and hot, and the natives seldom make a meal
-without it, though to us the taste was as disagreeable as that of a
-pickled olive generally is the first time it is eaten.
-
-As the making of this mahie depends, like brewing, upon fermentation,
-so, like brewing, it sometimes fails, without their being able to
-ascertain the cause; it is very natural, therefore, that the making it
-should be connected with superstitious notions and ceremonies. It
-generally falls to the lot of the old women, who will suffer no creature
-to touch any thing belonging to it, but those whom they employ as
-assistants, nor even to go into that part of the house where the
-operation is carrying on. Mr. Banks happened to spoil a large quantity
-of it only by inadvertently touching a leaf which lay upon it. The old
-woman, who then presided over these mysteries, told him, that the
-process would fail; and immediately uncovered the hole in a fit of
-vexation and despair. Mr. Banks regretted the mischief he had done, but
-was somewhat consoled by the opportunity which it gave him of examining
-the preparation, which perhaps, but for such an accident, would never
-have offered.
-
-Such is their food, to which salt water is the universal sauce, no meal
-being eaten without it: those who live near the sea have it fetched as
-it is wanted; those who live at some distance keep it in large bamboos,
-which are set up in their houses for use. Salt water, however, is not
-their only sauce; they make another of the kernels of cocoa-nuts, which
-being fermented till they dissolve into a paste somewhat resembling
-butter, are beaten up with salt water. The flavour of this is very
-strong, and was, when we first tasted it, exceedingly nauseous; a little
-use, however, reconciled some of our people to it so much, that they
-preferred it to our own sauces, especially with fish. The natives seemed
-to consider it as a dainty, and do not use it at their common meals;
-possibly, because they think it ill management to use cocoa-nuts so
-lavishly, or, perhaps, when we were at the island, they were scarcely
-ripe enough for the purpose.
-
-For drink, they have in general nothing but water, or the juice of the
-cocoa-nut; the art of producing liquors that intoxicate, by
-fermentation, being happily unknown among them; neither have they any
-narcotic which they chew, as the natives of some other countries do
-opium, beetle-root, and tobacco. Some of them drank freely of our
-liquors, and in a few instances became very drunk; but the persons to
-whom this happened were so far from desiring to repeat the debauch, that
-they would never touch any of our liquors afterwards. We were, however,
-informed, that they became drunk by drinking a juice that is expressed
-from the leaves of a plant which they call _Ava Ava_. This plant was not
-in season when we were there, so that we saw no instances of its
-effects; and as they considered drunkenness as a disgrace, they probably
-would have concealed from us any instances which might have happened
-during our stay. This vice is almost peculiar to the chiefs, and
-considerable persons, who vie with each other in drinking the greatest
-number of draughts, each draught being about a pint. They keep this
-intoxicating juice with great care from their women.
-
-Table they have none; but their apparatus for eating is set out with
-great neatness, though the articles are too simple and too few to allow
-any thing for show; and they commonly eat alone; but when a stranger
-happens to visit them, he sometimes makes a second in their mess. Of the
-meal of one of their principal people I shall give a particular
-description.
-
-He sits down under the shade of the next tree, or on the shady side of
-his house, and a large quantity of leaves, either of the bread-fruit or
-banana, are neatly spread before him upon the ground as a table-cloth; a
-basket is then set by him that contains his provision, which, if fish or
-flesh, is ready dressed, and wrapped up in leaves, and two cocoa-nut
-shells, one full of salt water, and the other of fresh: his attendants,
-which are not few, seat themselves round him, and when all is ready, he
-begins by washing his hands and his mouth thoroughly with the fresh
-water, and this he repeats almost continually throughout the whole meal;
-he then takes part of his provision out of the basket, which generally
-consists of a small fish or two, two or three bread-fruits, fourteen or
-fifteen ripe bananas, or six or seven apples; he first takes half a
-bread-fruit, peels off the rind, and takes out the core with his nails;
-of this he puts as much into his mouth as it can hold, and while he
-chews it, takes the fish out of the leaves, and breaks one of them into
-the salt water, placing the other, and what remains of the bread-fruit,
-upon the leaves that have been spread before him. When this is done, he
-takes up a small piece of the fish that has been broken into the salt
-water, with all the fingers of one hand, and sucks it into his mouth, so
-as to get with it as much of the salt water as possible: in the same
-manner he takes the rest by different morsels, and between each, at
-least very frequently, takes a small sup of the salt water, either out
-of the cocoa-nut shell, or the palm of his hand: in the mean time one of
-his attendants has prepared a young cocoa-nut, by peeling off the outer
-rind with his teeth, an operation which to an European appears very
-surprising; but it depends so much upon slight, that many of us were
-able to do it before we left the island, and some that could scarcely
-crack a filbert: the master, when he chooses to drink, takes the
-cocoa-nut thus prepared, and boring a hole through the shell with his
-finger, or breaking it with a stone, he sucks out the liquor. When he
-has eaten his bread-fruit and fish, he begins with his plantains, one of
-which makes but a mouthful, though it be as big as a black-pudding; if,
-instead of plantains, he has apples, he never tastes them till they have
-been pared; to do this a shell is picked up from the ground, where they
-are always in plenty, and tossed to him by an attendant: he immediately
-begins to cut or scrape off the rind, but so awkwardly that great part
-of the fruit is wasted. If, instead of fish, he has flesh, he must have
-some succedaneum for a knife to divide it; and for this purpose a piece
-of bamboo is tossed to him, of which he makes the necessary implement by
-splitting it transversely with his nail. While all this has been doing,
-some of his attendants have been employed in beating bread-fruit with a
-stone pestle upon a block of wood; by being beaten in this manner, and
-sprinkled from time to time with water, it is reduced to the consistence
-of a soft paste, and is then put into a vessel somewhat like a butcher’s
-tray, and either made up alone, or mixed with banana or mahie, according
-to the taste of the master, by pouring water upon it by degrees and
-squeezing it often through the hand: under this operation it acquires
-the consistence of a thick custard, and a large cocoa-nut shell full of
-it being set before him, he sips it as we should do a jelly if we had no
-spoon to take it from the glass: the meal is then finished by again
-washing his hands and his mouth. After which the cocoa-nut shells are
-cleaned, and every thing that is left is replaced in the basket.
-
-The quantity of food which these people eat at a meal is prodigious: I
-have seen one man devour two or three fishes as big as a perch; three
-bread-fruits, each bigger than two fists; fourteen or fifteen plantains
-or bananas, each of them six or seven inches long, and four or five
-round; and near a quart of the pounded bread-fruit, which is as
-substantial as the thickest unbaked custard. This is so extraordinary
-that I scarcely expect to be believed; and I would not have related it
-upon my own single testimony; but Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and most of
-the other gentlemen, have had ocular demonstration of its truth, and
-know that I mention them upon the occasion.
-
-It is very wonderful that these people, who are remarkably fond of
-society, and particularly that of their women, should exclude its
-pleasures from the table, where among all other nations, whether civil
-or savage, they have been principally enjoyed. How a meal, which every
-where else brings families and friends together, came to separate them
-here, we often enquired, but could never learn. They eat alone, they
-said, because it was right; but why it was right to eat alone they never
-attempted to tell us: such, however, was the force of habit, that they
-expressed the strongest dislike, and even disgust, at our eating in
-society, especially with our women, and of the same victuals. At first,
-we thought this strange singularity arose from some superstitious
-opinion; but they constantly affirmed the contrary. We observed also
-some caprices in the custom, for which we could as little account as for
-the custom itself. We could never prevail with any of the women to
-partake of the victuals at our table when we were dining in company; yet
-they would go, five or six together, into the servants’ apartments, and
-there eat very heartily of whatever they could find, of which I have
-before given a particular instance; nor were they in the least
-disconcerted if we came in while they were doing it. When any of us have
-been alone with a woman, she has sometimes eaten in our company; but
-then she has expressed the greatest unwillingness that it should be
-known, and always extorted the strongest promises of secrecy.
-
-Among themselves, even two brothers and two sisters have each their
-separate baskets, with provision and the apparatus of their meal. When
-they first visited us at our tents, each brought his basket with him;
-and when we sat down to table, they would go out, sit down upon the
-ground, at two or three yards’ distance from each other, and turning
-their faces different ways, take their repast without interchanging a
-single word.
-
-The women not only abstain from eating with the men, and of the same
-victuals, but even have their victuals separately prepared by boys kept
-for that purpose, who deposit it in a separate shed, and attend them
-with it at their meals.
-
-But though they would not eat with us or with each other, they have
-often asked us to eat with them, when we have visited those with whom we
-were particularly acquainted at their houses; and we have often upon
-such occasions eaten out of the same basket, and drunk out of the same
-cup. The elder women, however, always appeared to be offended at this
-liberty; and if we happened to touch their victuals, or even the basket
-that contained it, would throw it away.
-
-After meals, and in the heat of the day, the middle-aged people of the
-better sort generally sleep: they are indeed extremely indolent; and
-sleeping and eating is almost all that they do. Those that are older are
-less drowsy, and the boys and girls are kept awake by the natural
-activity and sprightliness of their age.
-
-Their amusements have occasionally been mentioned in my account of the
-incidents that happened during our residence in this island,
-particularly music, dancing, wrestling, and shooting with the bow; they
-also sometimes vie with each other in throwing a lance. As shooting is
-not at a mark, but for distance; throwing the lance is not for distance,
-but at a mark: the weapon is about nine feet long, the mark is the bole
-of a plantain, and the distance about twenty yards.
-
-Their only musical instruments are flutes and drums; the flutes are made
-of a hollow bamboo about a foot long, and, as has been observed before,
-have only two stops, and consequently but four notes, out of which they
-seem hitherto to have formed but one tune: to these stops they apply the
-fore-finger of the left hand and the middle finger of the right.
-
-The drum is made of a hollow block of wood, of a cylindrical form, solid
-at one end, and covered at the other with shark’s skin: these they beat
-not with sticks, but their hands; and they know how to tune two drums of
-different notes into concord. They have also an expedient to bring the
-flutes that play together into unison, which is to roll up a leaf so as
-to slip over the end of the shortest, like our sliding tubes for
-telescopes, which they move up or down till the purpose is answered, of
-which they seem to judge by their ear with great nicety.
-
-To these instruments they sing; and, as I have observed before, their
-songs are often extempore: they call every two verses or couplet a song,
-_Pehay_: they are generally, though not always, in rhime; and when
-pronounced by the natives, we could discover that they were metre. Mr.
-Banks took great pains to write down some of them which were made upon
-our arrival, as nearly as he could express their sounds by combinations
-of our letters; but when we read them, not having their accent, we could
-scarcely make them either metre or rhime. The reader will easily
-perceive that they are of very different structure.
-
- Tede pahai de parow-a
- Ha maru no mina.
-
- E pahah Tayo malama tai ya
- No Tabane tonatou whannomi ya.
-
- E Turai eattu terara patee whennua toai
- Ino o maio Pretane to whennuaia no Tute.
-
-Of these verses our knowledge of the language is too imperfect to
-attempt a translation. They frequently amuse themselves by singing such
-couplets as these when they are alone, or with their families,
-especially after it is dark; for though they need no fires, they are not
-without the comfort of artificial light between sunset and bedtime.
-Their candles are made of the kernels of a kind of oily nut, which they
-stick one over another upon a skewer that is thrust through the middle
-of them; the upper one being lighted, burns down to the second, at the
-same time consuming that part of the skewer which goes through it; the
-second taking fire burns in the same manner down to the third, and so of
-the rest: some of these candles will burn a considerable time, and they
-give a very tolerable light. They do not often sit up above an hour
-after it is dark; but when they have strangers who sleep in the house,
-they generally keep a light burning all night, possibly as a check upon
-such of the women as they wish not to honour them with their favours.
-
-Of their itinerary concerts I need add nothing to what has been said
-already; especially as I shall have occasion more particularly to
-mention them when I relate our adventures upon another island.
-
-In other countries, the girls and unmarried women are supposed to be
-wholly ignorant of what others upon some occasions may appear to know;
-and their conduct and conversation are consequently restrained within
-narrower bounds, and kept at a more remote distance from whatever
-relates to a connection with the other sex; but here it is just
-contrary. Among other diversions, there is a dance, called _Timorodee_,
-which is performed by young girls, whenever eight or ten of them can be
-collected together, consisting of motions and gestures beyond
-imagination wanton, in the practice of which they are brought up from
-their earliest childhood, accompanied by words, which, if it were
-possible, would more explicitly convey the same ideas. In these dances
-they keep time with an exactness which is scarcely excelled by the best
-performers upon the stages of Europe. But the practice which is allowed
-to the virgin is prohibited to the woman from the moment that she has
-put these hopeful lessons in practice, and realized the symbols of the
-dance.
-
-It cannot be supposed that, among these people, chastity is held in much
-estimation. It might be expected that sisters and daughters would be
-offered to strangers, either as a courtesy, or for reward; and that
-breaches of conjugal fidelity, even in the wife, should not be otherwise
-punished than by a few hard words, or perhaps a slight beating, as
-indeed is the case; but there is a scale in dissolute sensuality, which
-these people have ascended, wholly unknown to every other nation whose
-manners have been recorded from the beginning of the world to the
-present hour, and which no imagination could possibly conceive.
-
-A very considerable number of the principal people of Otaheite, of both
-sexes, have formed themselves into a society, in which every woman is
-common to every man; thus securing a perpetual variety as often as their
-inclination prompts them to seek it, which is so frequent, that the same
-man and woman seldom cohabit together more than two or three days.
-
-These societies are distinguished by the name of _Arreoy_; and the
-members have meetings, at which no other is present, where the men amuse
-themselves by wrestling, and the women, notwithstanding their occasional
-connection with different men, dance the Timorodee in all its latitude,
-as an incitement to desires which it is said are frequently gratified
-upon the spot. This, however, is comparatively nothing. If any of the
-women happen to be with child, which in this manner of life happens less
-frequently than if they were to cohabit only with one man, the poor
-infant is smothered the moment it is born, that it may be no incumbrance
-to the father, nor interrupt the mother in the pleasures of her
-diabolical prostitution. It sometimes indeed happens, that the passion
-which prompts a woman to enter into this society is surmounted when she
-becomes a mother, by that instinctive affection which nature has given
-to all creatures for the preservation of their offspring; but even in
-this case she is not permitted to spare the life of her infant, except
-she can find a man who will patronise it as his child: if this can be
-done, the murder is prevented; but both the man and woman, being deemed
-by this act to have appropriated each other, are ejected from the
-community, and forfeit all claim to the privileges and pleasures of the
-Arreoy for the future; the woman from that time being distinguished by
-the term _Whannownow_, “bearer of children,” which is here a term of
-reproach; though none can be more honourable in the estimation of wisdom
-and humanity, of right reason, and every passion that distinguishes the
-man from the brute.
-
-It is not fit that a practice so horrid and so strange should be imputed
-to human beings upon slight evidence, but I have such as abundantly
-justifies me in the account I have given. The people themselves are so
-far from concealing their connection with such a society as a disgrace,
-that they boast of it as a privilege; and both myself and Mr. Banks,
-when particular persons have been pointed out to us as members of the
-Arreoy, have questioned them about it, and received the account that has
-been here given from their own lips. They have acknowledged that they
-had long been of this accursed society, that they belonged to it at that
-time, and that several of their children had been put to death.
-
-But I must not conclude my account of the domestic life of these people
-without mentioning their personal cleanliness. If that which lessens the
-good of life and increases the evil is vice, surely cleanliness is a
-virtue: the want of it tends to destroy both beauty and health, and
-mingles disgust with our best pleasures. The natives of Otaheite, both
-men and women, constantly wash their whole bodies in running water three
-times every day; once as soon as they rise in the morning, once at noon,
-and again before they sleep at night, whether the sea or river is near
-them or at a distance. I have already observed, that they wash not only
-the mouth but the hands at their meals, almost between every morsel; and
-their clothes, as well as their persons, are kept without spot or stain;
-so that in a large company of these people nothing is suffered but heat,
-which, perhaps, is more than can be said of the politest assembly in
-Europe.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. XVIII.
-
- OF THE MANUFACTURES, BOATS, AND NAVIGATION OF OTAHEITE.
-
-
-IF necessity is the mother of invention, it cannot be supposed to have
-been much exerted where the liberality of Nature has rendered the
-diligence of Art almost superfluous; yet there are many instances both
-of ingenuity and labour among these people, which, considering the want
-of metal for tools, do honour to both.
-
-Their principal manufacture is their cloth, in the making and dying of
-which I think there are some particulars which may instruct even the
-artificers of Great Britain, and for that reason my description will be
-more minute.
-
-Their cloth is of three kinds; and it is made of the bark of three
-different trees, the Chinese paper mulberry, the bread-fruit tree, and
-the tree which resembles the wild fig-tree of the West Indies.
-
-The finest and whitest is made of the paper mulberry, _Aouta_; this is
-worn chiefly by the principal people, and when it is dyed red takes a
-better colour. A second sort, inferior in whiteness and softness, is
-made of the bread-fruit tree, _Ooroo_, and worn chiefly by the inferior
-people; and a third of the tree that resembles the fig, which is coarse
-and harsh, and of the colour of the darkest brown paper; this, though it
-is less pleasing both to the eye and the touch, is the most valuable,
-because it resists water, which the other two sorts will not. Of this,
-which is the most rare as well as the most useful, the greater part is
-perfumed, and worn by the Chiefs as a morning dress.
-
-All these trees are propagated with great care, particularly the
-mulberry, which covers the largest part of the cultivated land, and is
-not fit for use after two or three years growth, when it is about six or
-eight feet high, and somewhat thicker than a man’s thumb; its excellence
-is to be thin, straight, tall, and without branches: the lower leaves,
-therefore, are carefully plucked off, with their germs, as often as
-there is any appearance of their producing a branch.
-
-But though the cloth made of these three trees is different, it is all
-manufactured in the same manner; I shall, therefore, describe the
-process only in the fine sort, that is made of the mulberry. When the
-trees are of a proper size, they are drawn up, and stripped of their
-branches, after which the roots and tops are cut off; the bark of these
-rods being then slit up longitudinally is easily drawn off, and, when a
-proper quantity has been procured, it is carried down to some running
-water, in which it is deposited to soak, and secured from floating away
-by heavy stones: when it is supposed to be sufficiently softened, the
-women servants go down to the brook, and stripping themselves, sit down
-in the water, to separate the inner bark from the green part on the
-outside; to do this they place the under side upon a flat smooth board,
-and with the shell, which our dealers call tyger’s tongue, _tellina
-gargadia_, scrape it very carefully, dipping it continually in the water
-till nothing remains but the fine fibres of the inner coat. Being thus
-prepared in the afternoon, they are spread out upon plantain leaves in
-the evening; and in this part of the work there appears to be some
-difficulty, as the mistress of the family always superintends the doing
-of it: they are placed in lengths of about eleven or twelve yards, one
-by the side of another, till they are about a foot broad, and two or
-three layers are also laid one upon the other: care is taken that the
-cloth shall be in all parts of an equal thickness, so that if the bark
-happens to be thinner in any particular part of one layer than the rest,
-a piece that is somewhat thicker is picked out to be laid over it in the
-next. In this state it remains till the morning, when great part of the
-water which it contained when it was laid out, is either drained off or
-evaporated, and the several fibres adhere together, so as that the whole
-maybe raised from the ground in one piece.
-
-It is then taken away, and laid upon the smooth side of a long piece of
-wood, prepared for the purpose, and beaten by the women servants, with
-instruments about a foot long and three inches thick, made of a hard
-wood which they call _Etoa_. The shape of this instrument is not unlike
-a square razor strop, only that the handle is longer, and each of its
-four sides or faces is marked, lengthways, with small grooves, or
-furrows, of different degrees of fineness; those on one side being of a
-width and depth sufficient to receive a small packthread, and the others
-finer in a regular gradation, so that the last are not more than equal
-to sewing silk.
-
-They beat it first with the coarsest side of this mallet, keeping time
-like our smiths; it spreads very fast under the strokes, chiefly however
-in the breadth, and the grooves in the mallet mark it with the
-appearance of threads; it is successively beaten with the other sides,
-last with the finest, and is then fit for use. Sometimes, however, it is
-made still thinner, by beating it with the finest side of the mallet,
-after it has been several times doubled: it is then called _Hoboo_, and
-is almost as thin as a muslin; it becomes very white by being bleached
-in the air, but is made still whiter and softer by being washed and
-beaten again after it has been worn.
-
-Of this cloth there are several sorts, of different degrees of fineness,
-in proportion as it is more or less beaten without being doubled: the
-other cloth also differs in proportion as it is beaten; but they differ
-from each other in consequence of the different materials of which they
-are made. The bark of the bread-fruit is not taken till the trees are
-considerably longer and thicker than those of the fig, the process
-afterwards is the same.
-
-When cloth is to be washed after it has been worn, it is taken down to
-the brook, and left to soak, being kept fast to the bottom, as at first,
-by a stone; it is then gently wrung or squeezed; and sometimes several
-pieces of it are laid one upon another, and beaten together with the
-coarsest side of the mallet, and they are then equal in thickness to
-broad-cloth, and much more soft and agreeable to the touch, after they
-have been a little while in use, though when they come immediately from
-the mallet, they feel as if they had been starched. This cloth sometimes
-breaks in the beating, but is easily repaired by pasting on a patch with
-a gluten that is prepared from the root of the _Pea_, which is done so
-nicely that it cannot be discovered. The women also employ themselves in
-removing blemishes of every kind, as our ladies do in needle-work or
-knotting; sometimes when their work is intended to be very fine, they
-will paste an entire covering of hoboo over the whole. The principal
-excellencies of this cloth are its coolness and softness; and its
-imperfections, its being pervious to water like paper, and almost as
-easily torn.
-
-The colours with which they dye this cloth are principally red and
-yellow. The red is exceedingly beautiful, and I may venture to say a
-brighter and more delicate colour than any we have in Europe; that which
-approaches nearest is our full scarlet, and the best imitation which Mr.
-Banks’s natural history painter could produce, was by a mixture of
-vermillion and carmine. The yellow is also a bright color, but we have
-many as good.
-
-The red colour is produced by the mixture of the juices of two
-vegetables, neither of which separately has the least tendency to that
-hue. One is a species of fig called here _Matte_, and the other the
-_Cordia Sebestina_, or _Etou_; of the fig the fruit is used, and of the
-_Cordia_ the leaves.
-
-The fruit of the fig is about as big as a rounceval pea, or very small
-gooseberry; and each of them, upon breaking off the stalk very close,
-produces one drop of a milky liquor, resembling the juice of our figs,
-of which the tree is indeed a species. This liquor the women collect
-into a small quantity of cocoa-nut water: to prepare a gill of cocoa-nut
-water will require between three and four quarts of these little figs.
-When a sufficient quantity is prepared, the leaves of the Etou are well
-wetted in it, and then laid upon a plantain leaf, where they are turned
-about till they become more and more flaccid, and then they are gently
-squeezed, gradually increasing the pressure, but so as not to break
-them; as the flaccidity increases, and they become spungy, they are
-supplied with more of the liquor; in about five minutes the colour
-begins to appear upon the veins of the leaves, and in about ten or a
-little more, they are perfectly saturated with it: they are then
-squeezed, with as much force as can be applied, and the liquor strained
-at the same time that it is expressed.
-
-For this purpose, the boys prepare a large quantity of the Moo, by
-drawing it between their teeth, or two little sticks, till it is freed
-from the green bark and the branny substance that lies under it, and a
-thin web of the fibres only remains; in this the leaves of the Etou are
-inveloped, and through these the juice which they contain is strained as
-it is forced out. As the leaves are not succulent, little more juice is
-pressed out of them than they have imbibed: when they have been once
-emptied, they are filled again, and again pressed, till the quality
-which tinctures the liquor as it passes through them is exhausted, they
-are then thrown away; but the Moo, being deeply stained with the colour,
-is preserved, as a brush to lay the dye upon the cloth.
-
-The expressed liquor is always received into small cups made of the
-plantain leaf, whether from a notion that it has any quality favourable
-to the colour, or from the facility with which it is procured, and the
-convenience of small vessels to distribute it among the artificers, I do
-not know.
-
-Of the thin cloth they seldom dye more than the edges, but the thick
-cloth is coloured through the whole surface; the liquor is indeed used
-rather as a pigment than a dye, for a coat of it is laid upon one side
-only, with the fibres of the Moo; and though I have seen of the thin
-cloth that has appeared to have been soaked in the liquor, the colour
-has not had the same richness and lustre, as when it has been applied in
-the other manner.
-
-Though the leaf of the Etou is generally used in this process, and
-probably produces the finest colour, yet the juice of the figs will
-produce a red by a mixture with the species of Tournefortia, which they
-call _Taheinoo_, the _Pohuc_, the _Eurhe_, or _Convolvulus
-Brasiliensis_, and a species of Solanum called _Ebooa_; from the use of
-these different plants, or from different proportions of the materials,
-many varieties are observable in the colours of their cloth, some of
-which are conspicuously superior to others.
-
-The beauty, however, of the best is not permanent; but it is probable
-that some method might be found to fix it, if proper experiments were
-made, and perhaps to search for latent qualities, which may be brought
-out by the mixture of one vegetable juice with another, would not be an
-unprofitable employment: our present most valuable dyes afford
-sufficient encouragement to the attempt; for by the mere inspection of
-indigo, woad, dyer’s weed, and most of the leaves which are used for the
-like purposes, the colours which they yield could never be discovered.
-Of this Indian red I shall only add, that the women who have been
-employed in preparing or using it, carefully preserve the colour upon
-their fingers and nails, where it appears in its utmost beauty, as a
-great ornament.
-
-The yellow is made of the bark of the root of the _Morinda citrifolia_,
-called _Nono_, by scraping and infusing it in water; after standing some
-time, the water is strained and used as a dye, the cloth being dipped
-into it. The Morinda, of which this is a species, seems to be a good
-subject for examination with a view to dyeing. Brown, in his history of
-Jamaica, mentions three species of it, which he says are used to dye
-brown; and Rumphius says of the _Bancuda Angustifolia_, which is nearly
-allied to our Nono, that it is used by the inhabitants of the East
-Indian islands, as a fixing drug for red colours, with which it
-particularly agrees.
-
-The inhabitants of this island also dye yellow with the fruit of the
-Tamanu; but how the colour is extracted, we had no opportunity to
-discover. They have also a preparation with which they dye brown and
-black; but these colours are so indifferent, that the method of
-preparing them did not excite our curiosity.
-
-Another considerable manufacture is matting of various kinds; some of
-which is finer, and better, in every respect, than any we have in
-Europe: the coarser sort serves them to sleep upon, and the finer to
-wear in wet weather. With the fine, of which there are also two sorts,
-much pains is taken, especially with that made of the bark of the
-Poerou, the _Hibiscus tiliaceus_ of Linnæus, some of which is as fine as
-a coarse cloth; the other sort, which is still more beautiful, they call
-_Vanne_; it is white, glossy, and shining, and is made of the leaves of
-their _Wharrou_, a species of the _Pandanus_, of which we had no
-opportunity to see either the flowers or fruit: they have other matts,
-or as they call them _Moeas_, to sit or to sleep upon, which are formed
-of a great variety of rushes and grass, and which they make, as they do
-every thing else that is plaited, with amazing facility and dispatch.
-
-They are also very dexterous in making basket and wicker work; their
-baskets are of a thousand different patterns, many of them exceedingly
-neat; and the making them is an art that every one practises, both men
-and women: they make occasional baskets and panniers of the cocoa-nut
-leaf in a few minutes, and the women who visited us early in a morning
-used to send, as soon as the sun was high, for a few of the leaves, of
-which they made little bonnets to shade their faces, at so small an
-expence of time and trouble, that, when the sun was again low in the
-evening, they used to throw them away. These bonnets, however, did not
-cover the head, but consisted only of a band that went round it, and a
-shade that projected from the forehead.
-
-Of the bark of the Poerou, they make ropes and lines, from the thickness
-of an inch to the size of a small packthread: with these they make nets
-for fishing: of the fibres of the cocoa-nut they make thread, for
-fastening together the several parts of their canoes, and belts, either
-round or flat, twisted or plaited; and of the bark of the _Erowa_, a
-kind of nettle which grows in the mountains, and is therefore rather
-scarce, they make the best fishing lines in the world: with these they
-hold the strongest and most active fish, such as Bonetas and Albicores,
-which would snap our strongest silk lines in a minute, though they are
-twice as thick.
-
-They make also a kind of seine, of a coarse broad grass, the blades of
-which are like flags; these they twist and tie together in a loose
-manner, till the net, which is about as wide as a large sack, is from
-sixty to eighty fathom long: this they haul in shoal smooth water, and
-its own weight keeps it so close to the ground that scarcely a single
-fish can escape.
-
-In every expedient, indeed, for taking fish, they are exceedingly
-ingenious; they make harpoons of cane, and point them with hard wood,
-which in their hands strike fish more effectually, than those which are
-headed with iron can do in ours, setting aside the advantage of ours
-being fastened to a line, so that the fish is secured if the hook takes
-place, though it does not mortally wound him.
-
-Of fish-hooks they have two sorts, admirably adapted in their
-construction as well to the purpose they are to answer, as to the
-materials of which they are made. One of these, which they call _Wittee
-Wittee_, is used for towing. The shank is made of mother-of-pearl, the
-most glossy that can be got: the inside, which is naturally the
-brightest, is put behind. To these hooks a tuft of white dog’s or hog’s
-hair is fixed, so as somewhat to resemble the tail of a fish; these
-implements, therefore, are both hook and bait, and are used with a rod
-of bamboo, and line of _Erowa_. The fisher, to secure his success,
-watches the flight of the birds which constantly attend the Bonetas when
-they swim in shoals, by which he directs his canoe, and when he has the
-advantage of these guides, he seldom returns without a prize.
-
-The other kind of hook is also made of mother-of-pearl, or some other
-hard shell: they cannot make them bearded like our hooks; but to effect
-the same purpose, they make the point turn inwards. These are made of
-all sizes, and used to catch various kinds of fish with great success.
-The manner of making them is very simple, and every fisherman is his own
-artificer: the shell is first cut into square pieces, by the edge of
-another shell, and wrought into a form corresponding with the outline of
-the hook by pieces of coral, which are sufficiently rough to perform the
-office of a file; a hole is then bored in the middle; the drill being no
-other than the first stone they pick up that has a sharp corner: this
-they fix into the end of a piece of bamboo, and turn it between the
-hands like a chocolate-mill; when the shell is perforated, and the hole
-sufficiently wide, a small file of coral is introduced, by the
-application of which the hook is in a short time completed, few costing
-the artificer more time than a quarter of an hour.
-
-Of their masonry, carving, and architecture, the reader has already
-formed some idea from the account that has been given of the Morais, or
-repositories of the dead: the other most important article of building
-and carving is their boats; and perhaps, to fabricate one of their
-principal vessels with their tools is as great a work, as to build a
-British man of war with ours.
-
-They have an adze of stone; a chissel, or gouge of bone, generally that
-of a man’s arm between the wrist and elbow; a rasp of coral; and the
-skin of a sting-ray, with coral sand, as a file or polisher.
-
-This is a complete catalogue of their tools, and with these they build
-houses, construct canoes, hew stone, and fell, cleave, carve, and polish
-timber.
-
-The stone which makes the blade of their adzes is a kind of Basaltes, of
-a blackish or grey colour, not very hard, but of considerable toughness:
-they are formed of different sizes; some, that are intended for felling,
-weigh from six to eight pounds; others, that are used for carving, not
-more than so many ounces; but it is necessary to sharpen both almost
-every minute; for which purpose, a stone and a cocoa-nut shell full of
-water are always at hand.
-
-Their greatest exploit, to which these tools are less equal than to any
-other, is felling a tree: this requires many hands, and the constant
-labour of several days. When it is down, they split it, with the grain,
-into planks from three to four inches thick, the whole length and
-breadth of the tree, many of which are eight feet in the girt, and forty
-to the branches, and nearly of the same thickness throughout. The tree
-generally used is, in their language, called _Avie_, the stem of which
-is tall and straight; though some of the smaller boats are made of the
-bread-fruit tree, which is a light spongy wood, and easily wrought. They
-smooth the plank very expeditiously and dexterously with their adzes,
-and can take off a thin coat from a whole plank without missing a
-stroke. As they have not the art of warping a plank, every part of the
-canoe, whether hollow or flat, is shaped by hand.
-
-The canoes, or boats, which are used by the inhabitants of this and the
-neighbouring islands, may be divided into two general classes; one of
-which they call _Ivahahs_, the other _Pahies_.
-
-The Ivahah is used for short excursions to sea, and is wall-sided and
-flat-bottomed; the Pahie for longer voyages, and is bow-sided and
-sharp-bottomed. The Ivahas are all of the same figure, but of different
-sizes, and used for different purposes: their length is from seventy-two
-feet to ten, but the breadth is by no means in proportion; for those of
-ten feet are about a foot wide, and those of more than seventy are
-scarcely two. There is the fighting Ivahah, the fishing Ivahah, and the
-travelling Ivahah; for some of these go from one island to another. The
-fighting Ivahah is by far the longest, and the head and stern are
-considerably raised above the body, in a semicircular form; particularly
-the stern, which is sometimes seventeen or eighteen feet high, though
-the boat itself is scarcely three. These never go to sea single; but are
-fastened together, side by side, at the distance of about three feet, by
-strong poles of wood, which are laid across them and lashed to the
-gunwales. Upon these, in the forepart, a stage or platform is raised,
-about ten or twelve feet long, and somewhat wider than the boats, which
-is supported by pillars about six feet high: upon this stage stand the
-fighting men, whose missile weapons are slings and spears; for, among
-other singularities in the manners of these people, their bows and
-arrows are used only for diversion, as we throw quoits: below these
-stages sit the rowers, who receive from them those that are wounded, and
-furnish fresh men to ascend in their room. Some of these have a platform
-of bamboos or other light wood, through their whole length, and
-considerably broader, by means of which they will carry a great number
-of men; but we saw only one fitted in this manner.
-
-The fishing Ivahahs vary in length from about forty feet to the smallest
-size, which is about ten; all that are of the length of twenty-five feet
-and upwards, of whatever sort, occasionally carry sail. The travelling
-Ivahah is always double, and furnished with a small neat house, about
-five or six feet broad, and six or seven feet long, which is fastened
-upon the fore-part for the convenience of the principal people, who sit
-in them by day, and sleep in them at night. The fishing Ivahahs are
-sometimes joined together, and have a house on board; but this is not
-common.
-
-Those which are shorter than five and twenty feet, seldom or never carry
-sail; and, though the stern rises about four or five feet, have a flat
-head, and a board that projects forward about four feet.
-
-The Pahie is also of different sizes, from sixty to thirty feet long;
-but, like the Ivahah, is very narrow. One that I measured was fifty-one
-feet long, and only one foot and a half wide at the top. In the widest
-part, it was about three feet; and this is the general proportion. It
-does not, however, widen by a gradual swell; but the sides being
-straight and parallel, for a little way below the gunwale, it swells
-abruptly, and draws to a ridge at the bottom; so that a transverse
-section of it has somewhat the appearance of the mark upon cards called
-a Spade, the whole being much wider in proportion to its length. These,
-like the largest Ivahahs, are used for fighting; but principally for
-long voyages. The fighting Pahie, which is the largest, is fitted with
-the stage or platform, which is proportionably larger than those of the
-Ivahah, as their form enables them to sustain a much greater weight.
-Those that are used for sailing are generally double; and the middle
-size are said to be the best sea-boats. They are sometimes out a month
-together, going from island to island; and sometimes, as we were
-credibly informed, they are a fortnight or twenty days at sea, and could
-keep it longer if they had more stowage for provisions, and
-conveniencies to hold fresh water.
-
-When any of these boats carry sail single, they make use of a log of
-wood, which is fastened to the end of two poles that lie cross the
-vessel, and project from six to ten feet, according to the size of the
-vessel, beyond its side, somewhat like what is used by the flying Proa
-of the Ladrone Islands, and called in the account of Lord Anson’s
-Voyage, an Outrigger. To this outrigger the shrouds are fastened, and it
-is essentially necessary in trimming the boat when it blows fresh.
-
-Some of them have one mast, and some two; they are made of a single
-stick, and when the length of the canoe is thirty feet, that of the mast
-is somewhat less than five-and-twenty; it is fixed to a frame that is
-above the canoe, and receives a sail of matting about one-third longer
-than itself: the sail is pointed at the top, square at the bottom, and
-curved at the side; somewhat resembling what we call a shoulder of
-mutton sail, and used for boats belonging to men of war: it is placed in
-a frame of wood, which surrounds it on every side, and has no
-contrivance either for reefing or furling; so that, if either should
-become necessary, it must be cut away, which, however, in these equal
-climates, can seldom happen. At the top of the mast are fastened
-ornaments of feathers, which are placed inclining obliquely forwards;
-the shape and position of which will be conceived at once from the
-figure, in one of the cuts.
-
-The oars or paddles that are used with these boats, have a long handle
-and a flat blade, not unlike a baker’s peel. Of these every person in
-the boat has one, except those that sit under the awning; and they push
-her forward with them at a good rate. These boats, however, admit so
-much water at the seams, that one person at least is continually
-employed in throwing it out. The only thing in which they excel is
-landing, and putting off from the shore in a surf: by their great length
-and high sterns they land dry, when our boats could scarcely land at
-all; and have the same advantages in putting off by the height of the
-head.
-
-The Ivahahs are the only boats that are used by the inhabitants of
-Otaheite; but we saw several Pahies that came from other islands. Of one
-of these I shall give the exact dimensions from a careful admeasurement,
-and then particularly describe the manner in which they are built.
-
- Feet. Inches.
-
- Extreme length from stem to stern, not reckoning the 51 0
- bending up of either
-
- Breadth in the clear of the top forward 1 2
-
- Breadth in the midships 1 6
-
- Breadth aft 1 3
-
- In the bilge forward 2 8
-
- In the midships 2 11
-
- Aft 2 9
-
- Depth in the midships 3 4
-
- Height from the ground on which she stood 3 6
-
- Height of her head from the ground, without the figure 4 4
-
- Height of the figure 0 11
-
- Height of the stern from the ground 8 9
-
- Height of the figure 2 0
-
-[Illustration: Drawing of Vessel]
-
-To illustrate my description of the manner in which these vessels are
-built, it will be necessary to refer to the figure; in which _a a_ is
-the first seam, _b b_ the second, and _c c_ the third.
-
-The first stage or keel, under _a a_, is made of a tree hollowed out
-like a trough; for which the longest trees are chosen that can be got,
-so that there are never more than three in the whole length: the next
-stage, under _b b_, is formed of straight plank, about four feet long,
-fifteen inches broad, and two inches thick: the third stage, under _c
-c_, is, like the bottom, made of trunks, hollowed into its bilging form;
-the last is also cut out of trunks, so that the moulding is of one piece
-with the upright. To form these parts separately, without saw, plane,
-chissel, or any other iron tool, may well be thought no easy task; but
-the great difficulty is to join them together.
-
-When all the parts are prepared, the keel is laid upon blocks, and the
-planks being supported by stanchions, are sewed or clamped together with
-strong thongs of plaiting, which are passed several times through holes
-that are bored with a gouge or auger of bone, that has been described
-already; and the nicety with which this is done, may be inferred from
-their being sufficiently water-tight for use without caulking. As the
-platting soon rots in the water, it is renewed at least once a-year; in
-order to which, the vessel is taken entirely to pieces. The head and
-stern are rude with respect to the design; but very neatly finished, and
-polished to the highest degree.
-
-These Pahies are kept with great care in a kind of house built on
-purpose for their reception; the houses are formed of poles set upright
-in the ground, the tops of which are drawn towards each other, and
-fastened together with their strongest cord, so as to form a kind of
-Gothic arch, which is completely thatched quite to the ground, being
-open only at the ends; they are sometimes fifty or sixty paces long.
-
-As connected with the navigation of these people, I shall mention their
-wonderful sagacity in foretelling the weather, at least the quarter from
-which the wind shall blow at a future time; they have several ways of
-doing this, of which however I know but one. They say, that the
-Milky-way is always curved laterally; but sometimes in one direction,
-and sometimes in another: and that this curvature is the effect of its
-being already acted upon by the wind, and its hollow part therefore
-towards it; so that, if the same curvature continues a night, a
-corresponding wind certainly blows the next day. Of their rules, I shall
-not pretend to judge; but I know that, by whatever means, they can
-predict the weather, at least the wind, with much greater certainty than
-we can.
-
-In their longer voyages, they steer by the sun in the day, and in the
-night by the stars; all of which they distinguish separately by names,
-and know in what part of the heavens they will appear in any of the
-months during which they are visible in their horizon; they also know
-the time of their annual appearing and disappearing with more precision
-than will easily be believed by an European astronomer.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. XIX.
-
- OF THE DIVISION OF TIME IN OTAHEITE; NUMERATION, COMPUTATION OF
- DISTANCE, LANGUAGE, DISEASES, DISPOSAL OF THE DEAD, RELIGION, WAR,
- WEAPONS, AND GOVERNMENT; WITH SOME GENERAL OBSERVATIONS FOR THE USE OF
- FUTURE NAVIGATORS.
-
-
-WE were not able to acquire a perfect idea of their method of dividing
-time; but observed, that in speaking of it, either past or to come, they
-never used any term but _Malama_, which signifies Moon. Of these moons
-they count thirteen, and then begin again; which is a demonstration that
-they have a notion of the solar year: but how they compute their months
-so that thirteen of them shall be commensurate with the year, we could
-not discover; for they say that each month has twenty-nine days,
-including one in which the moon is not visible. They have names for them
-separately, and have frequently told us the fruits that would be in
-season, and the weather that would prevail, in each of them; and they
-have indeed a name for them collectively, though they use it only when
-they speak of the mysteries of their religion.
-
-Every day is subdivided into twelve parts, each of two hours, of which
-six belong to the day, and six to the night. At these divisions they
-guess pretty nearly by the height of the sun while he is above the
-horizon; but there are few of them that can guess at them, when he is
-below it, by the stars.
-
-In numeration they proceed from one to ten, the number of fingers on
-both hands; and though they have for each number a different name, they
-generally take hold of their fingers one by one, shifting from one hand
-to the other till they come to the number they want to express. And in
-other instances, we observed that, when they were conversing with each
-other, they joined signs to their words, which were so expressive that a
-stranger might easily apprehend their meaning.
-
-In counting from ten they repeat the name of that number, and add the
-word _more_; ten, and one more, is eleven; ten, and two more, twelve:
-and so of the rest, as we say one and twenty, two and twenty. When they
-come to ten and ten more, they have a new denomination, as we say a
-score; and by these scores they count till they get ten of them, when
-they have a denomination for two hundred; and we never could discover
-that they had any denomination to express a greater number: neither,
-indeed, do they seem to want any; for ten of these amount to two
-thousand, a greater number than they can ever apply.
-
-In measuring distance they are much more deficient than in computing
-numbers, having but one term, which answers to fathom; when they speak
-of distances from place to place, they express it, like the Asiatics, by
-the time that is required to pass it.
-
-Their language is soft and melodious; it abounds with vowels, and we
-easily learnt to pronounce it: but found it exceedingly difficult to
-teach them to pronounce a single word of ours; probably not only from
-its abounding in consonants, but from some peculiarity in its structure;
-for Spanish and Italian words, if ending in a vowel, they pronounced
-with great facility.
-
-Whether it is copious, we were not sufficiently acquainted with it to
-know; but it is certainly very imperfect, for it is almost totally
-without inflexion, both of nouns and verbs. Few of the nouns have more
-than one case, and few of the verbs more than one tense; yet we found no
-great difficulty in making ourselves mutually understood, however
-strange it may appear in speculation.
-
-They have, however, certain _affixa_, which, though but few in number,
-are very useful to them, and puzzled us extremely. One asks another,
-_Harre hea?_ “Where are you going?” The other answers, _Ivahinera_, “To
-my wives;” upon which the first, repeating the answer interrogatively,
-“To your wives?” is answered, _Ivahinereira_; “Yes, I am going to my
-wives.” Here the suffixa _era_ and _eira_ save several words to both
-parties.
-
-I have inserted a few of their words, from which, perhaps, some idea may
-be formed of the language.
-
- Pupo, _the head_.
- Ahewh, _the nose_.
- Roourou, _the hair_.
- Outou, _the mouth_.
- Niheo, _the teeth_.
- Arrero, _the tongue_.
- Meu-eumi, _the beard_.
- Tiarraboa, _the throat_.
- Tuamo, _the shoulders_.
- Tuah, _the back_.
- Oama, _the breast_.
- Eu, _the nipples_.
- Oboo, _the belly_.
- Rema, _the arm_.
- Vaee, _wild plantains_.
- Oporema, _the hand_.
- Manneow, _the fingers_.
- Mieu, _the nails_.
- Touhe, _the buttocks_.
- Hoouhah, _the thighs_.
- Avia, _the legs_.
- Tapoa, _the feet_.
- Booa, _a hog_.
- Moa, _a fowl_.
- Euree, _a dog_.
- Eure-eure, _iron_.
- Ooroo, _bread-fruit_.
- Hearee, _cocoa-nuts_.
- Mia, _bananas_.
- Poe, _beads_.
- Poe matawewwe, _pearl_.
- Ahou, _a garment_.
- Avee, _a fruit like apples_.
- Ahee, _another like chesnuts_.
- Ewharre, _a house_.
- Whennua, _a high island_.
- Motu, _a low island_.
- Toto, _blood_.
- Aeve, _bone_.
- Aeo, _flesh_.
- Mae, _fat_.
- Tuea, _lean_.
- Huru-huru, _hair_.
- Eraow, _a tree_.
- Ama, _a branch_.
- Tiale, _a flower_.
- Huero _fruit_.
- Etummoo, _the stem_.
- Aaa, _the root_.
- Eiherre, _herbaceous plants_.
- Ooopa, _a pigeon_.
- Avigne, _a paroquet_.
- A-a, _another species_.
- Mannu, _a bird_.
- Mora _a duck_.
- Mattow, _a fish-hook_.
- Toura, _a rope_.
- Mow, _a shark_.
- Mahi-mahi, _a dolphin_.
- Mattera, _a fishing-rod_.
- Eupea, _a net_.
- Mahanna, _the sun_.
- Malama, _the moon_.
- Whettu, _a star_.
- Whettu-euphe, _a comet_.
- Erai, _the sky_.
- Eatta, _a cloud_.
- Miti, _good_.
- Eno, _bad_.
- A, _yes_.
- Ima, _no_.
- Paree, _ugly_.
- Paroree, _hungry_.
- Pia, _full_.
- Timahah, _heavy_.
- Mama, _light_.
- Poto, _short_.
- Roa, _tall_.
- Nehenne, _sweet_.
- Mala-mala, _bitter_.
- Whanno, _to go far_.
- Harre, _to go_.
- Arrea, _to stay_.
- Enoho, _to remain_.
- Rohe rohe, _to be tired_.
- Maa, _to eat_.
- Inoo, _to drink_.
- Ete, _to understand_.
- Warrido, _to steal_.
- Worridde, _to be angry_.
- Teparahi, _to beat_.
-
-Among people whose food is so simple, and who in general are seldom
-drunk, it is scarcely necessary to say, that there are but few diseases;
-we saw no critical disease during our stay upon the island, and but few
-instances of sickness, which were accidental fits of the colic. The
-natives, however, are afflicted with the erysipelas, and cutaneous
-eruptions of the scaly kind, very nearly approaching to a leprosy. Those
-in whom this distemper was far advanced, lived in a state of seclusion
-from all society, each in a small house built upon some unfrequented
-spot, where they were supplied with provisions: but whether they had any
-hope of relief, or languished out the remainder of their lives in
-solitude and despair, we could not learn. We observed also a few who had
-ulcers upon different parts of their bodies, some of which had a very
-virulent appearance; yet they seemed not much to be regarded by those
-who were afflicted with them, for they were left entirely without
-application even to keep off the flies.
-
-Where intemperance produces no diseases, there will be no physicians by
-profession; yet where there is sufferance, there will always be attempts
-to relieve; and where the cause of the mischief and the remedy are alike
-unknown, these will naturally be directed by superstition: thus it
-happens, that in this country, and in all others which are not further
-injured by luxury, or improved by knowledge, the management of the sick
-falls to the lot of the priest. The method of cure that is practised by
-the priests of Otaheite, consists chiefly of prayers and ceremonies.
-When he visits his patient he repeats certain sentences, which appear to
-be set forms contrived for the occasion, and at the same time plats the
-leaves of the cocoa-nut into different figures very neatly; some of
-these he fastens to the fingers and toes of the sick, and often leaves
-behind him a few branches of the _thespecia populnea_, which they call
-_E’midho_: these ceremonies are repeated till the patient recovers or
-dies. If he recovers, they say the remedies cured him; if he dies, they
-say the disease was incurable; in which perhaps they do not much differ
-from the custom of other countries.
-
-If we had judged of their skill in surgery from the dreadful scars which
-we sometimes saw, we should have supposed it to be much superior to the
-art, not only of their physicians, but of ours. We saw one man whose
-face was almost entirely destroyed, his nose, including the bone, was
-perfectly flat, and one cheek and one eye were so beaten in, that the
-hollow would almost receive a man’s fist, yet no ulcer remained; and our
-companion, Tupia, had been pierced quite through his body by a spear,
-headed with the bone of the sting-ray, the weapon having entered his
-back, and come out just under his breast; but except in reducing
-dislocations and fractures, the best surgeon can contribute very little
-to the cure of a wound; the blood itself is the best vulnerary balsam,
-and when the juices of the body are pure, and the patient is temperate,
-nothing more is necessary as an aid to nature in the cure of the worst
-wound, than the keeping it clean.
-
-Their commerce with the inhabitants of Europe has, however, already
-entailed upon them that dreadful curse which avenged the inhumanities
-committed by the Spaniards in America, the venereal disease. As it is
-certain that no European vessel besides our own, except the Dolphin, and
-the two that were under the command of Mons. Bougainville, ever visited
-this island, it must have been brought either by one of them or by us.
-That it was not brought by the Dolphin, Captain Wallis has demonstrated
-in the account of her voyage, (Vol. I. p. 323, 324.), and nothing is
-more certain than that when we arrived, it had made most dreadful
-ravages in the island. One of our people contracted it within five days
-after we went on shore, and by the enquiries among the natives, which
-this occasioned, we learnt, when we came to understand a little of their
-language, that it had been brought by the vessels which had been there
-about fifteen months before us, and had lain on the east side of the
-island. They distinguished it by a name of the same import with
-_rottenness_, but of a more extensive signification, and described, in
-the most pathetic terms, the sufferings of the first victims to its
-rage, and told us that it caused the hair and the nails to fall off, and
-the flesh to rot from the bones: that it spread a universal terror and
-consternation among them, so that the sick were abandoned by their
-nearest relations, lest the calamity should spread by contagion, and
-left to perish alone in such misery as till then had never been known
-among them. We had some reason, however, to hope that they had found out
-a specific to cure it: during our stay upon the island we saw none in
-whom it had made a great progress, and one who went from us infected,
-returned after a short time in perfect health; and by this it appeared
-either that the disease had cured itself, or that they were not
-unacquainted with the virtues of simples, nor implicit dupes to the
-superstitious follies of their priests. We endeavoured to learn the
-medical qualities which they imputed to their plants, but our knowledge
-of their language was too imperfect for us to succeed. If we could have
-learnt their specific for the venereal disease, if such they have, it
-would have been of great advantage to us, for when we left the island it
-had been contracted by more than half the people on board the ship.
-
-It is impossible but that, in relating incidents, many particulars with
-respect to the customs, opinions, and works of these people should be
-anticipated; to avoid repetition, therefore, I shall only supply
-deficiencies. Of the manner of disposing of their dead, much has been
-said already. I must more explicitly observe, that there are two places
-in which the dead are deposited; one a kind of shed, where the flesh is
-suffered to putrify; the other an enclosure, with erections of stone,
-where the bones are afterwards buried. The sheds are called TUPAPOW, and
-the enclosures MORAI. The Morais are also places of worship.
-
-As soon as a native of Otaheite is known to be dead, the house is filled
-with relations, who deplore their loss, some by loud lamentations, and
-some by less clamorous, but more genuine expressions of grief. Those who
-are in the nearest degree of kindred, and are really affected by the
-event, are silent; the rest are one moment uttering passionate
-exclamations in a chorus, and the next laughing and talking without the
-least appearance of concern. In this manner the remainder of the day on
-which they assemble is spent, and all the succeeding night. On the next
-morning the body is shrouded in their cloth, and conveyed to the
-sea-side upon a bier, which the bearers support upon their shoulders,
-attended by the priest, who, having prayed over the body, repeats his
-sentences during the procession. When it arrives at the water’s edge, it
-is set down upon the beach; the priest renews his prayers, and taking up
-some of the water in his hands, sprinkles it towards the body, but not
-upon it. It is then carried back forty or fifty yards, and soon after
-brought again to the beach, where the prayers and sprinkling are
-repeated: it is thus removed backwards and forwards several times, and
-while these ceremonies have been performing a house has been built, and
-a small space of ground railed in. In the centre of this house, or
-Tupapow, posts are set up to support the bier, which is at length
-conveyed thither, and placed upon it, and here the body remains to
-putrify till the flesh is wholly wasted from the bones.
-
-These houses of corruption are of a size proportioned to the rank of the
-person whose body they are to contain; those allotted to the lower class
-are just sufficient to cover the bier, and have no railing round them.
-The largest we ever saw was eleven yards long, and such as these are
-ornamented according to the abilities and inclination of the surviving
-kindred, who never fail to lay a profusion of good cloth about the body,
-and sometimes almost cover the outside of the house. Garlands of the
-fruit of the palm-nut or _pandanus_, and cocoa-leaves, twisted by the
-priests in mysterious knots, with a plant called by them, _Ethee no
-Morai_, which is particularly consecrated to funeral solemnities, are
-deposited about the place; provision and water are also left at a little
-distance, of which, and of other decorations, a more particular
-description has been given already.
-
-As soon as the body is deposited in the Tupapow, the mourning is
-renewed. The women assemble, and are led to the door by the nearest
-relation, who strikes a shark’s tooth several times into the crown of
-her head: the blood copiously follows, and is carefully received upon
-pieces of linen, which are thrown under the bier. The rest of the women
-follow this example, and the ceremony is repeated at the interval of two
-or three days, as long as the zeal and sorrow of the parties hold out.
-The tears also which are shed upon these occasions, are received upon
-pieces of cloth, and offered as oblations to the dead: some of the
-younger people cut off their hair, and that is thrown under the bier
-with the other offerings. This custom is founded upon a notion that the
-soul of the deceased, which they believe to exist in a separate state,
-is hovering about the place where the body is deposited: that it
-observes the actions of the survivors, and is gratified by such
-testimonies of their affection and grief.
-
-Two or three days after these ceremonies have been commenced by the
-women, during which the men seem to be wholly insensible of their loss,
-they also begin to perform their part. The nearest relations take it in
-turn to assume the dress, and perform the office, which have already
-been particularly described in the account of Tubourai Tamaide’s having
-acted as chief mourner to an old woman, his relation, who died while we
-were in the island. One part of the ceremony, however, which accounts
-for the running away of the people as soon as this procession is in
-sight, has not been mentioned. The chief mourner carries in his hand a
-long flat stick, the edge of which is set with shark’s teeth, and in a
-phrenzy, which his grief is supposed to have inspired, he runs at all he
-sees, and if any of them happen to be overtaken, he strikes them most
-unmercifully with this indented cudgel, which cannot fail to wound them
-in a dangerous manner.
-
-These processions continue at certain intervals for five moons, but are
-less and less frequent, by a gradual diminution, as the end of that time
-approaches. When it is expired, what remains of the body is taken down
-from the bier, and the bones having been scraped and washed very clean,
-are buried, according to the rank of the person, either within or
-without a Morai. If the deceased was an Earee, or chief, his skull is
-not buried with the rest of the bones, but is wrapped up in fine cloth,
-and put in a kind of box made for that purpose, which is also placed in
-the Morai. This coffer is called _Ewharre no te Orometua_, the house of
-a teacher or master. After this the mourning ceases, except some of the
-women continue to be really afflicted for the loss, and in that case
-they will sometimes suddenly wound themselves with the shark’s tooth
-wherever they happen to be: this perhaps will account for the passion of
-grief in which Terapo wounded herself at the fort; some accidental
-circumstance might forcibly revive the remembrance of a friend or
-relation whom she had lost, with a pungency of regret and tenderness
-which forced a vent by tears, and prompted her to a repetition of the
-funeral rite.
-
-The ceremonies, however, do not cease with the mourning: prayers are
-still said by the priest, who is well paid by the surviving relations,
-and offerings made at the Morai. Some of the things, which from time to
-time are deposited there, are emblematical: a young plantain represents
-the deceased, and the bunch of feathers the deity who is invoked. The
-priest places himself over against the symbol of the god, accompanied by
-some of the relations, who are furnished with a small offering, and
-repeats his oraison in a set form, consisting of separate sentences; at
-the same time weaving the leaves of the cocoa-nut into different forms,
-which he afterwards deposits upon the ground where the bones have been
-interred; the deity is then addressed by a shrill screech, which is used
-only upon that occasion. When the priest retires, the tuft of feathers
-is removed, and the provisions left to putrify, or be devoured by the
-rats.
-
-Of the religion of these people, we were not able to acquire any clear
-and consistent knowledge: we found it like the religion of most other
-countries, involved in mystery, and perplexed with apparent
-inconsistencies. The religious language is also here, as it is in China,
-different from that which is used in common, so that Tupia, who took
-great pains to instruct us, having no words to express his meaning which
-we understood, gave us lectures to very little purpose: what we learnt,
-however, I will relate with as much perspicuity as I can.
-
-Nothing is more obvious to a rational being, however ignorant or stupid,
-than that the universe and its various parts, as far as they fall under
-his notice, were produced by some agent inconceivably more powerful than
-himself; and nothing is more difficult to be conceived, even by the most
-sagacious and knowing, than the production of them from nothing, which
-among us is expressed by the word _Creation_. It is natural, therefore,
-as no Being apparently capable of producing the universe is to be seen,
-that he should be supposed to reside in some distant part of it, or to
-be in his nature invisible, and that he should have originally produced
-all that now exists in a manner similar to that in which nature is
-renovated by the succession of one generation to another; but the idea
-of procreation includes in it that of two persons, and from the
-conjunction of two persons these people imagine every thing in the
-universe, either originally or derivatively, to proceed.
-
-The Supreme Deity, one of these two first beings, they call
-TAROATAIHETOOMOO, and the other, whom they suppose to have been a rock,
-TEPAPA. A daughter of these was TETTOWMATATAYO, the year, or thirteen
-months collectively, which they never name but upon this occasion, and
-she, by the common father, produced the months, and the months, by
-conjunction with each other, the days; the stars they suppose partly to
-be the immediate offspring of the first pair, and partly to have
-increased among themselves; and they have the same notion with respect
-to the different species of plants. Among other progeny of
-Taroataihetoomoo and Tepapa, they suppose an inferior race of deities,
-whom they call EATUAS. Two of these Eatuas, they say, at some remote
-period of time, inhabited the earth, and were the parents of the first
-man. When this man, their common ancestor, was born, they say that he
-was round like a ball, but that his mother, with great care, drew out
-his limbs, and having at length moulded him into his present form, she
-called him EOTHE, which signifies _finished_. That being prompted by the
-universal instinct to propagate his kind, and being able to find no
-female but his mother, he begot upon her a daughter, and upon the
-daughter other daughters for several generations, before there was a
-son; a son, however, being at length born, he, by the assistance of his
-sisters, peopled the world.
-
-Besides their daughter Tettowmatatayo, the first progenitors of nature
-had a son, whom they called TANE. Taroataihetoomoo, the supreme deity,
-they emphatically style the causer of earthquakes; but their prayers are
-more generally addressed to Tane, whom they suppose to take a greater
-part in the affairs of mankind.
-
-Their subordinate deities, or Eatuas, which are numerous, are of both
-sexes: the male are worshipped by the men, and the female by the women;
-and each have Morais to which the other sex is not admitted, though they
-have also Morais common to both. Men perform the office of priest to
-both sexes, but each sex has its priests, for those who officiate for
-one sex, do not officiate for the other.
-
-They believe the immortality of the soul, at least its existence in a
-separate state, and that there are two situations of different degrees
-of happiness, somewhat analogous to our heaven and hell: the superior
-situation they call _Tavirua l’erai_, the other _Tiahoboo_. They do not,
-however, consider them as places of reward and punishment, but as
-receptacles for different classes; the first, for their chiefs and
-principal people, the other for those of inferior rank, for they do not
-suppose that their actions here in the least influence their future
-state, or indeed that they come under the cognizance of their deities at
-all. Their religion, therefore, if it has no influence upon their
-morals, is at least disinterested; and their expressions of adoration
-and reverence, whether by words or actions, arise only from a humble
-sense of their own inferiority, and the ineffable excellence of divine
-perfection.
-
-The character of the priest or Tahowa, is hereditary: the class is
-numerous, and consists of all ranks of people; the chief, however, is
-generally the younger brother of a good family, and is respected in a
-degree next to their kings. Of the little knowledge that is possessed in
-this country, the priests have the greatest share; but it consists
-principally in an acquaintance with the names and ranks of the different
-Eatuas or subordinate divinities, and the opinions concerning the origin
-of things, which have been traditionally preserved among the order in
-detached sentences, of which some will repeat an incredible number,
-though but very few of the words that are used in their common dialect
-occur in them.
-
-The priests, however, are superior to the rest of the people in the
-knowledge of navigation and astronomy; and, indeed, the name Tahowa
-signifies nothing more than a man of knowledge. As there are priests of
-every class, they officiate only among that class to which they belong:
-the priest of the inferior class is never called upon by those of
-superior rank, nor will the priest of the superior rank officiate for
-any of the inferior class.
-
-Marriage in this island, as appeared to us, is nothing more than an
-agreement between the man and woman, with which the priest has no
-concern. Where it is contracted, it appears to be pretty well kept,
-though sometimes the parties separate by mutual consent, and in that
-case a divorce takes place with as little trouble as the marriage.
-
-But though the priesthood has laid the people under no tax for a nuptial
-benediction, there are two operations which it has appropriated, and
-from which it derives considerable advantages. One is _tattowing_, and
-the other circumcision, though neither of them have any connection with
-religion. The tattowing has been described already. Circumcision has
-been adopted merely from motives of cleanliness; it cannot indeed
-properly be called circumcision, because the _prepuce_ is not mutilated
-by a circular wound, but only slit through the upper part to prevent its
-contracting over the _glans_. As neither of these can be performed by
-any but a priest, and as to be without either is the greatest disgrace,
-they may be considered as a claim to surplice fees like our marriages
-and christenings, which are cheerfully and liberally paid, not according
-to any settled stipend, but the rank and abilities of the parties or
-their friends.
-
-The Morai, as has already been observed, is at once a burying-ground and
-a place of worship, and in this particular our churches too much
-resemble it. The Indian, however, approaches his Morai with a reverence
-and humility that disgraces the Christian, not because he holds any
-thing sacred that is there, but because he there worships an invisible
-divinity, for whom, though he neither hopes for reward, nor fears
-punishment at his hand, he always expresses the profoundest homage and
-most humble adoration. I have already given a very particular
-description both of the Morais and the altars that are placed near them.
-When an Indian is about to worship at the Morai, or brings his offering
-to the altar, he always uncovers his body to the waist, and his looks
-and attitude are such as sufficiently express a corresponding
-disposition of mind.
-
-It did not appear to us that these people are, in any instance, guilty
-of idolatry; at least they do not worship any thing that is the work of
-their hands, nor any visible part of the creation. This island, indeed,
-and the rest that lie near it, have a particular bird, some a heron, and
-others a king’s-fisher, to which they pay a peculiar regard, and
-concerning which they have some superstitious notions with respect to
-good and bad fortune, as we have of the swallow and robin-red-breast,
-giving them the name of EATUA, and by no means killing or molesting
-them; yet they never address a petition to them, or approach them with
-any act of adoration.
-
-Though I dare not assert that these people, to whom the art of writing,
-and consequently the recording of laws, are utterly unknown, live under
-a regular form of government; yet a subordination is established among
-them, that greatly resembles the early state of every nation in Europe
-under the feudal system, which secured liberty in the most licentious
-excess to a few, and entailed the most abject slavery upon the rest.
-
-Their orders are, _Earee rahie_, which answers to king; _Earee_, baron;
-_Manahouni_, vassal; and _Toutou_, villain. The Earee rahie, of which
-there are two in this island, one being the sovereign of each of the
-peninsulas of which it consists, is treated with great respect by all
-ranks, but did not appear to us to be invested with so much power as was
-exercised by the Earees in their own districts; nor, indeed, did we, as
-I have before observed, once see the sovereign of Obereonoo while we
-were in the island. The Earees are lords of one or more of the districts
-into which each of the peninsulas is divided, of which there may be
-about one hundred in the whole island; and they parcel out their
-territories to the Manahounies, who cultivate each his part which he
-holds under the baron. The lowest class, called Toutous, seem to be
-nearly under the same circumstances as the villains in feudal
-governments: these do all the laborious work; they cultivate the land
-under the Manahounies, who are only nominal cultivators for the lord,
-they fetch wood and water, and, under the direction of the mistress of
-the family, dress the victuals: they also catch the fish.
-
-Each of the Earees keeps a kind of court, and has a great number of
-attendants, chiefly the younger brothers of their own tribe; and among
-these some hold particular offices, but of what nature exactly we could
-not tell. One was called the _Eowa no l’Earee_, and another the _Whanno
-no l’Earee_, and these were frequently dispatched to us with messages.
-Of all the courts of these Earees, that of Tootahah was the most
-splendid, as indeed might reasonably be expected, because he
-administered the government for Outou, his nephew, who was Earee rahie
-of Obereonoo, and lived upon his estate. The child of the baron or
-Earee, as well as of the sovereign or Earee rahie, succeeds to the title
-and honours of the father as soon as it is born: so that a baron, who
-was yesterday called Earee, and was approached with the ceremony of
-lowering the garments, so as to uncover the upper part of the body, is
-to-day, if his wife was last night delivered of a child, reduced to the
-rank of a private man, all marks of respect being transferred to the
-child, if it is suffered to live, though the father still continues
-possessor and administrator of his estate: probably this custom has its
-share, among other inducements, in forming the societies called Arreoy.
-
-If a general attack happens to be made upon the island, every district
-under the command of an Earee, is obliged to furnish its proportion of
-soldiers for the common defence. The number furnished by the principal
-districts, which Tupia recollected, when added together, amounted, as I
-have observed before, to six thousand six hundred and eighty.
-
-Upon such occasions, the united force of the whole island is commanded
-in chief by the Earee rahie. Private differences between two Earees are
-decided by their own people, without at all disturbing the general
-tranquillity.
-
-Their weapons are slings, which they use with great dexterity, pikes
-headed with the stings of sting-rays, and clubs, of about six or seven
-feet long, made of a very hard heavy wood. Thus armed, they are said to
-fight with great obstinacy, which is the more likely to be true, as it
-is certain that they give no quarter to either man, woman, or child, who
-is so unfortunate as to fall into their hands during the battle, or for
-some hours afterwards, till their passion, which is always violent,
-though not lasting, has subsided.
-
-The Earee rahie of Obereonoo, while we were here, was in perfect amity
-with the Earee rahie of Tiarreboo, the other peninsula, though he took
-himself the title of king of the whole island: this, however, produced
-no more jealousy in the other sovereign, than the title of king of
-France, assumed by our sovereign, does in his most Christian Majesty.
-
-In a government so rude, it cannot be expected that distributive justice
-should be regularly administered, and indeed, where there is so little
-opposition of interest, in consequence of the facility with which every
-appetite and passion is gratified, there can be but few crimes. There is
-nothing like money, the common medium by which every want and every wish
-is supposed to be gratified by those who do not possess it; there is no
-apparently permanent good which either fraud or force can unlawfully
-obtain; and when all the crimes that are committed by the inhabitants of
-civilized countries, to get money, are set out of the account, not many
-will remain: add to this, that where the commerce with women is
-restrained by no law, men will seldom be under any temptation to commit
-adultery, especially as one woman is always less preferred to another,
-where they are less distinguished by personal decorations, and the
-adventitious circumstances which are produced by the varieties of art,
-and the refinements of sentiment. That they are thieves is true; but as
-among these people no man can be much injured or benefited by theft, it
-is not necessary to restrain it by such punishments, as in other
-countries are absolutely necessary to the very existence of civil
-society. Tupia, however, tells us, that adultery is sometimes committed
-as well as theft. In all cases where an injury has been committed, the
-punishment of the offender lies with the sufferer: adultery, if the
-parties are caught in the fact, is sometimes punished with death in the
-first ardour of resentment; but without circumstances of immediate
-provocation, the female sinner seldom suffers more than a beating. As
-punishment, however, is enforced by no law, nor taken into the hand of
-any magistrate, it is not often inflicted, except the injured party is
-the strongest; though the chiefs do sometimes punish their immediate
-dependents, for faults committed against each other, and even the
-dependents of others, if they are accused of any offence committed in
-their district.
-
-Having now given the best description that I can of the island in its
-present state, and of the people, with their customs and manners,
-language and arts, I shall only add a few general observations, which
-may be of use to future navigators, if any of the ships of Great Britain
-should receive orders to visit it. As it produces nothing that appears
-to be convertible into an article of trade, and can be used only by
-affording refreshments to shipping in their passage through these seas,
-it might be made to answer this purpose in a much greater degree, by
-transporting thither sheep, goats, and horned cattle, with European
-garden-stuff, and other useful vegetables, which there is the greatest
-reason to suppose will flourish in so fine a climate, and so rich a
-soil.
-
-Though this, and the neighbouring islands lie within the tropic of
-Capricorn, yet the heat is not troublesome, nor did the winds blow
-constantly from the east. We had frequently a fresh gale from the S. W.
-for two or three days, and sometimes, though very seldom, from the N. W.
-Tupia reported, that south westerly winds prevail in October, November,
-and December, and we have no doubt of the fact. When the winds are
-variable, they are always accompanied by a swell from the S. W. or W. S.
-W.; there is also a swell from the same points when it is calm, and the
-atmosphere loaded with clouds, which is a sure indication that the winds
-are variable, or westerly out at sea, for with the settled trade-wind
-the weather is clear.
-
-The meeting with westerly winds, within the general limits of the
-eastern trade, has induced some navigators to suppose that they were
-near some large track of land, of which, however, I think they are no
-indication.
-
-It has been found, both by us and the Dolphin, that the trade-wind, in
-these parts, does not extend farther to the south than twenty degrees,
-beyond which, we generally found a gale from the westward; and it is
-reasonable to suppose, that when these winds blow strong, they will
-drive back the easterly wind, and consequently encroach upon the limits
-within which they constantly blow, and thus necessarily produce variable
-winds, as either happens to prevail, and a south-westerly swell. This
-supposition is the more probable, as it is well known that the
-trade-winds blow but faintly for some distance within their limits, and
-therefore may be more easily stopped or repelled by a wind in the
-contrary direction: it is also well known, that the limits of the
-trade-winds vary not only at different seasons of the year, but
-sometimes at the same season, in different years.
-
-There is therefore no reason to suppose that south-westerly winds,
-within these limits, are caused by the vicinity of large tracts of land,
-especially as they are always accompanied with a large swell, in the
-same direction in which they blow; and we find a much greater surf
-beating upon the shores of the south-west side of the islands that are
-situated just within the limits of the trade-wind, than upon any other
-part of them.
-
-The tides about these islands are perhaps as inconsiderable as in any
-part of the world. A south or S. by W. moon, makes high water in the bay
-of Matavai at Otaheite; but the water very seldom rises perpendicularly
-above ten or twelve inches.
-
-The variation of the compass I found to be 4° 46ʹ easterly, this being
-the result of a great number of trials made with four of Dr. Knight’s
-needles, adapted to azimuth compasses. These compasses I thought the
-best that could be procured, yet when applied to the meridian line, I
-found them to differ, not only one from another, sometimes a degree and
-an half, but the same needle, half a degree from itself in different
-trials made on the same day; and I do not remember that I have ever
-found two needles which exactly agreed at the same time and place,
-though I have often found the same needle agree with itself, in several
-trials made one after the other. This imperfection of the needle,
-however, is of no consequence to navigation, as the variation can always
-be found to a degree of accuracy, more than sufficient for all nautical
-purposes.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. XX.
-
-A DESCRIPTION OF SEVERAL OTHER ISLANDS IN THE NEIGHBOURHOOD OF OTAHEITE,
- WITH VARIOUS INCIDENTS; A DRAMATIC ENTERTAINMENT; AND MANY PARTICULARS
- RELATIVE TO THE CUSTOMS AND MANNERS OF THE INHABITANTS.
-
-
-AFTER parting with our friends, we made an easy sail, with gentle
-breezes and clear weather, and were informed by Tupia, that four of the
-neighbouring islands, which he distinguished by the names of HUAHEINE,
-ULIETEA, OTAHA, and BOLABOLA, lay at the distance of between one and two
-days sail from Otaheite; and that hogs, fowls, and other refreshments,
-with which we had of late been but sparingly supplied, were there to be
-procured in great plenty; but having discovered from the hills of
-Otaheite, an island lying to the northward, which he called TETHUROA, I
-determined first to stand that way, to take a nearer view of it. It lies
-N. ½ W. distant eight leagues from the northern extremity of Otaheite,
-upon which we had observed the transit, and to which we had, for that
-reason, given the name of POINT VENUS. We found it to be a small low
-island, and were told by Tupia, that it had no settled inhabitants, but
-was occasionally visited by the inhabitants of Otaheite, who sometimes
-went thither for a few days to fish; we therefore determined to spend no
-more time in a farther examination of it, but to go in search of
-Huaheine and Ulietea, which he described to be well peopled, and as
-large as Otaheite.
-
-At six o’clock in the morning of the 14th, the westermost part of EIMEO,
-or York Island, bore S. E. ½ S. and the body of Otaheite E. ½ S. At
-noon, the body of York Island bore E. by S. ½ S.; and Port-Royal bay, at
-Otaheite, S. 70° 45ʹ E. distant 61 miles; and an island, which we took
-to be Saunders’s Island, called by the natives TAPOAMANAO, bore S. S. W.
-We also saw land bearing N. W. ½ W. which Tupia said was Huaheine.
-
-On the 15th, it was hazy, with light breezes and calms succeeding each
-other, so that we could see no land, and made but little way. Our
-Indian, Tupia, often prayed for a wind to his god Tane, and as often
-boasted of his success, which indeed he took a very effectual method to
-secure, for he never began his address to Tane, till he saw a breeze so
-near that he knew it must reach the ship before his oraison was well
-over.
-
-On the 16th, we had a gentle breeze; and in the morning about eight
-o’clock, being close in with the north-west part of the island Huaheine,
-we sounded, but had no bottom with 80 fathom. Some canoes very soon came
-off, but the people seemed afraid, and kept at a distance till they
-discovered Tupia, and then they ventured nearer. In one of the canoes
-that came up to the ship’s side, was the king of the island and his
-wife. Upon assurances of friendship, frequently and earnestly repeated,
-their majesties and some others came on board. At first they were struck
-with astonishment, and wondered at every thing that was shewn them; yet
-they made no inquiries, and seeming to be satisfied with what was
-offered to their notice, they made no search after other objects of
-curiosity, with which it was natural to suppose a building of such
-novelty and magnitude as the ship must abound. After some time, they
-became more familiar. I was given to understand, that the name of the
-king was OREE, and he proposed, as a mark of amity, that we should
-exchange names. To this I readily consented; and he was Cookee, for so
-he pronounced my name, and I was Oree, for the rest of the time we were
-together. We found these people to be very nearly the same with those of
-Otaheite, in person, dress, language, and every other circumstance,
-except, if Tupia might be believed, that they would not steal.
-
-Soon after dinner, we came to an anchor in a small but excellent harbour
-on the west side of the island, which the natives call OWHARRE, in
-eighteen fathom water, clear ground, and secure from all winds. I went
-immediately ashore, accompanied by Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, Mr.
-Monkhouse, Tupia, King Cookee, and some other of the natives who had
-been on board ever since the morning. The moment we landed, Tupia
-stripped himself as low as the waist, and desired Mr. Monkhouse to do
-the same: he then sat down before a great number of the natives, who
-were collected together in a large house or shed; for here, as well as
-at Otaheite, a house consists only of a roof supported upon poles; the
-rest of us, by his desire, standing behind. He then began a speech or
-prayer, which lasted about a quarter of an hour, the king, who stood
-over against him, every now and then answering in what appeared to be
-set responses. In the course of this harangue, he delivered, at
-different times, two handkerchiefs, a black silk neckcloth, some beads,
-two small bunches of feathers, and some plantains, as presents to their
-Eatua, or God. In return for these, he received for our Eatua, a hog,
-some young plantains, and two small bunches of feathers, which he
-ordered to be carried on board the ship. After these ceremonies, which
-we supposed to be the ratification of a treaty between us, every one was
-dismissed to go whither he pleased; and Tupia immediately repaired to
-offer his oblations at one of the Morais.
-
-The next morning, we went on shore again, and walked up the hills, where
-the productions were exactly the same as those of Otaheite, except that
-the rocks and clay appeared to be more burnt. The houses were neat, and
-the boat-houses remarkably large; one that we measured was fifty paces
-long, ten broad, and twenty-four feet high, the whole formed a pointed
-arch, like those of our old cathedrals, which was supported on one side
-by twenty-six, and on the other by thirty pillars, or rather posts,
-about two feet high, and one thick, upon most of which were rudely
-carved the heads of men, and several fanciful devices, not altogether
-unlike those which we sometimes see printed from wooden blocks, at the
-beginning and end of old books. The plains, or flat part of the country,
-abounded in bread-fruit, and cocoa-nut trees; in some places, however,
-there were salt swamps and lagoons, which would produce neither.
-
-We went again a-shore on the 18th, and would have taken the advantage of
-Tupia’s company, in our perambulation; but he was too much engaged with
-his friends: we took, however, his boy, whose name was TAYETO, and Mr.
-Banks went to take a farther view of what had much engaged his attention
-before; it was a kind of chest or ark, the lid of which was nicely sewed
-on, and thatched very neatly with palm-nut leaves: it was fixed upon two
-poles, and supported on little arches of wood, very neatly carved; the
-use of the poles seemed to be to remove it from place to place, in the
-manner of our sedan chairs: in one end of it was a square hole, in the
-middle of which was a ring touching the sides, and leaving the angles
-open, so as to form a round hole within a square one. The first time Mr.
-Banks saw this coffer, the aperture at the end was stopped with a piece
-of cloth, which, lest he should give offence, he left untouched;
-probably there was then something within, but now the cloth was taken
-away, and, upon looking into it, it was found empty. The general
-resemblance between this repository and the Ark of the Lord among the
-Jews is remarkable; but it is still more remarkable, that upon inquiring
-of the boy what it was called, he said, _Ewharre no Eatua_, the _house
-of the God_: he could however give no account of its signification or
-use. We had commenced a kind of trade with the natives, but it went on
-slowly; for when any thing was offered, not one of them would take it
-upon his own judgment, but collected the opinions of twenty or thirty
-people, which could not be done without great loss of time. We got,
-however, eleven pigs, and determined to try for more the next day.
-
-The next day, therefore, we brought out some hatchets, for which we
-hoped we should have had no occasion, upon an island which no European
-had ever visited before. These procured us three very large hogs; and as
-we proposed to sail in the afternoon, King Oree and several others came
-on board to take their leave. To the king I gave a small plate of
-pewter, on which was stamped this inscription, “His Britannic-Majesty’s
-ship, Endeavour, Lieutenant Cook, Commander, 16th July, 1769, Huaheine.”
-I gave him also some medals or counters, resembling the coin of England,
-struck in the year 1761, with some other presents; and he promised that
-with none of these, particularly the plate, he would ever part. I
-thought it as lasting a testimony of our having first discovered this
-island, as any we could leave behind; and having dismissed our visitors
-well satisfied, and in great good-humour, we set sail, about half an
-hour after two in the afternoon.
-
-The island of Huaheine, or Huahene, is situated in the latitude of 16°
-43ʹ S. and longitude 152° 52ʹ W. from Greenwich: it is distant from
-Otaheite about thirty-one leagues, in the direction of N. 58 W. and is
-about seven leagues in compass. Its surface is hilly and uneven, and it
-has a safe and commodious harbour. The harbour, which is called by the
-natives OWALLE, or OWHARRE, lies on the west side, under the
-northernmost high land, and within the north end of the reef, which lies
-along that side of the island; there are two inlets or openings, by
-which it may be entered, through the reef, about a mile and a half
-distant from each other; the southernmost is the widest, and on the
-south side of it lies a very small sandy island.
-
-Huaheine seems to be a month forwarder in its productions than Otaheite,
-as we found the cocoa-nuts full of kernel, and some of the new
-bread-fruit fit to eat. Of the cocoa-nuts the inhabitants make a food
-which they call _Poe_, by mixing them with yams; they scrape both fine,
-and having incorporated the powder, they put it into a wooden trough,
-with a number of hot stones, by which an oily kind of hasty-pudding is
-made, that our people relished very well, especially when it was fried.
-Mr. Banks found not more than eleven or twelve new plants; but he
-observed some insects, and a species of scorpion which he had not seen
-before.
-
-The inhabitants seem to be larger made, and more stout, than those of
-Otaheite. Mr. Banks measured one of the men, and found him to be six
-feet three inches and an half high; yet they are so lazy, that he could
-not persuade any of them to go up the hills with him: they said, if they
-were to attempt it, the fatigue would kill them. The women were very
-fair, more so than those of Otaheite; and in general, we thought them
-more handsome, though none that were equal to some individuals. Both
-sexes seemed to be less timid, and less curious: it has been observed,
-that they made no inquiries on board the ship; and when we fired a gun,
-they were frighted indeed, but they did not fall down, as our friends at
-Otaheite constantly did when we first came among them. For this
-difference, however, we can easily account upon other principles; the
-people at Huaheine had not seen the Dolphin, those at Otaheite had. In
-one, the report of a gun was connected with the idea of instant
-destruction; to the other, there was nothing dreadful in it but the
-appearance and the sound, as they had never experienced its power of
-dispensing death.
-
-While we were on shore, we found that Tupia had commended them beyond
-their merit, when he said that they would not steal; for one of them was
-detected in the fact. But when he was seized by the hair, the rest,
-instead of running away, as the people at Otaheite would have done,
-gathered round, and inquired what provocation had been given: but this
-also may be accounted for without giving them credit for superior
-courage; they had no experience of the consequence of European
-resentment, which the people at Otaheite had in many instances purchased
-with life. It must, however, be acknowledged, to their honour, that when
-they understood what had happened, they showed strong signs of
-disapprobation, and prescribed a good beating for the thief, which was
-immediately administered.
-
-We now made sail for the island of ULIETEA, which lies S. W. by W.
-distant seven or eight leagues from Huaheine, and at half an hour after
-six in the evening, we were within three leagues of the shore, on the
-eastern side. We stood off and on all night, and when the day broke the
-next morning, we stood in for the shore: we soon after discovered an
-opening in the reef which lies before the island, within which Tupia
-told us there was a good harbour. I did not, however, implicitly take
-his word; but sent the master out in the pinnace to examine it: he soon
-made the signal for the ship to follow; we accordingly stood in, and
-anchored in two-and-twenty fathom, with soft ground.
-
-The natives soon came off to us in two canoes, each of which brought a
-woman and a pig. The woman we supposed was a mark of confidence, and the
-pig was a present; we received both with proper acknowledgments, and
-complimented each of the ladies with a spike nail and some beads, much
-to their satisfaction. We were told by Tupia, who had always expressed
-much fear of the men of Bolabola, that they had made a conquest of this
-island; and that, if we remained here, they would certainly come down
-to-morrow, and fight us. We determined, therefore, to go on shore
-without delay, while the day was our own.
-
-I landed in company with Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and the other
-gentlemen, Tupia being also of the party. He introduced us by repeating
-the ceremonies which he had performed at Huaheine, after which I hoisted
-an English jack, and took possession of this and the three neighbouring
-islands, Huaheine, Otaha, and Bolabola, which were all in sight, in the
-name of his Britannic Majesty. After this, we took a walk to a great
-Morai, called Tapodeboatea. We found it very different from those of
-Otaheite; for it consisted only of four walls, about eight feet high, of
-coral stones, some of which were of an immense size, inclosing an area
-of about five-and-twenty yards square, which was filled up with smaller
-stones: upon the top of it many planks were set up on end, which were
-carved in their whole length: at a little distance we found an altar, or
-Ewhatta, upon which lay the last oblation or sacrifice, a hog of about
-eighty pounds weight, which had been offered whole, and very nicely
-roasted. Here were also four or five Ewharre-no-Eatua, or houses of God,
-to which carriage poles were fitted, like that which we had seen at
-Huaheine. One of these Mr. Banks examined by putting his hand into it,
-and found a parcel about five feet long and one thick, wrapped up in
-mats: he broke a way through several of these mats with his fingers, but
-at length came to one which was made of the fibres of the cocoa-nut, so
-firmly plaited together that he found it impossible to tear it, and
-therefore was forced to desist; especially as he perceived, that what he
-had done already gave great offence to our new friends. From hence we
-went to a long house, not far distant, where, among rolls of cloth, and
-several other things, we saw the model of a canoe, about three feet
-long, to which were tied eight human jaw-bones: we had already learnt
-that these, like scalps among the Indians of North America, were
-trophies of war. Tupia affirmed that they were the jaw-bones of the
-natives of this island: if so, they might have been hung up, with the
-model of a canoe, as a symbol of invasion, by the warriors of Bolabola,
-as a memorial of their conquest.
-
-Night now came on apace, but Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander continued their
-walk along the shore, and at a little distance saw another
-Ewharre-no-Eatua, and a tree of the fig kind, the same as that which Mr.
-Green had seen at Otaheite, in great perfection, the trunk, or rather
-congeries of the roots of which was forty-two paces in circumference.
-
-On the 21st, having dispatched the master in the long-boat to examine
-the coast of the south part of the island, and one of the mates in the
-yawl, to sound the harbour where the ship lay, I went myself in the
-pinnace, to survey that part of the island which lies to the north. Mr.
-Banks and the gentlemen were again on shore, trading with the natives,
-and examining the products and curiosities of the country; they saw
-nothing, however, worthy notice, but some more jaw-bones, of which they
-made no doubt but that the account they had heard was true.
-
-On the 22d and 23d, having strong gales and hazy weather, I did not
-think it safe to put to sea; but on the 24th, though the wind was still
-variable, I got under sail, and plied to the northward within the reef,
-with a view to go out at a wider opening than that by which I had
-entered; in doing this, however, I was unexpectedly in the most imminent
-danger of striking on the rock: the master, whom I had ordered to keep
-continually sounding in the chains, suddenly called out “two fathom.”
-This alarmed me, for though I knew the ship drew at least fourteen feet,
-and that therefore it was impossible such a shoal should be under her
-keel; yet the master was either mistaken, or she went along the edge of
-a coral rock, many of which, in the neighbourhood of these islands, are
-as steep as a wall.
-
-This harbour, or bay, is called by the natives OOPOA, and taken in its
-greatest extent, it is capable of holding any number of shipping. It
-extends almost the whole length of the east side of the island, and is
-defended from the sea by a reef of coral rocks: the southernmost opening
-in this reef, or channel into the harbour, by which we entered, is
-little more than a cable’s length wide; it lies off the easternmost part
-of the island, and may be known by another small woody island, which
-lies a little to the south-east of it, called by the people here OATARA.
-Between three and four miles north west from this island, lie two other
-islets, in the same direction as the reef, of which they are a part,
-called OPURURU and TAMOU; between these lies the other channel into the
-harbour, through which I went out, and which is a full quarter of a mile
-wide. Still farther to the north-west are some other small islands, near
-which I am told there is another small channel into the harbour; but
-this I know only by report.
-
-The principal refreshments that are to be procured at this part of the
-island are, plantains, cocoa-nuts, yams, hogs, and fowls; the hogs and
-fowls, however, are scarce; and the country, where we saw it, is neither
-so populous, nor so rich in produce as Otaheite, or even Huaheine. Wood
-and water may also be procured here; but the water cannot conveniently
-be got at.
-
-We were now again at sea, without having received any interruption from
-the hostile inhabitants of Bolabola, whom, notwithstanding the fears of
-Tupia, we intended to visit. At four o’clock in the afternoon of the
-25th, we were within a league of Otaha, which bore N. 77 W. To the
-northward of the south end of that island, on the east side of it, and
-something more than a mile from the shore, lie two small islands, called
-TOAHOUTU and WHENNUAIA; between which, Tupia says, there is a channel
-into a very good harbour, which lies within the reef, and appearances
-confirmed his report.
-
-[Illustration: _The Harbour of Oopoa._]
-
-As I discovered a broad channel between Otaha and Bolabola, I determined
-rather to go through it, than run to the northward of all; but the wind
-being right a-head, I got no ground.
-
-Between five and six in the evening of the 26th, as I was standing to
-the northward, I discovered a small low island, lying N. by W. or N. N.
-W. distant four or five leagues from Bolabola. We were told by Tupia
-that the name of this island is TUBAI; that it produces nothing but
-cocoa-nuts, and is inhabited only by three families; though it is
-visited by the inhabitants of the neighbouring islands, who resort
-thither to catch fish, with which the coast abounds.
-
-On the 27th, about noon, the peak of Bolabola bore N. 25 W. and the
-north end of OTAHA, N. 80 W. distant three leagues. The wind continued
-contrary all this day and the night following. On the 28th, at six in
-the morning, we were near the entrance of the harbour on the east side
-of OTAHA, which has been just mentioned; and finding that it might be
-examined without losing time, I sent away the master in the long-boat,
-with orders to sound it; and, if the wind did not shift in our favour,
-to land upon the island, and traffic with the natives for such
-refreshments as were to be had. In this boat went Mr. Banks and Dr.
-Solander, who landed upon the island, and before night purchased three
-hogs, twenty-one fowls, and as many yams and plantains as the boat would
-hold. Plantains we thought a more useful refreshment even than pork; for
-they were boiled and served to the ship’s company as bread, and were now
-the more acceptable as our bread was so full of vermin, that
-notwithstanding all possible care, we had sometimes twenty of them in
-our mouths at a time, everyone of which tasted as hot as mustard. The
-island seemed to be more barren than Ulietea, but the produce was of the
-same kind. The people also exactly resembled those that we had seen at
-the other islands; they were not numerous, but they flocked about the
-boat wherever she went from all quarters, bringing with them whatever
-they had to sell. They paid the strangers, of whom they had received an
-account from Tupia, the same compliment which they used towards their
-own kings, uncovering their shoulders, and wrapping their garments round
-their breasts; and were so solicitous to prevent its being neglected by
-any of their people, that a man was sent with them, who called out to
-every one they met, telling him what they were, and what he was to do.
-
-In the mean time, I kept plying off and on, waiting for the boat’s
-return; at half an hour after five, not seeing any thing of her, I fired
-a gun, and after it was dark hoisted a light; at half an hour after
-eight, we heard the report of a musquet, which we answered with a gun,
-and soon after the boat came on board. The master reported, that the
-harbour was safe and commodious, with good anchorage from twenty-five to
-sixteen fathom water, clear ground.
-
-As soon as the boat was hoisted in, I made sail to the northward, and at
-eight o’clock in the morning of the 29th, we were close under the Peak
-of Bolabola, which was high, rude, and craggy. As the island was
-altogether inaccessible in this part, and we found it impossible to
-weather it, we tacked and stood off, then tacked again, and after many
-trips did not weather the south end of it till twelve o’clock at night.
-At eight o’clock the next morning, we discovered an island, which bore
-from us N. 63° W. distant about eight leagues; at the same time the Peak
-of Bolabola bore N. ¼ E. distant three or four leagues. This island
-Tupia called MAURUA, and said that it was small, wholly surrounded by a
-reef, and without any harbour for shipping; but inhabited, and bearing
-the same produce as the neighbouring islands: the middle of it rises in
-a high round hill, that may be seen at the distance of ten leagues.
-
-When we were off Bolabola, we saw but few people on the shore, and were
-told by Tupia that many of the inhabitants were gone to Ulietea. In the
-afternoon we found ourselves nearly the length of the south end of
-Ulietea, and to windward of some harbours that lay on the west side of
-this island. Into one of these harbours, though we had before been
-ashore on the other side of the island, I intended to put, in order to
-stop a leak which we had sprung in the powder room, and to take in more
-ballast, as I found the ship too light to carry sail upon a wind. As the
-wind was right against us, we plied off one of the harbours, and about
-three o’clock in the afternoon on the 1st of August, we came to an
-anchor in the entrance of the channel leading into it, in fourteen
-fathom water, being prevented from working in, by a tide which set very
-strong out. We then carried out the kedge-anchor, in order to warp into
-the harbour; but when this was done, we could not trip the bower-anchor
-with all the purchase we could make; we were therefore obliged to lie
-still all night, and in the morning, when the tide turned, the ship
-going over the anchor, it tripped of itself, and we warped the ship into
-a proper birth with ease, and moored in twenty-eight fathom, with a
-sandy bottom. While this was doing, many of the natives came off to us
-with hogs, fowls, and plantains, which they parted with at an easy rate.
-
-When the ship was secured, I went on shore to look for a proper place to
-get ballast and water, both which I found in a very convenient
-situation.
-
-This day Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander spent on shore, very much to their
-satisfaction: every body seemed to fear and respect them, placing in
-them at the same time the utmost confidence, behaving as if conscious
-that they possessed the power of doing them mischief, without any
-propensity to make use of it. Men, women, and children, crowded round
-them, and followed them wherever they went; but none of them were guilty
-of the least incivility: on the contrary, whenever there happened to be
-dirt or water in the way, the men vied with each other to carry them
-over on their backs. They were conducted to the houses of the principal
-people, and were received in a manner altogether new: the people, who
-followed them while they were in their way, rushed forward as soon as
-they came to a house, and went hastily in before them, leaving however a
-lane sufficiently wide for them to pass. When they entered, they found
-those who had preceded them ranged on each side of a long matt, which
-was spread upon the ground, and at the farther end of which sat the
-family: in the first house they entered, they found some very young
-women or children, dressed with the utmost neatness, who kept their
-station, expecting the strangers to come up to them and make them
-presents, which they did with the greatest pleasure; for prettier
-children, or better dressed, they had never seen. One of them was a girl
-about six years old; her gown or upper garment was red; a large quantity
-of platted hair was wound round her head, the ornament to which they
-give the name of Tamou, and which they value more than any thing they
-possess. She sat at the upper end of a matt thirty feet long, upon which
-none of the spectators presumed to set a foot, notwithstanding the
-crowd; and she leaned upon the arm of a well-looking woman about thirty,
-who was probably her nurse. Our gentlemen walked up to her, and as soon
-as they approached, she stretched out her hand to receive the beads
-which they offered her, and no princess in Europe could have done it
-with a better grace.
-
-The people were so much gratified by the presents which were made to
-these girls, that when Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander returned, they seemed
-attentive to nothing but how to oblige them: and in one of the houses,
-they were, by order of the master, entertained with a dance different
-from any that they had seen. It was performed by one man, who put upon
-his head a large cylindrical piece of wickerwork, or basket, about four
-feet long and eight inches in diameter, which was faced with feathers,
-placed perpendicularly, with the tops bending forwards, and edged round
-with shark’s teeth, and the tail feathers of tropic birds: when he had
-put on this head-dress, which is called a _Whow_, he began to dance,
-moving slowly, and often turning his head so as that the top of his high
-wicker-cap described a circle, and sometimes throwing it so near the
-faces of the spectators as to make them start back: this was held among
-them as a very good joke, and never failed to produce a peal of
-laughter, especially when it was played off upon one of the strangers.
-
-On the 3d, we went along the shore to the northward, which was in a
-direction opposite to that of the route Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander had
-taken the day before, with a design to purchase stock, which we always
-found the people more ready to part with, and at a more easy price, at
-their houses than at the market. In the course of our walk, we met with
-a company of dancers, who detained us two hours, and during all that
-time afforded us great entertainment. The company consisted of two women
-dancers, and six men, with three drums; we were informed by Tupia, that
-they were some of the most considerable people of the island, and that,
-though they were continually going from place to place, they did not,
-like the little strolling companies of Otaheite, take any gratuity from
-the spectators. The women had upon their heads a considerable quantity
-of Tamou, or platted hair, which was brought several times round the
-head, and adorned in many parts with the flowers of the cape-jessamine,
-which were stuck in with much taste, and made a head-dress truly
-elegant. Their necks, shoulders, and arms, were naked; so were the
-breasts also, as low as the parting of the arm; below that, they were
-covered with black cloth, which set close to the body; at the side of
-each breast, next the arm, was placed a small plume of black feathers,
-much in the same manner as our ladies now wear their nosegays or
-_bouquets_; upon their hips rested a quantity of cloth plaited very
-full, which reached up to the breast, and fell down below into long
-petticoats, which quite concealed their feet, and which they managed
-with as much dexterity as our opera dancers could have done: the plaits
-above the waist were brown and white alternately, the petticoats below
-were all white.
-
-In this dress they advanced sideways in a measured step, keeping
-excellent time to the drums, which beat briskly and loud; soon after
-they began to shake their hips, giving the folds of cloth that lay upon
-them a very quick motion, which was in some degree continued through the
-whole dance, though the body was thrown into various postures, sometimes
-standing, sometimes sitting, and sometimes resting on their knees and
-elbows, the fingers also being moved at the same time with a quickness
-scarcely to be imagined. Much of the dexterity of the dancers, however,
-and the entertainment of the spectators, consisted in the wantonness of
-their attitudes and gestures, which was, indeed, such as exceeds all
-description.
-
-One of these girls had in her ear three pearls; one of them was very
-large, but so foul that it was of little value; the other two were as
-big as a middling pea; these were clear, and of a good colour and shape,
-though spoiled by the drilling. Mr. Banks would fain have purchased
-them, and offered the owner any thing she would ask for them, but she
-could not be persuaded to part with them at any price: he tempted her
-with the value of four hogs, and whatever else she should choose, but
-without success; and indeed they set a value upon their pearls very
-nearly equal to what they would fetch among us, except they could be
-procured before they are drilled.
-
-Between the dances of the women, the men performed a kind of dramatic
-interlude, in which there was dialogue as well as dancing; but we were
-not sufficiently acquainted with their language to understand the
-subject.
-
-On the 4th, some of our gentlemen saw a much more regular entertainment
-of the dramatic kind, which was divided into four acts.
-
-Tupia had often told us that he had large possessions in this island,
-which had been taken away from him by the inhabitants of Bolabola, and
-he now pointed them out in the very bay where the ship was at anchor.
-Upon our going on shore, this was confirmed by the inhabitants, who
-showed us several districts or Whennuas, which they acknowledged to be
-his right.
-
-On the 5th, I received a present of three hogs, some fowls, several
-pieces of cloth, the largest we had seen, being fifty yards long, which
-they unfolded and displayed so as to make the greatest show possible;
-and a considerable quantity of plantains, cocoa-nuts, and other
-refreshments, from Opoony, the formidable king, or, in the language of
-the country, Earee rahie, of Bolabola, with a message that he was at
-this time upon the island, and that the next day he intended to pay me a
-visit.
-
-In the mean time Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander went upon the hills,
-accompanied by several of the Indians, who conducted them by excellent
-paths, to such a height, that they plainly saw the other side of the
-island, and the passage through which the ship had passed the reef
-between the little islands of Opururu and Tamou, when we landed upon it
-the first time. As they were returning, they saw the Indians exercising
-themselves at what they call _Erowhaw_, which is nothing more than
-pitching a kind of light lance, headed with hard wood, at a mark: in
-this amusement, though they seem very fond of it, they do not excel, for
-not above one in twelve struck the mark, which was the hole of a
-plantain tree, at about twenty yards distance.
-
-On the 6th, we all staid at home, expecting the visit of the great king,
-but we were disappointed; we had, however, much more agreeable company,
-for he sent three very pretty girls to demand something in return for
-his present: perhaps he was unwilling to trust himself on board the
-ship, or perhaps he thought his messengers would procure a more valuable
-return for his hogs and poultry than he could himself; be that as it
-may, we did not regret his absence, nor his messengers their visit.
-
-In the afternoon, as the great king would not come to us, we determined
-to go to the great king. As he was lord of the Bolabola men, the
-conquerors of this, and the terror of all the other islands, we expected
-to see a chief young and vigorous, with an intelligent countenance, and
-an enterprising spirit: we found, however, a poor feeble wretch,
-withered and decrepit, half blind with age, and so sluggish and stupid
-that he appeared scarcely to have understanding enough left to know that
-it was probable we should be gratified either by hogs or women. He did
-not receive us sitting, or with any state or formality as the other
-chiefs had done: we made him our present, which he accepted, and gave a
-hog in return. We had learnt that his principal residence was at Otaha;
-and upon our telling him that we intended to go thither in our boats the
-next morning, and that we should be glad to have him along with us, he
-promised to be of the party.
-
-Early in the morning, therefore, I set out both with the pinnace and
-long-boat for Otaha, having some of the gentlemen with me; and in our
-way we called upon Opoony, who was in his canoe, ready to join us. As
-soon as we landed at Otaha, I made him a present of an axe, which I
-thought might induce him to encourage his subjects to bring us such
-provision as we wanted; but in this we found ourselves sadly
-disappointed; for after staying with him till noon, we left him without
-being able to procure a single article. I then proceeded to the north
-point of the island, in the pinnace, having sent the long-boat another
-way. As I went along, I picked up half a dozen hogs, as many fowls, and
-some plantains and yams. Having viewed and sketched the harbour on this
-side of the island, I made the best of my way back with the long-boat,
-which joined me soon after it was dark; and about ten o’clock at night
-we got on board the ship.
-
-In this excursion Mr. Banks was not with us: he spent the morning on
-board the ship, trading with the natives, who came off in their canoes,
-for provisions and curiosities; and, in the afternoon, he went on shore
-with his draughtsmen, to sketch the dresses of the dancers which he had
-seen a day or two before. He found the company exactly the same, except
-that another woman had been added to it: the dancing also of the women
-was the same, but the interludes of the men were somewhat varied; he saw
-five or six performed, which were different from each other, and very
-much resembled the drama of our stage dances. The next day, he went
-ashore again, with Dr. Solander, and they directed their course towards
-the dancing company, which, from the time of our second landing, had
-gradually moved about two leagues in their course round the island. They
-saw more dancing, and more interludes, the interludes still varying from
-each other: in one of them the performers, who were all men, were
-divided into two parties, which were distinguished from each other by
-the colour of their clothes, one being brown, and the other white. The
-brown party represented a master and servants, and the white party a
-company of thieves: the master gave a basket of meat to the rest of his
-party, with a charge to take care of it: the dance of the white party
-consisted of several expedients to steal it, and that of the brown party
-in preventing their success. After some time, those who had charge of
-the basket placed themselves round it upon the ground, and, leaning upon
-it, appeared to go to sleep; the others, improving this opportunity,
-came gently upon them, and lifting them up from the basket, carried off
-their prize: the sleepers, soon after awaking, missed their basket, but
-presently fell a dancing, without any farther regarding their loss; so
-that the dramatic action of this dance was, according to the severest
-laws of criticism, one, and our lovers of simplicity would here have
-been gratified with an entertainment perfectly suited to the chastity of
-their taste.
-
-On the 9th, having spent the morning in trading with the canoes, we took
-the opportunity of a breeze, which sprung up at east, and having stopped
-our leak, and got the fresh stock which we had purchased on board, we
-sailed out of the harbour. When we were sailing away, Tupia strongly
-urged me to fire a shot towards Bolabola, possibly as a mark of his
-resentment, and to show the power of his new allies: in this I thought
-proper to gratify him, though we were seven leagues distant.
-
-While we were about these islands, we expended very little of the ship’s
-provisions, and were very plentifully supplied with hogs, fowls,
-plantains and yams, which we hoped would have been of great use to us in
-our course to the southward; but the hogs would not eat European grain
-of any kind, pulse, or bread-dust, so that we could not preserve them
-alive; and the fowls were all very soon seized with a disease that
-affected the head so, that they continued to hold it down between their
-legs till they died: much dependence, therefore, must not be placed in
-live stock taken on board at these places, at least not till a discovery
-is made of some food that the hogs will eat, and some remedy for the
-disease of the poultry.
-
-Having been necessarily detained at Ulietea so long, by the carpenters,
-in stopping our leak, we determined to give up our design of going on
-shore at Bolabola, especially as it appeared to be difficult of access.
-
-To these six islands, Ulietea, Otaha, Bolabola, Huaheine, Tubai, and
-Maurua, as they lie contiguous to each other, I gave the names of
-SOCIETY ISLANDS, but did not think it proper to distinguish them
-separately by any other names than those by which they were known to the
-natives.
-
-They are situated between the latitude of 16° 10ʹ and 16° 55ʹ S., and
-between the longitude of 150° 57ʹ and 152° W. from the meridian of
-Greenwich. Ulietea and Otaha lie within about two miles of each other,
-and are both inclosed within one reef of coral rocks, so that there is
-no passage for shipping between them. This reef forms several excellent
-harbours; the entrances into them, indeed, are but narrow, yet when a
-ship is once in, nothing can hurt her. The harbours on the east side
-have been described already; and on the west side of Ulietea, which is
-the largest of the two, there are three. The northernmost, in which we
-lay, is called OHAMANENO: the channel leading into it is about a quarter
-of a mile wide, and lies between two low sandy islands, which are the
-northernmost on this side; between, or just within the two islands,
-there is good anchorage in twenty-eight fathom, soft ground. This
-harbour, though small, is preferable to the others, because it is
-situated in the most fertile part of the island, and where fresh water
-is easily to be got. The other two harbours lie to the southward of
-this, and not far from the south end of the island: in both of them
-there is good anchorage, with ten, twelve, and fourteen fathom. They are
-easily known by three small woody islands at their entrance. The
-southernmost of these two harbours lies within, and to the southward of
-the southernmost of these islands, and the other lies between the two
-northernmost. I was told that there were more harbours at the south end
-of this island, but I did not examine whether the report was true.
-
-Otaha affords two very good harbours, one on the east side, and the
-other on the west. That on the east side is called Ohamene, and has been
-mentioned already; the other is called OHERURUA, and lies about the
-middle of the south-west side of the island; it is pretty large, and
-affords good anchorage in twenty and twenty-five fathom, nor is there
-any want of fresh water. The breach in the reef, that forms a channel
-into this harbour, is about a quarter of a mile broad, and, like all the
-rest, is very steep on both sides: in general there is no danger here
-but what is visible.
-
-The island of Bolabola lies N. W. and by W. from Otaha, distant about
-four leagues; it is surrounded by a reef of rocks, and several small
-islands, in compass together about eight leagues. I was told, that, on
-the south-west side of the island, there is a channel through the reef
-into a very good harbour, but I did not think it worth while to examine
-it, for the reasons that have been just assigned. This island is
-rendered very remarkable by a high craggy hill, which appears to be
-almost perpendicular, and terminates at the top in two peaks, one higher
-than the other.
-
-The land of Ulietea and Otaha is hilly, broken, and irregular, except on
-the sea-coast, yet the hills look green and pleasant, and are, in many
-places, clothed with wood. The several particulars in which these
-islands, and their inhabitants, differ from what we had observed, at
-Otaheite, have been mentioned in the course of the narrative.
-
-We pursued our course without any event worthy of note till the 13th,
-about noon, when we saw land bearing S. E., which Tupia told us was an
-island called OHETEROA. About six in the evening, we were within two or
-three leagues of it, upon which I shortened sail, and stood off and on
-all night; the next morning stood in for the land. We ran to leeward of
-the island, keeping close in shore, and saw several of the natives,
-though in no great numbers, upon the beach. At nine o’clock I sent Mr.
-Gore, one of my lieutenants, in the pinnace, to endeavour to land upon
-the island, and learn from the natives whether there was anchorage in a
-bay then in sight, and what land lay farther to the southward. Mr. Banks
-and Dr. Solander accompanied Mr. Gore in this expedition, and as they
-thought Tupia might be useful, they took him with them.
-
-As the boat approached the shore, those on board perceived the natives
-to be armed with long lances: as they did not intend to land till they
-got round a point which runs out at a little distance, they stood along
-the coast, and the natives, therefore, very probably thought they were
-afraid of them. They had now got together to the number of about sixty,
-and all of them sat down upon the shore, except two, who were dispatched
-forward to observe the motions of those in the boat. These men, after
-walking abreast of her some time, at length leaped into the water, and
-swam towards her, but were soon left behind; two more then appeared, and
-attempted to board her in the same manner, but they also were soon left
-behind; a fifth man then ran forward alone, and having got a good way
-a-head of the boat before he took to the water, easily reached her. Mr.
-Banks urged the officer to take him in, thinking it a good opportunity
-to get the confidence and good-will of a people, who then certainly
-looked upon them as enemies, but he obstinately refused; this man,
-therefore, was left behind like the others, and so was a sixth, who
-followed him.
-
-When the boat had got round the point, she perceived that all her
-followers had desisted from the pursuit: she now opened a large bay, at
-the bottom of which appeared another body of men, armed with long lances
-like the first. Here our people prepared to land, and pushed towards the
-shore, a canoe at the same time putting off to meet them. As soon as it
-came near them, they lay upon their oars, and calling out to them, told
-them that they were friends, and, that if they would come up, they would
-give them nails, which were held up for them to see: after some
-hesitation they came up to the boat’s stern, and took some nails that
-were offered them with great seeming satisfaction; but in less than a
-minute they appeared to have formed a design of boarding the boat, and
-making her their prize: three of them suddenly leaped into it, and the
-others brought up the canoe, which the motion in quitting her had thrown
-off a little, manifestly with a design to follow their associates, and
-support them in their attempt. The first that boarded the boat, entered
-close to Mr. Banks, and instantly snatched his powder-horn out of his
-pocket: Mr. Banks seized it, and with some difficulty wrenched it out of
-his hand, at the same time pressing against his breast in order to force
-him over-board, but he was too strong for him, and kept his place: the
-officer then snapped his piece, but it missed fire, upon which he
-ordered some of the people to fire over their heads; two pieces were
-accordingly discharged, upon which they all instantly leaped into the
-water: one of the people, either from cowardice or cruelty, or both,
-levelled a third piece at one of them as he was swimming away, and the
-ball grazed his forehead; happily, however, the wound was very slight,
-for he recovered the canoe, and stood up in her as active and vigorous
-as the rest. The canoe immediately stood in for the shore, where a great
-number of people, not less than two hundred, were now assembled. The
-boat also pushed in, but found the land guarded all round with a shoal,
-upon which the sea broke with a considerable surf; it was, therefore,
-thought advisable by the officer to proceed along shore in search of a
-more convenient landing-place: in the mean time, the people on board saw
-the canoe go on shore, and the natives gather eagerly round her to
-enquire the particulars of what had happened. Soon after, a single man
-ran along the shore, armed with his lance, and when he came a-breast of
-the boat, he began to dance, brandish his weapon, and call out in a very
-shrill tone, which Tupia said was a defiance from the people. The boat
-continued to row along the shore, and the champion followed it,
-repeating his defiance by his voice and his gestures; but no better
-landing-place being found than that where the canoe had put the natives
-on shore, the officer turned back with a view to attempt it there,
-hoping, that if it should not be practicable, the people would come to a
-conference either on the shoals or in their canoes, and that a treaty of
-peace might be concluded with them.
-
-As the boat rowed slowly along the shore back again, another champion
-came down, shouting defiance, and brandishing his lance: his appearance
-was more formidable than that of the other, for he wore a large cap made
-of the tail feathers of the tropic bird, and his body was covered with
-stripes of different coloured cloth, yellow, red, and brown. This
-gentleman also danced, but with much more nimbleness and dexterity than
-the first; our people therefore, considering his agility and his dress,
-distinguished him by the name of HARLEQUIN. Soon after a more grave and
-elderly man came down to the beach, and hailing the people in the boat,
-inquired who they were, and from whence they came; Tupia answered in
-their own language, from Otaheite: the three natives then walked
-peaceably along the shore till they came to a shoal, upon which a few
-people were collected; here they stopped, and after a short conference,
-they all began to pray very loud: Tupia made his responses, but
-continued to tell us that they were not our friends. When their prayer,
-or, as they call it, their _Poorah_, was over, our people entered into a
-parley with them, telling them, that, if they would lay by their lances
-and clubs, for some had one and some the other, they would come on
-shore, and trade with them for whatever they would bring: they agreed,
-but it was only upon condition that we would leave behind us our
-musquets: this was a condition which, however equitable it might appear,
-could not be complied with, nor indeed would it have put the two parties
-upon an equality, except their numbers had been equal. Here then the
-negotiation seemed to be at an end; but in a little time they ventured
-to come nearer to the boat, and at last came near enough to trade, which
-they did very fairly, for a small quantity of their cloth and some of
-their weapons; but as they gave our people no hope of provisions, nor
-indeed any thing else, except they would venture through a narrow
-channel to the shore, which, all circumstances considered, they did not
-think it prudent to do, they put off the boat and left them.
-
-With the ship and the boat we had now made the circuit of the island,
-and finding that there was neither harbour nor anchorage about it, and
-that the hostile disposition of the people would render landing
-impracticable, without bloodshed, I determined not to attempt it, having
-no motive that could justify the risk of life.
-
-The bay which the boat entered lies on the west side of the island, the
-bottom was foul and rocky, but the water so clear that it could plainly
-be seen at the depth of five and twenty fathom, which is one hundred and
-fifty feet.
-
-This island is situated in the latitude of 22° 27ʹ S. and in the
-longitude of 150° 47ʹ W. from the meridian of Greenwich. It is thirteen
-miles in circuit, and rather high than low, but neither populous nor
-fertile in proportion to the other islands that we had seen in these
-seas. The chief produce seems to be the tree of which they make their
-weapons, called in their language _Etoa_; many plantations of it were
-seen along the shore, which is not surrounded, like the neighbouring
-islands, by a reef.
-
-The people seemed to be lusty and well made, rather browner than those
-we had left: under their arm-pits they had black marks about as broad as
-the hand, the edges of which formed not a straight but an indented line:
-they had also circles of the same colour, but not so broad, round their
-arms and legs, but were not marked on any other part of the body.
-
-Their dress was very different from any that we had seen before, as well
-as the cloth of which it was made. The cloth was of the same materials
-as that which is worn in the other islands, and most of that which was
-seen by our people was dyed of a bright but deep yellow, and covered on
-the outside with a composition like varnish, which was either red, or of
-a dark lead-colour; over this ground it was again painted in stripes of
-many different patterns, with wonderful regularity, in the manner of our
-striped silks in England: the cloth that was painted red was striped
-with black, and that which was painted lead-colour with white. Their
-habit was a short jacket of this cloth, which reached about as low as
-their knees; it was of one piece, and had no other making than a hole in
-the middle of it, stitched round with long stitches, in which it
-differed from all that we had seen before: through this hole the head
-was put, and what hung down was confined to their bodies by a piece of
-yellow cloth or sash, which, passing round the neck behind, was crossed
-upon the breast, and then collected round the waist like a belt, which
-passed over another belt of red cloth, so that they made a very gay and
-warlike appearance; some had caps of the feathers of the tropic bird,
-which have been before described, and some had a piece of white or
-lead-coloured cloth wound about the head like a small turban, which our
-people thought more becoming.
-
-Their arms were long lances, made of the Etoa, the wood of which is very
-hard; they were well polished and sharpened at one end: some were near
-twenty feet long, though not more than three fingers thick: they had
-also a weapon, which was both club and pike, made of the same wood,
-about seven feet long; this also was well polished, and sharpened at one
-end into a broad point. As a guard against these weapons, when they
-attack each other, they have matts folded up many times, which they
-place under their clothes from the neck to the waist: the weapons
-themselves indeed are capable of much less mischief than those of the
-same kind which we saw at the other islands, for the lances were there
-pointed with the sharp bone of the stingray that is called the sting,
-and the pikes were of much greater weight. The other things that we saw
-here were all superior in their kind to any we had seen before; the
-cloth was of a better colour in the dye, and painted with greater
-neatness and taste; the clubs were better cut and polished, and the
-canoe, though a small one, was very rich in ornament, and the carving
-was executed in a better manner: among other decorations peculiar to
-this canoe, was a line of small white feathers, which hung from the head
-and stern on the outside, and which, when we saw them, were thoroughly
-wetted by the spray.
-
-Tupia told us, that there were several islands lying at different
-distances, and in different directions from this, between the south and
-the north west; and that, at the distance of three days’ sail to the
-north-east, there was an island called MANUA, Bird-island: he seemed,
-however, most desirous that we should sail to the westward, and
-described several islands in that direction which he said he had
-visited: he told us that he had been ten or twelve days in going
-thither, and thirty in coming back, and that the _Pahie_ in which he had
-made the voyage, sailed much faster than the ship: reckoning his Pahie
-therefore to go at the rate of forty leagues a day, which, from my own
-observation, I have great reason to think these boats will do, it would
-make four hundred leagues in ten days, which I compute to be the
-distance of Boscawen and Keppel’s Islands, discovered by Captain Wallis,
-westward of Ulietea, and therefore think it very probable that they were
-the islands he had visited. The farthest island that he knew any thing
-of to the southward, he said, lay at the distance of about two days’
-sail from Oteroah, and was called MOUTOU; but he said that his father
-had told him there were islands to the southward of that: upon the
-whole, I was determined to stand southward in search of a continent, but
-to spend no time in searching for islands, if we did not happen to fall
-in with them during our course.
-
-
-
-
- BOOK II.
-
- CHAP. I.
-
- THE PASSAGE FROM OTEROAH TO NEW ZEALAND; INCIDENTS WHICH HAPPENED ON
- GOING A-SHORE THERE, AND WHILE THE SHIP LAY IN POVERTY BAY.
-
-
-WE sailed from Oteroah on the 15th of August, and on Friday the 25th we
-celebrated the anniversary of our leaving England, by taking a Cheshire
-cheese from a locker, where it had been carefully treasured up for this
-occasion, and tapping a cask of porter, which proved to be very good,
-and in excellent order. On the 29th, one of the sailors got so drunk,
-that the next morning he died: we thought at first that he could not
-have come honestly by the liquor, but we afterwards learnt that the
-boatswain, whose mate he was, had, in mere good-nature, given him part
-of a bottle of rum.
-
-On the 30th, we saw the comet; at one o’clock in the morning, it was a
-little above the horizon in the eastern part of the heavens; at about
-half an hour after four it passed the meridian, and its tail subtended
-an angle of forty-two degrees. Our latitude was 38° 20ʹ S., our
-longitude, by log, 147° 6ʹ W., and the variation of the needle, by the
-azimuth, 7° 9ʹ E. Among others that observed the comet, was Tupia, who
-instantly cried out, that as soon as it should be seen by the people of
-Bolabola, they would kill the inhabitants of Ulietea, who would, with
-the utmost precipitation, fly to the mountains.
-
-On the 1st of September, being in the latitude of 40° 22ʹ S., and
-longitude 147° 29ʹ W., and there not being any signs of land, with a
-heavy sea from the westward, and strong gales, I wore, and stood back to
-the northward, fearing that we might receive such damage in our sails
-and rigging, as would hinder the prosecution of the voyage.
-
-On the next day, there being strong gales to the westward, I brought to,
-with the ship’s head to the northward; but in the morning of the 3d, the
-wind being more moderate, we loosened the reef of the main-sail, set the
-top-sails, and plied to the westward.
-
-We continued our course till the 19th, when our latitude being 29° and
-our longitude 159° 29ʹ, we observed the variation to be 8° 32ʹ E. On the
-24th, being in latitude 33° 18ʹ, longitude 162° 51ʹ, we observed a small
-piece of sea-weed, and a piece of wood covered with barnacles: the
-variation here was 10° 48ʹ E.
-
-On the 27th, being in latitude 28° 59ʹ, longitude 169° 5ʹ, we saw a seal
-asleep upon the water, and several bunches of sea-weed. The next day we
-saw more sea-weed in bunches, and on the 29th, a bird, which we thought
-a land-bird; it somewhat resembled a snipe, but had a short bill. On the
-1st of October, we saw birds innumerable, and another seal asleep upon
-the water; it is a general opinion, that seals never go out of
-soundings, or far from land, but those that we saw in these seas prove
-the contrary. Rock-weed is, however, a certain indication that land is
-not far distant. The next day, it being calm, we hoisted out the boat,
-to try whether there was a current, but found none. Our latitude was 37°
-10ʹ, longitude 172° 54ʹ W. On the 3d, being in latitude 36° 56ʹ,
-longitude 173° 27ʹ, we took up more sea-weed, and another piece of wood
-covered with barnacles. The next day, we saw two more seals, and a brown
-bird, about as big as a raven, with some white feathers under the wing.
-Mr. Gore told us, that birds of this kind were seen in great numbers
-about Falkland’s Islands, and our people gave them the name of
-Port-Egmont hens.
-
-On the 5th, we thought the water changed colour, but, upon casting the
-lead, had no ground with 180 fathom. In the evening of this day, the
-variation was 12° 50ʹ E., and, while we were going nine leagues, it
-increased to 14° 2ʹ.
-
-On the next day, Friday, October the 6th, we saw land from the
-mast-head, bearing W. by N., and stood directly for it; in the evening,
-it could just be discerned from the deck, and appeared large. The
-variation this day was, by azimuth and amplitude, 15° 4-½ʹ E., and by
-observation made of the sun and moon, the longitude of the ship appeared
-to be 180° 55ʹ W., and by the medium of this and subsequent
-observations, there appeared to be an error in the ship’s account of
-longitude during her run from Otaheite of 3° 16ʹ, she being so much to
-the westward of the longitude resulting from the log. At midnight, I
-brought to and sounded, but had no ground with one hundred and seventy
-fathom.
-
-On the 7th, it fell calm, we therefore approached the land slowly, and
-in the afternoon, when a breeze sprung up, we were still distant seven
-or eight leagues. It appeared still larger as it was more distinctly
-seen, with four or five ranges of hills, rising one over the other, and
-a chain of mountains above all, which appeared to be of an enormous
-height. This land became the subject of much eager conversation; but the
-general opinion seemed to be that we had found the _Terra australis
-incognita_. About five o’clock, we saw the opening of a bay, which
-seemed to run pretty far inland, upon which we hauled our wind and stood
-in for it; we also saw smoke ascending from different places on shore.
-When night came on, however, we kept plying off and on till day-light,
-when we found ourselves to the leeward of the bay, the wind being at
-north: we could now perceive that the hills were clothed with wood, and
-that some of the trees in the valleys were very large. By noon we
-fetched in with the south-west point; but not being able to weather it,
-tacked and stood off: at this time we saw several canoes standing cross
-the bay, which, in a little time, made to shore, without seeming to take
-the least notice of the ship; we also saw some houses, which appeared to
-be small, but neat; and near one of them a considerable number of the
-people collected together, who were sitting upon the beach, and who, we
-thought, were the same that we had seen in the canoes. Upon a small
-peninsula, at the north-east head, we could plainly perceive a pretty
-high and regular paling, which inclosed the whole top of a hill; this
-was also the subject of much speculation, some supposing it to be a park
-of deer, others an inclosure for oxen and sheep. About four o’clock in
-the afternoon, we anchored on the north-west side of the bay, before the
-entrance of a small river, in ten fathom water, with a fine sandy
-bottom, and at about half a league from the shore. The sides of the bay
-are white cliffs of a great height; the middle is low land, with hills
-gradually rising behind, one towering above another, and terminating in
-the chain of mountains, which appeared to be far inland.
-
-In the evening I went on shore, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr.
-Solander, with the pinnace and yawl, and a party of men. We landed
-abreast of the ship, on the east side of the river, which was here about
-forty yards broad; but seeing some natives on the west side whom I
-wished to speak with, and finding the river not fordable, I ordered the
-yawl in to carry us over, and left the pinnace at the entrance. When we
-came near the place where the people were assembled, they all ran away;
-however, we landed, and leaving four boys to take care of the yawl, we
-walked up to some huts which were about two or three hundred yards from
-the water-side. When we had got some distance from the boat, four men,
-armed with long lances, rushed out of the woods, and running up to
-attack the boat, would certainly have cut her off, if the people in the
-pinnace had not discovered them, and called to the boys to drop down the
-stream: the boys instantly obeyed; but being closely pursued by the
-Indians, the Cockswain of the pinnace, who had the charge of the boats,
-fired a musket over their heads; at this they stopped and looked round
-them, but in a few minutes renewed the pursuit, brandishing their lances
-in a threatening manner: the Cockswain then fired a second musket over
-their heads, but of this they took no notice; and one of them lifting up
-his spear to dart it at the boat, another piece was fired, which shot
-him dead. When he fell, the other three stood motionless for some
-minutes, as if petrified with astonishment; as soon as they recovered,
-they went back, dragging after them the dead body, which however they
-soon left, that it might not encumber their flight. At the report of the
-first musket, we drew together, having straggled to a little distance
-from each other, and made the best of our way back to the boat; and
-crossing the river, we soon saw the Indian lying dead upon the ground.
-Upon examining the body, we found that he had been shot through the
-heart: he was a man of the middle size and stature; his complexion was
-brown, but not very dark; and one side of his face was tattowed in
-spiral lines of a very regular figure: he was covered with a fine cloth,
-of a manufacture altogether new to us, and it was tied on exactly
-according to the representation in Valentyn’s Account of Abel Tasman’s
-Voyage, vol. iii. part 2. page 50.: his hair also was tied in a knot on
-the top of his head, but had no feather in it. We returned immediately
-to the ship, where we could hear the people on shore talking with great
-earnestness, and in a very loud tone, probably about what had happened,
-and what should be done.
-
-In the morning, we saw several of the natives where they had been seen
-the night before, and some walking with a quick pace towards the place
-where we had landed, most of them unarmed; but three or four with long
-pikes in their hands. As I was desirous to establish an intercourse with
-them, I ordered three boats to be manned with seamen and marines, and
-proceeded towards the shore, accompanied by Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, the
-other gentlemen, and Tupia; about fifty of them seemed to wait for our
-landing, on the opposite side of the river, which we thought a sign of
-fear, and seated themselves upon the ground: at first, therefore,
-myself, with only Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and Tupia, landed from the
-little boat, and advanced towards them; but we had not proceeded many
-paces before they all started up, and every man produced either a long
-pike, or a small weapon of green Talc, extremely well polished, about a
-foot long, and thick enough to weigh four or five pounds: Tupia called
-to them in the language of Otaheite; but they answered only by
-flourishing their weapons, and making signs to us to depart; a musket
-was then fired wide of them, and the ball struck the water, the river
-being still between us; they saw the effect, and desisted from their
-threats: but we thought it prudent to retreat till the marines could be
-landed. This was soon done; and they marched, with a jack carried before
-them, to a little bank, about fifty yards from the water-side; here they
-were drawn up, and I again advanced, with Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander;
-Tupia, Mr. Green, and Mr. Monkhouse, being with us. Tupia was again
-directed to speak to them, and it was with great pleasure that we
-perceived he was perfectly understood, he and the natives speaking only
-different dialects of the same language. He told them that we wanted
-provision and water, and would give them iron in exchange, the
-properties of which he explained as well as he was able. They were
-willing to trade, and desired that we would come over to them for that
-purpose: to this we consented, provided they would lay by their arms;
-which, however, they could by no means be persuaded to do. During this
-conversation, Tupia warned us to be upon our guard, for that they were
-not our friends: we then pressed them in our turn to come over to us;
-and at last one of them stripped himself, and swam over without his
-arms: he was almost immediately followed by two more, and soon after by
-most of the rest, to the number of twenty or thirty; but these brought
-their arms with them. We made them all presents of iron and beads; but
-they seemed to set little value upon either, particularly the iron, not
-having the least idea of its use; so that we got nothing in return but a
-few feathers: they offered indeed to exchange their arms for ours, and,
-when we refused, made many attempts to snatch them out of our hands. As
-soon as they came over, Tupia repeated his declaration, that they were
-not our friends, and again warned us to be upon our guard; their
-attempts to snatch our weapons, therefore, did not succeed; and we gave
-them to understand by Tupia, that we should be obliged to kill them, if
-they offered any farther violence. In a few minutes, however, Mr. Green
-happening to turn about, one of them snatched away his hanger, and
-retiring to a little distance, waved it round his head, with a shout of
-exultation: the rest now began to be extremely insolent, and we saw more
-coming to join them from the opposite side of the river. It was
-therefore become necessary to repress them, and Mr. Banks fired at the
-man who had taken the hanger, with small shot, at the distance of about
-fifteen yards: when the shot struck him, he ceased his cry; but instead
-of returning the hanger, continued to flourish it over his head, at the
-same time slowly retreating to a greater distance. Mr. Monkhouse seeing
-this, fired at him with ball, and he instantly dropped. Upon this the
-main body, who had retired to a rock in the middle of the river upon the
-first discharge, began to return; two that were near to the man who had
-been killed, ran up to the body, one seized his weapon of green Talc,
-and the other endeavoured to secure the hanger, which Mr. Monkhouse had
-but just time to prevent. As all that had retired to the rock were now
-advancing, three of us discharged our pieces, loaded only with small
-shot, upon which they swam back for the shore; and we perceived, upon
-their landing, that two or three of them were wounded. They retired
-slowly up the country, and we reimbarked in our boats.
-
-As we had unhappily experienced, that nothing was to be done with these
-people at this place; and finding the water in the river to be salt, I
-proceeded in the boats round the head of the bay in search of fresh
-water, and with a design, if possible, to surprise some of the natives,
-and take them on board, where, by kind treatment and presents I might
-obtain their friendship, and by their means establish an amicable
-correspondence with their countrymen.
-
-To my great regret, I found no place where I could land, a dangerous
-surf every where beating upon the shore; but I saw two canoes coming in
-from the sea, one under sail, and the other worked with paddles. I
-thought this a favourable opportunity to get some of the people into my
-possession without mischief, as those in the canoe were probably
-fishermen, and without arms, and I had three boats full of men. I
-therefore disposed the boats so as most effectually to intercept them in
-their way to the shore; the people in the canoe that was paddled
-perceived us so soon, that, by making to the nearest land with their
-utmost strength, they escaped us; the other sailed on till she was in
-the midst of us without discerning what we were; but the moment she
-discovered us, the people on board struck their sail, and took to their
-paddles, which they plied so briskly that she out-ran the boat. They
-were however within hearing, and Tupia called out to them to come
-along-side, and promised for us that they should come to no hurt: they
-chose, however, rather to trust to their paddles than our promises, and
-continued to make from us with all their power. I then ordered a musket
-to be fired over their heads, as the least exceptionable expedient to
-accomplish my design, hoping it would either make them surrender, or
-leap into the water. Upon the discharge of the piece, they ceased
-paddling; and all of them, being seven in number, began to strip, as we
-imagined, to jump overboard; but it happened otherwise. They immediately
-formed a resolution not to fly, but to fight; and when the boat came up,
-they began the attack with their paddles, and with stones and other
-offensive weapons that were in the boat, so vigorously, that we were
-obliged to fire upon them in our own defence; four were unhappily
-killed, and the other three, who were boys, the eldest about nineteen,
-and the youngest about eleven, instantly leaped into the water; the
-eldest swam with great vigour, and resisted the attempts of our people
-to take him into the boat by every effort that he could make: he was
-however at last overpowered, and the other two were taken up with less
-difficulty. I am conscious that the feeling of every reader of humanity
-will censure me for having fired upon these unhappy people, and it is
-impossible that, upon a calm review, I should approve it myself. They
-certainly did not deserve death for not chusing to confide in my
-promises; or not consenting to come on board my boat, even if they had
-apprehended no danger; but the nature of my service required me to
-obtain a knowledge of their country, which I could no otherwise effect
-than by forcing my way into it in a hostile manner, or gaining admission
-through the confidence and good-will of the people. I had already tried
-the power of presents without effect; and I was now prompted, by my
-desire to avoid further hostilities, to get some of them on board, as
-the only method left of convincing them that we intended them no harm,
-and had it in our power to contribute to their gratification and
-convenience. Thus far my intentions certainly were not criminal; and
-though in the contest, which I had not the least reason to expect, our
-victory might have been complete without so great an expence of life;
-yet in such situations, when the command to fire has been given, no man
-can restrain its excess, or prescribe its effect.
-
-As soon as the poor wretches whom we had taken out of the water were in
-the boat, they squatted down, expecting no doubt instantly to be put to
-death: we made haste to convince them of the contrary, by every method
-in our power; we furnished them with clothes, and gave them every other
-testimony of kindness that could remove their fears and engage their
-good-will. Those who are acquainted with human nature will not wonder,
-that the sudden joy of these young savages at being unexpectedly
-delivered from the fear of death, and kindly treated by those whom they
-supposed would have been their instant executioners, surmounted their
-concern for the friends they had lost, and was strongly expressed in
-their countenances and behaviour. Before we reached the ship, their
-suspicions and fears being wholly removed, they appeared to be not only
-reconciled to their situation but in high spirits, and upon being
-offered some bread when they came on board, they devoured it with a
-voracious appetite. They answered and asked many questions, with great
-appearance of pleasure and curiosity; and when our dinner came, they
-expressed an inclination to taste every thing that they saw: they seemed
-best pleased with the salt pork, though we had other provisions upon the
-table. At sun-set, they eat another meal with great eagerness, each
-devouring a large quantity of bread, and drinking above a quart of
-water. We then made them beds upon the lockers, and they went to sleep
-with great seeming content. In the night, however, the tumult of their
-minds having subsided, and given way to reflection, they sighed often
-and loud. Tupia, who was always upon the watch to comfort them, got up,
-and by soothing and encouragement made them not only easy but cheerful;
-their cheerfulness was encouraged so that they sung a song with a degree
-of taste that surprised us: the tune was solemn and slow, like those of
-our Psalms, containing many notes and semi-tones. Their countenances
-were intelligent and expressive, and the middlemost, who seemed to be
-about fifteen, had an openness in his aspect, and an ease in his
-deportment, which were very striking: we found that the two eldest were
-brothers, and that their names were TAAHOURANGE and KOIKERANGE; the name
-of the youngest was MARAGOVETE. As we were returning to the ship, after
-having taken these boys into the boat, we picked up a large piece of
-pumice-stone floating upon the water; a sure sign that there either is,
-or has been a volcano in this neighbourhood.
-
-In the morning, they all seemed to be cheerful, and ate another enormous
-meal; after this we dressed them, and adorned them with bracelets,
-anclets, and necklaces, after their own fashion, and the boat being
-hoisted out, they were told that we were going to set them ashore: this
-produced a transport of joy; but upon perceiving that we made towards
-our first landing-place near the river, their countenances changed, and
-they entreated with great earnestness that they might not be set ashore
-at that place, because they said, it was inhabited by their enemies, who
-would kill them and eat them. This was a great disappointment to me;
-because I hoped the report and appearance of the boys would procure a
-favourable reception for ourselves. I had already sent an officer on
-shore with the marines and a party of men to cut wood, and I was
-determined to land near the place; not, however, to abandon the boys,
-if, when we got ashore, they should be unwilling to leave us; but to
-send a boat with them in the evening to that part of the bay to which
-they pointed, and which they call their home. Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander,
-and Tupia, were with me, and upon our landing with the boys, and
-crossing the river, they seemed at first to be unwilling to leave us;
-but at length they suddenly changed their mind, and, though not without
-a manifest struggle, and some tears, they took their leave: when they
-were gone, we proceeded along a swamp, with a design to shoot some
-ducks, of which we saw great plenty, and four of the marines attended
-us, walking abreast of us upon a bank that overlooked the country. After
-we had advanced about a mile, these men called out to us and told us,
-that a large body of the Indians was in sight, and advancing at a great
-rate. Upon receiving this intelligence, we drew together, and resolved
-to make the best of our way to the boats; we had scarcely begun to put
-this into execution, when the three Indian boys started suddenly from
-some bushes, where they had concealed themselves, and again claimed our
-protection: we readily received them, and repairing to the beach as the
-clearest place, we walked briskly towards the boats. The Indians were in
-two bodies; one ran along the bank which had been quitted by the
-marines, the other fetched a compass by the swamp, so that we could not
-see them: when they perceived that we had formed into one body, they
-slackened their pace, but still followed us in a gentle walk; that they
-slackened their pace, was for us, as well as for them, a fortunate
-circumstance; for when we came to the side of the river, where we
-expected to find the boats that were to carry us over to the wooders, we
-found the pinnace at least a mile from her station, having been sent to
-pick up a bird which had been shot by the officer on shore, and the
-little boat was obliged to make three trips before we could all get over
-to the rest of the party. As soon as we were drawn up on the other side,
-the Indians came down, not in a body as we expected, but by two or three
-at a time, all armed, and in a short time their number increased to
-about two hundred: as we now despaired of making peace with them, seeing
-that the dread of our small arms did not keep them at a distance, and
-that the ship was too far off to reach the place with a shot, we
-resolved to re-imbark, lest our stay should embroil us in another
-quarrel, and cost more of the Indians their lives. We therefore advanced
-towards the pinnace, which was now returning, when one of the boys
-suddenly cried out, that his uncle was among the people who had marched
-down to us, and desired us to stay and talk with them: we complied, and
-a parley immediately commenced between them and Tupia; during which the
-boys held up every thing we had given them as tokens of our kindness and
-liberality; but neither would either of the boys swim over to them, or
-any of them to the boys. The body of the man who had been killed the day
-before, still lay exposed upon the beach; the boys seeing it lie very
-near us, went up to it, and covered it with some of the clothes that we
-had given them; and soon after a single man, unarmed, who proved to be
-the uncle of Maragovete, the youngest of the boys, swam over to us,
-bringing in his hand a green branch, which we supposed, as well here as
-at Otaheite, to be an emblem of peace. We received his branch by the
-hands of Tupia, to whom he gave it, and made him many presents; we also
-invited him to go on board the ship, but he declined it; we therefore
-left him, and expected that his nephew, and the two other young Indians
-would have staid with him, but to our great surprise, they chose rather
-to go with us. As soon as we had retired, he went and gathered another
-green branch, and with this in his hand, he approached the dead body
-which the youth had covered with part of his clothes, walking sideways,
-with many ceremonies, and then throwing it towards him. When this was
-done, he returned to his companions, who had sat down upon the sand to
-observe the issue of his negociation: they immediately gathered round
-him, and continued in a body above an hour, without seeming to take any
-farther notice of us. We were more curious than they, and observing them
-with our glasses from on board the ship, we saw some of them cross the
-river upon a kind of raft, or catamarine, and four of them carry off the
-dead body which had been covered by the boy, and over which his uncle
-had performed the ceremony of the branch, upon a kind of bier, between
-four men: the other body was still suffered to remain where it had been
-first left.
-
-After dinner, I directed Tupia to ask the boys, if they had now any
-objection to going ashore, where we had left their uncle, the body
-having been carried off, which we understood was a ratification of
-peace: they said, they had not; and the boat being ordered, they went
-into it with great alacrity: when the boat, in which I had sent two
-midshipmen, came to land, they went willingly ashore; but soon after she
-put off, they returned to the rocks, and wading into the water,
-earnestly entreated to be taken on board again; but the people in the
-boat, having positive orders to leave them, could not comply. We were
-very attentive to what happened on shore, and keeping a constant watch
-with our glasses, we saw a man pass the river upon another raft, and
-fetch them to a place where forty or fifty of the natives were
-assembled, who closed round them, and continued in the same place till
-sun-set: upon looking again, when we saw them in motion, we could
-plainly distinguish our three prisoners, who separated themselves from
-the rest, came down to the beach, and having waved their hands three
-times towards the ship, ran nimbly back, and joined their companions,
-who walked leisurely away towards that part which the boys had pointed
-to as their dwelling-place; we had therefore the greatest reason to
-believe that no mischief would happen to them, especially as we
-perceived that they went off in the clothes we had given them.
-
-After it was dark, loud voices were heard on shore in the bottom of the
-bay as usual, of which we could never learn the meaning.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. II.
-
-A DESCRIPTION OF POVERTY BAY, AND THE FACE OF THE ADJACENT COUNTRY. THE
- RANGE FROM THENCE TO CAPE TURNAGAIN, AND BACK TO TOLAGA, WITH SOME
- ACCOUNT OF THE PEOPLE AND THE COUNTRY, AND SEVERAL INCIDENTS THAT
- HAPPENED ON THAT PART OF THE COAST.
-
-
-THE next morning, at six o’clock, we weighed, and stood away from this
-unfortunate and inhospitable place, to which I gave the name of POVERTY
-BAY, and which by the natives is called TAONEROA, or Long Sand, as it
-did not afford us a single article that we wanted, except a little wood.
-It lies in latitude 38° 42ʹ S. and longitude 181° 36ʹ W.; it is in the
-form of an horse-shoe, and is known by an island lying close under the
-north-east point: the two points which form the entrance are high, with
-steep white cliffs, and lie a league and a half, or two leagues from
-each other, N. E. by E. and S. W. by W.; the depth of water in the bay
-is from twelve to five fathom, with a sandy bottom and good anchorage;
-but the situation is open to the wind between the south and east: boats
-can go in and out of the river at any time of the tide in fine weather;
-but as there is a bar at the entrance, no boat can go either in or out
-when the sea runs high: the best place to attempt it, is on the
-north-east side, and it is there practicable when it is not so in any
-other part. The shore of the bay, a little within its entrance, is a low
-flat sand; behind which, at a small distance, the face of the country is
-finely diversified by hills and valleys, all clothed with wood, and
-covered with verdure. The country also appears to be well inhabited,
-especially in the valleys leading up from the bay, where we daily saw
-smoke rising in clouds one behind another, to a great distance, till the
-view terminated in mountains of a stupendous height.
-
-The south-west point of the bay I named YOUNG NICK’S HEAD, after
-Nicholas Young, the boy who first saw the land; at noon, it bore N. W.
-by W. distant about three or four leagues, and we were then about three
-miles from the shore. The main land extended from N. E. by N. to south,
-and I proposed to follow the direction of the coast to the southward as
-far as the latitude of 40 or 41; and then, if I met with no
-encouragement to proceed farther, to return to the northward.
-
-In the afternoon we lay becalmed, which the people on shore perceiving,
-several canoes put off, and came within less than a quarter of a mile of
-the vessel; but could not be persuaded to come nearer, though Tupia
-exerted all the powers of his lungs and his eloquence upon the occasion,
-shouting, and promising that they should not be hurt. Another canoe was
-now seen coming from Poverty Bay, with only four people on board, one of
-whom we well remembered to have seen in our first interview upon the
-rock. This canoe, without stopping or taking the least notice of the
-others, came directly alongside of the ship, and with very little
-persuasion, we got the Indians on board. Their example was soon followed
-by the rest, and we had about us seven canoes, and about fifty men. We
-made them all presents with a liberal hand; notwithstanding which, they
-were so desirous to have more of our commodities, that they sold us
-every thing they had, even the clothes from their backs, and the paddles
-from their boats. There were but two weapons among them, these were the
-instruments of green talc, which were shaped somewhat like a pointed
-battledore, with a short handle and sharp edges; they were called
-_Patoo-patoo_, and were well contrived for close-fighting, as they would
-certainly split the thickest skull at a single blow.
-
-When these people had recovered from the first impressions of fear,
-which, notwithstanding their resolution in coming on board, had
-manifestly thrown them into some confusion, we inquired after our poor
-boys. The man who first came on board immediately answered, that they
-were unhurt and at home; adding, that he had been induced to venture on
-board by the account which they had given him of the kindness with which
-they had been treated, and the wonders which were contained in the ship.
-
-While they were on board they showed every sign of friendship, and
-invited us very cordially to go back to our old bay, or to a small cove
-which they pointed out, that was not quite so far off; but I chose
-rather to prosecute my discoveries than go back, having reason to hope
-that I should find a better harbour than any I had yet seen.
-
-About an hour before sun-set, the canoes put off from the ship with the
-few paddles they had reserved, which were scarcely sufficient to set
-them on shore; but by some means or other three of their people were
-left behind: as soon as we discovered it, we hailed them; but not one of
-them would return to take them on board: this greatly surprised us; but
-we were surprised still more to observe that the deserted Indians did
-not seem at all uneasy at their situation, but entertained us with
-dancing and singing after their manner, eat their suppers, and went
-quietly to bed.
-
-A light breeze springing up soon after it was dark, we steered along the
-shore under an easy sail till midnight, and then brought to, soon after
-which it fell calm; we were now some leagues distant from the place
-where the canoes had left us, and at day-break, when the Indians
-perceived it, they were seized with consternation and terror, and
-lamented their situation in loud complaints, with gestures of despair
-and many tears. Tupia, with great difficulty, pacified them; and about
-seven o’clock in the morning, a light breeze springing up, we continued
-to stand south-west along the shore. Fortunately for our poor Indians,
-two canoes came off about this time, and made towards the ship: they
-stopped, however, at a little distance, and seemed unwilling to trust
-themselves nearer. Our Indians were greatly agitated in this state of
-uncertainty, and urged their fellows to come alongside of the ship, both
-by their voice and gestures, with the utmost eagerness and impatience.
-Tupia interpreted what they said, and we were much surprised to find,
-that, among other arguments, they assured the people in the canoes, we
-did not eat men. We now began seriously to believe that this horrid
-custom prevailed among them; for what the boys had said, we considered
-as a mere hyperbolical expression of their fear. One of the canoes, at
-length, ventured to come under the ship’s side; and an old man came on
-board, who seemed to be a chief from the finery of his garment, and the
-superiority of his weapon, which was a Patoo-patoo, made of bone, that,
-as he said, had belonged to a whale. He staid on board but a short time,
-and when he went away, he took with him our guests, very much to the
-satisfaction both of them and us.
-
-At the time when we sailed, we were abreast of a point, from which the
-land trends S. S. W. and which on account of its figure, I called CAPE
-TABLE. This point lies seven leagues to the southward of Poverty Bay, in
-latitude 39° 7ʹ S. and longitude 181° 36ʹ W.; it is of a considerable
-height, makes a sharp angle, and appears to be quite flat at the top.
-
-In steering along the shore to the southward of the Cape, at the
-distance of two or three miles, our soundings were from twenty to thirty
-fathom, having a chain of rocks between us and the shore, which appeared
-at different heights above the water.
-
-At noon, Cape Table bore N. 20 E. distant about four leagues, and a
-small island, which was the southernmost land in sight, bore S. 70 W. at
-the distance of about three miles. This island, which the natives call
-TEAHOWRAY, I named the ISLAND OF PORTLAND, from its very great
-resemblance to Portland, in the English Channel: it lies about a mile
-from a point on the main; but there appears to be a ridge of rocks,
-extending nearly, if not quite, from one to the other. N. 57 E. two
-miles from the south point of Portland, lies a sunken rock, upon which
-the sea breaks with great violence. We passed between this rock and the
-land, having from seventeen to twenty fathom.
-
-In sailing along the shore, we saw the natives assembled in great
-numbers as well upon Portland island as the main: we could also
-distinguish several spots of ground that were cultivated; some seemed to
-be fresh turned up, and lay in furrows like ploughed land, and some had
-plants upon them in different stages of their growth. We saw also in two
-places, high rails upon the ridges of hills, like what we had seen upon
-the peninsula at the north-east head of Poverty Bay: as they were ranged
-in lines only, and not so as to inclose an area, we could not guess at
-their use, and therefore supposed they might be the work of
-superstition.
-
-About noon another canoe appeared, in which were four men; she came
-within about a quarter of a mile of us, where the people on board seemed
-to perform divers ceremonies: one of them who was in the bow, sometimes
-seemed to ask and to offer peace, and sometimes to threaten war, by
-brandishing a weapon that he held in his hand: sometimes also he danced,
-and sometimes he sung. Tupia talked much to him, but could not persuade
-him to come to the ship.
-
-Between one and two o’clock we discovered land to the westward of
-Portland, extending to the southward as far as we could see; and as the
-ship was hauling round the south end of the island, she suddenly fell
-into shoal water and broken ground: we had indeed always seven fathom or
-more, but the soundings were never twice the same, jumping at once from
-seven fathom to eleven; in a short time, however, we got clear of all
-danger, and had again deep water under us.
-
-At this time the island lay within a mile of us, making in white cliffs,
-and a long spit of low land running from it towards the main. On the
-sides of these cliffs sat vast numbers of people, looking at us with a
-fixed attention, and it is probable that they perceived some appearance
-of hurry and confusion on board, and some irregularity in the working of
-the ship, while we were getting clear of the shallow water and broken
-ground, from which they might infer that we were alarmed or in distress:
-we thought that they wished to take advantage of our situation, for five
-canoes were put off with the utmost expedition, full of men, and well
-armed: they came so near, and showed so hostile a disposition by
-shouting, brandishing their lances, and using threatening gestures, that
-we were in some pain for our small boat, which was still employed in
-sounding: a musket was therefore fired over them, but finding it did
-them no harm, they seemed rather to be provoked than intimidated, and I
-therefore fired a four-pounder, charged with grape-shot, wide of them:
-this had a better effect; upon the report of the piece they all rose up
-and shouted, but instead of continuing the chace, drew altogether, and
-after a short consultation, went quietly away.
-
-Having got round Portland, we hauled in for the land N. W. having a
-gentle breeze at N. E. which about five o’clock died away, and obliged
-us to anchor; we had one-and-twenty fathom, with a fine sandy bottom:
-the south point of Portland bore S. E. ½ S. distant about two leagues,
-and a low point on the main bore N. ½ E. In the same direction with this
-low point, there runs a deep bay, behind the land of which Cape Table is
-the extremity, so as to make this land a peninsula, leaving only a low
-narrow neck between that and the main. Of this peninsula, which the
-natives call TERAKACO, Cape Table is the north point, and Portland the
-south.
-
-While we lay at anchor, two more canoes came off to us, one armed, and
-the other a small fishing boat, with only four men in her; they came so
-near that they entered into conversation with Tupia; they answered all
-the questions that he asked them with great civility, but could not be
-persuaded to come on board; they came near enough, however, to receive
-several presents that were thrown to them from the ship, with which they
-seemed much pleased, and went away. During the night many fires were
-kept upon shore, probably to show us that the inhabitants were too much
-upon their guard to be surprised.
-
-About five o’clock in the morning of the 13th, a breeze springing up
-northerly, we weighed, and steered in for the land. The shore here forms
-a large bay, of which Portland is the north-east point, and the bay,
-that runs behind Cape Table, an arm. This arm I had a great inclination
-to examine, because there appeared to be safe anchorage in it, but not
-being sure of that, and the wind being right on end, I was unwilling to
-spare the time. Four-and-twenty fathom was the greatest depth within
-Portland, but the ground was every where clear. The land near the shore
-is of a moderate height, with white cliffs and sandy beaches; within, it
-rises into mountains, and upon the whole the surface is hilly, for the
-most part covered with wood, and to appearance pleasant and fertile. In
-the morning nine canoes came after the ship, but whether with peaceable
-or hostile intentions we could not tell, for we soon left them behind
-us.
-
-In the evening we stood in for a place that had the appearance of an
-opening, but found no harbour; we therefore stood out again, and were
-soon followed by a large canoe, with eighteen or twenty men, all armed,
-who, though they could not reach us, shouted defiance, and brandished
-their weapons, with many gestures of menace and insult.
-
-In the morning we had a view of the mountains inland, upon which the
-snow was still lying: the country near the shore was low and unfit for
-culture, but in one place we perceived a patch of somewhat yellow, which
-had greatly the appearance of a cornfield, yet was probably nothing more
-than some dead flags, which are not uncommon in swampy places: at some
-distance we saw groves of trees, which appeared high and tapering, and
-being not above two leagues from the south-west cod of the great bay, in
-which we had been coasting for the two last days, I hoisted out the
-pinnace and long-boat to search for fresh water; but just as they were
-about to put off, we saw several boats full of people coming from the
-shore, and, therefore, I did not think it safe for them to leave the
-ship. About ten o’clock, five of these boats having drawn together, as
-if to hold a consultation, made towards the ship, having on board
-between eighty and ninety men, and four more followed at some distance,
-as if to sustain the attack: when the first five came within about a
-hundred yards of the ship, they began to sing their war-song, and
-brandishing their pikes, prepared for an engagement. We had now no time
-to lose, for if we could not prevent the attack, we should come under
-the unhappy necessity of using our fire-arms against them, which we were
-very desirous to avoid. Tupia, was therefore, ordered to acquaint them
-that we had weapons which, like thunder, would destroy them in a moment;
-that we would immediately convince them of their power by directing
-their effect so that they should not be hurt; but that if they persisted
-in any hostile attempt, we should be obliged to use them for our
-defence: a four-pounder, loaded with grape-shot, was then discharged
-wide of them, which produced the desired effect; the report, the flash,
-and above all, the shot, which spread very far in the water, so
-intimidated them, that they began to paddle away with all their might:
-Tupia, however, calling after them, and assuring them that if they would
-come unarmed, they should be kindly received; the people in one of the
-boats put their arms on board of another, and came under the ship’s
-stern; we made them several presents, and should certainly have
-prevailed upon them to come on board, if the other canoes had not come
-up, and again threatened us, by shouting and brandishing their weapons:
-at this the people who had come to the ship unarmed, expressed great
-displeasure, and soon after they all went away.
-
-In the afternoon we stood over to the south point of the bay, but not
-reaching it before it was dark, we stood off and on all night. At eight
-the next morning, being a-breast of the point, several fishing boats
-came off to us, and sold us some stinking fish: it was the best they
-had, and we were willing to trade with them upon any terms: these people
-behaved very well, and we should have parted good friends if it had not
-been for a large canoe, with two-and-twenty armed men on board, which
-came boldly up along-side of the ship. We soon saw that this boat had
-nothing for traffic, yet we gave them two or three pieces of cloth, an
-article which they seemed very fond of. I observed that one man had a
-black skin thrown over him, somewhat resembling that of a bear, and
-being desirous to know what animal was its first owner, I offered him
-for it a piece of red baize, and he seemed greatly pleased with the
-bargain, immediately pulling off the skin, and holding it up in the
-boat; he would not, however, part with it till he had the cloth in his
-possession, and as there could be no transfer of property, if with equal
-caution I had insisted upon the same condition, I ordered the cloth to
-be handed down to him, upon which, with amazing coolness, instead of
-sending up the skin, he began to pack up both that and the baize, which
-he had received as the purchase of it, in a basket, without paying the
-least regard to my demand or remonstrances, and soon after, with the
-fishing boats, put off from the ship; when they were at some distance,
-they drew together, and after a short consultation returned; the
-fishermen offered more fish, which, though good for nothing, was
-purchased, and trade was again renewed. Among others who were placed
-over the ship’s side to hand up what we bought, was little Tayeto,
-Tupia’s boy; and one of the Indians, watching his opportunity, suddenly
-seized him, and dragged him down into the canoe; two of them held him
-down in the forepart of it, and the others, with great activity, paddled
-her off, the rest of the canoes following as fast as they could; upon
-this the marines, who were under arms upon deck, were ordered to fire.
-The shot was directed to that part of the canoe which was farthest from
-the boy, and rather wide of her, being willing rather to miss the rowers
-than to hurt him: it happened, however, that one man dropped, upon which
-the others quitted their hold of the boy, who instantly leaped into the
-water, and swam towards the ship; the large canoe immediately pulled
-round and followed him, but some musquets, and a great gun being fired
-at her, she desisted from the pursuit. The ship being brought to, a boat
-was lowered, and the poor boy taken up unhurt, though so terrified, that
-for a time he seemed to be deprived of his senses. Some of the gentlemen
-who traced the canoes to shore with their glasses, said, that they saw
-three men carried up the beach, who appeared to be either dead, or
-wholly disabled by their wounds.
-
-To the cape off which this unhappy transaction happened, I gave the name
-of CAPE KIDNAPPERS. It lies in latitude 39° 43ʹ, and longitude 182° 24ʹ
-W., and is rendered remarkable by two white rocks like hay stacks, and
-the high white cliffs on each side. It lies S. W. by W. distant thirteen
-leagues from the isle of Portland; and between them is the bay of which
-it is the south point, and which, in honour of Sir Edward Hawke, then
-First Lord of the Admiralty, I called HAWKE’S BAY. We found in it from
-twenty-four to seven fathom, and good anchorage. From Cape Kidnappers
-the land trends S. S. W., and in this direction we made our run along
-the shore, keeping at about a league distance, with a steady breeze and
-clear weather.
-
-As soon as Tayeto recovered from his fright, he brought a fish to Tupia,
-and told him that he intended it as an offering to his Eatua, or god, in
-gratitude for his escape; Tupia commended his piety, and ordered him to
-throw the fish into the sea, which was accordingly done.
-
-About two o’clock in the afternoon, we passed a small but high white
-island lying close to the shore, upon which we saw many houses, boats,
-and people. The people we concluded to be fishers, because the island
-was totally barren; we saw several people also on shore, in a small bay
-upon the main, within the island. At eleven, we brought to till
-day-light, and then made sail to the southward, along the shore. About
-seven o’clock we passed a high point of land, which lies S. S. W. twelve
-leagues from Cape Kidnappers: from this point the land trends
-three-fourths of a point more to the westward; at ten, we saw more land
-open to the southward, and at noon, the southernmost land that was in
-sight, bore S. 39 W. distant eight or ten leagues, and a high bluff
-head, with yellowish cliffs, bore W. distant about two miles: the depth
-of water was thirty-two fathom.
-
-In the afternoon we had a fresh breeze at west, and during the night
-variable light airs and calms: in the morning a gentle breeze sprung up
-between the N. W. and N. E., and having till now stood to the southward,
-without seeing any probability of meeting with a harbour, and the
-country manifestly altering for the worse, I thought that standing
-farther in that direction would be attended with no advantage, but on
-the contrary would be a loss of time that might be employed with a
-better prospect of success in examining the coast to the northward;
-about one, therefore, in the afternoon, I tacked, and stood north, with
-a fresh breeze at west. The high bluff head, with yellowish cliffs,
-which we were abreast of at noon, I called CAPE TURNAGAIN, because here
-we turned back. It lies in latitude 40° 34ʹ S. longitude 182° 55ʹ W.,
-distant eighteen leagues S. S. W. and S. S. W. ½ W. from Cape
-Kidnappers. The land between them is of a very unequal height; in some
-places it is lofty next the sea with white cliffs, in others low, with
-sandy beaches: the face of the country is not so well clothed with wood
-as it is about Hawke’s bay, but looks more like our high downs in
-England: it is, however, to all appearance, well inhabited; for as we
-stood along the shore, we saw several villages, not only in the valleys,
-but on the tops and sides of the hills, and smoke in many other places.
-The ridge of mountains which has been mentioned before, extends to the
-southward farther than we could see, and was then every where chequered
-with snow. At night we saw two fires, inland, so very large, that we
-concluded they must have been made to clear the land for tillage; but
-however that be, they are a demonstration that the part of the country
-where they appeared is inhabited.
-
-On the 18th, at four o’clock in the morning, Cape Kidnappers bore N. 32
-W. distant two leagues: in this situation we had sixty-two fathom, and
-when the cape bore W. by N. distant three or four leagues, we had
-forty-five fathom: in the mid-way between the isle of Portland and the
-cape we had sixty-five fathom. In the evening, being abreast of the
-peninsula, within Portland island, called TERAKAKO, a canoe came off
-from that shore, and with much difficulty overtook the ship; there were
-on board five people, two of whom appeared to be chiefs, and the other
-three servants: the chiefs, with very little invitation, came on board,
-and ordered the rest to remain in their canoe. We treated them with
-great kindness, and they were not backward in expressing their
-satisfaction; they went down into the cabin, and after a short time told
-us that they had determined not to go on shore till the next morning. As
-the sleeping on board was an honour which we neither expected nor
-desired, I remonstrated strongly against it, and told them, that on
-their account it would not be proper, as the ship would probably be at a
-great distance from where she was then, the next morning: they
-persisted, however, in their resolution, and as I found it impossible to
-get rid of them without turning them by force out of the ship, I
-complied: as a proper precaution, however, I proposed to take their
-servants also on board, and hoist their canoe into the ship; they made
-no objection, and this was accordingly done. The countenance of one of
-these chiefs was the most open and ingenuous of all I have ever seen,
-and I very soon gave up every suspicion of his having any sinister
-design: they both examined every thing they saw with great curiosity and
-attention, and received very thankfully such little presents as we made
-them; neither of them, however, could be persuaded either to eat or
-drink, but their servants devoured every thing they could get with great
-voracity. We found that these men had heard of our kindness and
-liberality to the natives who had been on board before, yet we thought
-the confidence they placed in us, an extraordinary instance of their
-fortitude. At night I brought to till day-light, and then made sail; at
-seven in the morning, I brought to again under Cape Table, and sent away
-our guests with their canoe, who expressed some surprise at seeing
-themselves so far from home, but landed abreast of the ship. At this
-time I saw other canoes putting off from the shore, but I stood away to
-the northward without waiting for their coming up.
-
-About three, I passed a remarkable head-land, which I called
-GABLE-END-FORELAND, from the very great likeness of the white cliff at
-the point, to the gable-end of a house: it is not more remarkable for
-its figure, than for a rock which rises like a spire at a little
-distance. It lies from Cape Table N. 24 E. distant about twelve leagues.
-The shore between them forms a bay, within which lies Poverty Bay, at
-the distance of four leagues from the head-land, and eight from the
-Cape. At this place three canoes came off to us, and one man came on
-board; we gave him some trifles, and he soon returned to his boat,
-which, with all the rest, dropped astern.
-
-In the morning I made sail in shore, in order to look into two bays,
-which appeared about two leagues to the northward of the Foreland; the
-southernmost I could not fetch, but I anchored in the other about eleven
-o’clock.
-
-Into this bay we were invited by the people on board many canoes, who
-pointed to a place where they said there was plenty of fresh water: I
-did not find so good a shelter from the sea as I expected; but the
-natives who came about us, appearing to be of a friendly disposition, I
-was determined to try whether I could not get some knowledge of the
-country here before I proceeded farther to the northward.
-
-In one of the canoes that came about us as soon as we anchored, we saw
-two men, who by their habits appeared to be chiefs: one of them was
-dressed in a jacket, which was ornamented, after their manner, with
-dog’s skin; the jacket of the other was almost covered with small tufts
-of red feathers. These men I invited on board, and they entered the ship
-with very little hesitation: I gave each of them about four yards of
-linen, and a spike-nail; with the linen they were much pleased, but
-seemed to set no value upon the nail. We perceived that they knew what
-had happened in Poverty Bay, and we had therefore no reason to doubt but
-that they would behave peaceably; however, for further security, Tupia
-was ordered to tell them for what purpose we came thither, and to assure
-them that we would offer them no injury, if they offered none to us. In
-the mean time those who remained in the canoes traded with our people
-very fairly for what they happened to have with them: the chiefs, who
-were old men, staid with us till we had dined, and about two o’clock I
-put off with the boats, manned and armed, in order to go on shore in
-search of water, and the two chiefs went into the boat with me. The
-afternoon was tempestuous, with much rain, and the surf every where ran
-so high, that although we rowed almost round the bay, we found no place
-where we could land: I determined therefore to return to the ship, which
-being intimated to the chiefs, they called to the people on shore, and
-ordered a canoe to be sent off for themselves; this was accordingly
-done, and they left us, promising to come on board again in the morning,
-and bring us some fish and sweet potatoes.
-
-In the evening, the weather having become fair and moderate, the boats
-were again ordered out, and I landed, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr.
-Solander. We were received with great expressions of friendship by the
-natives, who behaved with a scrupulous attention not to give offence. In
-particular, they took care not to appear in great bodies: one family, or
-the inhabitants of two or three houses only, were generally placed
-together, to the number of fifteen or twenty, consisting of men, women,
-and children. These little companies sat upon the ground, not advancing
-towards us, but inviting us to them, by a kind of beckon, moving one
-hand towards the breast. We made them several little presents; and in
-our walk round the bay found two small streams of fresh water. This
-convenience, and the friendly behaviour of the people, determined me to
-stay at least a day, that I might fill some of my empty casks, and give
-Mr. Banks an opportunity of examining the natural produce of the
-country.
-
-In the morning of, the 21st, I sent lieutenant Gore on shore, to
-superintend the watering, with a strong party of men; and they were soon
-followed by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, with Tupia, Tayeto, and four
-others.
-
-The natives sat by our people, and seemed pleased to observe them; but
-did not intermix with them: they traded, however, chiefly for cloth, and
-after a short time applied to their ordinary occupations, as if no
-stranger had been among them. In the forenoon, several of their boats
-went out a-fishing, and at dinner time every one repaired to his
-respective dwelling; from which, after a certain time, he returned.
-These fair appearances encouraged Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander to range
-the bay with very little precaution, where they found many plants, and
-shot some birds of exquisite beauty. In their walk, they visited several
-houses of the natives, and saw something of their manner of life; for
-they showed, without any reserve, every thing which the gentlemen
-desired to see. They were sometimes found at their meals, which the
-approach of the strangers never interrupted. Their food at this season
-consisted of fish, with which, instead of bread, they eat the root of a
-kind of fern, very like that which grows upon our commons in England.
-These roots they scorch over the fire, and then beat with a stick, till
-the bark and dry outside fall off; what remains is a soft substance,
-somewhat clammy and sweet, not unpleasing to the taste, but mixed with
-three or four times its quantity of strings and fibres, which are very
-disagreeable; these were swallowed by some, but spit out by the far
-greater number, who had baskets under them to receive the rejected part
-of what had been chewed, which had an appearance very like that of
-tobacco in the same state, in other seasons they have certainly plenty
-of excellent vegetables; but no tame animals were seen among them except
-dogs, which were very small and ugly. Mr. Banks saw some of their
-plantations, where the ground was as well broken down and tilled as even
-in the gardens of the most curious people among us: in these spots were
-sweet potatoes, coccos or eddas, which are well known and much esteemed
-both in the East and West Indies, and some gourds: the sweet potatoes
-were planted in small hills, some ranged in rows, and others in
-quincunx, all laid by a line with the greatest regularity: the coccos
-were planted upon flat land, but none of them yet appeared above ground;
-and the gourds were set in small hollows, or dishes, much as in England.
-These plantations were of different extent, from one or two acres to
-ten: taken together, there appeared to be from 150 to 200 acres in
-cultivation in the whole bay, though we never saw an hundred people.
-Each district was fenced in, generally with reeds, which were placed so
-close together that there was scarcely room for a mouse to creep
-between.
-
-The women were plain, and made themselves more so by painting their
-faces with red ochre and oil, which, being generally fresh and wet upon
-their cheeks and foreheads, was easily transferred to the noses of those
-who thought fit to salute them; and that they were not wholly averse to
-such familiarity, the noses of several of our people strongly testified:
-they were, however, as great coquets as any of the most fashionable
-ladies in Europe, and the young ones as skittish as an unbroken filly:
-each of them wore a petticoat, under which there was a girdle, made of
-the blades of grass highly perfumed, and to the girdle was fastened a
-small bunch of the leaves of some fragrant plant, which served their
-modesty as its innermost veil. The faces of the men were not so
-generally painted, yet we saw one whose whole body, and even his
-garments, were rubbed over with dry ochre, of which he kept a piece
-constantly in his hand, and was every minute renewing the decoration in
-one part or another, where he supposed it was become deficient. In
-personal delicacy they were not equal to our friends at Otaheite, for
-the coldness of the climate did not invite them so often to bathe; but
-we saw among them one instance of cleanliness in which they exceeded
-them, and of which perhaps there is no example in any other Indian
-nation. Every house, or every little cluster of three or four houses,
-was furnished with a privy, so that the ground was every where clean.
-The offals of their food, and other litter, were also piled up in
-regular dunghills, which probably they made use of at a proper time for
-manure.
-
-In this decent article of civil economy they were beforehand with one of
-the most considerable nations of Europe; for I am credibly informed,
-that, till the year 1760, there was no such thing as a privy in Madrid,
-the metropolis of Spain, though it is plentifully supplied with water.
-Before that time it was the universal practice to throw the ordure out
-of the windows, during the night, into the street, where numbers of men
-were employed to remove it, with shovels, from the upper parts of the
-city to the lower, where it lay till it was dry, and was then carried
-away in carts, and deposited without the gates. His present Catholic
-Majesty, having determined to free his capital from so gross a nuisance,
-ordered, by proclamation, that the proprietor of every house should
-build a privy, and that sinks, drains, and common sewers should be made
-at the public expense. The Spaniards, though long accustomed to an
-arbitrary government, resented this proclamation with great spirit, as
-an infringement of the common rights of mankind, and made a vigorous
-struggle against its being carried into execution. Every class devised
-some objection against it, but the physicians bid the fairest to
-interest the king in the preservation of the ancient privileges of his
-people; for they remonstrated that if the filth was not, as usual,
-thrown into the streets, a fatal sickness would probably ensue, because
-the putrescent particles of the air, which such filth attracted, would
-then be imbibed by the human body. But this expedient, with every other
-that could be thought of, proved unsuccessful, and the popular
-discontent then ran so high that it was very near producing an
-insurrection; his Majesty, however, at length prevailed, and Madrid is
-now as clear as most of the considerable cities in Europe. But many of
-the citizens, probably upon the principles advanced by their physicians,
-that heaps of filth prevent deleterious particles of air from fixing
-upon neighbouring substances, have, to keep their food wholesome,
-constructed their privies by the kitchen fire.
-
-In the evening, all our boats being employed in carrying the water on
-board, and Mr. Banks and his company finding it probable that they
-should be left on shore after it was dark, by which much time would be
-lost, which they were impatient to employ in putting the plants they had
-gathered in order, they applied to the Indians for a passage in one of
-their canoes: they immediately consented, and a canoe was launched for
-their use. They went all on board, being eight in number, but not being
-used to a vessel that required so even a balance, they unfortunately
-overset her in the surf: no life, however, was lost, but it was thought
-advisable that half of them should wait for another turn. Mr. Banks, Dr.
-Solander, Tupia, and Tayeto embarked again, and without any further
-accident arrived safely at the ship, well pleased with the good nature
-of their Indian friends, who cheerfully undertook to carry them a second
-time, after having experienced how unfit a freight they were for such a
-vessel.
-
-While these gentlemen were on shore, several of the natives went off to
-the ship, and trafficked, by exchanging their cloth for that of
-Otaheite: of this barter they were for some time very fond, preferring
-the Indian cloth to that of Europe: but before night it decreased in its
-value five hundred per cent. Many of these Indians I took on board, and
-showed them the ship and her apparatus, at which they expressed equal
-satisfaction and astonishment.
-
-As I found it exceedingly difficult to get water on board on account of
-the surf, I determined to stay no longer at this place; on the next
-morning, therefore, about five o’clock, I weighed anchor, and put to
-sea.
-
-This bay, which is called by the natives TEGADOO, lies in the latitude
-of 38° 10ʹ S.; but as it has nothing to recommend it, a description of
-it is unnecessary.
-
-From this bay I intended to stand on to the northward, but the wind
-being right against me, I could make no way. While I was beating about
-to windward, some of the natives came on board, and told me, that in a
-bay which lay a little to the southward, being the same that I could not
-fetch the day I put into Tegadoo, there was excellent water, where the
-boats might land without a surf. I thought it better, therefore, to put
-into this bay, where I might complete my water, and form farther
-connections with the Indians, than to keep the sea. With this view I
-bore up for it, and sent in two boats, manned and armed, to examine the
-watering-place, who confirming the report of the Indians at their
-return, I came to an anchor about one o’clock, in eleven fathom water,
-with a fine sandy bottom, the north point of the bay N. by E., and the
-south point S. E. The watering-place, which was in a small cove a little
-within the south point of the bay, bore S. by E., distant about a mile.
-Many canoes came immediately off from the shore, and all traded very
-honestly for Otaheite cloth and glass-bottles, of which they were
-immoderately fond.
-
-In the afternoon of the 23d, as soon as the ship was moored, I went on
-shore to examine the watering-place, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr.
-Solander: the boat landed in the cove, without the least surf; the water
-was excellent, and conveniently situated; there was plenty of wood close
-to high-water mark, and the disposition of the people was in every
-respect such as we could wish.
-
-Having, with Mr. Green, taken several observations of the sun and moon,
-the mean result of them gave 180° 47ʹ W. longitude; but, as all the
-observations made before exceeded these, I have laid down the coast from
-the mean of the whole. At noon, I took the sun’s meridian altitude with
-an astronomical quadrant, which was set up at the watering-place, and
-found the latitude to be 38° 22ʹ 24ʺ.
-
-On the 24th, early in the morning, I sent Lieutenant Gore on shore, to
-superintend the cutting of wood and filling of water, with a sufficient
-number of men for both purposes, and all the marines as a guard. After
-breakfast, I went on shore myself, and continued there the whole day.
-
-Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander also went on shore to gather plants, and in
-their walks saw several things worthy of notice. They met with many
-houses in the valleys that seemed to be wholly deserted, the people
-living on the ridges of the hills in a kind of sheds very slightly
-built. As they were advancing in one of these valleys, the hills on each
-side of which were very steep, they were suddenly struck with the sight
-of a very extraordinary natural curiosity. It was a rock, perforated
-through its whole substance, so as to form a rude but stupendous arch or
-cavern, opening directly to the sea: this aperture was seventy-five feet
-long, twenty-seven broad, and five-and-forty high, commanding a view of
-the bay and the hills on the other side, which were seen through it,
-and, opening at once upon the view, produced an effect far superior to
-any of the contrivances of art.
-
-As they were returning to the watering-place in the evening, they met an
-old man, who detained them some time by showing them the military
-exercises of the country with the lance and patoo-patoo, which are all
-the weapons in use. The lance is from ten to fourteen feet long, made of
-a very hard wood, and sharp at both ends: the patoo-patoo has been
-described already: it is about a foot long, made of talc or bone, with
-sharp edges, and used as a battle-axe. A post or stake was set up as his
-enemy, to which he advanced with a most furious aspect, brandishing his
-lance, which he grasped with great firmness; when it was supposed to
-have been pierced by his lance, he ran at it with his patoo-patoo, and
-falling upon the upper end of it, which was to represent his adversary’s
-head, he laid on with great vehemence, striking many blows, any one of
-which would probably have split the skull of an ox. From our champion’s
-falling upon his mock enemy with the patoo-patoo, after he was supposed
-to have been pierced with the lance, our gentlemen inferred, that in the
-battles of this country there is no quarter.
-
-This afternoon, we set up the armourer’s forge, to repair the braces of
-the tiller, which had been broken, and went on getting our wood and
-water, without suffering the least molestation from the natives; who
-came down with different sorts of fish, which we purchased with cloth,
-beads, and glass-bottles, as usual.
-
-On the 25th, Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander went again on shore; and while
-they were searching for plants, Tupia staid with the waterers: among
-other Indians who came down to them, was a priest, with whom Tupia
-entered into a very learned conversation. In their notions of religion
-they seemed to agree very well, which is not often the case between
-learned divines on our side of the ocean: Tupia, however, seemed to have
-the most knowledge, and he was listened to with great deference and
-attention by the other. In the course of this conversation, after the
-important points of divinity had been settled, Tupia enquired if it was
-their practice to eat men, to which they answered in the affirmative;
-but said, that they eat only their enemies who were slain in battle.
-
-On the 26th, it rained all day, so that none of us could go ashore; and
-very few of the Indians came either to the watering-place or the ship.
-
-On the 27th, I went with Dr. Solander to examine the bottom of the bay;
-but though we went ashore at two places we met with little worth notice.
-The people behaved very civilly, showing us every thing that we
-expressed a desire to see. Among other trifling curiosities which Dr.
-Solander purchased of them, was a boy’s top, shaped exactly like those
-which children play with in England; and they made signs that to make it
-spin it was to be whipped. Mr. Banks in the mean time went ashore at the
-watering-place, and climbed a hill which stood at a little distant to
-see a fence of poles, which we had observed from the ship, and which had
-been much the subject of speculation. The hill was extremely steep, and
-rendered almost inaccessible by wood; yet he reached the place, near
-which he found many houses that for some reason had been deserted by
-their inhabitants. The poles appeared to be about sixteen feet high;
-they were placed in two rows, with a space of about six feet between
-them, and the poles in each row were about ten feet distant from each
-other. The lane between them was covered by sticks, that were set up
-sloping towards each other from the top of the poles on each side, like
-the roof of a house. This rail-work, with a ditch that was parallel to
-it, was carried about a hundred yards down the hill in a kind of curve;
-but for what purpose we could not guess.
-
-The Indians, at the watering-place, at our request, entertained us with
-their war-song, in which the women joined, with the most horrid
-distortions of countenance, rolling their eyes, thrusting out their
-tongues, and often heaving loud and deep sighs; though all was done in
-very good time.
-
-On the 28th, we went ashore upon an island that lies to the left hand of
-the entrance of the bay, where we saw the largest canoe that we had yet
-met with: she was sixty-eight feet and a half long, five broad, and
-three feet six high; she had a sharp bottom, consisting of three trunks
-of trees hollowed, of which that in the middle was the longest: the side
-planks were sixty-two feet long, in one piece, and were not despicably
-carved in bas-relief; the head also was adorned with carving still more
-richly. Upon this island there was a larger house than any we had yet
-seen; but it seemed unfinished, and was full of chips. The wood-work was
-squared so even and smooth, that we made no doubt of their having among
-them very sharp tools. The sides of the posts were carved in a masterly
-style, though after their whimsical taste, which seems to prefer spiril
-lines and distorted faces: as these carved posts appeared to have been
-brought from some other place, such work is probably of great value
-among them.
-
-At four o’clock in the morning of the 29th, having got on board our wood
-and water, and a large supply of excellent celery, with which the
-country abounds, and which proved a powerful antiscorbutic, I unmoored
-and put to sea.
-
-This bay is called by the natives TOLAGA; it is moderately large, and
-has from seven to thirteen fathom, with a clean sandy bottom and good
-anchorage; and is sheltered from all winds except the north-east. It
-lies in latitude 38° 22ʹ S. and four leagues and a half to the north of
-Gable-end Foreland. On the south point lies a small but high island, so
-near the main as not to be distinguished from it. Close to the north end
-of the island, at the entrance into the bay, are two high rocks; one is
-round, like a corn-stack, but the other is long, and perforated in
-several places, so that the openings appear like the arches of a bridge.
-Within these rocks is the cove where we cut wood, and filled our
-water-casks. Off the north point of the bay is a pretty high rocky
-island; and about a mile without it are some rocks and breakers. The
-variation of the compass here is 14° 31ʹ E., and the tide flows at the
-full and change of the moon, about six o’clock, and rises and falls
-perpendicularly from five to six feet: whether the flood comes from the
-southward or the northward I have not been able to determine.
-
-We got nothing here by traffic but a few fish, and some sweet potatoes,
-except a few trifles, which we considered merely as curiosities. We saw
-no four-footed animals, nor the appearance of any, either tame or wild,
-except dogs and rats, and these were very scarce: the people eat the
-dogs, like our friends at Otaheite; and adorn their garments with the
-skins, as we do ours with fur and ermine. I climbed many of the hills,
-hoping to get a view of the country, but I could see nothing from the
-top except higher hills, in a boundless succession. The ridges of these
-hills produce little besides fern; but the sides are most luxuriantly
-clothed with wood, and verdure of various kinds, with little plantations
-intermixed. In the woods, we found trees of above twenty different
-sorts, and carried specimens of each on board; but there was nobody
-among us to whom they were not altogether unknown. The tree which we cut
-for firing was somewhat like our maple, and yielded a whitish gum. We
-found another sort of it of a deep yellow, which we thought might be
-useful in dyeing. We found also one cabbage-tree, which we cut down for
-the cabbages. The country abounds with plants, and the woods with birds,
-in an endless variety, exquisitely beautiful, and of which none of us
-had the least knowledge. The soil both of the hills and valleys is light
-and sandy, and very fit for the production of all kinds of roots; though
-we saw none except sweet potatoes and yams.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. III.
-
-THE RANGE FROM TOLAGA TO MERCURY BAY, WITH AN ACCOUNT OF MANY INCIDENTS
- THAT HAPPENED BOTH ON BOARD AND ASHORE: A DESCRIPTION OF SEVERAL VIEWS
- EXHIBITED BY THE COUNTRY, AND OF THE HEPPAHS, OR FORTIFIED VILLAGES OF
- THE INHABITANTS.
-
-
-On Monday, the 30th, about half an hour after one o’clock, having made
-sail again to the northward for about ten hours, with a light breeze, I
-hauled round a small island which lay east one mile from the north-east
-point of the land: from this place I found the land trend away N. W. by
-W. and W. N. W. as far as I could see, this point being the easternmost
-land on the whole coast. I gave it the name of EAST CAPE, and I called
-the island that lies off it EAST ISLAND; it is of a small circuit, high
-and round, and appears white and barren: the cape is high, with white
-cliffs, and lies in latitude 37° 42ʹ 30ʺ S. and longitude 181° W. The
-land from Tolaga Bay to East Cape is of a moderate but unequal height,
-forming several small bays, in which are sandy beaches: of the inland
-country we could not see much, the weather being cloudy and hazy. The
-soundings were from twenty to thirty fathom, at the distance of about a
-league from the shore. After we had rounded the Cape, we saw in our run
-along the shore a great number of villages, and much cultivated land;
-the country in general appeared more fertile than before, and was low
-near the sea, but hilly within. At six in the evening, being four
-leagues to the westward of East Cape, we passed a bay which was first
-discovered by Lieutenant Hicks, and which, therefore, I called HICKS’S
-BAY. At eight in the evening, being eight leagues to the westward of the
-Cape, and three or four miles from the shore, I shortened sail, and
-brought to for the night, having at this time a fresh gale at S. S. E.
-and squally; but it soon became moderate, and at two in the morning we
-made sail again to the S. W. as the land now trended; and at eight
-o’clock in the morning saw land, which made like an island, bearing
-west, the south-westernmost part of the main bearing south-west; and
-about nine no less than five canoes came off, in which were more than
-forty men, all armed with their country pikes and battle-axes, shouting,
-and threatening an attack; this gave us great uneasiness, and was,
-indeed, what we did not expect; for we hoped, that the report both of
-our power and clemency had spread to a greater extent. When one of these
-canoes had almost reached the ship, another of an immense size, the
-largest we had yet seen, crowded with people who were also armed, put
-off from the shore, and came up at a great rate: as it approached it
-received signals from the canoe that was nearest to the ship; and we
-could see that it had sixteen paddles on a side, beside people that sat,
-and others that stood in a row from stem to stern, being in all about
-sixty men: as they made directly to the ship, we were desirous of
-preventing an attack, by showing what we could do; and, therefore, fired
-a gun, loaded with grape-shot, a-head of them: this made them stop, but
-not retreat; a round-shot was then fired over them, and upon seeing it
-fall, they seized their paddles and made towards the shore with such
-precipitation that they seemed scarcely to allow themselves time to
-breathe. In the evening, three or four more canoes came off unarmed; but
-they would not venture within a musket-shot of the vessel. The Cape off
-which we had been threatened with hostilities I called, from the hasty
-retreat of the enemy, CAPE RUNAWAY. It lies in latitude 37° 32ʹ;
-longitude 181° 48ʹ. In this day’s run, we found that the land, which
-made like an island in the morning, bearing west, was so; and we gave it
-the name of WHITE ISLAND.
-
-At day-break, on the 1st of November, we counted no less than
-five-and-forty canoes that were coming from the shore towards the ship:
-seven of them came up with us, and after some conversation with Tupia,
-sold us some lobsters and mussels, and two conger eels. These people
-traded pretty fairly; but when they were gone, some others came off from
-another place, who began also to trade fairly: but after some time they
-took what was handed down to them, without making any return; one of
-them who had done so, upon being threatened, began to laugh, and with
-many marks of derision set us at defiance, at the same time putting off
-the canoe from the ship: a musket was then fired over his head, which
-brought him back in a more serious mood, and trade went on with great
-regularity. At length, when the cabin and gun-room had got as much as
-they wanted, the men were allowed to come to the gangway, and trade for
-themselves. Unhappily the same care was not taken to prevent frauds as
-had been taken before, so that the Indians, finding that they could
-cheat with impunity, grew insolent again, and proceeded to take greater
-liberties. One of the canoes, having sold every thing on board, pulled
-forward, and the people that were in her seeing some linen hang over the
-ship’s side to dry, one of them, without any ceremony, untied it, and
-put it up in his bundle: he was immediately called to, and required to
-return it; instead of which, he let his canoe drop astern, and laughed
-at us: a musket was fired over his head, which did not put a stop to his
-mirth; another was then fired at him with small shot, which struck him
-upon the back; he shrunk a little when the shot hit him, but did not
-regard it more than one of our men would have done the stroke of a
-rattan: he continued with great composure to pack up the linen that he
-had stolen. All the canoes now dropped astern about a hundred yards, and
-all set up their song of defiance, which they continued till the ship
-was distant from them about four hundred yards. As they seemed to have
-no design to attack us, I was not willing to do them any hurt; yet I
-thought their going off in a bravado might have a bad effect when it
-should be reported ashore. To show them, therefore, that they were still
-in our power, though very much beyond the reach of any missile weapon
-with which they were acquainted, I gave the ship a yaw, and fired a
-four-pounder so as to pass near them. The shot happened to strike the
-water and rise several times at a great distance beyond the canoes: this
-struck them with terror, and they paddled away without once looking
-behind them.
-
-About two in the afternoon, we saw a pretty high island bearing west
-from us; and at five, saw more islands and rocks to the westward of
-that. We hauled our wind in order to go without them, but could not
-weather them before it was dark. I, therefore, bore up, and ran between
-them and the main. At seven, I was close under the first, from which a
-large double canoe, or rather two canoes lashed together at the distance
-of about a foot, and covered with boards so as to make a deck, put off,
-and made sail for the ship: this was the first vessel of the kind that
-we had seen since we left the South Sea islands. When she came near, the
-people on board entered very freely into conversation with Tupia, and we
-thought showed a friendly disposition; but when it was just dark, they
-ran their canoe close to the ship’s side, and threw in a volley of
-stones, after which they paddled away.
-
-We learnt from Tupia, that the people in the canoe called the island
-which we were under MOWTOHORA; it is but of a small circuit, though
-high, and lies six miles from the main; on the south side is anchorage
-in fourteen fathom water. Upon the main land S. W. by W. of this island,
-and apparently at no great distance from the sea, is a high round
-mountain, which I called MOUNT EDGECUMBE: it stands in the middle of a
-large plain, and is, therefore, the more conspicuous; latitude 37° 59ʹ,
-longitude 183° 7ʹ.
-
-In standing westward, we suddenly shoaled our water from seventeen to
-ten fathom; and knowing that we were not far from the small islands and
-rocks which we had seen before dark, and which I intended to have passed
-before I brought to for the night, I thought it more prudent to tack,
-and spend the night under Mowtohora, where I knew there was no danger.
-It was, indeed, happy for us that we did so; for in the morning, after
-we had made sail to the westward, we discovered ahead of us several
-rocks, some of which were level with the surface of the water, and some
-below it: they lay N. N. E. from Mount Edgecumbe, one league and a half
-distant from the island Mowtohora, and about nine miles from the main.
-We passed between these rocks and the main, having from ten to seven
-fathom water.
-
-This morning, many canoes and much people were seen along the shore:
-several of the canoes followed us, but none of them could reach us,
-except one with a sail, which proved to be the same that had pelted us
-the night before. The people on board again entered into conversation
-with Tupia; but we expected another volley of their ammunition, which
-was not, indeed, dangerous to any thing but the cabin windows. They
-continued abreast of the ship about an hour, and behaved very peaceably;
-but at last the salute which we expected was given: we returned it by
-firing a musket over them, and they immediately dropped astern and left
-us, perhaps rather satisfied with having given a test of their courage
-by twice insulting a vessel so much superior to their own, than
-intimidated by the shot.
-
-At half an hour after ten, we passed between a low flat island and the
-main: the distance from one to the other was about four miles, and the
-depth of water from ten to twelve fathom. The main land between this
-flat island and Mowtohora is of a moderate height, but level, pretty
-clear of wood, and full of plantations and villages. The villages, which
-were larger than any we had yet seen, were built upon eminences near the
-sea, and fortified on the land side by a bank and ditch, with a high
-paling within it, which was carried all round: beside a bank, ditch, and
-pallisadoes, some of them appeared to have outworks. Tupia had a notion
-that the small inclosure of pallisadoes, and a ditch that we had seen
-before, were morais or places of worship; but we were of opinion that
-they were forts, and concluded that these people had neighbouring
-enemies, and were always exposed to hostile attacks.
-
-At two o’clock we passed a small high island, lying four miles from a
-high round head upon the main. From this head the land trends N. W. as
-far as can be seen, and has a rugged and hilly appearance. As the
-weather was hazy, and the wind blew fresh on the shore, we hauled off
-for the weathermost island in sight, which bore from us N. N. E.,
-distant about six or seven leagues.
-
-Under this island, which I have called the MAYOR, we spent the night. At
-seven in the morning it bore S. 47 E., distant six leagues, and a
-cluster of small islands and rocks bore N. ½ E., distant one league, to
-which I gave the name of the COURT OF ALDERMEN. They lie in the compass
-of about half a league every way, and five leagues from the main,
-between which and them lie other islands, most of them barren rocks, of
-which there is great variety: some of them are as small in compass as
-the Monument of London, but rise to a much greater height, and some of
-them are inhabited. They lie in latitude 36° 57ʹ, and at noon bore S. 60
-E., distant three or four leagues; and a rock like a castle, lying not
-far from the main, bore N. 40 W., at the distance of one league. The
-country that we passed the night before appeared to be well inhabited,
-many towns were in sight, and some hundreds of large canoes lay under
-them upon the beach; but this day, after having sailed about fifteen
-leagues, it appeared to be barren and desolate. As far as we had yet
-coasted this country from Cape Turnagain, the people acknowledged one
-chief, whom they called TERATU, and to whose residence they pointed, in
-a direction that we thought to be very far inland, but afterwards found
-to be otherwise.
-
-About one o’clock, three canoes came off to us from the main, with
-one-and-twenty men on board. The construction of these vessels appeared
-to be more simple than that of any we had seen, they being nothing more
-than trunks of a single tree hollowed by fire, without any convenience
-or ornament. The people on board were almost naked, and appeared to be
-of a browner complexion; yet naked and despicable as they were, they
-sung their song of defiance, and seemed to denounce against us
-inevitable destruction: they remained, however, some time out of stone’s
-throw, and then venturing nearer, with less appearance of hostility, one
-of our men went to the ship’s side, and was about to hand them a rope;
-this courtesy, however, they thought fit to return by throwing a lance
-at him, which having missed him, they immediately threw another into the
-ship: upon this a musket was fired over them, which at once sent them
-away.
-
-About two, we saw a large opening, or inlet, for which we bore up; we
-had now forty-one fathom water, which gradually decreased to nine, at
-which time we were one mile and a half distant from a high towered rock
-which lay near the south point of the inlet: this rock, and the
-northernmost of the Court of Alderman being in one, bearing S. 61 E.
-
-About seven in the evening we anchored in seven fathom, a little within
-the south entrance of the bay: to this place we were accompanied by
-several canoes and people like those we had seen last, and for some time
-they behaved very civilly. While they were hovering about us, a bird was
-shot from the ship, as it was swimming upon the water: at this they
-showed less surprise than we expected, and taking up the bird, they tied
-it to a fishing line that was towing astern; as an acknowledgment for
-this favour, we gave them a piece of cloth: but notwithstanding this
-effect of our fire-arms, and this interchange of civilities, as soon as
-it grew dark, they sung their war-song, and attempted to tow away the
-buoy of the anchor. Two or three muskets were then fired over them, but
-this seemed rather to make them angry than afraid, and they went away,
-threatening that to-morrow they would return with more force, and be the
-death of us all; at the same time sending off a boat, which they told us
-was going to another part of the bay for assistance.
-
-There was some appearance of generosity, as well as courage, in
-acquainting us with the time when they intended to make their attack,
-but they forfeited all credit which this procured them, by coming
-secretly upon us in the night, when they certainly hoped to find us
-asleep: upon approaching the ship, they found themselves mistaken, and
-therefore retired without speaking a word, supposing that they were too
-early; after some time, they came a second time, and being again
-disappointed, they retired as silently as before.
-
-In the morning, at day-break, they prepared to effect by force what they
-had in vain attempted by stealth and artifice: no less than twelve
-canoes came against us with about a hundred and fifty men, all armed
-with pikes, lances, and stones. As they could do nothing till they came
-very near the ship, Tupia was ordered to expostulate with them, and if
-possible divert them from their purpose: during the conversation, they
-appeared to be sometimes friendly and sometimes otherwise; at length,
-however, they began to trade, and we offered to purchase their weapons,
-which some of them consented to sell: they sold two very fairly, but
-having received what had been agreed upon for the purchase of a third,
-they refused to send it up, but offered it for a second price; a second
-was sent down, but the weapon was still detained, and a demand made of a
-third; this being refused with some expressions of displeasure and
-resentment, the offender, with many ludicrous tokens of contempt and
-defiance, paddled his canoe off a few yards from the ship. As I intended
-to continue in this place five or six days, in order to make an
-observation of the transit of Mercury, it was absolutely necessary, in
-order to prevent future mischief, to show these people that we were not
-to be treated ill with impunity; some small shot were therefore fired at
-the thief, and a musket ball through the bottom of his boat: upon this
-it was paddled to about a hundred yards’ distance, and to our great
-surprise the people in the other canoes took not the least notice of
-their wounded companion, though he bled very much, but returned to the
-ship, and continued to trade with the most perfect indifference and
-unconcern. They sold us many more of their weapons, without making any
-other attempt to defraud us, for a considerable time; at last, however,
-one of them thought fit to paddle away with two different pieces of
-cloth which had been given for the same weapon: when he had got about an
-hundred yards’ distance, and thought himself secure of his prize, a
-musket was fired after him, which fortunately struck the boat just at
-the water’s edge, and made two holes in her side; this only incited them
-to ply their paddles with greater activity, and the rest of the canoes
-also made off with the utmost expedition. As the last proof of our
-superiority, therefore, we fired a round shot over them, and not a boat
-stopped till they got on shore.
-
-About ten o’clock, I went with two boats to sound the bay, and look out
-for a more convenient anchoring-place, the master being in one boat and
-myself in the other. We pulled first over to the north shore, from which
-some canoes came out to meet us; as we advanced, however, they retired,
-inviting us to follow them; but seeing them all armed, I did not think
-it proper to comply, but went towards the head of the bay, where I
-observed a village upon a very high point, fortified in the manner that
-has been already described, and having fixed upon an anchoring-place not
-far from where the ship lay, I returned on board.
-
-At three o’clock in the afternoon, I weighed, run in nearer to the
-shore, and anchored in four fathom and an half water, with a soft sandy
-bottom, the south point of the bay bearing E. distant one mile, and a
-river which the boats can enter at low water S. S. E., distant a mile
-and an half.
-
-In the morning, the natives came off again to the ship, and we had the
-satisfaction to observe that their behaviour was very different from
-what it had been yesterday: among them was an old man, whom we had
-before remarked for his prudence and honesty: his name was TOIAVA, and
-he seemed to be a person of a superior rank; in the transactions of
-yesterday morning he had behaved with great propriety and good sense,
-lying in a small canoe, always near the ship, and treating those on
-board as if he neither intended a fraud, nor suspected an injury: with
-some persuasion this man and another came on board, and ventured into
-the cabin, where I presented each of them with a piece of English cloth
-and some spike nails. They told us that the Indians were now very much
-afraid of us, and on our part we promised friendship, if they would
-behave peaceably, desiring only to purchase what they had to sell upon
-their own terms.
-
-After the natives had left us, I went with the pinnace and long boat
-into the river with a design to haul the seine, and sent the master in
-the yawl to sound the bay and dredge for fish. The Indians, who were on
-one side of the river, expressed their friendship by all the signs they
-could devise, beckoning us to land among them; but we chose to go ashore
-on the other side, as the situation was more convenient for hauling the
-seine and shooting birds, of which we saw great numbers of various
-kinds: the Indians, with much persuasion, about noon, ventured over to
-us. With the seine we had very little success, catching only a few
-mullets, neither did we get any thing by the trawl or the dredge, except
-a few shells; but we shot several birds, most of them resembling
-sea-pies, except that they had black plumage, and red bills and feet.
-While we were absent with our guns, the people who staid by the boats
-saw two of the Indians quarrel and fight: they began the battle with
-their lances, but some old men interposed and took them away, leaving
-them to decide the difference, like Englishmen, with their fists: they
-boxed with great vigour and obstinacy for some time, but by degrees all
-retired behind a little hill, so that our people could not see the event
-of the combat.
-
-In the morning the long-boat was sent again to traul in the bay, and an
-officer, with the marines, and a party of men, to cut wood and haul the
-seine. The Indians on shore appeared very peaceable and submissive, and
-we had reason to believe that their habitations were at a considerable
-distance, for we saw no houses, and found that they slept under the
-bushes: the bay is probably a place to which they frequently resort in
-parties to gather shell-fish, of which it affords incredible plenty; for
-wherever we went, whether upon the hills or in the valleys, the woods or
-the plains, we saw vast heaps of shells, often many waggon-loads
-together, some appearing to be very old, and others recent. We saw no
-cultivation in this place, which had a desolate and barren appearance;
-the tops of the hills were green, but nothing grew there, except a large
-kind of fern, the roots of which the natives had got together in large
-quantities, in order to carry away with them. In the evening Mr. Banks
-walked up the river, which, at the mouth, looked fine and broad, but at
-the distance of about two miles was not deep enough to cover the foot;
-and the country inland was still more barren than at the sea side. The
-seine and dredge were not more successful to-day than yesterday, but the
-Indians in some measure compensated for the disappointment by bringing
-us several baskets of fish, some dry, and some fresh dressed; it was not
-indeed of the best, but I ordered it all to be bought for the
-encouragement of trade.
-
-On the 7th, the weather was so bad that none of us left the ship, nor
-did any of the Indians come on board.
-
-On the 8th, I sent a party of men on shore to wood and water; and in the
-mean time many canoes came off, in one of which was our friend Toiava;
-soon after he was alongside of the ship, he saw two canoes coming from
-the opposite side of the bay, upon which he hasted back again to the
-shore with all his canoes, telling us that he was afraid of the people
-who were coming: this was a farther proof that the people of this
-country were perpetually committing hostilities against each other. In a
-short time, however, he returned, having discovered that the people who
-had alarmed him were not the same that he had supposed. The natives that
-came to the ship this morning sold us, for a few pieces of cloth, as
-much fish of the mackerel kind as served the whole ship’s company, and
-they were as good as ever were eaten. At noon, this day, I observed the
-sun’s meridional zenith distance by an astronomical quadrant, which gave
-the latitude 36° 47ʹ 43ʺ within the south entrance of the bay.
-
-Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander went on shore and collected a great variety
-of plants, altogether unknown, and not returning till the evening, had
-an opportunity of observing in what manner the Indians disposed
-themselves to pass the night. They had no shelter but a few shrubs; the
-women and the children were ranged innermost, or farthest from the sea;
-the men lay in a kind of half circle round them, and their arms were set
-up against the trees close by them, in a manner which showed that they
-were afraid of an attack by some enemy not far distant. It was also
-discovered that they acknowledged neither Teratu, nor any other person
-as their king: as in this particular they differed from all the people
-that we had seen upon other parts of the coast, we thought it possible
-that they might be a set of outlaws, in a state of rebellion against
-Teratu, and in that case they might have no settled habitations, or
-cultivated land in any part of the country.
-
-On the 9th, at day-break, a great number of canoes came on board, loaded
-with mackerel of two sorts, one exactly the same with those caught in
-England, and the other somewhat different: we imagined the people had
-taken a large shoal, and brought us an overplus which they could not
-consume; for they sold them at a very low rate. They were, however, very
-welcome to us; at eight o’clock, the ship had more fish on board than
-all her people could eat in three days; and before night, the quantity
-was so much increased, that every man who could get salt, cured as many
-as would last him a month.
-
-After an early breakfast, I went ashore, with Mr. Green and proper
-instruments, to observe the transit of Mercury, Mr. Banks and Dr.
-Solander being of the party; the weather had for some time been very
-thick, with much rain, but this day was so favourable that not a cloud
-intervened during the whole transit. The observation of the ingress was
-made by Mr. Green alone, while I was employed in taking the sun’s
-altitude to ascertain the time. It came on at 7^h 20ʹ 58ʺ apparent time:
-according to Mr. Green’s observation, the internal contact was at 12^h
-8ʹ 58ʺ, the external at 12^h 9ʹ 55ʺ P. M. And according to mine, the
-internal contact was at 12^h 8ʹ 54ʺ, and the external 12^h 9ʹ 48ʺ; the
-latitude of the place of observation was 30° 48ʹ 5-½ʺ. The latitude
-observed at noon was 36° 48ʹ 28ʺ. The mean of this and yesterday’s
-observation gives 36° 48ʹ 5-½ʺ S. the latitude of the place of
-observation; the variation of the compass was 11° 9ʹ E.
-
-About noon, we were alarmed by the firing of a great gun from the ship;
-Mr. Gore, my second lieutenant, was at this time commanding officer on
-board, and the account that he gave was this. While some small canoes
-were trading with the people, two very large ones came up, full of men,
-one of them having on board forty-seven, all armed with pikes, darts,
-and stones, and apparently with a hostile intention: they appeared to be
-strangers, and to be rather conscious of superiority over us by their
-numbers, than afraid of any weapons which could give us the superiority
-over them: no attack however was made; probably because they learnt from
-the people in the other canoes, with whom they immediately entered into
-conference, what kind of an enemy they had to deal with: after a little
-time, they began to trade, some of them offering their arms, and one of
-them a square piece of cloth, which makes a part of their dress, called
-a _Haahow_; several of the weapons were purchased, and Mr. Gore having
-agreed for a Haahow, sent down the price, which was a piece of British
-cloth, and expected his purchase: but the Indian, as soon as he had got
-Mr. Gore’s cloth in his possession, refused to part with his own, and
-put off the canoe: upon being threatened for this fraud, he and his
-companions began to sing their war-song in defiance, and shook their
-paddles: still however they began no attack, only defying Mr. Gore to
-take any remedy in his power, which so provoked him that he levelled a
-musket loaded with ball at the offender, while he was holding the cloth
-in his hand, and shot him dead. It would have been happy, if the effect
-of a few small shot had been tried upon this occasion, which, upon some
-others, had been successful.
-
-When the Indian dropped, all the canoes put off to some distance; but as
-they did not go away, it was thought they might still meditate an
-attack. To secure therefore a safe passage for the boat, which it was
-necessary to send on shore, a round shot was fired over their heads,
-which effectually answered the purpose, and put them all to flight. When
-an account of what had happened was brought ashore, our Indians were
-alarmed, and drawing all together, retreated in a body. After a short
-time, however, they returned, having heard a more particular account of
-the affair; and intimated that they thought the man who had been killed
-deserved his fate.
-
-A little before sunset the Indians retired to eat their supper, and we
-went with them to be spectators of the repast; it consisted of fish of
-different kinds, among which were lobsters, and some birds, of a species
-unknown to us: these were either roasted or baked; to roast them, they
-fastened them upon a small stick, which was stuck up in the ground
-inclining towards their fire; and to bake them, they put them into a
-hole in the ground, with hot stones, in the same manner as the people of
-Otaheite.
-
-Among the natives that were assembled upon this occasion, we saw a
-woman, who, after their manner, was mourning for the death of her
-relation: she sat upon the ground near the rest, who, one only excepted,
-seemed not at all to regard her: the tears constantly trickled down her
-cheeks, and she repeated in a low, but very mournful voice, words, which
-even Tupia did not at all understand: at the end of every sentence she
-cut her arms, her face, or her breast with a shell that she held in her
-hand, so that she was almost covered with blood, and was indeed one of
-the most affecting spectacles that can be conceived. The cuts, however,
-did not appear to be so deep as are sometimes made upon similar
-occasions, if we may judge by the scars which we saw upon the arms,
-thighs, breasts, and cheeks of many of them, which we were told were the
-remains of wounds which they had inflicted upon themselves as
-testimonies of their affection and sorrow.
-
-The next day, I went with two boats, accompanied by Mr. Banks and the
-other gentlemen, to examine a large river that empties itself into the
-head of the bay. We rowed about four or five miles up, and could have
-gone much farther, if the weather had been favourable. It was here wider
-than at the mouth, and divided into many streams by small flat islands,
-which are covered with mangroves, and overflowed at high water. From
-these trees exudes a viscous substance which very much resembles resin:
-we found it first in small lumps upon the sea-beach, and now saw it
-sticking to the trees, by which we knew whence it came. We landed on the
-east side of the river, where we saw a tree upon which several shags had
-built their nests, and here therefore we determined to dine; twenty of
-the shags were soon killed, and being broiled upon the spot, afforded us
-an excellent meal. We then went upon the hills from whence I thought I
-saw the head of the river. The shore on each side, as well as the
-islands in the middle, were covered with mangroves; and the sandbanks
-abounded in cockles and clams: in many places there were rock-oysters,
-and every where plenty of wild fowl, principally shags, ducks, curlieus,
-and the sea-pie, that has been described before. We also saw fish in the
-river, but of what kind we could not discover: the country on the east
-side of this river is for the most part barren, and destitute of wood;
-but on the west it has a better aspect, and in some places is adorned
-with trees, but has in no part the appearance of cultivation. In the
-entrance of the river, and for two or three miles up, there is good
-anchoring in four and five fathom water, and places very convenient for
-laying a vessel on shore, where the tide rises and falls seven feet at
-the full and change of the moon. We could not determine, whether any
-considerable stream of fresh water came into this river out of the
-country; but we saw a number of small rivulets issue from the adjacent
-hills. Near the mouth of this river, on the east side, we found a little
-Indian village, consisting of small temporary sheds, where we landed,
-and were received by the people with the utmost kindness and
-hospitality: they treated us with a flat shell fish of a most delicious
-taste, somewhat like a cockle, which we eat hot from the coals. Near
-this place is a high point or peninsula, projecting into the river, and
-upon it are the remains of a fort, which they call _Eppah_, or _Heppah_.
-The best engineer in Europe could not have chosen a situation better
-adapted to enable a small number to defend themselves against a greater.
-The steepness of the cliffs renders it wholly inaccessible from the
-water which incloses it on three sides; and, to the land, it is
-fortified by a ditch, and a bank raised on the inside: from the top of
-the bank to the bottom of the ditch, is two and twenty feet; the ditch
-on the outside is fourteen feet deep, and its breadth is in proportion.
-The whole seemed to have been executed with great judgment; and there
-had been a row of pickets or pallisadoes, both on the top of the bank
-and along the brink of the ditch on the outside; those on the outside
-had been driven very deep into the ground, and were inclined towards the
-ditch, so as to project over it; but of these the thickest posts only
-were left, and upon them there were evident marks of fire, so that the
-place had probably been taken and destroyed by an enemy. If any occasion
-should make it necessary for a ship to winter here, or stay any time,
-tents might be built in this place, which is sufficiently spacious, with
-great convenience, and might easily be made impregnable to the whole
-country.
-
-[Illustration: _A Fortified Town or Village, called a Hippah at
-Tolaga._]
-
-[Illustration: _A Natural Arch or Perforated Rock._]
-
-On the eleventh, there was so much wind and rain that no canoe came off;
-but the long-boat was sent to fetch oysters from one of the beds which
-had been discovered the day before: the boat soon returned, deeply
-laden, and the oysters, which were as good as ever came from Colchester,
-and about the same size, were laid down under the booms, and the ship’s
-company did nothing but eat them from the time they came on board till
-night, when, as may reasonably be supposed, great part of them were
-expended; this, however, gave us no concern, as we knew that not the
-boat only, but the ship, might have been loaded, almost in one tide, as
-the beds are dry at half ebb.
-
-In the morning of Sunday the 12th, two canoes came off full of people
-whom we had never seen before, but who appeared to have heard of us by
-the caution which they used in approaching us. As we invited them to
-come alongside with all the tokens of friendship that we could show,
-they ventured up, and two of them came on board; the rest traded very
-fairly for what they had: a small canoe also came from the other side of
-the bay, and sold us some very large fish, which they gave us to
-understand they would have brought yesterday, having caught them the day
-before, but that the wind was so high they could not venture to sea.
-
-[Illustration: _The Inside of a Hippah in New Zealand._]
-
-After breakfast, I went with the pinnace and yawl, accompanied by Mr.
-Banks and Dr. Solander, over to the north side of the bay, to take a
-view of the country, and two fortified villages which we had discovered
-at a distance. We landed near the smallest of them, the situation of
-which was the most beautifully romantic that can be imagined; it was
-built upon a small rock, detached from the main, and surrounded at high
-water. The whole body of this rock was perforated by an hollow or arch,
-which possessed much the largest part of it; the top of the arch was
-above sixty feet perpendicular above the sea, which at high water flowed
-through the bottom of it: the whole summit of the rock above the arch
-was fenced round after their manner; but the area was not large enough
-to contain more than five or six houses: it was accessible only by one
-very narrow and steep path, by which the inhabitants, at our approach,
-came down, and invited us into the place; but we refused, intending to
-visit a much more considerable fort of the same kind at about a mile’s
-distance. We made some presents however to the women, and in the mean
-time we saw the inhabitants of the town which we were going to, coming
-towards us in a body, men, women, and children, to the number of about
-one hundred: when they came near enough to be heard, they waved their
-hands and called out _Horomai_; after which they sat down among the
-bushes near the beach; these ceremonies we were told were certain signs
-of their friendly disposition. We advanced to the place where they were
-sitting, and when we came up, made them a few presents, and asked leave
-to visit their Heppah; they consented with joy in their countenances,
-and immediately led the way. It is called WHARRETOUWA, and is situated
-upon a high promontory or point, which projects into the sea, on the
-north side, and near the head of the bay: two sides of it are washed by
-the sea, and these are altogether inaccessible; two other sides are to
-the land: up one of them, which is very steep, lies the avenue from the
-beach; the other is flat and open to the country upon the hill, which is
-a narrow ridge: the whole is inclosed by a pallisade about ten feet
-high, consisting of strong pales bound together with withes. The weak
-side next the land is also defended by a double ditch, the innermost of
-which has a bank and an additional pallisade: the inner pallisades are
-upon the bank next the town, but at such a distance from the top of the
-bank as to leave room for men to walk and use their arms, between them
-and the inner ditch; the outermost pallisades are between the two
-ditches, and driven obliquely into the ground, so that their upper ends
-incline over the inner ditch: the depth of this ditch, from the bottom
-to the top or crown of the bank, is four-and-twenty feet. Close within
-the innermost pallisade is a stage, twenty feet high, forty feet long,
-and six broad; it is supported by strong posts, and is intended as a
-station for those who defend the place, from which they may annoy the
-assailants by darts and stones, heaps of which lay ready for use.
-Another stage of the same kind commands the steep avenue from the beach,
-and stands also within the pallisade; on this side of the hill, there
-are some little outworks and huts, not intended as advanced posts, but
-as the habitations of people who, for want of room, could not be
-accommodated within the works, but who were, notwithstanding, desirous
-of placing themselves under their protection. The pallisades, as has
-been observed already, run round the whole brow of the hill, as well
-towards the sea as towards the land; but the ground within having
-originally been a mount, they have reduced it not to one level, but to
-several, rising in stages one above the other, like an amphitheatre,
-each of which is inclosed within its separate pallisade; they
-communicate with each other by narrow lanes, which might easily be stopt
-up, so that if an enemy should force the outward pallisade, he would
-have others to carry before the place could be wholly reduced, supposing
-these places to be obstinately defended one after the other. The only
-entrance is by a narrow passage, about twelve feet long, communicating
-with the steep ascent from the beach: it passes under one of the
-fighting stages, and though we saw nothing like a door or gateway, it
-may be easily barricaded in a manner that will make the forcing it a
-very dangerous and difficult undertaking. Upon the whole, this must be
-considered as a place of great strength, in which a small number of
-resolute men may defend themselves against all the force which a people
-with no other arms than those that are in use here could bring against
-it. It seemed to be well furnished for a siege with every thing but
-water; we saw great quantities of fern root, which they eat as bread,
-and dried fish piled up in heaps; but we could not perceive that they
-had any fresh water nearer than a brook, which runs close under the foot
-of the hill: whether they have any means of getting it from this place
-during a siege, or whether they have any method of storing it within the
-works in gourds or other vessels, we could not learn; some resource they
-certainly have with respect to this article, an indispensable necessary
-of life, for otherwise the laying up dry provisions could answer no
-purpose. Upon our expressing a desire to see their method of attack and
-defence, one of the young men mounted a fighting stage, which they call
-_Porava_, and another went into the ditch: both he that was to defend
-the place, and he that was to assault it, sung the war-song, and danced
-with the same frightful gesticulations that we had seen used in more
-serious circumstances, to work themselves up into a degree of that
-mechanical fury, which, among all uncivilized nations, is the necessary
-prelude to a battle; for dispassionate courage, a strength of mind that
-can surmount the sense of danger, without a flow of animal spirits by
-which it is extinguished, seems to be the prerogative of those who have
-projects of more lasting importance, and a keener sense of honour and
-disgrace, than can be formed or felt by men who have few pains or
-pleasures besides those of mere animal life, and scarcely any purpose
-but to provide for the day that is passing over them, to obtain plunder,
-or revenge an insult: they will march against each other indeed in cool
-blood, though they find it necessary to work themselves into passion
-before they engage; as among us there have been many instances of people
-who have deliberately made themselves drunk, that they might execute a
-project which they formed when they were sober, but which, while they
-continued so, they did not dare to undertake.
-
-On the side of the hill, near this inclosure, we saw about half an acre
-planted with gourds and sweet potatoes, which was the only cultivation
-in the bay: under the foot of the point upon which this fortification
-stands, are two rocks, one just broken off from the main, and the other
-not perfectly detached from it: they are both small, and seem more
-proper for the habitations of birds than men; yet there are houses and
-places of defence upon each of them. And we saw many other works of the
-same kind upon small islands, rocks, and ridges of hills, on different
-parts of the coast, besides many fortified towns, which appeared to be
-much superior to this.
-
-The perpetual hostility in which these poor savages, who have made every
-village a fort, must necessarily live, will account for there being so
-little of their land in a state of cultivation; and, as mischiefs very
-often reciprocally produce each other, it may perhaps appear, that there
-being so little land in a state of cultivation, will account for their
-living in perpetual hostility. But it is very strange, that the same
-invention and diligence which have been used in the construction of
-places so admirably adapted to defence, almost without tools, should
-not, when urged by the same necessity, have furnished them with a single
-missile weapon except the lance, which is thrown by hand; they have no
-contrivance like a bow to discharge a dart, nor any thing like a sling
-to assist them in throwing a stone; which is the more surprising, as the
-invention of slings, and bows and arrows, is much more obvious than of
-the works which these people construct, and both these weapons are found
-among much ruder nations, and in almost every other part of the world.
-Besides the long lance and Patoo-patoo, which have been mentioned
-already, they have a staff about five feet long, sometimes pointed like
-a Serjeant’s halberd, sometimes only tapering to a point at one end, and
-having the other end broad, and shaped somewhat like the blade of an
-oar. They have also another weapon, about a foot shorter than these,
-pointed at one end, and at the other shaped like an axe. The points of
-their long lances are barbed, and they handle them with such strength
-and agility, that we can match them with no weapon but a loaded musquet.
-
-After taking a slight view of the country, and loading both the boats
-with celery, which we found in great plenty near the beach, we returned
-from our excursion, and about five o’clock in the evening got on board
-the ship.
-
-On the 15th, I sailed out of the bay, and at the same time had several
-canoes on board, in one of which was our friend Toiava, who said, that
-as soon as we were gone he must repair to his Heppah or fort, because
-the friends of the man who had been shot by Mr. Gore on the 9th, had
-threatened to revenge his death upon him, whom they had reproached as
-being our friend. Off the north point of the bay, I saw a great number
-of islands, of various extent, which lay scattered to the north-west, in
-a direction parallel with the main as far as I could see. I steered
-north-east for the north-easternmost of these islands, but the wind
-coming to the north-west, I was obliged to stand out to sea.
-
-To the bay which we had now left I gave the name of MERCURY BAY, on
-account of the observation which we had made there of the transit of
-that planet over the sun. It lies in latitude 36° 47ʹ S.; and in the
-longitude of 184° 4ʹ W.: there are several islands lying both to the
-southward and northward of it, and a small island or rock in the middle
-of the entrance: within this island the depth of water no where exceeds
-nine fathom; the best anchoring is in a sandy bay, which lies just
-within the south head, in five and four fathom, bringing a high tower or
-rock, which lies without the head, in one with the head, or just shut in
-behind it. This place is very convenient both for wooding and watering,
-and in the river there is an immense quantity of oysters and other
-shell-fish: I have for this reason given it the name of OYSTER RIVER.
-But for a ship that wants to stay here any time, the best and safest
-place is in the river at the head of the bay; which, from the number of
-mangrove trees about it, I have called MANGROVE RIVER. To sail into this
-river, the south shore must be kept all the way on board. The country on
-the east side of the river and bay, is very barren, its only produce
-being fern, and a few other plants that will grow in a poor soil. The
-land on the north-west side is covered with wood, and the soil being
-much more fertile would doubtless produce all the necessaries of life
-with proper cultivation: it is not however so fertile as the lands that
-we have seen to the southward, nor do the inhabitants, though numerous,
-make so good an appearance: they have no plantations; their canoes are
-mean, and without ornament; they sleep in the open air; and say, that
-Teratu, whose sovereignty they do not acknowledge, if he was to come
-among them, would kill them. This favoured our opinion of their being
-out-laws; yet they told us, that they had Heppahs, or strongholds, to
-which they retired in time of imminent danger.
-
-We found, thrown upon the shore, in several parts of this bay, great
-quantities of iron sand, which is brought down by every little rivulet
-of fresh water that finds its way from the country; which is a
-demonstration that there is ore of that metal not far inland: yet
-neither the inhabitants of this place, or any other part of the coast
-that we have seen, know the use of iron, or set the least value upon it;
-all of them preferring the most worthless and useless trifle, not only
-to a nail, but to any tool of that metal.
-
-Before we left the bay, we cut upon one of the trees near the
-watering-place the ship’s name, and that of the commander, with the date
-of the year and month when we were there; and after displaying the
-English colours, I took a formal possession of it in the name of his
-Britannic Majesty King George the Third.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. IV.
-
- THE RANGE FROM MERCURY BAY TO THE BAY OF ISLANDS; AN EXPEDITION UP THE
-RIVER THAMES: SOME ACCOUNT OF THE INDIANS WHO INHABIT ITS BANKS, AND THE
- FINE TIMBER THAT GROWS THERE: SEVERAL INTERVIEWS WITH THE NATIVES ON
- DIFFERENT PARTS OF THE COAST, AND A SKIRMISH WITH THEM UPON AN ISLAND.
-
-
-I continued plying to windward two days to get under the land, and on
-the 18th, about seven in the morning, we were abreast of a very
-conspicuous promontory, being then in latitude 36° 26ʹ, and in the
-direction of N. 48 W. from the north head of Mercury Bay, or Point
-Mercury, which was distant nine leagues: upon this point stood many
-people, who seemed to take little notice of us, but talked together with
-great earnestness. In about half an hour, several canoes put off from
-different places, and came towards the ship; upon which the people on
-the point also launched a canoe, and about twenty of them came in her up
-with the others. When two of these canoes, in which there might be about
-sixty men, came near enough to make themselves heard, they sung their
-war-song; but seeing that we took little notice of it, they threw a few
-stones at us, and then rowed off towards the shore. We hoped that we had
-now done with them, but in a short time they returned, as if with a
-fixed resolution to provoke us into a battle, animating themselves by
-their song as they had done before. Tupia, without any directions from
-us, went to the poop, and began to expostulate: he told them, that we
-had weapons which would destroy them in a moment; and that, if they
-ventured to attack us, we should be obliged to use them. Upon this, they
-flourished their weapons, and cried out, in their language, “Come on
-shore, and we will kill you all:” Well, said Tupia, but why should you
-molest us while we are at sea? as we do not wish to fight, we shall not
-accept your challenge to come on shore; and here there is no pretence
-for quarrel, the sea being no more your property than the ship. This
-eloquence of Tupia, though it greatly surprised us, having given him no
-hints for the arguments he used, had no effect upon our enemies, who
-very soon renewed their battery: a musket was then fired through one of
-their boats, and this was an argument of sufficient weight, for they
-immediately fell astern and left us.
-
-From the point, of which we were now abreast, the land trends W. ½ S.
-near a league, and then S. S. E. as far as we could see; and, besides
-the islands that lay without us, we could see land round by the S. W. as
-far as N. W.; but whether this was the main or islands, we could not
-then determine: the fear of losing the main, however, made me resolve to
-follow its direction. With this view, I hauled round the point, and
-steered to the southward, but there being light airs all round the
-compass, we made but little progress.
-
-About one o’clock, a breeze sprung up at east, which afterwards came to
-N. E. and we steered along the shore S. by E. and S. S. E. having from
-twenty-five to eighteen fathom.
-
-At about half an hour after seven in the evening, having run seven or
-eight leagues since noon, I anchored in twenty-three fathom, not
-choosing to run any farther in the dark, as I had now land on both
-sides, forming the entrance of a straight, bay, or river, lying S. by E.
-for on that point we could see no land.
-
-At day-break, on the 19th, the wind being still favourable, we weighed
-and stood with an easy sail up the inlet, keeping nearest to the east
-side. In a short time, two large canoes came off to us from the shore;
-the people on board said, that they knew Toiava very well, and called
-Tupia by his name. I invited some of them on board; and as they knew
-they had nothing to fear from us, while they behaved honestly and
-peaceably, they immediately complied: I made each of them some presents,
-and dismissed them much gratified. Other canoes afterwards came up to us
-from a different side of the bay; and the people on board of these also
-mentioned the name of Toiava, and sent a young man into the ship, who
-told us he was his grandson, and he also was dismissed with a present.
-
-After having run about five leagues from the place where we had anchored
-the night before, our depth of water gradually decreased to six fathom;
-and not choosing to go into less, as it was tide of flood, and the wind
-blew right up the inlet, I came to an anchor about the middle of the
-channel, which is near eleven miles over; after which I sent two boats
-out to sound, one on one side, and the other on the other.
-
-The boats not having found above three feet more water than we were now
-in, I determined to go no farther with the ship, but to examine the head
-of the bay in the boats; for, as it appeared to run a good way inland, I
-thought this a favourable opportunity to examine the interior part of
-the country, and its produce.
-
-At day-break, therefore, I set out in the pinnace and long-boat,
-accompanied by Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and Tupia; and we found the
-inlet end in a river, about nine miles above the ship: into this river
-we entered with the first of the flood, and within three miles found the
-water perfectly fresh. Before we had proceeded more than one third of
-that distance, we found an Indian town, which was built upon a small
-bank of dry sand, but entirely surrounded by a deep mud, which possibly
-the inhabitants might consider as a defence. These people, as soon as
-they saw us, thronged to the banks, and invited us on shore. We accepted
-the invitation, and made them a visit notwithstanding the mud. They
-received us with open arms, having heard of us from our good old friend
-Toiava; but our stay could not be long, as we had other objects of
-curiosity in view. We proceeded up the river till near noon, when we
-were fourteen miles within its entrance; and then, finding the face of
-the country to continue nearly the same, without any alteration in the
-course of the stream, which we had no hope of tracing to its source, we
-landed on the west side, to take a view of the lofty trees which every
-where adorned its banks. They were of a kind that we had seen before,
-though only at a distance, both in Poverty Bay and Hawke’s Bay. Before
-we had walked an hundred yards into the wood, we met with one of them
-which was nineteen feet eight inches in the girt, at the height of six
-feet above the ground: having a quadrant with me, I measured its height
-from the root to the first branch, and found it to be eighty-nine feet:
-it was as straight as an arrow, and tapered but very little in
-proportion to its height; so that I judged there were three hundred and
-fifty-six feet of solid timber in it, exclusive of the branches. As we
-advanced, we saw many others that were still larger; we cut down a young
-one, and the wood proved heavy and solid, not fit for masts, but such as
-would make the finest plank in the world. Our carpenter, who was with
-us, said that the timber resembled that of the pitch-pine, which is
-lightened by tapping; and possibly some such method might be found to
-lighten these, and they would then be such masts as no country in Europe
-can produce. As the wood was swampy, we could not range far; but we
-found many stout trees of other kinds, all of them utterly unknown to
-us, specimens of which we brought away.
-
-The river at this height is as broad as the Thames at Greenwich, and the
-tide of flood as strong; it is not indeed quite so deep, but has water
-enough for vessels of more than a middle size, and a bottom of mud so
-soft, that nothing could take damage by running ashore.
-
-About three o’clock, we reimbarked, in order to return with the first of
-the ebb, and named the river the THAMES, it having some resemblance to
-our own river of that name. In our return, the inhabitants of the
-village where we had been ashore, seeing us take another channel, came
-off to us in their canoes, and trafficked with us in the most friendly
-manner, till they had disposed of the few trifles they had. The tide of
-ebb just carried us out of the narrow part of the river, into the
-channel that run up from the sea before it was dark; and we pulled hard
-to reach the ship, but meeting the flood, and a strong breeze at N. N.
-W. with showers of rain, we were obliged to desist; and about midnight,
-we run under the land, and came to a grappling, where we took such rest
-as our situation would admit. At break of day, we set forward again, and
-it was past seven o’clock before we reached the ship. We were all
-extremely tired, but thought ourselves happy to be on board; for before
-nine it blew so hard that the boat could not have rowed ahead, and must
-therefore either have gone ashore, or taken shelter under it.
-
-About three o’clock, having the tide of ebb, we took up our anchor, made
-sail, and plied down the river till eight in the evening, when we came
-to an anchor again: early in the morning, we made sail with the first
-ebb, and kept plying till the flood obliged us once more to come to an
-anchor. As we had now only a light breeze, I went in the pinnace,
-accompanied by Dr. Solander, to the western shore, but I saw nothing
-worthy of notice.
-
-When I left the ship, many canoes were about it; Mr. Banks therefore
-chose to stay on board and traffic with the natives; they bartered their
-clothes and arms, chiefly for paper, and behaved with great friendship
-and honesty. But while some of them were below with Mr. Banks, a young
-man who was upon the deck stole a half minute glass which was in the
-binnacle, and was detected just as he was carrying it off. Mr. Hicks,
-who was commanding-officer on board, took it into his head to punish
-him, by giving him twelve lashes with a cat-o’nine-tails; and
-accordingly ordered him to be taken to the gangway, and tied up to the
-shrouds. When the other Indians who were on board saw him seized, they
-attempted to rescue him; and being resisted called for their arms, which
-were handed up from the canoes, and the people of one of them attempted
-to come up the ship’s side. The tumult was heard by Mr. Banks, who, with
-Tupia, came hastily upon the deck to see what had happened. The Indians
-immediately ran to Tupia, who, finding Mr. Hicks inexorable, could only
-assure them, that nothing was intended against the life of their
-companion; but that it was necessary he should suffer some punishment
-for his offence; which being explained to them, they seemed to be
-satisfied. The punishment was then inflicted, and as soon as the
-criminal was unbound, an old man among the spectators, who was supposed
-to be his father, gave him a hearty beating, and sent him down into his
-canoe. All the canoes then dropped a-stern, and the people said that
-they were afraid to come any more near the ship: after much persuasion,
-however, they ventured back again, but their cheerful confidence was at
-an end, and their stay was short; they promised indeed, at their
-departure, to return with some fish, but we saw no more of them.
-
-On the 23d, the wind being contrary, we kept plying down the river, and
-at seven in the evening, got without the N. W. point of the islands
-lying on the west side of it. The weather being bad, night coming on,
-and having land on every side of us, I thought it most advisable to
-tack, and stretch in under the point, where we anchored in nineteen
-fathom. At five in the morning of the 24th, we weighed, and made sail to
-the N. W. under our courses and double reefed topsails, the wind being
-at S. W. by W. and W. S. W. a strong gale and squally. As the gale would
-not permit us to come near the land, we had but a slight and distant
-view of it from the time when we got under sail till noon, during a run
-of twelve leagues, but we never once lost sight of it. At this time, our
-latitude by observation was 36° 15ʹ 20ʺ, we were not above two miles
-from a point of land on the main, and three leagues and an half from a
-very high island, which bore N. E. by E.: in this situation we had
-twenty-six fathom water: the farthest point on the main that we could
-see bore N. W. but we could perceive several small islands lying to the
-north of that direction. The point of land of which we were now
-a-breast, and which I called POINT RODNEY, is the N. W. extremity of the
-river Thames; for under that name I comprehend the deep bay, which
-terminates in the fresh water stream, and the N. E. extremity is the
-promontory which we passed when we entered it, and which I called CAPE
-COLVILLE, in honour of the Right Honourable Lord Colville.
-
-Cape Colville lies in latitude 36° 26ʹ, longitude 184° 27ʹ; it rises
-directly from the sea, to a considerable height, and is remarkable for a
-lofty rock, which stands to the pitch of the point, and may be
-distinguished at a very great distance. From the south point of this
-cape, the river runs in a direct line S. by E., and is no where less
-than three leagues broad for the distance of fourteen leagues above the
-cape, and there it is contracted to a narrow stream, but continues the
-same course through a low flat country, or broad valley, which lies
-parallel with the sea coast, and the end of which we could not see. On
-the east side of the broad part of this river, the land is tolerably
-high and hilly; on the west side, it is rather low, but the whole is
-covered with verdure and wood, and has the appearance of great
-fertility, though there were but a few small spots which had been
-cultivated. At the entrance of the narrow part of the river, the land is
-covered with mangroves and other shrubs; but farther, there are immense
-woods of perhaps the finest timber in the world, of which some account
-has already been given: in several places, the wood extends to the very
-edge of the water, and where it is at a little distance, the
-intermediate space is marshy, like some parts of the banks of the Thames
-in England: it is probable that the river contains plenty of fish, for
-we saw poles stuck up in many places to set nets for catching them, but
-of what kinds I do not know. The greatest depth of water that we found
-in this river was six-and-twenty fathom, which gradually decreased to
-one fathom and an half: in the mouth of the fresh-water stream, it is
-from four to three fathom, but there are large flats and sand banks
-lying before it. A ship of moderate draught may, notwithstanding, go a
-long way up this river with a flowing tide, for it rises perpendicularly
-near ten feet, and at the full and change of the moon, it is high water
-about nine o’clock.
-
-Six leagues within Cape Colville, under the eastern shore, are several
-small islands, which, together with the main, seem to form good
-harbours; and opposite to these islands, under the western shore, lie
-other islands, by which it is also probable that good harbours may be
-formed: but if there are no harbours about this river, there is good
-anchoring in every part of it where the depth of water is sufficient,
-for it is defended from the sea by a chain of islands of different
-extent, which lie cross the mouth of it, and which I have, for that
-reason, called BARRIER ISLANDS: they stretch N. W. and S. E. ten
-leagues. The south end of the chain lies N. E. between two and three
-leagues from Cape Colville; and the north end lies N. E. four leagues
-and an half from Point Rodney. Point Rodney lies W. N. W. nine leagues
-from Cape Colville, in latitude 36° 15ʹ S. longitude 184° 53ʹ W.
-
-The natives residing about this river do not appear to be numerous,
-considering the great extent of the country. But they are strong,
-well-made, and active people, and all of them paint their bodies with
-red oker and oil from head to foot, which we had not seen before. Their
-canoes were large and well built, and adorned with carving, in as good a
-taste as any that we had seen upon the coast.
-
-We continued to stand along the shore till night, with the main land on
-one side, and islands on the other, and then anchored in a bay, with
-fourteen fathom, and a sandy bottom. We had no sooner come to an anchor,
-than we tried our lines, and in a short time caught near one hundred
-fish, which the people called Sea-bream; they weighed from six to eight
-pounds a-piece, and consequently would supply the whole ship’s company
-with food for two days. From the success of our lines here, we called
-the place BREAM BAY: the two points that form it lie north and south,
-five leagues from each other; it is every where of a good breadth, and
-between three and four leagues deep: at the bottom of it there appears
-to be a river of fresh water. The north head of the bay, called BREAM
-HEAD, is high land, and remarkable for several pointed rocks, which
-stand in a range upon the top of it: it may also be known by some small
-islands which lie before it, called the HEN AND CHICKENS, one of which
-is high, and terminates in two peaks. It lies in latitude 35° 46ʹ S.,
-and at the distance of seventeen leagues and an half from Cape Colville,
-in the direction of N. 41 W.
-
-The land between Point Rodney and Bream Head, an extent of ten leagues,
-is low, and wooded in tufts, with white sand banks between the sea and
-the firm lands. We saw no inhabitants, but many fires in the night; and
-where there are fires, there are always people.
-
-At day-break, on the 25th, we left the bay, and steered along shore to
-the northward: we found the variation of the compass to be 12° 42ʹ E. At
-noon, our latitude was 35° 36ʹ S., Bream Head bore south, distant ten
-miles; and we saw some small islands, to which I gave the name of the
-POOR KNIGHTS, at N. E. by N. distant three leagues; the northernmost
-land in sight bore N. N. W.: we were in this place at the distance of
-two miles from the shore, and had twenty-six fathom water.
-
-The country appeared low, but well covered with wood: we saw some
-straggling houses, three or four fortified towns, and near them a large
-quantity of cultivated land.
-
-In the evening, seven large canoes came off to us, with about two
-hundred men: some of them came on board, and said that they had heard of
-us. To two of them, who appeared to be chiefs, I gave presents; but when
-these were gone out of the ship, the others became exceedingly
-troublesome. Some of those in the canoes began to trade, and, according
-to their custom, to cheat, by refusing to deliver what had been bought,
-after they had received the price: among these was one who had received
-an old pair of black breeches, which, upon a few small shot being fired
-at him, he threw into the sea. All the boats soon after paddled off to
-some distance, and when they thought they were out of reach, they began
-to defy us, by singing their song, and brandishing their weapons. We
-thought it advisable to intimidate them, as well for their sakes as our
-own, and therefore fired first some small arms, and then round shot over
-their heads; the last put them in a terrible fright, though they
-received no damage, except by over-heating themselves in paddling away,
-which they did with astonishing expedition.
-
-In the night we had variable light airs; but towards the morning, a
-breeze sprung up at S. and afterwards at S. E. with which we proceeded
-slowly to the northward, along the shore.
-
-Between six and seven o’clock, two canoes came off, and told us that
-they had heard of yesterday’s adventure, notwithstanding which the
-people came on board, and traded very quietly and honestly for whatever
-they had: soon after two canoes came off from a more distant part of the
-shore; these were of a much larger, size and full of people: when they
-came near, they called off the other canoes which were along side of the
-ship, and after a short conference they all came up together. The
-strangers appeared to be persons of a superior rank; their canoes were
-well carved with many ornaments, and they had with them a great variety
-of weapons: they had patoo-patoos both of stone and whalebone, upon
-which they appeared to set a great value; they had also ribs of whale,
-of which we had before seen imitations in wood, carved and adorned with
-tufts of dog’s hair. Their complexions were browner than those of the
-people we had seen to the southward, and their bodies and faces were
-more marked with the black stains which they call Amoco: they had a
-broad spiral on each buttock; and the thighs of many of them were almost
-entirely black, some narrow lines only being left untouched, so that at
-first sight they appeared to wear striped breeches. With respect to the
-Amoco, every different tribe seemed to have a different custom; for all
-the men, in some canoes, seemed to be almost covered with it, and those
-in others had scarcely a stain, except on the lips, which were black in
-all of them, without a single exception. These gentlemen, for a long
-time, refused to part with any of their weapons, whatever was offered
-for them; at last, however, one of them produced a piece of talc,
-wrought into the shape of an axe, and agreed to sell it for a piece of
-cloth: the cloth was handed over the ship’s side, but his honour
-immediately put off his canoe with the axe. We had recourse to our usual
-expedient, and fired a musket ball over the canoe, upon which it put
-back to the ship, and the piece of cloth was returned; all the boats
-then went ashore, without offering any further intercourse.
-
-At noon, the main land extended from S. by E. to N. W. by W. a
-remarkable point of land bearing W. distant four or five miles; at three
-we passed it, and I gave it the name of CAPE BRET, in honour of Sir
-Piercy. The land of this cape is considerably higher than any part of
-the adjacent coast: at the point of it, is a high round hillock, and N.
-E. by N. at the distance of about a mile, is a small high island or
-rock, which, like several that have already been described, was
-perforated quite through, so as to appear like the arch of a bridge.
-This cape, or at least some part of it, is by the natives called
-MOTUGOGOGO, and it lies in latitude 35° 10ʹ 30ʺ S. longitude 185° 25ʹ W.
-On the west side of it is a large and pretty deep bay, lying in S. W. by
-W. in which there appeared to be several small islands: the point that
-forms the N. W. entrance, lies W. ¼ N. at the distance of three or four
-leagues from Cape Bret, and I distinguished it by the name of POINT
-POCOCKE. On the west side of the bay, we saw several villages, both upon
-islands and the main, and several very large canoes came off to us, full
-of people, who made a better appearance than any we had seen yet: they
-were all stout and well-made; their hair, which was black, was tied up
-in a bunch on the crown of their heads, and stuck with white feathers.
-In each of the canoes, were two or three chiefs, whose habits were of
-the best sort of cloth, and covered with dog’s skin, so as to make an
-agreeable appearance: most of these people were marked with the Amoco,
-like those who had been alongside of us before: their manner of trading
-was also equally fraudulent; and the officers neglecting either to
-punish or fright them, one of the midshipmen who had been defrauded in
-his bargain, had recourse, for revenge, to an expedient which was
-equally ludicrous and severe: he got a fishing line, and when the man
-who had cheated him was close under the ship’s side in his canoe, he
-heaved the lead with so good an aim, that the hook caught him by the
-backside; he then pulled the line, and the man holding back, the hook
-broke in the shank, and the beard was left sticking in the flesh.
-
-During the course of this day, though we did not range more than six or
-eight leagues of the coast, we had alongside and on board the ship
-between four and five hundred of the natives, which is a proof that this
-part of the country is well inhabited.
-
-At eight o’clock the next morning, we were within a mile of a group of
-islands which lie close under the main, at the distance of
-two-and-twenty miles from Cape Bret, in the direction of N. W. by W. ½
-W. At this place, having but little wind, we lay about two hours, during
-which time several canoes came off, and sold us some fish, which we
-called Cavalles, and for that reason I gave the same name to the
-islands. These people were very insolent, frequently threatening us,
-even while they were selling their fish; and when some more canoes came
-up, they began to pelt us with stones. Some small shot were then fired,
-and hit one of them while he had a stone in his hand, in the very action
-of throwing it into the ship: they did not, however, desist, till some
-others had been wounded, and then they went away, and we stood off to
-sea.
-
-The wind being directly against us, we kept plying to windward till the
-29th, when we had rather lost than gained ground; I therefore bore up
-for a bay which lies to the westward of Cape Bret; at this time it was
-about two leagues to leeward of us; and at about eleven o’clock we
-anchored under the south west side of one of the many islands which line
-it on the south-east, in four fathom and an half water; we shoaled our
-water to this depth all at once, and if this had not happened, I should
-not have come to an anchor so soon. The master was immediately sent out
-with two boats to sound, and he soon discovered that we had got upon a
-bank, which runs out from the north-west end of the island, and that on
-the outside of it there was from eight to ten fathom.
-
-In the mean time the natives, to the number of near four hundred,
-crowded upon us in their canoes, and some of them were admitted on
-board: to one, who seemed to be a chief, I gave a piece of broad cloth,
-and distributed some trifling presents among the rest. I perceived that
-some of these people had been about the ship when she was off at sea,
-and that they knew the power of our fire-arms, for the very sight of a
-gun threw them into manifest confusion: under this impression, they
-traded very fairly; but the people in one of the canoes took the
-opportunity of our being at dinner to tow away our buoy: a musket was
-fired over them without effect, we then endeavoured to reach them with
-some small shot, but they were too far off: by this time they had got
-the buoy into their canoe, and we were obliged to fire a musket at them
-with ball: this hit one of them, and they immediately threw the buoy
-over board: a round shot was then fired over them, which struck the
-water and went ashore. Two or three of the canoes immediately landed
-their people, who ran about the beach, as we imagined, in search of the
-ball. Tupia called to them, and assured them that, while they were
-honest, they should be safe, and with a little persuasion many of them
-returned to the ship, and their behaviour was such as left us no reason
-to suspect that they intended to give us any farther trouble.
-
-After the ship was removed into deeper water, and properly secured, I
-went with the pinnace and yawl, manned and armed, accompanied by Mr.
-Banks and Dr. Solander, and landed upon the island, which was about
-three quarters of a mile distant: we observed that the canoes which were
-about the ship, did not follow us upon our leaving her, which we thought
-a good sign; but we had no sooner landed than they crowded to different
-parts of the island and came on shore. We were in a little cove, and in
-a few minutes were surrounded by two or three hundred people, some
-rushing from behind the heads of the cove, and others appearing on the
-tops of the hills: they were all armed, but they came on in so confused
-and straggling a manner that we scarcely suspected they meant us any
-harm, and we were determined that hostilities should not begin on our
-part. We marched towards them, and then drew a line upon the sand
-between them and us, which we gave them to understand they were not to
-pass: at first they continued quiet, but their weapons were held ready
-to strike, and they seemed to be rather irresolute than peaceable. While
-we remained in this state of suspense, another party of Indians came up,
-and now growing more bold as their number increased, they began the
-dance and song, which are their preludes to a battle: still, however,
-they delayed the attack, but a party ran to each of our boats, and
-attempted to draw them on shore; this seemed to be the signal, for the
-people about us at the same time began to press in upon our line: our
-situation was now become too critical for us to remain longer inactive,
-I therefore discharged my musket, which was loaded with small shot, at
-one of the forwardest, and Mr. Banks and two of the men fired
-immediately afterwards: this made them fall back in some confusion, but
-one of the chiefs, who was at the distance of about twenty yards,
-rallied them, and running forward, weaving his patoo-patoo, and calling
-loudly to his companions, led them to the charge. Dr. Solander, whose
-piece was not yet discharged, fired at this champion, who stopped short
-upon feeling the shot, and then ran away with the rest: they did not
-however disperse, but got together upon a rising ground, and seemed only
-to want some leader of resolution to renew their attack. As they were
-now beyond the reach of small shot, we fired with ball, but as none of
-them took place, they still continued in a body, and in this situation
-we remained about a quarter of an hour: in the mean time the ship, from
-whence a much greater number of Indians were seen than could be
-discovered in our situation, brought her broad-side to bear, and
-entirely dispersed them, by firing a few shot over their heads. In this
-skirmish only two of the Indians were hurt with the small shot, and not
-a single life was lost, which would not have been the case, if I had not
-restrained the men, who, either from fear or the love of mischief,
-showed as much impatience to destroy them as a sportsman to kill his
-game. When we were in quiet possession of our cove, we laid down our
-arms and began to gather celery, which grew here in great plenty: after
-a little time we recollected to have seen some of the people hide
-themselves in a cave of one of the rocks, we therefore went towards the
-place, when an old Indian, who proved to be the chief that I had
-presented with a piece of broad cloth in the morning, came out with his
-wife and his brother, and in a supplicating posture put themselves under
-our protection. We spoke kindly to them, and the old man then told us
-that he had another brother, who was one of those that had been wounded
-by the small shot, and enquired, with much solicitude and concern, if he
-would die. We assured him that he would not, and at the same time put
-into his hand both a musket-ball and some small shot, telling him, that
-those only who were wounded with the ball would die, and that the others
-would recover; at the same time assuring him, that if we were attacked
-again, we should certainly defend ourselves with the ball, which would
-wound them mortally. Having now taken courage, they came and sat down by
-us, and as tokens of our perfect amity, we made them presents of such
-trifles as we happened to have about us.
-
-Soon after we re-embarked in our boats, and having rowed to another cove
-in the same island, climbed a neighbouring hill, which commanded the
-country to a considerable distance. The prospect was very uncommon and
-romantic, consisting of innumerable islands, which formed as many
-harbours, where the water was as smooth as a mill-pool: we saw also many
-towns, scattered houses, and plantations, the country being much more
-populous than any we had seen. One of the towns was very near us, from
-which many of the Indians advanced, taking great pains to show us that
-they were unarmed, and in their gestures and countenances expressing
-great meekness and humility. In the mean time some of our people, who,
-when the Indians were to be punished for a fraud, assumed the inexorable
-justice of a Lycurgus, thought fit to break into one of their
-plantations, and dig up some potatoes: for this offence I ordered each
-of them to be punished with twelve lashes, after which two of them were
-discharged; but the third, insisting that it was no crime in an
-Englishman to plunder an Indian plantation, though it was a crime in an
-Indian to defraud an Englishman of a nail, I ordered him back into his
-confinement, from which I would not release him till he had received six
-lashes more.
-
-On the 30th, there being a dead calm, and no probability of our getting
-to sea, I sent the master, with two boats, to sound the harbour; and all
-the forenoon had several canoes about the ship, who traded in a very
-fair and friendly manner. In the evening we went ashore upon the main,
-where the people received us very cordially; but we found nothing worthy
-of notice.
-
-In this bay we were detained by contrary winds and calms several days,
-during which time our intercourse with the natives was continued in the
-most peaceable and friendly manner, they being frequently about the
-ship, and we ashore, both upon the islands and the main. In one of our
-visits to the continent, an old man showed us the instrument they use in
-the staining their bodies, which exactly resembled those that were
-employed for the same purpose at Otaheite. We saw also the man who was
-wounded in attempting to steal our buoy: the ball had passed through the
-fleshy part of his arm, and grazed his breast; but the wound, under the
-care of Nature, the best surgeon, and a simple diet, the best nurse, was
-in a good state, and seemed to give the patient neither pain nor
-apprehension. We saw also the brother of our old chief, who had been
-wounded with small shot in our skirmish: they had struck his thigh
-obliquely, and though several of them were still in the flesh, the wound
-seemed to be attended with neither danger nor pain. We found among their
-plantations the _morus papyrifera_, of which these people, as well as
-those of Otaheite, make cloth; but here the plant seems to be rare, and
-we saw no pieces of the cloth large enough for any use but to wear by
-way of ornament in their ears.
-
-Having one day landed in a very distant part of the bay, the people
-immediately fled, except one old man, who accompanied us wherever we
-went, and seemed much pleased with the little presents we made him. We
-came at last to a little fort, built upon a small rock, which at high
-water was surrounded by the sea, and accessible only by a ladder: we
-perceived that he eyed us with a kind of restless solicitude as we
-approached it, and upon our expressing a desire to enter it, he told us
-that his wife was there: he saw that our curiosity was not diminished by
-this intelligence, and after some hesitation, he said, if we would
-promise to offer no indecency, he would accompany us: our promise was
-readily given, and he immediately led the way. The ladder consisted of
-steps fastened to a pole, but we found the ascent both difficult and
-dangerous. When we entered we found three women, who, the moment they
-saw us, burst into tears of terror and surprise: some kind words and a
-few presents soon removed their apprehensions, and put them into good
-humour. We examined the house of our old friend, and by his interest two
-others, which were all that the fortification contained, and having
-distributed a few more presents, we parted with mutual satisfaction.
-
-At four o’clock in the morning of the 5th of December, we weighed, with
-a light breeze, but it being variable with frequent calms, we made
-little way. We kept turning out of the bay till the afternoon, and about
-ten o’clock we were suddenly becalmed, so that the ship would neither
-wear nor stay, and the tide or current setting strong, she drove towards
-land so fast, that before any measures could be taken for her security,
-she was within a cable’s length of the breakers: we had thirteen fathom
-water, but the ground was so foul that we did not dare to drop our
-anchor; the pinnace therefore was immediately hoisted out to take the
-ship in tow, and the men, sensible of their danger, exerting themselves
-to the utmost, and a faint breeze springing up off the land, we
-perceived, with unspeakable joy, that she made head-way, after having
-been so near the shore that Tupia, who was not sensible of our hair’s
-breadth escape, was at this very time conversing with the people upon
-the beach, whose voices were distinctly heard, notwithstanding the roar
-of the breakers. We now thought all danger was over, but about an hour
-afterwards, just as the man in the chains had cried “seventeen fathom,”
-the ship struck. The shock threw us all into the utmost consternation;
-Mr. Banks, who had undressed himself and was stepping into bed, ran
-hastily up to the deck, and the man in the chains called out “five
-fathom;” by this time, the rock on which we had struck being to
-windward, the ship went off without having received the least damage,
-and the water very soon deepened to twenty fathom.
-
-This rock lies half a mile W. N. W. of the northernmost or outermost
-island on the south-east side of the bay. We had light airs from the
-land, with calms, till nine o’clock the next morning, when we got out of
-the bay, and a breeze springing up at N. N. W. we stood out to sea.
-
-This bay, as I have before observed, lies on the west side of Cape Bret,
-and I named it the BAY OF ISLANDS, from the great number of islands
-which line its shores, and from several harbours equally safe and
-commodious, where there is room and depth for any number of shipping.
-That in which we lay is on the south-west side of the south westernmost
-island, called MATURARO, on the south-east side of the bay. I have made
-no accurate survey of this bay, being discouraged by the time it would
-cost me; I thought also that it was sufficient to be able to affirm that
-it afforded us good anchorage, and refreshment of every kind. It was not
-the season for roots, but we had plenty of fish, most of which, however,
-we purchased of the natives, for we could catch very little ourselves
-either with net or line. When we showed the natives our seine, which is
-such as the King’s ships are generally furnished with, they laughed at
-it, and in triumph produced their own, which, was indeed of an enormous
-size, and made of a kind of grass, which is very strong: it was five
-fathom deep, and by the room it took up, it could not be less than three
-or four hundred fathom long. Fishing seems indeed to be the chief
-business of life in this part of the country; we saw about all their
-towns a great number of nets, laid in heaps like hay-cocks, and covered
-with a thatch to keep them from the weather, and we scarcely entered a
-house where some of the people were not employed in making them. The
-fish we procured here were sharks, sting-rays, sea-bream, mullet,
-mackerel, and some others.
-
-The inhabitants in this bay are far more numerous than in any other part
-of the country that we had before visited; it did not appear to us that
-they were united under one head, and though their towns were fortified,
-they seemed to live together in perfect amity.
-
-It is high water in this bay at the full and change of the moon, about
-eight o’clock, and the tide then rises from six to eight feet
-perpendicularly. It appears, from such observations as I was able to
-make of the tides upon the sea-coast, that the flood comes from the
-southward; and I have reason to think that there is a current which
-comes from the westward, and sets along the shore to the S. E. or S. S.
-E. as the land happens to lie.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. V.
-
- RANGE FROM THE BAY OF ISLANDS ROUND NORTH CAPE TO QUEEN CHARLOTTE’S
- SOUND; AND A DESCRIPTION OF THAT PART OF THE COAST.
-
-
-ON Thursday the 7th of December, at noon, Cape Bret bore S. S. E. ½ E.
-distant ten miles, and our latitude, by observation, was 34° 59ʹ S.;
-soon after we made several observations of the sun and moon, the result
-of which made our longitude 185° 36ʹ W. The wind being against us, we
-had made but little way. In the afternoon, we stood in shore, and
-fetched close under the Cavalles, from which islands the main trends W.
-by N.: several canoes put off and followed us, but a light breeze
-springing up, I did not choose to wait for them. I kept standing to the
-W. N. W. and N. W. till the next morning ten o’clock, when I tacked and
-stood in for the shore, from which we were about five leagues distant.
-At noon, the westernmost land in sight bore W. by S. and was about four
-leagues distant. In the afternoon, we had a gentle breeze to the west,
-which in the evening came to the south, and continuing so all night, by
-day-light brought us pretty well in with the land, seven leagues to the
-westward of the Cavalles, where we found a deep bay running in S. W. by
-W. and W. S. W. the bottom of which we could but just see, and there the
-land appeared to be low and level. To this bay, which I called DOUBTLESS
-BAY, the entrance is formed by two points, which lie W. N. W. and E. S.
-E. and are five miles distant from each other. The wind not permitting
-us to look in here, we steered for the westernmost land in sight, which
-bore from us W. N. W. about three leagues, but before we got the length
-of it, it fell calm.
-
-While we lay becalmed, several canoes came off to us, but the people
-having heard of our guns, it was not without great difficulty that they
-were persuaded to come under our stern: after having bought some of
-their cloaths, as well as their fish, we began to make inquiries
-concerning their country, and learnt, by the help of Tupia, that, at the
-distance of three days’ rowing in their canoes, at a place called
-MOOREWENNUA, the land would take a short turn to the southward, and from
-thence extend no more to the west. This place we concluded to be the
-land discovered by Tasman, which he called CAPE MARIA VAN DIEMEN, and
-finding these people so intelligent, we inquired farther, if they knew
-of any country besides their own: they answered, that they never had
-visited any other, but that their ancestors had told them, that to the
-N. W. by N. or N. N. W. there was a country of great extent, called
-ULIMAROA, to which some people had sailed in a very large canoe; that
-only part of them returned, and reported, that after a passage of a
-month they had seen a country where the people eat hogs. Tupia then
-inquired whether these adventurers brought any hogs with them when they
-returned; they said, No: Then, replied Tupia, your story is certainly
-false, for it cannot be believed that men who came back from an
-expedition without hogs, had ever visited a country where hogs were to
-be procured. It is however remarkable, notwithstanding the shrewdness of
-Tupia’s objection, that when they mentioned hogs, it was not by
-description but by name; calling them _Booah_, the name which is given
-them in the South-sea islands; but if the animal had been wholly unknown
-to them, and they had had no communication with people to whom it was
-known, they could not possibly have been acquainted with the name.
-
-About ten o’clock at night, a breeze sprung up at W. N. W. with which we
-stood off north; and at noon the next day, the Cavalles bore S. E. by E.
-distant eight leagues; the entrance of Doubtless Bay S. by W., distant
-three leagues; and the north-west extremity of the land in sight, which
-we judged to be the main, bore N. W. by W.: our latitude by observation
-was 34° 44ʹ S. In the evening, we found the variation to be 12° 41ʹ E.
-by the azimuth, and 12° 40ʹ by the amplitude.
-
-Early in the morning, we stood in with the land, seven leagues to the
-westward of Doubtless Bay, the bottom of which is not far distant from
-the bottom of another large bay, which the shore forms at this place,
-being separated only by a low neck of land, which juts out into a
-peninsula that I have called KNUCKLE POINT. About the middle of this
-bay, which we called SANDY BAY, is a high mountain, standing upon a
-distant shore, to which I gave the name of MOUNT CAMEL. The latitude
-here is 34° 51ʹ S. and longitude 186° 50ʹ. We had twenty-four and
-twenty-five fathom water, with a good bottom; but there seems to be
-nothing in this bay that can induce a ship to put into it; for the land
-about it is utterly barren and desolate, and, except Mount Camel, the
-situation is low: the soil appears to be nothing but white sand, thrown
-up in low irregular hills and narrow ridges, lying parallel with the
-shore. But barren and desolate as this place is, it is not without
-inhabitants: we saw one village on the west side of Mount Camel, and
-another on the east side; we saw also five canoes full of people, who
-pulled after the ship, but could not come up with us. At nine o’clock,
-we tacked and stood to the northward; and at noon, the Cavalles bore S.
-E. by E., distant thirteen leagues; the north extremity of the land in
-sight, making like an island, bore N. W. ¼ N. distant nine leagues; and
-Mount Camel bore S. W. by S., distance six leagues.
-
-The wind being contrary, we kept plying northward till five o’clock in
-the evening of the 12th, when, having made very little way, we tacked
-and stood to the N. E. being two leagues to the northward of Mount
-Camel, and about a mile and a half from the shore, in which situation we
-had two-and-twenty fathom water.
-
-At ten it began to blow and rain, which brought us under double reefed
-topsails; at twelve we tacked and stood to the westward till seven the
-next morning, when we tacked and stood again to the N. E., being about a
-mile to windward of the place where we tacked last night. Soon after it
-blew very hard at N. N. W. with heavy squalls and much rain, which
-brought us under our courses, and split the maintopsail; so that we were
-obliged to unbend it and bend another: at ten, it became more moderate,
-and we set the topsails, double reefed: at noon, having strong gales and
-heavy weather, we tacked and stood to the westward, and had no land in
-sight for the first time since we had been upon this coast.
-
-We had now strong gales at W. and W. S. W.; and at half an hour past
-three we tacked and stood to the northward. Soon after, a small island
-lying off Knuckle Point bore S. ½ W., distant half a league. In the
-evening, having split the fore and mizen topsails, we brought the ship
-under her courses; and at midnight, we wore, and stood to the southward
-till five in the morning; when we tacked and stood to the N. W., and saw
-land bearing south, at the distance of eight or nine leagues; by this we
-discovered that we had fallen much to the leeward since yesterday
-morning. At noon our latitude by observation was 34° 6ʹ S.; and the same
-land which we had seen before to the N. W. now bore S. W., and appeared
-to be the northern extremity of the country. We had a large swell
-rolling in from the westward, and, therefore, concluded that we were not
-covered by any land in that quarter. At eight in the evening, we tacked
-and stood to the westward, with as much sail as we could bear; and at
-noon the next day, we were in latitude 34° 10ʹ, longitude 185° 45ʹ W.,
-and by estimation about seventeen leagues from the land, notwithstanding
-our utmost endeavours to keep in with it.
-
-On the 16th, at six in the morning, we saw land from the mast-head,
-bearing S. S. W.; and at noon it bore S. by W. distant fourteen leagues:
-while we were standing in for the shore, we sounded several times, but
-had no ground with ninety fathom. At eight, we tacked in a hundred and
-eight fathom, at about three or four miles from the shore, which was the
-same point of land that we had to the N. W. before we were blown off. At
-noon, it bore S. W., distant about three miles; Mount Camel bore S. by
-E., distant about eleven leagues, and the westernmost land in sight bore
-S. 75 W.; the latitude by observation was 34° 20ʹ S. At four o’clock, we
-tacked and stood in shore, in doing which, we met with a strong
-rippling, and the ship fell fast to leeward, which we imputed to a
-current setting east. At eight, we tacked and stood off till eight the
-next morning; when we tacked and stood in, being about ten leagues from
-the land: at noon, the point of land which we were near the day before,
-bore S. S. W. distant five leagues. The wind still continued at west;
-and at seven o’clock, we tacked in thirty-five fathom, when the point of
-land which has been mentioned before, bore N. W. by N., distant four or
-five miles; so that we had not gained one inch to windward the last
-twenty-four hours, which confirmed our opinion that there was a current
-to the eastward. The point of land I called NORTH CAPE, it being the
-northern extremity of this country. It lies in latitude 34° 22ʹ S.,
-longitude 186° 55ʹ W., and thirty-one leagues distant from Cape Bret, in
-the direction of N. 63 W. It forms the north point of Sandy Bay, and is
-a peninsula jutting out N. E. about two miles, and terminating in a
-bluff head that is flat at the top. The isthmus which joins this head to
-the main land is very low, and for that reason the land of the cape,
-from several situations, has the appearance of an island. It is still
-more remarkable when it is seen from the southward, by the appearance of
-a high round island at the S. E. point of the cape; but this also is a
-deception; for what appears to be an island is a round hill, joined to
-the cape by a low narrow neck of land. Upon the cape we saw a Hippah or
-village, and a few inhabitants; and on the south-east side of it, there
-appears to be anchorage, and good shelter from the south-west and
-north-west winds.
-
-We continued to stand off and on, making N. W. till noon on the 21st,
-when North Cape bore S. 39 E. distant thirty-eight leagues. Our
-situation varied only a few leagues till the 23d, when, about seven
-o’clock in the evening, we saw land from the mast-head, bearing S. ½ E.
-At eleven the next morning, we saw it again, bearing S. S. E. at the
-distance of eight leagues: we now stood to the S. W.; and at four
-o’clock, the land bore S. E. by S. distant four leagues, and proved to
-be a small island, with other islands or rocks, still smaller, lying off
-the south-west end of it, and another lying off the north-east end,
-which were discovered by Tasman, and called the Three Kings. The
-principal island lies in latitude 34° 12ʹ S., longitude 187° 48ʹ W., and
-distant fourteen or fifteen leagues from North Cape, in the direction of
-W. 14 N. At midnight, we tacked and stood to the N. E. till six the next
-morning, which was Christmas-day, when we tacked and stood to the
-southward. At noon, the Three Kings bore E. 8 N. distant five or six
-leagues. The variation this morning by the azimuth was 11° 25ʹ E.
-
-On the 26th, we stood to the southward close upon a wind; and at noon,
-were in latitude 35° 10ʹ S., longitude 188° 20ʹ W., the Three Kings
-bearing N. 26 W. distant twenty-two leagues. In this situation we had no
-land in sight; and yet, by observation, we were in the latitude of the
-Bay of Islands; and by my reckoning but twenty leagues to the westward
-of North Cape: from whence it appears, that the northern part of this
-island is very narrow; for otherwise we must have seen some part of the
-west side of it. We stood to the southward till twelve at night, and
-then tacked and stood to the northward.
-
-At four o’clock in the morning, the wind freshened, and at nine, blew a
-storm; so that we were obliged to bring the ship to under her mainsail.
-Our course made good between noon this day and yesterday was S. S. W. ½
-W., distance eleven miles. The Three Kings bore N. 27 E. distant
-seventy-seven miles. The gale continued all this day, and till two the
-next morning, when it fell, and began to veer to the southward and S.
-W., where it fixed about four, when we made sail and steered east in for
-the land, under the fore-sail and main-sail; but the wind then rising,
-and by eight o’clock being increased to a hurricane, with a prodigious
-sea, we were obliged to take in the main-sail; we then wore the ship,
-and brought her to with her head to the north-west. At noon the gale was
-somewhat abated, but we had still heavy squalls. Our course made good
-this day, was north, a little easterly, twenty-nine miles; latitude by
-account 34° 50ʹ S., longitude 188° 27ʹ W.; the Three Kings bore N. 41 E.
-distant fifty-two miles. At seven o’clock in the evening, the wind being
-at S. W. and S. W. by W., with hard squalls, we wore and lay on the
-other tack; and at six the next morning spread more sail. Our course and
-distance since yesterday was E. by N. twenty-nine miles. In the
-afternoon, we had hard squalls at S. W.; and at eight in the evening,
-wore and stood to the N. W. till five the next morning; and then wore
-and stood to the S. E. At six, we saw the land bearing N. E., distant
-about six leagues, which we judged to be Cape _Maria Van Diemen_, and
-which corresponded with the account that had been given of it by the
-Indians. At midnight we wore and stood to the S. E. And on the next day
-at noon, Cape Maria Van Diemen bore N. E. by N., distant about five
-leagues. At seven in the evening, we tacked and stood to the westward,
-with a moderate breeze at S. W. by S. and S. W. Mount Camel then bore N.
-83 E., and the northernmost land, or Cape Maria Van Diemen, N. by W.; we
-were now distant from the nearest land about three leagues, where we had
-something more than forty fathom water; and it must be remarked, that
-Mount Camel, which when seen on the other side did not seem to be more
-than one mile from the sea, seemed to be but little more when seen from
-this side; which is a demonstration that the land here cannot be more
-than two or three miles broad, or from sea to sea.
-
-At six o’clock in the morning of January the 1st, 1770, being New-year’s
-day, we tacked and stood to the eastward, the Three Kings bearing N. W.
-by N. At noon, we tacked again, and stood to the westward, being in
-latitude 34° 37ʹ S.; the Three Kings bearing N. W. by N. at the distance
-of ten or eleven leagues; and Cape Maria Van Diemen N. 31 E. distant
-about four leagues and a half: in this situation we had fifty-four
-fathom water.
-
-During this part of our navigation two particulars are very remarkable;
-in latitude 35° S., and in the midst of summer, I met with a gale of
-wind, which for its strength and continuance was such as I had scarcely
-ever been in before, and we were three weeks in getting ten leagues to
-the westward, and five week in getting fifty leagues, for at this time
-it was so long since we passed Cape Bret. During the gale, we were
-happily at a considerable distance from the land, otherwise it is highly
-probable that we should never have returned to relate our adventures.
-
-At five o’clock in the evening, having a fresh breeze to the westward,
-we tacked and stood to the southward: at this time North Cape bore E. ¾
-N., and just open of a point that lies three leagues W. by N. from it.
-
-This cape, as I have observed before, is the northernmost extremity of
-this country, and the easternmost point of a peninsula, which runs out
-N. W. and N. W. by N. seventeen or eighteen leagues, and of which Cape
-Maria Van Diemen is the westernmost point. Cape Maria lies in latitude
-34° 30ʹ S., longitude 187° 18ʹ W.; and from this point the land trends
-away S. E. by S. and S. E. beyond Mount Camel, and is every where a
-barren shore, consisting of banks of white sand.
-
-On the 2d, at noon, we were in latitude 35° 17ʹ S., and Cape Maria bore
-north, distant about sixteen leagues, as near as we could guess; for we
-had no land in sight, and did not dare to go nearer, as a fresh gale
-blew right on shore, with a rolling sea. The wind continued at W. S. W.
-and S. W. with frequent squalls; in the evening we shortened sail, and
-at midnight tacked, and made a trip to the N. W. till two in the
-morning, when we wore and stood to the southward. At break of day, we
-made sail, and edged away, in order to make land; and at ten o’clock, we
-saw it, bearing N. W. It appeared to be high, and at noon extended from
-N. to E. N. E. distant by estimation eight or ten leagues. Cape Maria
-then bore N. 2° 30ʹ W. distant thirty-three leagues; our latitude by
-observation was 36° 2ʹ S. About seven o’clock in the evening, we were
-within six leagues of it; but having a fresh gale upon it, with a
-rolling sea, we hauled our wind to the S. E., and kept on that course
-close upon the wind all night, sounding several times, but having no
-ground with one hundred, and one hundred and ten fathom.
-
-At eight o’clock the next morning, we were about five leagues from the
-land, and off a place which lies in latitude 36° 25ʹ, and had the
-appearance of a bay or inlet. It bore east; and in order to see more of
-it, we kept on our course till eleven o’clock, when we were not more
-than three leagues from it, and then discovered that it was neither
-inlet nor bay, but a tract of low land, bounded by higher lands on each
-side, which produced the deception. At this time, we tacked and stood to
-the N. W.; and at noon, the land was not distant more than three or four
-leagues. We were now in latitude 36° 31ʹ S., longitude 185° 50ʹ W. Cape
-Maria bore N. 25 W. distant forty-four leagues and a half; so that the
-coast must be almost straight in the direction of S. S. E. ¾ E. and N.
-N. W. ¾ W. nearly. In about latitude 35° 45ʹ is some high land adjoining
-to the sea; to the southward of which the shore is also high, and has
-the most desolate and inhospitable appearance that can be imagined.
-Nothing is to be seen but hills of sand, on which there is scarcely a
-blade of verdure; and a vast sea, impelled by the westerly winds
-breaking upon it in a dreadful surf, renders it not only forlorn, but
-frightful; complicating the idea of danger with desolation, and
-impressing the mind at once with a sense of misery and death. From this
-place I steered to the northward, resolving never more to come within
-the same distance of the coast, except the wind should be very
-favourable indeed. I stood under a fresh sail all the day, hoping to get
-an offing by the next noon, and we made good a course of a hundred and
-two miles N. 38 W. Our latitude by observation was 35° 10ʹ S.; and Cape
-Maria bore N. 10 E., distance forty-one miles. In the night, the wind
-shifted from S. W. by S. to S., and blew fresh. Our course to the noon
-of the 5th, was N. 75 W., distance eight miles.
-
-At day-break on the 6th, we saw the land, which we took to be Cape
-Maria, bearing N. N. E., distant eight or nine leagues: and on the 7th,
-in the afternoon, the land bore east: and some time after, we discovered
-a turtle upon the water; but being awake, it dived instantly, so that we
-could not take it. At noon, the high land, which has just been
-mentioned, extended from N. to E. at the distance of five or six
-leagues; and in two places, a flat gave it the appearance of a bay or
-inlet. The course that we made good the last four-and-twenty hours was
-S. 33 E. fifty-three miles; Cape Maria bearing N. 25 W., distant thirty
-leagues.
-
-We sailed within sight of land all this day, with gentle gales between
-the N. E. and N. W.; and by the next noon had sailed sixty-nine miles,
-in the direction of S. 37 E.; our latitude by observation was 36° 39ʹ S.
-The land which on the 4th we had taken for a bay, now bore N. E. by N.,
-distant five leagues and a half; and Cape Maria N. 29 W., forty-seven
-leagues.
-
-On the 9th, we continued a south-east course till eight o’clock in the
-evening, having run seven leagues since noon, with the wind at N. N. E.
-and N., and being within three or four leagues of the land, which
-appeared to be low and sandy. I then steered S. E. by S. in a direction
-parallel with the coast, having from forty-eight to thirty-four fathom
-water, with a black sandy bottom. At day-break the next morning, we
-found ourselves between two and three leagues from the land, which began
-to have a better appearance, rising in gentle slopes, and being covered
-with trees and herbage. We saw a smoke and a few houses, but it appeared
-to be but thinly inhabited. At seven o’clock, we steered S. by E., and
-afterwards S. by W., the land lying in that direction. At nine, we were
-a-breast of a point which rises with an easy ascent from the sea to a
-considerable height: this point, which lies in latitude 37° 43ʹ, I named
-WOODY HEAD. About eleven miles from this Head, in the direction of S. W.
-½ W. lies a very small island, upon which we saw a great number of
-gannets, and which we, therefore, called GANNET ISLAND. At noon, a high
-craggy point bore E. N. E. distant about a league and a half, to which I
-gave the name of ALBATROSS POINT: it lies in latitude 38° 4ʹ S.,
-longitude 184° 42ʹ W.; and is distant seven leagues in the direction of
-S. 17 W. from Woody Head. On the north-side of this point the shore
-forms a bay, in which there appears to be anchorage and shelter for
-shipping. Our course and distance for the last twenty-four hours was S.
-37 E. sixty-nine miles; and at noon this day Cape Maria bore N. 30 W.
-distant eighty-two leagues. Between twelve and one, the wind shifted at
-once from N. N. E. to S. S. W. with which we stood to the westward till
-four o’clock in the afternoon; and then tacked, and stood again in shore
-till seven; when we tacked again and stood to the westward, having but
-little wind. At this time Albatross Point bore N. E., distant near two
-leagues, and the southernmost land in sight bore S. S. W. ½ W. being a
-very high mountain, and in appearance greatly resembling the Peak of
-Teneriffe. In this situation we had thirty fathom water, and having but
-little wind all night, we tacked about four in the morning, and stood in
-for the shore. Soon after, it fell calm; and being in forty-two fathom
-water, the people caught a few sea-bream. At eleven, a light breeze
-sprung up from the west, and we made sail to the southward. We continued
-to steer S. by W. and S. S. W. along the shore, at the distance of about
-four leagues, with gentle breezes from between N. W. and N. N. E. At
-seven in the evening, we saw the top of the peak to the southward, above
-the clouds, which concealed it below. And at this time, the southernmost
-land in sight bore S. by W.; the variation, by several azimuths which
-were taken both in the morning and the evening, appeared to be 14° 15ʹ
-easterly.
-
-At noon on the 12th, we were distant about three leagues from the shore
-which lies under the peak, but the peak itself was wholly concealed by
-clouds: we judged it to bear about S. S. E.; and some very remarkable
-peaked islands, which lay under the shore, bore E. S. E., distant three
-or four leagues. At seven in the evening we sounded, and had forty-two
-fathom, being distant from the shore between two and three leagues: we
-judged the peak to bear east; and after it was dark, we saw fires upon
-the shore.
-
-At five o’clock in the morning we saw, for a few minutes, the summit of
-the peak, towering above the clouds, and covered with snow. It now bore
-N. E.; it lies in latitude 39° 16ʹ S., longitude 185° 15ʹ W.; and I
-named it MOUNT EGMONT, in honour of the earl. It seems to have a large
-base, and to rise with a gradual ascent; it lies near the sea, and is
-surrounded by a flat country, of a pleasant appearance, being clothed
-with verdure and wood, which renders it the more conspicuous, and the
-shore under it forms a large cape, which I have named CAPE EGMONT. It
-lies S. S. W. ½ W. twenty-seven leagues distant from Albatross Point,
-and on the north-side of it are two small islands, which lie near a
-remarkable point on the main, that rises to a considerable height in the
-form of a sugar-loaf. To the southward of the cape, the land trends away
-S. E. by E. and S. S. E., and seems to be every where a bold shore. At
-noon, Cape Egmont bore about N. E.; and in this direction, at about four
-leagues from the shore, we had forty fathom of water. The wind during
-the rest of the day was from W. to N. W. by W., and we continued to
-steer along the shore S. S. E. and S. E. by E., keeping at the distance
-of between two or three leagues. At half an hour after seven, we had
-another transient view of Mount Edgcombe, which bore N. 17 W., distant
-about ten leagues.
-
-At five the next morning, we steered S. E. by S., the coast inclining
-more southerly; and in about half an hour we saw land, bearing S. W. by
-S., for which we hauled up. At noon, the north-west extremity of the
-land in sight bore S. 63 W., and some high land, which had the
-appearance of an island lying under the main, bore S. S. E., distant
-five leagues. We were now in a bay, the bottom of which bearing south,
-we could not see, though it was clear in that quarter. Our latitude by
-observation was 40° 27ʹ S., longitude 184° 39ʹ W. At eight in the
-evening, we were within two leagues of the land which we had discovered
-in the morning, having run ten leagues since noon: the land which then
-bore S. 63 W., now bore N. 59 W., at the distance of seven or eight
-leagues, and had the appearance of an island. Between this land and CAPE
-EGMONT lies the bay, the west-side of which was our situation at this
-time, and the land here is of a considerable height, and diversified by
-hill and valley.
-
-
-
-
- CHAP. VI.
-
- TRANSACTIONS IN QUEEN CHARLOTTE’S SOUND: PASSAGE THROUGH THE STRAIGHT
-WHICH DIVIDES THE TWO ISLANDS, AND BACK TO CAPE TURNAGAIN: HORRID CUSTOM
-OF THE INHABITANTS: REMARKABLE MELODY OF BIRDS: A VISIT TO A HEPPAH, AND
- MANY OTHER PARTICULARS.
-
-
-THE shore at this place seemed to form several bays, into one of which I
-proposed to carry the ship, which was become very foul, in order to
-careen her, and at the same time repair some defects, and recruit our
-wood and water.
-
-With this view, I kept plying on and off all night, having from eighty
-to sixty-three fathom. At day-break the next morning, I stood for an
-inlet which runs in S. W.; and at eight I got within the entrance which
-may be known by a reef of rocks, stretching from the north-west point,
-and some rocky islands which lie off the south-east point. At nine
-o’clock, there being little wind, and what there was being variable, we
-were carried by the tide or current within two cables’ length of the
-north-west shore, where we had fifty-four fathom water, but by the help
-of our boats we got clear. Just at this time we saw a sea-lion rise
-twice near the shore, the head of which exactly resembled that of the
-male which has been described in the Account of Lord Anson’s Voyage. We
-also saw some of the natives in a canoe cross the bay, and a village
-situated upon the point of an island which lies seven or eight miles
-within the entrance. At noon, we were the length of this island, but
-there being little wind, the boats were ordered a-head to tow. About one
-o’clock, we hauled close round the south-west end of the island; and the
-inhabitants of the village which was built upon it, were immediately up
-in arms. About two, we anchored in a very safe and convenient cove, on
-the north-west-side of the bay, and facing the south-west end of the
-island, in eleven fathom water, with soft ground, and moored with the
-stream anchor.
-
-We were about four long cannon shot distant from the village or Heppah,
-from which four canoes were immediately dispatched, as we imagined, to
-reconnoitre, and, if they should find themselves able, to take us. The
-men were all well armed, and dressed nearly as they are represented in
-the figure published by Tasman; two corners of the cloth which they
-wrapped round the body were passed over the shoulders from behind, and
-being brought down to the upper edge of it before, were made fast to it
-just under the breast; but few, or none, had feathers in their hair.
-
-They rowed round the ship several times, with their usual tokens of
-menace and defiance, and at last began the assault by throwing some
-stones: Tupia expostulated with them, but apparently to very little
-purpose; and we began to fear that they would oblige us to fire at them,
-when a very old man in one of the boats expressed a desire of coming on
-board. We gladly encouraged him in his design, a rope was thrown into
-his canoe, and she was immediately along side of the ship: the old man
-rose up, and prepared to come up the ship’s side, upon which all the
-rest expostulated with great vehemence against the attempt, and at last
-laid hold of him, and held him back: he adhered however to his purpose
-with a calm but steady perseverance, and having at length disengaged
-himself, he came on board. We received him with all possible expressions
-of friendship and kindness, and after some time dismissed him, with many
-presents, to his companions. As soon as he was returned on board his
-canoe, the people in all the rest began to dance, but whether as a token
-of enmity or friendship we could not certainly determine, for we had
-seen them dance in a disposition both for peace and war. In a short
-time, however, they retired to their fort, and soon after I went on
-shore, with most of the gentlemen, at the bottom of the cove, a-breast
-of the ship.
-
-We found a fine stream of excellent water, and wood in the greatest
-plenty, for the land here was one forest, of vast extent. As we brought
-the seine with us, we hauled it once or twice, and with such success
-that we caught near three hundred weight of fish of different sorts,
-which was equally distributed among the ship’s company.
-
-At day-break, while we were busy in careening the ship, three canoes
-came off to us, having on board above a hundred men, besides several of
-their women, which we were pleased to see, as in general it is a sign of
-peace; but they soon afterwards became very troublesome, and gave us
-reason to apprehend some mischief from them to the people that were in
-our boats alongside the ship. While we were in this situation, the
-long-boat was sent ashore with some water casks, and some of the canoes
-attempting to follow her, we found it necessary to intimidate them by
-firing some small-shot: we were at such a distance that it was
-impossible to hurt them, yet our reproof had its effect, and they
-desisted from the pursuit. They had some fish in their canoes which they
-now offered to sell, and which, though it stunk, we consented to buy:
-for this purpose a man in a small boat was sent among them, and they
-traded for some time very fairly. At length, however, one of them
-watching his opportunity, snatched at some paper which our market-man
-held in his hand, and missing it, immediately put himself in a posture
-of defence, flourished his patoo-patoo, and making show as if he was
-about to strike; some small shot were then fired at him from the ship, a
-few of which struck him upon the knee: this put an end to our trade, but
-the Indians still continued near the ship, rowing round her many times,
-and conversing with Tupia, chiefly concerning the traditions they had
-among them with respect to the antiquities of their country. To this
-subject they were led by the inquiries which Tupia had been directed to
-make, whether they had ever seen such a vessel as ours, or had ever
-heard that any such had been upon their coast. These inquiries were all
-answered in the negative, so that tradition has preserved among them no
-memorial of Tasman; though, by an observation made this day, we find
-that we are only fifteen miles south of Murderer’s Bay, our latitude
-being 41° 5ʹ 32ʺ, and Murderer’s Bay, according to his account, being
-40° 50ʹ.
-
-The women in these canoes, and some of the men, had a head-dress which
-we had not before seen. It consisted of a bunch of black feathers, made
-up in a round form, and tied upon the top of the head, which it entirely
-covered, and made it twice as high, to appearance, as it was in reality.
-
-After dinner I went in the pinnace with Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, Tupia,
-and some others, into another cove, about two miles distant from that in
-which the ship lay: in our way we saw something floating upon the water,
-which we took for a dead seal, but upon rowing up to it, found it to be
-the body of a woman, which, to all appearance, had been dead some days.
-We proceeded to our cove, where we went on shore, and found a small
-family of Indians, who appeared to be greatly terrified at our approach,
-and all ran away except one. A conversation between this person and
-Tupia soon brought back the rest, except an old man and a child, who
-still kept aloof, but stood peeping at us from the woods. Of these
-people, our curiosity naturally led us to enquire after the body of the
-woman, which we had seen floating upon the water: and they acquainted
-us, by Tupia, that she was a relation, who had died a natural death; and
-that, according to their custom, they had tied a stone to the body, and
-thrown it into the sea, which stone, they supposed, had, by some
-accident, been disengaged.
-
-This family, when we came on shore, was employed in dressing some
-provisions: the body of a dog was at this time buried in their oven, and
-many provision-baskets stood near it. Having cast our eyes carelessly
-into one of these, as we passed it, we saw two bones pretty cleanly
-picked, which did not seem to be the bones of a dog, and which, upon a
-nearer examination, we discovered to be those of a human body. At this
-sight we were struck with horror, though it was only a confirmation of
-what we had heard many times since we arrived upon this coast. As we
-could have no doubt but the bones were human, neither could we have any
-doubt but that the flesh which covered them had been eaten. They were
-found in a provision basket; the flesh that remained appeared manifestly
-to have been dressed by fire, and in the gristles at the end, were the
-marks of the teeth which had gnawed them: to put an end, however, to
-conjecture, founded upon circumstances and appearances, we directed
-Tupia to ask what bones they were; and the Indians, without the least
-hesitation, answered, the bones of a man: they were then asked what was
-become of the flesh, and they replied that they had eaten it; but, said
-Tupia, why did you not eat the body of the woman which we saw floating
-upon the water: the woman, said they, died of disease; besides, she was
-our relation, and we eat only the bodies of our enemies, who are killed
-in battle. Upon enquiry who the man was whose bones we had found, they
-told us, that about five days before, a boat belonging to their enemies
-came into the bay, with many persons on board, and that this man was of
-the seven whom they had killed. Though stronger evidence of this horrid
-practice prevailing among the inhabitants of this coast will scarcely be
-required, we have still stronger to give. One of us asked if they had
-any human bones with the flesh remaining upon them, and upon their
-answering us that all had been eaten, we affected to disbelieve that the
-bones were human, and said that they were the bones of a dog; upon which
-one of the Indians, with some eagerness, took hold of his own fore-arm,
-and thrusting it towards us, said, that the bone which Mr. Banks held in
-his hand had belonged to that part of the human body; at the same time,
-to convince us that the flesh had been eaten, he took hold of his own
-arm with his teeth, and made show of eating: he also bit and gnawed the
-bone which Mr. Banks had taken, drawing it through his mouth, and
-showing, by signs, that it had afforded a delicious repast; the bone was
-then returned to Mr. Banks, and he brought it away with him. Among the
-persons of this family, there was a woman who had her arms, legs, and
-thighs, frightfully cut in several places; and we were told that she had
-inflicted the wounds upon herself, in token of her grief for the loss of
-her husband, who had been lately killed and eaten by their enemies, who
-had come from some place to the eastward, towards which the Indians
-pointed.
-
-The ship lay at the distance of somewhat less than a quarter of a mile
-from the shore, and in the morning we were awakened by the singing of
-the birds: the number was incredible, and they seemed to strain their
-throats in emulation of each other. This wild melody was infinitely
-superior to any that we had ever heard of the same kind; it seemed to be
-like small bells, most exquisitely tuned, and perhaps the distance, and
-the water between, might be no small advantage to the sound. Upon
-inquiry, we were informed that the birds here always began to sing about
-two hours after midnight, and continuing their music till sunrise, were,
-like our nightingales, silent the rest of the day. In the forenoon, a
-small canoe came off from the Indian village to the ship, and among
-those that were in it, was the old man who had first come on board at
-our arrival in the bay. As soon as it came alongside, Tupia renewed the
-conversation that had passed the day before, concerning their practice
-of eating human flesh, during which they repeated what they had told us
-already; but, said Tupia, where are the heads? do you eat them too? Of
-the heads, said the old man, we eat only the brains, and the next time I
-come I will bring some of them to convince you that what we have told
-you is truth. After some farther conversation between these people and
-Tupia, they told him that they expected their enemies to come very
-shortly, to revenge the death of the seven men whom they had killed and
-eaten.
-
-On the 18th, the Indians were more quiet than usual, no canoe came near
-the ship, nor did we see one of them moving on the shore, their fishing,
-and other usual occupations being totally suspended. We thought they
-expected an attack on this day, and, therefore, attended more diligently
-to what passed on shore; but we saw nothing to gratify our curiosity.
-
-After breakfast, we went out in the pinnace, to take a view of the bay,
-which was of vast extent, and consisted of numberless small harbours and
-coves, in every direction: we confined our excursion, however, to the
-western side, and the country being an impenetrable forest where we
-landed, we could see nothing worthy of notice: we killed, however, a
-good number of shags, which we saw sitting upon their nests in the
-trees, and which, whether roasted or stewed, we considered as very good
-provision. As we were returning, we saw a single man in a canoe fishing;
-we rowed up to him, and, to our great surprise, he took not the least
-notice of us, but even when we were alongside of him, continued to
-follow his occupation, without adverting to us any more than if we had
-been invisible. He did not, however, appear to be either sullen or
-stupid: we requested him to draw up his net, that we might examine it,
-and he readily complied: it was of a circular form, extended by two
-hoops, and about seven or eight feet in diameter: the top was open, and
-sea-ears were fastened to the bottom as a bait: this he let down so as
-to lie upon the ground, and when he thought fish enough were assembled
-over it, he drew it up by a very gentle and even motion, so that the
-fish rose with it, scarcely sensible that they were lifted, till they
-came very near the surface of the water, and then were brought out in
-the net by a sudden jerk. By this simple method, he had caught abundance
-of fish, and, indeed, they are so plenty in this bay, that the catching
-them requires neither much labour nor art.
-
-This day, some of our people found in the skirts of the wood, near a
-hole or oven, three human hipbones, which they brought on board; a
-farther proof that these people eat human flesh: Mr. Monkhouse, our
-surgeon, also brought on board, from a place where he saw many deserted
-houses, the hair of a man’s head, which he had found, among many other
-things, tied up to the branches of trees.
-
-In the morning of the 19th, we set up the armourer’s forge to repair the
-braces of the tiller, and other iron-work, all hands on board being
-still busy in careening, and other necessary operations about the
-vessel: this day, some Indians came on board from another part of the
-bay, where they said there was a town which we had not seen: they
-brought plenty of fish, which they sold for nails, having now acquired
-some notion of their use; and in this traffic no unfair practice was
-attempted.
-
-In the morning of the 20th, our old man kept his promise, and brought on
-board four of the heads of the seven people who had been so much the
-subject of our inquiries: the hair and flesh were entire, but we
-perceived that the brains had been extracted; the flesh was soft, but
-had by some method been preserved from putrefaction, for it had no
-disagreeable smell. Mr. Banks purchased one of them, but they sold it
-with great reluctance, and could not by any means be prevailed upon to
-part with a second; probably they may be preserved as trophies, like the
-scalps in America, and the jaw-bones in the islands of the South Seas.
-Upon examining the head which had been bought by Mr. Banks, we perceived
-that it had received a blow upon the temples, which had fractured the
-skull. This day we made another excursion in the pinnace, to survey the
-bay, but we found no flat large enough for a potatoe garden, nor could
-we discover the least appearance of cultivation: we met not a single
-Indian, but found an excellent harbour; and about eight o’clock in the
-evening returned on board the ship.
-
-On the 21st, Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander went a fishing with hook and
-line, and caught an immense quantity every where upon the rocks, in
-between four and five fathom water: the seine was hauled every night,
-and seldom failed to supply the whole ship’s company with as much fish
-as they could eat. This day all the people had leave to go on shore at
-the watering-place, and divert themselves as they should think proper.
-
-In the morning of the 22d, I set out again in the pinnace, accompanied
-by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, with a design to examine the head of the
-inlet, but, after rowing about four or five leagues without so much as
-coming in sight of it, the wind being contrary, and the day half spent,
-we went on shore on the south-east side, to try what might be discovered
-from the hills.
-
-Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander immediately employed themselves in botanizing
-near the beach, and I, taking a seaman with me, ascended one of the
-hills: when I reached the summit, I found a view of the inlet
-intercepted by hills, which in that direction rose still higher, and
-which were rendered inaccessible by impenetrable woods; I was, however,
-abundantly compensated for my labour, for I saw the sea on the eastern
-side of the country, and a passage leading from it to that on the west,
-a little to the eastward of the entrance of the inlet where the ship now
-lay. The main land, which lay on the south-east of this inlet, appeared
-to be a narrow ridge of very high hills, and to form part of the
-south-west side of the straight; the land on the opposite side appeared
-to trend away east as far as the eye could reach; and to the south-east
-there appeared to be an opening to the sea, which washed the eastern
-coast: on the east side of the inlet also I saw some islands which I had
-before taken to be part of the main land. Having made this discovery, I
-descended the hill, and as soon as we had taken some refreshment, we set
-out on our return to the ship. In our way, we examined the harbours and
-coves which lie behind the islands that I had discovered from the hill;
-and in this route we saw an old village, in which there were many houses
-that seemed to have been long deserted: we also saw another village
-which was inhabited, but the day was too far spent for us to visit it,
-and we therefore made the best of our way to the ship, which we reached
-between eight and nine o’clock at night.
-
-The 23d I employed in carrying on a survey of the place; and upon one of
-the islands where I landed, I saw many houses which seemed to have been
-long deserted, and no appearance of any inhabitant.
-
-On the 24th, we went to visit our friends at the Hippah or village on
-the point of the island near the ship’s station, who had come off to us
-on our first arrival in the bay. They received us with the utmost
-confidence and civility, showing us every part of their habitations,
-which were commodious and neat. The island or rock on which this town is
-situated, is divided from the main by a breach or fissure so narrow,
-that a man might almost leap from one to the other: the sides of it are
-every where so steep as to render the artificial fortification of these
-people almost unnecessary: there was, however, one slight pallisade, and
-one small fighting-stage, towards that part of the rock where access was
-least difficult.
-
-The people here brought us out several human bones, the flesh of which
-they had eaten, and offered them to sale; for the curiosity of those
-among us who had purchased them as memorials of the horrid practice
-which many, notwithstanding the reports of travellers, have professed
-not to believe, had rendered them a kind of article of trade. In one
-part of this village, we observed, not without some surprise, a cross
-exactly like that of a crucifix; it was adorned with feathers, and upon
-our inquiring for what purpose it had been set up, we were told that it
-was a monument for a man who was dead: we had before understood that
-their dead were not buried, but thrown into the sea; but to our inquiry
-how the body of the man had been disposed of, to whose memory this cross
-had been erected, they refused to answer.
-
-When we left these people, we went to the other end of the island, and
-there taking water, crossed over to the main, where we saw several
-houses, but no inhabitants, except a few in some straggling canoes, that
-seemed to be fishing. After viewing this place, we returned on board the
-ship to dinner.
-
-During our visit to the Indians this day, Tupia being always of our
-party, they had been observed to be continually talking of guns, and
-shooting people: for this subject of their conversation we could not at
-all account; and it had so much engaged our attention, that we talked of
-it all the way back, and even after we got on board the ship: we had
-perplexed ourselves with various conjectures, which were all given up in
-their turn; but now we learnt, that on the 21st one of our officers,
-upon pretence of going out to fish, had rowed up to the Hippah, and that
-two or three canoes coming off towards his boat, his fears suggested
-that an attack was intended, in consequence of which three muskets were
-fired, one with small shot and two with ball, at the Indians, who
-retired with the utmost precipitation, having probably come out with
-friendly intentions; for such their behaviour both before and afterwards
-expressed; and having no reason to expect such treatment from people who
-had always behaved to them not only with humanity but kindness, and to
-whom they were not conscious of having given offence.
-
-On the 25th, I made another excursion along the coast, in the pinnace,
-towards the mouth of the inlet, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr.
-Solander, and going on shore at a little cove, to shoot shags, we fell
-in with a large family of Indians, whose custom it is to disperse
-themselves among the different creeks and coves, where fish is to be
-procured in the greatest plenty, leaving a few only in the hippah, to
-which the rest repair in times of danger. Some of these people came out
-a good way to meet us, and gave us an invitation to go with them to the
-rest of their party, which we readily accepted. We found a company of
-about thirty, men, women, and children, who received us with all
-possible demonstrations of friendship: we distributed among them a few
-ribands and beads, and, in return, received the kisses and embraces of
-both sexes, both young and old: they gave us also some fish, and after a
-little time we returned, much pleased with our new acquaintance.
-
-In the morning of the 26th, I went again out in the boat, with Mr. Banks
-and Dr. Solander, and entered one of the bays, which lie on the east
-side of the inlet, in order to get another sight of the streight, which
-passed between the eastern and western seas. For this purpose, having
-landed at a convenient place, we climbed a hill of a very considerable
-height, from which we had a full view of it, with the land on the
-opposite shore, which we judged to be about four leagues distant; but as
-it was hazy in the horizon, we could not see far to the south-east: I
-resolved, however, to search the passage with the ship, as soon as I
-should put to sea. Upon the top of this hill we found a parcel of loose
-stones, with which we erected a pyramid, and left in it some musket
-balls, small shot, beads, and other things, which we happened to have
-about us, that were likely to stand the test of time, and, not being of
-Indian workmanship, would convince any European who should come to the
-place and pull it down, that other natives of Europe had been there
-before him. When this was done, we descended the hill, and made a
-comfortable meal of the shags and fish which our guns and lines had
-procured us, and which were dressed by the boat’s crew in a place that
-we had appointed: in this place we found another Indian family, who
-received us, as usual, with strong expressions of kindness and pleasure,
-showing us where to procure water, and doing us such other good offices
-as were in their power. From this place we went to the town of which the
-Indians had told us, who visited us on the 19th; this, like that which
-we had seen before, was built upon a small island or rock, so difficult
-of access, that we gratified our curiosity at the risk of our necks. The
-Indians here also received us with open arms, carried us to every part
-of the place, and showed us all that it contained: this town, like the
-other, consisted of between eighty and an hundred houses, and had only
-one fighting-stage. We happened to have with us a few nails and ribands,
-and some paper, with which our guests were so gratified, that at our
-coming away they filled our boat with dried fish, of which we perceived
-they had laid up great quantities.
-
-The 27th and 28th were spent in refitting the ship for the sea, fixing a
-transom for the tiller, getting stones on board to put into the bottom
-of the bread-room, to bring the ship more by the stern, in repairing the
-casks, and catching fish.
-
-On the 29th, we received a visit from our old man, whose name we found
-to be TOPĀA, and three other natives, with whom Tupia had much
-conversation. The old man told us, that one of the men who had been
-fired upon by the officer who had visited their hippah, under pretence
-of fishing, was dead; but to my great comfort I afterwards discovered
-that this report was not true, and that if Topāa’s discourses were taken
-literally, they would frequently lead us into mistakes. Mr. Banks and
-Dr. Solander were several times on shore during the last two or three
-days, not without success, but greatly circumscribed in their walks, by
-climbers of a most luxuriant growth, which were so interwoven together
-as to fill up the space between the trees about which they grew, and
-render the woods altogether impassable. This day, also, I went on shore
-again myself, upon the western point of the inlet, and from a hill of
-considerable height I had a view of the coast to the N. W. The farthest
-land I could see in that quarter was an island which has been mentioned
-before, at the distance of about ten leagues, lying not far from the
-main: between this island and the place where I stood, I discovered,
-close under the shore, several other islands, forming many bays, in
-which there appeared to be good anchorage for shipping. After I had set
-off the different points for my survey, I erected another pile of
-stones, in which I left a piece of silver coin, with some musket balls
-and beads, and a piece of an old pendant flying on the top. In my return
-to the ship, I made a visit to several of the natives, whom I saw along
-the shore, and purchased a small quantity of fish.
-
-On the 30th, early in the morning, I sent a boat to one of the islands
-for celery, and while the people were gathering it, about twenty of the
-natives, men, women, and children, landed near some empty huts: as soon
-as they were on shore, five or six of the women sat down upon the ground
-together, and began to cut their legs, arms, and faces, with shells, and
-sharp pieces of talc or jaspar, in a terrible manner. Our people
-understood that their husbands had lately been killed by their enemies:
-but, while they were performing this horrid ceremony, the men set about
-repairing the huts, with the utmost negligence and unconcern.
-
-The carpenter having prepared two posts to be left as memorials of our
-having visited this place, I ordered them to be inscribed with the
-ship’s name, and the year and month: one of them I set up at the
-watering-place, hoisting the Union-flag upon the top of it; and the
-other I carried over to the island that lies nearest to the sea, called
-by the natives MOTUARA. I went first to the village or hippah,
-accompanied by Mr. Monkhouse and Tupia, where I met with our old man,
-and told him and several others, by means of Tupia, that we were come to
-set up a mark upon the island, in order to show to any other ship which
-should happen to come thither, that we had been there before. To this
-they readily consented, and promised that they never would pull it down:
-I then gave something to every one present; and to the old man I gave a
-silver three-pence, dated 1736, and some spike-nails, with the king’s
-broad arrow cut deep upon them; things which I thought most likely to
-remain long among them: I then took the post to the highest part of the
-island, and, after fixing it firmly in the ground, I hoisted upon it the
-Union-flag, and honoured this inlet with the name of QUEEN CHARLOTTE’S
-SOUND; at the same time taking formal possession of this and the
-adjacent country, in the name and for the use of his Majesty King George
-the Third. We then drank a bottle of wine to her Majesty’s health, and
-gave the bottle to the old man who had attended us up the hill, and who
-was mightily delighted with his present.
-
-While the post was setting up, we enquired of the old man concerning the
-passage into the eastern sea, the existence of which he confirmed; and
-then asked him about the land to the S. W. of the streight, where we
-were then situated: this land, he said, consisted of two whennuas or
-islands, which may be circumnavigated in a few days, and which he called
-TOVY POENAMMOO: the literal translation of this word is, “the water of
-green talc;” and probably if we had understood him better, we should
-have found that Tovy Poenammoo was the name of some particular place
-where they got the green talc or stone of which they make their
-ornaments and tools, and not a general name for the whole southern
-district: he said there was also a third whennua, on the east side of
-the streight, the circumnavigation of which would take up many moons:
-this he called EAHEINOMAUWE; and to the land on the borders of the
-streight he gave the name of TIERA WITTE. Having set up our post, and
-procured this intelligence, we returned on board the ship, and brought
-the old man with us, who was attended by his canoe, in which, after
-dinner, he returned home.
-
-On the 31st, having completed our wooding, and filled all our
-water-casks, I sent out two parties, one to cut and make brooms, and
-another to catch fish. In the evening we had a strong gale from the N.
-W., with such a heavy rain, that our little wild musicians on shore
-suspended their song, which till now we had constantly heard during the
-night, with a pleasure which it was impossible to lose without regret.
-
-On the 1st, the gale increased to a storm, with heavy gusts from the
-high land, one of which broke the hawser that we had fastened to the
-shore, and obliged us to let go another anchor. Towards midnight, the
-gale became more moderate, but the rain continued with such violence,
-that the brook which had supplied us with water overflowed its banks,
-and carried away ten small casks which had been left there full of
-water, and, notwithstanding we searched the whole cove, we could never
-recover one of them.
-
-On the 3d, as I intended to sail the first opportunity, I went over to
-the hippah on the east side of the Sound, and purchased a considerable
-quantity of split and half-dried fish, for sea-stores. The people here
-confirmed all that the old man had told us concerning the streight and
-the country, and about noon I took leave of them: some of them seemed to
-be sorry, and others glad, that we were going: the fish which I had
-bought they sold freely, but there were some who showed manifest signs
-of disapprobation. As we returned to the ship, some of us made an
-excursion along the shore to the northward, to traffic with the natives
-for a farther supply of fish; in which, however, they had no great
-success. In the evening we got every thing off from the shore, as I
-intended to sail in the morning, but the wind would not permit.
-
-On the 4th, while we were waiting for a wind, we amused ourselves by
-fishing, and gathering shells and seeds of various kinds; and early in
-the morning of the 5th, we cast off the hawser, hove short on the bower,
-and carried the kedge-anchor out, in order to warp the ship out of the
-cove, which having done, about two o’clock in the afternoon, we hove up
-the anchor and got under sail; but the wind soon failing, we were
-obliged to come to an anchor again a little above Motuara. When we were
-under sail, our old man, Topāa, came on board to take his leave of us;
-and as we were still desirous of making farther enquiries whether any
-memory of Tasman had been preserved among these people, Tupia was
-directed to ask him whether he had ever heard that such a vessel as ours
-had before visited the country. To this he replied in the negative; but
-said that his ancestors had told him there had once come to this place a
-small vessel, from a distant country, called ULIMAROA, in which were
-four men, who, upon their coming on shore, were all killed: upon being
-asked where this distant land lay, he pointed to the northward. Of
-Ulimaroa we had heard something before, from the people about the Bay of
-Islands, who said that their ancestors had visited it; and Tupia had
-also talked to us of Ulimaroa, concerning which he had some confused
-traditionary notions, not very different from those of our old man, so
-that we could draw no certain conclusion from the accounts of either.
-
-Soon after the ship came to an anchor the second time, Mr. Banks and Dr.
-Solander went on shore, to see if any gleanings of natural knowledge
-remained; and by accident fell in with the most agreeable Indian family
-they had seen, which afforded them a better opportunity of remarking the
-personal subordination among these people than had before offered. The
-principal persons were a widow, and a pretty boy about ten years old:
-the widow was mourning for her husband with tears of blood, according to
-their custom, and the child, by the death of its father, was become
-proprietor of the land where we had cut our wood. The mother and the son
-were sitting upon mats, and the rest of the family, to the number of
-sixteen or seventeen, of both sexes, sat round them in the open air, for
-they did not appear to have any house, or other shelter from the
-weather, the inclemencies of which custom has probably enabled them to
-endure without any lasting inconvenience. Their whole behaviour was
-affable, obliging, and unsuspicious: they presented each person with
-fish, and a brand of fire to dress it, and pressed them many times to
-stay till the morning, which they would certainly have done if they had
-not expected the ship to sail, greatly regretting that they had not
-become acquainted with them sooner, as they made no doubt but that more
-knowledge of the manners and disposition of the inhabitants of this
-country would have been obtained from them in a day than they had yet
-been able to acquire during our whole stay upon the coast.
-
-On the 6th, about six o’clock in the morning, a light breeze sprung up
-at north, and we again got under sail; but the wind proving variable, we
-reached no farther than just without Motuara; in the afternoon, however,
-a more steady gale at N. by W. set us clear of the Sound, which I shall
-now describe.
-
-The entrance of Queen Charlotte’s Sound is situated in latitude 41° S.,
-longitude 184° 45ʹ W., and near the middle of the south-west side of the
-streight in which it lies. The land of the south-east head of the Sound,
-called by the natives KOAMAROO, off which lie two small islands and some
-rocks, makes the narrowest part of the streight. From the north-west
-head a reef of rocks runs out about two miles, in the direction of N. E.
-by N.; part of which is above the water, and part below. By this account
-of the heads, the Sound will be sufficiently known: at the entrance it
-is three leagues broad, and lies in S. W. by S. S. W. and W. S. W. at
-least ten leagues, and is a collection of some of the finest harbours in
-the world, as will appear from the plan, which is laid down with all the
-accuracy that time and circumstances would admit. The land forming the
-harbour or cove in which we lay, is called by the natives TOTARRANUE:
-the harbour itself, which I called SHIP COVE, is not inferior to any in
-the Sound, either for convenience or safety: it lies on the west side of
-the Sound, and is the southernmost of three coves, that are situated
-within the island of Motuara, which bears east of it. Ship Cove may be
-entered, either between Motuara and a long island, called by the natives
-HAMOTE, or between Motuara and the western shore. In the last of these
-channels are two ledges of rocks, three fathom under water, which may
-easily be known by the sea-weed that grows upon them. In sailing either
-in or out of the Sound, with little wind, attention must be had to the
-tides, which flow about nine or ten o’clock at the full and change of
-the moon, and rise and fall between seven and eight feet
-perpendicularly. The flood comes in through the streight from the S. E.
-and sets strongly over upon the north-west head, and the reef that lies
-off it: the ebb sets with still greater rapidity to the S. E. over upon
-the rocks and islands that lie off the south-east head. The variation of
-the compass we found, from good observation, to be 13° 5ʹ E.
-
-The land about this Sound, which is of such a height that we saw it at
-the distance of twenty-leagues, consists wholly of high hills and deep
-valleys, well stored with a variety of excellent timber, fit for all
-purposes except masts, for which it is too hard and heavy. The sea
-abounds with a variety of fish, so that, without going out of the cove
-where we lay, we caught every day, with the seine and hooks and lines, a
-quantity sufficient to serve the whole ship’s company; and along the
-shore we found plenty of shags, and a few other species of wild-fowl,
-which those who have long lived upon salt provisions will not think
-despicable food.
-
-The number of inhabitants scarcely exceeds four hundred, and they live
-dispersed along the shores, where their food, consisting of fish and
-fern roots, is most easily procured; for we saw no cultivated ground.
-Upon any appearance of danger, they retire to their hippahs, or forts:
-in this situation we found them, and in this situation they continued
-for some time after our arrival. In comparison of the inhabitants of
-other parts of this country, they are poor, and their canoes are without
-ornament: the little traffic we had with them was wholly for fish; and
-indeed they had scarcely any thing else to dispose of. They seemed,
-however, to have some knowledge of iron, which the inhabitants of some
-other parts had not; for they willingly took nails for their fish, and
-sometimes seemed to prefer it to every thing else that we could offer,
-which had not always been the case. They were at first very fond of
-paper; but when they found that it was spoiled by being wet, they would
-not take it: neither did they set much value upon the cloth of Otaheite;
-but English broad cloth and red kersey were in high estimation; which
-showed that they had sense enough to appreciate the commodities which we
-offered by their use, which is more than could be said of some of their
-neighbours, who made a much better appearance. Their dress has been
-mentioned already, particularly their large round head-dresses of
-feathers, which were far from being unbecoming.
-
-As soon as we got out of the Sound, I stood over to the eastward, in
-order to get the streight well open before the tide of ebb came on. At
-seven in the evening, the two small islands which lie off Cape Koamaroo,
-the south-east head of Queen Charlotte’s Sound, bore east, distant about
-four miles: at this time it was nearly calm, and the tide of ebb setting
-out, we were, in a very short time, carried by the rapidity of the
-stream close upon one of the islands, which was a rock rising almost
-perpendicularly out of the sea: we perceived our danger increase every
-moment, and had but one expedient to prevent our being dashed to pieces,
-the success of which a few minutes would determine. We were now within
-little more than a cable’s length of the rock, and had more than
-seventy-five fathom water; but upon dropping an anchor, and veering
-about one hundred and fifty fathom of cable, the ship was happily
-brought up: this, however, would not have saved us, if the tide which
-set S. by E. had not, upon meeting with the island, changed its
-direction to S. E. and carried us beyond the first point. In this
-situation, we were not above two cables’ length from the rocks; and here
-we remained in the strength of the tide, which set to the S. E. after
-the rate of at least five miles an hour, from a little after seven till
-near midnight, when the tide abated, and we began to heave. By three in
-the morning the anchor was at the bows, and having a light breeze at N.
-W. we made sail for the eastern shore; but the tide being against us, we
-made but little way: the wind, however, afterwards freshened, and came
-to N. and N. E. with which, and the tide of ebb, we were in a short time
-hurried through the narrowest part of the streight, and then stood away
-for the southernmost land we had in sight, which bore from us S. by W.
-Over this land appeared a mountain of stupendous height, which was
-covered with snow.
-
-The narrowest part of the streight, through which we had been driven
-with such rapidity, lies between Cape Tierawitte, on the coast of
-Eaheinomauwe, and Cape Koamaroo: the distance between them I judged to
-be between four or five leagues, and, notwithstanding the tide, now its
-strength is known, may be passed without much danger. It is, however,
-safest to keep on the north-east shore, for on that side there appeared
-to be nothing to fear; but on the other shore there are not only the
-islands and rocks which lie off Cape Koamaroo, but a reef of rocks
-stretching from these islands six or seven miles to the southward, at
-the distance of two or three miles from the shore, which I had
-discovered from the hill when I took my second view of the streight from
-the east to the western sea. The length of the streight we had passed, I
-shall not pretend to assign, but some judgment may be formed of it from
-a view of the chart.
-
-About nine leagues north from Cape Tierawitte, and under the same shore,
-is a high and remarkable island which may be distinctly seen from Queen
-Charlotte’s Sound, from which it is distant about six or seven leagues.
-This island, which was noticed when we passed it on the 14th of January,
-I have called ENTRY ISLE.
-
-On the east side of Cape Tierawitte, the land trends away S. E. by E.
-about eight leagues, where it ends in a point, and is the southernmost
-land on Eaheinomauwe. To this point I have given the name of CAPE
-PALLISER, in honour of my worthy friend Captain Palliser. It lies in
-latitude 41° 34ʹ S., longitude 183° 58ʹ W., and bore from us this day at
-noon S. 79 E. distant about thirteen leagues, the ship being then in the
-latitude of 41° 27ʹ S.; Koamaroo at the same time bearing N. ½ E.
-distant seven or eight leagues. The southernmost land in sight bore S.
-16 W. and the snowy mountain S. W. At this time we were about three
-leagues from the shore, and abreast of a deep bay or inlet, to which I
-gave the name of CLOUDY BAY, and at the bottom of which there appeared
-low land covered with tall trees.
-
-At three o’clock in the afternoon we were abreast of the southernmost
-point of land that we had seen at noon, which I called CAPE CAMPBELL: it
-lies S. by W. distant between twelve and thirteen leagues from Cape
-Koamaroo, in latitude 41° 44ʹ S., longitude 183° 45ʹ W.; and with Cape
-Palliser forms the southern entrance of the straight, the distance
-between them being between thirteen and fourteen leagues W. by S. and E.
-by N.
-
-From this Cape we steered along the shore S. W. by S. till eight o’clock
-in the evening, when the wind died away. About half an hour afterwards,
-however, afresh breeze sprung up at S. W., and I put the ship right
-before it. My reason for this was a notion which some of the officers
-had just started, that Eaheinomauwe was not an island, and that the land
-might stretch away to the S. E. from between Cape Turnagain and Cape
-Palliser, there being a space of between twelve and fifteen leagues that
-we had not seen. I had, indeed, the strongest conviction that they were
-mistaken, not only from what I had seen the first time I discovered the
-straight, but from many other concurrent testimonies, that the land in
-question was an island; but being resolved to leave no possibility of
-doubt with respect to an object of such importance, I took the
-opportunity of the wind’s shifting, to stand eastward, and accordingly
-steered N. E. by E. all the night. At nine o’clock in the morning we
-were abreast of Cape Palliser, and found the land trend away N. E.
-towards Cape Turnagain, which I reckoned to be distant about twenty-six
-leagues: however, as the weather was hazy, so as to prevent our seeing
-above four or five leagues, I still kept standing to the N. E. with a
-light breeze at south; and at noon Cape Palliser bore N. 72 W. distant
-about three leagues.
-
-About three o’clock in the afternoon three canoes came up to the ship
-with between thirty and forty people on board, who had been pulling
-after us with great labour and perseverance for some time: they appeared
-to be more cleanly, and a better class, than any we had met with since
-we left the Bay of Islands; and their canoes were also distinguished by
-the same ornaments which we had seen upon the northernly part of the
-coast. They came on board with very little invitation; and their
-behaviour was courteous and friendly. Upon receiving presents from us,
-they made us presents in return, which had not been done by any of the
-natives that we had seen before. We soon perceived that our guests had
-heard of us, for as soon as they came on board, they asked for _Whow_,
-the name by which nails were known among the people with whom we had
-trafficked: but though they had heard of nails, it was plain they had
-seen none; for when nails were given them, they asked Tupia what they
-were. The term _Whow_, indeed, conveyed to them the idea not of their
-quality, but only of their use; for it is the same by which they
-distinguish a tool, commonly made of bone, which they use both as an
-auger and a chisel. However, their knowing that we had _whow_ to sell,
-was a proof that their connections extended as far north as Cape
-Kidnappers, which was distant no less than forty-five leagues; for that
-was the southernmost place on this side the coast where we had had any
-traffic with the natives. It is also probable, that the little knowledge
-which the inhabitants of Queen Charlotte’s Sound had of iron, they
-obtained from their neighbours at Tierawitte; for we had no reason to
-think that the inhabitants of any part of this coast had the least
-knowledge of iron or its use before we came among them, especially as,
-when it was first offered, they seemed to disregard it as of no value.
-We thought it probable, that we were now once more in the territories of
-Teratu; but upon enquiring of these people, they said that he was not
-their king. After a short time, they went away, much gratified with the
-presents that we had made them; and we pursued our course along the
-shore to the N. E. till eleven o’clock the next morning. About this
-time, the weather happening to clear up, we saw Cape Turnagain, bearing
-N. by E. ½ E. at the distance of about seven leagues: I then called the
-officers upon deck, and asked them, whether they were not now satisfied
-that Eahienomauwe was an island: they readily answered in the
-affirmative; and all doubts being now removed, we hauled our wind to the
-eastward.
-
-
- END OF THE FIRST VOLUME.
-
-
- Printed by A. and R. Spottiswoode,
- Printers-Street, London.
-
-Footnote 1:
-
- The celebrated navigator who discovered this streight was a native of
- Portugal, and his name, in the language of his country, was _Fernando
- de Magalhaens_; the Spaniards call him _Hernando Magalhanes_, and the
- French _Magellan_, which is the orthography that has been generally
- adopted: a gentleman, the fifth in descent from this great adventurer,
- is now living in or near London, and communicated the true name of his
- ancestor to Mr. Banks, with a request that it might be inserted in
- this work.
-
-
-
-
- Transcriber’s Note
-
-
-This book uses inconsistent spelling and hyphenation, which were
-retained in the ebook version. Some corrections have been made to the
-text, including such as normalizing punctuation. Further corrections are
-noted below:
-
- p. 9: appearance; the the sides -> appearance; the sides
- p. 26: whereever I went -> wherever I went
- p. 29: some doubs whether -> some doubts whether
- p. 36: as to to declare -> as to declare
- Caption to illustration facing p. 84: Otahiete -> Otaheite
- p. 174: by a a succession -> by a succession
- p. 178: tellting us, that they -> telling us, that they
- p. 190: not sraight lines -> not straight lines
- p. 200: sucks it into his month -> sucks it into his mouth
- p. 222: inhabiants of Otaheite -> inhabitants of Otaheite
- p. 240: the cermony of lowering -> the ceremony of lowering
- p. 240: to day -> to-day
- p. 279: for our our landing -> for our landing
- p. 295: wind being right an end -> wind being right on end
- p. 309: the sun’s meridan -> the sun’s meridian
- p. 310: their is no quarter -> there is no quarter
- p. 316: lobsters and muscles -> lobsters and mussels
- p. 320: the nothernmost of the Court -> the northernmost of the Court
- p. 333: the botton to the top -> the bottom to the top
- p. 361: discovered by Tafman -> discovered by Tasman
- p. 365: by obervation -> by observation
- p. 380: continued to folllow -> continued to follow
- p. 397: they aked for -> they asked for
-
-
-
-
-
-End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of The Three Voyages of Captain Cook
-Round the World. Vol. I. Being th, by James Cook and Joseph Banks and Dr. Hawkesworth
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THREE VOYAGES OF CAPTAIN COOK, VOL 1 ***
-
-***** This file should be named 56196-0.txt or 56196-0.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/5/6/1/9/56196/
-
-Produced by Sonya Schermann and the Online Distributed
-Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was
-produced from images generously made available by The
-Internet Archive)
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
-be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
-States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks, unless you receive
-specific permission. If you do not charge anything for copies of this
-eBook, complying with the rules is very easy. You may use this eBook
-for nearly any purpose such as creation of derivative works, reports,
-performances and research. They may be modified and printed and given
-away--you may do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks
-not protected by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the
-trademark license, especially commercial redistribution.
-
-START: FULL LICENSE
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
-person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
-1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
-Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country outside the United States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
-on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
- most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
- restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
- under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
- eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
- United States, you'll have to check the laws of the country where you
- are located before using this ebook.
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
-other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
-Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-provided that
-
-* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
- works.
-
-* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
-
-* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and The
-Project Gutenberg Trademark LLC, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark. Contact the Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
-www.gutenberg.org
-
-
-
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is in Fairbanks, Alaska, with the
-mailing address: PO Box 750175, Fairbanks, AK 99775, but its
-volunteers and employees are scattered throughout numerous
-locations. Its business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt
-Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up to
-date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and
-official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-For additional contact information:
-
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
-state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
-facility: www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-
diff --git a/old/56196-0.zip b/old/56196-0.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index 18ff7aa..0000000
--- a/old/56196-0.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/56196-h.zip b/old/56196-h.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index 61eb10b..0000000
--- a/old/56196-h.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/56196-h/56196-h.htm b/old/56196-h/56196-h.htm
deleted file mode 100644
index e9c6660..0000000
--- a/old/56196-h/56196-h.htm
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,17016 +0,0 @@
-<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
- "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
-<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en">
- <head>
- <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=UTF-8" />
- <title>The Project Gutenberg eBook of The Three Voyages of Captain James Cook Round the World. Vol I. Being the First of The First Voyage</title>
- <link rel="coverpage" href="images/cover.jpg" />
- <style type="text/css">
- body { margin-left: 8%; margin-right: 10%; }
- h1 { text-align: center; font-weight: normal; font-size: 1.4em; }
- h2 { text-align: center; font-weight: normal; font-size: 1.2em; }
- .pageno { right: 1%; font-size: x-small; background-color: inherit; color: silver;
- text-indent: 0em; text-align: right; position: absolute;
- border: thin solid silver; padding: .1em .2em; font-style: normal;
- font-variant: normal; font-weight: normal; text-decoration: none; }
- p { text-indent: 0; margin-top: 0.5em; margin-bottom: 0.5em; text-align: justify; }
- sup { vertical-align: top; font-size: 0.6em; }
- .sc { font-variant: small-caps; }
- .large { font-size: large; }
- .xlarge { font-size: x-large; }
- .lg-container-b { text-align: center; }
- @media handheld { .lg-container-b { clear: both; } }
- .linegroup { display: inline-block; text-align: left; }
- @media handheld { .linegroup { display: block; margin-left: 1.5em; } }
- .linegroup .group { margin: 1em auto; }
- .linegroup .line { text-indent: -3em; padding-left: 3em; }
- div.linegroup > :first-child { margin-top: 0; }
- .linegroup .in2 { padding-left: 4.0em; }
- .linegroup .in4 { padding-left: 5.0em; }
- div.footnote > :first-child { margin-top: 1em; }
- div.footnote p { text-indent: 1em; margin-top: 0.25em; margin-bottom: 0.25em; }
- .chapter { clear: both; page-break-before: always; }
- .figcenter { clear: both; max-width: 100%; margin: 2em auto; text-align: center; }
- .figright { clear: right; float: right; max-width: 100%; margin: 0.5em 0 1em 1em;
- text-align: right; }
- div.figcenter p { text-align: center; text-indent: 0; }
- @media handheld { .figright { float: right; } }
- .figcenter img { max-width: 100%; height: auto; }
- .figright img { max-width: 100%; height: auto; }
- .id001 { width:407px; }
- .id002 { width:800px; }
- .id003 { width:200px; }
- @media handheld { .id001 { margin-left:25%; width:50%; } }
- @media handheld { .id002 { margin-left:0%; width:100%; } }
- @media handheld { .id003 { width:25%; } }
- .ic001 { width:100%; }
- .ig001 { width:100%; }
- .table0 { margin: auto; }
- .nf-center { text-align: center; }
- .nf-center-c0 { text-align: left; margin: 0.5em 0; }
- p.drop-capa0_0 { text-indent: -0em; }
- p.drop-capa0_2_0 { text-indent: -0.2em; }
- p.drop-capa0_0:first-letter { float: left; margin: 0.100em 0.100em 0em 0em;
- font-size: 250%; line-height: 0em; text-indent: 0; }
- p.drop-capa0_2_0:first-letter { float: left; margin: 0.100em 0.100em 0em 0em;
- font-size: 250%; line-height: 0em; text-indent: 0; }
- @media handheld {
- p.drop-capa0_0 { text-indent: 0; }
- p.drop-capa0_2_0 { text-indent: 0; }
- p.drop-capa0_0:first-letter { float: none; margin: 0; font-size: 100%; }
- p.drop-capa0_2_0:first-letter { float: none; margin: 0; font-size: 100%; }
- }
- .c000 { text-indent: 1em; margin-top: 0.25em; margin-bottom: 0.25em; }
- .c001 { page-break-before: always; margin-top: 4em; }
- .c002 { margin-top: 1em; }
- .c003 { border: none; border-bottom: thin solid; margin-top: 1em;
- margin-bottom: 1em; margin-left: 40%; width: 20%; margin-right: 40%; }
- .c004 { page-break-before:auto; margin-top: 4em; }
- .c005 { border: none; border-bottom: thin solid; margin-top: 1em;
- margin-bottom: 1em; margin-left: 40%; width: 20%; margin-right: 40%;
- margin-top: 2em; }
- .c006 { margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 0.25em; }
- .c007 { text-align: center; }
- .c008 { vertical-align: top; text-align: left; text-indent: -1em;
- padding-left: 1em; padding-right: 1em; }
- .c009 { vertical-align: top; text-align: left; }
- .c010 { vertical-align: top; text-align: left; padding-right: 1em; }
- .c011 { vertical-align: top; text-align: right; }
- .c012 { margin-top: 4em; }
- .c013 { margin-top: 2em; }
- .c014 { text-indent: 0; margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 0.25em; }
- .c015 { text-decoration: none; }
- .c016 { margin-left: 2.78%; text-indent: -2.78%; margin-top: 2em;
- margin-bottom: 0.25em; }
- .c017 { text-align: right; }
- .c018 { vertical-align: top; text-align: right; padding-right: 1em; }
- .c019 { margin-top: 2em; text-indent: 1em; margin-bottom: 0.25em; }
- #transit {margin:auto; border-collapse:collapse; }
- td.bt { border-top: thin solid black; }
- td.bb { border-bottom: thin solid black; }
- td.br { border-right: thin solid black; }
- td.fs {font-size:0.2em; }
- .tnotes { border:thin solid black; padding:2em; margin:2em; }
- .covercaption { display: none; }
- @media handheld { .covercaption {display: block;} }
- </style>
- </head>
- <body>
-
-
-<pre>
-
-The Project Gutenberg EBook of The Three Voyages of Captain Cook Round the
-World. Vol. I. Being the First of the First, by James Cook and Joseph Banks and Dr. Hawkesworth
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
-other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms of
-the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
-www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you'll have
-to check the laws of the country where you are located before using this ebook.
-
-Title: The Three Voyages of Captain Cook Round the World. Vol. I. Being the First of the First Voyage.
-
-Author: James Cook
- Joseph Banks
- Dr. Hawkesworth
-
-Release Date: December 17, 2017 [EBook #56196]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THREE VOYAGES OF CAPTAIN COOK, VOL 1 ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by Sonya Schermann and the Online Distributed
-Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was
-produced from images generously made available by The
-Internet Archive)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
-
-<div><span class='pageno' id='Page_ii'>ii</span></div>
-<div class='covercaption'>
-
-<p class='c000'>The cover image was created by the transcriber and is placed in the public domain.</p>
-
-</div>
-<div id='frontis' class='figcenter id001'>
-<img src='images/frontis.jpg' alt='' class='ig001' />
-<div class='ic001'>
-<p><i>Captain Cook.</i><br /><br /><i>Drawn &amp; Engraved by W. Bond, from the large Picture by George Dance R.A.</i><br /><br /><i>Published by Longman &amp; C<sup>o</sup>. London Sept<sup>r</sup>. 6<sup>th</sup>. 1821.</i></p>
-</div>
-</div>
-
-<div>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_iii'>iii</span>
- <h1 class='c001'>THE<br /> <br /><span class='large'>THREE</span><br /> <br /><span class='xlarge'>VOYAGES</span><br /> <br />OF<br /> <br /><span class='xlarge'>CAPTAIN JAMES COOK</span><br /> <br /><span class='large'>ROUND THE WORLD.</span></h1>
-</div>
-
-<div class='nf-center-c0'>
-<div class='nf-center c002'>
- <div>COMPLETE</div>
- <div class='c002'><span class='large'>In Seven Volumes.</span></div>
- </div>
-</div>
-
-<hr class='c003' />
-
-<div class='nf-center-c0'>
- <div class='nf-center'>
- <div><i>WITH MAP AND OTHER PLATES.</i></div>
- </div>
-</div>
-
-<hr class='c003' />
-
-<div class='nf-center-c0'>
- <div class='nf-center'>
- <div>VOL. I.</div>
- <div class='c002'>BEING THE FIRST OF THE FIRST VOYAGE.</div>
- </div>
-</div>
-
-<hr class='c003' />
-
-<div class='nf-center-c0'>
- <div class='nf-center'>
- <div><span class='large'>LONDON:</span></div>
- <div class='c002'>PRINTED FOR</div>
- <div>LONGMAN, HURST, REES, ORME, AND BROWN,</div>
- <div>PATERNOSTER-ROW.</div>
- <div class='c002'>1821.</div>
- </div>
-</div>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_iv'>iv</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>LIFE<br /> <br />OF<br /> <br />CAPTAIN JAMES COOK.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<hr class='c005' />
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c006'><span class='sc'>This</span> celebrated navigator was the son of a day-labourer,
-and born at Marton, a village in Yorkshire,
-Nov. 3. 1728. At the age of thirteen he was put to
-a school, where he learnt writing and arithmetic;
-after which he was bound apprentice to a shopkeeper
-at Snaith, but on discovering an inclination
-for the sea, his master gave up his indentures, and
-he articled himself for three years to a ship-owner at
-Whitby. After serving out his time diligently, he
-entered in 1755 on board the Eagle sixty gun ship;
-and in 1759 he obtained a warrant as master of the
-Mercury, in which ship he was present at the taking
-of Quebec, where he made a complete draught
-of the channel and river of St. Laurence, which
-chart was published. Mr. Cook was next appointed
-to the Northumberland, then employed in the recapture
-of Newfoundland; and there also he made a
-survey of the harbour and coasts. At the latter end
-of 1762 he returned to England, and married a young
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_vi'>vi</span>woman of Barking; but early in the next year he
-went again to Newfoundland, as surveyor, with Captain
-Graves, and he afterwards acted in the same
-capacity under Sir Hugh Palliser. While thus employed,
-he made an observation of an eclipse of the
-sun, which he communicated to the Royal Society.
-It being determined to send out astronomers to observe
-the transit of Venus in some part of the South
-Sea, Mr. Cook was selected to command the Endeavour,
-a ship taken up for that service; and accordingly
-he was promoted to the rank of lieutenant,
-May 25. 1768. Our limits will not allow of giving
-the details of this interesting voyage; and therefore
-we shall content ourselves with stating, that the
-transit was observed to great advantage at Otaheite;
-after which lieutenant Cook explored the neighbouring
-islands, and then shaped his course for New Zealand,
-which he circumnavigated, and thus ascertained
-that it was not a continent. From thence he sailed
-to New Holland, or, as it is now called, New South
-Wales, where he anchored in Botany Bay, April 28.
-1770, an epoch of great importance in the history of
-that part of the world. From hence he sailed to New
-Guinea, and next to Batavia, where the ship being
-refitted, he returned to Europe, and arrived in the
-Downs, June 12. 1771. For his services on this occasion,
-Mr. Cook was promoted to the rank of commander,
-and an account of his voyage was soon after
-published by Dr. Hawkesworth. The interest excited
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_vii'>vii</span>hereby induced government to send Captain
-Cook on another voyage of discovery to the southern
-hemisphere, and he accordingly sailed with two ships,
-the Resolution, commanded by himself, and the Adventure,
-by Captain Furneaux, April 9. 1772. After
-proceeding as far as 71° 10ʹ of south latitude, amidst
-mountains of ice, and discovering some new islands,
-our voyagers returned to England, July 30. 1775.
-The Resolution in this enterprize lost only one man
-out of her whole complement, for which Captain
-Cook was elected a member of the Royal Society,
-and afterwards the gold medal was voted to him by
-the same learned body. He was also appointed a
-post-captain, and promoted to a valuable situation in
-Greenwich hospital. As the narrative of the former
-voyage had not given satisfaction, the history of the
-second was drawn almost wholly from the captain’s
-journals, and digested by Dr. Douglas, late bishop of
-Salisbury. But the labours of Cook were not to
-end here. In July 1776 he sailed again, to decide
-the long agitated question of a northern passage to
-the Pacific Ocean. In this voyage he had two ships,
-the Resolution and the Discovery; but after sailing
-as high as 74° 44ʹ N. the object was considered impracticable;
-and on Nov. 26. 1778, the ships arrived
-at the Sandwich islands. Here at first they were
-well received, but at length the people of Owhyhee
-stole one of the boats, to recover which Captain
-Cook went on shore, with the intention of getting
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_viii'>viii</span>into his possession the person of the king; but in
-doing this a crowd assembled, and the brave commander
-fell by a club, after which he was dispatched
-by a dagger; and his body was carried off in triumph
-and devoured. This melancholy event occurred
-in the morning of the 14th February, 1779.
-Captain Cook left a widow and family; on the
-former a pension of 200<i>l.</i> a year was settled by the
-king, and 25<i>l.</i> a-year on each of the children.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_ix'>ix</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CONTENTS<br /> <br />OF<br /> <br /><i>THE FIRST VOLUME.</i></h2>
-</div>
-
-<hr class='c005' />
-<table class='table0' summary=''>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>FIRST VOYAGE.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <th class='c008'></th>
- <th class='c009'>Page</th>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'><span class='sc'>Introduction</span> to the first Voyage</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_3'>3</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>BOOK I.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. I.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>The Passage from Plymouth to Madeira, with some Account of that Island</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_7'>7</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. II.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>The Passage from Madeira to Rio de Janeiro, with some Account of the Country, and the Incidents that happened there</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_18'>18</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. III.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>The Passage from Rio de Janeiro to the Entrance of the Strait of Le Maire, with a Description of some of the Inhabitants of Terra del Fuego</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_44'>44</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. IV.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>An Account of what happened in ascending a Mountain to search for Plants</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_51'>51</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. V.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>The Passage through the Strait of Le Maire, and a further Description of the Inhabitants of Terra del Fuego, and its Productions</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_59'>59</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. VI.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>A general Description of the south-east Part of Terra del Fuego, and the Strait of Le Maire; with some Remarks on Lord Anson’s Account of them, and Directions for the Passage westward, round this Part of America, into the South Seas</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_67'>67</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'><span class='pageno' id='Page_x'>x</span>CHAP. VII.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>The Sequel of the Passage from Cape Horn to the newly discovered Islands in the South Seas, with a Description of their Figure and Appearance.—Some Account of the Inhabitants, and several Incidents that happened during the Course, and at the Ship’s arrival among them</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_74'>74</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. VIII.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>The Arrival of the Endeavour at Otaheite, called by Captain Wallis, King George the III.’s Island.—Rules established for Traffic with the Natives, and an Account of several Incidents which happened in a Visit to Tootahah and Toubourai Tamaide, two Chiefs</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_84'>84</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. IX.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>A Place fixed upon for an Observatory and Fort.—An Excursion into the Woods, and its Consequences.—The Fort erected.—A Visit from several Chiefs on Board and at the Fort, with some Account of the Music of the Natives, and the Manner in which they dispose of their Dead</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_93'>93</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. X.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>An Excursion to the eastward, an Account of several Incidents that happened both on Board and on Shore, and of the first Interview with Oberea, the Person who, when the Dolphin was here, was supposed to be Queen of the Island, with a Description of the Fort</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_102'>102</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. XI.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>The Observatory set up.—The Quadrant stolen, and Consequences of the Theft.—A Visit to Tootahah.—Description of a wrestling Match.—European seeds sown.—Names given to our People by the Indians</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_113'>113</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. XII.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Some Ladies visit the Fort with very uncommon Ceremonies.—The Indians attend Divine Service, and in the Evening exhibit a most extraordinary spectacle.—Toubourai Tamaide falls into Temptation</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_126'>126</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. XIII.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'><span class='pageno' id='Page_xi'>xi</span>Another Visit to Tootahah, with various Adventures.—Extraordinary Amusement of the Indians, with Remarks upon it.—Preparations to observe the Transit of Venus, and what happened in the mean time at the Fort</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_134'>134</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. XIV.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>The Ceremonies of an Indian Funeral particularly described.—General Observations on the Subject.—A Character found among the Indians to which the Ancients paid great Veneration.—A Robbery at the Fort, and its Consequences; with a Specimen of Indian Cookery, and various Incidents</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_144'>144</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. XV.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>An Account of the Circumnavigation of the Island, and various Incidents that happened during the Expedition; with a Description of a Burying-place and Place of Worship, called a Morai</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_157'>157</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. XVI.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>An Expedition of Mr. Banks to trace the River.—Marks of subterraneous Fire.—Preparations for leaving the Island.—An Account of Tupia</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_173'>173</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. XVII.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>A particular Description of the Island; its Produce and Inhabitants; their Dress, Habitations, Food, Domestic Life and Amusements</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_184'>184</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. XVIII.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Of the Manufactures, Boats, and Navigation of Otaheite</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_209'>209</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. XIX.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Of the Division of Time in Otaheite; Numeration, Computation of Distance, Language, Diseases, Disposal of the Dead, Religion, War, Weapons, and Government; with some general Observations for the Use of future Navigators</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_225'>225</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. XX.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>A Description of several other Islands in the Neighbourhood of Otaheite, with various Incidents; a Dramatic Entertainment; and many Particulars relative to the Customs and Manners of the Inhabitants</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_245'>245</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'><span class='pageno' id='Page_xii'>xii</span>BOOK II.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. I.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>The Passage from Oteroah to New Zealand; Incidents which happened on going ashore there, and while the Ship lay in Poverty Bay</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_274'>274</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. II.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>A Description of Poverty Bay, and the Face of the adjacent Country.—The Range from thence to Cape Turnagain, and back to Tolaga; with some Account of the People and the Country, and several Incidents that happened on that Part of the Coast</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_289'>289</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. III.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>The Range from Tolaga to Mercury Bay, with an Account of many Incidents that happened both on board and ashore.—A Description of several Views exhibited by the Country, and of the Heppahs, or fortified Villages of the Inhabitants</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_314'>314</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. IV.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>The Range from Mercury Bay to the Bay of Islands.—An Expedition up the River Thames.—Some Account of the Indians who inhabit its Banks, and the fine Timber that grows there.—Several Interviews with the Natives on different Parts of the Coast, and a Skirmish with them upon an Island</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_339'>339</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. V.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Range from the Bay of Islands round North Cape to Queen Charlotte’s Sound; and a Description of that part of the Coast</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_360'>360</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>CHAP. VI.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Transactions in Queen Charlotte’s Sound.—Passage through the Strait which divides the two Islands, and back to Cape Turnagain.—Horrid Custom of the Inhabitants.—Remarkable Melody of Birds.—A Visit to a Heppah, and many other Particulars</td>
- <td class='c009'><a href='#Page_374'>374</a></td>
- </tr>
-</table>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_xiii'>xiii</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>DIRECTIONS FOR PLACING<br />THE PLATES.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<hr class='c005' />
-
-<table class='table0' summary=''>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>VOL. I.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Portrait</td>
- <td class='c011'><a href='#frontis'><i>to face the Title</i>.</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Map of the World</td>
- <td class='c011'><a href='#il1_01'><i>Page</i> 1</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Island of Otaheite</td>
- <td class='c011'><a href='#il1_02'>84</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Harbour of Oopoa</td>
- <td class='c011'><a href='#il1_03'>254</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>A fortified Town at Tolaga</td>
- <td class='c011'><a href='#il1_04'>331</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>A natural Arch, or perforated Rock</td>
- <td class='c011'><a href='#il1_05'>331</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Inside of a Hippah in New Zealand</td>
- <td class='c011'><a href='#il1_06'>332</a></td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>VOL. II.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Canoe of New Zealand</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to face the Title</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>VOL. III.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Landing at Middleburgh, Friendly Isles</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to face the Title</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Boats of the Friendly Isles</td>
- <td class='c011'>222</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Resolution Bay, in the Marquesas</td>
- <td class='c011'>299</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>The Fleet of Otaheite at Opárre</td>
- <td class='c011'>318</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>VOL. IV.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>A View in the Island of Rotterdam</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to face the Title</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>View in the Island of New Caledonia</td>
- <td class='c011'>98</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Christmas Sound Terra del Fuego</td>
- <td class='c011'>178</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>VOL. V.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Christmas Harbour in Kerguelen’s Land</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to face the Title</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>View at Anamooka</td>
- <td class='c011'>301</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>VOL. VI.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Canoe of the Sandwich Islands</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to face the Title</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>A Morai, at Otaheite</td>
- <td class='c011'>31</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>View at Huaheine</td>
- <td class='c011'>85</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>A Morai in Atooi</td>
- <td class='c011'>185</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Inland View in Atooi</td>
- <td class='c011'>206</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Natives of Oonolashka</td>
- <td class='c011'>466</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr><td class='c007' colspan='2'>VOL. VII.</td></tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Summer and Winter Habitations at Kamtschatka</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to face the Title</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Karakakooa, Owyhee</td>
- <td class='c011'>3</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Town and Harbour of St. Peter, Kamtschatka</td>
- <td class='c011'>168</td>
- </tr>
-</table>
-
-<div id='il1_01' class='figcenter id002'>
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_xvi'>xvi</span>
-<a href='images/il1_01l.jpg'><img src='images/il1_01.jpg' alt='' class='ig001' /></a>
-<div class='ic001'>
-<p>THE WORLD,<br />on<br /><i><span class='sc'>Mercator’s Projection</span></i>,<br /><i>Shewing</i> the Courses <i>of</i><br /><span class='sc'>Captain Cook’s three Voyages</span>.</p>
-</div>
-</div>
-
-<div class='nf-center-c0'>
-<div class='nf-center c012'>
- <div><span class='pageno' id='Page_1'>1</span>AN</div>
- <div class='c002'>ACCOUNT</div>
- <div class='c002'>OF A</div>
- <div class='c002'><span class='xlarge'>VOYAGE ROUND THE WORLD,</span></div>
- <div class='c002'>IN THE YEARS 1768, 1769, 1770, and 1771.</div>
- <div class='c002'>BY</div>
- <div class='c002'>LIEUTENANT JAMES COOK,</div>
- <div class='c002'>COMMANDER OF HIS MAJESTY’S BARK THE ENDEAVOUR.</div>
- <div class='c013'>Drawn up from his Journal,</div>
- <div>And from the Papers of Sir <span class='sc'>Joseph Banks</span>, Bart</div>
- <div class='c002'>BY</div>
- <div class='c002'><span class='sc'>Dr.</span> HAWKESWORTH.</div>
- </div>
-</div>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_3'>3</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>INTRODUCTION<br /> <br />TO<br /> <br />THE FIRST VOYAGE.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>With</span> Lieutenant Cook, in this voyage, embarked
-Joseph Banks, Esquire, a gentleman possessed of considerable
-landed property in Lincolnshire. He received
-the education of a scholar rather to qualify
-him for the enjoyments than the labours of life; yet
-an ardent desire to know more of Nature than could
-be learnt from books determined him, at a very early
-age, to forego what are generally thought to be the
-principal advantages of a liberal fortune, and to apply
-his revenue not in procuring the pleasures of leisure and
-ease, but in the pursuit of his favourite study, through
-a series of fatigue and danger, which, in such circumstances,
-have very seldom been voluntarily incurred,
-except to gratify the restless and insatiable desires
-of avarice or ambition.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Upon his leaving the university of Oxford, in the
-year 1763, he crossed the Atlantic, and visited the
-coasts of Newfoundland and Labradore. The danger,
-difficulty, and inconvenience that attend long
-voyages are very different in idea and experience;
-Mr. Banks, however, returned, undiscouraged, from
-his first expedition; and when he found that the
-Endeavour was equipping for a voyage to the South
-Seas, in order to observe the Transit of Venus, and
-afterwards attempt farther discoveries, he determined
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_4'>4</span>to embark in the expedition, that he might
-enrich his native country with a tribute of knowledge
-from those which have been hitherto unknown,
-and not without hope of leaving among the rude
-and uncultivated nations that he might discover,
-something that would render life of more value, and
-enrich them, perhaps, in a certain degree, with the
-knowledge, or at least with the productions, of
-Europe.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As he was determined to spare no expense in the
-execution of his plan, he engaged Dr. Solander to
-accompany him in the voyage. This Gentleman,
-by birth a Swede, was educated under the celebrated
-Linnæus, from whom he brought letters of recommendation
-into England, and his merit being soon
-known, he obtained an appointment in the British
-Museum, a public institution, which was then just
-established; such a companion Mr. Banks considered
-as an acquisition of no small importance,
-and, to his great satisfaction, the event abundantly
-proved that he was not mistaken. He also took
-with him two draftsmen, one to delineate views and
-figures, the other to paint such subjects of natural
-history as might offer; together with a secretary
-and four servants, two of whom were negroes.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Mr. Banks kept an accurate and circumstantial
-journal of the voyage, and, soon after I had received
-that of Captain Cook from the Admiralty, was so
-obliging as to put it into my hands, with permission
-to take out of it whatever I thought would improve
-or embellish the narrative. This was an offer of
-which I gladly and thankfully accepted: I knew
-the advantage would be great, for few philosophers
-have furnished materials for accounts of voyages
-undertaken to discover new countries. The adventurers
-in such expeditions have generally looked
-only upon the great outline of Nature, without
-attending to the variety of shades within, which
-give life and beauty to the piece.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_5'>5</span>The papers of Captain Cook contained a very
-particular account of all the nautical incidents of
-the voyage, and a very minute description of the
-figure and extent of the countries he had visited,
-with the bearings of the headlands and bays that
-diversify the coasts, the situation of the harbours in
-which shipping may obtain refreshments, with the
-depth of water wherever there were soundings; the
-latitudes, longitudes, variation of the needle, and
-such other particulars as lay in his department; and
-abundantly showed him to be an excellent officer,
-and skilful navigator. But in the papers which
-were communicated to me by Mr. Banks, I found a
-great variety of incidents which had not come under
-the notice of Captain Cook, with descriptions of
-countries and people, their productions, manners,
-customs, religion, policy, and language, much more
-full and particular than were expected from a Gentleman
-whose station and office naturally turned his
-principal attention to other objects; for these particulars,
-therefore, besides many practical observations,
-the Public is indebted to Mr. Banks. To Mr. Banks
-also the Public is indebted for the designs of the
-engravings which illustrate and adorn the account
-of this voyage, all of them, except the maps, charts,
-and views of the coasts as they appear at sea, being
-copied from his valuable drawings, and some of
-them from such as were made for the use of the
-artists at his expense.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As the materials furnished by Mr. Banks were so
-interesting and copious, there arose an objection
-against writing an account of this voyage in the
-person of the Commander, which could have no
-place with respect to the others; the descriptions
-and observations of Mr. Banks would be absorbed
-without any distinction, in a general narrative given
-under another name: but this objection he generously
-over-ruled, and it, therefore, became necessary
-to give some account of the obligations which he
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_6'>6</span>has laid upon the Public and myself in this place.
-It is, indeed, fortunate for mankind, when wealth and
-science, and a strong inclination to exert the powers
-of both for purposes of public benefit, unite in the
-same person; and I cannot but congratulate my
-country upon the prospect of further pleasure and
-advantage from the same Gentleman, to whom we
-are indebted for so considerable a part of this
-narrative.</p>
-
-<div class='nf-center-c0'>
-<div class='nf-center c012'>
- <div><span class='pageno' id='Page_7'>7</span>AN</div>
- <div class='c002'>ACCOUNT</div>
- <div class='c002'>OF A</div>
- <div class='c002'><span class='xlarge'>VOYAGE ROUND THE WORLD,</span></div>
- <div class='c002'>IN 1768, 1769, 1770, AND 1771.</div>
- </div>
-</div>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <h2 class='c004'>BOOK I.<br /> <br />CHAP. I.<br /> <br />THE PASSAGE FROM PLYMOUTH TO MADEIRA, WITH SOME ACCOUNT OF THAT ISLAND.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>Having</span> received my commission, which was dated
-the 25th of May, 1768, I went on board on the 27th,
-hoisted the pennant, and took charge of the ship,
-which then lay in the basin in Deptford Yard. She
-was fitted for sea with all expedition; and stores
-and provisions being taken on board, sailed down the
-river on the 30th of July, and on the 13th of August
-anchored in Plymouth Sound.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>While we lay here waiting for a wind, the articles
-of war and the act of parliament were read to the
-ship’s company, who were paid two months’ wages
-in advance, and told that they were to expect no
-additional pay for the performance of the voyage.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On Friday, the 26th of August, the wind becoming
-fair, we got under sail, and put to sea. On the 31st,
-we saw several of the birds which the sailors call
-Mother Carey’s Chickens, and which they suppose
-to be the forerunners of a storm; and on the next
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_8'>8</span>day we had a very hard gale, which brought us
-under our courses, washed over-board a small boat
-belonging to the boatswain, and drowned three or
-four dozen of our poultry, which we regretted still
-more.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On Friday, the 2d of September, we saw land
-between Cape Finister and Cape Ortegal, on the coast
-of Gallicia, in Spain; and on the 5th, by an observation
-of the sun and moon, we found the latitude of
-Cape Finister to be 42° 53ʹ North, and its longitude
-8° 46ʹ West, our first meridian being always supposed
-to pass through Greenwich; variation of the needle
-21° 4ʹ W.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>During this course, Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander
-had an opportunity of observing many marine animals,
-of which no naturalist has hitherto taken notice;
-particularly a new species of the <i>Oniscus</i>, which was
-found adhering to the <i>Medusa Pelagica</i>; and an
-animal of an angular figure, about three inches long,
-and one thick, with a hollow passing quite through
-it, and a brown spot on one end, which they conjectured
-might be its stomach; four of these adhered
-together by their sides when they were taken, so that
-at first they were thought to be one animal, but upon
-being put into a glass of water they soon separated,
-and swam about very briskly. These animals are of
-a new genus, to which Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander
-gave the name of <i>Dagysa</i>, from the likeness of one
-species of them to a gem: several specimens of them
-were taken, adhering together sometimes to the length
-of a yard or more, and shining in the water with
-very beautiful colours. Another animal, of a new
-genus, they also discovered, which shone in the
-water with colours still more beautiful and vivid, and
-which indeed exceeded in variety and brightness any
-thing that we had ever seen: the colouring and
-splendour of these animals were equal to those of an
-Opal, and from their resemblance to that gem, the
-genus was called <i>Carcinium Opalinum</i>. One of them
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_9'>9</span>lived several hours in a glass of salt water, swimming
-about with great agility, and at every motion displaying
-a change of colours almost infinitely various.
-We caught also among the rigging of the ship, when
-we were at the distance of about ten leagues from
-Cape Finister, several birds which have not been
-described by Linnæus; they were supposed to have
-come from Spain, and our gentlemen called the species
-<i>Motacilla velificans</i>, as they said none but sailors would
-venture themselves on board a ship that was going
-round the world: one of them was so exhausted, that
-it died in Mr. Banks’s hand, almost as soon as it was
-brought to him.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It was thought extraordinary that no naturalist
-had hitherto taken notice of the <i>Dagysa</i>, as the sea
-abounds with them not twenty leagues from the
-coast of Spain; but, unfortunately for the cause of
-science, there are but very few of those who traverse
-the sea, that are either disposed or qualified to
-remark the curiosities of which Nature has made it
-the repository.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 12th we discovered the islands of Porto
-Santo and Madeira, and on the next day anchored in
-Funchiale road, and moored with the stream-anchor:
-but, in the night, the bend of the hawser of the
-stream-anchor slipped, owing to the negligence of the
-person who had been employed to make it fast.
-In the morning the anchor was heaved up into the
-boat, and carried out to the southward; but in
-heaving it again, Mr. Weir, the master’s mate, was
-carried overboard by the buoy-rope, and went to
-the bottom with the anchor; the people in the ship
-saw the accident, and got the anchor up with all
-possible expedition; it was, however, too late; the
-body came up intangled in the buoy-rope, but it was
-dead.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When the island of Madeira is first approached
-from the sea, it has a very beautiful appearance; <a id='the'></a>the
-sides of the hills being entirely covered with vines
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_10'>10</span>almost as high as the eye can distinguish; and the
-vines are green when every kind of herbage, except
-where they shade the ground, and here and there
-by the sides of a rill, is entirely burnt up, which was
-the case at this time.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 13th, about eleven o’clock in the forenoon,
-a boat, which our sailors call the product boat, came
-on board from the officers of health, without whose
-permission no person is suffered to land from on
-board a ship. As soon as this permission was obtained,
-we went on shore at Funchiale, the capital of the
-island, and proceeded directly to the house of
-Mr. Cheap, who is the English consul there, and
-one of the most considerable merchants of the place.
-This gentleman received us with the kindness of a
-brother, and the liberality of a prince; he insisted
-upon our taking possession of his house, in which
-he furnished us with every possible accommodation
-during our stay upon the island; he procured leave
-for Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander to search the island
-for such natural curiosities as they should think worth
-their notice; employed persons to take fish and
-gather shells, which time would not have permitted
-them to collect for themselves; and he provided
-horses and guides to take them to any part of the
-country which they should choose to visit. With
-all these advantages, however, their excursions were
-seldom pushed farther than three miles from the town,
-as they were only five days on shore; one of which
-they spent at home, in receiving the honour of a
-visit from the governor. The season was the worst
-in the year for their purpose, as it was neither that
-of plants nor insects; a few of the plants, however,
-were procured in flower, by the kind attention of
-Dr. Heberden, the chief physician of the island, and
-brother to Dr. Heberden of London, who also gave
-them such specimens as he had in his possession,
-and a copy of his Botanical Observations; containing,
-among other things, a particular description of the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_11'>11</span>trees of the island. Mr. Banks inquired after the
-wood which has been imported into England for
-cabinet work, and is here called Madeira mahogany:
-he learnt that no wood was exported from the island
-under that name, but he found a tree called by the
-natives Vigniatico, the <i>Laurus indicus</i> of Linnæus,
-the wood of which cannot easily be distinguished
-from mahogany. Dr. Heberden has a book-case, in
-which the vigniatico and mahogany are mixed, and
-they are no otherwise to be known from each other
-than by the colour, which, upon a nice examination,
-appears to be somewhat less brown in the vigniatico
-than the mahogany; it is, therefore, in the highest
-degree probable, that the wood known in England
-by the name of Madeira mahogany, is the vigniatico.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>There is great reason to suppose that this whole
-island was, at some remote period, thrown up by
-the explosion of subterraneous fire, as every stone,
-whether whole or in fragments, that we saw upon it,
-appeared to have been burnt, and even the sand
-itself to be nothing more than ashes: we did not,
-indeed, see much of the country, but the people
-informed us that what we did see was a very exact
-specimen of the rest.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The only article of trade in this island is wine,
-and the manner in which it is made is so simple, that
-it might have been used by Noah, who is said to
-have planted the first vineyard after the flood: the
-grapes are put into a square wooden vessel, the
-dimensions of which are proportioned to the size of
-the vineyard to which it belongs; the servants then,
-having taken off their stockings and jackets, get
-into it, and with their feet and elbows press out as
-much of the juice as they can: the stalks are afterwards
-collected, and being tied together with a rope,
-are put under a square piece of wood, which is
-pressed down upon them by a lever with a stone tied
-to the end of it. The inhabitants have made so little
-improvement in knowledge or art, that they have
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_12'>12</span>but very lately brought all the fruit of a vineyard to
-be of one sort, by engrafting their vines: there
-seems to be in mind as there is in matter, a kind of
-<i><span lang="la" xml:lang="la">vis inertiæ</span></i>, which resists the first impulse to change.
-He who proposes to assist the artificer or the husbandman
-by a new application of the principles of
-philosophy, or the powers of mechanism, will find,
-that his having hitherto done without them will be
-a stronger motive for continuing to do without them
-still, than any advantage, however manifest and considerable,
-for adopting the improvement. Wherever
-there is ignorance there is prejudice; and the
-common people of all nations are, with respect to
-improvements, like the parish poor of England with
-respect to a maintenance, for whom the law must
-not only make a provision, but compel them to accept
-it, or else they will be still found begging in the
-streets. It was, therefore, with great difficulty that
-the people of Madeira were persuaded to engraft
-their vines, and some of them still obstinately refuse
-to adopt the practice, though a whole vintage is very
-often spoiled by the number of bad grapes which are
-mixed in the vat, and which they will not throw out,
-because they increase the quantity of the wine: an
-instance of the force of habit, which is the more
-extraordinary, as they have adopted the practice of
-engrafting with respect to their chesnut-trees, an
-object of much less importance, which, however, are
-thus brought to bear sooner than they would otherwise
-have done.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We saw no wheel-carriages of any sort in the place,
-which, perhaps, is not more owing to the want of ingenuity
-to invent them than to the want of industry
-to mend the roads, which, at present, it is impossible
-that any wheel-carriage should pass: the inhabitants
-have horses and mules, indeed, excellently adapted
-to such ways; but their wine is, notwithstanding,
-brought to town from the vineyards where it is made
-in vessels of goat-skins, which are carried by men
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_13'>13</span>upon their heads. The only imitation of a carriage
-among these people is a board, made somewhat
-hollow in the middle, to one end of which a pole is
-tied, by a strap of whit-leather: this wretched sledge
-approaches about as near to an English cart as an
-Indian canoe to a ship’s long-boat; and even this
-would probably never have been thought of, if the
-English had not introduced wine-vessels, which are
-too big to be carried by hand, and which, therefore,
-are dragged about the town upon these machines.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>One reason, perhaps, why art and industry have
-done so little for Madeira, is, Nature’s having done
-so much. The soil is very rich, and there is such a
-difference of climate between the plains and the
-hills, that there is scarcely a single object of luxury
-that grows either in Europe or the Indies that might
-not be produced here. When we went to visit
-Dr. Heberden, who lives upon a considerable ascent,
-about two miles from town, we left the thermometer
-at 74, and when we arrived at his house, we found
-it at 66. The hills produce, almost spontaneously,
-walnuts, chesnuts, and apples in great abundance;
-and in the town there are many plants which are the
-natives both of the East and West Indies, particularly
-the banana, the guava, the pine-apple or
-anana, and the mango, which flourish almost without
-culture. The corn of this country is of a most
-excellent quality, large grained and very fine, and
-the island would produce it in great plenty; yet
-most of what is consumed by the inhabitants is imported.
-The mutton, pork, and beef, are also very
-good; the beef, in particular, which we took on board
-here, was universally allowed to be scarcely inferior
-to our own; the lean part was very like it, both in
-colour and grain, though the beasts are much smaller,
-but the fat is as white as the fat of mutton.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The town of Funchiale derives its name from
-<i><span lang="pt" xml:lang="pt">Funcho</span></i>, the Portuguese name for fennel, which grows
-in great plenty upon the neighbouring rocks, and by
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_14'>14</span>the observation of Dr. Heberden, lies in the latitude
-of 32° 33ʹ 33ʺ N. and longitude 16° 49ʹ W. It is
-situated in the bottom of a bay, and though larger
-than the extent of the island seems to deserve, is
-very ill built; the houses of the principal inhabitants
-are large, those of the common people are small, the
-streets are narrow, and worse paved than any I ever
-saw. The churches are loaded with ornaments,
-among which are many pictures, and images of
-favourite saints; but the pictures are in general
-wretchedly painted, and the saints are dressed in
-laced clothes. Some of the convents are in a better
-taste, especially that of the Franciscans, which is
-plain, simple, and neat in the highest degree. The
-infirmary in particular drew our attention as a model
-which might be adopted in other countries with great
-advantage. It consists of a long room, on one side
-of which are the windows, and an altar for the convenience
-of administering the sacrament to the sick:
-the other side is divided into wards, each of which is
-just big enough to contain a bed, and neatly lined
-with gally-tiles; behind these wards, and parallel to
-the room in which they stand, there runs a long gallery,
-with which each ward communicates by a door,
-so that the sick may be separately supplied with
-whatever they want without disturbing their neighbours.
-In this convent there is also a singular curiosity
-of another kind; a small chapel, the whole
-lining of which, both sides and ceiling, is composed
-of human sculls and thigh-bones; the thigh-bones
-are laid across each other, and a scull is placed in
-each of the four angles. Among the sculls one is
-very remarkable; the upper and the lower jaw, on
-one side, perfectly and firmly cohere; how the ossification
-which unites them was formed, it is not, perhaps,
-very easy to conceive, but it is certain that the
-patient must have lived some time without opening
-his mouth: what nourishment he received was conveyed
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_15'>15</span>through a hole, which we discovered to have
-been made on the other side, by forcing out some of
-the teeth, in doing which the jaw also seems to have
-been injured.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We visited the good Fathers of this convent on a
-Thursday evening, just before supper-time, and they
-received us with great politeness: “We will not ask
-you,” said they, “to sup with us, because we are
-not prepared; but if you will come to-morrow,
-though it is a fast with us, we will have a turkey
-roasted for you.” This invitation, which showed
-a liberality of sentiment not to have been expected
-in a convent of Portuguese friars at this place, gratified
-us much, though it was not in our power to
-accept it.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We visited also a convent of nuns, dedicated to
-<i>Santa Clara</i>, and the ladies did us the honour to express
-a particular pleasure in seeing us there: they
-had heard that there were great philosophers among
-us, and not at all knowing what were the objects of
-philosophical knowledge, they asked us several questions
-that were absurd and extravagant in the highest
-degree; one was, when it would thunder; and another,
-whether a spring of fresh water was to be
-found any where within the walls of their convent,
-of which it seems they were in great want. It will
-naturally be supposed that our answers to such questions
-were neither satisfactory to the ladies, nor, in
-their estimation, honourable to us; yet their disappointment
-did not in the least lessen their civility,
-and they talked, without ceasing, during the whole
-of our visit, which lasted about half an hour.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The hills of this country are very high; the highest,
-Pico Ruivo, rises 5068 feet, near an English mile,
-perpendicularly from its base, which is much higher
-than any land that has been measured in Great
-Britain. The sides of these hills are covered with
-vines to a certain height, above which there are
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_16'>16</span>woods of chesnut and pine of immense extent, and
-above them forests of wild timber of various kinds
-not known in Europe; particularly two, called by
-the Portuguese <i><span lang="pt" xml:lang="pt">Mirmulano</span></i> and <i><span lang="pt" xml:lang="pt">Paobranco</span></i>, the leaves
-of both which, particularly the <i><span lang="pt" xml:lang="pt">Paobranco</span></i>, are so
-beautiful, that these trees would be a great ornament
-to the gardens of Europe.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The number of inhabitants in this island is supposed
-to be about 80,000, and the custom-house
-duties produce a revenue to the King of Portugal of
-20,000 pounds a-year, clear of all expenses, which
-might easily be doubled by the product of the island,
-exclusive of the vines, if advantage was taken of
-the excellence of the climate, and the amazing fertility
-of the soil; but this object is utterly neglected
-by the Portuguese. In the trade of the inhabitants
-of Madeira with Lisbon the balance is against them,
-so that all the Portuguese money naturally going
-thither, the currency of the island is Spanish; there
-are, indeed, a few Portuguese pieces of copper, but
-they are so scarce that we did not see one of them: the
-Spanish coin is of three denominations; Pistereens,
-worth about a shilling; Bitts, worth about sixpence;
-and Half-bitts, three-pence.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The tides at this place flow at the full and change
-of the moon, north and south; the spring tides rise
-seven feet perpendicular, and the neap tides four.
-By Dr. Heberden’s observation, the variation of the
-compass here is now 15° 30ʹ West, and decreasing;
-but I have some doubt whether he is not mistaken
-with respect to its decrease: we found that the North
-point of the dipping needle belonging to the Royal
-Society dipped 77° 18ʺ.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The refreshments to be had here are water, wine,
-fruit of several sorts, onions in plenty, and some
-sweetmeats; fresh meat and poultry are not to be had
-without leave from the governor, and the payment
-of a very high price.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_17'>17</span>We took in 270 lb. of fresh beef, and a live bullock,
-charged at 613 lb. 3032 gallons of water, and
-ten tons of wine; and in the night, between Sunday
-the 18th and Monday the 19th of September, we set
-sail in prosecution of our voyage.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When Funchiale bore North, 13 East, at the distance
-of 76 miles, the variation appeared by several
-azimuths to be 16° 30ʹ West.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_18'>18</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. II.<br /> <br />THE PASSAGE FROM MADEIRA TO RIO DE JANEIRO, WITH SOME ACCOUNT OF THE COUNTRY, AND THE INCIDENTS THAT HAPPENED THERE.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>On</span> the 21st of September we saw the islands called
-the Salvages, to the north of the Canaries; when
-the principal of these bore S. ½ W. at the distance
-of about five leagues, we found the variation of the
-compass by an azimuth to be 17° 50ʹ. I make these
-islands to lie in latitude 30° 11ʹ North, and distant
-58 leagues from Funchiale in Madeira, in the direction
-of S. 16 E.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On Friday the 23d we saw the Peak of Teneriffe
-bearing W. by S. ½ S. and found the variation of the
-compass to be from 17° 22ʹ to 16° 30ʹ. The height
-of this mountain, from which I took a new departure,
-has been determined by Dr. Heberden, who
-has been upon it, to be 15,396 feet, which is but 148
-yards less than three miles, reckoning the mile at
-1760 yards. Its appearance at sunset was very striking;
-when the sun was below the horizon, and the
-rest of the island appeared of a deep black, the
-mountain still reflected his rays, and glowed with a
-warmth of colour which no painting can express.
-There is no eruption of visible fire from it, but a
-heat issues from the chinks near the top, too strong
-to be borne by the hand when it is held near them.
-We had received from Dr. Heberden, among other
-favours, some salt which he collected on the top of
-the mountain, where it is found in large quantities,
-and which he supposes to be the true <i><span lang="la" xml:lang="la">natrum</span></i>, or
-<i><span lang="la" xml:lang="la">nitrum</span></i> of the ancients: he gave us also some native
-sulphur exceedingly pure, which he had likewise
-found upon the surface in great plenty.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_19'>19</span>On the next day, Saturday the 24th, we came into
-the north-east trade wind, and on Friday the 30th saw
-Bona Vista, one of the Cape de Verd islands; we
-ranged the east side of it, at the distance of three
-or four miles from the shore, till we were obliged to
-haul off to avoid a ledge of rocks which stretch out
-S. W. by W. from the body, or S. E. point of the
-island, to the extent of a league and a half. Bona
-Vista, by our observation, lies in latitude 16 N. and
-longitude 21° 5ʹ West.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 1st of October, in latitude 14° 6ʹ N. and
-longitude 22° 10ʹ W. we found the variation by a
-very good azimuth to be 10° 37ʹ W. and the next
-morning it appeared to be 10°. This day we found
-the ship five miles a head of the log, and the next
-day seven. On the third, hoisted out the boat to
-discover whether there was a current, and found one
-to the eastward, at the rate of three quarters of a
-mile an hour.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>During our course from Teneriffe to Bona Vista
-we saw great numbers of flying fish, which from the
-cabin windows appear beautiful beyond imagination,
-their sides having the colour and brightness of burnished
-silver; when they are seen from the deck they
-do not appear to so much advantage, because their
-backs are of a dark colour. We also took a shark,
-which proved to be the <i>Squalus Carcharias</i> of
-Linnæus.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Having lost the trade wind on the 3d, in latitude
-12° 14ʹ, and longitude 22° 10ʹ, the wind became
-somewhat variable, and we had light airs and calms
-by turns.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 7th, Mr. Banks went out in the boat and
-took what the seamen call a Portuguese man of war;
-it is the <i>Holuthuria Physalis</i> of Linnæus, and a species
-of the <i>Mollusca</i>. It consisted of a small bladder
-about seven inches long, very much resembling the
-air-bladder of fishes, from the bottom of which descended
-a number of strings, of a bright blue and
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_20'>20</span>red, some of them three or four feet in length, which,
-upon being touched, sting like a nettle, but with much
-more force. On the top of the bladder is a membrane
-which is used as a sail, and turned so as to
-receive the wind which way soever it blows: this
-membrane is marked in fine pink-coloured veins, and
-the animal is in every respect an object exquisitely
-curious and beautiful.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We also took several of the shell-fishes, or testaceous
-animals, which are always found floating upon
-the water, particularly the <i>Helix Janthina</i> and <i>Violacea</i>;
-they are about the size of a snail, and are
-supported upon the surface of the water by a small
-cluster of bubbles, which are filled with air, and
-consist of a tenacious slimy substance that will not
-easily part with its contents; the animal is oviparous,
-and these bubbles serve also as a <i><span lang="la" xml:lang="la">nidus</span></i> for its eggs. It
-is probable that it never goes down to the bottom,
-nor willingly approaches any shore; for the shell is
-exceedingly brittle, and that of few fresh water
-snails is so thin: every shell contains about a teaspoonful
-of liquor, which it easily discharges upon
-being touched, and which is of the most beautiful
-red purple that can be conceived. It dies linen
-cloth, and it may perhaps be worth enquiry, as the
-shell is certainly found in the Mediterranean, whether
-it be not the <i>Purpura</i> of the ancients.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 8th, in latitude 8° 25ʹ North, longitude
-22° 4ʹ West, we found a current setting to the southward,
-which the next day in latitude 7° 58ʹ, longitude
-22° 13ʹ, shifted to the N. N. W. ¾ W., at the rate of
-one mile and a furlong an hour. The variation here,
-by the mean of several azimuths, appeared to be
-8° 39ʹ W.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 10th, Mr. Banks shot the black-toed gull,
-not yet described according to Linnæus’s system;
-he gave it the name of <i>Larus crepidatus</i>: it is remarkable
-that the dung of this bird is of a lively red,
-somewhat like that of the liquor procured from the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_21'>21</span>shells, only not so full; its principal food therefore
-is probably the <i>Helix</i> just mentioned. A current to
-the N. W. prevailed more or less till Monday the
-24th, when we were in latitude 1° 7ʹ N., and longitude
-28° 50ʹ.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 25th we crossed the line with the usual
-ceremonies, in longitude 29° 30ʹ, when, by the result
-of several very good azimuths, the variation was
-2° 24ʹ.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 28th, at noon, being in the latitude of
-Ferdinand <i>Noronha</i>, and, by the mean of several observations
-by Mr. Green and myself in longitude
-32° 5ʹ 16ʺ W., which is to the westward of it by some
-charts, and to the eastward by others, we expected
-to see the island, or some of the shoals that are laid
-down in the charts between it and the main, but we
-saw neither one nor the other.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the evening of the 29th, we observed that
-luminous appearance of the sea which has been so
-often mentioned by navigators, and of which such
-various causes have been assigned; some supposing
-it to be occasioned by fish, which agitated the water
-by darting at their prey, some by the putrefaction of
-fish and other marine animals, some by electricity,
-and others referring it into a great variety of different
-causes. It appeared to emit flashes of light exactly
-resembling those of lightning, only not so considerable;
-but they were so frequent, that sometimes eight
-or ten were visible almost at the same moment. We
-were of opinion that they proceeded from some luminous
-animal, and upon throwing out the casting net
-our opinion was confirmed: it brought up a species of
-the <i>Medusa</i>, which, when it came on board, had the
-appearance of metal violently heated, and emitted
-a white light: with these animals were taken some
-very small crabs, of three different species, each of
-which gave as much light as a glow-worm, though
-the creature was not so large by nine-tenths: upon
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_22'>22</span>examination of these animals Mr. Banks had the satisfaction
-to find that they were all entirely new.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On Wednesday, the 2d of November, about noon,
-being in the latitude of 10° 38ʹ S., and longitude
-32° 13ʹ 43ʺ W., we passed the line in which the needle
-at this time would have pointed due north and south,
-without any variation: for in the morning, having
-decreased gradually in its deviation for some days,
-it was no more than 18ʹ W., and in the afternoon it
-was 34ʹ East.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 6th, being in latitude 19° 3ʹ South, longitude
-35° 50ʹ West, the colour of the water was observed
-to change, upon which we sounded, and found
-ground at the depth of 32 fathoms: the lead was
-cast three times within about four hours, without a
-foot difference in the depth or quality of the bottom,
-which was coral rock, fine sand, and shells; we therefore
-supposed that we had passed over the tail of the
-great shoal which is laid down in all our charts by
-the name of <i>Abrothos</i>, on which Lord Anson struck
-soundings in his passage outwards: at four the next
-morning we had no ground with 100 fathom.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As several articles of our stock and provisions now
-began to fall short, I determined to put into Rio de
-Janeiro, rather than at any port in Brazil or Falkland’s
-Islands, knowing that it could better supply
-us with what we wanted, and making no doubt but
-that we should be well received.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 8th, at day-break, we saw the coast of
-Brazil, and about ten o’clock we brought to, and
-spoke with a fishing boat: the people on board told
-us that the land which we saw lay to the southward
-of <i>Sancto Espirito</i>, but belonging to the captainship
-of that place.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander went on board this
-vessel, in which they found eleven men, nine of whom
-were blacks: they all fished with lines; and their
-fresh cargo, the chief part of which Mr. Banks
-bought, consisted of dolphins, large pelagic scombers
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_23'>23</span>of two kinds, sea-bream, and some of the fish which,
-in the West Indies, are called Welshmen. Mr. Banks
-had taken Spanish silver with him, which he imagined
-to be the currency of the Continent, but to
-his great surprise the people asked him for English
-shillings; he gave them two, which he happened to
-have about him, and it was not without some dispute
-that they took the rest of the money in pistereens.
-Their business seemed to be to catch large fish at a
-good distance from the shore, which they salted in
-bulk, in a place made for that purpose in the middle
-of their boat: of this merchandize they had about
-two quintals on board, which they offered for about
-16 shillings, and would probably have sold for half
-the money. The fresh fish, which was bought for
-about nineteen shillings and sixpence, served the
-whole ship’s company: the salt was not wanted.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The sea-provision of these fishermen consisted of
-nothing more than a cask of water, and a bag of
-Cassada flour, which they called <i>Farinha de Pao</i>, or
-wooden flour; which, indeed, is a name which very
-well suits its taste and appearance. Their water-cask
-was large, as wide as their boat, and exactly
-fitted a place that was made for it in the ballast; it
-was impossible therefore to draw out any of its contents
-by a tap, the sides being, from the bottom to
-the top, wholly inaccessible; neither could any be
-taken out by dipping a vessel in at the head, for an
-opening sufficiently wide for that purpose would have
-endangered the loss of great part of it by the rolling
-of the vessel: their expedient to get at their water,
-so situated, was curious; when one of them wanted
-to drink, he applied to his neighbour, who accompanied
-him to the water-cask with a hollow cane
-about three feet long, which was open at both ends;
-this he thrust into the cask through a small hole in
-the top, and then, stopping the upper end with the
-palm of his hand, drew it out; the pressure of the
-air against the other end keeping in the water which
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_24'>24</span>it contained; to this end the person who wanted to
-drink applied his mouth, and the assistant then taking
-his hand from the other, and admitting the air above,
-the cane immediately parted with its contents, which
-the drinker drew off till he was satisfied.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We stood off and on along the shore till the 12th,
-and successively saw a remarkable hill near Santo
-Espirito, then Cape St. Thomas, and then an island
-just without Cape Frio, which in some maps is called
-the Island of Frio, and which being high, with a
-hollow in the middle, has the appearance of two
-islands when seen at a distance. On this day we
-stood along the shore for Rio de Janeiro, and at nine
-the next morning made sail for the harbour. I then
-sent Mr. Hicks, my first lieutenant, before us in
-the pinnace, up to the city, to acquaint the Governor,
-that we put in there to procure water and refreshments;
-and to desire the assistance of a pilot to
-bring us into proper anchoring-ground. I continued
-to stand up the river, trusting to Mr. Bellisle’s
-draught, published in the <cite>Petit Atlas Maritime</cite>,
-Vol. II. No. 54., which we found very good, till five
-o’clock in the evening, expecting the return of my
-lieutenant; and just as I was about to anchor, above
-the island of Cobras, which lies before the city, the
-pinnace came back without him, having on board a
-Portuguese officer, but no pilot. The people in the
-boat told me, that my lieutenant was detained by the
-Viceroy till I should go on shore. We came immediately
-to an anchor; and, almost at the same time,
-a ten-oared boat, full of soldiers, came up and kept
-rowing round the ship, without exchanging a word:
-in less than a quarter of an hour, another boat came
-on board with several of the Viceroy’s officers, who
-asked whence we came; what was our cargo; the
-number of men and guns on board; the object of
-our voyage, and several other questions, which we
-directly and truly answered: they then told me, as a
-kind of apology for detaining my lieutenant, and putting
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_25'>25</span>an officer on board my pinnace, that it was the
-invariable custom of the place, to detain the first
-officer who came on shore from any ship on her
-arrival, till a boat from the Viceroy had visited her,
-and to suffer no boat to go either from or to a ship,
-while she lay there, without having a soldier on
-board. They said that I might go on shore when I
-pleased; but wished that every other person might
-remain on board till the paper which they should
-draw up had been delivered to the Viceroy, promising
-that, immediately upon their return, the lieutenant
-should be sent on board.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This promise was performed; and on the next
-morning, the 14th, I went on shore, and obtained
-leave of the Viceroy to purchase provisions and refreshments
-for the ship, provided I would employ
-one of their own people as a factor, but not otherwise.
-I made some objections to this, but he insisted
-upon it as the custom of the place. I objected also
-against the putting a soldier into the boat every time
-she went between the ship and the shore; but he
-told me, that this was done by the express orders of
-his court, with which he could in no case dispense.
-I then requested, that the gentlemen whom I had
-on board might reside on shore during our stay, and
-that Mr. Banks might go up the country to gather
-plants; but this he absolutely refused. I judged
-from his extreme caution, and the severity of these
-restrictions, that he suspected we were come to
-trade; I therefore took some pains to convince him
-of the contrary. I told him, that we were bound to
-the southward, by the order of His Britannic Majesty,
-to observe a transit of the planet Venus over the
-sun, an astronomical phænomenon of great importance
-to navigation. Of the transit of Venus, however,
-he could form no other conception, than that
-it was the passing of the North star through the
-South Pole; for these are the very words of his interpreter,
-who was a Swede, and spoke English very
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_26'>26</span>well. I did not think it necessary to ask permission
-for the gentlemen to come on shore during the day,
-or that, when I was on shore myself, I might be at
-liberty, taking for granted that nothing was intended
-to the contrary; but in this I was unfortunately mistaken.
-As soon as I took leave of His Excellency, I
-found an officer who had orders to attend me <a id='where'></a>wherever
-I went: of this I desired an explanation, and
-was told that it was meant as a compliment. I
-earnestly desired to be excused from accepting such
-an honour, but the good Viceroy would by no means
-suffer it to be dispensed with.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>With this officer, therefore, I returned on board
-about twelve o’clock, where I was impatiently expected
-by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, who made
-no doubt but that a fair account of us having been
-given by the officers who had been on board the
-evening before, in their paper called a <i>Practica</i>, and
-every scruple of the Viceroy removed in my conference
-with His Excellency, they should immediately
-be at liberty to go on shore, and dispose of themselves
-as they pleased. Their disappointment at receiving
-my report may easily be conceived; and it
-was still increased by an account, that it had been
-resolved, not only to prevent their residing on shore,
-and going up the country, but even their leaving the
-ship; orders having been given that no person, except
-the captain, and such common sailors as were
-required to be upon duty, should be permitted to
-land; and that there was probably a particular view
-to the passengers in this prohibition, as they were
-reported to be gentlemen sent abroad to make observations
-and discoveries, and were uncommonly
-qualified for that purpose. In the evening, however,
-Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander dressed themselves, and
-attempted to go on shore, in order to make a visit
-to the Viceroy; but they were stopped by the
-guard-boat which had come off with our pinnace,
-and which kept hovering round the ship all the while
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_27'>27</span>she lay here, for that purpose; the officer on board
-saying, that he had particular orders, which he could
-not disobey, to suffer no passenger, nor any officer,
-except the captain, to pass the boat. After much
-expostulation to no purpose, they were obliged, with
-whatever reluctance and mortification, to return on
-board. I then went on shore myself, but found the
-Viceroy inflexible; he had one answer ready for every
-thing I could say, that the restrictions under which
-he had laid us were in obedience to the King of Portugal’s
-commands, and therefore indispensable.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In this situation I determined, rather than be made
-a prisoner in my own boat, to go on shore no more;
-for the officer who, under pretence of a compliment,
-attended me when I was ashore, insisted also upon
-going with me to and from the ship: but still
-imagining, that the scrupulous vigilance of the Viceroy
-must proceed from some mistaken notion about
-us, which might more easily be removed by writing
-than in conversation, I drew up a memorial, and
-Mr. Banks drew up another, which we sent on shore.
-These memorials were both answered, but by no
-means to our satisfaction; we therefore replied: in
-consequence of which, several other papers were interchanged
-between us and the Viceroy, but still
-without effect. However, as I thought some degree
-of force, on the part of the Viceroy, to enforce these
-restrictions, necessary to justify my acquiescence in
-them to the Admiralty, I gave orders to my lieutenant,
-Mr. Hicks, when I sent him with our last
-reply on Sunday the 20th, in the evening, not to
-suffer a guard to be put into his boat. When the
-officer on board the guard-boat found that Mr. Hicks
-was determined to obey my orders, he did not proceed
-to force, but attended him to the landing-place, and
-reported the matter to the Viceroy. Upon this His
-Excellency refused to receive the memorial, and ordered
-Mr. Hicks to return to the ship; when he came
-back to the boat, he found that a guard had been
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_28'>28</span>put on board in his absence, but he absolutely refused
-to return till the soldier was removed: the officer then
-proceeded to enforce the Viceroy’s orders; he seized
-all the boat’s crew, and sent them under an armed
-force to prison, putting Mr. Hicks, at the same time,
-into one of their own boats, and sending him under
-a guard back to the ship. As soon as he had reported
-these particulars, I wrote again to the Viceroy, demanding
-my boat and crew, and in my letter inclosed
-the memorial which he had refused to receive from
-Mr. Hicks: these papers I sent by a petty officer,
-that I might wave the dispute about a guard, against
-which I had never objected except when there was a
-commissioned officer on board the boat. The petty
-officer was permitted to go on shore with his guard,
-and, having delivered his letter, was told that an answer
-would be sent the next day.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About eight o’clock this evening it began to blow
-very hard in sudden gusts from the south, and our
-long-boat coming on board just at this time with
-four pipes of rum, the rope which was thrown to her
-from the ship, and which was taken hold of by the
-people on board, unfortunately broke, and the boat,
-which had come to the ship before the wind, went
-adrift to windward of her, with a small skiff of Mr.
-Banks’s that was fastened to her stern. This was a
-great misfortune, as the pinnace being detained on
-shore, we had no boat on board but a four-oared
-yawl: the yawl, however, was immediately manned
-and sent to her assistance; but, notwithstanding the
-utmost effort of the people in both boats, they were
-very soon out of sight: far, indeed, we could not see at
-that time in the evening, but the distance was enough
-to convince us that they were not under command,
-which gave us great uneasiness, as we knew they
-must drive directly upon a reef of rocks which ran
-out just to leeward of where we lay: after waiting
-some hours in the utmost anxiety, we gave them over
-for lost, but, about three o’clock the next morning,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_29'>29</span>had the satisfaction to see all the people come on
-board in the yawl. From them we learnt, that the
-long-boat having filled with water they had brought
-her to a grappling, and left her; and that, having
-fallen in with the reef of rocks in their return to the
-ship, they had been obliged to cut Mr. Banks’s little
-boat adrift. As the loss of our long-boat, which we
-had now too much reason to apprehend, would have
-been an unspeakable disadvantage to us, considering
-the nature of our expedition, I sent another letter to
-the Viceroy, as soon as I thought he could be seen,
-acquainting him with our misfortune, and requesting
-the assistance of a boat from the shore for the recovery
-of our own; I also renewed my demand that
-the pinnace and her crew should be no longer detained:
-after some delay, His Excellency thought fit
-to comply both with my request and demand; and
-the same day we happily recovered both the long-boat
-and skiff, with the rum, but every thing else that
-was on board was lost. On the 23d, the Viceroy, in
-his answer to my remonstrance against seizing my
-men and detaining the boat, acknowledged that I had
-been treated with some incivility, but said that the
-resistance of my officers to what he had declared to
-be the King’s orders made it absolutely necessary;
-he also expressed some <a id='doubts'></a>doubts whether the Endeavour,
-considering her structure and other circumstances,
-was in the service of His Majesty, though I had before
-showed him my commission: to this I answered in
-writing, that, to remove all scruples, I was ready to
-produce my commission again. His Excellency’s
-scruples, however, still remained, and in his reply to
-my letter he not only expressed them in still plainer
-terms, but accused my people of smuggling. This
-charge, I am confident, was without the least foundation
-in truth. Mr. Banks’s servants had indeed
-found means to go on shore on the 22d at day-break,
-and stay till it was dark in the evening, but they
-brought on board only plants and insects, having been
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_30'>30</span>sent for no other purpose. And I had the greatest
-reason to believe that not a single article was smuggled
-by any of our people who were admitted on
-shore, though many artful means were used to tempt
-them, even by the very officers that were under His
-Excellency’s roof, which made the charge still more
-injurious and provoking. I have indeed some reason
-to suspect that one poor fellow bought a single bottle
-of rum with some of the clothes upon his back; and
-in my answer I requested of His Excellency, that, if
-such an attempt at illicit trade should be repeated,
-he would without scruple order the offender to be
-taken into custody. And thus ended our altercation,
-both by conference and writing, with the Viceroy of
-Rio de Janeiro.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>A friar in the town having requested the assistance
-of our surgeon, Dr. Solander easily got admittance
-in that character on the 25th, and received many
-marks of civility from the people. On the 26th,
-before day-break, Mr. Banks also found means to
-elude the vigilance of the people in the guard-boat,
-and got on shore; he did not, however, go into the
-town, for the principal objects of his curiosity were
-to be found in the fields: to him also the people behaved
-with great civility, many of them invited him
-to their houses, and he bought a porker and some
-other things of them for the ship’s company; the
-porker, which was by no means lean, cost him eleven
-shillings, and he paid something less than two for a
-Muscovy duck.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 27th, when the boats returned from watering,
-the people told us there was a report in town,
-that search was making after some persons who had
-been on shore from the ship without the Viceroy’s
-permission: these persons we conjectured to be Dr.
-Solander and Mr. Banks, and therefore they determined
-to go on shore no more.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the first of December, having got our water
-and other necessaries on board, I sent to the Viceroy
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_31'>31</span>for a pilot to carry us to sea, who came off to us;
-but the wind preventing us from getting out, we took
-on board a plentiful supply of fresh beef, yams, and
-greens for the ship’s company. On the 2d, a Spanish
-packet arrived, with letters from Buenos Ayres for
-Spain, commanded by Don Antonio de Monte Negro y
-Velasco, who with great politeness offered to take our
-letters to Europe: I accepted the favour, and gave
-him a packet for the secretary of the Admiralty,
-containing copies of all the papers that had passed
-between me and the Viceroy; leaving also duplicates
-with the Viceroy, to be by him forwarded to Lisbon.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On Monday, the 5th, it being a dead calm, we
-weighed anchor and towed down the bay; but, to
-our great astonishment, when we got abreast of Santa
-Cruz, the principal fortification, two shot were fired
-at us. We immediately cast anchor, and sent to the
-fort to enquire the reason of what had happened;
-our people brought us word, that the commandant
-had received no order from the Viceroy to let us pass;
-and that, without such an order, no vessel was ever
-suffered to go below the fort. It was now, therefore,
-become necessary, that we should send to the Viceroy,
-to enquire why the necessary order had not
-been given, as he had notice of our departure, and
-had thought fit to write me a polite letter, wishing
-me a good voyage. Our messenger soon returned
-with an account, that the order had been written
-some days, but, by an unaccountable negligence, not
-sent.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We did not get under sail till the 7th; and, when
-we had passed the fort, the pilot desired to be discharged.
-As soon as he was dismissed, we were left
-by our guard-boat, which had hovered about us from
-the first hour of our being in this place to the last;
-and Mr. Banks, having been prevented from going
-ashore at Rio de Janeiro, availed himself of her departure
-to examine the neighbouring islands, where,
-particularly on one in the mouth of the harbour,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_32'>32</span>called Raza, he gathered many species of plants, and
-caught a variety of insects.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It is remarkable, that, during the last three or four
-days of our staying in this harbour, the air was loaded
-with butterflies: they were chiefly of one sort, but in
-such numbers that thousands were in view in every
-direction, and the greatest part of them above our
-mast-head.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We lay here from the 14th of November to the 7th
-of December, something more than three weeks,
-during which time Mr. Monkhouse, our surgeon, was
-on shore every day to buy our provisions; Dr. Solander
-was on shore once; I was several times on shore myself,
-and Mr. Banks also found means to get into the
-country, notwithstanding the watch that was set over
-us. I shall, therefore, with the intelligence obtained
-from these gentlemen, and my own observations,
-give some account of the town, and the country
-adjacent.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Rio de Janeiro, or the river of Januarius, was probably
-so called from its having been discovered on
-the feast-day of that saint; and the town, which is
-the capital of the Portuguese dominions in America,
-derives its name from the river, which, indeed, is
-rather an arm of the sea, for it did not appear to
-receive any considerable stream of fresh water: it
-stands on a plain, close to the shore, on the west side
-of the bay, at the foot of several high mountains
-which rise behind it. It is neither ill designed nor
-ill built: the houses, in general, are of stone, and
-two stories high; every house having, after the manner
-of the Portuguese, a little balcony before its windows,
-and a lattice of wood before the balcony. I computed
-its circuit to be about three miles; for it appears to
-be equal in size to the largest country towns in England,
-Bristol and Liverpool not excepted: the streets
-are straight, and of a convenient breadth, intersecting
-each other at right angles; the greater part, however,
-lie in a line with the citadel called St. Sebastian,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_33'>33</span>which stands on the top of a hill that commands the
-town.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It is supplied with water from the neighbouring
-hills, by an aqueduct, which is raised upon two stories
-of arches, and is said in some places to be at a great
-height from the ground, from which the water is
-conveyed by pipes into a fountain in the great square
-that exactly fronts the Viceroy’s palace. At this
-fountain great numbers of people are continually
-waiting for their turn to draw water; and the soldiers,
-who are posted at the governor’s door, find it very
-difficult to maintain any regularity among them. The
-water at this fountain, however, is so bad, that we, who
-had been two months at sea, confined to that in our
-casks, which was almost always foul, could not drink
-it with pleasure. Water of a better quality is laid
-into some other part of the town, but I could not
-learn by what means.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The churches are very fine, and there is more religious
-parade in this place than in any of the Popish
-countries in Europe: there is a procession of some
-parish every day, with various insignia, all splendid
-and costly in the highest degree: they beg money,
-and say prayers in great form, at the corner of every
-street.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>While we lay here, one of the churches was rebuilding;
-and to defray the expense, the parish to
-which it belonged had leave to beg in procession
-through the whole city once a week, by which very
-considerable sums were collected. At this ceremony,
-which was performed by night, all the boys of a certain
-age were obliged to assist, the sons of gentlemen
-not being excused. Each of these boys was dressed
-in a black cassock, with a short red cloak, hanging
-about as low as the waist, and carried in his hand a
-pole about six or seven feet long, at the end of which
-was tied a lantern: the number of lanterns was generally
-above two hundred, and the light they gave was
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_34'>34</span>so great, that the people who saw it from the cabin
-windows thought the town had been on fire.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The inhabitants, however, may pay their devotions
-at the shrine of any saint in the calendar, without
-waiting till there is a procession; for before almost
-every house there is a little cupboard, furnished with
-a glass window, in which one of these tutelary powers
-is waiting to be gracious; and to prevent his being
-out of mind, by being out of sight, a lamp is kept
-constantly burning before the window of his tabernacle
-in the night. The people, indeed, are by no
-means remiss in their devotions, for before these
-saints they pray and sing hymns with such vehemence,
-that in the night they were very distinctly heard on
-board the ship, though she lay at the distance of at
-least half a mile from the town.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The government here, as to its form, is mixed; it
-is notwithstanding very despotic in fact. It consists
-of the Viceroy, the governor of the town, and a
-council, the number of which I could not learn:
-without the consent of this council, in which the
-Viceroy has a casting vote, no judicial act should be
-performed; yet both the Viceroy and Governor frequently
-commit persons to prison at their own pleasure,
-and sometimes send them to Lisbon, without
-acquainting their friends or family with what is laid
-to their charge, or where they may be found.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>To restrain the people from travelling into the
-country, and getting into any district where gold or
-diamonds may be found, of both which there is much
-more than the government can otherwise secure, certain
-bounds are prescribed them, at the discretion of
-the Viceroy, sometimes at a few, and sometimes at
-many miles’ distance from the city. On the verge of
-these limits a guard constantly patroles, and whoever
-is found beyond it, is immediately seized and thrown
-into prison; and if a man is, upon any pretence,
-taken up by the guard without the limits, he will be
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_35'>35</span>sent to prison, though it should appear that he did
-not know their extent.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The inhabitants, which are very numerous, consist
-of Portuguese, negroes, and Indians, the original
-natives of the country. The township of Rio, which,
-as I was told, is but a small part of the Capitanea, or
-province, is said to contain 37,000 white persons,
-and 629,000 blacks, many of whom are free; making
-together 666,000 in the proportion of seventeen to
-one. The Indians, who are employed to do the King’s
-work in this neighbourhood, can scarcely be considered
-as inhabitants; their residence is at a distance,
-from whence they come by turns to their task, which
-they are obliged to perform for a small pay. The
-guard-boat was constantly rowed by these people,
-who are of a light copper colour, and have long
-black hair.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The military establishment here consists of twelve
-regiments of regular troops, six of which are Portuguese
-and six Creoles; and twelve other regiments
-of provincial militia. To the regulars the inhabitants
-behave with the utmost humility and submission;
-and I was told, that if any of them should neglect to
-take off his hat upon meeting an officer, he would
-immediately be knocked down. These haughty severities
-render the people extremely civil to any stranger
-who has the appearance of a gentleman. But the
-subordination of the officers themselves to the Viceroy
-is enforced with circumstances equally mortifying,
-for they are obliged to attend in his hall three times
-every day to ask his commands; the answer constantly
-is, “There is nothing new.” I have been told, that
-this servile attendance is exacted to prevent their going
-into the country; and if so, it effectually answers
-the purpose.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It is, I believe, universally allowed, that the women,
-both of the Spanish and Portuguese settlements in
-South America, make less difficulty of granting personal
-favours, than those of any other civilized
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_36'>36</span>country in the world. Of the ladies of this town
-some have formed so unfavourable an opinion as <a id='to'></a>to
-declare, that they did not believe there was a modest
-one among them. This censure is certainly too general;
-but what Dr. Solander saw of them when he
-was on shore, gave him no very exalted idea of their
-chastity: he told me, that as soon as it was dark, one
-or more of them appeared in every window, and distinguished
-those whom they liked, among the gentlemen
-that walked past them, by giving them nosegays;
-that he, and two gentlemen who were with him, received
-so many of these favours, that, at the end of
-their walk, which was not a long one, they threw whole
-hatfuls of them away. Great allowance must certainly
-be made for local customs; that which in one country
-would be an indecent familiarity, is a mere act of general
-courtesy in another; of the fact, therefore, which
-I have related, I shall say nothing, but that I am confident
-it is true.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Neither will I take upon me to affirm, that murders
-are frequently committed here; but the churches
-afford an asylum to the criminal: and as our cockswain
-was one day looking at two men, who appeared
-to be talking together in a friendly manner, one of
-them suddenly drew a knife, and stabbed the other;
-who not instantly falling, the murderer withdrew the
-weapon, and stabbed him a second time. He then
-ran away, and was pursued by some negroes who
-were also witnesses of the fact; but whether he
-escaped or was taken I never heard.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The country, at a small distance round the town,
-which is all that any of us saw, is beautiful in the
-highest degree; the wildest spots being varied with
-a greater luxuriance of flowers, both as to number
-and beauty, than the best gardens in England.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Upon the trees and bushes sat an almost endless
-variety of birds, especially small ones, many of them
-covered with the most elegant plumage; among
-which were the humming-bird. Of insects, too, there
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_37'>37</span>was a great variety, and some of them very beautiful;
-but they were much more nimble than those
-of Europe, especially the butterflies, most of which
-flew near the tops of the trees, and were, therefore,
-very difficult to be caught, except when the sea
-breeze blew fresh, which kept them nearer to the
-ground.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The banks of the sea, and of the small brooks
-which water this part of the country, are almost
-covered with the small crabs called <i>Cancer vocans</i>;
-some of these had one of the claws called by naturalists
-the hand, very large; others had them both
-remarkably small, and of equal size, a difference
-which is said to distinguish the sexes, that with the
-large claw being the male.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>There is the appearance of but little cultivation;
-the greater part of the land is wholly uncultivated,
-and very little care and labour seem to have been
-bestowed upon the rest; there are, indeed, little
-patches or gardens, in which many kinds of European
-garden stuff are produced, particularly cabbages,
-peas, beans, kidney beans, turnips, and white radishes,
-but all much inferior to our own: water-melons and
-pine-apples are also produced in these spots, and
-they are the only fruits that we saw cultivated, though
-the country produces musk, melons, oranges, limes,
-lemons, sweet lemons, citrons, plantains, bananas,
-mangos, mamane apples, acajou or cashou apples
-and nuts; jamboira of two kinds, one of which
-bears a small black fruit; cocoa-nuts, mangos, palm-nuts
-of two kinds, one long, the other round; and
-palm-berries; all which were in season while we were
-there.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Of these fruits the water-melons and oranges are
-the best in their kind; the pine-apples are much
-inferior to those that I have eaten in England; they
-are, indeed, more juicy and sweet, but have no flavour:
-I believe them to be natives of this country, though
-we heard of none that at this time grow wild; they
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_38'>38</span>have, however, very little care bestowed upon them,
-the plants being set between beds of any kind of
-garden-stuff, and suffered to take the chance of the
-season. The melons are still worse, at least those
-that we tasted, which were mealy and insipid; but
-the water-melons are excellent; they have a flavour,
-at least a degree of acidity which ours have not.
-We saw also several species of the prickle pear, and
-some European fruits, particularly the apple and
-peach, both which were very mealy and insipid. In
-these gardens also grow yams and mandihoca, which
-in the West Indies is called Cassada or Cassava, and
-to the flower of which the people here, as I have
-before observed, give the name of <i>Farinha de Pao</i>,
-which may not improperly be translated, Powder of
-Post. The soil, though it produces tobacco and
-sugar, will not produce bread-corn; so that the people
-here have no wheat-flour, but what is brought from
-Portugal, and sold at the rate of a shilling a pound,
-though it is generally spoiled by being heated in its
-passage. Mr. Banks is of opinion, that all the products
-of our West Indian islands would grow here;
-notwithstanding which, the inhabitants import their
-coffee and chocolate from Lisbon.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Most of the land, as far we saw of the country,
-is laid down in grass, upon which cattle are pastured
-in great plenty; but they are so lean, that an Englishman
-will scarcely eat of their flesh: the herbage of
-these pastures consists principally of cresses, and consequently
-is so short, that though it may afford a
-bite for horses and sheep, it can scarcely be grazed
-by horned cattle in a sufficient quantity to keep them
-alive.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This country may possibly produce many valuable
-drugs; but we could not find any in the apothecaries’
-shops, except pariera brava, and balsam capivi; both
-of which were excellent in their kind, and sold at a
-very low price. The drug trade is probably carried
-on to the northward, as well as that of the dying
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_39'>39</span>woods, for we could get no intelligence of either of
-them here.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As to manufactures, we neither saw nor heard of
-any except that of cotton hammocks, in which people
-are carried about here, as they are with us in sedan
-chairs; and these are principally, if not wholly,
-fabricated by the Indians.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The riches of the place consist chiefly in the mines,
-which we supposed to lie far up the country, though
-we could never learn where, or at what distance;
-for the situation is concealed as much as possible,
-and troops are continually employed in guarding the
-roads that lead to them: it is almost impossible for
-any man to get a sight of them, except those who
-are employed there; and, indeed, the strongest curiosity
-would scarcely induce any man to attempt it,
-for whoever is found upon the road to them, if he
-cannot give undeniable evidence of his having business
-there, is immediately hanged up upon the next
-tree.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Much gold is certainly brought from these mines,
-but at an expense of life that must strike every man,
-to whom custom has not made it familiar, with
-horror. No less than forty thousand negroes are
-annually imported on the king’s account, to dig the
-mines; and we were credibly informed, that the
-last year but one before we arrived here this number
-fell so short, probably from some epidemic disease
-that twenty thousand more were draughted from the
-town of Rio.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Precious stones are also found here in such plenty,
-that a certain quantity only is allowed to be collected
-in a year; to collect this quantity, a number of
-people are sent into the country where they are
-found, and when it is got together, which sometimes
-happens in a month, sometimes in less, and
-sometimes in more, they return; and after that,
-whoever is found in these precious districts, on any
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_40'>40</span>pretence, before the next year, is immediately put
-to death.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The jewels found here are diamonds, topazes of
-several kinds, and amethysts. We did not see any
-of the diamonds, but were informed that the Viceroy
-had a large quantity by him, which he would sell on
-the King of Portugal’s account, but not at a less
-price than they are sold for in Europe. Mr. Banks
-bought a few topazes and amethysts as specimens:
-of the topazes there are three sorts, of very different
-value, which are distinguished here by the names of
-Pinga d’agua qualidade primeiro, Pinga d’agua
-qualidade secundo, and Chrystallos armerillos: they
-are sold, large and small, good and bad together, by
-octavos, or the eighth part of an ounce; the best
-at 4s. 9d. All dealing, however, in these stones is
-prohibited to the subject under the severest penalties:
-there were jewellers here formerly, who purchased
-and worked them on their own account; but about
-fourteen months before our arrival, orders came from
-the court of Portugal, that no more stones should
-be wrought here, except on the King’s account: the
-jewellers were ordered to bring all their tools to the
-Viceroy, and left without any means of subsistence.
-The persons employed here to work stones for the
-King are slaves.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The coin that is current here, is either that of
-Portugal, consisting chiefly of thirty-six shillings
-pieces; or pieces, both of gold and silver, which
-are struck at this place: the pieces of silver, which
-are very much debased, are called Petacks, and are
-of different value, and easily distinguished by the
-number of rees that is marked on the outside. Here
-is also a copper coin, like that in Portugal, of five
-and ten ree pieces. A ree is a nominal coin of
-Portugal, ten of which are equal in value to about
-three farthings sterling.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The harbour of Rio de Janeiro is situated W. by
-N. 18 leagues from Cape Frio, and may be known by
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_41'>41</span>a remarkable hill, in the form of a sugar-loaf, at the
-west point of the bay; but as all the coast is very
-high, and rises in many peaks, the entrance of this
-harbour may be more certainly distinguished by the
-islands that lie before it; one of which, called
-Rodonda, is high and round, like a hay-stack, and
-lies at the distance of two leagues and a half from
-the entrance of the bay, in the direction of S. by W.;
-but the first islands which are met with, coming from
-the east, or Cape Frio, are two that have a rocky
-appearance, lying near to each other, and at the
-distance of about four miles from the shore: there
-are also at the distance of three leagues to the westward
-of these two other islands, which lie near to
-each other, a little without the bay on the east side,
-and very near the shore. This harbour is certainly
-a good one; the entrance, indeed, is not wide, but
-the sea-breeze, which blows every day from ten or
-twelve o’clock till sunset makes it easy for any ship
-to go in before the wind; and it grows wider as the
-town is approached, so that abreast of it there is
-room for the largest fleet, in five or six fathom water,
-with an oozy bottom. At the narrow part, the
-entrance is defended by two forts. The principal is
-Santa Cruz, which stands on the east point of the
-bay, and has been mentioned before; that on the
-west side is called fort Lozia, and is built upon a
-rock that lies close to the main; the distance between
-them is about ¾ of a mile, but the channel is
-not quite so broad, because there are sunken rocks
-which lie off each fort, and in this part alone there
-is danger: the narrowness of the channel causes the
-tides, both flood and ebb, to run with considerable
-strength, so that they cannot be stemmed without a
-fresh breeze. The rockiness of the bottom makes it
-also unsafe to anchor here; but all danger may be
-avoided by keeping in the middle of the channel.
-Within the entrance, the course up the bay is first
-N. by W. ½ W., and N. N. W., something more than a
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_42'>42</span>league; this will bring the vessel the length of the
-great road; and N. W. and W. N. W. one league
-more will carry her to the Isle dos Cobras, which
-lies before the city: she should then keep the north
-side of this island close on board, and anchor above
-it, before a monastery of Benedictines, which stands
-upon a hill at the N. W. end of the city.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The river, and, indeed, the whole coast, abounds
-with a greater variety of fish than we had ever seen;
-a day seldom passed in which one or more of a new
-species were not brought to Mr. Banks: the bay
-also is as well adapted for catching these fish as can
-be conceived; for it is full of small islands, between
-which there is shallow water, and proper beaches
-for drawing the seine. The sea, without the bay,
-abounds with dolphins, and large mackarel of different
-kinds, which readily bite at a hook, and the
-inhabitants always tow one after their boats for that
-purpose.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Though the climate is hot, the situation of this
-place is certainly wholesome; while we stayed here
-the thermometer never rose higher than 83 degrees.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We had frequent rains, and once a very hard gale
-of wind.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Ships water here at the fountain in the great
-square, though, as I have observed, the water is not
-good: they land their casks upon a smooth sandy
-beach, which is not more than a hundred yards distant
-from the fountain; and, upon application to the Viceroy,
-a sentinel will be appointed to look after them,
-and clear the way to the fountain where they are to
-be filled.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Upon the whole, Rio de Janeiro is a very good
-place for ships to put in at that want refreshment:
-the harbour is safe and commodious; and provisions,
-except wheaten bread and flour, may be easily procured:
-as a succedaneum for bread, there are yams
-and cassada in plenty; beef, both fresh and jerked,
-may be bought at about two-pence farthing a pound;
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_43'>43</span>though, as I have before remarked, it is very lean. The
-people here jerk their beef by taking out the bones,
-cutting it into large but thin slices, then curing it
-with salt, and drying it in the shade: it eats very
-well, and, if kept dry, will remain good a long time
-at sea. Mutton is scarcely to be procured, and hogs
-and poultry are dear; of garden-stuff and fruit-trees
-there is abundance, of which, however, none can
-be preserved at sea but the pumpkin; rum, sugar,
-and molasses, all excellent in their kind, may be had
-at a reasonable price; tobacco also is cheap, but it is
-not good. Here is a yard for building shipping, and
-a small hulk to heave down by; for as the tide never
-rises above six or seven feet, there is no other way of
-coming at a ship’s bottom.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When the boat which had been sent on shore
-returned, we hoisted her on board, and stood out to
-sea.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_44'>44</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. III.<br /> <br />THE PASSAGE FROM RIO DE JANEIRO TO THE ENTRANCE OF THE STREIGHT OF LE MAIRE, WITH A DESCRIPTION OF SOME OF THE INHABITANTS OF TERRA DEL FUEGO.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>On</span> the 9th of December we observed the sea to be
-covered with broad streaks of a yellowish colour,
-several of them a mile long, and three or four hundred
-yards wide; some of the water thus coloured
-was taken up, and found to be full of innumerable
-atoms, pointed at the end, of a yellowish colour, and
-none more than a quarter of a line, or the fortieth
-part of an inch long; in the microscope they appeared
-to be <i>Fasciculi</i> of small fibres interwoven with
-each other, not unlike the nidus of some of the <i>Phyganeas</i>,
-called Caddices; but whether they were
-animal or vegetable substances, whence they came,
-or for what they were designed, neither Mr. Banks
-nor Dr. Solander could guess. The same appearance
-had been observed before, when we first discovered
-the Continent of South America.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 11th we hooked a shark, and while we
-were playing it under the cabin window, it threw
-out, and drew in again, several times, what appeared
-to be its stomach: it proved to be a female, and
-upon being opened six young ones were taken out
-of it; five of them were alive, and swam briskly in a
-tub of water, but the sixth appeared to have been
-dead some time.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Nothing remarkable happened till the 30th, except
-that we prepared for the bad weather, which we were
-shortly to expect, by bending a new suit of sails;
-but on this day we ran a course of one hundred and
-sixty miles by the log, through innumerable land
-insects of various kinds, some upon the wing, and
-more upon the water, many of which were alive;
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_45'>45</span>they appeared to be exactly the same with the <i>Carabi</i>,
-the <i>Grylli</i>, the <i>Phalanæ</i>, <i>Aranea</i>, and other flies that
-are seen in England, though at this time we could
-not be less than thirty leagues from land; and some
-of these insects, particularly the <i>Grylli Aranea</i>, never
-voluntarily leave it at a greater distance than twenty
-yards. We judged ourselves to be now nearly opposite
-to <i>Baye sans fond</i>, where Mr. Dalrymple supposes
-there is a passage quite through the continent
-of America; and we thought from the insects that
-there might be at least a very large river, and that
-it had overflowed its banks.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 3d of January, 1769, being in latitude
-47° 17ʹ S. and longitude 61° 29ʹ 45ʺ W., we were all
-looking out for Pepys’ island, and for some time an
-appearance was seen in the east which so much resembled
-land, that we bore away for it; and it was
-more than two hours and a half before we were
-convinced that it was nothing but what sailors call a
-fog-bank.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The people now beginning to complain of cold,
-each of them received what is called a Magellanic
-jacket, and a pair of trowsers. The jacket is made
-of a thick woollen stuff, called <i>Fearnought</i>, which is
-provided by the government. We saw, from time to
-time, a great number of penguins, albatrosses, and
-sheerwaters, seals, whales, and porpoises; and on
-the 11th, having passed Falkland’s islands, we discovered
-the coast of Terra del Fuego, at the distance
-of about four leagues, extending from the W. to
-S. E. by S. We had here five-and-thirty fathom, the
-ground soft, small slate stones. As we ranged along
-the shore to the S. E., at the distance of two or three
-leagues, we perceived smoke in several places, which
-was made by the natives, probably as a signal, for
-they did not continue it after we had passed by.
-This day we discovered that the ship had got near a
-degree of longitude to the westward of the log,
-which, in this latitude, is 35 minutes of a degree on
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_46'>46</span>the equator: probably there is a small current setting
-to the westward, which may be caused by the westerly
-current coming round Cape Horn, and through
-the Streight of Le Maire, and the indraught of the
-Streight of Magellan.<a id='r1' /><a href='#f1' class='c015'><sup>[1]</sup></a></p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Having continued to range the coast, on the 14th
-we entered the Streight of Le Maire; but the tide
-turning against us, drove us out with great violence,
-and raised such a sea off Cape St. Deigo, that the
-waves had exactly the same appearance as they
-would have had if they had broke over a ledge of
-rocks; and when the ship was in this torrent, she
-frequently pitched, so that the bowsprit was under
-water. About noon, we got under the land between
-Cape St. Deigo and Cape St. Vincent, where I intended
-to have anchored; but finding the ground
-every where hard and rocky, and shallowing from
-thirty to twelve fathoms, I sent the master to examine
-a little cove which lay at a small distance to the eastward
-of Cape St. Vincent. When he returned, he
-reported that there was anchorage in four fathom,
-and a good bottom, close to the eastward, of the first
-bluff point, on the east of Cape St. Vincent, at the
-very entrance of the cove, to which I gave the name
-of <span class='sc'>Vincent</span>’s Bay: before this anchoring ground,
-however, lay several rocky ledges, that were covered
-with sea-weed; but I was told that there was not
-less than eight and nine fathom over all of them.
-It will probably be thought strange, that where
-weeds, which grow at the bottom, appear above the
-surface, there should be this depth of water; but the
-weeds which grow upon rocky ground in these countries,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_47'>47</span>and which always distinguish it from sand and
-ooze, are of an enormous size. The leaves are four
-feet long, and some of the stalks, though not thicker
-than a man’s thumb, above one hundred and twenty.
-Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander examined some of
-them, over which we sounded and had fourteen
-fathom, which is eighty-four feet; and, as they made
-a very acute angle with the bottom, they were
-thought to be at least one half longer: the foot-stalks
-were swelled into an air vessel, and Mr. Banks
-and Dr. Solander called this plant <i>Fucus giganteus</i>.
-Upon the report of the master, I stood in with the
-ship; but not trusting implicitly to his intelligence,
-I continued to sound, and found but four fathom
-upon the first ledge that I went over; concluding,
-therefore, that I could not anchor here without risk,
-I determined to seek some port in the Streight,
-where I might get on board such wood and water as
-we wanted.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, however, being very
-desirous to go on shore, I sent a boat with them and
-their people, while I kept plying as near as possible
-with the ship.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Having been on shore four hours, they returned
-about nine in the evening, with above an hundred
-different plants and flowers, all of them wholly unknown
-to the botanists of Europe. They found the
-country about the bay to be in general flat, the
-bottom of it in particular was a plain covered with
-grass, which might easily have been made into a
-large quantity of hay; they found also abundance
-of good wood and water, and fowl in great plenty.
-Among other things, of which nature has been
-liberal in this place, is Winter’s bark, <i>Winteranea
-aromatica</i>; which may easily be known by its broad
-leaf, shaped like the laurel, of a light green colour
-without, and inclining to blue within; the bark is
-easily stripped with a bone or a stick, and its virtues
-are well known; it may be used for culinary purposes
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_48'>48</span>as a spice, and is not less pleasant than wholesome:
-here is also plenty of wild celery and scurvy-grass.
-The trees are chiefly of one kind, a species of the
-birch, called <i>Betula antarctica</i>; the stem is from
-thirty to forty feet long, and from two to three
-feet in diameter, so that in a case of necessity they
-might possibly supply a ship with top-masts; they
-are a light white wood, bear a small leaf, and cleave
-very straight. Cranberries were also found here in
-great plenty, both white and red.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The persons who landed saw none of the inhabitants,
-but fell in with two of their deserted huts, one
-in a thick wood, and the other close by the beach.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Having taken the boat on board, I made sail into
-the Streight, and at three in the morning of the 15th
-I anchored in twelve fathom and a half, upon coral
-rocks, before a small cove, which we took for Port
-Maurice, at the distance of about half a mile from
-the shore. Two of the natives came down to the
-beach, expecting us to land; but this spot afforded
-so little shelter, that I at length determined not to
-examine it; I therefore got under sail again about
-ten o’clock, and the savages retired into the woods.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At two o’clock, we anchored in the bay of Good
-Success; and after dinner I went on shore, accompanied
-by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, to look for a
-watering-place, and speak to the Indians, several of
-whom had come in sight. We landed on the starboard
-side of the bay near some rocks, which made
-smooth water and good landing: thirty or forty of
-the Indians soon made their appearance at the end
-of a sandy beach on the other side of the bay, but
-seeing our number, which was ten or twelve, they
-retreated. Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander then advanced
-about one hundred yards before us, upon
-which two of the Indians returned, and, having advanced
-some paces towards them, sat down: as soon
-as they came up, the Indians rose, and each of them
-having a small stick in his hand threw it away, in a
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_49'>49</span>direction both from themselves and the strangers,
-which was considered as the renunciation of weapons
-in token of peace: they then walked briskly towards
-their companions, who had halted at about fifty yards
-behind them, and beckoned the gentlemen to follow,
-which they did. They were received with many uncouth
-signs of friendship; and, in return, they distributed
-among them some beads and ribbons, which
-had been brought on shore for that purpose, and with
-which they were greatly delighted. A mutual confidence
-and good-will being thus produced, our parties
-joined: the conversation, such as it was, became
-general; and three of them accompanied us back to
-the ship. When they came on board, one of them,
-whom we took to be a priest, performed much the
-same ceremonies which M. Bougainville describes,
-and supposes to be an exorcism. When he was introduced
-into a new part of the ship, or when any
-thing that he had not seen before caught his attention,
-he shouted with all his force for some minutes,
-without directing his voice either to us or his companions.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>They eat some bread and some beef, but not apparently
-with much pleasure, though such part of what
-was given them as they did not eat they took away
-with them; but they would not swallow a drop either
-of wine or spirits: they put the glass to their lips,
-but, having tasted the liquor, they returned it, with
-strong expressions of disgust. Curiosity seems to
-be one of the few passions which distinguish men
-from brutes; and of this our guests appeared to have
-very little. They went from one part of the ship to
-another, and looked at the vast variety of new objects
-that every moment presented themselves, without
-any expression either of wonder or pleasure; for the
-vociferation of our exorcist seemed to be neither.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After having been on board about two hours, they
-expressed a desire to go ashore. A boat was immediately
-ordered, and Mr. Banks thought fit to accompany
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_50'>50</span>them: he landed them in safety, and conducted
-them to their companions, among whom he remarked
-the same vacant indifference, as in those who had
-been on board; for as on one side there appeared no
-eagerness to relate, so on the other there seemed to
-be no curiosity to hear, how they had been received,
-or what they had seen. In about half an hour, Mr.
-Banks returned to the ship, and the Indians retired
-from the shore.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_51'>51</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. IV.<br /> <br />AN ACCOUNT OF WHAT HAPPENED IN ASCENDING A MOUNTAIN TO SEARCH FOR PLANTS.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>On</span> the 16th, early in the morning, Mr. Banks and
-Dr. Solander, with their attendants and servants, and
-two seamen to assist in carrying the baggage, accompanied
-by Mr. Monkhouse the surgeon, and Mr. Green
-the astronomer, set out from the ship, with a view to
-penetrate as far as they could into the country, and
-return at night. The hills, when viewed at a distance,
-seemed to be partly a wood, partly a plain, and above
-them a bare rock. Mr. Banks hoped to get through
-the wood, and made no doubt but that, beyond it,
-he should, in a country which no botanist had ever
-yet visited, find alpine plants which would abundantly
-compensate his labour. They entered the wood
-at a small sandy beach, a little to the westward of
-the watering-place, and continued to ascend the hill,
-through the pathless wilderness, till three o’clock,
-before they got a near view of the places which they
-intended to visit. Soon after they reached what they
-had taken for a plain; but, to their great disappointment,
-found it a swamp, covered with low bushes of
-birch, about three feet high, interwoven with each
-other, and so stubborn that they could not be bent
-out of the way; it was therefore necessary to lift the
-leg over them, which at every step was buried, ancle
-deep, in the soil. To aggravate the pain and difficulty
-of such travelling, the weather, which had hitherto
-been very fine, much like one of our bright days in
-May, became gloomy and cold, with sudden blasts
-of a most piercing wind, accompanied with snow.
-They pushed forward, however, in good spirits, notwithstanding
-their fatigue, hoping the worst of the
-way was past, and that the bare rock which they
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_52'>52</span>had seen from the tops of the lower hills was not
-more than a mile before them: but when they had
-got about two-thirds over this woody swamp, Mr.
-Buchan, one of Mr. Banks’s draughtsmen, was unhappily
-seized with a fit. This made it necessary for
-the whole company to halt, and as it was impossible
-that he should go any farther, a fire was kindled,
-and those who were most fatigued were left behind
-to take care of him. Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, Mr.
-Green, and Mr. Monkhouse went on, and in a short
-time reached the summit. As botanists, their expectations
-were here abundantly gratified; for they found
-a great variety of plants, which, with respect to the
-alpine plants in Europe, are exactly what those
-plants are with respect to such as grow in the plain.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The cold was now become more severe, and the
-snow-blasts more frequent; the day also was so far
-spent, that it was found impossible to get back to the
-ship before the next morning: to pass the night
-upon such a mountain, in such a climate, was not only
-comfortless, but dreadful; it was impossible, however,
-to be avoided, and they were to provide for it as well
-as they could.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, while they were improving
-an opportunity which they had, with so much
-danger and difficulty, procured, by gathering the
-plants which they found upon the mountain, sent
-Mr. Green and Mr. Monkhouse back to Mr. Buchan
-and the people that were with him, with directions to
-bring them to a hill, which they thought lay in a better
-rout for returning to the wood, and which was therefore
-appointed as a general rendezvous. It was proposed,
-that from this hill they should push through
-the swamp, which seemed by the new rout not to be
-more than half a mile over, into the shelter of the
-wood and there build their wigwam, and make a fire:
-this, as their way was all down hill, it seemed easy to
-accomplish. Their whole company assembled at the
-rendezvous, and, though pinched with the cold, were
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_53'>53</span>in health and spirits, Mr. Buchan himself having recovered
-his strength in a much greater degree than
-could have been expected. It was now near eight
-o’clock in the evening, but still good daylight, and
-they set forward for the nearest valley, Mr. Banks
-himself undertaking to bring up the rear, and see
-that no straggler was left behind: this may, perhaps,
-be thought a superfluous caution, but it will soon
-appear to be otherwise. Dr. Solander, who had more
-than once crossed the mountains which divide Sweden
-from Norway, well knew that extreme cold, especially
-when joined with fatigue, produces a torpor
-and sleepiness that are almost irresistible: he therefore
-conjured the company to keep moving, whatever
-pain it might cost them, and whatever relief they
-might be promised by an inclination to rest. Whoever
-sits down, says he, will sleep; and whoever
-sleeps, will wake no more. Thus, at once admonished
-and alarmed, they set forward; but while they were
-still upon the naked rock, and before they had got
-among the bushes, the cold became suddenly so intense,
-as to produce the effects that had been most
-dreaded. Dr. Solander himself was the first who
-found the inclination, against which he had warned
-others, irresistible; and insisted upon being suffered
-to lie down. Mr. Banks entreated and remonstrated
-in vain: down he lay upon the ground, though it was
-covered with snow; and it was with great difficulty
-that his friend kept him from sleeping. Richmond
-also, one of the black servants, began to linger, having
-suffered from the cold in the same manner as the
-Doctor. Mr. Banks, therefore, sent five of the company,
-among whom was Mr. Buchan, forward to get
-a fire ready at the first convenient place they could
-find; and himself, with four others, remained with
-the Doctor and Richmond, whom, partly by persuasion
-and entreaty, and partly by force, they brought
-on; but when they had got through the greatest
-part of the birch and swamp, they both declared they
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_54'>54</span>could go no farther. Mr. Banks had recourse again
-to entreaty and expostulation, but they produced no
-effect: when Richmond was told, that if he did not
-go on he would in a short time be frozen to death,
-he answered, that he desired nothing but to lie down
-and die: the Doctor did not so explicitly renounce
-his life; he said he was willing to go on, but that
-he must first take some sleep, though he had before
-told the company that to sleep was to perish. Mr.
-Banks and the rest found it impossible to carry them,
-and there being no remedy, they were both suffered
-to sit down, being partly supported by the bushes,
-and in a few minutes they fell into a profound sleep:
-soon after, some of the people who had been sent
-forward, returned, with the welcome news that a fire
-was kindled about a quarter of a mile farther on the
-way. Mr. Banks then endeavoured to wake Dr. Solander,
-and happily succeeded: but, though he had not
-slept five minutes, he had almost lost the use of his
-limbs, and the muscles were so shrunk that his shoes fell
-from his feet: he consented to go forward with such
-assistance as could be given him, but no attempts to
-relieve poor Richmond were successful. It being
-found impossible to make him stir, after some time
-had been lost in the attempt, Mr. Banks left his
-other black servant and a seaman, who seemed to
-have suffered least by the cold, to look after him;
-promising, that as soon as two others should be sufficiently
-warmed, they should be relieved. Mr. Banks,
-with much difficulty, at length got the Doctor to the
-fire; and soon after sent two of the people who had
-been refreshed, in hopes that, with the assistance of
-those who had been left behind, they would be able
-to bring Richmond, even though it should still be
-found impossible to wake him. In about half an
-hour, however, they had the mortification to see these
-two men return alone: they said, that they had been
-all round the place to which they had been directed,
-but could neither find Richmond nor those who had
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_55'>55</span>been left with him; and that though they had shouted
-many times, no voice had replied. This was matter of
-equal surprise and concern, particularly to Mr. Banks,
-who, while he was wondering how it could happen,
-missed a bottle of rum, the company’s whole stock,
-which they now concluded to be in the knapsack
-of one of the absentees. It was conjectured, that
-with this Richmond had been roused by the two persons
-who had been left with him, and that, having
-perhaps drank too freely of it themselves, they had
-all rambled from the place where they had been left,
-in search of the fire, instead of waiting for those
-who should have been their assistants and guides.
-Another fall of snow now came on, and continued
-incessantly for two hours, so that all hope of seeing
-them again, at least alive, were given up; but about
-twelve o’clock, to the great joy of those at the fire,
-a shouting was heard at some distance. Mr. Banks,
-with four more, immediately went out, and found the
-seaman with just strength enough left to stagger
-along, and call out for assistance: Mr. Banks sent him
-immediately to the fire, and, by his direction, proceeded
-in search of the other two, whom he soon
-after found. Richmond was upon his legs, but not
-able to put one before the other: his companion was
-lying upon the ground, as insensible as a stone. All
-hands were now called from the fire, and an attempt
-was made to carry them to it; but this, notwithstanding
-the united efforts of the whole company, was
-found to be impossible. The night was extremely
-dark, the snow was now very deep, and, under these
-additional disadvantages, they found it very difficult to
-make way through the bushes and the bog for themselves,
-all of them getting many falls in the attempt.
-The only alternative was to make a fire upon the
-spot; but the snow which had fallen, and was still
-falling, besides what was every moment shaken in
-flakes from the trees, rendered it equally impracticable
-to kindle one there and to bring any part of
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_56'>56</span>that which had been kindled in the wood thither:
-they were, therefore, reduced to the sad necessity
-of leaving the unhappy wretches to their fate; having
-first made them a bed of boughs from the trees, and
-spread a covering of the same kind over them, to a
-considerable height.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Having now been exposed to the cold and the
-snow near an hour and a half, some of the rest
-began to lose their sensibility; and one, Briscoe,
-another of Mr. Banks’s servants, was so ill, that it
-was thought he must die before he could be got to
-the fire.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At the fire, however, at length they arrived; and
-passed the night in a situation, which however dreadful
-in itself, was rendered more afflicting by the
-remembrance of what was past, and the uncertainty
-of what was to come. Of twelve, the number that
-set out together in health and spirits, two were supposed
-to be already dead; a third was so ill, that it
-was very doubtful whether he would be able to go
-forward in the morning; and a fourth, Mr. Buchan,
-was in danger of a return of his fits, by fresh fatigue,
-after so uncomfortable a night: they were distant
-from the ship a long day’s journey, through pathless
-woods, in which it was too probable they might be
-bewildered till they were overtaken by the next
-night; and, not having prepared for a journey of
-more than eight or ten hours, they were wholly
-destitute of provisions, except a vulture, which they
-happened to shoot while they were out, and which,
-if equally divided, would not afford each of them
-half a meal; and they knew not how much more
-they might suffer from the cold, as the snow still
-continued to fall. A dreadful testimony of the
-severity of the climate, as it was now the midst of
-summer in this part of the world, the twenty-first of
-December being here the longest day; and every
-thing might justly be dreaded from a phænomenon
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_57'>57</span>which, in the corresponding season, is unknown even
-in Norway and Lapland.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When the morning dawned, they saw nothing
-round them, as far as the eye could reach, but snow,
-which seemed to lie as thick upon the trees as upon
-the ground; and the blasts returned so frequently,
-and with such violence, that they found it impossible
-for them to set out: how long this might last
-they knew not, and they had but too much reason
-to apprehend that it would confine them in that
-desolate forest till they perished with hunger and
-cold.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After having suffered the misery and terror of this
-situation till six o’clock in the morning, they conceived
-some hope of deliverance by discovering the
-place of the sun through the clouds, which were
-become thinner, and began to break away. Their
-first care was to see whether the poor wretches
-whom they had been obliged to leave among the
-bushes were yet alive; three of the company were
-dispatched for that purpose, and very soon afterwards
-returned with the melancholy news, that they
-were dead.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Notwithstanding the flattering appearance of the
-sky, the snow still continued to fall so thick, that
-they could not venture out on their journey to the
-ship; but about eight o’clock a small regular breeze
-sprung up, which, with the prevailing influence of
-the sun, at length cleared the air; and they soon
-after, with great joy, saw the snow fall in large flakes
-from the trees, a certain sign of an approaching thaw:
-they now examined more critically the state of their
-invalids: Briscoe was still very ill, but said, that he
-thought himself able to walk; and Mr. Buchan was
-much better than either he or his friends had any
-reason to expect. They were now, however, pressed
-by the calls of hunger; to which, after long fasting,
-every consideration of future good or evil immediately
-gives way. Before they set forward, therefore,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_58'>58</span>it was unanimously agreed, that they should eat their
-vulture: the bird was accordingly skinned; and, it
-being thought best to divide it before it was fit to be
-eaten, it was cut into ten portions, and every man
-cooked his own as he thought fit. After this repast,
-which furnished each of them with about three
-mouthfuls, they prepared to set out; but it was ten
-o’clock before the snow was sufficiently gone off, to
-render a march practicable. After a walk of about
-three hours, they were very agreeably surprised to
-find themselves upon the beach, and much nearer
-to the ship than they had any reason to expect.
-Upon reviewing their track from the vessel, they
-perceived that, instead of ascending the hill in a line,
-so as to penetrate into the country, they had made
-almost a circle round it. When they came on board,
-they congratulated each other upon their safety, with
-a joy that no man can feel who has not been exposed
-to equal danger; and as I had suffered great anxiety
-at their not returning in the evening of the day on
-which they set out, I was not wholly without my
-share.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_59'>59</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. V.<br /> <br />THE PASSAGE THROUGH THE STREIGHT OF LE MAIRE, AND A FURTHER DESCRIPTION OF THE INHABITANTS OF TERRA DEL FUEGO, AND ITS PRODUCTIONS.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>On</span> the 18th and 19th, we were delayed in getting
-on board our wood and water by a swell: but on the
-20th, the weather being more moderate, we again
-sent the boat on shore, and Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander
-went in it. They landed in the bottom of
-the bay; and while my people were employed in
-cutting brooms, they pursued their great object, the
-improvement of natural knowledge, with success, collecting
-many shells and plants which hitherto have
-been altogether unknown: they came on board to
-dinner, and afterwards went again on shore to visit
-an Indian town, which some of the people had reported
-to lie about two miles up the country. They
-found the distance not more than by the account,
-and they approached it by what appeared to be the
-common road, yet they were above an hour in getting
-thither, for they were frequently up to their knees
-in mud. When they got within a small distance, two
-of the people came out to meet them, with such
-state as they could assume: when they joined them,
-they began to hollow as they had done on board the
-ship, without addressing themselves either to the
-strangers or their companions; and having continued
-this strange vociferation some time, they conducted
-them to the town. It was situated on a dry knoll,
-or small hill, covered with wood, none of which
-seemed to have been cleared away, and consisted of
-about twelve or fourteen hovels, of the most rude
-and inartificial structure that can be imagined.
-They were nothing more than a few poles set up so
-as to incline towards each other, and meet at the top,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_60'>60</span>forming a kind of a cone, like some of our bee-hives:
-on the weather-side they were covered with a few
-boughs, and a little grass; and on the lee-side about
-one-eighth of the circle was left open, both for a
-door and a fire-place; and of this kind were the huts
-that had been seen in St. Vincent’s bay, in one of
-which the embers of a fire were still remaining.
-Furniture they had none: a little grass, which lay
-round the inside of the hovel, served both for chairs
-and beds; and of all the utensils which necessity and
-ingenuity have concurred to produce among other
-savage nations, they saw only a basket to carry in
-the hand, a satchel to hang at the back, and the
-bladder of some beast to hold water, which the natives
-drink through a hole that is made near the top for
-that purpose.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The inhabitants of this town were a small tribe,
-not more than fifty in number, of both sexes and of
-every age. Their colour resembles that of the rust
-of iron mixed with oil, and they have long black
-hair: the men are large, but clumsily built: their
-stature is from five feet eight to five feet ten: the
-women are much less, few of them being more than
-five feet high. Their whole apparel consists of the
-skin of a guanicoe, or seal, which is thrown over
-their shoulders, exactly in the state in which it came
-from the animal’s back; a piece of the same skin,
-which is drawn over their feet, and gathered about the
-ancles like a purse, and a small flap, which is worn
-by the women as a succedaneum for a fig-leaf. The
-men wear their cloak open, the women tie it about
-their waist with a thong. But although they are
-content to be naked, they are very ambitious to be
-fine. Their faces were painted in various forms:
-the region of the eye was in general white, and the
-rest of the face adorned with horizontal streaks of
-red and black; yet scarcely any two were exactly
-alike. This decoration seems to be more profuse and
-elaborate upon particular occasions; for the two
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_61'>61</span>gentlemen who introduced Mr. Banks and the Doctor
-into the town were almost covered with streaks
-of black in all directions, so as to make a very striking
-appearance. Both men and women wore bracelets
-of such beads as they could make themselves of
-small shells or bones; the women both upon their
-wrists and ancles, the men upon their wrists only:
-but to compensate for the want of bracelets on their
-legs, they wore a kind of fillet of brown worsted round
-their heads. They seemed to set a particular value
-upon any thing that was red, and preferred beads even
-to a knife or a hatchet.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their language in general is guttural, and they
-express some of their words by a sound exactly like
-that which we make to clear the throat when any
-thing happens to obstruct it; yet they have words
-that would be deemed soft in the better languages of
-Europe. Mr. Banks learnt what he supposes to be
-their name for beads and water. When they wanted
-beads, instead of ribbons or other trifles, they said
-<i>hallĕcă</i>; and when they were taken on shore from
-the ship, and by signs asked where water might be
-found, they made the sign of drinking, and pointing
-as well to the casks as the watering-place, cried
-<i>Oodâ</i>.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We saw no appearance of their having any food
-but shell-fish; for though seals were frequently seen
-near the shore, they seemed to have no implements for
-taking them. The shell-fish is collected by the women,
-whose business it seems to be to attend at low water,
-with a basket in one hand, and a stick, pointed and
-barbed, in the other, and a satchel at their backs:
-they loosen the limpets, and other fish that adhere
-to the rocks with the stick, and put them into
-the basket, which, when full, they empty into the
-satchel.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The only things that we found among them in
-which there was the least appearance of neatness or
-ingenuity were their weapons, which consisted of
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_62'>62</span>a bow and arrows. The bow was not inelegantly
-made, and the arrows were the neatest that we had
-ever seen: they were of wood, polished to the
-highest degree; and the point, which was of glass
-or flint, and barbed, was formed and fitted with
-wonderful dexterity. We saw also some pieces of
-glass and flint among them unwrought, besides rings,
-buttons, cloth, and canvass, with other European
-commodities; they must, therefore, sometimes travel
-to the northward, for it is many years since any ship
-has been so far south as this part of Terra del
-Fuego. We observed, also, that they showed no
-surprise at our fire-arms, with the use of which they
-appeared to be well acquainted; for they made
-signs to Mr. Banks to shoot a seal which followed
-the boat, as they were going on shore from the ship.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>M. de Bougainville, who, in January, 1768, just
-one year before us, had been on shore upon this
-coast in latitude 53° 40ʹ 41ʺ, had, among other things,
-given glass to the people whom he found here; for
-he says, that a boy about twelve years old took it
-into his head to eat some of it: by this unhappy
-accident he died in great misery; but the endeavours
-of the good father, the French <i><span lang="fr" xml:lang="fr">aumonier</span></i>, were more
-successful than those of the surgeon; for though
-the surgeon could not save his life, the charitable
-priest found means to steal a Christian baptism upon
-him so secretly, that none of his Pagan relations
-knew any thing of the matter. These people might
-probably have some of the very glass which Bougainville
-left behind him, either from other natives, or
-perhaps from himself; for they appeared rather to
-be a travelling horde than to have any fixed habitation.
-Their houses are built to stand but for a short
-time. They have no utensil or furniture but the
-basket and satchel, which have been mentioned
-before, and which have handles adapted to the
-carrying them about, in the hand and upon the back.
-The only clothing they had here was scarcely sufficient
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_63'>63</span>to prevent their perishing with cold in the summer
-of this country, much less in the extreme severity of
-winter. The shell-fish, which seems to be their only
-food, must soon be exhausted at any one place; and
-we had seen houses upon what appeared to be a
-deserted station in St. Vincent’s Bay.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It is also probable that the place where we found
-them was only a temporary residence, from their
-having here nothing like a boat or canoe, of which
-it can scarcely be supposed that they were wholly
-destitute, especially as they were not sea-sick, or
-particularly affected, either in our boat or on board
-the ship. We conjectured that there might be a
-streight or inlet, running from the sea through great
-part of this island, from the Streight of Magellan,
-whence these people might come, leaving their canoes
-where such inlet terminated.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>They did not appear to have among them any
-government or subordination: none was more respected
-than another; yet they seemed to live together
-in the utmost harmony and good fellowship. Neither
-did we discover any appearance of religion among
-them, except the noises which have been mentioned,
-and which we supposed to be a superstitious ceremony,
-merely because we could refer them to nothing
-else: they were used only by one of those who came
-on board the ship, and the two who conducted
-Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander to the town, whom we
-therefore conjectured to be priests. Upon the whole,
-these people appeared to be the most destitute and
-forlorn, as well as the most stupid, of all human
-beings; the outcasts of nature, who spent their lives
-in wandering about the dreary wastes, where two of
-our people perished with cold in the midst of summer;
-with no dwelling but a wretched hovel of sticks and
-grass, which would not only admit the wind, but the
-snow and the rain; almost naked; and destitute of
-every convenience that is furnished by the rudest art,
-having no implement even to dress their food: yet
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_64'>64</span>they were content. They seemed to have no wish
-for any thing more than they possessed, nor did any
-thing that we offered them appear acceptable but
-beads, as an ornamental superfluity of life. What
-bodily pain they might suffer from the severities of
-their winter we could not know; but it is certain
-that they suffered nothing from the want of the
-innumerable articles which we consider not as the
-luxuries and conveniencies only but the necessaries
-of life: as their desires are few, they probably enjoy
-them all; and how much they may be gainers by an
-exemption from the care, labour, and solicitude,
-which arise from a perpetual and unsuccessful effort
-to gratify that infinite variety of desires which the
-refinements of artificial life have produced among us,
-is not very easy to determine: possibly this may
-counterbalance all the real disadvantages of their
-situation in comparison with ours, and make the
-scales by which good and evil are distributed to man
-hang even between us.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In this place we saw no quadruped except seals,
-sea-lions, and dogs: of the dogs it is remarkable
-that they bark, which those that are originally bred
-in America do not. And this is a further proof, that
-the people we saw here had, either immediately or
-remotely, communicated with the inhabitants of
-Europe. There are, however, other quadrupeds in
-this part of the country; for when Mr. Banks was at
-the top of the highest hill that he ascended in his
-expedition through the woods, he saw the footsteps
-of a large beast imprinted upon the surface of a bog,
-though he could not with any probability guess of
-what kind it might be.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Of land-birds there are but few: Mr. Banks saw
-none larger than an English blackbird, except some
-hawks and a vulture; but of water-fowl there is
-great plenty, particularly ducks. Of fish we saw
-scarce any, and with our hooks could catch none
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_65'>65</span>that was fit to eat; but shell-fish, limpets, clams, and
-mussels, were to be found in abundance.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Among the insects, which were not numerous, there
-was neither gnat nor musquito, nor any other species
-that was either hurtful or troublesome, which perhaps
-is more than can be said of any other uncleared
-country. During the snow-blasts, which happened
-every day while we were here, they hide themselves;
-and the moment it is fair they appear again, as
-nimble and vigorous as the warmest weather could
-make them.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Of plants, Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander found a
-vast variety; the far greater part wholly different
-from any that have been hitherto described. Besides
-the birch and winter’s bark, which have been
-mentioned already; there is the beach, <i>Fagus
-antarcticus</i>, which, as well as the birch, may be used
-for timber. The plants cannot be enumerated here;
-but as the scurvy-grass, <i>Cardamine antiscorbutica</i>, and
-the wild celery, <i>Apium antarcticum</i>, probably contain
-antiscorbutic qualities, which may be of great benefit
-to the crews of such ships as shall hereafter touch at
-this place, the following short description is inserted:</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The scurvy-grass will be found in plenty in damp
-places, near springs of water, and, in general, in all
-places that lie near the beach, especially at the
-watering-place in the Bay of Good Success: when
-it is young, the state of its greatest perfection, it lies
-flat upon the ground, having many leaves of a bright
-green, standing in pairs opposite to each other, with
-a single one at the end, which generally makes the
-fifth upon a foot-stalk. The plant, passing from this
-state, shoots up in stalks that are sometimes two
-feet high, at the top of which are small white blossoms,
-and these are succeeded by long pods: the
-whole plant greatly resembles that which in England
-is called Lady’s smock, or Cuckow-flower. The
-wild celery is very like the celery in our gardens,
-the flowers are white, and stand in the same manner,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_66'>66</span>in small tufts at the top of the branches, but the
-leaves are of a deeper green. It grows in great
-abundance near the beach, and generally upon the
-soil that lies next above the spring tides. It may,
-indeed, easily be known by the taste, which is between
-that of celery and parsley. We used the
-celery in large quantities, particularly in our soup,
-which, thus medicated, produced the same good
-effects which seamen generally derive from a vegetable
-diet, after having been long confined to salt
-provisions.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On Sunday the 22d of January, about two o’clock
-in the morning, having got our wood and water on
-board, we sailed out of the bay, and continued our
-course through the Streight.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_67'>67</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. VI.<br /> <br />A GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF THE S. E. PART OF TERRA DEL FUEGO, AND THE STREIGHT OF LE MAIRE; WITH SOME REMARKS ON LORD ANSON’S ACCOUNT OF THEM, AND DIRECTIONS FOR THE PASSAGE WESTWARD, ROUND THIS PART OF AMERICA, INTO THE SOUTH SEAS.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>Almost</span> all writers who have mentioned the island
-of Terra del Fuego, describe it as destitute of wood,
-and covered with snow. In the winter it may possibly
-be covered with snow, and those who saw it at
-that season might, perhaps, be easily deceived, by its
-appearance, into an opinion that it was destitute of
-wood. Lord Anson was there in the beginning of
-March, which answers to our September, and we
-were there the beginning of January, which answers
-to our July; which may account for the difference
-of his description of it from ours. We fell in with
-it about twenty-one leagues to the westward of the
-Streight of Le Maire, and from the time that we first
-saw it, trees were plainly to be distinguished with
-our glasses: and as we came nearer, though here
-and there we discovered patches of snow, the sides
-of the hills and the sea coast appeared to be covered
-with a beautiful verdure. The hills are lofty, but
-not mountainous, though the summits of them are
-quite naked. The soil in the valleys is rich, and of a
-considerable depth: and at the foot of almost every
-hill there is a brook, the water of which has a reddish
-hue, like that which runs through our turf bogs
-in England; but it is by no means ill tasted, and,
-upon the whole, proved to be the best that we took
-in during our voyage. We ranged the coast to the
-Streight, and had soundings all the way from forty
-to twenty fathom upon a gravelly and sandy bottom.
-The most remarkable land on Terra del Fuego is a
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_68'>68</span>hill in the form of a sugar-loaf, which stands on the
-west side not far from the sea; and the three hills,
-called the Three Brothers, about nine miles to the
-westward of Cape St. Diego, the low point that forms
-the north entrance of the Streight of Le Maire.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It is said in the account of Lord Anson’s voyage,
-that it is difficult to determine exactly where the
-Streight lies, though the appearance of Terra del
-Fuego be well known, without knowing also the
-appearance of Staten Land; and that some navigators
-have been deceived by three hills on Staten Land,
-which have been mistaken for the Three Brothers on
-Terra del Fuego, and so over-shot the Streight. But
-no ship can possibly miss the Streight that coasts
-Terra del Fuego within sight of land, for it will then
-of itself be sufficiently conspicuous; and Staten
-Land, which forms the east side, will be still more
-manifestly distinguished, for there is no land on
-Terra del Fuego like it. The Streight of Le Maire
-can be missed only by standing too far to the eastward,
-without keeping the land of Terra del Fuego
-in sight: if this is done, it may be missed, however
-accurately the appearance of the coast of Staten
-Land may have been exhibited; and if this is not
-done, it cannot be missed, though the appearance of
-that coast be not known. The entrance of the
-Streight should not be attempted but with a fair
-wind and moderate weather, and upon the very beginning
-of the tide of flood, which happens here at
-the full and change of the moon, about one or two
-o’clock; it is also best to keep as near to the Terra
-del Fuego shore as the winds will admit. By attending
-to these particulars, a ship may be got quite
-through the Streight in one tide; or, at least, to the
-southward of Success Bay, into which it will be more
-prudent to put, if the wind should be southerly, than
-to attempt the weathering of Staten Land with a lee
-wind and a current, which may endanger her being
-driven on that island.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_69'>69</span>The Streight itself, which is bounded on the west
-by Terra del Fuego, and on the east by the west end
-of Staten Land, is about five leagues long, and as
-many broad. The Bay of Good Success lies about
-the middle of it, on the Terra del Fuego side, and is
-discovered immediately upon entering the Streight
-from the northward: and the south head of it may
-be distinguished by a mark on the land, that has the
-appearance of a broad road, leading up from the sea
-into the country: at the entrance it is half a league
-wide, and runs in westward about two miles and a
-half. There is good anchorage in every part of it,
-in from ten to seven fathom, clear ground; and it
-affords plenty of exceeding good wood and water.
-The tides flow in the Bay, at the full and change of
-the moon, about four or five o’clock, and rise about
-five or six feet perpendicular. But the flood runs
-two or three hours longer in the Streight than in the
-Bay; and the ebb, or northerly current, runs with
-near double the strength of the flood.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the appearance of Staten Land, we did not discover
-the wildness and horror that is ascribed to it in
-the account of Lord Anson’s voyage. On the north
-side are the appearances of bays or harbours; and
-the land, when we saw it, was neither destitute of
-wood nor verdure, nor covered with snow. The
-island seems to be about twelve leagues in length, and
-five broad.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the west side of the Cape of Good Success,
-which forms the S. W. entrance of the Streight, lies
-Valentine’s Bay, of which we only saw the entrance;
-from this bay the land trends away to the W. S. W.
-for twenty or thirty leagues; it appears to be high
-and mountainous, and forms several bays and inlets.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At the distance of fourteen leagues from the Bay
-of Good Success, in the direction of S. W. ½ W. and
-between two and three leagues from the shore, lies
-New Island. It is about two leagues in length from
-N. E. to S. W. and terminates to the N. E. in a remarkable
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_70'>70</span>hillock. At the distance of seven leagues
-from New Island, in the direction of S. W. lies the
-Isle <i>Evouts</i>; and a little to the W. of the south
-of this island lie Barnevelt’s two small flat islands,
-close to each other; they are partly surrounded with
-rocks, which rise to different heights above the water,
-and lie twenty-four leagues from the Streight of Le
-Maire. At the distance of three leagues from Barnevelt’s
-islands, in the direction of S. W. by S. lies
-the S. E. point of Hermit’s islands: these islands lie
-S. E. and N. W., and are pretty high: from most
-points of view they will be taken for one island, or a
-part of the main.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>From the S. E. point of Hermit’s islands to Cape
-Horn the course is S. W. by S., distance three
-leagues.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The appearance of this Cape and Hermit’s islands
-is represented in the chart of this coast, from our
-first making land to the Cape, which includes the
-Streight of Le Maire, and part of Staten Land. In
-this chart I have laid down no land, nor traced out
-any shore but what I saw myself, and thus far it may
-be depended upon: the bays and inlets, of which we
-saw only the openings, are not traced; it can, however,
-scarcely be doubted, but that most, if not all
-of them, afford anchorage, wood, and water. The
-Dutch squadron, commanded by Hermit, certainly
-put into some of them in the year 1624. And it was
-Chapenham, the Vice-Admiral of this squadron, who
-first discovered that the land of Cape Horn consisted
-of a number of islands. The account, however,
-which those who sailed in Hermit’s fleet have given
-of these parts is extremely defective; and those of
-Schouton and Le Maire are still worse. It is therefore
-no wonder that the charts hitherto published
-should be erroneous, not only in laying down the
-land, but in the latitude and longitude of the places
-they contain. I will, however, venture to assert, that
-the longitude of few parts of the world is better
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_71'>71</span>ascertained than that of the Streight of Le Maire,
-and Cape Horn, in the chart now offered to the public,
-as it was laid down by several observations of the
-sun and moon, that were made both by myself and
-Mr. Green.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The variation of the compass on this coast I found
-to be from 23° to 25° E. except near Barnevelt’s
-islands and Cape Horn, where we found it less, and
-unsettled: probably it is disturbed here by the land,
-as Hermit’s squadron, in this very place, found all
-their compasses differ from each other. The declination
-of the dipping-needle, when set upon shore in
-Success Bay, was 68° 15ʹ below the horizon.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Between Streight Le Maire and Cape Horn we
-found a current setting, generally very strong, to the
-N. E. when we were in with the shore; but lost it
-when we were at the distance of fifteen or twenty
-leagues.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 26th January, we took our departure from
-Cape Horn, which lies in latitude 55° 53ʹ S. longitude,
-68° 13ʹ W. The farthest southern latitude that we
-made was 60° 10ʹ, our longitude was then 74° 30ʹ W.;
-and we found the variation of the compass, by the
-mean of eighteen azimuths, to be 27° 9ʹ E. As the
-weather was frequently calm, Mr. Banks went out in
-a small boat to shoot birds, among which were some
-albatrosses and sheerwaters. The albatrosses were
-observed to be larger than those which had been taken
-northward of the Streight; one of them measured
-ten feet two inches from the tip of one wing to that
-of the other, when they were extended: the sheerwater,
-on the contrary, is less, and darker coloured
-on the back. The albatrosses we skinned, and having
-soaked them in salt-water till the morning, we parboiled
-them, then throwing away the liquor, stewed
-them in a very little fresh water till they were tender,
-and had them served up with savoury sauce; thus
-dressed, the dish was universally commended, and we
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_72'>72</span>eat of it very heartily even when there was fresh pork
-upon the table.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>From a variety of observations which were made
-with great care, it appeared probable in the highest
-degree, that, from the time of our leaving the land
-to the 13th of February, when we were in latitude
-49° 32ʹ, and longitude 90° 37ʹ, we had no current to
-the west.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At this time we had advanced about 12° to the
-westward, and 3 and ½ to the northward of the
-Streight of Magellan; having been just three and
-thirty days in coming round the land of Terra del
-Fuego, or Cape Horn, from the east entrance of the
-Streight to this situation. And though the doubling
-of Cape Horn is so much dreaded, that, in the general
-opinion, it is more eligible to pass through the
-Streight of Magellan, we were not once brought
-under our close-reef’d topsails after we left the
-Streight of Le Maire. The Dolphin, in her last voyage,
-which she performed at the same season of the
-year with ours, was three months in getting through
-the Streight of Magellan, exclusive of the time that
-she lay in Port Famine; and I am persuaded, from
-the winds we had, that if we had come by that passage,
-we should not at this time have been in these
-seas; that our people would have been fatigued, and
-our anchors, cables, sails and rigging much damaged;
-neither of which inconveniencies we had now suffered.
-But supposing it more eligible to go round the
-Cape, than through the Streight of Magellan; it may
-still be questioned, whether it is better to go through
-the Streight of Le Maire, or stand to the eastward,
-and go round Staten Land. The advice given in the
-Account of Lord Anson’s voyage is, “That all
-ships bound to the South Seas, instead of passing
-through the Streight of Le Maire, should constantly
-pass to the eastward of Staten Land, and should
-be invariably bent on running to the southward as
-far as the latitude of 61 or 62 degrees, before they
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_73'>73</span>endeavour to stand to the westward.” But, in my
-opinion, different circumstances may at one time
-render it eligible to pass through the Streight, and to
-keep to the eastward of Staten Land at another. If
-the land is fallen in with to the westward of the
-Streight, and the wind is favourable for going through,
-I think it would be very injudicious to lose time by
-going round Staten Land, as I am confident that, by
-attending to the directions which I have given, the
-Streight may be passed with the utmost safety and
-convenience. But if, on the contrary, the land is
-fallen in with to the eastward of the Streight, and
-the wind should prove tempestuous or unfavourable,
-I think it would be best to go round Staten Land.
-But I cannot in any case concur in recommending
-the running into the latitude of 61 or 62, before any
-endeavour is made to stand to the westward. We
-found neither the current nor the storms which the
-running so far to the southward is supposed necessary
-to avoid; and, indeed, as the winds almost constantly
-blow from that quarter, it is scarcely possible to pursue
-the advice. The navigator has no choice but to
-stand to the southward, close upon a wind, and by
-keeping upon that tack, he will not only make southing,
-but westing; and, if the wind varies towards the
-north of the west, his westing will be considerable.
-It will, indeed, be highly proper to make sure of a
-westing sufficient to double all the lands, before an
-attempt is made to stand to the northward, and to
-this every man’s own prudence will of necessity
-direct him.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We now began to have strong gales and heavy
-seas, with irregular intervals of calm and fine
-weather.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_74'>74</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. VII.<br /> <br />THE SEQUEL OF THE PASSAGE FROM CAPE HORN TO THE NEWLY DISCOVERED ISLANDS IN THE SOUTH SEAS, WITH A DESCRIPTION OF THEIR FIGURE AND APPEARANCE; SOME ACCOUNT OF THE INHABITANTS, AND SEVERAL INCIDENTS THAT HAPPENED DURING THE COURSE, AND AT THE SHIP’S ARRIVAL AMONG THEM.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>On</span> the first of March, we were in latitude 38° 44ʹ S.
-and longitude 110° 33ʹ W. both by observation and
-by the log. This agreement, after a run of 660
-leagues, was thought to be very extraordinary; and
-is a demonstration, that after we left the land of
-Cape Horn we had no current that affected the ship.
-It renders it also highly probable, that we had been
-near no land of any considerable extent; for currents
-are always found when land is not remote, and sometimes,
-particularly on the east side of the continent
-in the North Sea, when land has been distant 100
-leagues.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Many birds, as usual, were constantly about the
-ship, so that Mr. Banks killed no less than 62 in one
-day; and what is more remarkable, he caught two
-forest flies, both of them of the same species, but
-different from any that have hitherto been described;
-these probably belonged to the birds, and came with
-them from the land, which we judged to be at a
-great distance. Mr. Banks also, about this time,
-found a large cuttle-fish, which had just been killed
-by the birds, floating in a mangled condition upon
-the water; it is very different from the cuttle-fishes
-that are found in the European seas; for its arms,
-instead of suckers, were furnished with a double row
-of very sharp talons, which resemble those of a cat,
-and, like them, were retractable into a sheath of skin,
-from which they might be thrust at pleasure. Of
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_75'>75</span>this cuttle-fish we made one of the best soups we had
-ever tasted.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The albatrosses now began to leave us, and after
-the 8th there was not one to be seen. We continued
-our course without any memorable event till the 24th,
-when some of the people who were upon the watch
-in the night, reported that they saw a log of wood
-pass by the ship; and that the sea, which was rather
-rough, became suddenly as smooth as a mill pond.
-It was a general opinion that there was land to windward;
-but I did not think myself at liberty to search
-for what I was not sure to find; though I judged we
-were not far from the islands that were discovered by
-Quiros in 1606. Our latitude was 22° 11ʹ S. and
-longitude 127° 55ʹ W.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 25th, about noon, one of the marines, a
-young fellow about twenty, was placed as centry at
-the cabin-door; while he was upon this duty, one of
-my servants was at the same place preparing to cut
-a piece of seal-skin into tobacco pouches: he had
-promised one to several of the men, but had refused
-one to this young fellow, though he had asked him
-several times; upon which he jocularly threatened
-to steal one, if it should be in his power. It happened
-that the servant being called hastily away,
-gave the skin in charge to the centinel, without
-regarding what had passed between them. The
-centinel immediately secured a piece of the skin,
-which the other missing at his return, grew angry;
-but after some altercation, contented himself with
-taking it away, declaring that, for so trifling an affair,
-he would not complain of him to the officers. But
-it happened that one of his fellow-soldiers, over-hearing
-the dispute, came to the knowledge of what had
-happened, and told it to the rest; who, taking it
-into their heads to stand up for the honour of their
-corps, reproached the offender with great bitterness,
-and reviled him in the most opprobrious terms; they
-exaggerated his offence into a crime of the deepest
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_76'>76</span>dye; they said it was a theft by a centry when he was
-upon duty, and of a thing that had been committed
-to his trust; they declared it a disgrace to associate
-with him; and the serjeant, in particular, said that,
-if the person from whom the skin had been stolen
-would not complain, he would complain himself;
-for that his honour would suffer if the offender was
-not punished. From the scoffs and reproaches of
-these men of honour, the poor young fellow retired
-to his hammock in an agony of confusion and shame.
-The serjeant soon after went to him, and ordered
-him to follow him to the deck: he obeyed without
-reply; but it being in the dusk of the evening, he
-slipped from the serjeant and went forward: he was
-seen by some of the people, who thought he was
-gone to the head; but a search being made for him
-afterwards, it was found that he had thrown himself
-overboard; and I was then first made acquainted with
-the theft and its circumstances.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The loss of this man was the more regretted as
-he was remarkably quiet and industrious, and as the
-very action that put an end to his life was a proof of
-an ingenuous mind; for to such only disgrace is
-insupportable.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On Tuesday the 4th of April, about ten o’clock
-in the morning, Mr. Banks’s servant, Peter Briscoe,
-discovered land, bearing south, at the distance of
-about three or four leagues. I immediately hauled
-up for it, and found it to be an island of an oval
-form, with a lagoon in the middle, which occupied
-much the larger part of it; the border of land which
-circumscribes the lagoon is in many places very low
-and narrow, particularly on the south side, where it
-consists principally of a beach or reef of rocks. It
-has the same appearance also in three places on the
-north side; so that the firm land being disjoined, the
-whole looks like many islands covered with wood.
-On the west end of the island is a large tree, or
-clump of trees, that in appearance resembles a tower;
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_77'>77</span>and about the middle are two cocoa-nut trees, which
-rise above all the rest, and, as we came near to the
-island, appeared like a flag. We approached it on
-the north side, and though we came within a mile,
-we found no bottom with 130 fathom of line, nor
-did there appear to be any anchorage about it. The
-whole is covered with trees of different verdure, but
-we could distinguish none, even with our glasses,
-except cocoa-nuts and palm-nuts. We saw several
-of the natives upon the shore, and counted four and
-twenty. They appeared to be tall, and to have
-heads remarkably large; perhaps they had something
-wound round them which we could not distinguish;
-they were of a copper colour, and had
-long black hair. Eleven of them walked along the
-beach abreast of the ship, with poles or pikes in
-their hands which reached twice as high as themselves.
-While they walked on the beach they seemed
-to be naked; but soon after they retired, which they
-did as soon as the ship had passed the island, they
-covered themselves with something that made them
-appear of a light colour. Their habitations were
-under some clumps of palm-nut trees, which at a
-distance appeared like high ground; and to us, who
-for a long time had seen nothing but water and sky,
-except the dreary hills of Terra del Fuego, these
-groves seemed a terrestrial paradise. To this spot,
-which lies in latitude 18° 47ʺ S., and longitude 139°
-28ʹ W. we gave the name of <span class='sc'>Lagoon Island</span>. The
-variation of the needle here is 2° 54ʹ E.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About one o’clock we made sail to the westward,
-and about half an hour after three we saw land again
-to the N. W. We got up with it at sunset, and it
-proved to be a low woody island, of a circular form,
-and not much above a mile in compass. We discovered
-no inhabitants, nor could we distinguish any
-cocoa-nut trees, though we were within half a mile
-of the shore. The land, however, was covered with
-verdure of many hues. It lies in latitude 18° 35ʹ S.,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_78'>78</span>and longitude 139° 48ʹ W., and is distant from Lagoon
-Island, in the direction of N. 62 W., about seven
-leagues. We called it <span class='sc'>Thrumb-Cap</span>. I discovered by
-the appearance of the shore, that at this place it
-was low water; and I had observed at Lagoon Island,
-that it was either high water, or that the sea neither
-ebbed nor flowed. I infer, therefore, that a S. by
-E. or S. moon makes high water.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We went on with a fine trade-wind and pleasant
-weather, and on the 5th, about three in the afternoon,
-we discovered land to the westward. It proved to
-be a low island of much greater extent than either
-of those that we had seen before, being about ten or
-twelve leagues in compass. Several of us remained at
-the mast-head the whole evening, admiring its extraordinary
-figure: it was shaped exactly like a bow,
-the arch and cord of which were land, and the space
-between them water: the cord was a flat beach,
-without any signs of vegetation, having nothing
-upon it but heaps of sea-weed, which lay in different
-ridges, as higher or lower tides had left them. It
-appeared to be about three or four leagues long, and
-not more than two hundred yards wide; but as a
-horizontal plane is always seen in perspective, and
-greatly foreshortened, it is certainly much wider
-than it appeared: the horns, or extremities of the
-bow, were two large tufts of cocoa-nut trees; and
-much the greater part of the arch was covered with
-trees of different height, figure, and hue; in some
-parts, however, it was naked and low, like the
-cord. Some of us thought they discovered openings
-through the cord, into the pool or lake, that was
-included between that and the bow; but whether
-there were or were not such openings is uncertain.
-We sailed abreast of the low beach or bow-string,
-within less than a league of the shore, till sunset,
-and we then judged ourselves to be about half-way
-between the two horns. Here we brought to, and
-sounded, but found no bottom with one hundred and
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_79'>79</span>thirty fathom; and, as it is dark almost instantly
-after sunset in these latitudes, we suddenly lost sight
-of the land, and making sail again, before the line
-was well hauled in, we steered by the sound of the
-breakers, which were distinctly heard till we got clear
-of the coast.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We knew this island to be inhabited, by smoke
-which we saw in different parts of it, and we gave it
-the name of <span class='sc'>Bow Island</span>. Mr. Gore, my second
-lieutenant, said, after we had sailed by the island, that
-he had seen several of the natives, under the first
-clump of trees, from the deck; that he had distinguished
-their houses, and seen several canoes hauled
-up under the shade; but in this he was more fortunate
-than any other person on board. The east end of
-this island, which, from its figure, we called the Bow,
-lies in latitude 18° 23ʹ S., and longitude 141° 12ʹ W.;
-we observed the variation of the compass to be 5°
-38ʹ E.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the next day, Thursday the 6th, about noon,
-we saw land again to the westward, and came up with
-it about three. It appeared to be two islands, or
-rather groups of islands, extending from N. W. by
-N. to S. E. by S. about nine leagues. Of these, the
-two largest were separated from each other by a
-channel of about half a mile broad, and were severally
-surrounded by smaller islands, to which they
-were joined by reefs that lay under water.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>These islands were long narrow strips of land,
-ranging in all directions, some of them ten miles or
-upwards in length, but none more than a quarter of
-a mile broad, and upon all of them there were trees
-of various kinds, particularly the cocoa-nut. The
-south-eastermost of them lies in the latitude of 18°
-12ʹ S. and longitude 142° 42ʹ W., and at the distance
-of twenty-five leagues in the direction of W. ½ N.
-from the west end of Bow Island. We ranged along
-the S. W. side of this island, and hauled into a bay
-which lies to the N. W. of the southermost point of
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_80'>80</span>the Group, where there was a smooth sea, and the
-appearance of anchorage, without much surf on the
-shore. We sounded, but we found no bottom with
-one hundred fathom, at the distance of no more than
-three quarters of a mile from the beach; and I did
-not think it prudent to go nearer.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>While this was doing, several of the inhabitants
-assembled upon the shore, and some came out in
-their canoes as far as the reefs, but would not pass
-them. When we saw this, we ranged, with an easy
-sail, along the shore; but just as we were passing
-the end of the island, six men, who had for some
-time kept abreast of the ship, suddenly launched two
-canoes with great quickness and dexterity, and three
-of them getting into each, they put off, as we imagined,
-with a design to come on board us; the ship
-was therefore brought to, but they, like their fellows,
-stopped at the reef. We did not, however, immediately
-make sail, as we observed two messengers dispatched
-to them from the other canoes, which were of a much
-larger size. We perceived that these messengers made
-great expedition, wading and swimming along the
-reef; at length they met, and the men on board the
-canoes making no dispositions to pass the reef, after
-having received the message, we judged that they had
-resolved to come no farther. After waiting, therefore,
-some little time longer, we stood off; but when we
-were got about two or three miles from the shore, we
-perceived some of the natives following us in a canoe
-with a sail. We did not, however, think it worth
-while to wait for her, and though she had passed the
-reef, she soon after gave over the chace.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>According to the best judgment that we could
-form of the people when we were nearest the shore,
-they were about our size, and well-made. They were
-of a brown-complexion, and appeared to be naked;
-their hair, which was black, was confined by a fillet
-that went round the head, and stuck out behind like
-a bush. The greater part of them carried in their
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_81'>81</span>hands two weapons; one of them was a slender pole,
-from ten to fourteen feet long, on one end of which
-was a small knob, not unlike the point of a spear;
-the other was about four feet long, and shaped like a
-paddle, and possibly might be so, for some of their
-canoes were very small: those which we saw them
-launch seemed not intended to carry more than the
-three men that got into them: we saw others that
-had on board six or seven men, and one of them
-hoisted a sail which did not seem to reach more than
-six feet above the gun-wale of the boat, and which,
-upon the falling of a slight shower, was taken down
-and converted into an awning or tilt. The canoe
-which followed us to sea hoisted a sail not unlike an
-English lug-sail, and almost as lofty as an English
-boat of the same size would have carried.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The people, who kept abreast of the ship on the
-beach, made many signals; but whether they were
-intended to frighten us away, or invite us on shore,
-it is not easy to determine: we returned them by
-waving our hats and shouting, and they replied by
-shouting again. We did not put their disposition to
-the test, by attempting to land; because, as the island
-was inconsiderable, and as we wanted nothing that it
-could afford, we thought it imprudent as well as cruel
-to risk a contest, in which the natives must have suffered
-by our superiority, merely to gratify an idle
-curiosity; especially as we expected soon to fall in
-with the island where we had been directed to make
-our astronomical observation, the inhabitants of which
-would probably admit us without opposition, as they
-were already acquainted with our strength, and might
-also procure us a ready and peaceable reception among
-the neighbouring people, if we should desire it.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>To these islands we gave the name of <span class='sc'>The
-Groups</span>.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 7th, about half an hour after six in the
-morning, being just at day-break, we discovered another
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_82'>82</span>island to the northward, which we judged to
-be about four miles in circumference. The land lay
-very low, and there was a piece of water in the
-middle of it; there seemed to be some wood upon
-it, and it looked green and pleasant; but we saw
-neither cocoa-trees nor inhabitants: it abounded, however,
-with birds, and we therefore gave it the name
-of <span class='sc'>Bird Island</span>.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It lies in latitude 17° 48ʹ S. and longitude 143° 35ʹ W.
-at the distance of ten leagues, in the direction W. ½ N.
-from the west end of the Groups. The variation
-here was 6° 32ʹ E.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 8th, about two o’clock in the afternoon, we
-saw land to the northward, and about sunset came
-abreast of it, at about the distance of two leagues.
-It appeared to be a double range of low woody islands
-joined together by reefs, so as to form one island, in
-the form of an ellipsis or oval, with a lake in the
-middle of it. The small islands and reefs that circumscribe
-the lake have the appearance of a chain,
-and we therefore gave it the name of <span class='sc'>Chain Island</span>.
-Its length seemed to be about five leagues, in the
-direction of N. W. and S. E., and its breadth about five
-miles. The trees upon it appeared to be large, and
-we saw smoke rising in different parts of it from
-among them, a certain sign that it was inhabited.
-The middle of it lies in latitude 17° 23ʹ S. and longitude
-145° 54ʹ W., and is distant from Bird Island
-forty-five leagues, in the direction of W. by N. The
-variation here was, by several azimuths, found to be
-4° 54ʹ E.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 10th, having had a tempestuous night
-with thunder and rain, the weather was hazy till
-about nine o’clock in the morning, when it cleared
-up, and we saw the island to which Captain Wallis,
-who first discovered it, gave the name of Osnaburgh
-Island, called by the natives <i>Maitea</i>, bearing N. W.
-by W. distant about five leagues. It is a high round
-island, not above a league in circuit; in some parts
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_83'>83</span>it is covered with trees, and in others a naked rock.
-In this direction it looked like a high-crowned hat;
-but when it bears north, the top of it has more the
-appearance of the roof of a house. We made its
-latitude to be 17° 48ʹ S. its longitude 148° 10ʹ W.,
-and its distance from Chain Island forty-four leagues,
-in the direction of W. by S.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_84'>84</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. VIII.<br /> <br />THE ARRIVAL OF THE ENDEAVOUR AT OTAHEITE, CALLED BY CAPTAIN WALLIS KING GEORGE THE THIRD’S ISLAND.—RULES ESTABLISHED FOR TRAFFIC WITH THE NATIVES, AND AN ACCOUNT OF SEVERAL INCIDENTS WHICH HAPPENED IN A VISIT TO TOOTAHAH AND TOUBOURAI TAMAIDA, TWO CHIEFS.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>About</span> one o’clock, on Monday the 10th of April,
-some of the people who were looking out for the
-island to which we were bound, said they saw land
-a-head, in that part of the horizon where it was expected
-to appear; but it was so faint that whether
-there was land in sight or not, remained a matter of
-dispute till sunset. The next morning, however, at
-six o’clock, we were convinced that those who said
-they had discovered land were not mistaken; it appeared
-to be very high and mountainous, extending
-from W. by S. ½ S. to W. by N. ½ N., and we knew it
-to be the same that Captain Wallis had called King
-George the Third’s Island. We were delayed in our
-approach to it by light airs and calms, so that in the
-morning of the 12th we were but little nearer than
-we had been the night before; but about seven a
-breeze sprung up, and before eleven several canoes
-were seen making towards the ship: there were but
-few of them, however, that would come near; and
-the people in those that did could not be persuaded
-to come on board. In every canoe there were young
-plantains, and branches of a tree which the Indians
-call <i>E’ Midho</i>: these, as we afterwards learnt, were
-brought as tokens of peace and amity; and the people
-in one of the canoes handed them up the ship’s side,
-making signals at the same time with great earnestness,
-which we did not immediately understand; at
-length we guessed that they wished these symbols
-should be placed in some conspicuous part of the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_85'>85</span>ship; we, therefore, immediately stuck them among
-the rigging, at which they expressed the greatest
-satisfaction. We then purchased their cargoes, consisting
-of cocoa-nuts, and various kinds of fruit,
-which, after our long voyage, were very acceptable.</p>
-
-<div id='il1_02' class='figcenter id002'>
-<img src='images/il1_02.jpg' alt='' class='ig001' />
-<div class='ic001'>
-<p><i>The Island of <a id='ota'></a>Otaheite.</i></p>
-</div>
-</div>
-
-<p class='c000'>We stood on with an easy sail all night, with
-soundings from twenty-two fathom to twelve, and
-about seven o’clock in the morning we came to an
-anchor in thirteen fathom, in Port-royal Bay, called
-by the natives <i>Matavai</i>. We were immediately surrounded
-by the natives in their canoes, who gave us
-cocoa-nuts, fruit resembling apples, bread-fruit, and
-some small fishes, in exchange for beads and other
-trifles. They had with them a pig, which they
-would not part with for any thing but a hatchet, and
-therefore we refused to purchase it; because if we
-gave them a hatchet for a pig now, we knew they
-would never afterwards sell one for less, and we
-could not afford to buy as many as it was probable
-we should want at that price. The bread-fruit
-grows on a tree that is about the size of a middling
-oak: its leaves are frequently a foot and a half
-long, of an oblong shape, deeply sinuated like those
-of the fig-tree, which they resemble in consistence
-and colour, and in the exuding of a white milky
-juice upon being broken. The fruit is about the
-size and shape of a child’s head, and the surface is
-reticulated, not much unlike a truffle: it is covered
-with a thin skin, and has a core about as big as the
-handle of a small knife: the eatable part lies between
-the skin and the core: it is as white as snow,
-and somewhat of the consistence of new bread: it
-must be roasted before it is eaten, being first divided
-into three or four parts: its taste is insipid, with a
-slight sweetness, somewhat resembling that of the
-crumb of wheaten-bread mixed with a Jerusalem
-artichoke.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Among others who came off to the ship was an
-elderly man, whose name, as we learnt afterwards,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_86'>86</span>was <span class='sc'>Owhaw</span> and who was immediately known to
-Mr. Gore, and several others who had been here
-with Captain Wallis. As I was informed that he had
-been very useful to them, I took him on board the
-ship with some others, and was particularly attentive
-to gratify him, as I hoped he might also be useful
-to us.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As our stay here was not likely to be very short,
-and as it was necessary that the merchandize which
-we had brought for traffic with the natives should
-not diminish in its value, which it would certainly
-have done if every person had been left at liberty to
-give what he pleased for such things as he should
-purchase; at the same time, that confusion and
-quarrels must necessarily have arisen from there
-being no standard at market, I drew up the following
-rules, and ordered that they should be punctually
-observed:—</p>
-
-<p class='c016'><i>Rules to be observed by every Person in or belonging
-to His Majesty’s Bark the Endeavour, for the
-better establishing a regular and uniform Trade for
-Provision, &amp;c. with the Inhabitants of George’s
-Island.</i></p>
-
-<p class='c000'>“I. To endeavour, by every fair means, to cultivate
-a friendship with the natives; and to treat
-them with all imaginable humanity.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>“II. A proper person or persons will be appointed
-to trade with the natives for all manner
-of provisions, fruit, and other productions of the
-earth; and no officer or seaman, or other person
-belonging to the ship, excepting such as are so
-appointed, shall trade or offer to trade for any
-sort of provision, fruit, or other productions of the
-earth, unless they have leave so to do.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>“III. Every person employed on shore, on any
-duty whatsoever, is strictly to attend to the same;
-and if by any neglect he loseth any of his arms, or
-working tools, or suffers them to be stolen, the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_87'>87</span>full value thereof will be charged against his pay,
-according to the custom of the navy in such cases;
-and he shall receive such farther punishment as
-the nature of the offence may deserve.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>“IV. The same penalty will be inflicted on every
-person who is found to embezzle, trade, or offer
-to trade, with any part of the ship’s stores of what
-nature soever.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>“V. No sort of iron, or any thing that is made
-of iron, or any sort of cloth, or other useful or
-necessary articles, are to be given in exchange for
-any thing but provision.</p>
-
-<div class='c017'>“<span class='sc'>J. Cook.</span>”</div>
-
-<p class='c000'>As soon as the ship was properly secured, I went
-on shore with Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, a party
-of men under arms, and our friend Owhaw. We
-were received from the boat by some hundreds of
-the inhabitants, whose looks at least gave us welcome,
-though they were struck with such awe, that the
-first who approached us crouched so low that he
-almost crept upon his hands and knees. It is remarkable
-that he, like the people in the canoes,
-presented to us the same symbol of peace that is
-known to have been in use among the ancient and
-mighty nations of the northern hemisphere, the
-green branch of a tree. We received it with looks
-and gestures of kindness and satisfaction; and observing
-that each of them held one in his hand, we
-immediately gathered every one a bough, and carried
-it in our hands in the same manner.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>They marched with us about half a mile towards
-the place where the Dolphin had watered, conducted
-by Owhaw; they then made a full stop, and having
-laid the ground bare, by clearing away all the plants
-that grew upon it, the principal persons among them
-threw their green branches upon the naked spot, and
-made signs that we should do the same; we immediately
-showed our readiness to comply, and to give
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_88'>88</span>a greater solemnity to the rite, the marines were
-drawn up, and marching in order, each dropped
-his bough upon those of the Indians, and we followed
-their example. We then proceeded, and when
-we came to the watering-place it was intimated to us
-by signs, that we might occupy that ground, but it
-happened not to be fit for our purpose. During our
-walk, they had shaken off their first timid sense of
-our superiority, and were become familiar: they went
-with us from the watering-place and took a circuit
-through the woods; as we went along, we distributed
-beads and other small presents among them, and had
-the satisfaction to see that they were much gratified.
-Our circuit was not less than four or five miles,
-through groves of trees, which were loaded with
-cocoa-nuts and bread-fruit, and afforded the most
-grateful shade. Under these trees were the habitations
-of the people, most of them being only a roof
-without walls, and the whole scene realised the
-poetical fables of Arcadia. We remarked, however,
-not without some regret, that in all our walk we had
-seen only two hogs, and not a single fowl. Those
-of our company who had been here with the Dolphin
-told us, that none of the people whom we had yet
-seen were of the first class: they suspected that the
-chiefs had removed; and upon carrying us to the
-place where what they called the Queen’s palace had
-stood, we found that no traces of it were left. We
-determined therefore to return in the morning, and
-endeavour to find out the <i><span lang="fr" xml:lang="fr">noblesse</span></i> in their retreats.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the morning, however, before we could leave
-the ship, several canoes came about us, most of them
-from the westward, and two of them were filled
-with people, who, by their dress and deportment,
-appeared to be of a superior rank: two of these
-came on board, and each singled out his friend; one
-of them, whose name we found to be <span class='sc'>Matahah</span>,
-fixed upon Mr. Banks, and the other upon me: this
-ceremony consisted in taking off great part of their
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_89'>89</span>clothes and putting them upon us. In return for
-this, we presented each of them with a hatchet and
-some beads. Soon after they made signs for us to go
-with them to the places where they lived, pointing to
-the S. W.; and as I was desirous of finding a more
-commodious harbour, and making farther trial of the
-disposition of the people, I consented.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>I ordered out two boats, and with Mr. Banks and
-Dr. Solander, the other gentlemen, and our two
-Indian friends, we embarked for our expedition.
-After rowing about a league, they made signs that
-we should go on shore, and gave us to understand
-that this was the place of their residence. We accordingly
-landed, among several hundreds of the
-natives, who conducted us into a house of much
-greater length than any we had seen. When we
-entered, we saw a middle-aged man, whose name
-was afterwards discovered to be <span class='sc'>Tootahah</span>: mats
-were immediately spread, and we were desired to sit
-down over against him. Soon after we were seated,
-he ordered a cock and hen to be brought out, which
-he presented to Mr. Banks and me: we accepted the
-present; and in a short time each of us received a
-piece of cloth, perfumed after their manner, by no
-means disagreeably, which they took great pains to
-make us remark. The piece presented to Mr. Banks
-was eleven yards long and two wide; in return for
-which, he gave a laced silk neckcloth, which he happened
-to have on, and a linen pocket handkerchief:
-Tootahah immediately dressed himself in this new
-finery, with an air of perfect complacency and satisfaction.
-But it is now time that I should take some
-notice of the ladies.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Soon after the interchanging of our presents with
-Tootahah, they attended us to several large houses,
-in which we walked about with great freedom: they
-showed us all the civility of which, in our situation,
-we could accept; and, on their part, seemed to
-have no scruple that would have prevented its being
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_90'>90</span>carried farther. The houses, which, as I have
-observed before, are all open, except a roof, afforded
-no place of retirement; but the ladies, by frequently
-pointing to the mats upon the ground,
-and sometimes seating themselves and drawing us
-down upon them, left us no room to doubt of their
-being much less jealous of observation than we
-were.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We now took leave of our friendly chief, and
-directed our course along the shore. When we had
-walked about a mile, we met, at the head of a great
-number of people, another chief, whose name was
-<span class='sc'>Toubourai Tamaide</span>, with whom we were also to
-ratify a treaty of peace, with the ceremony of which
-we were now become better acquainted. Having
-received the branch which he presented to us, and
-given another in return, we laid our hands upon our
-left breasts, and pronounced the word <i>Taio</i>, which
-we supposed to signify friend; the chief then
-gave us to understand, that if we chose to eat, he
-had victuals ready for us. We accepted his offer,
-and dined very heartily upon fish, bread-fruit, cocoa-nuts,
-and plantains, dressed after their manner: they
-eat some of their fish raw; and raw fish was offered
-to us, but we declined that part of the entertainment.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>During this visit a wife of our noble host, whose
-name was <span class='sc'>Tomio</span>, did Mr. Banks the honour to place
-herself upon the same mat, close by him. Tomio
-was not in the first bloom of her youth, nor did she
-appear to have been ever remarkable for her beauty;
-he did not, therefore, I believe, pay her the most
-flattering attention: it happened, too, as a farther
-mortification to this lady, that seeing a very pretty
-girl among the crowd, he, not adverting to the
-dignity of his companion, beckoned her to come to
-him: the girl, after some entreaty, complied, and
-sat down on the other side of him: he loaded her
-with beads, and every showy trifle that would please
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_91'>91</span>her: his princess, though she was somewhat mortified
-at the preference that was given to her rival, did
-not discontinue her civilities, but still assiduously
-supplied him with the milk of the cocoa-nut, and
-such other dainties as were in her reach. This scene
-might possibly have become more curious and interesting,
-if it had not been suddenly interrupted by
-an interlude of a more serious kind. Just at this
-time, Dr. Solander and Mr. Monkhouse complained
-that their pockets had been picked. Dr. Solander
-had lost an opera-glass in a shagreen case, and
-Mr. Monkhouse his snuff-box. This incident unfortunately
-put an end to the good humour of the
-company. Complaint of the injury was made to
-the chief; and, to give it weight, Mr. Banks
-started up, and hastily struck the but-end of his
-firelock upon the ground: this action, and the noise
-that accompanied it, struck the whole assembly with
-a panic; and every one of the natives ran out of the
-house with the utmost precipitation, except the chief,
-three women, and two or three others, who appeared
-by their dress to be of a superior rank.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The chief, with a mixture of confusion and concern,
-took Mr. Banks by the hand, and led him to a large
-quantity of cloth, which lay at the other end of the
-house: this he offered to him piece by piece, intimating
-by signs, that if that would atone for the wrong
-which had been done, he might take any part of
-it, or, if he pleased, the whole. Mr. Banks put
-it by, and gave him to understand, that he wanted
-nothing but what had been dishonestly taken away.
-Toubourai Tamaide then went hastily out, leaving
-Mr. Banks with his wife Tomio, who, during the
-whole scene of terror and confusion, had kept
-constantly at his side, and intimating his desire
-that he should wait there till his return. Mr. Banks
-accordingly sat down, and conversed with her, as
-well as he could by signs, about half an hour.
-The chief then came back with the snuff-box and
-the case of the opera-glass in his hand, and, with
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_92'>92</span>a joy in his countenance that was painted with a
-strength of expression which distinguishes these
-people from all others, delivered them to the owners.
-The case of the opera-glass, however, upon being
-opened, was found to be empty; upon this discovery,
-his countenance changed in a moment;
-and catching Mr. Banks again by the hand, he
-rushed out of the house, without uttering any sound,
-and led him along the shore, walking with great
-rapidity: when they had got about a mile from the
-house, a woman met him and gave him a piece of
-cloth, which he hastily took from her, and continued
-to press forward with it in his hand. Dr. Solander
-and Mr. Monkhouse had followed them, and they
-came at length to a house where they were received
-by a woman, to whom he gave the cloth, and intimated
-to the gentlemen that they should give her
-some beads. They immediately complied; and the
-beads and cloth being deposited upon the floor, the
-woman went out, and in about half an hour returned
-with the opera-glass, expressing the same
-joy upon the occasion that had before been expressed
-by the chief. The beads were now returned,
-with an inflexible resolution not to accept
-them; and the cloth was, with the same pertinacity,
-forced upon Dr. Solander, as a recompence for the
-injury that had been done him. He could not
-avoid accepting the cloth, but insisted in his turn
-upon giving a new present of beads to the woman.
-It will not, perhaps, be easy to account for all
-the steps that were taken in the recovery of this
-glass and snuff-box; but this cannot be thought
-strange, considering that the scene of action was
-among a people whose language, policy, and connections,
-are even now but imperfectly known;
-upon the whole, however, they show an intelligence
-and influence which would do honour to any system
-of government, however regular and improved. In
-the evening, about six o’clock, we returned to the
-ship.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_93'>93</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. IX.<br /> <br />A PLACE FIXED UPON FOR AN OBSERVATORY AND FORT: AN EXCURSION INTO THE WOODS, AND ITS CONSEQUENCES.—THE FORT ERECTED: A VISIT FROM SEVERAL CHIEFS ON BOARD AND AT THE FORT, WITH SOME ACCOUNT OF THE MUSIC OF THE NATIVES, AND THE MANNER IN WHICH THEY DISPOSE OF THEIR DEAD.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>On</span> the next morning, Saturday the 15th, several of
-the chiefs whom we had seen the day before came
-on board, and brought with them hogs, bread-fruit,
-and other refreshments, for which we gave them
-hatchets and linen, and such things as seemed to be
-most acceptable.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As in my excursion to the westward, I had not
-found any more convenient harbour than that in
-which we lay, I determined to go on shore and fix
-upon some spot, commanded by the ship’s guns,
-where I might throw up a small fort for our defence,
-and prepare for making our astronomical observation.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>I therefore took a party of men, and landed without
-delay, accompanied by Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander,
-and the astronomer, Mr. Green. We soon fixed
-upon a part of the sandy beach, on the N. E. point
-of the bay, which was in every respect convenient
-for our purpose, and not near any habitation of the
-natives. Having marked out the ground that we intended
-to occupy, a small tent belonging to Mr. Banks
-was set up, which had been brought on shore for that
-purpose: by this time a great number of the people
-had gathered about us; but, as it appeared, only to
-look on, there not being a single weapon of any kind
-among them. I intimated, however, that none of
-them were to come within the line I had drawn, except
-one who appeared to be a chief, and Owhaw.
-To these two persons I addressed myself by signs,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_94'>94</span>and endeavoured to make them understand, that we
-wanted the ground which we had marked out to
-sleep upon for a certain number of nights, and that
-then we should go away. Whether I was understood
-I cannot certainly determine; but the people behaved
-with a deference and respect that at once
-pleased and surprised us: they sat down peaceably
-without the circle, and looked on, without giving us
-any interruption till we had done, which was upwards
-of two hours. As we had seen no poultry, and but
-two hogs, in our walk when we were last on shore at
-this place, we suspected that, upon our arrival, they
-had been driven farther up the country; and the
-rather, as Owhaw was very importunate with us, by
-signs, not to go into the woods, which, however,
-and partly for these reasons, we were determined to
-do. Having therefore appointed the thirteen marines
-and a petty officer to guard the tent, we set out,
-and a great number of the natives joined our party.
-As we were crossing a little river that lay in our way
-we saw some ducks, and Mr. Banks, as soon as he
-had got over, fired at them, and happened to kill
-three at one shot: this struck them with the utmost
-terror, so that most of them fell suddenly to the
-ground, as if they also had been shot at the same
-discharge: it was not long, however, before they
-recovered from their fright, and we continued our
-route; but we had not gone far before we were
-alarmed by the report of two pieces, which were
-fired by the guard at the tent. We had then straggled
-a little distance from each other, but Owhaw immediately
-called us together, and by waving his hand
-sent away every Indian who followed us except three
-each of whom, as a pledge of peace on their part,
-and an entreaty that there might be peace on ours,
-hastily broke a branch from the trees, and came to
-us with it in their hands. As we had too much
-reason to fear that some mischief had happened, we
-hasted back to the tent, which was not distant above
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_95'>95</span>half a mile, and when we came up, we found it
-entirely deserted, except by our own people.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It appeared that one of the Indians who remained
-about the tent after we left it had watched his opportunity,
-and, taking the sentry unawares, had
-snatched away his musket. Upon this, the petty
-officer, a midshipman, who commanded the party,
-perhaps from a sudden fear of farther violence,
-perhaps from the natural petulance of power newly
-acquired, and perhaps from a brutality in his
-nature, ordered the marines to fire: the men, with
-as little consideration or humanity as the officer, immediately
-discharged their pieces among the thickest
-of the flying crowd, consisting of more than a hundred;
-and observing that the thief did not fall,
-pursued him, and shot him dead. We afterwards
-learnt that none of the others were either killed or
-wounded.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Owhaw, who had never left us, observing that we
-were now totally deserted, got together a few of those
-who had fled, though not without some difficulty,
-and ranged them about us: we endeavoured to justify
-our people as well as we could, and to convince the
-Indians that if they did no wrong to us, we should
-do no wrong to them: they went away without any
-appearance of distrust or resentment; and having
-struck our tent, we returned to the ship, but by no
-means satisfied with the transactions of the day.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Upon questioning our people more particularly,
-whose conduct they soon perceived we could not
-approve, they alleged that the sentinel whose musket
-was taken away was violently assaulted and thrown
-down, and that a push was afterwards made at him
-by the man who took the musket, before any command
-was given to fire. It was also suggested,
-that Owhaw had suspicions, at least, if not certain
-knowledge, that something would be attempted
-against our people at the tent, which made him so
-very earnest in his endeavours to prevent our leaving
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_96'>96</span>it; others imputed his importunity to his desire that
-we should confine ourselves to the beach; and it was
-remarked that neither Owhaw nor the chiefs who
-remained with us after he had sent the rest of the
-people away would have inferred the breach of peace
-from the firing at the tent, if they had had no reason
-to suspect that some injury had been offered by their
-countrymen; especially as Mr. Banks had just fired
-at the ducks: and yet that they did infer a breach of
-peace from that incident was manifest from their
-waving their hands for the people to disperse, and
-instantly pulling green branches from the trees. But
-what were the real circumstances of this unhappy
-affair, and whether either and which of these conjectures
-were true, can never certainly be known.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The next morning but few of the natives were
-seen upon the beach, and not one of them came off
-to the ship. This convinced us that our endeavours
-to quiet their apprehensions had not been effectual;
-and we remarked with particular regret, that we were
-deserted even by Owhaw, who had hitherto been so
-constant in his attachment, and so active in renewing
-the peace that had been broken.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Appearances being thus unfavourable, I warped
-the ship nearer to the shore, and moored her in such
-a manner as to command all the N. E. part of the
-bay, particularly the place which I had marked out
-for the building a fort. In the evening, however, I
-went on shore with only a boat’s crew, and some of
-the gentlemen: the natives gathered about us, but
-not in the same number as before: there were, I
-believe, between thirty and forty, and they trafficked
-with us for cocoa-nuts and other fruit, to all appearance
-as friendly as ever.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 17th, early in the morning, we had the
-misfortune to lose Mr. Buchan, the person whom
-Mr. Banks had brought out as a painter of landscapes
-and figures. He was a sober, diligent, and ingenious
-young man, and greatly regretted by Mr. Banks;
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_97'>97</span>who hoped, by his means, to have gratified his friends
-in England with representations of this country and
-its inhabitants, which no other person on board could
-delineate with the same accuracy and elegance. He
-had always been subject to epileptic fits, one of which
-seized him on the mountains of Terra del Fuego, and
-this disorder being aggravated by a bilious complaint
-which he contracted on board the ship, at length put
-an end to his life. It was at first proposed to bury
-him on shore, but Mr. Banks thinking that it might
-perhaps give offence to the natives, with whose customs
-we were then wholly unacquainted, we committed
-his body to the sea, with as much decency and
-solemnity as our circumstances and situation would
-admit.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the forenoon of this day we received a visit from
-Tubourai Tamaide and Tootahah, our chiefs, from
-the west: they brought with them, as emblems of
-peace, not branches of plantain, but two young trees,
-and would not venture on board till these had been
-received, having probably been alarmed by the mischief
-which had been done at the tent. Each of
-them also brought, as propitiatory gifts, some bread-fruit,
-and a hog ready dressed: this was a most acceptable
-present, as we perceived that hogs were not
-always to be got; and in return we gave to each of
-our noble benefactors a hatchet and a nail. In the
-evening we went on shore and set up a tent, in which
-Mr. Green and myself spent the night, in order to
-observe an eclipse of the first satellite of Jupiter; but
-the weather becoming cloudy, we were disappointed.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 18th, at day-break, I went on shore, with
-as many people as could possibly be spared from the
-ship, and began to erect our fort. While some were
-employed in throwing up intrenchments, others were
-busy in cutting pickets and fascines, which the natives,
-who soon gathered round us as they had been
-used to do, were so far from hindering, that many of
-them voluntarily assisted us, bringing the pickets and
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_98'>98</span>fascines from the wood where they had been cut, with
-great alacrity: we had, indeed, been so scrupulous
-of invading their property, that we purchased every
-stake which was used upon this occasion, and cut
-down no tree till we had first obtained their consent.
-The soil where we constructed our fort was sandy,
-and this made it necessary to strengthen the intrenchments
-with wood; three sides were to be fortified in
-this manner; the fourth was bounded by a river, upon
-the banks of which I proposed to place a proper
-number of water-casks. This day we served pork to
-the ship’s company for the first time, and the Indians
-brought down so much bread-fruit and cocoa-nuts,
-that we found it necessary to send away part of them
-unbought, and to acquaint them by signs, that we
-should want no more for two days to come. Every
-thing was purchased this day with beads: a single
-bead, as big as a pea, being the purchase of five or
-six cocoa-nuts, and as many of the bread-fruit. Mr.
-Banks’s tent was got up before night within the
-works, and he slept on shore for the first time. Proper
-sentries were placed round it, but no Indian attempted
-to approach it the whole night.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The next morning, our friend Tubourai Tamaide
-made Mr. Banks a visit at the tent, and brought with
-him not only his wife and family, but the roof of a
-house, and several materials for setting it up, with
-furniture and implements of various kinds, intending,
-as we understood him, to take up his residence in our
-neighbourhood: this instance of his confidence and
-good-will gave us great pleasure, and we determined
-to strengthen his attachment to us by every means in
-our power. Soon after his arrival, he took Mr. Banks
-by the hand, and leading him out of the line, signified
-that he should accompany him into the woods.
-Mr. Banks readily consented, and having walked with
-him about a quarter of a mile, they arrived at a kind
-of awning which he had already set up, and which
-seemed to be his occasional habitation. Here he
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_99'>99</span>unfolded a bundle of his country cloth, and taking
-out two garments, one of red cloth, and the other of
-very neat matting, he clothed Mr. Banks in them,
-and without any other ceremony, immediately conducted
-him back to the tent. His attendants soon
-after brought him some pork and bread-fruit, which
-he ate, dipping his meat into salt water instead of
-sauce: after his meal he retired to Mr. Banks’s bed,
-and slept about an hour. In the afternoon, his wife
-Tomio brought to the tent a young man about two-and-twenty
-years of age, of a very comely appearance,
-whom they both seemed to acknowledge as
-their son, though we afterwards discovered that he
-was not so. In the evening, this young man and another
-chief, who had also paid us a visit, went away
-to the westward, but Tubourai Tamaide and his wife
-returned to the awning in the skirts of the wood.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Our surgeon, Mr. Monkhouse, having walked out
-this evening, reported, that he had seen the body of
-the man who had been shot at the tents, which he
-said was wrapped in cloth, and placed on a kind of
-bier, supported by stakes, under a roof that seemed
-to have been set up for the purpose: that near it were
-deposited some instruments of war and other things,
-which he would particularly have examined but for
-the stench of the body, which was intolerable. He
-said, that he saw also two more sheds of the same
-kind, in one of which were the bones of a human
-body that had lain till they were quite dry. We discovered
-afterwards, that this was the way in which
-they usually disposed of their dead.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>A kind of market now began to be kept just without
-the lines, and was plentifully supplied with every
-thing but pork. Tubourai Tamaide was our constant
-guest, imitating our manners, even to the using of a
-knife and fork, which he did very handily.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As my curiosity was excited by Mr. Monkhouse’s
-account of the situation of the man who had been
-shot, I took an opportunity to go with some others to
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_100'>100</span>see it. I found the shed under which his body lay,
-close by the house in which he resided when he was
-alive, some others being not more than ten yards distant;
-it was about 15 feet long, and 11 broad, and
-of a proportionable height: one end was wholly open,
-and the other end, and the two sides, were partly
-enclosed with a kind of wicker work. The bier on
-which the corpse was deposited, was a frame of wood
-like that in which the sea-beds, called cotts, are
-placed, with a matted bottom, and supported by four
-posts, at the height of about five feet from the ground.
-The body was covered first with a mat, and then with
-white cloth; by the side of it lay a wooden mace,
-one of their weapons of war, and near the head of it,
-which lay next to the close end of the shed, lay two
-cocoa-nut shells, such as are sometimes used to carry
-water in; at the other end a bunch of green leaves,
-with some dried twigs, all tied together, were stuck
-in the ground, by which lay a stone about as big as a
-cocoa-nut: near these lay one of the young plantain
-trees, which are used for emblems of peace, and close
-by it a stone axe. At the open end of the shed also
-hung, in several strings, a great number of palm-nuts,
-and without the shed was stuck upright in the
-ground the stem of a plantain tree about five feet
-high, upon the top of which was placed a cocoa-nut
-shell full of fresh water: against the side of one of
-the posts hung a small bag, containing a few pieces
-of bread-fruit ready roasted, which were not all put
-in at the same time, for some of them were fresh,
-and others stale. I took notice that several of the
-natives observed us with a mixture of solicitude and
-jealousy in their countenances, and by their gestures
-expressed uneasiness when we went near the body,
-standing themselves at a little distance while we were
-making our examination, and appearing to be pleased
-when we came away.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Our residence on shore would by no means have
-been disagreeable if we had not been incessantly tormented
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_101'>101</span>by the flies, which, among other mischief,
-made it almost impossible for Mr. Parkinson, Mr.
-Banks’s natural-history painter, to work; for they
-not only covered his subject so as that no part of its
-surface could be seen, but even ate the colour off
-the paper as fast as he could lay it on. We had recourse
-to musquito-nets and fly-traps, which, though
-they made the inconvenience tolerable, were very far
-from removing it.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 22d, Tootahah gave us a specimen of the
-music of this country: four persons performed upon
-flutes, which had only two stops, and therefore could
-not sound more than four notes, by half tones: they
-were sounded like our German flutes, except that
-the performer, instead of applying it to his mouth,
-blew into it with one nostril, while he stopped the
-other with his thumb: to these instruments four
-other persons sung, and kept very good time; but
-only one tune was played during the whole concert.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Several of the natives brought us axes, which they
-had received from on board the Dolphin, to grind
-and repair; but among others there was one which
-became the subject of much speculation, as it appeared
-to be French: after much enquiry, we learnt that
-a ship had been here between our arrival and the departure
-of the Dolphin, which we then conjectured
-to have been a Spaniard, but now know to have been
-the Boudeuse, commanded by M. Bougainville.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_102'>102</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. X.<br /> <br />AN EXCURSION TO THE EASTWARD, AN ACCOUNT OF SEVERAL INCIDENTS THAT HAPPENED BOTH ON BOARD AND ON SHORE, AND OF THE FIRST INTERVIEW WITH OBEREA, THE PERSON WHO, WHEN THE DOLPHIN WAS HERE, WAS SUPPOSED TO BE QUEEN OF THE ISLAND, WITH A DESCRIPTION OF THE FORT.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>On</span> the 24th, Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander examined
-the country for several miles along the shore to the
-eastward: for about two miles it was flat and fertile;
-after that, the hills stretched quite to the water’s
-edge, and a little farther ran out into the sea, so that
-they were obliged to climb over them. These hills,
-which were barren, continued for about three miles
-more, and then terminated in a large plain, which
-was full of good houses, and people who appeared
-to live in great affluence. In this place there was a
-river, much more considerable than that at our fort,
-which issued from a deep and beautiful valley, and,
-where our travellers crossed it, though at some
-distance from the sea, was near one hundred yards
-wide. About a mile beyond this river the country
-became again barren, the rocks every where projecting
-into the sea, for which reason they resolved
-to return. Just as they had formed this resolution,
-one of the natives offered them refreshment, which
-they accepted. They found this man to be of a kind
-that has been described by various authors, as mixed
-with many nations, but distinct from them all.
-His skin was of a dead white, without the least
-appearance of what is called complexion, though
-some parts of his body were in a small degree less
-white than others: his hair, eye-brows, and beard,
-were as white as his skin; his eyes appeared as if
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_103'>103</span>they were bloodshot, and he seemed to be very
-short-sighted.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At their return they were met by Tubourai Tamaide,
-and his women, who, at seeing them, felt
-a joy which, not being able to express, they burst
-into tears, and wept some time before their passion
-could be restrained.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This evening Dr. Solander lent his knife to one
-of these women, who neglected to return it, and the
-next morning Mr. Banks’s also was missing; upon
-this occasion I must bear my testimony, that the
-people of this country, of all ranks, men and women,
-are the errantest thieves upon the face of the earth.
-The very day after we arrived here, when they came
-on board us, the chiefs were employed in stealing
-what they could in the cabin, and their dependents
-were no less industrious in other parts of the ship:
-they snatched up every thing that it was possible for
-them to secrete till they got on shore, even to the
-glass ports, two of which they carried off undetected.
-Tubourai Tamaide was the only one except Tootahah
-who had not been found guilty; and the presumption,
-arising from this circumstance, that he was exempt
-from a vice, of which the whole nation besides were
-guilty, cannot be supposed to outweigh strong appearances
-to the contrary. Mr. Banks, therefore,
-though not without some reluctance, accused him of
-having stolen his knife: he solemnly and steadily
-denied that he knew any thing of it; upon which
-Mr. Banks made him understand, that whoever had
-taken it, he was determined to have it returned:
-upon this resolute declaration, one of the natives
-who was present produced a rag, in which three
-knives were very carefully tied up. One was that
-which Dr. Solander had lent to the woman, another
-was a table-knife belonging to me, and the owner of
-the third was not known. With these the chief immediately
-set out, in order to make restitution of them
-to their owners at the tents. Mr. Banks remained
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_104'>104</span>with the women, who expressed great apprehensions
-that some mischief was designed against their lord.
-When he came to the tents, he restored one of the
-knives to Dr. Solander, and another to me, the
-third not being owned, and then began to search
-for Mr. Banks’s in all the places where he had ever
-seen it. After some time, one of Mr. Banks’s servants,
-understanding what he was about, immediately
-fetched his master’s knife, which it seems he had
-laid by the day before, and till now knew nothing
-of its having been missed. Tubourai Tamaide, upon
-this demonstration of his innocence, expressed the
-strongest emotions of mind, both in his looks and
-gestures: the tears started from his eyes; and he
-made signs with the knife, that, if he was ever
-guilty of such an action as had been imputed to
-him, he would submit to have his throat cut. He
-then rushed out of the lines, and returned hastily
-to Mr. Banks, with a countenance that severely
-reproached him with his suspicions. Mr. Banks soon
-understood that the knife had been received from
-his servant, and was scarcely less affected at what
-had happened than the chief: he felt himself to be
-the guilty person, and was very desirous to atone for
-his fault. The poor Indian, however violent his
-passions, was a stranger to sullen resentment; and
-upon Mr. Banks’s spending a little time familiarly
-with him, and making him a few trifling presents,
-he forgot the wrongs that had been done him, and
-was perfectly reconciled.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Upon this occasion it may be observed, that these
-people have a knowledge of right and wrong from
-the mere dictates of natural conscience; and involuntarily
-condemn themselves when they do that to
-others which they would condemn others for doing
-to them. That Tubourai Tamaide felt the force
-of moral obligation is certain; for the imputation
-of an action which he considered as indifferent would
-not, when it appeared to be groundless, have moved
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_105'>105</span>him with such excess of passion. We must indeed
-estimate the virtue of these people by the only
-standard of morality, the conformity of their conduct
-to what in their opinion is right; but we must not
-hastily conclude that theft is a testimony of the
-same depravity in them that it is in us, in the
-instances in which our people were sufferers by their
-dishonesty; for their temptation was such as to
-surmount would be considered as a proof of uncommon
-integrity among those who have more knowledge,
-better principles, and stronger motives to
-resist the temptations of illicit advantage: an Indian
-among penny knives, and beads, or even nails and
-broken glass, is in the same state of trial with the
-meanest servant in Europe among unlocked coffers
-of jewels and gold.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 26th, I mounted six swivel guns upon the
-fort, which I was sorry to see struck the natives with
-dread: some fishermen who lived upon the point
-removed farther off, and Owhaw told us, by signs,
-that in four days we should fire great guns.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 27th, Tubourai Tamaide, with a friend,
-who ate with a voracity that I never saw before,
-and the three women that usually attended him,
-whose names were <span class='sc'>Terapo</span>, <span class='sc'>Tirao</span>, and <span class='sc'>Omie</span>, dined
-at the fort: in the evening they took their leave,
-and set out for the house which Tubourai Tamaide
-had set up in the skirts of the wood; but in less than
-a quarter of an hour he returned in great emotion,
-and hastily seizing Mr. Banks’s arm, made signs
-that he should follow him. Mr. Banks immediately
-complied, and they soon came up to a place where
-they found the ship’s butcher, with a reaping-hook in
-his hand: here the chief stopped, and, in a transport
-of rage which rendered his signs scarcely intelligible,
-intimated that the butcher had threatened, or attempted,
-to cut his wife’s throat with the reaping-hook.
-Mr. Banks then signified to him, that if he could fully
-explain the offence, the man should be punished.
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_106'>106</span>Upon this he became more calm, and made Mr.
-Banks understand that the offender, having taken a
-fancy to a stone-hatchet which lay in his house, had
-offered to purchase it of his wife for a nail: that she
-having refused to part with it upon any terms, he
-had catched it up, and throwing down the nail,
-threatened to cut her throat if she made any resistance:
-to prove this charge the hatchet and the nail
-were produced, and the butcher had so little to say
-in his defence, that there was not the least reason to
-doubt of its truth.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Mr. Banks having reported this matter to me, I
-took an opportunity, when the chief and his women,
-with other Indians, were on board the ship, to call
-up the butcher, and after a recapitulation of the
-charge and the proof, I gave orders that he should
-be punished, as well to prevent other offences of the
-same kind, as to acquit Mr. Banks of his promise:
-the Indians saw him stripped and tied up to the
-rigging with a fixed attention, waiting in silent
-suspense for the event; but as soon as the first stroke
-was given, they interfered with great agitation, earnestly
-intreating that the rest of the punishment
-might be remitted: to this, however, for many reasons,
-I could not consent, and when they found that
-they could not prevail by their intercession, they
-gave vent to their pity by tears.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their tears, indeed, like those of children, were
-always ready to express any passion that was strongly
-excited, and like those of children they also appeared
-to be forgotten as soon as shed; of which the following,
-among many others, is a remarkable instance.
-Very early in the morning of the 28th, even before
-it was day, a great number of them came down to
-the fort, and Terapo being observed among the
-women on the outside of the gate, Mr. Banks went
-out and brought her in; he saw that the tears then
-stood in her eyes, and as soon as she entered they
-began to flow in great abundance: he enquired
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_107'>107</span>earnestly the cause, but instead of answering she
-took from under her garment a shark’s tooth, and
-struck it six or seven times into her head with great
-force; a profusion of blood followed, and she talked
-loud, but in a most melancholy tone, for some minutes,
-without at all regarding his enquiries, which
-he repeated with still more impatience and concern,
-while the other Indians, to his great surprise, talked
-and laughed, without taking the least notice of her
-distress. But her own behaviour was still more extraordinary.
-As soon as the bleeding was over, she
-looked up with a smile, and began to collect some
-small pieces of cloth, which during her bleeding she
-had thrown down to catch the blood; as soon as she
-had picked them all up, she carried them out of the
-tent, and threw them into the sea, carefully dispersing
-them abroad, as if she wished to prevent the sight
-of them from reviving the remembrance of what she
-had done. She then plunged into the river, and after
-having washed her whole body returned to the tents
-with the same gaiety and cheerfulness as if nothing
-had happened.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It is not, indeed, strange, that the sorrows of these
-artless people should be transient, any more than that
-their passions should be suddenly and strongly expressed:
-what they feel they have never been taught
-either to disguise or suppress, and having no habits
-of thinking which perpetually recall the past, and
-anticipate the future, they are affected by all the
-changes of the passing hour, and reflect the colour
-of the time, however frequently it may vary: they
-have no project which is to be pursued from day to
-day, the subject of unremitted anxiety and solicitude,
-that first rushes into the mind when they awake in
-the morning, and is last dismissed when they sleep
-at the night. Yet if we admit that they are upon
-the whole happier than we, we must admit that the
-child is happier than the man, and that we are losers
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_108'>108</span>by the perfection of our nature, the increase of our
-knowledge, and the enlargement of our views.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Canoes were continually coming in during all this
-forenoon, and the tents at the fort were crowded
-with people of both sexes from different parts of the
-island. I was myself busy on board the ship, but
-Mr. Mollineux, our master, who was one of those
-that made the last voyage in the Dolphin, went on
-shore. As soon as he entered Mr. Banks’s tent he
-fixed his eyes upon one of the women, who was sitting
-there with great composure among the rest, and immediately
-declared her to be the person who at that
-time was supposed to be the queen of the island;
-she also, at the same time, acknowledging him to be
-one of the strangers whom she had seen before. The
-attention of all present was now diverted from every
-other object, and wholly engaged in considering a
-person who had made so distinguished a figure in
-the accounts that had been given of this island by its
-first discoverers; and we soon learnt that her name
-was <span class='sc'>Oberea</span>. She seemed to be about forty years
-of age, and was not only tall, but of a large make;
-her skin was white, and there was an uncommon intelligence
-and sensibility in her eyes: she appeared
-to have been handsome when she was young, but at
-this time little more than memorials of her beauty
-were left.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As soon as her quality was known, an offer was
-made to conduct her to the ship. Of this she readily
-accepted, and came on board with two men and
-several women, who seemed to be all of her family:
-I received her with such marks of distinction as I
-thought would gratify her most, and was not sparing
-of my presents, among which this august personage
-seemed particularly delighted with a child’s doll.
-After some time spent on board, I attended her back
-to the shore; and as soon as we landed, she presented
-me with a hog, and several bunches of plantains,
-which she caused to be carried from her canoes up
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_109'>109</span>to the fort in a kind of procession, of which she and
-myself brought up the rear. In our way to the fort
-we met Tootahah, who, though not king, appeared
-to be at this time invested with the sovereign authority;
-he seemed not to be well pleased with the distinction
-that was showed to the lady, and became so
-jealous when she produced her doll, that to propitiate
-him it was thought proper to compliment him with
-another. At this time he thought fit to prefer a doll
-to a hatchet; but this preference arose only from a
-childish jealousy, which could not be soothed but
-by a gift of exactly the same kind with that which
-had been presented to Oberea; for dolls in a very
-short time were universally considered as trifles of no
-value.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The men who had visited us from time to time had,
-without scruple, eaten of our provisions; but the
-women had never yet been prevailed upon to taste a
-morsel. To day, however, though they refused the
-most pressing solicitations to dine with the gentlemen,
-they afterwards retired to the servants’ apartment,
-and ate of plantains very heartily; a mystery
-of female economy here, which none of us could explain.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 29th, not very early in the forenoon, Mr.
-Banks went to pay his court to Oberea, and was told
-that she was still asleep under the awning of her
-canoe: thither therefore he went, intending to call
-her up, a liberty which he thought he might take,
-without any danger of giving offence: but, upon
-looking into her chamber, to his great astonishment
-he found her in bed with a handsome young fellow
-about five-and-twenty, whose name was <span class='sc'>Obadée</span>: he
-retreated with some haste and confusion, but was
-soon made to understand, that such amours gave no
-occasion to scandal, and that Obadée was universally
-known to have been selected by her as the object of
-her private favours. The lady being too polite to
-suffer Mr. Banks to wait long in her antichamber,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_110'>110</span>dressed herself with more than usual expedition; and,
-as a token of special grace, clothed him in a suit of
-fine cloth and proceeded with him to the tents. In
-the evening Mr. Banks paid a visit to Tubourai Tamaide,
-as he had often done before, by candle-light,
-and was equally grieved and surprised to find him
-and his family in a melancholy mood, and most of
-them in tears: he endeavoured in vain to discover
-the cause, and therefore his stay among them was
-but short. When he reported this circumstance to
-the officers at the fort, they recollected that Owhaw
-had foretold, that in four days we should fire our
-great guns; and as this was the eve of the third day,
-the situation in which Tubourai Tamaide and his family
-had been found alarmed them. The sentries
-therefore were doubled at the fort, and the gentlemen
-slept under arms. At two in the morning, Mr.
-Banks himself went round the point, but found every
-thing so quiet, that he gave up all suspicions of mischief
-intended by the natives as groundless. We
-had, however, another source of security,—our little
-fortification was now complete. The north and south
-sides consisted of a bank of earth four feet and a
-half high on the inside, and a ditch without ten feet
-broad and six deep: on the west side, facing the
-bay, there was a bank of earth four feet high, and
-palisadoes upon that, but no ditch, the works here
-being at high-water mark: on the east side, upon the
-bank of the river, was placed a double row of water-casks,
-filled with water; and as this was the weakest
-side, the two four pounders were planted there, and
-six swivel guns were mounted so as to command the
-only two avenues from the woods. Our garrison
-consisted of about five-and-forty men with small
-arms, including the officers and the gentlemen who
-resided on shore; and our sentries were as well relieved
-as in the best regulated frontier in Europe.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We continued our vigilance the next day, though
-we had no particular reason to think it necessary;
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_111'>111</span>but about ten o’clock in the morning, Tomio came
-running to the tents, with a mixture of grief and fear
-in her countenance, and taking Mr. Banks, to whom
-they applied in every emergency and distress, by the
-arm, intimated that Tubourai Tamaide was dying,
-in consequence of something which our people had
-given him to eat, and that he must instantly go with
-her to his house. Mr. Banks set out without delay,
-and found his Indian friend leaning his head against
-a post, in an attitude of the utmost languor and despondency:
-the people about him intimated that he
-had been vomiting, and brought out a leaf folded
-up with great care, which they said contained some
-of the poison, by the deleterious effects of which he
-was now dying. Mr. Banks hastily opened the leaf,
-and upon examining its contents found them to be
-no other than a chew of tobacco, which the chief
-had begged of some of our people, and which they
-had indiscreetly given him: he had observed that
-they kept it long in the mouth, and being desirous
-of doing the same, he had chewed it to powder, and
-swallowed the spittle. During the examination of
-the leaf and its contents, he looked up at Mr. Banks
-with the most piteous aspect, and intimated that he
-had but a very short time to live. Mr. Banks, however,
-being now master of his disease, directed him
-to drink plentifully of cocoa-nut milk, which in a
-short time put an end to his sickness and apprehensions;
-and he spent the day at the fort with that
-uncommon flow of cheerfulness and good humour
-which is always produced by a sudden and unexpected
-relief from pain either of body or mind.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Captain Wallis having brought home one of the
-adzes which these people, having no metal of any
-kind, make of stone, Mr. Stevens, the secretary to
-the Admiralty, procured one to be made of iron in
-imitation of it, which I brought out with me, to
-show how much we excelled in making tools after
-their own fashion: this I had not yet produced, as
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_112'>112</span>it never happened to come into my mind. But on
-the first of May Tootahah coming on board about
-ten o’clock in the forenoon, expressed a great curiosity
-to see the contents of every chest and drawer
-that was in my cabin: as I always made a point of
-gratifying him, I opened them immediately; and
-having taken a fancy to many things that he saw,
-and collected them together, he at last happened to
-cast his eye upon this adze: he instantly snatched it
-up with the greatest eagerness, and putting away
-every thing which he had before selected, he asked
-me whether I would let him have that: I readily
-consented; and, as if he was afraid I should repent,
-he carried it off immediately in a transport of joy,
-without making any other request, which, whatever
-had been our liberality, was seldom the case.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About noon, a chief, who had dined with me a
-few days before, accompanied by some of his women,
-came on board alone: I had observed that he was
-fed by his women, but I made no doubt that upon
-occasion he would condescend to feed himself: in
-this, however, I found myself mistaken. When my
-noble guest was seated, and the dinner upon the
-table, I helped him to some victuals: as I observed
-that he did not immediately begin his meal, I pressed
-him to eat; but he still continued to sit motionless
-like a statue, without attempting to put a single morsel
-into his mouth, and would certainly have gone
-without his dinner, if one of the servants had not fed
-him.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_113'>113</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. XI.<br /> <br />THE OBSERVATORY SET UP; THE QUADRANT STOLEN, AND CONSEQUENCES OF THE THEFT: A VISIT TO TOOTAHAH: DESCRIPTION OF A WRESTLING-MATCH: EUROPEAN SEEDS SOWN: NAMES GIVEN TO OUR PEOPLE BY THE INDIANS.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>In</span> the afternoon of Monday the first of May, we set
-up the observatory, and took the astronomical quadrant,
-with some other instruments, on shore, for the
-first time.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The next morning, about nine o’clock, I went on
-shore with Mr. Green to fix the quadrant in a situation
-for use, when to our inexpressible surprise and
-concern it was not to be found. It had been deposited
-in the tent which was reserved for my use,
-where, as I passed the night on board, nobody slept:
-it had never been taken out of the packing-case,
-which was eighteen inches square, and the whole was
-of considerable weight; a sentinel had been posted
-the whole night within five yards of the tent door,
-and none of the other instruments were missing.
-We at first suspected that it might have been stolen
-by some of our own people, who seeing a deal box,
-and not knowing the contents, might think it contained
-nails, or some other subjects of traffic with the
-natives. A large reward was therefore offered to
-any one who could find it, as, without this, we could
-not perform the service for which our voyage was
-principally undertaken. Our search in the mean
-time was not confined to the fort and places adjacent,
-but as the case might possibly have been carried
-back to the ship, if any of our own people had
-been the thieves, the most diligent search was made
-for it on board; all the parties, however, returned
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_114'>114</span>without any news of the quadrant. Mr. Banks,
-therefore, who upon such occasions declined neither
-labour nor risk, and who had more influence over
-the Indians than any of us, determined to go in
-search of it into the woods; he hoped, that if it had
-been stolen by the natives, he should find it wherever
-they had opened the box, as they would immediately
-discover that to them it would be wholly useless:
-or, if in this expectation he should be disappointed,
-that he might recover it by the ascendancy
-he had acquired over the chiefs. He set out, accompanied
-by a midshipman and Mr. Green, and as he
-was crossing the river he was met by Tubourai Tamaide,
-who immediately made the figure of a triangle
-with three bits of straw upon his hand. By this Mr.
-Banks knew that the Indians were the thieves; and
-that, although they had opened the case, they were
-not disposed to part with the contents. No time
-was therefore to be lost, and Mr. Banks made Tubourai
-Tamaide understand, that he must instantly
-go with him to the place whither the quadrant had
-been carried; he consented, and they set out together
-to the eastward, the chief enquiring at every
-house which they passed after the thief by name:
-the people readily told him which way he was gone,
-and how long it was since he had been there: the
-hope which this gave them that they should overtake
-him, supported them under their fatigue, and
-they pressed forward, sometimes walking, sometimes
-running, though the weather was intolerably hot;
-when they had climbed a hill at the distance of about
-four miles, their conductor showed them a point full
-three miles farther, and gave them to understand
-that they were not to expect the instrument till they
-had got thither. Here they paused; they had no
-arms, except a pair of pistols, which Mr. Banks always
-carried in his pocket; they were going to a
-place that was at least seven miles distant from the
-fort, where the Indians might be less submissive than
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_115'>115</span>at home, and to take from them what they had ventured
-their lives to get; and what, notwithstanding
-our conjectures, they appeared desirous to keep:
-these were discouraging circumstances, and their situation
-would become more critical at every step.
-They determined, however, not to relinquish their
-enterprise, nor to pursue it without taking the best
-measures for their security that were in their power.
-It was therefore determined, that Mr. Banks and
-Mr. Green should go on, and that the midshipman
-should return to me, and desire that I would send a
-party of men after them, acquainting me at the same
-time, that it was impossible they should return till it
-was dark. Upon receiving this message, I set out,
-with such a party as I thought sufficient for the occasion;
-leaving orders, both at the ship and at the
-fort, that no canoe should be suffered to go out of
-the bay, but that none of the natives should be seized
-or detained.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the mean time, Mr. Banks and Mr. Green pursued
-their journey, under the auspices of Tubourai
-Tamaide, and in the very spot which he had specified,
-they met one of his own people, with part of
-the quadrant in his hand. At this most welcome
-sight they stopped; and a great number of Indians
-immediately came up, some of whom pressing rather
-rudely upon them, Mr. Banks thought it necessary
-to show one of his pistols, the sight of which reduced
-them instantly to order: as the crowd that gathered
-round them was every moment increasing, he marked
-out a circle in the grass, and they ranged themselves
-on the outside of it to the number of several
-hundreds with great quietness and decorum. Into
-the middle of this circle, the box, which was now
-arrived, was ordered to be brought, with several
-reading-glasses, and other small matters, which in
-their hurry they had put into a pistol-case, that Mr.
-Banks knew to be his property, it having been some
-time before stolen from the tents, with a horse pistol
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_116'>116</span>in it, which he immediately demanded, and which
-was also restored.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Mr. Green was impatient to see whether all that
-had been taken away was returned, and upon examining
-the box found the stand, and a few small
-things of less consequence, wanting; several persons
-were sent in search of these, and most of the small
-things were returned: but it was signified that the
-thief had not brought the stand so far, and that it
-would be delivered to our friends as they went back;
-this being confirmed by Tubourai Tamaide, they
-prepared to return, as nothing would then be wanting
-but what might easily be supplied; and after they
-had advanced about two miles, I met them with my
-party, to our mutual satisfaction, congratulating each
-other upon the recovery of the quadrant, with a pleasure
-proportionate to the importance of the event.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About eight o’clock, Mr. Banks with Tubourai
-Tamaide got back to the fort; when to his great
-surprise, he found Tootahah in custody, and many
-of the natives in the utmost terror and distress,
-crowding about the gate. He went hastily in, some
-of the Indians were suffered to follow him, and
-the scene was extremely affecting. Tubourai Tamaide
-pressing forward, ran up to Tootahah, and
-catching him in his arms, they both burst into
-tears, and wept over each other, without being able
-to speak: the other Indians were also in tears for
-their chief, both he and they being strongly possessed
-with the notion that he was to be put to death. In
-this situation they continued till I entered the fort,
-which was about a quarter of an hour afterwards. I
-was equally surprised and concerned at what had
-happened, the confining Tootahah being contrary to
-my orders, and therefore instantly set him at liberty.
-Upon inquiring into the affair, I was told, that my
-going into the woods with a party of men under
-arms, at a time when a robbery had been committed,
-which it was supposed I should resent, in proportion
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_117'>117</span>to our apparent injury by the loss, had so alarmed
-the natives, that in the evening they began to leave
-the neighbourhood of the fort with their effects:
-that a double canoe having been seen to put off from
-the bottom of the bay by Mr. Gore, the second lieutenant,
-who was left in command on board the ship,
-and who had received orders not to suffer any canoe
-to go out, he sent the boatswain with a boat after
-her to bring her back: that as soon as the boat
-came up, the Indians being alarmed, leaped into the
-sea; and that Tootahah, being unfortunately one of
-the number, the boatswain took him up, and brought
-him to the ship, suffering the rest of the people to
-swim on shore: that Mr. Gore, not sufficiently
-attending to the order that none of the people
-should be confined, had sent him to the fort, and
-Mr. Hicks, the first lieutenant, who commanded
-there, receiving him in charge from Mr. Gore, did
-not think himself at liberty to dismiss him.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The notion that we intended to put him to death
-had possessed him so strongly, that he could not be
-persuaded to the contrary till by my orders he was
-led out of the fort. The people received him as they
-would have done a father in the same circumstances,
-and every one pressed forward to embrace him. Sudden
-joy is commonly liberal, without a scrupulous regard
-to merit: and Tootahah, in the first expansion of
-his heart, upon being unexpectedly restored to liberty
-and life, insisted upon our receiving a present of two
-hogs; though, being conscious that upon this occasion
-we had no claim to favours, we refused them
-many times.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander attended the next
-morning in their usual capacity of marketmen, but very
-few Indians appeared, and those who came brought
-no provisions. Tootahah, however, sent some of his
-people for the canoe that had been detained, which
-they took away. A canoe having also been detained
-that belonged to Oberea, <span class='sc'>Tupia</span>, the person who
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_118'>118</span>managed her affairs when the Dolphin was here, was
-sent to examine whether any thing on board had
-been taken away: and he was so well satisfied of the
-contrary, that he left the canoe where he found it,
-and joined us at the fort, where he spent the day,
-and slept on board the canoe at night. About noon,
-some fishing boats came abreast of the tents, but
-would part with very little of what they had on
-board; and we felt the want of cocoa-nuts and
-bread-fruit very severely. In the course of the day,
-Mr. Banks walked out into the woods, that by conversing
-with the people he might recover their confidence
-and good-will: he found them civil, but they
-all complained of the ill-treatment of their Chief;
-who, they said, had been beaten and pulled by the
-hair. Mr. Banks endeavoured to convince them,
-that he had suffered no personal violence, which to
-the best of our knowledge was true; yet, perhaps
-the boatswain had behaved with a brutality which he
-was afraid or ashamed to acknowledge. The Chief
-himself being probably, upon recollection, of opinion
-that we had ill deserved the hogs, which he had left
-with us as a present, sent a messenger in the afternoon
-to demand an axe, and a shirt, in return: but
-as I was told that he did not intend to come down
-to the fort for ten days, I excused myself from
-giving them till I should see him, hoping that his
-impatience might induce him to fetch them, and
-knowing that absence would probably continue the
-coolness between us, to which the first interview
-might put an end.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The next day we were still more sensible of the
-inconvenience we had incurred by giving offence to
-the people in the person of their chief, for the market
-was so ill-supplied that we were in want of necessaries.
-Mr. Banks therefore went into the woods to
-Tubourai Tamaide, and with some difficulty persuaded
-him to let us have five baskets of bread-fruit; a
-very seasonable supply, as they contained above one
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_119'>119</span>hundred and twenty. In the afternoon another messenger
-arrived from Tootahah for the axe and shirt;
-as it was now become absolutely necessary to recover
-the friendship of this man, without which it would
-be scarcely possible to procure provisions, I sent word
-that Mr. Banks and myself would visit him on the
-morrow, and bring what he wanted with us.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Early the next morning he sent again to remind
-me of my promise, and his people seemed to wait till
-we should set out with great impatience: I therefore
-ordered the pinnace, in which I embarked with Mr.
-Banks and Dr. Solander about ten o’clock: we took
-one of Tootahah’s people in the boat with us, and in
-about an hour we arrived at his place of residence
-which is called <span class='sc'>Eparre</span>, and is about four miles to
-the westward of the tents.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We found the people waiting for us in great numbers
-upon the shore, so that it would have been impossible
-for us to have proceeded, if way had not
-been made for us by a tall well-looking man, who had
-something like a turban about his head, and a long
-white stick in his hand, with which he laid about him
-at an unmerciful rate. This man conducted us to
-the chief, while the people shouted round us, <i>Taio
-Tootahah</i>, “Tootahah is your friend.” We found
-him, like an ancient Patriarch, sitting under a tree,
-with a number of venerable old men standing round
-him; he made a sign to us to sit down, and immediately
-asked for his axe: this I presented to him, with
-an upper garment of broad cloth, made after the
-country fashion, and trimmed with tape, to which
-I also added a shirt: he received them with
-great satisfaction, and immediately put on the garment;
-but the shirt he gave to the person who had
-cleared the way for us upon our landing, who was
-now seated by us, and of whom he seemed desirous
-that we should take particular notice. In a short
-time, Oberea, and several other women whom we
-knew, came and sat down among us: Tootahah left
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_120'>120</span>us several times, but after a short absence returned;
-we thought it had been to shew himself in his new
-finery to the people, but we wronged him, for it was
-to give directions for our refreshment and entertainment.
-While we were waiting for his return the last
-time he left us, very impatient to be dismissed, as we
-were almost suffocated in the crowd, word was brought
-us, that he expected us elsewhere: we found him
-sitting under the awning of our own boat, and making
-signs that we should come to him: as many of us
-therefore went on board as the boat would hold, and
-he then ordered bread-fruit and cocoa-nuts to be
-brought, of both which we tasted, rather to gratify
-him than because we had a desire to eat. A message
-was soon after brought him, upon which he went out
-of the boat, and we were in a short time desired to
-follow. We were conducted to a large area or court-yard,
-which was railed round with bamboos about
-three feet high, on one side of his house, where an
-entertainment was provided for us, entirely new: this
-was a wrestling-match. At the upper end of the
-area sat the chief, and several of his principal men
-were ranged on each side of him, so as to form a semicircle;
-these were the judges, by whom the victor
-was to be applauded; seats were also left for us at
-each end of the line; but we chose rather to be at
-liberty among the rest of the spectators.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When all was ready, ten or twelve persons, whom
-we understood to be the combatants, and who were
-naked, except a cloth that was fastened about the
-waist, entered the area, and walked slowly round it,
-in a stooping posture, with their left hands on their
-right breasts, and their right hands open, with which
-they frequently struck the left fore-arm so as to produce
-a quick smart sound: this was a general challenge
-to the combatants whom they were to engage,
-or any other person present: after these followed
-others in the same manner, and then a particular challenge
-was given, by which each man singled out his
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_121'>121</span>antagonist: this was done by joining the finger ends
-of both hands, and bringing them to the breast, at
-the same time moving the elbows up and down with
-a quick motion: if the person to whom this was addressed
-accepted the challenge, he repeated the signs,
-and immediately each put himself into an attitude to
-engage; the next minute they closed; but, except in
-first seizing each other, it was a mere contest of
-strength: each endeavoured to lay hold of the other,
-first by the thigh, and if that failed by the hand, the
-hair, the cloth, or elsewhere as he could: when this
-was done they grappled, without the least dexterity
-or skill, till one of them, by having a more advantageous
-hold, or greater muscular force, threw the other
-on his back. When the contest was over, the old
-men gave their plaudits to the victor in a few words,
-which they repeated together in a kind of tune: his
-conquest was also generally celebrated by three huzzas.
-The entertainment was then suspended for a
-few minutes, after which another couple of wrestlers
-came forward and engaged in the same manner: if it
-happened that neither was thrown, after the contest
-had continued about a minute, they parted, either by
-consent or the intervention of their friends, and in
-this case each slapped his arm, as a challenge to a
-new engagement, either with the same antagonist or
-some other. While the wrestlers were engaged,
-another party of men performed a dance which lasted
-also about a minute; but neither of these parties took
-the least notice of each other, their attention being
-wholly fixed on what they were doing. We observed
-with pleasure, that the conqueror never exulted over
-the vanquished, and that the vanquished never repined
-at the success of the conqueror; the whole contest
-was carried on with perfect good-will and good-humour,
-though in the presence of at least five hundred
-spectators, of whom some were women. The
-number of women indeed was comparatively small,
-none but those of rank were present, and we had reason
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_122'>122</span>to believe that they would not have been spectators
-of this exercise but in compliment to us.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This lasted about two hours; during all which
-time the man who had made way for us when we
-landed, kept the people at a proper distance, by striking
-those who pressed forward very severely with his
-stick: upon inquiry we learnt, that he was an officer
-belonging to Tootahah, acting as a master of the ceremonies.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It is scarcely possible for those who are acquainted
-with the athletic sports of very remote antiquity, not
-to remark a rude resemblance of them in this wrestling-match
-among the natives of a little island in the
-midst of the Pacific Ocean: and even our female
-readers may recollect the account given of them by
-Fenelon in his Telemachus, where, though the events
-are fictitious, the manners of the age are faithfully
-transcribed from authors by whom they are supposed
-to have been truly related.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When the wrestling was over, we were given to understand
-that two hogs, and a large quantity of bread-fruit,
-were preparing for our dinner, which, as our
-appetites were now keen, was very agreeable intelligence.
-Our host, however, seemed to repent of his
-liberality; for, instead of setting his two hogs before
-us, he ordered one of them to be carried into our
-boat; at first we were not sorry for this new disposition
-of matters, thinking that we should dine more
-comfortably in the boat than on shore, as the crowd
-would more easily be kept at a distance: but when
-we came on board, he ordered us to proceed with
-his hog to the ship: this was mortifying, as we were
-now to row four miles while our dinner was growing
-cold; however, we thought fit to comply, and were
-at last gratified with the cheer that he had provided,
-of which he and Tubourai Tamaide had a liberal
-share.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Our reconciliation with this man operated upon the
-people like a charm; for he was no sooner known to
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_123'>123</span>be on board, than bread-fruit, cocoa-nuts, and other
-provisions were brought to the fort in great plenty.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Affairs now went on in the usual channel; but
-pork being still a scarce commodity, our master, Mr.
-Mollineux, and Mr. Green, went in the pinnace to
-the eastward, on the 8th, early in the morning to
-see whether they could procure any hogs or poultry
-in that part of the country: they proceeded in that
-direction twenty miles; but though they saw many
-hogs, and one turtle, they could not purchase either
-at any price: the people every where told them, that
-they all belonged to Tootahah, and that they could
-sell none of them without his permission. We now
-began to think that this man was indeed a great
-prince; for an influence so extensive and absolute
-could be acquired by no other. And we afterwards
-found that he administered the government of this
-part of the island, as sovereign, for a minor whom
-we never saw all the time that we were upon it. When
-Mr. Green returned from this expedition, he said
-he had seen a tree of a size which he was afraid to
-relate, it being no less than sixty yards in circumference;
-but Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander soon explained
-to him, that it was a species of the fig, the
-branches of which, bending down, take fresh root
-in the earth, and thus form a congeries of trunks,
-which being very close to each other, and all joined
-by a common vegetation, might easily be mistaken
-for one.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Though the market at the fort was now tolerably
-supplied, provisions were brought more slowly; a
-sufficient quantity used to be purchased between sunrise
-and eight o’clock, but it was now become necessary
-to attend the greatest part of the day. Mr.
-Banks, therefore, fixed his little boat up before the
-door of the fort, which was of great use as a place
-to trade in: hitherto we had purchased cocoa-nuts
-and bread-fruit for beads; but the market becoming
-rather slack in these articles, we were now, for the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_124'>124</span>first time, forced to bring out our nails: one of our
-smallest size, which was about four inches long, procured
-us twenty cocoa-nuts, and bread-fruit in proportion,
-so that in a short time our first plenty was
-restored.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 9th, soon after breakfast, we received a
-visit from Oberea, being the first that she had made
-us after the loss of our quadrant, and the unfortunate
-confinement of Tootahah; with her came her present
-favourite, Obadée, and Tupia: they brought us a
-hog and some bread-fruit, in return for which we gave
-her a hatchet. We had now afforded our Indian
-friends a new and interesting object of curiosity, our
-forge, which having been set up some time, was almost
-constantly at work. It was now common for
-them to bring pieces of iron, which we suppose they
-must have got from the Dolphin, to be made into
-tools of various kinds; and as I was very desirous to
-gratify them, they were indulged except when the
-smith’s time was too precious to be spared. Oberea
-having received her hatchet, produced as much old
-iron as would have made another, with a request that
-another might be made of it; in this, however, I
-could not gratify her, upon which she brought out a
-broken axe, and desired it might be mended: I was
-glad of an opportunity to compromise the difference
-between us: her axe was mended, and she appeared
-to be content. They went away at night, and took
-with them the canoe, which had been a considerable
-time at the point, but promised to return in three
-days.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 10th, I put some seeds of melons and other
-plants into a spot of ground which had been turned
-up for the purpose; they had all been sealed up by
-the person of whom they were bought, in small bottles
-with rosin; but none of them came up except
-mustard; even the cucumbers and melons failed, and
-Mr. Banks is of opinion that they were spoiled by the
-total exclusion of fresh air.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_125'>125</span>This day we learnt the Indian name of the island,
-which is <span class='sc'>Otaheite</span>, and by that name I shall hereafter
-distinguish it: but after great pains taken we
-found it utterly impossible to teach the Indians to
-pronounce our names; we had, therefore, new names,
-consisting of such sounds as they produced in the
-attempt. They called me <i>Toote</i>; Mr. Hicks, <i>Hete</i>;
-Mollineux they renounced in absolute despair, and
-called the Master <i>Boba</i>, from his Christian name
-Robert; Mr. Gore was <i>Toarro</i>; Dr. Solander, <i>Torano</i>;
-and Mr. Banks, <i>Tapane</i>; Mr. Green, <i>Eteree</i>;
-Mr. Parkinson, <i>Patini</i>; Mr. Sporing, <i>Polini</i>; Petersgill,
-<i>Petrodero</i>; and in this manner they had now
-formed names for almost every man in the ship: in
-some, however, it was not easy to find any traces of
-the original, and they were perhaps not mere arbitrary
-sounds formed upon the occasion, but significant
-words in their own language. Monkhouse, the
-Midshipman, who commanded the party that killed
-the man for stealing the musket, they called <i>Matte</i>;
-not merely by an attempt to imitate in sound the first
-syllable of Monkhouse, but because <i>Matte</i> signifies
-<em>dead</em>; and this probably might be the case with others.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_126'>126</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. XII.<br /> <br />SOME LADIES VISIT THE FORT WITH VERY UNCOMMON CEREMONIES: THE INDIANS ATTEND DIVINE SERVICE, AND IN THE EVENING EXHIBIT A MOST EXTRAORDINARY SPECTACLE: TUBOURAI TAMAIDE FALLS INTO TEMPTATION.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>Friday</span>, the 12th of May, was distinguished by
-a visit from some ladies whom we had never seen before,
-and who introduced themselves with some very
-singular ceremonies. Mr. Banks was trading in his
-boat at the gate of the fort as usual, in company
-with Tootahah, who had that morning paid him a
-visit, and some other of the natives; between nine
-and ten o’clock, a double canoe came to the landing-place,
-under the awning of which sat a man and two
-women: the Indians that were about Mr. Banks
-made signs that he should go out to meet them,
-which he hastened to do; but by the time he could
-get out of the boat, they had advanced within ten
-yards of him; they then stopped, and made signs
-that he should do so too, laying down about a dozen
-young plantain trees, and some other small plants:
-he complied, and the people having made a lane between
-them, the man, who appeared to be a servant,
-brought six of them to Mr. Banks by one of each at
-a time, passing and repassing six times, and always
-pronouncing a short sentence when he delivered them.
-Tupia, who stood by Mr. Banks, acted as his master
-of the ceremonies, and receiving the branches as
-they were brought, laid them down in the boat.
-When this was done, another man brought a large
-bundle of cloth, which having opened, he spread
-piece by piece upon the ground, in the space between
-Mr. Banks and his visitors; there were nine pieces,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_127'>127</span>and having laid three pieces one upon another, the
-foremost of the women, who seemed to be the principal,
-and who was called <span class='sc'>Oorattooa</span>, stepped upon
-them, and taking up her garments all round her to
-the waist, turned about, with great composure and
-deliberation, and with an air of perfect innocence
-and simplicity, three times; when this was done, she
-dropped the veil, and stepping off the cloth, three
-more pieces were laid on, and she repeated the ceremony,
-then stepping off as before, the last three
-were laid on, and the ceremony was repeated
-in the same manner the third time. Immediately
-after this the cloth was rolled up, and given
-to Mr. Banks as a present from the lady, who, with
-her friend, came up and saluted him. He made such
-presents to them both, as he thought would be most
-acceptable, and after having staid about an hour they
-went away. In the evening the Gentlemen at the
-fort had a visit from Oberea, and her favourite female
-attendant, whose name was <span class='sc'>Otheothea</span>, an
-agreeable girl, whom they were the more pleased to
-see, because, having been some days absent, it had
-been reported she was either sick or dead.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 13th, the market being over about ten
-o’clock, Mr. Banks walked into the woods with his
-gun, as he generally did, for the benefit of the shade
-in the heat of the day: as he was returning back,
-he met Tubourai Tamaide, near his occasional dwelling,
-and stopping to spend a little time with him, he
-suddenly took the gun out of Mr. Banks’s hand,
-cocked it, and, holding it up in the air, drew the
-trigger: fortunately for him it flashed in the pan:
-Mr. Banks immediately took it from him, not a little
-surprised how he had acquired sufficient knowledge
-of a gun to discharge it, and reproved him with great
-severity for what he had done. As it was of infinite
-importance to keep the Indians totally ignorant of
-the management of fire-arms, he had taken every opportunity
-of intimating that they could never offend
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_128'>128</span>him so highly as by even touching his piece; it was
-now proper to enforce this prohibition, and he therefore
-added threats to his reproof: the Indian bore
-all patiently; but the moment Mr. Banks crossed the
-river, he set off with all his family and furniture for
-his house at Eparre. This being quickly known from
-the Indians at the fort, and great inconvenience being
-apprehended from the displeasure of this man,
-who upon all occasions had been particularly useful,
-Mr. Banks determined to follow him without delay,
-and solicit his return: he set out the same evening
-accompanied by Mr. Mollineux, and found him sitting
-in the middle of a large circle of people, to whom
-he had probably related what had happened, and his
-fears of the consequences; he was himself the very
-picture of grief and dejection, and the same passions
-were strongly marked in the countenances of all the
-people that surrounded him. When Mr. Banks and
-Mr. Mollineux went into the circle, one of the women
-expressed her trouble, as Terapo had done upon
-another occasion, and struck a shark’s tooth into her
-head several times, till it was covered with blood.
-Mr. Banks lost no time in putting an end to this universal
-distress; he assured the Chief, that every thing
-which had passed should be forgotten, that there was
-not the least animosity remaining on one side, nor
-any thing to be feared on the other. The Chief was
-soon soothed into confidence and complacency, a
-double canoe was ordered to be got ready, they all
-returned together to the fort before supper, and as a
-pledge of perfect reconciliation, both he and his wife
-slept all night in Mr. Banks’s tent: their presence,
-however, was no palladium; for, between eleven and
-twelve o’clock, one of the natives attempted to get
-into the fort by scaling the walls, with a design, no
-doubt, to steal whatever he should happen to find;
-he was discovered by the sentinel, who happily did
-not fire, and he ran away much faster than any of
-our people could follow him. The iron, and iron-tools,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_129'>129</span>which were in continual use at the armourer’s
-forge, that was set up within the works, were temptations
-to theft which none of these people could
-withstand.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 14th, which was Sunday, I directed that
-Divine service should be performed at the fort: we
-were desirous that some of the principal Indians
-should be present, but when the hour came, most of
-them were returned home. Mr. Banks, however,
-crossed the river, and brought back Tubourai Tamaide
-and his wife Tomio, hoping that it would give
-occasion to some enquiries on their part, and some
-instruction on ours: having seated them, he placed
-himself between them, and during the whole service,
-they very attentively observed his behaviour, and
-very exactly imitated it; standing, sitting, or kneeling,
-as they saw him do: they were conscious that
-we were employed about somewhat serious and important,
-as appeared by their calling to the Indians
-without the fort to be silent; yet when the service
-was over, neither of them asked any questions, nor
-would they attend to any attempt that was made to
-explain what had been done.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Such were our matins; our Indians thought fit
-to perform vespers of a very different kind. A young
-man, near six feet high, performed the rites of Venus
-with a little girl about eleven or twelve years of
-age, before several of our people, and a great number
-of the natives, without the least sense of its being indecent
-or improper, but, as appeared, in perfect conformity
-to the custom of the place. Among the
-spectators were several women of superior rank, particularly
-Oberea, who may properly be said to have
-assisted at the ceremony; for they gave instructions
-to the girl how to perform her part, which, young as
-she was, she did not seem much to stand in need of.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This incident is not mentioned as an object of idle
-curiosity, but as it deserves consideration in determining
-a question which has been long debated in
-philosophy; Whether the shame attending certain
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_130'>130</span>actions, which are allowed on all sides to be in themselves
-innocent, is implanted in nature, or superinduced
-by custom? If it has its origin in custom, it
-will, perhaps, be found difficult to trace that custom,
-however general, to its source; if in instinct, it will
-be equally difficult to discover from what cause it is
-subdued, or at least over-ruled among these people,
-in whose manners not the least trace of it is to be
-found.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 14th and 15th, we had another opportunity
-of observing the general knowledge which these
-people had of any design that was formed among
-them. In the night between the 13th and 14th, one
-of the water-casks was stolen from the outside of the
-fort: in the morning, there was not an Indian to be
-seen who did not know that it was gone; yet they
-appeared not to have been trusted, or not to have
-been worthy of trust; for they seemed all of them
-disposed to give intelligence where it might be found.
-Mr. Banks traced it to a part of the bay where he
-was told it had been put into a canoe, but as it was
-not of great consequence he did not complete the discovery.
-When he returned, he was told by Tubourai
-Tamaide, that another cask would be stolen before
-the morning: how he came by this knowledge
-it is not easy to imagine; that he was not a party in
-the design is certain, for he came with his wife and
-his family to the place where the water-casks stood,
-and placing their beds near them, he said he would
-himself be a pledge for their safety, in despight of
-the thief: of this, however, we would not admit;
-and making them understand that a sentry would be
-placed to watch the casks till the morning, he removed
-the beds into Mr. Banks’s tent, where he and
-his family spent the night, making signs to the sentry
-when he retired, that he should keep his eyes
-open. In the night this intelligence appeared to be
-true; about twelve o’clock the thief came, but discovering
-that a watch had been set, he went away
-without his booty.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_131'>131</span>Mr. Banks’s confidence in Tubourai Tamaide had
-greatly increased since the affair of the knife, in
-consequence of which he was at length exposed to
-temptations which neither his integrity nor his
-honour was able to resist. They had withstood
-many allurements, but were at length ensnared by
-the fascinating charms of a basket of nails: these
-nails were much larger than any that had yet been
-brought into trade, and had, with perhaps some degree
-of criminal negligence, been left in a corner of
-Mr. Banks’s tent, to which the chief had always free
-access. One of these nails Mr. Banks’s servant happened
-to see in his possession, upon his having inadvertently
-thrown back that part of his garment under
-which it was concealed. Mr. Banks being told
-of this, and knowing that no such thing had been
-given him, either as a present or in barter, immediately
-examined the basket, and discovered, that out
-of seven nails five were missing. He then, though
-not without great reluctance, charged him with the
-fact, which he immediately confessed, and however
-he might suffer, was probably not more hurt than his
-accuser. A demand was immediately made of restitution;
-but this he declined, saying, that the nails
-were at Eparre: however, Mr. Banks appearing to
-be much in earnest, and using some threatening
-signs, he thought fit to produce one of them. He
-was then taken to the fort, to receive such judgment
-as should be given against him by the general voice.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After some deliberation, that we might not appear
-to think too lightly of his offence, he was told, that
-if he would bring the other four nails to the fort, it
-should be forgotten. To this condition he agreed;
-but I am sorry to say he did not fulfil it. Instead of
-fetching the nails, he removed with his family before
-night, and took all his furniture with him.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As our long-boat had appeared to be leaky, I
-thought it necessary to examine her bottom, and to
-my great surprise found it so much eaten by the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_132'>132</span>worms, that it was necessary to give her a new one;
-no such accident had happened to the Dolphin’s
-boats, as I was informed by the officers on board,
-and therefore it was a misfortune that I did not expect:
-I feared that the pinnace also might be nearly
-in the same condition; but, upon examining her, I
-had the satisfaction to find that not a worm had
-touched her, though she was built of the same wood,
-and had been as much in the water; the reason of
-this difference I imagine to be, that the long-boat
-was paid with varnish of pine, and the pinnace
-painted with white lead and oil; the bottoms of all
-boats, therefore, which are sent into this country,
-should be painted like that of the pinnace, and the
-ships should be supplied with a good stock, in order
-to give them a new coating when it should be found
-necessary.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Having received repeated messages from Tootahah,
-that if we would pay him a visit he would acknowledge
-the favour by a present of four hogs, I
-sent Mr. Hicks, my first lieutenant, to try if he could
-not procure the hogs upon easier terms, with orders
-to show him every civility in his power. Mr. Hicks
-found that he was removed from Eparre to a place
-called <span class='sc'>Tettahah</span>, five miles farther to the westward.
-He was received with great cordiality; one hog was
-immediately produced, and he was told that the other
-three, which were at some distance, should be brought
-in the morning. Mr. Hicks readily consented to
-stay; but the morning came without the hogs, and
-it not being convenient to stay longer, he returned
-in the evening with the one he had got.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 25th, Tubourai Tamaide and his wife Tomio
-made their appearance at the tent, for the first
-time since he had been detected in stealing the nails;
-he seemed to be under some discontent and apprehension,
-yet he did not think fit to purchase our
-countenance and good will by restoring the four
-which he had sent away. As Mr. Banks and the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_133'>133</span>other gentlemen treated him with a coolness and reserve
-which did not at all tend to restore his peace
-or good humour, his stay was short, and his departure
-abrupt. Mr. Monkhouse, the surgeon, went the next
-morning in order to effect a reconciliation, by persuading
-him to bring down the nails, but he could
-not succeed.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_134'>134</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. XIII.<br /> <br />ANOTHER VISIT TO TOOTAHAH, WITH VARIOUS ADVENTURES: EXTRAORDINARY AMUSEMENT OF THE INDIANS, WITH REMARKS UPON IT: PREPARATIONS TO OBSERVE THE TRANSIT OF VENUS, AND WHAT HAPPENED IN THE MEAN TIME AT THE FORT.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>On</span> the 27th, it was determined that we should pay
-our visit to Tootahah, though we were not very confident
-that we should receive the hogs for our pains.
-I therefore set out early in the morning, with Mr.
-Banks and Dr. Solander, and three others, in the
-pinnace. He was now removed from Tettahah,
-where Mr. Hicks had seen him, to a place called <span class='sc'>Atahourou</span>,
-about six miles farther, and as we could
-not go above half-way thither in the boat, it was almost
-evening before we arrived: we found him in
-his usual state, sitting under a tree, with a great
-crowd about him. We made our presents in due
-form, consisting of a yellow stuff petticoat, and some
-other trifling articles, which were graciously received;
-a hog was immediately ordered to be killed and
-dressed for supper, with a promise of more in the
-morning: however, as we were less desirous of feasting
-upon our journey than of carrying back with us
-provisions, which would be more welcome at the fort,
-we procured a reprieve for the hog, and supped upon
-the fruits of the country. As night now came on,
-and the place was crowded with many more than
-the houses and canoes would contain; there being
-Oberea with her attendants, and many other travellers
-whom we knew, we began to look out for lodgings.
-Our party consisted of six: Mr. Banks thought
-himself fortunate in being offered a place by Oberea
-in her canoe, and wishing his friends a good
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_135'>135</span>night, took his leave. He went to rest early, according
-to the custom of the country, and taking off his
-clothes, as was his constant practice, the nights being
-hot, Oberea kindly insisted upon taking them
-into her own custody, for otherwise she said they
-would certainly be stolen. Mr. Banks having such
-a safeguard, resigned himself to sleep with all imaginable
-tranquillity: but waking about eleven
-o’clock, and wanting to get up, he searched for his
-clothes where he had seen them deposited by Oberea
-when he lay down to sleep, and soon perceived that
-they were missing. He immediately awakened Oberea,
-who starting up, and hearing his complaint,
-ordered lights, and prepared in great haste to recover
-what he had lost: Tootahah himself slept in
-the next canoe, and being soon alarmed, he came to
-them, and set out with Oberea in search of the thief.
-Mr. Banks was not in a condition to go with them,
-for of his apparel scarce any thing was left him but
-his breeches; his coat, and his waistcoat, with his
-pistols, powder-horn, and many other things that
-were in the pockets, were gone. In about half an
-hour his two noble friends returned, but without
-having obtained any intelligence of his clothes or of
-the thief. At first he began to be alarmed, his musket
-had not indeed been taken away, but he had
-neglected to load it; where I and Dr. Solander had
-disposed of ourselves he did not know; and therefore,
-whatever might happen, he could not have recourse
-to us for assistance. He thought it best,
-however, to express neither fear nor suspicion of
-those about him, and giving his musket to Tupia,
-who had been waked in the confusion and stood by
-him, with a charge not to suffer it to be stolen, he
-betook himself again to rest, declaring himself perfectly
-satisfied with the pains that Tootahah and
-Oberea had taken to recover his things, though they
-had not been successful. As it cannot be supposed
-that in such a situation his sleep was very sound, he
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_136'>136</span>soon after heard music, and saw lights at a little distance
-on shore: this was a concert or assembly,
-which they call a <span class='sc'>Heiva</span>, a common name for every
-public exhibition; and as it would necessarily bring
-many people together, and there was a chance of my
-being among them with his other friends, he rose,
-and made the best of his way towards it: he was
-soon led by the lights and the sound to the hut
-where I lay, with three other gentlemen of our party;
-and easily distinguishing us from the rest, he made
-up to us more than half naked, and told us his melancholy
-story. We gave him such comfort as the
-unfortunate generally give to each other, by telling
-him that we were fellow-sufferers; I showed him
-that I was myself without stockings, they having
-been stolen from under my head, though I was sure
-I had never been asleep, and each of my associates
-convinced him, by his appearance, that he had lost
-a jacket. We determined, however, to hear out the
-concert, however deficient we might appear in our
-dress; it consisted of three drums, four flutes, and
-several voices: when this entertainment, which lasted
-about an hour, was over, we retired again to our
-sleeping-places; having agreed, that nothing could
-be done toward the recovery of our things till the
-morning.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We rose at day-break, according to the custom of
-the country: the first man that Mr. Banks saw was
-Tupia, faithfully attending with his musket; and
-soon after, Oberea brought him some of her country
-clothes, as a succedaneum for his own, so that when
-he came to us he made a most motley appearance,
-half Indian and half English. Our party soon got
-together, except Dr. Solander, whose quarters we did
-not know, and who had not assisted at the concert:
-in a short time Tootahah made his appearance, and
-we pressed him to recover our clothes; but neither
-he nor Oberea could be persuaded to take any
-measure for that purpose, so that we began to suspect
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_137'>137</span>that they had been parties in the theft. About
-eight o’clock, we were joined by Dr. Solander, who
-had fallen into honester hands, at a house about a
-mile distant, and had lost nothing.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Having given up all hope of recovering our clothes,
-which, indeed, were never afterwards heard of, we
-spent all the morning in soliciting the hogs which
-we had been promised; but in this we had no better
-success: we, therefore, in no very good humour, set
-out for the boat about twelve o’clock, with only that
-which we had redeemed from the butcher and the
-cook the night before.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As we were returning to the boat, however, we
-were entertained with a sight that in some measure
-compensated for our fatigue and disappointment. In
-our way we came to one of the few places where access
-to the island is not guarded by a reef, and, consequently,
-a high surf breaks upon the shore; a more
-dreadful one, indeed, I had seldom seen; it was impossible
-for any European boat to have lived in it;
-and if the best swimmer in Europe had, by any accident,
-been exposed to its fury, I am confident that
-he would not have been able to preserve himself
-from drowning, especially as the shore was covered
-with pebbles and large stones; yet, in the midst of
-these breakers, were ten or twelve Indians swimming
-for their amusement: whenever a surf broke near
-them, they dived under it, and, to all appearance
-with infinite facility, rose again on the other side.
-This diversion was greatly improved by the stern of
-an old canoe, which they happened to find upon the
-spot: they took this before them, and swam out with
-it as far as the outermost breach, then two or three
-of them getting into it, and turning the square end
-to the breaking wave, were driven in towards the
-shore with incredible rapidity, sometimes almost to
-the beach; but generally the wave broke over them
-before they got half way, in which case they dived,
-and rose on the other side with the canoe in their
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_138'>138</span>hands: they then swam out with it again, and were
-again driven back, just as our holiday youth climb
-the hill in Greenwich-park for the pleasure of rolling
-down it. At this wonderful scene we stood gazing
-for more than half an hour, during which time none
-of the swimmers attempted to come on shore, but
-seemed to enjoy their sport in the highest degree;
-we then proceeded in our journey, and late in the
-evening got back to the fort.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Upon this occasion it may be observed, that human
-nature is endued with powers which are only accidentally
-exerted to the utmost; and that all men are
-capable of what no man attains, except he is stimulated
-to the effort by some uncommon circumstances
-or situation. These Indians effected what to us appeared
-to be supernatural, merely by the application of
-such powers as they possessed in common with us,
-and all other men who have no particular infirmity
-or defect. The truth of the observation is also
-manifest from more familiar instances. The rope-dancer
-and balance-master owe their art, not to any
-peculiar liberality of nature, but to an accidental
-improvement of her common gifts; and though equal
-diligence and application would not always produce
-equal excellence in these, any more than in other
-arts, yet there is no doubt but that a certain degree
-of proficiency in them might be universally attained.
-Another proof of the existence of abilities in mankind,
-that are almost universally dormant, is furnished
-by the attainments of blind men. It cannot
-be supposed that the loss of one sense, like the
-amputation of a branch from a tree, gives new vigour
-to those that remain. Every man’s hearing and
-touch, therefore, are capable of the nice distinctions
-which astonish us in those that have lost their sight,
-and if they do not give the same intelligence to the
-mind, it is merely because the same intelligence is
-not required of them: he that can see may do from
-choice what the blind do by necessity, and by the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_139'>139</span>same diligent attention to the other senses may receive
-the same notices from them; let it, therefore,
-be remembered, as an encouragement to persevering
-diligence, and a principle of general use to mankind,
-that he who does all he can will ever effect much
-more than is generally thought to be possible.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Among other Indians that had visited us, there
-were some from a neighbouring island which they
-called <span class='sc'>Eimeo</span> or <span class='sc'>Imao</span>, the same to which Captain
-Wallis had given the name of the Duke of York’s
-island, and they gave us an account of no less than
-two-and-twenty islands that lay in the neighbourhood
-of Otaheite.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As the day of observation now approached, I
-determined, in consequence of some hints which
-had been given me by Lord Morton, to send out two
-parties to observe the transit from other situations;
-hoping, that if we should fail at Otaheite, they might
-have better success. We were, therefore, now busily
-employed in preparing our instruments, and instructing
-such gentlemen in the use of them as I
-intended to send out.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On Thursday the 1st of June, the Saturday following
-being the day of the transit, I dispatched
-Mr. Gore in the long boat to Imao, with Mr. Monkhouse
-and Mr. Sporing, a gentleman belonging to
-Mr. Banks, Mr. Green having furnished them with
-proper instruments. Mr. Banks himself thought fit
-to go upon this expedition, and several natives, particularly
-Tubourai Tamaide and Tomio, were also
-of the party. Very early on the Friday morning, I
-sent Mr. Hicks with Mr. Clerk and Mr. Petersgill,
-the master’s mates, and Mr. Saunders, one of the
-midshipmen, in the pinnace to the eastward, with
-orders to fix on some convenient spot, at a distance
-from our principal observatory, where they also
-might employ the instruments with which they had
-been furnished for the same purpose.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The long-boat not having been got ready till
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_140'>140</span>Thursday in the afternoon, though all possible expedition
-was used to fit her out; the people on
-board, after having rowed most part of the night,
-brought her to a grappling just under the land of
-Imao. Soon after day-break, they saw an Indian
-canoe, which they hailed, and the people on board
-shewed them an inlet through the reef into which
-they pulled, and soon fixed upon a coral rock, which
-rose out of the water about one hundred and fifty
-yards from the shore, as a proper situation for their
-observatory: it was about eighty yards long and
-twenty broad, and in the middle of it was a bed of
-white sand, large enough for the tents to stand upon.
-Mr. Gore and his assistants immediately began to set
-them up, and make other necessary preparations for
-the important business of the next day. While this
-was doing, Mr. Banks, with the Indians of Otaheite,
-and the people whom they had met in the canoe,
-went ashore upon the main island, to buy provisions;
-of which he procured a sufficient supply before night.
-When he returned to the rock, he found the observatory
-in order, and the telescopes all fixed and
-tried. The evening was very fine, yet their solicitude
-did not permit them to take much rest in the night:
-one or other of them was up every half hour, who
-satisfied the impatience of the rest by reporting the
-changes of the sky, now encouraging their hope, by
-telling them that it was clear, and now alarming
-their fears, by an account that it was hazy.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At day-break they got up, and had the satisfaction
-to see the sun rise without a cloud. Mr. Banks
-then wishing the observers, Mr. Gore and Mr.
-Monkhouse, success, repaired again to the island,
-that he might examine its produce, and get a fresh
-supply of provisions: he began by trading with the
-natives, for which purpose he took his station under
-a tree; and to keep them from pressing upon him in
-a crowd, he drew a circle round him, which he suffered
-none of them to enter.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_141'>141</span>About eight o’clock, he saw two canoes coming
-towards the place, and was given to understand by
-the people about him, that they belonged to <span class='sc'>Tarrao</span>,
-the King of the island, who was coming to make
-him a visit. As soon as the canoes came near the
-shore, the people made a lane from the beach to the
-trading-place, and his Majesty landed, with his sister,
-whose name was <span class='sc'>Nuna</span>; as they advanced towards
-the tree where Mr. Banks stood, he went out to
-meet them, and, with great formality, introduced
-them into the circle from which the other natives
-had been excluded. As it is the custom of these
-people to sit during all their conferences, Mr. Banks
-unwrapped a kind of turban of Indian cloth, which
-he wore upon his head instead of a hat, and spreading
-it upon the ground, they all sat down upon it
-together. The royal present was then brought,
-which consisted of a hog and a dog, some bread-fruit,
-cocoa-nuts, and other articles of the like kind. Mr.
-Banks then dispatched a canoe to the observatory
-for his present, and the messengers soon returned
-with an adze, a shirt, and some beads, which were
-presented to his Majesty, and received with great
-satisfaction.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>By this time, Tubourai Tamaide and Tomio joined
-them, from the observatory. Tomio said, that she
-was related to Tarrao, and brought him a present of
-a long nail, at the same time complimenting Nuna
-with a shirt.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The first internal contact of the planet with the
-sun being over, Mr. Banks returned to the observatory,
-taking Tarrao, Nuna, and some of their principal
-attendants, among whom were three very handsome
-young women, with him: he showed them the planet
-upon the sun, and endeavoured to make them understand
-that he and his companions had come from
-their own country on purpose to see it. Soon after,
-Mr. Banks returned with them to the island, where
-he spent the rest of the day in examining its produce,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_142'>142</span>which he found to be much the same with
-that of Otaheite. The people whom he saw there
-also exactly resembled the inhabitants of that island,
-and many of them were persons whom he had seen
-upon it; so that all those whom he had dealt with
-knew of what his trading articles consisted, and the
-value they bore.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The next morning, having struck the tents, they
-set out on their return, and arrived at the fort before
-night.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The observation was made with equal success by
-the persons whom I had sent to the eastward, and at
-the fort, there not being a cloud in the sky from the
-rising to the setting of the sun, the whole passage of
-the planet Venus over the sun’s disk was observed with
-great advantage by Mr. Green, Dr. Solander, and
-myself: Mr. Green’s telescope and mine were of the
-same magnifying power, but that of Dr. Solander was
-greater. We all saw an atmosphere or dusky cloud
-round the body of the planet, which very much
-disturbed the times of contact, especially of the internal
-ones; and we differed from each other in our
-accounts of the times of the contacts much more
-than might have been expected. According to Mr.
-Green,</p>
-
-<table id='transit' summary=''>
- <tr>
- <th>&nbsp;</th>
- <th>Hours.</th>
- <th>Min.</th>
- <th>Sec.</th>
- <th colspan='2'>&nbsp;</th>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='fs' colspan='6'>&nbsp;</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td>The first external contact, or first appearance of Venus on the sun, was</td>
- <td>9</td>
- <td>25</td>
- <td>42</td>
- <td class='bt br bb fs' rowspan='2'>&nbsp;</td>
- <td rowspan='2'>Morning</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td>The first internal contact, or total immersion, was</td>
- <td>9</td>
- <td>44</td>
- <td>4</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='fs' colspan='6'>&nbsp;</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td>The second internal contact, or beginning of the emersion,</td>
- <td>3</td>
- <td>14</td>
- <td>8</td>
- <td class='bt br bb fs' rowspan='2'>&nbsp;</td>
- <td rowspan='2'>Afternoon</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td>The second external contact, or total emersion,</td>
- <td>3</td>
- <td>32</td>
- <td>10</td>
- </tr>
-</table>
-
-<p class='c000'>The latitude of the observatory was found to be
-17° 29ʹ 15ʺ, and the longitude 149° 32ʹ 30ʺ W. of
-Greenwich. A more particular account will appear
-by the tables, for which the reader is referred to the
-Transactions of the Royal Society, vol. lxi. part 2.
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_143'>143</span>page 39. <i>et seq.</i>, where they are illustrated by
-a cut.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>But if we had reason to congratulate ourselves
-upon the success of our observation, we had scarce
-less cause to regret the diligence with which that
-time had been improved by some of our people to
-another purpose. While the attention of the officers
-was engrossed by the transit of Venus, some of the
-ship’s company broke into one of the store-rooms,
-and stole a quantity of spike-nails, amounting to no
-less than one hundred weight: this was a matter of
-public and serious concern; for these nails, if circulated
-by the people among the Indians, would do
-us irreparable injury, by reducing the value of iron,
-our staple commodity. One of the thieves was detected,
-but only seven nails were found in his custody.
-He was punished with two dozen lashes, but would
-impeach none of his accomplices.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_144'>144</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. XIV.<br /> <br />THE CEREMONIES OF AN INDIAN FUNERAL PARTICULARLY DESCRIBED: GENERAL OBSERVATIONS ON THE SUBJECT: A CHARACTER FOUND AMONG THE INDIANS TO WHICH THE ANCIENTS PAID GREAT VENERATION: A ROBBERY AT THE FORT, AND ITS CONSEQUENCES: WITH A SPECIMEN OF INDIAN COOKERY, AND VARIOUS INCIDENTS.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>On</span> the 5th, we kept his Majesty’s birth-day; for
-though it is the 4th, we were unwilling to celebrate
-it during the absence of the two parties who had been
-sent out to observe the transit. We had several of
-the Indian chiefs at our entertainment, who drank
-his Majesty’s health by the name of Kihiargo, which
-was the nearest imitation they could produce of King
-George.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About this time died an old woman of some rank,
-who was related to Tomio, which gave us an opportunity
-to see how they disposed of the body, and
-confirmed us in our opinion that these people, contrary
-to the present custom of all other nations now
-known, never bury their dead. In the middle of a
-small square, neatly railed in with bamboo, the awning
-of a canoe was raised upon two posts, and under
-this the body was deposited upon such a frame as
-has before been described: it was covered with fine
-cloth, and near it was placed bread-fruit, fish, and
-other provisions: we supposed that the food was
-placed there for the spirit of the deceased, and, consequently,
-that these Indians had some confused
-notion of a separate state; but upon our applying for
-further information to Tubourai Tamaide, he told
-us, that the food was placed there as an offering to
-their gods. They do not, however, suppose that the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_145'>145</span>gods eat, any more than the Jews suppose that Jehovah
-could dwell in a house: the offering is made here
-upon the same principle as the temple was built at
-Jerusalem, as an expression of reverence and gratitude,
-and a solicitation of the more immediate presence
-of the Deity. In the front of the area was a
-kind of stile, where the relations of the deceased
-stood, to pay the tribute of their sorrow; and under
-the awning were innumerable small pieces of cloth,
-on which the tears and blood of the mourners had
-been shed; for in their paroxysms of grief it is a
-universal custom to wound themselves with the shark’s
-tooth. Within a few yards two occasional houses
-were set up, in one of which some relations of the
-deceased constantly resided, and in the other the
-chief mourner, who is always a man, and who keeps
-there a very singular dress in which a ceremony is
-performed that will be described in its turn. Near
-the place where the dead are thus set up to rot the
-bones are afterwards buried.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>What can have introduced among these people the
-custom of exposing their dead above ground till the
-flesh is consumed by putrefaction, and then burying
-the bones, it is, perhaps, impossible to guess; but it
-is remarkable, that Ælian and Apollonius Rhodius
-impute a similar practice to the ancient inhabitants
-of Colchis, a country near Pontus, in Asia, now called
-Mingrelia; except that among them this manner of
-disposing of the dead did not extend to both sexes:
-the women they buried; but the men they wrapped
-in a hide, and hung up in the air by a chain. This
-practice among the Colchians is referred to a religious
-cause. The principal objects of their worship were
-the earth and the air; and it is supposed that, in
-consequence of some superstitious notion, they devoted
-their dead to both. Whether the natives of
-Otaheite had any notion of the same kind, we were
-never able certainly to determine; but we soon discovered,
-that the repositories of their dead were also
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_146'>146</span>places of worship. Upon this occasion it may be observed,
-that nothing can be more absurd than the notion
-that the happiness or misery of a future life
-depends, in any degree, upon the disposition of the
-body when the state of probation is past; yet that
-nothing is more general than a solicitude about it.
-However cheap we may hold any funeral rites which
-custom has not familiarized, or superstition rendered
-sacred, most men gravely deliberate how to prevent
-their body from being broken by the mattock and
-devoured by the worm, when it is no longer capable
-of sensation; and purchase a place for it in holy
-ground, when they believe the lot of its future existence
-to be irrevocably determined. So strong is the
-association of pleasing or painful ideas with certain
-opinions and actions which affect us while we live,
-that we involuntarily act as if it was equally certain
-that they would affect us in the same manner when
-we are dead, though this is an opinion that nobody
-will maintain. Thus it happens, that the desire of
-preserving from reproach even the name that we leave
-behind us, or of procuring it honour, is one of the
-most powerful principles of action, among the inhabitants
-of the most speculative and enlightened nations.
-Posthumous reputation, upon every principle, must be
-acknowledged to have no influence upon the dead; yet
-the desire of obtaining and securing it, no force of reason,
-no habits of thinking, can subdue, except in those
-whom habitual baseness and guilt have rendered indifferent
-to honour and shame while they lived. This,
-indeed, seems to be among the happy imperfections
-of our nature, upon which the general good of society
-in a certain measure depends; for as some crimes are
-supposed to be prevented by hanging the body of the
-criminal in chains after he is dead, so in consequence
-of the same association of ideas, much good is procured
-to society, and much evil prevented, by a desire
-of preventing disgrace or procuring honour to a
-name, when nothing but a name remains.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_147'>147</span>Perhaps no better use can be made of reading an
-account of manners altogether new, by which the
-follies and absurdities of mankind are taken out of
-that particular connection in which habit has reconciled
-them to us, than to consider in how many instances
-they are essentially the same. When an honest
-devotee of the church of Rome reads, that there
-are Indians on the banks of the Ganges who believe
-that they shall secure the happiness of a future state
-by dying with a cow’s tail in their hands, he laughs
-at their folly and superstition; and if these Indians
-were to be told, that there are people upon the
-continent of Europe, who imagine that they shall
-derive the same advantage from dying with the
-slipper of St. Francis upon their foot, they would
-laugh in their turn. But if, when the Indian heard
-the account of the Catholic, and the Catholic that
-of the Indian, each was to reflect, that there was
-no difference between the absurdity of the slipper
-and of the tail; but that the veil of prejudice and
-custom, which covered it in their own case, was
-withdrawn in the other, they would turn their knowledge
-to a profitable purpose.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Having observed that bread-fruit had for some
-days been brought in less quantities than usual, we
-enquired the reason; and were told, that there being
-a great show of fruit upon the trees, they had been
-thinned all at once, in order to make a kind of sour
-paste, which the natives call <i>Mahie</i>, and which, in
-consequence of having undergone a fermentation,
-will keep a considerable time, and supply them with
-food when no ripe fruit is to be had.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 10th the ceremony was to be performed,
-in honour of the old woman whose sepulchral tabernacle
-has just been described, by the chief mourner;
-and Mr. Banks had so great a curiosity to see all the
-mysteries of the solemnity, that he determined to
-take a part in it, being told, that he could be present
-upon no other condition. In the evening, therefore,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_148'>148</span>he repaired to the place where the body lay, and was
-received by the daughter of the deceased, and several
-other persons, among whom was a boy about fourteen
-years old, who were to assist in the ceremony. Tubourai
-Tamaide was to be the principal mourner;
-and his dress, which was extremely fantastical, though
-not unbecoming, is represented by a figure in one of
-the plates. Mr. Banks was stripped of his European
-clothes, and a small piece of cloth being tied round
-his middle, his body was smeared with charcoal and
-water, as low as the shoulders, till it was as black as
-that of a negro: the same operation was performed
-upon several others, among whom were some women,
-who were reduced to a state as near to nakedness as
-himself; the boy was blacked all over, and then the
-procession set forward. Tubourai Tamaide uttered
-something, which was supposed to be a prayer, near
-the body; and did the same when he came up to his
-own house: when this was done, the procession was
-continued towards the fort, permission having been
-obtained to approach it upon this occasion. It is the
-custom of the Indians to fly from these processions
-with the utmost precipitation, so that as soon as those
-who were about the fort saw it at a distance they
-hid themselves in the woods. It proceeded from the
-fort along the shore, and put to flight another body
-of Indians, consisting of more than a hundred, every
-one hiding himself under the first shelter that he
-could find: it then crossed the river, and entered the
-woods, passing several houses, all which were deserted,
-and not a single Indian could be seen during
-the rest of the procession, which continued more than
-half an hour. The office that Mr. Banks performed,
-was called that of the <i>Nineveh</i>, of which there were
-two besides himself; and the natives having all disappeared,
-they came to the chief mourner, and said,
-<i>Imatata</i>, there are no people; after which the company
-was dismissed to wash themselves in the river,
-and put on their customary apparel.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_149'>149</span>On the 12th, complaint being made to me, by
-some of the natives, that two of the seamen had
-taken from them several bows and arrows, and some
-strings of plaited hair, I examined the matter, and
-finding the charge well supported, I punished each
-of the criminals with two-dozen lashes.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their bows and arrows have not been mentioned
-before, nor were they often brought down to the
-fort. This day, however, Tubourai Tamaide brought
-down his, in consequence of a challenge which he
-had received from Mr. Gore. The chief supposed
-it was to try who could send the arrow farthest; Mr.
-Gore, who best could hit a mark; and as Mr. Gore
-did not value himself upon shooting to a great distance,
-nor the chief upon hitting a mark, there was
-no trial of skill between them. Tubourai Tamaide,
-however, to show us what he could do, drew his
-bow, and sent an arrow, none of which are feathered,
-two hundred and seventy-four yards, which is something
-more than a seventh, and something less than a
-sixth part of a mile. Their manner of shooting is
-somewhat singular; they kneel down, and the moment
-the arrow is discharged drop the bow.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Mr. Banks, in his morning walk this day, met a
-number of the natives, whom, upon enquiry, he
-found to be travelling musicians; and having learnt
-where they were to be at night, we all repaired to
-the place. The band consisted of two flutes and
-three drums, and we found a great number of people
-assembled upon the occasion. The drummers accompanied
-the music with their voices, and, to our
-great surprise, we discovered that we were generally
-the subject of the song. We did not expect to have
-found among the uncivilized inhabitants of this sequestered
-spot a character, which has been the subject
-of such praise and veneration where genius and
-knowledge have been most conspicuous; yet these
-were the bards or minstrels of Otaheite. Their song
-was unpremeditated, and accompanied with music;
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_150'>150</span>they were continually going about from place to
-place, and they were rewarded by the master of the
-house, and the audience, with such things as one
-wanted and the other could spare.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 14th, we were brought into new difficulties
-and inconvenience by another robbery at the fort.
-In the middle of the night, one of the natives contrived
-to steal an iron coal-rake, that was made use
-of for the oven. It happened to be set up against
-the inside of the wall, so that the top of the handle
-was visible from without; and we were informed
-that the thief, who had been seen lurking there in
-the evening, came secretly about three o’clock in the
-morning, and, watching his opportunity when the
-sentinel’s back was turned, very dexterously laid hold
-of it with a long crooked stick, and drew it over the
-wall. I thought it of some consequence, if possible,
-to put an end to these practices at once, by doing
-something that should make it the common interest
-of the natives themselves to prevent them. I had
-given strict orders that they should not be fired upon,
-even when detected in these attempts, for which I
-had many reasons: the common sentinels were by no
-means fit to be intrusted with a power of life and
-death, to be exerted whenever they should think fit,
-and I had already experienced that they were ready
-to take away the lives that were in their power upon
-the slightest occasion; neither, indeed, did I think
-that the thefts which these people committed
-against us were, in them, crimes worthy of death:
-that thieves are hanged in England, I thought no
-reason why they should be shot in Otaheite; because,
-with respect to the natives, it would have been an
-execution by a law <i><span lang="la" xml:lang="la">ex post facto</span></i>. They had no such
-law among themselves, and it did not appear to me
-that we had any right to make such a law for them.
-That they should abstain from theft, or be punished
-with death, was not one of the conditions under
-which they claimed the advantages of civil society,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_151'>151</span>as it is among us; and as I was not willing to expose
-them to fire-arms, loaded with shot, neither
-could I perfectly approve of firing only with powder.
-At first, indeed, the noise and the smoke would
-alarm them, but when they found that no mischief
-followed, they would be led to despise the weapons
-themselves, and proceed to insults, which would
-make it necessary to put them to the test, and from
-which they would be deterred by the very sight of a
-gun, if it was never used but with effect. At this
-time an accident furnished me with what I thought
-a happy expedient. It happened that above twenty
-of their sailing canoes were just come in with a supply
-of fish: upon these I immediately seized, and
-bringing them into the river behind the fort, gave
-public notice, that except the rake, and all the rest
-of the things which from time to time had been
-stolen, were returned, the canoes should be burnt.
-This menace I ventured to publish, though I had no
-design to put it into execution, making no doubt but
-that it was well known in whose possession the stolen
-goods were, and that as restitution was thus made a
-common cause, they would all of them in a short
-time be brought back. A list of the things was
-made out, consisting principally of the rake, the
-musket which had been taken from the marine when
-the Indian was shot; the pistols which Mr. Banks
-lost with his clothes at Atahourou; a sword belonging
-to one of the petty officers, and the water-cask.
-About noon, the rake was restored, and great solicitation
-was made for the release of the canoes; but I
-still insisted upon my original condition. The next
-day came, and nothing farther was restored, at which
-I was much surprised, for the people were in the utmost
-distress for the fish, which in a short time would
-be spoilt; I was, therefore, reduced to a disagreeable
-situation, either of releasing the canoes, contrary to
-what I had solemnly and publicly declared, or to detain
-them, to the great injury of those who were innocent,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_152'>152</span>without answering any good purpose to ourselves:
-as a temporary expedient, I permitted them
-to take the fish; but still detained the canoes. This
-very licence, however, was productive of new confusion
-and injury; for, it not being easy at once to
-distinguish to what particular persons the several lots
-of fish belonged, the canoes were plundered, under
-favour of this circumstance, by those who had no
-right to any part of their cargo. Most pressing
-instances were still made that the canoes might be
-restored; and I having now the greatest reason to
-believe, either that the things for which I detained
-them were not in the island, or that those who suffered
-by their detention had not sufficient influence
-over the thieves to prevail upon them to relinquish
-their booty, determined at length to give them up,
-not a little mortified at the bad success of my project.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Another accident also about this time was, notwithstanding
-all our caution, very near embroiling
-us with the Indians. I sent the boat on shore with
-an officer to get ballast for the ship, and not immediately
-finding stones convenient for the purpose, he
-began to pull down some part of an enclosure where
-they deposited the bones of their dead. This the Indians
-violently opposed, and a messenger came down
-to the tents to acquaint the officers that they would
-not suffer it. Mr. Banks immediately repaired to
-the place, and an amicable end was soon put to the
-dispute by sending the boat’s crew to the river,
-where stones enough were to be gathered without a
-possibility of giving offence. It is very remarkable,
-that these Indians appeared to be much more jealous
-of what was done to the dead than the living. This
-was the only measure in which they ventured to oppose
-us, and the only insult that was offered to any
-individual among us was upon a similar occasion.
-Mr. Monkhouse, happening one day to pull a flower
-from a tree which grew in one of their sepulchral
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_153'>153</span>enclosures, an Indian, whose jealousy had probably
-been upon the watch, came suddenly behind him,
-and struck him. Mr. Monkhouse laid hold of him,
-but he was instantly rescued by two more, who took
-hold of Mr. Monkhouse’s hair, and forced him to quit
-his hold of their companion, and then ran away without
-offering him any farther violence.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the evening of the 19th, while the canoes were
-still detained, we received a visit from Oberea, which
-surprised us not a little, as she brought with her none
-of the things that had been stolen, and knew that she
-was suspected of having some of them in her custody.
-She said, indeed, that her favourite Obadee, whom
-she had beaten and dismissed, had taken them away;
-but she seemed conscious, that she had no right to
-be believed. She discovered the strongest signs of
-fear, yet she surmounted it with astonishing resolution;
-and was very pressing to sleep with her attendants
-in Mr. Banks’s tent. In this, however, she
-was not gratified; the affair of the jacket was too
-recent, and the tent was besides filled with other
-people. Nobody else seemed willing to entertain
-her, and she, therefore, with great appearance of
-mortification and disappointment, spent the night in
-her canoe.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The next morning early, she returned to the fort
-with her canoe, and every thing that it contained,
-putting herself wholly into our power, with something
-like greatness of mind, which excited our wonder
-and admiration. As the most effectual means to
-bring about a reconciliation, she presented us with a
-hog, and several other things, among which was a
-dog. We had lately learnt, that these animals were
-esteemed by the Indians as more delicate food than
-their pork; and upon this occasion we determined
-to try the experiment. The dog, which was very fat,
-we consigned over to Tupia, who undertook to perform
-the double office of butcher and cook. He
-killed him by holding his hands close over his mouth
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_154'>154</span>and nose, an operation which continued above a
-quarter of an hour. While this was doing, a hole
-was made in the ground about a foot deep, in which
-a fire was kindled, and some small stones placed in
-layers alternately with the wood to heat; the dog
-was then singed, by holding him over the fire, and,
-by scraping him with a shell, the hair taken off as
-clean as if he had been scalded in hot water: he was
-then cut up with the same instrument, and his entrails,
-being taken out, were sent to the sea, where,
-being carefully washed, they were put into cocoa-nut
-shells, with what blood had come from the body.
-When the hole was sufficiently heated, the fire was
-taken out, and some of the stones, which were not so
-hot as to discolour any thing that they touched, being
-placed at the bottom, were covered with green
-leaves. The dog, with the entrails, was then placed
-upon the leaves, and other leaves being laid upon
-them, the whole was covered with the rest of the hot
-stones, and the mouth of the hole close stopped with
-mould. In somewhat less than four hours it was again
-opened, and the dog taken out excellently baked,
-and we all agreed that he made a very good dish.
-The dogs which are here bred to be eaten taste no
-animal food, but are kept wholly upon bread-fruit,
-cocoa-nuts, yams, and other vegetables of the like
-kind: all the flesh and fish eaten by the inhabitants
-is dressed in the same way.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 21st we were visited at the fort by a chief,
-called <span class='sc'>Oamo</span>, whom we had never seen before, and
-who was treated by the natives with uncommon respect;
-he brought with him a boy about seven years
-old, and a young woman about sixteen: the boy was
-carried upon a man’s back, which we considered as a
-piece of state, for he was as well able to walk as any
-present. As soon as they were in sight, Oberea, and
-several other natives who were in the fort, went out
-to meet them, having first uncovered their heads and
-bodies as low as the waist: as they came on, the same
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_155'>155</span>ceremony was performed by all the natives who were
-without the fort. Uncovering the body, therefore,
-is in this country probably a mark of respect; and
-as all parts are here exposed with equal indifference,
-the ceremony of uncovering it from the waist downwards,
-which was performed by Oorattooa, might be
-nothing more than a different mode of compliment,
-adapted to persons of a different rank. The chief
-came into the tent, but no entreaty could prevail upon
-the young woman to follow him, though she seemed
-to refuse contrary to her inclination. The natives without
-were, indeed, all very solicitous to prevent her,
-sometimes, when her resolution seemed to fail, almost
-using force: the boy also they restrained in the same
-manner; but Dr. Solander, happening to meet him at
-the gate, took him by the hand, and led him in before
-the people were aware of it. As soon, however, as
-those that were within saw him, they took care to
-have him sent out.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>These circumstances having strongly excited our
-curiosity, we inquired who they were, and were informed,
-that Oamo was the husband of Oberea,
-though they had been a long time separated by mutual
-consent; and that the young woman and the boy
-were their children. We learnt also, that the boy,
-whose name was <span class='sc'>Terridiri</span>, was heir-apparent to the
-sovereignty of the island, and that his sister was intended
-for his wife, the marriage being deferred only
-till he should arrive at a proper age. The sovereign
-at this time was a son of <span class='sc'>Whappai</span>, whose name was
-<span class='sc'>Outou</span>, and who, as before has been observed, was a
-minor. Whappai, Oamo, and Tootahah, were
-brothers: Whappai was the eldest, and Oamo the second;
-so that, Whappai having no child but Outou,
-Terridiri, the son of his next brother Oamo, was heir
-to the sovereignty. It will, perhaps, seem strange
-that a boy should be sovereign during the life of his
-father; but, according to the custom of the country,
-a child succeeds to a father’s title and authority
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_156'>156</span>as soon as it is born: a regent is then elected, and
-the father of the new sovereign is generally continued
-in his authority, under that title, till his child
-is of age; but, at this time, the choice had fallen
-upon Tootahah, the uncle, in consequence of his
-having distinguished himself in a war. Oamo asked
-many questions concerning England and its inhabitants,
-by which he appeared to have great shrewdness
-and understanding.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_157'>157</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. XV.<br /> <br />AN ACCOUNT OF THE CIRCUMNAVIGATION OF THE ISLAND, AND VARIOUS INCIDENTS THAT HAPPENED DURING THE EXPEDITION; WITH A DESCRIPTION OF A BURYING-PLACE AND PLACE OF WORSHIP, CALLED A MORAI.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>On</span> Monday, the 26th, about three o’clock in the
-morning, I set out in the pinnace, accompanied by
-Mr. Banks, to make the circuit of the island, with a
-view to sketch out the coast and harbours. We took
-our route to the eastward, and about eight in the
-forenoon we went on shore, in a district called <span class='sc'>Oahounue</span>,
-which is governed by <span class='sc'>Ahio</span>, a young chief,
-whom we had often seen at the tents, and who favoured
-us with his company to breakfast. Here also
-we found two other natives of our old acquaintance,
-<span class='sc'>Tituboalo</span> and <span class='sc'>Hoona</span>, who carried us to their
-houses, near which we saw the body of the old woman,
-at whose funeral rites Mr. Banks had assisted, and
-which had been removed hither from the spot where
-it was first deposited, this place having descended
-from her by inheritance to Hoona, and it being necessary
-on that account that it should lie here. We
-then proceeded on foot, the boat attending within
-call, to the harbour in which Mr. Bougainville lay,
-called <span class='sc'>Ohidea</span>, where the natives showed us the
-ground upon which his people pitched their tent, and
-the brook at which they watered, though no trace of
-them remained, except the holes where the poles of
-the tent had been fixed, and a small piece of potsheard,
-which Mr. Banks found in looking narrowly
-about the spot. We met, however, with <span class='sc'>Orette</span>, a
-chief who was their principal friend, and whose
-brother, <span class='sc'>Outorrou</span>, went away with them.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This harbour lies on the west side of a great bay,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_158'>158</span>under shelter of a small island called Boourou, near
-which is another called <span class='sc'>Taawirrii</span>; the breach in the
-reefs is here very large, but the shelter for the ships
-is not the best.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Soon after we had examined this place, we took
-boat, and asked Tituboalo to go with us to the other
-side of the bay; but he refused, and advised us not
-to go, for he said the country there was inhabited by
-people who were not subject to Tootahah, and who
-would kill both him and us. Upon receiving this intelligence,
-we did not, as may be imagined, relinquish
-our enterprise; but we immediately loaded our pieces
-with ball: this was so well understood by Tituboalo
-as a precaution which rendered us formidable, that
-he now consented to be of our party.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Having rowed till it was dark, we reached a low
-neck of land, or isthmus, at the bottom of the bay,
-that divides the island into two peninsulas, each of
-which is a district or government wholly independent
-of the other. From Port-Royal, where the ship was
-at anchor, the coast trends E. by S. and E. S. E. ten
-miles, then S. by E. and S. eleven miles to the isthmus.
-In the first direction, the shore is in general open to
-the sea; but in the last it is covered by reefs of rocks,
-which form several good harbours, with safe anchorage,
-in 16, 18, 20, and 24 fathom of water, with
-other conveniences. As we had not yet got into our
-enemy’s country, we determined to sleep on shore.
-We landed, and though we found but few houses, we
-saw several double canoes, whose owners were well
-known to us, and who provided us with supper and
-lodging; of which Mr. Banks was indebted for his
-share to Ooratooa, the lady who had paid him her
-compliments in so singular a manner at the fort.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the morning we looked about the country, and
-found it to be a marshy flat, about two miles over,
-across which the natives haul their canoes to the corresponding
-bay on the other side. We then prepared
-to continue our route for what Tituboalo called the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_159'>159</span>other kingdom; he said that the name of it was
-<span class='sc'>Tiarrabou</span>, or <span class='sc'>Otaheite Ete</span>; and that of the chief
-who governed it <span class='sc'>Waheatua</span>. Upon this occasion, also,
-we learnt that the name of the peninsula where we
-had taken our station was <span class='sc'>Opoureonu</span>, or <span class='sc'>Otaheite
-Nue</span>. Our new associate seemed to be now in better
-spirits than he had been the day before: the people in
-Tiarrabou would not kill us, he said; but he assured
-us that we should be able to procure no victuals
-among them; and, indeed, we had seen no bread-fruit
-since we set out.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After rowing a few miles, we landed in a district,
-which was the dominion of a chief called <span class='sc'>Maraitata</span>,
-the burying-place of men, whose father’s name was
-<span class='sc'>Pahairedo</span>, the stealer of boats. Though these
-names seemed to favour the account that had been
-given by Tituboalo, we soon found that it was not
-true. Both the father and the son received us with
-the greatest civility, gave us provisions, and, after
-some delay, sold us a very large hog for a hatchet. A
-crowd soon gathered round us, but we saw only two
-people that we knew; neither did we observe a single
-bead or ornament among them that had come from
-our ship, though we saw several things which had
-been brought from Europe. In one of the houses lay
-two twelve-pound shot, one of which was marked with
-the broad arrow of England, though the people said
-they had them from the ships that lay in Bougainville’s
-harbour.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We proceeded on foot till we came to the district
-which was immediately under the government of the
-principal chief, or king of the peninsula, Waheatua.
-Waheatua had a son, but whether, according to the
-custom of Opoureonu, he administered the government
-as regent, or in his own right, is uncertain.
-This district consists of a large and fertile plain, watered
-by a river so wide, that we were obliged to ferry
-over it in a canoe: our Indian train, however, chose
-to swim, and took to the water with the same facility
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_160'>160</span>as a pack of hounds. In this place we saw no
-house that appeared to be inhabited, but the ruins of
-many that had been very large. We proceeded along
-the shore, which forms a bay, called <span class='sc'>Oaitipeha</span>,
-and at last we found the chief sitting near some
-pretty canoe awnings, under which, we supposed,
-he and his attendants slept. He was a thin old man,
-with a very white head and beard, and had with him
-a comely woman, about five-and-twenty years old,
-whose name was <span class='sc'>Toudidde</span>. We had often heard the
-name of this woman, and, from report and observation,
-we had reason to think that she was the <span class='sc'>Oberea</span>
-of this peninsula. From this place, between which
-and the isthmus there are other harbours, formed by
-the reefs that lie along the shore, where shipping
-may lie in perfect security, and from whence the land
-trends S. S. E. and S. to the S. E. part of the island,
-we were accompanied by <span class='sc'>Tearee</span>, the son of Waheatua,
-of whom we had purchased a hog, and the
-country we passed through appeared to be more cultivated
-than any we had seen in other parts of the
-island: the brooks were every where banked into
-narrow channels with stone, and the shore had also a
-facing of stone, where it was washed by the sea. The
-houses were neither large nor numerous, but the canoes
-that were hauled up along the shore were almost
-innumerable, and superior to any that we had seen
-before, both in size and make; they were longer, the
-sterns were higher, and the awnings were supported by
-pillars. At almost every point there was a sepulchral
-building, and there were many of them also inland.
-They were of the same figure as those in Opoureonu,
-but they were cleaner and better kept, and decorated
-with many carved boards, which were set upright,
-and on the top of which were various figures
-of birds and men. On one in particular, there was
-the representation of a cock, which was painted
-red and yellow, to imitate the feathers of that animal,
-and rude images of men were, in some of them,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_161'>161</span>placed one upon the head of another. But in this
-part of the country, however fertile and cultivated,
-we did not see a single bread-fruit: the trees were
-entirely bare; and the inhabitants seemed to subsist
-principally upon nuts, which are not unlike a chesnut,
-and which they call <i>Ahee</i>.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When we had walked till we were weary, we called
-up the boat, but both our Indians, Tituboalo and Tuahow,
-were missing: they had, it seems, stayed behind
-at Waheatua’s, expecting us to return thither,
-in consequence of a promise which had been extorted
-from us, and which we had it not in our power to
-fulfil.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Tearee, however, and another, embarked with us,
-and we proceeded till we came abreast of a small
-island called <span class='sc'>Otooareite</span>; it being then dark, we
-determined to land, and our Indians conducted us to
-a place where they said we might sleep: it was a deserted
-house, and near it was a little cove, in which
-the boat might lie with great safety and convenience.
-We were, however, in want of provisions, having
-been very sparingly supplied since we set out; and
-Mr. Banks immediately went into the woods to see
-whether any could be procured. As it was dark, he
-met with no people, and could find but one house that
-was inhabited: a bread-fruit and a half, a few ahees,
-and some fire, were all that it afforded; upon which,
-with a duck or two, and a few curlieus, we made our
-supper, which, if not scanty, was disagreeable, by
-the want of bread, with which we had neglected to
-furnish ourselves, as we depended upon meeting with
-bread-fruit, and took up our lodging under the
-awning of a canoe belonging to Tearee, which followed
-us.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The next morning, after having spent some time
-in another fruitless attempt to procure a supply of
-provisions, we proceeded round the south-east point,
-part of which is not covered by any reef, but lies
-open to the sea; and here the hill rises directly from
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_162'>162</span>the shore. At the southernmost part of the island,
-the shore is again covered by a reef, which forms a
-good harbour; and the land about it is very fertile.
-We made this rout partly on foot, and partly in the
-boat: when we had walked about three miles, we arrived
-at a place where we saw several large canoes,
-and a number of people with them, whom we were
-agreeably surprised to find were of our intimate acquaintance.
-Here, with much difficulty, we procured
-some cocoa-nuts, and then embarked, taking
-with us Tuahow, one of the Indians who had waited
-for us at Waheatua’s, and had returned the night before,
-long after it was dark.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When we came abreast of the south-east end
-of the island, we went ashore, by the advice of
-our Indian guide, who told us that the country
-was rich and good. The chief, whose name was
-<span class='sc'>Mathiabo</span>, soon came down to us, but seemed to be
-a total stranger both to us and to our trade: his subjects,
-however, brought us plenty of cocoa-nuts, and
-about twenty bread-fruit. The bread-fruit we bought
-at a very dear rate, but his excellency sold us a pig for
-a glass-bottle, which he preferred to every thing else
-that we could give him. We found in his possession
-a goose and a turkey-cock, which, we were informed,
-had been left upon the island by the Dolphin: they
-were both enormously fat, and so tame that they followed
-the Indians, who were fond of them to excess,
-wherever they went.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In a long house in this neighbourhood, we saw what
-was altogether new to us. At one end of it, fastened
-to a semicircular board, hung fifteen human jaw-bones:
-they appeared to be fresh; and there was not one of
-them that wanted a single tooth. A sight so extraordinary,
-strongly excited our curiosity, and we made
-many enquiries about it; but at this time could get
-no information, for the people either could not, or
-would not, understand us.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_163'>163</span>When we left this place, the chief, Mathiabo, desired
-leave to accompany us, which was readily
-granted. He continued with us the remainder of the
-day, and proved very useful, by piloting us over the
-shoals. In the evening, we opened the bay on the
-north-west side of the island, which answered to that
-on the south-east, so as at the isthmus, or carrying
-place, almost to intersect the island, as I have observed
-before; and when we had coasted about two-thirds
-of it, we determined to go on shore for the
-night. We saw a large house at some distance,
-which Mathiabo informed us belonged to one of
-his friends; and soon after several canoes came off to
-meet us, having on board some very handsome women,
-who, by their behaviour, seemed to have been
-sent to entice us on shore. As we had before resolved
-to take up our residence here for the night,
-little invitation was necessary. We found that the
-house belonged to the chief of the district, whose
-name was <span class='sc'>Wiverou</span>: he received us in a very friendly
-manner, and ordered his people to assist us in dressing
-our provision, of which we had now got a tolerable
-stock. When our supper was ready, we were
-conducted into that part of the house where Wiverou
-was sitting, in order to eat it: Mathiabo supped with
-us; and Wiverou calling for his supper at the same
-time, we ate our meal very sociably, and with great
-good humour. When it was over, we began to enquire
-where we were to sleep, and a part of the house
-was shown us, of which we were told we might take
-possession for that purpose. We then sent for our
-cloaks, and Mr. Banks began to undress, as his custom
-was, and, with a precaution which he had been
-taught by the loss of the jackets at Atahourou, sent
-his clothes aboard the boat, proposing to cover himself
-with a piece of Indian cloth. When Mathiabo
-perceived what was doing, he also pretended to want
-a cloak; and, as he had behaved very well, and done
-us some service, a cloak was ordered for him. We
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_164'>164</span>lay down, and observed that Mathiabo was not with
-us; but we supposed that he was gone to bathe, as
-the Indians always do before they sleep. We had not
-waited long, however, when an Indian, who was a
-stranger to us, came and told Mr. Banks, that the
-cloak and Mathiabo had disappeared together. This
-man had so far gained our confidence, that we did
-not at first believe the report; but it being soon after
-confirmed by Tuahow, our own Indian, we knew no
-time was to be lost. As it was impossible for us to
-pursue the thief with any hope of success, without
-the assistance of the people about us, Mr. Banks
-started up, and telling our case, required them to
-recover the cloak; and to enforce this requisition,
-showed one of his pocket-pistols, which he always
-kept about him. Upon the sight of the pistol, the
-whole company took the alarm, and, instead of assisting
-to catch the thief, or recover what had been
-stolen, began with great precipitation to leave the
-place: one of them, however, was seized; upon
-which he immediately offered to direct the chase: I
-set out, therefore, with Mr. Banks; and though we
-ran all the way, the alarm had got before us; for in
-about ten minutes we met a man bringing back the
-cloak, which the thief had relinquished in great terror;
-and as we did not then think fit to continue the
-pursuit, he made his escape. When we returned, we
-found the house, in which there had been between
-two and three hundred people, entirely deserted. It
-being, however, soon known that we had no resentment
-against any body but Mathiabo, the chief,
-Wiverou, our host, with his wife, and many others,
-returned, and took up their lodgings with us for the
-night. In this place, however, we were destined to
-more confusion and trouble; for about five o’clock in
-the morning our sentry alarmed us, with an account
-that the boat was missing: he had seen her, he said,
-about half an hour before, at her grappling, which
-was not above fifty yards from the shore; but, upon
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_165'>165</span>hearing the sound of oars, he had looked out again,
-and could see nothing of her. At this account we
-started up greatly alarmed, and ran to the water-side:
-the morning was clear and star light, so that we could
-see to a considerable distance, but there was no appearance
-of the boat. Our situation was now such
-as might justify the most terrifying apprehensions:
-as it was a dead calm, and we could not therefore
-suppose her to have broken from her grappling, we
-had great reason to fear that the Indians had attacked
-her, and finding the people asleep, had succeeded in
-their enterprise: we were but four, with only one
-musket and two pocket pistols, without a spare ball
-or charge of powder for either. In this state of
-anxiety and distress we remained a considerable time,
-expecting the Indians every moment to improve their
-advantage, when, to our unspeakable satisfaction,
-we saw the boat return, which had been driven from
-her grappling by the tide; a circumstance to which,
-in our confusion and surprise, we did not advert.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As soon as the boat returned, we got our breakfast,
-and were impatient to leave the place, lest some other
-vexatious accident should befall us. It is situated on
-the north side of Tiarrabou, the south-east peninsula,
-or division, of the island, and at the distance of about
-five miles south-east from the isthmus, having a large
-and commodious harbour, inferior to none in the
-island, about which the land is very rich in produce.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Notwithstanding we had had little communication
-with this division, the inhabitants every where received
-us in a friendly manner: we found the whole
-of it fertile and populous, and, to all appearance, in
-a more flourishing state than Opoureonu, though it
-is not above one-fourth part as large.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The next district in which we landed was the last
-in Tiarrabou, and governed by a chief, whose name
-we understood to be <span class='sc'>Omoe</span>. Omoe was building a
-house, and being therefore very desirous of procuring
-a hatchet, he would have been glad to have purchased
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_166'>166</span>one with any thing that he had in his possession;
-it happened, however, rather unfortunately for
-him and us, that we had not one hatchet left in the
-boat. We offered to trade with nails, but he would
-not part with any thing in exchange for them; we
-therefore reimbarked, and put off our boat, but the
-chief being unwilling to relinquish all hope of obtaining
-something from us that would be of use to
-him, embarked in a canoe, with his wife <span class='sc'>Whannoouda</span>,
-and followed us. After some time, we took
-them into the boat, and when we had rowed about a
-league, they desired we would put ashore: we immediately
-complied with his request, and found some of
-his people, who had brought down a very large hog.
-We were as unwilling to lose the hog, as the chief
-was to part with us, and it was indeed worth the best
-axe we had in the ship; we therefore hit upon an
-expedient, and told him, that if he would bring his
-hog to the fort at <span class='sc'>Matavai</span>, the Indian name for
-Port Royal bay, he should have a large axe, and a
-nail into the bargain for his trouble. To this proposal,
-after having consulted with his wife, he agreed,
-and gave us a large piece of his country cloth as a
-pledge that he would perform his agreement, which,
-however, he never did.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At this place we saw a very singular curiosity: it
-was the figure of a man, constructed of basket-work,
-rudely made, but not ill designed; it was something
-more than seven feet high, and rather too bulky in
-proportion to its height. The wicker skeleton was
-completely covered with feathers, which were white
-where the skin was to appear, and black in the parts
-which it is their custom to paint or stain, and upon
-the head, where there was to be a representation of
-hair: upon the head also were four protuberances,
-three in front and one behind, which we should have
-called horns, but which the Indians dignified with
-the name of <span class='sc'>Tate Ete</span>, little men. The image was
-called <span class='sc'>Manioe</span>, and was said to be the only one of
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_167'>167</span>the kind in Otaheite. They attempted to give us an
-explanation of its use and design, but we had not
-then acquired enough of their language to understand
-them. We learnt, however, afterwards, that it was a
-representation of Mauwe, one of their Eatuas, or gods
-of the second class.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After having settled our affairs with Omoe, we proceeded
-on our return, and soon reached Opoureonu,
-the north-west peninsula. After rowing a few miles,
-we went on shore again, but the only thing we saw
-worth notice was a repository for the dead, uncommonly
-decorated: the pavement was extremely neat,
-and upon it was raised a pyramid, about five feet
-high, which was entirely covered with the fruits of
-two plants, peculiar to the country. Near the pyramid
-was a small image of stone, of very rude workmanship,
-and the first instance of carving in stone
-that we had seen among these people. They appeared
-to set a high value upon it, for it was covered
-from the weather by a shed, that had been erected
-on purpose.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We proceeded in the boat, and passed through the
-only harbour, on the south side of Opoureonu, that
-is fit for shipping. It is situated about five miles to
-the westward of the isthmus, between two small
-islands that lie near the shore, and about a mile distant
-from each other, and affords good anchorage in
-eleven and twelve fathom water. We were now not
-far from the district called <span class='sc'>Paparra</span>, which belonged
-to our friends Oamo and Oberea, where we proposed
-to sleep. We went on shore about an hour before
-night, and found that they were both absent, having
-left their habitations to pay us a visit at Matavai:
-this, however, did not alter our purpose, we took up
-our quarters at the house of Oberea, which, though
-small, was very neat, and at this time had no inhabitant
-but her father, who received us with looks that
-bid us welcome. Having taken possession, we were
-willing to improve the little day-light that was left
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_168'>168</span>us, and therefore walked out to a point, upon which
-we had seen, at a distance, trees that are here called
-<i>Etoa</i>, which generally distinguish the places where
-these people bury the bones of their dead: their
-name for such burying-grounds, which are also places
-of worship, is <span class='sc'>Morai</span>. We were soon struck with
-the sight of an enormous pile, which, we were told,
-was the morai of Oamo and Oberea, and the principal
-piece of Indian architecture in the island. It was a
-pile of stone work, raised pyramidically, upon an oblong
-base, or square, two hundred and sixty-seven
-feet long, and eighty-seven wide. It was built like
-the small pyramidal mounts upon which we sometimes
-fix the pillar of a sun-dial, where each side is a
-flight of steps; the steps, however, at the sides, were
-broader than those at the ends, so that it terminated,
-not in a square of the same figure with the base but
-in a ridge, like the roof of a house: there were eleven
-of these steps, each of which was four feet high, so
-that the height of the pile was forty-four feet; each
-step was formed of one course of white coral stone,
-which was neatly squared and polished; the rest of
-the mass, for there was no hollow within, consisted of
-round pebbles, which, from the regularity of their
-figure, seemed to have been wrought. Some of the
-coral stones were very large; we measured one of
-them, and found it three feet and a half by two feet
-and a half. The foundation was of rock stones,
-which were also squared; and one of them measured
-four feet seven inches by two feet four. Such a
-structure, raised without the assistance of iron tools
-to shape the stones, or mortar to join them, struck us
-with astonishment: it seemed to be as compact and
-firm as it could have been made by any workman in
-Europe, except that the steps, which range along its
-greatest length, are not perfectly strait, but sink in a
-kind of hollow in the middle, so that the whole surface,
-from end to end, is not a right line, but a curve.
-The quarry stones, as we saw no quarry in the neighbourhood,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_169'>169</span>must have been brought from a considerable
-distance; and there is no method of conveyance
-here but by hand: the coral must also have been
-fished from under the water, where, though it may
-be found in plenty, it lies at a considerable depth,
-never less than three feet. Both the rock stone and
-the coral could be squared only by tools made of the
-same substance, which must have been a work of incredible
-labour; but the polishing was more easily
-effected by means of the sharp coral sand, which is
-found every where upon the sea-shore in great abundance.
-In the middle of the top stood the image of
-a bird, carved in wood; and near it lay the broken
-one of a fish, carved in stone. The whole of this
-pyramid made part of one side of a spacious area or
-square, nearly of equal sides, being three hundred
-and sixty feet by three hundred and fifty-four, which
-was walled in with stone, and paved with flat stones
-in its whole extent; though there were growing in
-it, notwithstanding the pavement, several of the trees
-which they call <i>Etoa</i>, and plantains. About an hundred
-yards to the west of this building was another
-paved area or court, in which were several small
-stages raised on wooden pillars, about seven feet
-high, which are called by the Indians <i>Ewattas</i>, and
-seem to be a kind of altars, as upon these are placed
-provisions of all kinds as offerings to their gods: we
-have since seen whole hogs placed upon them, and
-we found here the skulls of above fifty, besides the
-skulls of a great number of dogs.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The principal object of ambition among these
-people is to have a magnificent morai, and this was
-a striking memorial of the rank and power of Oberea.
-It has been remarked, that we did not find her invested
-with the same authority that she exercised
-when the Dolphin was at this place, and we now
-learnt the reason of it. Our way from her house to
-the morai lay along the sea-side, and we observed
-every where under our feet a great number of human
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_170'>170</span>bones, chiefly ribs and vertebræ. Upon enquiring
-into the cause of so singular an appearance, we were
-told, that in the then last month of <i>Owarahew</i>, which
-answered to our December, 1768, about four or five
-months before our arrival, the people of Tiarrabou,
-the S. E. peninsula which we had just visited, made
-a descent at this place, and killed a great number of
-people, whose bones were those that we saw upon
-the shore: that, upon this occasion, Oberea, and
-Oamo, who then administered the government for
-his son, had fled to the mountains; and that the conquerors
-burnt all the houses, which were very large,
-and carried away the hogs, and what other animals
-they found. We learnt also, that the turkey and
-goose, which we had seen when we were with Mathiabo,
-the stealer of cloaks, were among the spoils: this
-accounted for their being found among people with
-whom the Dolphin had little or no communication;
-and upon mentioning the jaw-bones, which we had
-seen hanging from a board in a long house, we were
-told, that they also had been carried away as trophies,
-the people here carrying away the jaw-bones of their
-enemies, as the Indians of North America do the
-scalps.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After having thus gratified our curiosity, we returned
-to our quarters, where we passed the night
-in perfect security and quiet. By the next evening
-we arrived at Atahourou, the residence of our friend
-Tootahah, where, the last time we passed the night
-under his protection, we had been obliged to leave
-the best part of our clothes behind us. This adventure,
-however, seemed now to be forgotten on both
-sides. Our friends received us with great pleasure,
-and gave us a good supper and a good lodging, where
-we suffered neither loss nor disturbance.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The next day, Saturday, July the 1st, we got back
-to our fort at Matavai, having found the circuit of
-the island, including both peninsulas, to be about
-thirty leagues. Upon our complaining of the want
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_171'>171</span>of bread-fruit, we were told, that the produce of the
-last season was nearly exhausted; and that what was
-seen sprouting upon the trees, would not be fit to use
-in less than three months: this accounted for our
-having been able to procure so little of it in our
-route.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>While the bread-fruit is ripening upon the flats,
-the inhabitants are supplied in some measure from
-the trees which they have planted upon the hills to
-preserve a succession; but the quantity is not sufficient
-to prevent scarcity: they live therefore upon
-the sour paste, which they call <i>Mahie</i>, upon wild
-plantains, and ahee-nuts, which at this time are in
-perfection. How it happened that the Dolphin,
-which was here at this season, found such plenty of
-bread-fruit upon the trees I cannot tell, except the
-season in which they ripen varies.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At our return, our Indian friends crowded about
-us, and none of them came empty-handed. Though
-I had determined to restore the canoes which had
-been detained to their owners, it had not yet been
-done; but I now released them as they were applied
-for. Upon this occasion I could not but remark with
-concern, that these people were capable of practising
-petty frauds against each other, with a deliberate
-dishonesty, which gave me a much worse opinion of
-them than I had ever entertained from the robberies
-they committed, under the strong temptation to
-which a sudden opportunity of enriching themselves
-with the inestimable metal and manufactures of
-Europe exposed them.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Among others who applied to me for the release of
-a canoe, was one <span class='sc'>Potattow</span>, a man of some consequence,
-well known to us all. I consented, supposing
-the vessel to be his own, or that he applied on
-the behalf of a friend: he went immediately to the
-beach, and took possession of one of the boats, which,
-with the assistance of his people, he began to carry
-off. Upon this, however, it was eagerly claimed by
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_172'>172</span>the right owners, who, supported by the other Indians,
-clamorously reproached him for invading their
-property, and prepared to take the canoe from him
-by force. Upon this, he desired to be heard, and
-told them, that the canoe did, indeed, once belong
-to those who claimed it; but that I, having seized it
-as a forfeit, had sold it to him for a pig. This silenced
-the clamour: the owners, knowing that from my
-power there was no appeal, acquiesced; and Potattow
-would have carried off his prize, if the dispute
-had not fortunately been overheard by some of our
-people, who reported it to me. I gave orders immediately
-that the Indians should be undeceived;
-upon which the right owners took possession of their
-canoe, and Potattow was so conscious of his guilt,
-that neither he nor his wife, who was privy to his
-knavery, could look us in the face for some time
-afterwards.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_173'>173</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. XVI.<br /> <br />AN EXPEDITION OF MR. BANKS TO TRACE THE RIVER: MARKS OF SUBTERRANEOUS FIRE: PREPARATIONS FOR LEAVING THE ISLAND: AN ACCOUNT OF TUPIA.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>On</span> the 3d, Mr. Banks set out early in the morning
-with some Indian guides, to trace our river up the
-valley from which it issues, and examine how far its
-banks were inhabited. For about six miles they met
-with houses, not far distant from each other, on each
-side of the river, and the valley was every where about
-four hundred yards wide from the foot of the hill on
-one side to the foot of that on the other; but they
-were now shown a house which they were told was
-the last that they would see. When they came up
-to it, the master of it offered them refreshments of
-cocoa-nuts and other fruits, of which they accepted.
-After a short stay, they walked forward for a considerable
-time: in bad way it is not easy to compute
-distances, but they imagined that they had walked
-about six miles farther, following the course of the
-river, when they frequently passed under vaults,
-formed by fragments of the rock, in which they were
-told people who were benighted frequently passed
-the night. Soon after they found the river banked
-by steep rocks, from which a cascade, falling with
-great violence, formed a pool, so steep, that the Indians
-said they could not pass it. They seemed, indeed,
-not much to be acquainted with the valley
-beyond this place, their business lying chiefly upon
-the declivity of the rocks on each side, and the plains
-which extended on their summits, where they found
-plenty of wild plantain, which they called <i>Vae</i>. The
-way up these rocks from the banks of the river was
-in every respect dreadful: the sides were nearly perpendicular,
-and in some places one hundred feet
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_174'>174</span>high: they were also rendered exceedingly slippery
-by the water of innumerable springs which issued
-from the fissures on the surface: yet up these precipices
-a way was to be traced by <a id='aa'></a>a succession of
-long pieces of the bark of the <i>Hibiscus tiliaceus</i>,
-which served as a rope for the climber to take hold
-of, and assisted him in scrambling from one ledge to
-another, though upon these ledges there was footing
-only for an Indian or a goat. One of these ropes
-was nearly thirty feet in length, and their guides offered
-to assist them in mounting this pass, but recommended
-another at a little distance lower down, as
-less difficult and dangerous. They took a view of
-this “better way,” but found it so bad that they did
-not choose to attempt it, as there was nothing at the
-top to reward their toil and hazard, but a grove of
-the wild plantain or vae tree, which they had often
-seen before.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>During this excursion, Mr. Banks had an excellent
-opportunity to examine the rocks, which were almost
-every where naked, for minerals; but he found not
-the least appearance of any. The stones every where,
-like those of Madeira, showed manifest tokens of
-having been burnt; nor is there a single specimen
-of any stone, among all those that were collected in
-the island, upon which there are not manifest and indubitable
-marks of fire; except, perhaps, some small
-pieces of the hatchet-stone, and even of that, other
-fragments were collected which were burnt almost to
-a pumice. Traces of fire are also manifest in the
-very clay upon the hills; and it may, therefore, not
-unreasonably be supposed, that this and the neighbouring
-islands are either shattered remains of a
-continent, which some have supposed to be necessary
-in this part of the globe, to preserve an equilibrium
-of its parts, which were left behind when the rest
-sunk by the mining of a subterraneous fire, so as to
-give a passage to the sea over it; or were torn from
-rocks, which, from the creation of the world, had
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_175'>175</span>been the bed of the sea, and thrown up in heaps, to
-a height which the waters never reach. One or other
-of these suppositions will perhaps be thought the
-more probable, as the water does not gradually grow
-shallow as the shore is approached, and the islands
-are almost every where surrounded by reefs, which
-appear to be rude and broken, as some violent concussion
-would naturally leave the solid substance of
-the earth. It may also be remarked upon this occasion,
-that the most probable cause of earthquakes
-seems to be the sudden rushing in of water upon some
-vast mass of subterraneous fire, by the instantaneous
-rarefaction of which into vapour the mine is sprung,
-and various substances, in all stages of vitrification,
-with shells, and other marine productions, that are
-now found fossil, and the strata that covered the
-furnace, are thrown up; while those parts of the land
-which were supported upon the broken shell give
-way, and sink into the gulf. With this theory the
-phænomena of all earthquakes seem to agree: pools
-of water are frequently left where land has subsided;
-and various substances, which manifestly appear to
-have suffered by the action of fire, are thrown up.
-It is indeed true, that fire cannot subsist without air;
-but this cannot be urged against there being fire
-below that part of the earth which forms the bed of
-the sea; because there may be innumerable fissures
-by which a communication between those parts and
-the external air may be kept up, even upon the highest
-mountains, and at the greatest distance from the sea-shore.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 4th, Mr. Banks employed himself in planting
-a great quantity of the seeds of water melons,
-oranges, lemons, limes, and other plants and trees
-which he had collected at Rio de Janeiro. For
-these he prepared ground on each side of the fort,
-with as many varieties of soil as he could choose; and
-there is little doubt but that they will succeed. He
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_176'>176</span>also gave liberally of these seeds to the Indians, and
-planted many of them in the woods: some of the
-melon seeds having been planted soon after our arrival,
-the natives showed him several of the plants
-which appeared to be in the most flourishing condition,
-and were continually asking him for more.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We now began to prepare for our departure, by
-bending the sails and performing other necessary
-operations on board the ship, our water being already
-on board, and the provisions examined. In the
-mean time we had another visit from Oamo, Oberea,
-and their son and daughter; the Indians expressing
-their respect by uncovering the upper parts of their
-body as they had done before. The daughter, whose
-name we understood to be <span class='sc'>Toimata</span>, was very desirous
-to see the fort, but her father would by no
-means suffer her to come in. Tearee, the son of Waheatua,
-the sovereign of Tiarrabou, the south-east
-peninsula, was also with us at this time; and we received
-intelligence of the landing of another guest,
-whose company was neither expected nor desired:
-this was no other than the ingenious gentleman who
-contrived to steal our quadrant. We were told, that
-he intended to try his fortune again in the night;
-but the Indians all offered very zealously to assist us
-against him, desiring that, for this purpose, they
-might be permitted to lie in the fort. This had so
-good an effect, that the thief relinquished his enterprise
-in despair.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 7th, the carpenters were employed in taking
-down the gates and pallisadoes of our little fortification,
-for firewood on board the ship; and one
-of the Indians had dexterity enough to steal the
-staple and hook upon which the gate turned: he
-was immediately pursued, and after a chace of six
-miles, he appeared to have been passed, having concealed
-himself among some rushes in the brook; the
-rushes were searched, and though the thief had
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_177'>177</span>escaped, a scraper was found which had been stolen
-from the ship some time before; and soon after our
-old friend Tubourai Tamaide brought us the staple.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 8th and 9th, we continued to dismantle
-our fort, and our friends still flocked about us; some,
-I believe, sorry at the approach of our departure,
-and others desirous to make as much as they could
-of us while we staid.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We were in hopes that we should now leave the
-island, without giving or receiving any other offence;
-but it unfortunately happened otherwise. Two
-foreign seamen having been out with my permission,
-one of them was robbed of his knife, and endeavouring
-to recover it, probably with circumstances of
-great provocation, the Indians attacked him, and
-dangerously wounded him with a stone; they wounded
-his companion also slightly in the head, and then
-fled into the mountains. As I should have been
-sorry to take any farther notice of the affair, I was
-not displeased that the offenders had escaped; but I
-was immediately involved in a quarrel which I very
-much regretted, and which yet it was not possible to
-avoid.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the middle of the night between the 8th and
-9th, Clement Webb and Samuel Gibson, two of the
-marines, both young men, went privately from the
-fort, and in the morning were not to be found. As
-public notice had been given, that all hands were to
-go on board on the next day, and that the ship would
-sail on the morrow of that day or the day following,
-I began to fear that the absentees intended to stay
-behind. I knew that I could take no effectual steps
-to recover them, without endangering the harmony
-and good-will which at present subsisted among us;
-and therefore determined to wait a day for the chance
-of their return.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On Monday morning the 10th, the marines, to my
-great concern, not being returned, an enquiry was
-made after them of the Indians, who frankly told us,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_178'>178</span>that they did not intend to return, and had taken refuge
-in the mountains, where it was impossible for
-our people to find them. They were then requested
-to assist in the search, and after some deliberation,
-two of them undertook to conduct such persons as I
-should think proper to send after them to the place
-of their retreat. As they were known to be without
-arms, I thought two would be sufficient, and accordingly
-dispatched a petty officer, and the corporal
-of the marines, with the Indian guides, to fetch
-them back. As the recovery of these men was a matter
-of great importance, as I had no time to lose, and
-as the Indians spoke doubtfully of their return, <a id='tell'></a>telling
-us, that they had each of them taken a wife, and
-were become inhabitants of the country, it was intimated
-to several of the chiefs who were in the fort
-with their women, among whom were Tubourai Tamaide,
-Tomio, and Oberea, that they would not be
-permitted to leave it till our deserters were brought
-back. This precaution I thought the more necessary,
-as, by concealing them a few days, they might compel
-me to go without them; and I had the pleasure
-to observe, that they received the intimation with
-very little signs either of fear or discontent; assuring
-me that my people should be secured and sent back
-as soon as possible. While this was doing at the fort,
-I sent Mr. Hicks in the pinnace to fetch Tootahah
-on board the ship, which he did, without alarming
-either him or his people. If the Indian guides
-proved faithful and in earnest, I had reason to expect
-the return of my people with the deserters before
-evening. Being disappointed, my suspicions increased;
-and night coming on, I thought it was not
-safe to let the people whom I had detained as hostages
-continue at the fort, and I therefore ordered
-Tubourai Tamaide, Oberea, and some others, to be
-taken on board the ship. This spread a general
-alarm, and several of them, especially the women,
-expressed their apprehensions with great emotion
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_179'>179</span>and many tears when they were put into the boat. I
-went on board with them, and Mr. Banks remained
-on shore, with some others whom I thought it of less
-consequence to secure.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About nine o’clock, Webb was brought back by
-some of the natives, who declared, that Gibson, and
-the petty officer and corporal, would be detained till
-Tootahah should be set at liberty. The tables were
-now turned upon me; but I had proceeded too far
-to retreat. I immediately dispatched Mr. Hicks in
-the long-boat, with a strong party of men, to rescue
-the prisoners, and told Tootahah that it behoved
-him to send some of his people with them, with
-orders to afford them effectual assistance, and to demand
-the release of my men in his name, for that I
-should expect him to answer for the contrary. He
-readily complied: this party recovered my men
-without the least opposition; and about seven
-o’clock in the morning returned with them to the
-ship, though they had not been able to recover the
-arms which had been taken from them when they
-were seized: these, however, were brought on board
-in less than half an hour, and the chiefs were immediately
-set at liberty.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When I questioned the petty officer concerning
-what had happened on shore, he told me, that neither
-the natives who went with him, nor those whom they
-met in their way, would give them any intelligence
-of the deserters; but, on the contrary, became very
-troublesome: that, as he was returning for further
-orders to the ship, he and his comrade were suddenly
-seized by a number of armed men, who having learnt
-that Tootahah was confined, had concealed themselves
-in a wood for that purpose, and who, having
-taken them at a disadvantage, forced their weapons
-out of their hands, and declared, that they would
-detain them till their chief should be set at liberty.
-He said, however, that the Indians were not unanimous
-in this measure; that some were for setting
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_180'>180</span>them at liberty, and others for detaining them; that
-an eager dispute ensued, and that from words they
-came to blows, but that the party for detaining them
-at length prevailed; that soon after Webb and
-Gibson were brought in by a party of the natives,
-as prisoners, that they also might be secured as
-hostages for the chief; but that it was, after some
-debate, resolved to send Webb to inform me of their
-resolution, to assure me that his companions were safe,
-and direct me where I might send my answer. Thus
-it appears, that, whatever were the disadvantages of
-seizing the chiefs, I should never have recovered my
-men by any other method. When the chiefs were
-set on shore from the ship, those at the fort were also
-set at liberty, and, after staying with Mr. Banks
-about an hour, they all went away. Upon this
-occasion, as they had done upon another of the same
-kind, they expressed their joy by an undeserved
-liberality, strongly urging us to accept of four hogs.
-These we absolutely refused as a present, and they as
-absolutely refusing to be paid for them, the hogs did
-not change masters. Upon examining the deserters,
-we found that the account which the Indians had
-given of them was true: they had strongly attached
-themselves to two girls, and it was their intention to
-conceal themselves till the ship had sailed, and take
-up their residence upon the island. This night every
-thing was got off from the shore, and every body
-slept on board.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Among the natives who were almost constantly
-with us, was Tupia, whose name has been often
-mentioned in this narrative. He had been, as I have
-before observed, the first minister of Oberea, when
-she was in the height of her power: he was also the
-chief Tahowa or priest of the island, consequently
-well acquainted with the religion of the country, as
-well with respect to its ceremonies as principles. He
-had also great experience and knowledge in navigation,
-and was particularly acquainted with the number
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_181'>181</span>and situation of the neighbouring islands. This
-man had often expressed a desire to go with us, and
-on the 12th in the morning, having, with the other
-natives, left us the day before, he came on board,
-with a boy about thirteen years of age, his servant, and
-urged us to let him proceed with us on our voyage.
-To have such a person on board was certainly desirable
-for many reasons; by learning his language,
-and teaching him ours, we should be able to acquire
-a much better knowledge of the customs, policy, and
-religion of the people, than our short stay among
-them could give us, I therefore gladly agreed to
-receive them on board. As we were prevented from
-sailing to-day, by having found it necessary to make
-new stocks to our small and best bower anchors, the
-old ones having been totally destroyed by the worms,
-Tupia said, he would go once more on shore, and
-make a signal for the boat to fetch him off in the
-evening. He went accordingly, and took with him
-a miniature picture of Mr. Banks, to shew his friends,
-and several little things to give them as parting
-presents.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After dinner, Mr. Banks being desirous to procure
-a drawing of the Morai belonging to Tootahah at
-Eparré, I attended him thither, accompanied by
-Dr. Solander, in the pinnace. As soon as we landed,
-many of our friends came to meet us, though some
-absented themselves in resentment of what had
-happened the day before. We immediately proceeded
-to Tootahah’s house, where we were joined
-by Oberea, with several others who had not come
-out to meet us, and a perfect reconciliation was soon
-brought about; in consequence of which they promised
-to visit us early the next day, to take a last
-farewell of us, as we told them we should certainly
-set sail in the afternoon. At this place also we found
-Tupia, who returned with us, and slept this night
-on board the ship for the first time.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the next morning, Thursday the 13th of July,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_182'>182</span>the ship was very early crowded with our friends, and
-surrounded by a multitude of canoes, which were
-filled with the natives of an inferior class. Between
-eleven and twelve we weighed anchor, and as soon
-as the ship was under sail, the Indians on board took
-their leaves, and wept, with a decent and silent
-sorrow, in which there was something very striking
-and tender: the people in the canoes, on the contrary,
-seemed to vie with each other in the loudness
-of their lamentations, which we considered rather as
-affectation than grief. Tupia sustained himself in
-this scene with a firmness and resolution truly admirable:
-he wept, indeed, but the effort that he
-made to conceal his tears, concurred, with them, to
-do him honour. He sent his last present, a shirt,
-by Otheothea, to Potomai, Tootahah’s favourite
-mistress, and then went with Mr. Banks to the mast-head,
-waving to the canoes as long as they continued
-in sight.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Thus we took leave of Otaheite, and its inhabitants,
-after a stay of just three months; for much the
-greater part of the time we lived together in the
-most cordial friendship, and a perpetual reciprocation
-of good offices. The accidental differences
-which now and then happened, could not be more
-sincerely regretted on their part than they were on
-ours: the principal causes were such as necessarily
-resulted from our situation and circumstances, in
-conjunction with the infirmities of human nature,
-from our not being able perfectly to understand each
-other, and from the disposition of the inhabitants to
-theft, which we could not at all times bear with or
-prevent. They had not, however, except in one
-instance, been attended with any fatal consequence;
-and to that accident were owing the measures that
-I took to prevent others of the same kind. I hoped,
-indeed, to have availed myself of the impression which
-had been made upon them by the lives that had been
-sacrificed in their contest with the Dolphin, so as
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_183'>183</span>that the intercourse between us should have been
-carried on wholly without bloodshed; and by this
-hope all my measures were directed during the whole
-of my continuance at the island; and I sincerely wish,
-that whoever shall next visit it, may be still more
-fortunate. Our traffic here was carried on with as
-much order as in the best regulated market in
-Europe. It was managed principally by Mr. Banks,
-who was indefatigable in procuring provisions and
-refreshments while they were to be had; but during
-the latter part of our time they became scarce, partly
-by the increased consumption at the fort and ship,
-and partly by the coming on of the season in which
-cocoa-nuts and bread-fruit fail. All kind of fruit
-we purchased for beads and nails; but no nails less
-than fortypenny were current: after a very short
-time we could never get a pig of more than ten or
-twelve pounds for less than a hatchet; because,
-though these people set a high value upon spike-nails,
-yet these being an article with which many people
-in the ship were provided, the women found a much
-more easy way of procuring them than by bringing
-down provisions.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The best articles for traffic here are axes, hatches,
-spikes, large nails, looking-glasses, knives, and beads;
-for some of which, every thing that the natives have
-may be procured. They are indeed fond of fine
-linen cloth, both white and printed; but an axe
-worth half-a-crown will fetch more than a piece of
-cloth worth twenty shillings.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_184'>184</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. XVII.<br /> <br />A PARTICULAR DESCRIPTION OF THE ISLAND; ITS PRODUCE AND INHABITANTS; THEIR DRESS, HABITATIONS, FOOD, DOMESTIC LIFE, AND AMUSEMENTS.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>We</span> found the longitude of Port-Royal bay, in this
-island, as settled by Captain Wallis, who discovered
-it on the 9th of June, 1767, to be within half a degree
-of the truth. We found Point Venus, the northern
-extremity of the island, and the eastern point of the
-bay, to lie in the longitude of 149° 13ʹ, this being
-the mean result of a great number of observations
-made upon the spot. The island is surrounded by a
-reef of coral rock, which forms several excellent bays
-and harbours, some of which have been particularly
-described, where there is room and depth of water for
-any number of the largest ships. Port-Royal bay, called
-by the natives Matavai, which is not inferior to any
-in Otaheite, may easily be known by a very high
-mountain in the middle of the island, which bears
-due south from Point Venus. To sail into it, either
-keep the west point of the reef that lies before Point
-Venus close on board, or give it a birth of near half
-a mile, in order to avoid a small shoal of coral rocks,
-on which there is but two fathom and a half of
-water. The best anchoring is on the eastern side of
-the bay, where there is sixteen and fourteen fathom
-upon an ousey bottom. The shore of the bay is a
-fine sandy beach, behind which runs a river of fresh
-water, so that any number of ships may water here
-without incommoding each other; but the only wood
-for firing, upon the whole island, is that of fruit trees,
-which must be purchased of the natives, or all hope
-of living upon good terms with them given up.
-There are some harbours to the westward of this bay
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_185'>185</span>which have not been mentioned; but, as they are
-contiguous to it, and laid down in the plan, a description
-of them is unnecessary.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The face of the country, except that part of it
-which borders upon the sea, is very uneven; it rises
-in ridges that run up into the middle of the island,
-and there form mountains, which may be seen at the
-distance of sixty miles: between the foot of these
-ridges and the sea is a border of low land, surrounding
-the whole island, except in a few places where
-the ridges rise directly from the sea: the border of
-low land is in different parts of different breadths,
-but no where more than a mile and a half. The soil,
-except upon the very tops of the ridges, is extremely
-rich and fertile, watered by a great number of rivulets
-of excellent water, and covered with fruit trees
-of various kinds, some of which are of a stately
-growth and thick foliage, so as to form one continued
-wood; and even the tops of the ridges, though
-in general they are bare, and burnt up by the sun,
-are, in some parts, not without their produce.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The low land that lies between the foot of the
-ridges and the sea, and some of the valleys, are the
-only parts of the island that are inhabited, and here
-it is populous: the houses do not form villages or
-towns, but are ranged along the whole border at the
-distance of about fifty yards from each other, with
-little plantations of plantains, the tree which furnishes
-them with cloth. The whole island, according
-to Tupia’s account, who certainly knew, could furnish
-six thousand seven hundred and eighty fighting
-men, from which the number of inhabitants may easily
-be computed.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The produce of this island is bread-fruit, cocoa-nuts,
-bananas, of thirteen sorts, the best we had ever
-eaten; plantains; a fruit not unlike an apple, which,
-when ripe, is very pleasant; sweet potatoes, yams,
-cocoas, a kind of <i>Arum</i>; a fruit known here by the
-name of <i>Jambu</i>, and reckoned most delicious; sugar-cane,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_186'>186</span>which the inhabitants eat raw; a root of the
-salop kind, called by the inhabitants <i>Pea</i>; a plant
-called <i>Ethee</i>, of which the root only is eaten; a fruit
-that grows in a pod, like that of a large kidney-bean,
-which, when it is roasted, eats very much like a
-chesnut, by the natives called <i>Ahee</i>; a tree called
-<i>Wharra</i>, called in the East Indies <i>Pandanes</i>, which
-produces fruit, something like the pine-apple; a shrub
-called <i>Nono</i>; the <i>Morinda</i>, which also produces
-fruit; a species of fern, of which the root is eaten,
-and sometimes the leaves; and a plant called <i>Theve</i>,
-of which the root also is eaten: but the fruits of the
-<i>Nono</i>, the fern, and the <i>Theve</i>, are eaten only by the
-inferior people, and in times of scarcity. All these,
-which serve the inhabitants for food, the earth produces
-spontaneously, or with so little culture, that
-they seem to be exempted from the first general
-curse, that “man should eat his bread in the sweat
-of his brow.” They have also the Chinese paper
-mulberry, <i>morus papyrifera</i>, which they call <i>Aouta</i>;
-a tree resembling the wild fig-tree of the West Indies;
-another species of fig, which they call <i>Matte</i>; the
-<i>cordia sebestina orientalis</i>, which they call <i>Etou</i>; a
-kind of Cyperus grass, which they call <i>Moo</i>; a species
-of <i>tournefortia</i>, which they call <i>Taheinoo</i>; another
-of the <i>convolvulus poluce</i>, which they call <i>Eurhe</i>;
-the <i>solanum centifolium</i>, which they call <i>Ebooa</i>; the
-<i>calophyllum mophylum</i>, which they call <i>Tamannu</i>; the
-<i>hibiscus tiliaceus</i>, called <i>Poerou</i>, a frutescent nettle;
-the <i>urtica argentea</i>, called <i>Erowa</i>; with many other
-plants which cannot here be particularly mentioned:
-those that have been named already will be referred
-to in the subsequent part of this work.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>They have no European fruit, garden stuff, pulse,
-or legumes, nor grain of any kind.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Of tame animals they have only hogs, dogs, and
-poultry; neither is there a wild animal in the island,
-except ducks, pigeons, paroquets, with a few other
-birds, and rats, there being no other quadruped, nor
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_187'>187</span>any serpent. But the sea supplies them with great
-variety of most excellent fish, to eat which is their
-chief luxury, and to catch it their principal labour.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As to the people they are of the largest size of Europeans.
-The men are tall, strong, well-limbed, and
-finely shaped. The tallest that we saw was a man
-upon a neighbouring island, called <span class='sc'>Huaheine</span>, who
-measured six feet three inches and a half. The
-women of the superior rank are also in general above
-our middle stature, but those of the inferior class are
-rather below it, and some of them are very small.
-This defect in size probably proceeds from their early
-commerce with men, the only thing in which they
-differ from their superiors, that could possibly affect
-their growth.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their natural complexion is that kind of clear
-olive, or <i>brunette</i>, which many people in Europe
-prefer to the finest white and red. In those that
-are exposed to the wind and sun, it is considerably
-deepened, but in others that live under shelter, especially
-the superior class of women, it continues of its
-native hue, and the skin is most delicately smooth
-and soft: they have no tint in their cheeks, which
-we distinguish by the name of colour. The shape of
-the face is comely, the cheek-bones are not high,
-neither are the eyes hollow, nor the brow prominent:
-the only feature that does not correspond with our
-ideas of beauty is the nose, which, in general, is
-somewhat flat; but their eyes, especially those of the
-women, are full of expression, sometimes sparkling
-with fire, and sometimes melting with softness; their
-teeth also are, almost without exception, most beautifully
-even and white, and their breath perfectly without
-taint.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The hair is almost universally black, and rather
-coarse: the men have beards, which they wear in
-many fashions, always, however, plucking out great
-part of them, and keeping the rest perfectly clean
-and neat. Both sexes also eradicate every hair from
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_188'>188</span>under their arms, and accused us of great uncleanliness
-for not doing the same. In their motions there
-is at once vigour and ease; their walk is graceful,
-their deportment liberal, and their behaviour to
-strangers and to each other affable and courteous.
-In their dispositions, also, they seemed to be brave,
-open, and candid, without either suspicion or treachery,
-cruelty or revenge; so that we placed the same
-confidence in them as in our best friends, many of
-us, particularly Mr. Banks, sleeping frequently in
-their houses in the woods, without a companion, and
-consequently wholly in their power. They were,
-however, all thieves; and when that is allowed, they
-need not much fear a competition with the people of
-any other nation upon earth. During our stay in
-this island, we saw about five or six persons, like one
-that was met by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander on the
-24th of April, in their walk to the eastward, whose
-skins were of a dead white, like the nose of a white
-horse; with white hair, beard, brows, and eye-lashes;
-red, tender eyes; a short sight, and scurfy skins,
-covered with a kind of white down; but we found
-that no two of these belonged to the same family,
-and therefore concluded, that they were not a species,
-but unhappy individuals, rendered anomalous
-by disease.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It is a custom in most countries where the inhabitants
-have long hair, for the men to cut it short, and
-the women to pride themselves in its length. Here,
-however, the contrary custom prevails; the women
-always cut it short round their ears, and the men, except
-the fishers, who are almost continually in the
-water, suffer it to flow in large waves over their
-shoulders, or tie it up in a bunch on the top of their
-heads.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>They have a custom, also, of anointing their heads,
-with what they call <i>Monoe</i>, an oil expressed from
-the cocoa-nut, in which some sweet herbs or flowers
-have been infused: as the oil is generally rancid, the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_189'>189</span>smell is at first very disagreeable to a European; and
-as they live in a hot country, and have no such thing
-as a comb, they are not able to keep their heads free
-from lice, which the children and common people
-sometimes pick out and eat; a hateful custom,
-wholly different from their manners in every other
-particular; for they are delicate and cleanly almost
-without example; and those to whom we distributed
-combs soon delivered themselves from vermin, with
-a diligence which showed that they were not more
-odious to us than to them.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>They have a custom of staining their bodies, nearly
-in the same manner as is practised in many other
-parts of the world, which they call <i>Tattowing</i>. They
-prick the skin, so as just not to fetch blood, with a
-small instrument, something in the form of a hoe;
-that part which answers to the blade is made of a
-bone or shell, scraped very thin, and is from a quarter
-of an inch to an inch and a half wide; the edge
-is cut into sharp teeth or points, from the number of
-three to twenty, according to its size: when this is
-to be used, they dip the teeth into a mixture of a
-kind of lamp-black, formed of the smoke that rises
-from an oily nut which they burn instead of candles,
-and water; the teeth, thus prepared, are placed upon
-the skin, and the handle to which they are fastened
-being struck, by quick smart blows, with a stick
-fitted to the purpose, they pierce it, and at the same
-time carry into the puncture the black composition,
-which leaves an indelible stain. The operation is
-painful, and it is some days before the wounds are
-healed. It is performed upon the youth of both
-sexes when they are about twelve or fourteen years
-of age, on several parts of the body, and in various
-figures, according to the fancy of the parent, or
-perhaps the rank of the party. The women are
-generally marked with this stain, in the form of a Z,
-on every joint of their fingers and toes, and frequently
-round the outside of their feet: the men are
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_190'>190</span>also marked with the same figure, and both men and
-women have squares, circles, crescents, and ill-designed
-representations of men, birds, or dogs, and various
-other devices impressed upon their legs, and arms,
-some of which, we were told, had significations, though
-we could never learn what they were. But the part
-on which these ornaments are lavished with the
-greatest profusion is the breech: this, in both sexes,
-is covered with a deep black; above which, arches
-are drawn one over another as high as the short ribs.
-They are often a quarter of an inch broad, and the
-edges are not <a id='stra'></a>straight lines, but indented. These
-arches are their pride, and are shown both by men
-and women with a mixture of ostentation and pleasure;
-whether as an ornament, or a proof of their
-fortitude and resolution in bearing pain, we could not
-determine. The face in general is left unmarked:
-for we saw but one instance to the contrary. Some
-old men had the greatest part of their bodies covered
-with large patches of black, deeply indented at the
-edges, like a rude imitation of flame; but we were
-told, that they came from a low island, called
-<span class='sc'>Noouoora</span>, and were not natives of Otaheite.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Mr. Banks saw the operation of <i>tattowing</i> performed
-upon the backside of a girl about thirteen
-years old. The instrument used upon this occasion
-had thirty teeth, and every stroke, of which at least
-a hundred were made in a minute, drew an ichor or
-serum a little tinged with blood. The girl bore it with
-most stoical resolution for about a quarter of an hour;
-but the pain of so many hundred punctures as she had
-received in that time then became intolerable: she first
-complained in murmurs, then wept, and at last burst
-into loud lamentations, earnestly imploring the operator
-to desist. He was, however, inexorable; and
-when she began to struggle, she was held down by
-two women, who sometimes soothed and sometimes
-chid her, and now and then, when she was most
-unruly, gave her a smart blow. Mr. Banks staid in
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_191'>191</span>a neighbouring house an hour, and the operation was
-not over when he went away; yet it was performed
-but upon one side, the other having been done some
-time before; and the arches upon the loins, in which
-they most pride themselves, and which give more
-pain than all the rest, were still to be done.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It is strange that these people should value themselves
-upon what is no distinction; for I never saw a
-native of this island, either man or woman, in a state
-of maturity, in whom these marks were wanting:
-possibly they may have their rise in superstition,
-especially as they produce no visible advantage, and
-are not made without great pain; but though we
-enquired of many hundreds, we could never get any
-account of the matter.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their clothing consists of cloth or matting of different
-kinds, which will be described among their
-other manufactures. The cloth which will not bear
-wetting they wear in dry weather, and the matting
-when it rains: they are put on in many different
-ways, just as their fancy leads them; for in their
-garments nothing is cut into shape, nor are any two
-pieces sewed together. The dress of the better sort
-of women consists of three or four pieces: one piece,
-about two yards wide, and eleven yards long, they
-wrap several times round their waist, so as to hang
-down like a petticoat as low as the middle of the leg,
-and this they call <i>Parou</i>: two or three other pieces,
-about two yards and a half long, and one wide, each
-having a hole cut in the middle, they place one upon
-another, and then putting the head through the holes,
-they bring the long ends down before and behind;
-the others remain open at the sides, and give liberty
-to the arms: this, which they call the <i>Tebuta</i>, is
-gathered round the waist, and confined with a girdle
-or sash of thinner cloth, which is long enough to go
-many times round them, and exactly resembles the
-garment worn by the inhabitants of Peru and Chili,
-which the Spaniards call <i>Poncho</i>. The dress of the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_192'>192</span>men is the same, except that, instead of suffering the
-cloth that is wound about the hips to hang down like a
-petticoat, they bring it between their legs so as to
-have some resemblance to breeches, and it is then
-called <i>Maro</i>. This is the dress of all ranks of people,
-and being universally the same as to form, the gentlemen
-and ladies distinguish themselves from the
-lower people by the quantity; some of them will
-wrap round them several pieces of cloth, eight or ten
-yards long, and two or three broad; and some throw
-a large piece loosely over their shoulders, in the
-manner of a cloak; or perhaps two pieces, if they are
-very great personages, and are desirous to appear in
-state. The inferior sort, who have only a small
-allowance of cloth from the tribes or families to
-which they belong, are obliged to be more thinly
-clad. In the heat of the day, they appear almost
-naked, the women having only a scanty petticoat,
-and the men nothing but the sash that is passed between
-their legs and fastened round the waist. As
-finery is always troublesome, and particularly in a
-hot country, where it consists in putting one covering
-upon another, the women of rank always uncover
-themselves as low as the waist in the evening, throwing
-off all that they wear on the upper part of the
-body, with the same negligence and ease as our ladies
-would lay by a cardinal or double handkerchief.
-And the chiefs, even when they visited us, though
-they had as much cloth round their middle as would
-clothe a dozen people, had frequently the rest of the
-body quite naked.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Upon their legs and feet, they wear no covering;
-but they shade their faces from the sun with little
-bonnets, either of matting or of cocoa-nut leaves,
-which they make occasionally in a few minutes. This,
-however, is not all their head-dress; the women
-sometimes wear little turbans, and sometimes a dress
-which they value much more, and which, indeed, is
-much more becoming, called <i>Tomou</i>: the <i>tomou</i>
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_193'>193</span>consists of human hair, plaited in threads, scarcely
-thicker than sewing silk. Mr. Banks has pieces of
-it above a mile in length, without a knot. These they
-wind round the head in such a manner as produces a
-very pretty effect, and in a very great quantity; for
-I have seen five or six such pieces wound about the
-head of one woman: among these threads they stick
-flowers of various kinds, particularly the Cape-jessamine,
-of which they have great plenty, as it is
-always planted near their houses. The men sometimes
-stick the tail-feather of the Tropic-bird upright in
-their hair, which, as I have observed before, is often
-tied in a bunch upon the top of their heads: sometimes
-they wear a kind of whimsical garland, made
-of flowers of various kinds, stuck into a piece of the
-rind of a plantain; or of scarlet peas, stuck with gum
-upon a piece of wood: and sometimes they wear a
-kind of wig, made of the hair of men or dogs, or
-perhaps of cocoa-nut strings, woven upon one thread,
-which is tied under their hair, so that these artificial
-honours of their head may hang down behind.
-Their personal ornaments, besides flowers, are few;
-both sexes wear ear-rings but they are placed only
-on one side: when we came they consisted of small
-pieces of shell, stone, berries, red peas, or some small
-pearls, three in a string; but our beads very soon
-supplanted them all.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The children go quite naked: the girls till they
-are three or four years old; and the boys till they are
-six or seven.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The houses, or rather dwellings, of these people,
-have been occasionally mentioned before: they are
-all built in the wood, between the sea and the mountains,
-and no more ground is cleared for each house
-than just sufficient to prevent the dropping of the
-branches from rotting the thatch with which they are
-covered; from the house, therefore, the inhabitant
-steps immediately under the shade, which is the
-most delightful that can be imagined. It consists of
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_194'>194</span>groves of bread-fruit and cocoa-nuts, without underwood,
-which are intersected, in all directions, by the
-paths that lead from one house to the other. Nothing
-can be more grateful than this shade in so warm a
-climate, nor any thing more beautiful than these
-walks. As there is no underwood, the shade cools
-without impeding the air; and the houses, having
-no walls, receive the gale from whatever point it
-blows. I shall now give a particular description of a
-house of a middling size, from which, as the structure
-is universally the same, a perfect idea may be formed
-both of those that are bigger and those that are less.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The ground which it covers is an oblong square,
-four-and-twenty feet long, and eleven wide; over
-this a roof is raised, upon three rows of pillars or
-posts, parallel to each other, one on each side, and
-the other in the middle. This roof consists of two
-flat sides inclining to each other, and terminating in
-a ridge, exactly like the roofs of our thatched houses
-in England. The utmost height within is about nine
-feet, and the eaves on each side reach to within
-about three feet and a half of the ground: below
-this, and through the whole height, at each end, it
-is open, no part of it being inclosed with a wall. The
-roof is thatched with palm-leaves, and the floor is
-covered, some inches deep, with soft hay; over this
-are laid mats, so that the whole is one cushion, upon
-which they sit in the day, and sleep in the night.
-In some houses, however, there is one stool, which is
-wholly appropriated to the master of the family;
-besides this, they have no furniture, except a few
-little blocks of wood, the upper side of which is
-hollowed into a curve, and which serves them for
-pillows.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The house is indeed principally used as a dormitory;
-for, except it rains, they eat in the open
-air, under the shade of the next tree. The clothes
-that they wear in the day serve them for covering
-in the night: the floor is the common bed of the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_195'>195</span>whole household, and is not divided by any partition.
-The master of the house and his wife sleep in the
-middle, next to them the married people, next to
-them the unmarried women, and next to them, at a
-little distance, the unmarried men: the servants, or
-<i>Toutous</i>, as they are called, sleep in the open air,
-except it rains, and in that case they come just
-within the shade.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>There are, however, houses of another kind belonging
-to the chiefs, in which there is some degree
-of privacy. These are much smaller, and so
-constructed as to be carried about in their canoes
-from place to place, and set up occasionally like a
-tent: they are enclosed on the sides with cocoa-nut
-leaves, but not so close as to exclude the air, and the
-chief and his wife sleep in them alone.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>There are houses also of a much larger size, not
-built either for the accommodation of a single chief,
-or a single family; but as common receptacles for all
-the people of a district. Some of them are two
-hundred feet long, thirty broad, and, under the ridge,
-twenty feet high: these are built and maintained at
-the common expence of the district, for the accommodation
-of which they are intended; and have on
-one side of them a large area, inclosed with low pallisadoes.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>These houses, like those of separate families, have
-no walls. Privacy, indeed, is little wanted among
-people who have not even the idea of indecency,
-and who gratify every appetite and passion before
-witnesses, with no more sense of impropriety than
-we feel when we satisfy our hunger at a social board
-with our family or friends. Those who have no idea
-of indecency with respect to actions, can have none
-with respect to words; it is, therefore, scarcely necessary
-to observe, that, in the conversation of these
-people, that which is the principal source of their
-pleasure is always the principal topic; and that
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_196'>196</span>every thing is mentioned without any restraint
-or emotion, and in the most direct terms, by both
-sexes.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Of the food eaten here the greater part is vegetable.
-Here are no tame animals except hogs, dogs,
-and poultry, as I have observed before, and these
-are by no means plenty. When a chief kills a hog,
-it is almost equally divided among his dependants;
-and, as they are very numerous, the share of each
-individual at these feasts, which are not frequent,
-must necessarily be small. Dogs and fowls fall somewhat
-more frequently to the share of the common
-people. I cannot much commend the flavour of
-their fowls; but we all agreed, that a South-sea dog
-was little inferior to an English lamb: their excellence
-is probably owing to their being kept up, and
-fed wholly upon vegetables. The sea affords them a
-great variety of fish. The smaller fish, when they
-catch any, are generally eaten raw, as we eat oysters;
-and nothing that the sea produces comes amiss to
-them: they are fond of lobsters, crabs, and other
-shell-fish, which are found upon the coast; and they
-will eat not only sea-insects, but what the seamen
-call <i>Blubbers</i>, though some of them are so tough,
-that they are obliged to suffer them to become putrid
-before they can be chewed. Of the many vegetables
-that have been mentioned already as serving them
-for food, the principal is the bread-fruit, to procure
-which costs them no trouble or labour but climbing
-a tree: the tree which produces it does not indeed
-shoot up spontaneously: but if a man plants ten of
-them in his lifetime, which he may do in about an
-hour, he will as completely fulfil his duty to his own
-and future generations as the natives of our less temperate
-climate can do by ploughing in the cold of
-winter, and reaping in the summer’s heat, as often
-as these seasons return; even if, after he has procured
-bread for his present household, he should
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_197'>197</span>convert a surplus into money, and lay it up for his
-children.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It is true, indeed, that the bread-fruit is not always
-in season; but cocoa-nuts, bananas, plantains, and a
-great variety of other fruits, supply the deficiency.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It may well be supposed, that cookery is but little
-studied by these people as an art; and, indeed, they
-have but two ways of applying fire to dress their
-food, broiling and baking; the operation of broiling
-is so simple that it requires no description, and their
-baking has been described already, (page <a href='#Page_154'>154</a>.)
-in the account of an entertainment prepared for us
-by Tupia. Hogs, and large fish, are extremely well
-dressed in the same manner; and, in our opinion,
-were more juicy and more equally done than by any
-art of cookery now practised in Europe. Bread-fruit
-is also cooked in an oven of the same kind, which
-renders it soft, and something like a boiled potatoe;
-not quite so farinaceous as a good one, but more so
-than those of the middling sort.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Of the bread-fruit they also make three dishes, by
-putting either water or the milk of the cocoa-nut to
-it, then beating it to a paste with a stone pestle, and
-afterwards mixing it with ripe plantains, bananas, or
-the sour paste which they call <i>Mahie</i>.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The mahie, which has been mentioned as a succedaneum
-for ripe bread-fruit, before the season for
-gathering a fresh crop comes on, is thus made:</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The fruit is gathered just before it is perfectly ripe,
-and being laid in heaps, is closely covered with leaves;
-in this state it undergoes a fermentation, and becomes
-disagreeably sweet: the core is then taken out
-entire, which is done by gently pulling the stalk, and
-the rest of the fruit is thrown into a hole which is
-dug for that purpose, generally in the houses, and
-neatly lined in the bottom and sides with grass; the
-whole is then covered with leaves, and heavy stones
-laid upon them: in this state it undergoes a second
-fermentation, and becomes sour, after which it will
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_198'>198</span>suffer no change for many months: it is taken out of
-the hole as it is wanted for use, and being made into
-balls, it is wrapped up in leaves and baked; after it is
-dressed, it will keep five or six weeks. It is eaten
-both cold and hot, and the natives seldom make a
-meal without it, though to us the taste was as disagreeable
-as that of a pickled olive generally is the
-first time it is eaten.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As the making of this mahie depends, like brewing,
-upon fermentation, so, like brewing, it sometimes
-fails, without their being able to ascertain the
-cause; it is very natural, therefore, that the making
-it should be connected with superstitious notions and
-ceremonies. It generally falls to the lot of the old
-women, who will suffer no creature to touch any thing
-belonging to it, but those whom they employ as assistants,
-nor even to go into that part of the house
-where the operation is carrying on. Mr. Banks happened
-to spoil a large quantity of it only by inadvertently
-touching a leaf which lay upon it. The
-old woman, who then presided over these mysteries,
-told him, that the process would fail; and immediately
-uncovered the hole in a fit of vexation and
-despair. Mr. Banks regretted the mischief he had
-done, but was somewhat consoled by the opportunity
-which it gave him of examining the preparation,
-which perhaps, but for such an accident, would
-never have offered.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Such is their food, to which salt water is the universal
-sauce, no meal being eaten without it: those
-who live near the sea have it fetched as it is wanted;
-those who live at some distance keep it in large bamboos,
-which are set up in their houses for use. Salt
-water, however, is not their only sauce; they make
-another of the kernels of cocoa-nuts, which being
-fermented till they dissolve into a paste somewhat resembling
-butter, are beaten up with salt water. The
-flavour of this is very strong, and was, when we first
-tasted it, exceedingly nauseous; a little use, however,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_199'>199</span>reconciled some of our people to it so much, that
-they preferred it to our own sauces, especially with
-fish. The natives seemed to consider it as a dainty,
-and do not use it at their common meals; possibly,
-because they think it ill management to use cocoa-nuts
-so lavishly, or, perhaps, when we were at the
-island, they were scarcely ripe enough for the purpose.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>For drink, they have in general nothing but water,
-or the juice of the cocoa-nut; the art of producing
-liquors that intoxicate, by fermentation, being happily
-unknown among them; neither have they any narcotic
-which they chew, as the natives of some other
-countries do opium, beetle-root, and tobacco. Some
-of them drank freely of our liquors, and in a few instances
-became very drunk; but the persons to whom
-this happened were so far from desiring to repeat the
-debauch, that they would never touch any of our
-liquors afterwards. We were, however, informed,
-that they became drunk by drinking a juice that is
-expressed from the leaves of a plant which they call
-<i>Ava Ava</i>. This plant was not in season when we
-were there, so that we saw no instances of its effects;
-and as they considered drunkenness as a disgrace,
-they probably would have concealed from us any instances
-which might have happened during our stay.
-This vice is almost peculiar to the chiefs, and considerable
-persons, who vie with each other in drinking
-the greatest number of draughts, each draught being
-about a pint. They keep this intoxicating juice with
-great care from their women.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Table they have none; but their apparatus for eating
-is set out with great neatness, though the articles
-are too simple and too few to allow any thing for
-show; and they commonly eat alone; but when a
-stranger happens to visit them, he sometimes makes
-a second in their mess. Of the meal of one of their
-principal people I shall give a particular description.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>He sits down under the shade of the next tree, or
-on the shady side of his house, and a large quantity
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_200'>200</span>of leaves, either of the bread-fruit or banana, are
-neatly spread before him upon the ground as a table-cloth;
-a basket is then set by him that contains his
-provision, which, if fish or flesh, is ready dressed,
-and wrapped up in leaves, and two cocoa-nut shells,
-one full of salt water, and the other of fresh: his attendants,
-which are not few, seat themselves round
-him, and when all is ready, he begins by washing
-his hands and his mouth thoroughly with the fresh
-water, and this he repeats almost continually throughout
-the whole meal; he then takes part of his provision
-out of the basket, which generally consists of
-a small fish or two, two or three bread-fruits, fourteen
-or fifteen ripe bananas, or six or seven apples;
-he first takes half a bread-fruit, peels off the rind,
-and takes out the core with his nails; of this he puts
-as much into his mouth as it can hold, and while he
-chews it, takes the fish out of the leaves, and breaks
-one of them into the salt water, placing the other,
-and what remains of the bread-fruit, upon the leaves
-that have been spread before him. When this is
-done, he takes up a small piece of the fish that has
-been broken into the salt water, with all the fingers
-of one hand, and sucks it into his <a id='mouth'></a>mouth, so as to get
-with it as much of the salt water as possible: in the
-same manner he takes the rest by different morsels,
-and between each, at least very frequently, takes a
-small sup of the salt water, either out of the cocoa-nut
-shell, or the palm of his hand: in the mean time
-one of his attendants has prepared a young cocoa-nut,
-by peeling off the outer rind with his teeth, an
-operation which to an European appears very surprising;
-but it depends so much upon slight, that many
-of us were able to do it before we left the island,
-and some that could scarcely crack a filbert: the
-master, when he chooses to drink, takes the cocoa-nut
-thus prepared, and boring a hole through the
-shell with his finger, or breaking it with a stone, he
-sucks out the liquor. When he has eaten his bread-fruit
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_201'>201</span>and fish, he begins with his plantains, one of
-which makes but a mouthful, though it be as big as
-a black-pudding; if, instead of plantains, he has apples,
-he never tastes them till they have been pared; to
-do this a shell is picked up from the ground, where
-they are always in plenty, and tossed to him by an
-attendant: he immediately begins to cut or scrape
-off the rind, but so awkwardly that great part of the
-fruit is wasted. If, instead of fish, he has flesh, he
-must have some succedaneum for a knife to divide it;
-and for this purpose a piece of bamboo is tossed to
-him, of which he makes the necessary implement by
-splitting it transversely with his nail. While all this
-has been doing, some of his attendants have been
-employed in beating bread-fruit with a stone pestle
-upon a block of wood; by being beaten in this manner,
-and sprinkled from time to time with water, it
-is reduced to the consistence of a soft paste, and is
-then put into a vessel somewhat like a butcher’s tray,
-and either made up alone, or mixed with banana or
-mahie, according to the taste of the master, by pouring
-water upon it by degrees and squeezing it often
-through the hand: under this operation it acquires
-the consistence of a thick custard, and a large cocoa-nut
-shell full of it being set before him, he sips it as
-we should do a jelly if we had no spoon to take it
-from the glass: the meal is then finished by again
-washing his hands and his mouth. After which the
-cocoa-nut shells are cleaned, and every thing that is
-left is replaced in the basket.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The quantity of food which these people eat at a
-meal is prodigious: I have seen one man devour two
-or three fishes as big as a perch; three bread-fruits,
-each bigger than two fists; fourteen or fifteen plantains
-or bananas, each of them six or seven inches
-long, and four or five round; and near a quart of
-the pounded bread-fruit, which is as substantial as
-the thickest unbaked custard. This is so extraordinary
-that I scarcely expect to be believed; and I
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_202'>202</span>would not have related it upon my own single testimony;
-but Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and most of
-the other gentlemen, have had ocular demonstration
-of its truth, and know that I mention them upon the
-occasion.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It is very wonderful that these people, who are
-remarkably fond of society, and particularly that of
-their women, should exclude its pleasures from the
-table, where among all other nations, whether civil
-or savage, they have been principally enjoyed. How
-a meal, which every where else brings families and
-friends together, came to separate them here, we
-often enquired, but could never learn. They eat
-alone, they said, because it was right; but why it
-was right to eat alone they never attempted to tell
-us: such, however, was the force of habit, that they
-expressed the strongest dislike, and even disgust, at
-our eating in society, especially with our women, and
-of the same victuals. At first, we thought this
-strange singularity arose from some superstitious opinion;
-but they constantly affirmed the contrary. We
-observed also some caprices in the custom, for which
-we could as little account as for the custom itself.
-We could never prevail with any of the women to
-partake of the victuals at our table when we were
-dining in company; yet they would go, five or six
-together, into the servants’ apartments, and there eat
-very heartily of whatever they could find, of which
-I have before given a particular instance; nor were
-they in the least disconcerted if we came in while
-they were doing it. When any of us have been alone
-with a woman, she has sometimes eaten in our company;
-but then she has expressed the greatest unwillingness
-that it should be known, and always extorted
-the strongest promises of secrecy.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Among themselves, even two brothers and two sisters
-have each their separate baskets, with provision
-and the apparatus of their meal. When they first
-visited us at our tents, each brought his basket with
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_203'>203</span>him; and when we sat down to table, they would go
-out, sit down upon the ground, at two or three yards’
-distance from each other, and turning their faces different
-ways, take their repast without interchanging
-a single word.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The women not only abstain from eating with the
-men, and of the same victuals, but even have their
-victuals separately prepared by boys kept for that purpose,
-who deposit it in a separate shed, and attend
-them with it at their meals.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>But though they would not eat with us or with
-each other, they have often asked us to eat with them,
-when we have visited those with whom we were particularly
-acquainted at their houses; and we have
-often upon such occasions eaten out of the same
-basket, and drunk out of the same cup. The elder
-women, however, always appeared to be offended at
-this liberty; and if we happened to touch their victuals,
-or even the basket that contained it, would
-throw it away.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After meals, and in the heat of the day, the middle-aged
-people of the better sort generally sleep:
-they are indeed extremely indolent; and sleeping and
-eating is almost all that they do. Those that are
-older are less drowsy, and the boys and girls are
-kept awake by the natural activity and sprightliness
-of their age.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their amusements have occasionally been mentioned
-in my account of the incidents that happened
-during our residence in this island, particularly music,
-dancing, wrestling, and shooting with the bow;
-they also sometimes vie with each other in throwing a
-lance. As shooting is not at a mark, but for distance;
-throwing the lance is not for distance, but at a mark:
-the weapon is about nine feet long, the mark is
-the bole of a plantain, and the distance about
-twenty yards.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their only musical instruments are flutes and drums;
-the flutes are made of a hollow bamboo about a foot
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_204'>204</span>long, and, as has been observed before, have only
-two stops, and consequently but four notes, out of
-which they seem hitherto to have formed but one
-tune: to these stops they apply the fore-finger of the
-left hand and the middle finger of the right.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The drum is made of a hollow block of wood, of
-a cylindrical form, solid at one end, and covered at
-the other with shark’s skin: these they beat not with
-sticks, but their hands; and they know how to tune
-two drums of different notes into concord. They
-have also an expedient to bring the flutes that play
-together into unison, which is to roll up a leaf so as
-to slip over the end of the shortest, like our sliding
-tubes for telescopes, which they move up or down till
-the purpose is answered, of which they seem to judge
-by their ear with great nicety.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>To these instruments they sing; and, as I have
-observed before, their songs are often extempore:
-they call every two verses or couplet a song, <i>Pehay</i>:
-they are generally, though not always, in rhime; and
-when pronounced by the natives, we could discover
-that they were metre. Mr. Banks took great pains
-to write down some of them which were made upon
-our arrival, as nearly as he could express their sounds
-by combinations of our letters; but when we read
-them, not having their accent, we could scarcely
-make them either metre or rhime. The reader will
-easily perceive that they are of very different structure.</p>
-
-<div class='lg-container-b'>
- <div class='linegroup'>
- <div class='group'>
- <div class='line in4'>Tede pahai de parow-a</div>
- <div class='line in4'>Ha maru no mina.</div>
- </div>
- <div class='group'>
- <div class='line in2'>E pahah Tayo malama tai ya</div>
- <div class='line in2'>No Tabane tonatou whannomi ya.</div>
- </div>
- <div class='group'>
- <div class='line'>E Turai eattu terara patee whennua toai</div>
- <div class='line'>Ino o maio Pretane to whennuaia no Tute.</div>
- </div>
- </div>
-</div>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_205'>205</span>Of these verses our knowledge of the language is
-too imperfect to attempt a translation. They frequently
-amuse themselves by singing such couplets
-as these when they are alone, or with their families,
-especially after it is dark; for though they need no
-fires, they are not without the comfort of artificial
-light between sunset and bedtime. Their candles
-are made of the kernels of a kind of oily nut, which
-they stick one over another upon a skewer that is
-thrust through the middle of them; the upper one
-being lighted, burns down to the second, at the same
-time consuming that part of the skewer which goes
-through it; the second taking fire burns in the same
-manner down to the third, and so of the rest: some
-of these candles will burn a considerable time, and
-they give a very tolerable light. They do not often
-sit up above an hour after it is dark; but when they
-have strangers who sleep in the house, they generally
-keep a light burning all night, possibly as a check
-upon such of the women as they wish not to honour
-them with their favours.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Of their itinerary concerts I need add nothing
-to what has been said already; especially as I
-shall have occasion more particularly to mention
-them when I relate our adventures upon another
-island.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In other countries, the girls and unmarried women
-are supposed to be wholly ignorant of what others
-upon some occasions may appear to know; and their
-conduct and conversation are consequently restrained
-within narrower bounds, and kept at a more remote
-distance from whatever relates to a connection with
-the other sex; but here it is just contrary. Among
-other diversions, there is a dance, called <i>Timorodee</i>,
-which is performed by young girls, whenever eight
-or ten of them can be collected together, consisting
-of motions and gestures beyond imagination wanton,
-in the practice of which they are brought up from
-their earliest childhood, accompanied by words, which,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_206'>206</span>if it were possible, would more explicitly convey the
-same ideas. In these dances they keep time with an
-exactness which is scarcely excelled by the best performers
-upon the stages of Europe. But the practice
-which is allowed to the virgin is prohibited to the
-woman from the moment that she has put these
-hopeful lessons in practice, and realized the symbols
-of the dance.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It cannot be supposed that, among these people,
-chastity is held in much estimation. It might be expected
-that sisters and daughters would be offered to
-strangers, either as a courtesy, or for reward; and
-that breaches of conjugal fidelity, even in the wife,
-should not be otherwise punished than by a few hard
-words, or perhaps a slight beating, as indeed is the
-case; but there is a scale in dissolute sensuality,
-which these people have ascended, wholly unknown
-to every other nation whose manners have been recorded
-from the beginning of the world to the present
-hour, and which no imagination could possibly
-conceive.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>A very considerable number of the principal people
-of Otaheite, of both sexes, have formed themselves
-into a society, in which every woman is common
-to every man; thus securing a perpetual variety
-as often as their inclination prompts them to seek
-it, which is so frequent, that the same man and
-woman seldom cohabit together more than two or
-three days.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>These societies are distinguished by the name of
-<i>Arreoy</i>; and the members have meetings, at which
-no other is present, where the men amuse themselves
-by wrestling, and the women, notwithstanding their
-occasional connection with different men, dance the
-Timorodee in all its latitude, as an incitement to desires
-which it is said are frequently gratified upon the
-spot. This, however, is comparatively nothing. If
-any of the women happen to be with child, which in
-this manner of life happens less frequently than if
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_207'>207</span>they were to cohabit only with one man, the poor infant
-is smothered the moment it is born, that it may
-be no incumbrance to the father, nor interrupt the
-mother in the pleasures of her diabolical prostitution.
-It sometimes indeed happens, that the passion which
-prompts a woman to enter into this society is surmounted
-when she becomes a mother, by that instinctive
-affection which nature has given to all creatures
-for the preservation of their offspring; but even in
-this case she is not permitted to spare the life of her
-infant, except she can find a man who will patronise
-it as his child: if this can be done, the murder is
-prevented; but both the man and woman, being
-deemed by this act to have appropriated each other,
-are ejected from the community, and forfeit all claim
-to the privileges and pleasures of the Arreoy for the
-future; the woman from that time being distinguished
-by the term <i>Whannownow</i>, “bearer of children,”
-which is here a term of reproach; though none
-can be more honourable in the estimation of wisdom
-and humanity, of right reason, and every passion
-that distinguishes the man from the brute.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It is not fit that a practice so horrid and so strange
-should be imputed to human beings upon slight evidence,
-but I have such as abundantly justifies me in
-the account I have given. The people themselves
-are so far from concealing their connection with such
-a society as a disgrace, that they boast of it as a privilege;
-and both myself and Mr. Banks, when particular
-persons have been pointed out to us as members
-of the Arreoy, have questioned them about it,
-and received the account that has been here given
-from their own lips. They have acknowledged that
-they had long been of this accursed society, that
-they belonged to it at that time, and that several of
-their children had been put to death.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>But I must not conclude my account of the domestic
-life of these people without mentioning their
-personal cleanliness. If that which lessens the good
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_208'>208</span>of life and increases the evil is vice, surely cleanliness
-is a virtue: the want of it tends to destroy both
-beauty and health, and mingles disgust with our best
-pleasures. The natives of Otaheite, both men and
-women, constantly wash their whole bodies in running
-water three times every day; once as soon as
-they rise in the morning, once at noon, and again
-before they sleep at night, whether the sea or river
-is near them or at a distance. I have already observed,
-that they wash not only the mouth but the
-hands at their meals, almost between every morsel;
-and their clothes, as well as their persons, are kept
-without spot or stain; so that in a large company of
-these people nothing is suffered but heat, which,
-perhaps, is more than can be said of the politest assembly
-in Europe.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_209'>209</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. XVIII.<br /> <br />OF THE MANUFACTURES, BOATS, AND NAVIGATION OF OTAHEITE.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>If</span> necessity is the mother of invention, it cannot
-be supposed to have been much exerted where the liberality
-of Nature has rendered the diligence of Art
-almost superfluous; yet there are many instances both
-of ingenuity and labour among these people, which,
-considering the want of metal for tools, do honour
-to both.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their principal manufacture is their cloth, in the
-making and dying of which I think there are some
-particulars which may instruct even the artificers of
-Great Britain, and for that reason my description will
-be more minute.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their cloth is of three kinds; and it is made of
-the bark of three different trees, the Chinese paper
-mulberry, the bread-fruit tree, and the tree which resembles
-the wild fig-tree of the West Indies.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The finest and whitest is made of the paper mulberry,
-<i>Aouta</i>; this is worn chiefly by the principal
-people, and when it is dyed red takes a better colour.
-A second sort, inferior in whiteness and softness, is
-made of the bread-fruit tree, <i>Ooroo</i>, and worn chiefly
-by the inferior people; and a third of the tree that
-resembles the fig, which is coarse and harsh, and of
-the colour of the darkest brown paper; this, though
-it is less pleasing both to the eye and the touch, is the
-most valuable, because it resists water, which the other
-two sorts will not. Of this, which is the most rare
-as well as the most useful, the greater part is perfumed,
-and worn by the Chiefs as a morning dress.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>All these trees are propagated with great care, particularly
-the mulberry, which covers the largest part
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_210'>210</span>of the cultivated land, and is not fit for use after two
-or three years growth, when it is about six or eight
-feet high, and somewhat thicker than a man’s thumb;
-its excellence is to be thin, straight, tall, and without
-branches: the lower leaves, therefore, are carefully
-plucked off, with their germs, as often as there
-is any appearance of their producing a branch.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>But though the cloth made of these three trees is
-different, it is all manufactured in the same manner;
-I shall, therefore, describe the process only in the
-fine sort, that is made of the mulberry. When the
-trees are of a proper size, they are drawn up, and
-stripped of their branches, after which the roots and
-tops are cut off; the bark of these rods being then
-slit up longitudinally is easily drawn off, and, when
-a proper quantity has been procured, it is carried
-down to some running water, in which it is deposited
-to soak, and secured from floating away by heavy
-stones: when it is supposed to be sufficiently softened,
-the women servants go down to the brook, and
-stripping themselves, sit down in the water, to separate
-the inner bark from the green part on the outside;
-to do this they place the under side upon a flat
-smooth board, and with the shell, which our dealers
-call tyger’s tongue, <i>tellina gargadia</i>, scrape it very
-carefully, dipping it continually in the water till
-nothing remains but the fine fibres of the inner coat.
-Being thus prepared in the afternoon, they are spread
-out upon plantain leaves in the evening; and in this
-part of the work there appears to be some difficulty,
-as the mistress of the family always superintends the
-doing of it: they are placed in lengths of about eleven
-or twelve yards, one by the side of another, till they
-are about a foot broad, and two or three layers are
-also laid one upon the other: care is taken that the
-cloth shall be in all parts of an equal thickness, so
-that if the bark happens to be thinner in any particular
-part of one layer than the rest, a piece that is
-somewhat thicker is picked out to be laid over it in
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_211'>211</span>the next. In this state it remains till the morning,
-when great part of the water which it contained
-when it was laid out, is either drained off or evaporated,
-and the several fibres adhere together, so as that
-the whole maybe raised from the ground in one piece.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It is then taken away, and laid upon the smooth
-side of a long piece of wood, prepared for the purpose,
-and beaten by the women servants, with instruments
-about a foot long and three inches thick, made
-of a hard wood which they call <i>Etoa</i>. The shape of this
-instrument is not unlike a square razor strop, only
-that the handle is longer, and each of its four sides
-or faces is marked, lengthways, with small grooves,
-or furrows, of different degrees of fineness; those
-on one side being of a width and depth sufficient to
-receive a small packthread, and the others finer in a
-regular gradation, so that the last are not more than
-equal to sewing silk.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>They beat it first with the coarsest side of this mallet,
-keeping time like our smiths; it spreads very
-fast under the strokes, chiefly however in the breadth,
-and the grooves in the mallet mark it with the appearance
-of threads; it is successively beaten with
-the other sides, last with the finest, and is then fit
-for use. Sometimes, however, it is made still thinner,
-by beating it with the finest side of the mallet,
-after it has been several times doubled: it is then
-called <i>Hoboo</i>, and is almost as thin as a muslin; it
-becomes very white by being bleached in the air, but
-is made still whiter and softer by being washed and
-beaten again after it has been worn.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Of this cloth there are several sorts, of different
-degrees of fineness, in proportion as it is more or less
-beaten without being doubled: the other cloth also
-differs in proportion as it is beaten; but they differ
-from each other in consequence of the different materials
-of which they are made. The bark of the bread-fruit
-is not taken till the trees are considerably longer
-and thicker than those of the fig, the process afterwards
-is the same.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_212'>212</span>When cloth is to be washed after it has been worn,
-it is taken down to the brook, and left to soak, being
-kept fast to the bottom, as at first, by a stone; it is
-then gently wrung or squeezed; and sometimes several
-pieces of it are laid one upon another, and
-beaten together with the coarsest side of the mallet,
-and they are then equal in thickness to broad-cloth,
-and much more soft and agreeable to the touch, after
-they have been a little while in use, though when
-they come immediately from the mallet, they feel as
-if they had been starched. This cloth sometimes
-breaks in the beating, but is easily repaired by pasting
-on a patch with a gluten that is prepared from
-the root of the <i>Pea</i>, which is done so nicely that it
-cannot be discovered. The women also employ themselves
-in removing blemishes of every kind, as our
-ladies do in needle-work or knotting; sometimes
-when their work is intended to be very fine, they will
-paste an entire covering of hoboo over the whole.
-The principal excellencies of this cloth are its coolness
-and softness; and its imperfections, its being
-pervious to water like paper, and almost as easily torn.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The colours with which they dye this cloth are
-principally red and yellow. The red is exceedingly
-beautiful, and I may venture to say a brighter and
-more delicate colour than any we have in Europe;
-that which approaches nearest is our full scarlet, and
-the best imitation which Mr. Banks’s natural history
-painter could produce, was by a mixture of vermillion
-and carmine. The yellow is also a bright color,
-but we have many as good.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The red colour is produced by the mixture of the
-juices of two vegetables, neither of which separately
-has the least tendency to that hue. One is a species
-of fig called here <i>Matte</i>, and the other the <i>Cordia
-Sebestina</i>, or <i>Etou</i>; of the fig the fruit is used, and
-of the <i>Cordia</i> the leaves.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The fruit of the fig is about as big as a rounceval
-pea, or very small gooseberry; and each of them,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_213'>213</span>upon breaking off the stalk very close, produces one
-drop of a milky liquor, resembling the juice of our figs,
-of which the tree is indeed a species. This liquor
-the women collect into a small quantity of cocoa-nut
-water: to prepare a gill of cocoa-nut water will require
-between three and four quarts of these little figs.
-When a sufficient quantity is prepared, the leaves of
-the Etou are well wetted in it, and then laid upon a
-plantain leaf, where they are turned about till they
-become more and more flaccid, and then they are
-gently squeezed, gradually increasing the pressure,
-but so as not to break them; as the flaccidity increases,
-and they become spungy, they are supplied
-with more of the liquor; in about five minutes the
-colour begins to appear upon the veins of the leaves,
-and in about ten or a little more, they are perfectly
-saturated with it: they are then squeezed, with as
-much force as can be applied, and the liquor strained
-at the same time that it is expressed.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>For this purpose, the boys prepare a large quantity
-of the Moo, by drawing it between their teeth,
-or two little sticks, till it is freed from the green bark
-and the branny substance that lies under it, and a
-thin web of the fibres only remains; in this the leaves
-of the Etou are inveloped, and through these the
-juice which they contain is strained as it is forced out.
-As the leaves are not succulent, little more juice is
-pressed out of them than they have imbibed: when
-they have been once emptied, they are filled again,
-and again pressed, till the quality which tinctures
-the liquor as it passes through them is exhausted,
-they are then thrown away; but the Moo, being
-deeply stained with the colour, is preserved, as a brush
-to lay the dye upon the cloth.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The expressed liquor is always received into small
-cups made of the plantain leaf, whether from a notion
-that it has any quality favourable to the colour,
-or from the facility with which it is procured, and
-the convenience of small vessels to distribute it among
-the artificers, I do not know.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_214'>214</span>Of the thin cloth they seldom dye more than the
-edges, but the thick cloth is coloured through the
-whole surface; the liquor is indeed used rather as a
-pigment than a dye, for a coat of it is laid upon one
-side only, with the fibres of the Moo; and though
-I have seen of the thin cloth that has appeared to
-have been soaked in the liquor, the colour has not
-had the same richness and lustre, as when it has been
-applied in the other manner.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Though the leaf of the Etou is generally used in
-this process, and probably produces the finest colour,
-yet the juice of the figs will produce a red by a mixture
-with the species of Tournefortia, which they
-call <i>Taheinoo</i>, the <i>Pohuc</i>, the <i>Eurhe</i>, or <i>Convolvulus
-Brasiliensis</i>, and a species of Solanum called <i>Ebooa</i>;
-from the use of these different plants, or from different
-proportions of the materials, many varieties are
-observable in the colours of their cloth, some of
-which are conspicuously superior to others.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The beauty, however, of the best is not permanent;
-but it is probable that some method might be
-found to fix it, if proper experiments were made,
-and perhaps to search for latent qualities, which may
-be brought out by the mixture of one vegetable juice
-with another, would not be an unprofitable employment:
-our present most valuable dyes afford sufficient
-encouragement to the attempt; for by the mere inspection
-of indigo, woad, dyer’s weed, and most of
-the leaves which are used for the like purposes, the
-colours which they yield could never be discovered.
-Of this Indian red I shall only add, that the women
-who have been employed in preparing or using it,
-carefully preserve the colour upon their fingers and
-nails, where it appears in its utmost beauty, as a great
-ornament.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The yellow is made of the bark of the root of the
-<i>Morinda citrifolia</i>, called <i>Nono</i>, by scraping and infusing
-it in water; after standing some time, the
-water is strained and used as a dye, the cloth being
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_215'>215</span>dipped into it. The Morinda, of which this is a species,
-seems to be a good subject for examination with
-a view to dyeing. Brown, in his history of Jamaica,
-mentions three species of it, which he says are used
-to dye brown; and Rumphius says of the <i>Bancuda
-Angustifolia</i>, which is nearly allied to our Nono, that
-it is used by the inhabitants of the East Indian islands,
-as a fixing drug for red colours, with which it
-particularly agrees.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The inhabitants of this island also dye yellow with
-the fruit of the Tamanu; but how the colour is extracted,
-we had no opportunity to discover. They
-have also a preparation with which they dye brown and
-black; but these colours are so indifferent, that the method
-of preparing them did not excite our curiosity.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Another considerable manufacture is matting of
-various kinds; some of which is finer, and better,
-in every respect, than any we have in Europe: the
-coarser sort serves them to sleep upon, and the finer
-to wear in wet weather. With the fine, of which
-there are also two sorts, much pains is taken, especially
-with that made of the bark of the Poerou, the
-<i>Hibiscus tiliaceus</i> of Linnæus, some of which is as
-fine as a coarse cloth; the other sort, which is still
-more beautiful, they call <i>Vanne</i>; it is white, glossy,
-and shining, and is made of the leaves of their <i>Wharrou</i>,
-a species of the <i>Pandanus</i>, of which we had no
-opportunity to see either the flowers or fruit: they
-have other matts, or as they call them <i>Moeas</i>, to sit
-or to sleep upon, which are formed of a great variety
-of rushes and grass, and which they make, as they
-do every thing else that is plaited, with amazing facility
-and dispatch.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>They are also very dexterous in making basket and
-wicker work; their baskets are of a thousand different
-patterns, many of them exceedingly neat; and
-the making them is an art that every one practises,
-both men and women: they make occasional baskets
-and panniers of the cocoa-nut leaf in a few minutes,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_216'>216</span>and the women who visited us early in a morning used
-to send, as soon as the sun was high, for a few of the
-leaves, of which they made little bonnets to shade
-their faces, at so small an expence of time and trouble,
-that, when the sun was again low in the evening,
-they used to throw them away. These bonnets,
-however, did not cover the head, but consisted only
-of a band that went round it, and a shade that projected
-from the forehead.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Of the bark of the Poerou, they make ropes and
-lines, from the thickness of an inch to the size of a
-small packthread: with these they make nets for fishing:
-of the fibres of the cocoa-nut they make thread,
-for fastening together the several parts of their canoes,
-and belts, either round or flat, twisted or plaited;
-and of the bark of the <i>Erowa</i>, a kind of nettle which
-grows in the mountains, and is therefore rather
-scarce, they make the best fishing lines in the world:
-with these they hold the strongest and most active
-fish, such as Bonetas and Albicores, which would snap
-our strongest silk lines in a minute, though they are
-twice as thick.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>They make also a kind of seine, of a coarse broad
-grass, the blades of which are like flags; these they
-twist and tie together in a loose manner, till the net,
-which is about as wide as a large sack, is from sixty
-to eighty fathom long: this they haul in shoal smooth
-water, and its own weight keeps it so close to the
-ground that scarcely a single fish can escape.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In every expedient, indeed, for taking fish, they
-are exceedingly ingenious; they make harpoons of
-cane, and point them with hard wood, which in
-their hands strike fish more effectually, than those
-which are headed with iron can do in ours, setting
-aside the advantage of ours being fastened to a line,
-so that the fish is secured if the hook takes place,
-though it does not mortally wound him.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Of fish-hooks they have two sorts, admirably
-adapted in their construction as well to the purpose
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_217'>217</span>they are to answer, as to the materials of which they
-are made. One of these, which they call <i>Wittee
-Wittee</i>, is used for towing. The shank is made of
-mother-of-pearl, the most glossy that can be got: the
-inside, which is naturally the brightest, is put behind.
-To these hooks a tuft of white dog’s or hog’s hair is
-fixed, so as somewhat to resemble the tail of a fish;
-these implements, therefore, are both hook and bait,
-and are used with a rod of bamboo, and line of <i>Erowa</i>.
-The fisher, to secure his success, watches the flight
-of the birds which constantly attend the Bonetas
-when they swim in shoals, by which he directs his
-canoe, and when he has the advantage of these
-guides, he seldom returns without a prize.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The other kind of hook is also made of mother-of-pearl,
-or some other hard shell: they cannot make
-them bearded like our hooks; but to effect the same
-purpose, they make the point turn inwards. These
-are made of all sizes, and used to catch various kinds
-of fish with great success. The manner of making
-them is very simple, and every fisherman is his own
-artificer: the shell is first cut into square pieces, by
-the edge of another shell, and wrought into a form
-corresponding with the outline of the hook by pieces
-of coral, which are sufficiently rough to perform the
-office of a file; a hole is then bored in the middle;
-the drill being no other than the first stone they pick
-up that has a sharp corner: this they fix into the end
-of a piece of bamboo, and turn it between the hands
-like a chocolate-mill; when the shell is perforated,
-and the hole sufficiently wide, a small file of coral is
-introduced, by the application of which the hook is
-in a short time completed, few costing the artificer
-more time than a quarter of an hour.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Of their masonry, carving, and architecture, the
-reader has already formed some idea from the account
-that has been given of the Morais, or repositories
-of the dead: the other most important article
-of building and carving is their boats; and perhaps,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_218'>218</span>to fabricate one of their principal vessels with their
-tools is as great a work, as to build a British man of
-war with ours.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>They have an adze of stone; a chissel, or gouge
-of bone, generally that of a man’s arm between the
-wrist and elbow; a rasp of coral; and the skin of a
-sting-ray, with coral sand, as a file or polisher.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This is a complete catalogue of their tools, and
-with these they build houses, construct canoes, hew
-stone, and fell, cleave, carve, and polish timber.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The stone which makes the blade of their adzes is
-a kind of Basaltes, of a blackish or grey colour, not
-very hard, but of considerable toughness: they are
-formed of different sizes; some, that are intended
-for felling, weigh from six to eight pounds; others,
-that are used for carving, not more than so many
-ounces; but it is necessary to sharpen both almost
-every minute; for which purpose, a stone and a
-cocoa-nut shell full of water are always at hand.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their greatest exploit, to which these tools are
-less equal than to any other, is felling a tree: this
-requires many hands, and the constant labour of
-several days. When it is down, they split it, with
-the grain, into planks from three to four inches
-thick, the whole length and breadth of the tree,
-many of which are eight feet in the girt, and forty
-to the branches, and nearly of the same thickness
-throughout. The tree generally used is, in their
-language, called <i>Avie</i>, the stem of which is tall and
-straight; though some of the smaller boats are made
-of the bread-fruit tree, which is a light spongy
-wood, and easily wrought. They smooth the plank
-very expeditiously and dexterously with their adzes,
-and can take off a thin coat from a whole plank without
-missing a stroke. As they have not the art of
-warping a plank, every part of the canoe, whether
-hollow or flat, is shaped by hand.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The canoes, or boats, which are used by the inhabitants
-of this and the neighbouring islands, may be
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_219'>219</span>divided into two general classes; one of which they
-call <i>Ivahahs</i>, the other <i>Pahies</i>.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The Ivahah is used for short excursions to sea,
-and is wall-sided and flat-bottomed; the Pahie for
-longer voyages, and is bow-sided and sharp-bottomed.
-The Ivahas are all of the same figure, but
-of different sizes, and used for different purposes:
-their length is from seventy-two feet to ten, but the
-breadth is by no means in proportion; for those of
-ten feet are about a foot wide, and those of more
-than seventy are scarcely two. There is the fighting
-Ivahah, the fishing Ivahah, and the travelling Ivahah;
-for some of these go from one island to another. The
-fighting Ivahah is by far the longest, and the head
-and stern are considerably raised above the body, in
-a semicircular form; particularly the stern, which
-is sometimes seventeen or eighteen feet high, though
-the boat itself is scarcely three. These never go to
-sea single; but are fastened together, side by side,
-at the distance of about three feet, by strong poles of
-wood, which are laid across them and lashed to the
-gunwales. Upon these, in the forepart, a stage or
-platform is raised, about ten or twelve feet long, and
-somewhat wider than the boats, which is supported
-by pillars about six feet high: upon this stage stand
-the fighting men, whose missile weapons are slings
-and spears; for, among other singularities in the
-manners of these people, their bows and arrows are
-used only for diversion, as we throw quoits: below
-these stages sit the rowers, who receive from them
-those that are wounded, and furnish fresh men to
-ascend in their room. Some of these have a platform
-of bamboos or other light wood, through their
-whole length, and considerably broader, by means of
-which they will carry a great number of men; but
-we saw only one fitted in this manner.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The fishing Ivahahs vary in length from about
-forty feet to the smallest size, which is about ten;
-all that are of the length of twenty-five feet and upwards,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_220'>220</span>of whatever sort, occasionally carry sail. The
-travelling Ivahah is always double, and furnished with
-a small neat house, about five or six feet broad, and
-six or seven feet long, which is fastened upon the
-fore-part for the convenience of the principal people,
-who sit in them by day, and sleep in them at night.
-The fishing Ivahahs are sometimes joined together,
-and have a house on board; but this is not common.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Those which are shorter than five and twenty feet,
-seldom or never carry sail; and, though the stern
-rises about four or five feet, have a flat head, and a
-board that projects forward about four feet.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The Pahie is also of different sizes, from sixty to
-thirty feet long; but, like the Ivahah, is very narrow.
-One that I measured was fifty-one feet long, and only
-one foot and a half wide at the top. In the widest
-part, it was about three feet; and this is the general
-proportion. It does not, however, widen by a gradual
-swell; but the sides being straight and parallel,
-for a little way below the gunwale, it swells abruptly,
-and draws to a ridge at the bottom; so that a transverse
-section of it has somewhat the appearance of
-the mark upon cards called a Spade, the whole being
-much wider in proportion to its length. These, like
-the largest Ivahahs, are used for fighting; but principally
-for long voyages. The fighting Pahie, which
-is the largest, is fitted with the stage or platform,
-which is proportionably larger than those of the Ivahah,
-as their form enables them to sustain a much
-greater weight. Those that are used for sailing are
-generally double; and the middle size are said to be
-the best sea-boats. They are sometimes out a month
-together, going from island to island; and sometimes,
-as we were credibly informed, they are a fortnight or
-twenty days at sea, and could keep it longer if they
-had more stowage for provisions, and conveniencies
-to hold fresh water.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When any of these boats carry sail single, they
-make use of a log of wood, which is fastened to the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_221'>221</span>end of two poles that lie cross the vessel, and project
-from six to ten feet, according to the size of the
-vessel, beyond its side, somewhat like what is used
-by the flying Proa of the Ladrone Islands, and called
-in the account of Lord Anson’s Voyage, an Outrigger.
-To this outrigger the shrouds are fastened, and it is
-essentially necessary in trimming the boat when it
-blows fresh.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Some of them have one mast, and some two; they
-are made of a single stick, and when the length of
-the canoe is thirty feet, that of the mast is somewhat
-less than five-and-twenty; it is fixed to a frame
-that is above the canoe, and receives a sail of matting
-about one-third longer than itself: the sail is pointed
-at the top, square at the bottom, and curved at the
-side; somewhat resembling what we call a shoulder
-of mutton sail, and used for boats belonging to men
-of war: it is placed in a frame of wood, which surrounds
-it on every side, and has no contrivance either
-for reefing or furling; so that, if either should become
-necessary, it must be cut away, which, however,
-in these equal climates, can seldom happen.
-At the top of the mast are fastened ornaments of
-feathers, which are placed inclining obliquely forwards;
-the shape and position of which will be conceived
-at once from the figure, in one of the cuts.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The oars or paddles that are used with these boats,
-have a long handle and a flat blade, not unlike a
-baker’s peel. Of these every person in the boat has
-one, except those that sit under the awning; and
-they push her forward with them at a good rate.
-These boats, however, admit so much water at the
-seams, that one person at least is continually employed
-in throwing it out. The only thing in which
-they excel is landing, and putting off from the shore
-in a surf: by their great length and high sterns they
-land dry, when our boats could scarcely land at all;
-and have the same advantages in putting off by
-the height of the head.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_222'>222</span>The Ivahahs are the only boats that are used by
-the <a id='inhab'></a>inhabitants of Otaheite; but we saw several Pahies
-that came from other islands. Of one of these
-I shall give the exact dimensions from a careful admeasurement,
-and then particularly describe the
-manner in which they are built.</p>
-
-<table class='table0' summary=''>
- <tr>
- <th class='c008'></th>
- <th class='c018'>Feet.</th>
- <th class='c009'>Inches.</th>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Extreme length from stem to stern, not reckoning the bending up of either</td>
- <td class='c018'>51</td>
- <td class='c009'>0</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Breadth in the clear of the top forward</td>
- <td class='c018'>1</td>
- <td class='c009'>2</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Breadth in the midships</td>
- <td class='c018'>1</td>
- <td class='c009'>6</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Breadth aft</td>
- <td class='c018'>1</td>
- <td class='c009'>3</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>In the bilge forward</td>
- <td class='c018'>2</td>
- <td class='c009'>8</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>In the midships</td>
- <td class='c018'>2</td>
- <td class='c009'>11</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Aft</td>
- <td class='c018'>2</td>
- <td class='c009'>9</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Depth in the midships</td>
- <td class='c018'>3</td>
- <td class='c009'>4</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Height from the ground on which she stood</td>
- <td class='c018'>3</td>
- <td class='c009'>6</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Height of her head from the ground, without the figure</td>
- <td class='c018'>4</td>
- <td class='c009'>4</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Height of the figure</td>
- <td class='c018'>0</td>
- <td class='c009'>11</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Height of the stern from the ground</td>
- <td class='c018'>8</td>
- <td class='c009'>9</td>
- </tr>
- <tr><td>&nbsp;</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c008'>Height of the figure</td>
- <td class='c018'>2</td>
- <td class='c009'>0</td>
- </tr>
-</table>
-
-<div class='figright id003'>
-<img src='images/il222.jpg' alt='Drawing of Vessel' class='ig001' />
-</div>
-
-<p class='c000'>To illustrate my description of the manner in which
-these vessels are built,
-it will be necessary to
-refer to the figure;
-in which <i>a a</i> is the
-first seam, <i>b b</i> the second,
-and <i>c c</i> the third.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The first stage or keel, under <i>a a</i>, is made of a
-tree hollowed out like a trough; for which the
-longest trees are chosen that can be got, so that
-there are never more than three in the whole length:
-the next stage, under <i>b b</i>, is formed of straight plank,
-about four feet long, fifteen inches broad, and two
-inches thick: the third stage, under <i>c c</i>, is, like the
-bottom, made of trunks, hollowed into its bilging
-form; the last is also cut out of trunks, so that the
-moulding is of one piece with the upright. To form
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_223'>223</span>these parts separately, without saw, plane, chissel, or
-any other iron tool, may well be thought no easy
-task; but the great difficulty is to join them together.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When all the parts are prepared, the keel is laid
-upon blocks, and the planks being supported by
-stanchions, are sewed or clamped together with
-strong thongs of plaiting, which are passed several
-times through holes that are bored with a gouge or
-auger of bone, that has been described already; and
-the nicety with which this is done, may be inferred
-from their being sufficiently water-tight for use without
-caulking. As the platting soon rots in the water,
-it is renewed at least once a-year; in order to which,
-the vessel is taken entirely to pieces. The head and
-stern are rude with respect to the design; but very
-neatly finished, and polished to the highest degree.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>These Pahies are kept with great care in a kind
-of house built on purpose for their reception; the
-houses are formed of poles set upright in the ground,
-the tops of which are drawn towards each other, and
-fastened together with their strongest cord, so as to
-form a kind of Gothic arch, which is completely
-thatched quite to the ground, being open only at the
-ends; they are sometimes fifty or sixty paces long.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As connected with the navigation of these people,
-I shall mention their wonderful sagacity in foretelling
-the weather, at least the quarter from which the wind
-shall blow at a future time; they have several ways
-of doing this, of which however I know but one.
-They say, that the Milky-way is always curved laterally;
-but sometimes in one direction, and sometimes
-in another: and that this curvature is the effect of
-its being already acted upon by the wind, and its
-hollow part therefore towards it; so that, if the same
-curvature continues a night, a corresponding wind
-certainly blows the next day. Of their rules, I shall
-not pretend to judge; but I know that, by whatever
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_224'>224</span>means, they can predict the weather, at least the
-wind, with much greater certainty than we can.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In their longer voyages, they steer by the sun in
-the day, and in the night by the stars; all of which
-they distinguish separately by names, and know in
-what part of the heavens they will appear in any of
-the months during which they are visible in their
-horizon; they also know the time of their annual
-appearing and disappearing with more precision than
-will easily be believed by an European astronomer.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_225'>225</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. XIX.<br /> <br />OF THE DIVISION OF TIME IN OTAHEITE; NUMERATION, COMPUTATION OF DISTANCE, LANGUAGE, DISEASES, DISPOSAL OF THE DEAD, RELIGION, WAR, WEAPONS, AND GOVERNMENT; WITH SOME GENERAL OBSERVATIONS FOR THE USE OF FUTURE NAVIGATORS.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>We</span> were not able to acquire a perfect idea of their
-method of dividing time; but observed, that in
-speaking of it, either past or to come, they never
-used any term but <i>Malama</i>, which signifies Moon.
-Of these moons they count thirteen, and then begin
-again; which is a demonstration that they have a
-notion of the solar year: but how they compute their
-months so that thirteen of them shall be commensurate
-with the year, we could not discover; for they
-say that each month has twenty-nine days, including
-one in which the moon is not visible. They have
-names for them separately, and have frequently told
-us the fruits that would be in season, and the weather
-that would prevail, in each of them; and they have
-indeed a name for them collectively, though they use
-it only when they speak of the mysteries of their religion.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Every day is subdivided into twelve parts, each of
-two hours, of which six belong to the day, and six to
-the night. At these divisions they guess pretty
-nearly by the height of the sun while he is above
-the horizon; but there are few of them that can
-guess at them, when he is below it, by the stars.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In numeration they proceed from one to ten, the
-number of fingers on both hands; and though they
-have for each number a different name, they generally
-take hold of their fingers one by one, shifting
-from one hand to the other till they come to the
-number they want to express. And in other instances,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_226'>226</span>we observed that, when they were conversing
-with each other, they joined signs to their words,
-which were so expressive that a stranger might easily
-apprehend their meaning.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In counting from ten they repeat the name of that
-number, and add the word <i>more</i>; ten, and one more,
-is eleven; ten, and two more, twelve: and so of the
-rest, as we say one and twenty, two and twenty.
-When they come to ten and ten more, they have a
-new denomination, as we say a score; and by these
-scores they count till they get ten of them, when
-they have a denomination for two hundred; and we
-never could discover that they had any denomination
-to express a greater number: neither, indeed, do
-they seem to want any; for ten of these amount to
-two thousand, a greater number than they can ever
-apply.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In measuring distance they are much more deficient
-than in computing numbers, having but one term,
-which answers to fathom; when they speak of distances
-from place to place, they express it, like the
-Asiatics, by the time that is required to pass it.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their language is soft and melodious; it abounds
-with vowels, and we easily learnt to pronounce it:
-but found it exceedingly difficult to teach them to
-pronounce a single word of ours; probably not only
-from its abounding in consonants, but from some peculiarity
-in its structure; for Spanish and Italian
-words, if ending in a vowel, they pronounced with
-great facility.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Whether it is copious, we were not sufficiently acquainted
-with it to know; but it is certainly very
-imperfect, for it is almost totally without inflexion,
-both of nouns and verbs. Few of the nouns have
-more than one case, and few of the verbs more than
-one tense; yet we found no great difficulty in making
-ourselves mutually understood, however strange
-it may appear in speculation.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>They have, however, certain <i>affixa</i>, which, though
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_227'>227</span>but few in number, are very useful to them, and
-puzzled us extremely. One asks another, <i>Harre
-hea?</i> “Where are you going?” The other answers,
-<i>Ivahinera</i>, “To my wives;” upon which the first, repeating
-the answer interrogatively, “To your wives?”
-is answered, <i>Ivahinereira</i>; “Yes, I am going to my
-wives.” Here the suffixa <i>era</i> and <i>eira</i> save several
-words to both parties.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>I have inserted a few of their words, from which,
-perhaps, some idea may be formed of the language.</p>
-
-<table class='table0' summary=''>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Pupo,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the head</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Ahewh,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the nose</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Roourou,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the hair</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Outou,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the mouth</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Niheo,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the teeth</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Arrero,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the tongue</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Meu-eumi,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the beard</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Tiarraboa,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the throat</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Tuamo,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the shoulders</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Tuah,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the back</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Oama,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the breast</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Eu,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the nipples</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Oboo,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the belly</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Rema,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the arm</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Vaee,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>wild plantains</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Oporema,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the hand</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Manneow,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the fingers</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Mieu,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the nails</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Touhe,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the buttocks</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Hoouhah,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the thighs</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Avia,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the legs</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Tapoa,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the feet</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Booa,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a hog</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Moa,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a fowl</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Euree,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a dog</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Eure-eure,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>iron</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Ooroo,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>bread-fruit</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Hearee,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>cocoa-nuts</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Mia,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>bananas</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Poe,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>beads</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Poe matawewwe,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>pearl</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Ahou,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a garment</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Avee,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a fruit like apples</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Ahee,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>another like chesnuts</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Ewharre,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a house</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Whennua,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a high island</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Motu,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a low island</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Toto,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>blood</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Aeve,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>bone</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Aeo,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>flesh</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Mae,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>fat</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Tuea,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>lean</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Huru-huru,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>hair</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Eraow,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a tree</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Ama,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a branch</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Tiale,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a flower</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Huero</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>fruit</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Etummoo,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the stem</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Aaa,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the root</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Eiherre,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>herbaceous plants</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Ooopa,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a pigeon</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Avigne,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a paroquet</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>A-a,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>another species</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Mannu,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a bird</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Mora</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a duck</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Mattow,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a fish-hook</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'><span class='pageno' id='Page_228'>228</span>Toura,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a rope</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Mow,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a shark</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Mahi-mahi,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a dolphin</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Mattera,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a fishing-rod</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Eupea,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a net</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Mahanna,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the sun</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Malama,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the moon</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Whettu,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a star</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Whettu-euphe,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a comet</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Erai,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>the sky</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Eatta,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>a cloud</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Miti,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>good</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Eno,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>bad</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>A,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>yes</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Ima,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>no</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Paree,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>ugly</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Paroree,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>hungry</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Pia,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>full</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Timahah,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>heavy</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Mama,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>light</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Poto,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>short</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Roa,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>tall</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Nehenne,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>sweet</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Mala-mala,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>bitter</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Whanno,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to go far</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Harre,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to go</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Arrea,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to stay</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Enoho,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to remain</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Rohe rohe,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to be tired</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Maa,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to eat</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Inoo,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to drink</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Ete,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to understand</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Warrido,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to steal</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Worridde,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to be angry</i>.</td>
- </tr>
- <tr>
- <td class='c010'>Teparahi,</td>
- <td class='c011'><i>to beat</i>.</td>
- </tr>
-</table>
-
-<p class='c000'>Among people whose food is so simple, and who
-in general are seldom drunk, it is scarcely necessary
-to say, that there are but few diseases; we saw no
-critical disease during our stay upon the island, and
-but few instances of sickness, which were accidental
-fits of the colic. The natives, however, are afflicted
-with the erysipelas, and cutaneous eruptions of the
-scaly kind, very nearly approaching to a leprosy.
-Those in whom this distemper was far advanced,
-lived in a state of seclusion from all society, each in
-a small house built upon some unfrequented spot,
-where they were supplied with provisions: but
-whether they had any hope of relief, or languished
-out the remainder of their lives in solitude and despair,
-we could not learn. We observed also a few
-who had ulcers upon different parts of their bodies,
-some of which had a very virulent appearance; yet
-they seemed not much to be regarded by those who
-were afflicted with them, for they were left entirely
-without application even to keep off the flies.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_229'>229</span>Where intemperance produces no diseases, there
-will be no physicians by profession; yet where there
-is sufferance, there will always be attempts to relieve;
-and where the cause of the mischief and the remedy
-are alike unknown, these will naturally be directed
-by superstition: thus it happens, that in this country,
-and in all others which are not further injured by
-luxury, or improved by knowledge, the management
-of the sick falls to the lot of the priest. The method
-of cure that is practised by the priests of Otaheite,
-consists chiefly of prayers and ceremonies. When he
-visits his patient he repeats certain sentences, which
-appear to be set forms contrived for the occasion,
-and at the same time plats the leaves of the cocoa-nut
-into different figures very neatly; some of these
-he fastens to the fingers and toes of the sick, and
-often leaves behind him a few branches of the
-<i>thespecia populnea</i>, which they call <i>E’midho</i>: these
-ceremonies are repeated till the patient recovers or
-dies. If he recovers, they say the remedies cured
-him; if he dies, they say the disease was incurable;
-in which perhaps they do not much differ from the
-custom of other countries.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>If we had judged of their skill in surgery from the
-dreadful scars which we sometimes saw, we should
-have supposed it to be much superior to the art, not
-only of their physicians, but of ours. We saw one
-man whose face was almost entirely destroyed, his nose,
-including the bone, was perfectly flat, and one cheek
-and one eye were so beaten in, that the hollow would
-almost receive a man’s fist, yet no ulcer remained;
-and our companion, Tupia, had been pierced quite
-through his body by a spear, headed with the bone
-of the sting-ray, the weapon having entered his back,
-and come out just under his breast; but except in
-reducing dislocations and fractures, the best surgeon
-can contribute very little to the cure of a wound;
-the blood itself is the best vulnerary balsam, and
-when the juices of the body are pure, and the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_230'>230</span>patient is temperate, nothing more is necessary as an
-aid to nature in the cure of the worst wound, than
-the keeping it clean.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their commerce with the inhabitants of Europe
-has, however, already entailed upon them that dreadful
-curse which avenged the inhumanities committed
-by the Spaniards in America, the venereal disease.
-As it is certain that no European vessel besides our
-own, except the Dolphin, and the two that were
-under the command of Mons. Bougainville, ever
-visited this island, it must have been brought either
-by one of them or by us. That it was not brought by
-the Dolphin, Captain Wallis has demonstrated in the
-account of her voyage, (Vol. I. p. 323, 324.), and
-nothing is more certain than that when we arrived,
-it had made most dreadful ravages in the island.
-One of our people contracted it within five days after
-we went on shore, and by the enquiries among the
-natives, which this occasioned, we learnt, when we
-came to understand a little of their language, that it
-had been brought by the vessels which had been
-there about fifteen months before us, and had lain on
-the east side of the island. They distinguished it by
-a name of the same import with <i>rottenness</i>, but of a
-more extensive signification, and described, in the
-most pathetic terms, the sufferings of the first victims
-to its rage, and told us that it caused the hair and
-the nails to fall off, and the flesh to rot from the
-bones: that it spread a universal terror and consternation
-among them, so that the sick were abandoned
-by their nearest relations, lest the calamity
-should spread by contagion, and left to perish alone in
-such misery as till then had never been known among
-them. We had some reason, however, to hope that
-they had found out a specific to cure it: during our
-stay upon the island we saw none in whom it had made
-a great progress, and one who went from us infected,
-returned after a short time in perfect health; and by
-this it appeared either that the disease had cured
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_231'>231</span>itself, or that they were not unacquainted with the
-virtues of simples, nor implicit dupes to the superstitious
-follies of their priests. We endeavoured to
-learn the medical qualities which they imputed to
-their plants, but our knowledge of their language was
-too imperfect for us to succeed. If we could have
-learnt their specific for the venereal disease, if such
-they have, it would have been of great advantage to
-us, for when we left the island it had been contracted
-by more than half the people on board the ship.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It is impossible but that, in relating incidents,
-many particulars with respect to the customs, opinions,
-and works of these people should be anticipated; to
-avoid repetition, therefore, I shall only supply deficiencies.
-Of the manner of disposing of their dead,
-much has been said already. I must more explicitly
-observe, that there are two places in which the dead
-are deposited; one a kind of shed, where the flesh is
-suffered to putrify; the other an enclosure, with
-erections of stone, where the bones are afterwards
-buried. The sheds are called <span class='sc'>Tupapow</span>, and the enclosures
-<span class='sc'>Morai</span>. The Morais are also places of
-worship.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As soon as a native of Otaheite is known to be
-dead, the house is filled with relations, who deplore
-their loss, some by loud lamentations, and some by
-less clamorous, but more genuine expressions of grief.
-Those who are in the nearest degree of kindred, and
-are really affected by the event, are silent; the rest
-are one moment uttering passionate exclamations in
-a chorus, and the next laughing and talking without
-the least appearance of concern. In this manner the
-remainder of the day on which they assemble is
-spent, and all the succeeding night. On the next
-morning the body is shrouded in their cloth, and
-conveyed to the sea-side upon a bier, which the
-bearers support upon their shoulders, attended by the
-priest, who, having prayed over the body, repeats his
-sentences during the procession. When it arrives at
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_232'>232</span>the water’s edge, it is set down upon the beach; the
-priest renews his prayers, and taking up some of the
-water in his hands, sprinkles it towards the body,
-but not upon it. It is then carried back forty or fifty
-yards, and soon after brought again to the beach,
-where the prayers and sprinkling are repeated: it is
-thus removed backwards and forwards several times,
-and while these ceremonies have been performing a
-house has been built, and a small space of ground
-railed in. In the centre of this house, or Tupapow,
-posts are set up to support the bier, which is at
-length conveyed thither, and placed upon it, and
-here the body remains to putrify till the flesh is
-wholly wasted from the bones.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>These houses of corruption are of a size proportioned
-to the rank of the person whose body they
-are to contain; those allotted to the lower class are
-just sufficient to cover the bier, and have no railing
-round them. The largest we ever saw was eleven yards
-long, and such as these are ornamented according to
-the abilities and inclination of the surviving kindred,
-who never fail to lay a profusion of good cloth about
-the body, and sometimes almost cover the outside of
-the house. Garlands of the fruit of the palm-nut or
-<i>pandanus</i>, and cocoa-leaves, twisted by the priests in
-mysterious knots, with a plant called by them, <i>Ethee
-no Morai</i>, which is particularly consecrated to funeral
-solemnities, are deposited about the place; provision
-and water are also left at a little distance, of which,
-and of other decorations, a more particular description
-has been given already.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As soon as the body is deposited in the Tupapow,
-the mourning is renewed. The women assemble, and
-are led to the door by the nearest relation, who strikes
-a shark’s tooth several times into the crown of her
-head: the blood copiously follows, and is carefully
-received upon pieces of linen, which are thrown
-under the bier. The rest of the women follow this
-example, and the ceremony is repeated at the interval
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_233'>233</span>of two or three days, as long as the zeal and
-sorrow of the parties hold out. The tears also which
-are shed upon these occasions, are received upon
-pieces of cloth, and offered as oblations to the dead:
-some of the younger people cut off their hair, and
-that is thrown under the bier with the other offerings.
-This custom is founded upon a notion that the soul
-of the deceased, which they believe to exist in a
-separate state, is hovering about the place where the
-body is deposited: that it observes the actions of
-the survivors, and is gratified by such testimonies of
-their affection and grief.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Two or three days after these ceremonies have
-been commenced by the women, during which the
-men seem to be wholly insensible of their loss, they
-also begin to perform their part. The nearest relations
-take it in turn to assume the dress, and perform the
-office, which have already been particularly described
-in the account of Tubourai Tamaide’s having acted
-as chief mourner to an old woman, his relation,
-who died while we were in the island. One part of
-the ceremony, however, which accounts for the
-running away of the people as soon as this procession
-is in sight, has not been mentioned. The chief
-mourner carries in his hand a long flat stick, the
-edge of which is set with shark’s teeth, and in a
-phrenzy, which his grief is supposed to have inspired,
-he runs at all he sees, and if any of them happen to
-be overtaken, he strikes them most unmercifully with
-this indented cudgel, which cannot fail to wound
-them in a dangerous manner.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>These processions continue at certain intervals for
-five moons, but are less and less frequent, by a
-gradual diminution, as the end of that time approaches.
-When it is expired, what remains of the
-body is taken down from the bier, and the bones
-having been scraped and washed very clean, are
-buried, according to the rank of the person, either
-within or without a Morai. If the deceased was an
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_234'>234</span>Earee, or chief, his skull is not buried with the rest of
-the bones, but is wrapped up in fine cloth, and put
-in a kind of box made for that purpose, which is also
-placed in the Morai. This coffer is called <i>Ewharre
-no te Orometua</i>, the house of a teacher or master.
-After this the mourning ceases, except some of the
-women continue to be really afflicted for the loss,
-and in that case they will sometimes suddenly wound
-themselves with the shark’s tooth wherever they happen
-to be: this perhaps will account for the passion
-of grief in which Terapo wounded herself at the
-fort; some accidental circumstance might forcibly
-revive the remembrance of a friend or relation whom
-she had lost, with a pungency of regret and tenderness
-which forced a vent by tears, and prompted her
-to a repetition of the funeral rite.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The ceremonies, however, do not cease with the
-mourning: prayers are still said by the priest, who
-is well paid by the surviving relations, and offerings
-made at the Morai. Some of the things, which from
-time to time are deposited there, are emblematical:
-a young plantain represents the deceased, and the
-bunch of feathers the deity who is invoked. The
-priest places himself over against the symbol of the
-god, accompanied by some of the relations, who are
-furnished with a small offering, and repeats his
-oraison in a set form, consisting of separate sentences;
-at the same time weaving the leaves of the
-cocoa-nut into different forms, which he afterwards
-deposits upon the ground where the bones have been
-interred; the deity is then addressed by a shrill
-screech, which is used only upon that occasion.
-When the priest retires, the tuft of feathers is removed,
-and the provisions left to putrify, or be
-devoured by the rats.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Of the religion of these people, we were not able
-to acquire any clear and consistent knowledge: we
-found it like the religion of most other countries,
-involved in mystery, and perplexed with apparent
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_235'>235</span>inconsistencies. The religious language is also here, as
-it is in China, different from that which is used in common,
-so that Tupia, who took great pains to instruct
-us, having no words to express his meaning which
-we understood, gave us lectures to very little purpose:
-what we learnt, however, I will relate with as much
-perspicuity as I can.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Nothing is more obvious to a rational being, however
-ignorant or stupid, than that the universe and
-its various parts, as far as they fall under his notice,
-were produced by some agent inconceivably more
-powerful than himself; and nothing is more difficult
-to be conceived, even by the most sagacious and
-knowing, than the production of them from nothing,
-which among us is expressed by the word <i>Creation</i>.
-It is natural, therefore, as no Being apparently capable
-of producing the universe is to be seen, that he
-should be supposed to reside in some distant part of
-it, or to be in his nature invisible, and that he should
-have originally produced all that now exists in a
-manner similar to that in which nature is renovated
-by the succession of one generation to another; but
-the idea of procreation includes in it that of two
-persons, and from the conjunction of two persons
-these people imagine every thing in the universe,
-either originally or derivatively, to proceed.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The Supreme Deity, one of these two first beings,
-they call <span class='sc'>Taroataihetoomoo</span>, and the other, whom
-they suppose to have been a rock, <span class='sc'>Tepapa</span>. A daughter
-of these was <span class='sc'>Tettowmatatayo</span>, the year, or thirteen
-months collectively, which they never name but upon
-this occasion, and she, by the common father, produced
-the months, and the months, by conjunction
-with each other, the days; the stars they suppose
-partly to be the immediate offspring of the first pair,
-and partly to have increased among themselves; and
-they have the same notion with respect to the different
-species of plants. Among other progeny of
-Taroataihetoomoo and Tepapa, they suppose an inferior
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_236'>236</span>race of deities, whom they call <span class='sc'>Eatuas</span>. Two
-of these Eatuas, they say, at some remote period of
-time, inhabited the earth, and were the parents of
-the first man. When this man, their common ancestor,
-was born, they say that he was round like a ball, but
-that his mother, with great care, drew out his limbs, and
-having at length moulded him into his present form,
-she called him <span class='sc'>Eothe</span>, which signifies <i>finished</i>. That
-being prompted by the universal instinct to propagate
-his kind, and being able to find no female
-but his mother, he begot upon her a daughter, and
-upon the daughter other daughters for several generations,
-before there was a son; a son, however,
-being at length born, he, by the assistance of his
-sisters, peopled the world.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Besides their daughter Tettowmatatayo, the first
-progenitors of nature had a son, whom they called
-<span class='sc'>Tane</span>. Taroataihetoomoo, the supreme deity, they
-emphatically style the causer of earthquakes; but
-their prayers are more generally addressed to Tane,
-whom they suppose to take a greater part in the
-affairs of mankind.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their subordinate deities, or Eatuas, which are
-numerous, are of both sexes: the male are worshipped
-by the men, and the female by the women;
-and each have Morais to which the other sex is not
-admitted, though they have also Morais common to
-both. Men perform the office of priest to both
-sexes, but each sex has its priests, for those who
-officiate for one sex, do not officiate for the other.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>They believe the immortality of the soul, at least
-its existence in a separate state, and that there are
-two situations of different degrees of happiness, somewhat
-analogous to our heaven and hell: the superior
-situation they call <i>Tavirua l’erai</i>, the other <i>Tiahoboo</i>.
-They do not, however, consider them as places of
-reward and punishment, but as receptacles for different
-classes; the first, for their chiefs and principal
-people, the other for those of inferior rank, for
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_237'>237</span>they do not suppose that their actions here in the
-least influence their future state, or indeed that they
-come under the cognizance of their deities at all.
-Their religion, therefore, if it has no influence upon
-their morals, is at least disinterested; and their expressions
-of adoration and reverence, whether by
-words or actions, arise only from a humble sense of
-their own inferiority, and the ineffable excellence of
-divine perfection.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The character of the priest or Tahowa, is hereditary:
-the class is numerous, and consists of all ranks
-of people; the chief, however, is generally the
-younger brother of a good family, and is respected
-in a degree next to their kings. Of the little knowledge
-that is possessed in this country, the priests
-have the greatest share; but it consists principally in
-an acquaintance with the names and ranks of the
-different Eatuas or subordinate divinities, and the
-opinions concerning the origin of things, which have
-been traditionally preserved among the order in detached
-sentences, of which some will repeat an incredible
-number, though but very few of the words
-that are used in their common dialect occur in them.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The priests, however, are superior to the rest of
-the people in the knowledge of navigation and astronomy;
-and, indeed, the name Tahowa signifies nothing
-more than a man of knowledge. As there are
-priests of every class, they officiate only among that
-class to which they belong: the priest of the inferior
-class is never called upon by those of superior rank,
-nor will the priest of the superior rank officiate for
-any of the inferior class.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Marriage in this island, as appeared to us, is nothing
-more than an agreement between the man and
-woman, with which the priest has no concern. Where
-it is contracted, it appears to be pretty well kept,
-though sometimes the parties separate by mutual
-consent, and in that case a divorce takes place with
-as little trouble as the marriage.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_238'>238</span>But though the priesthood has laid the people under
-no tax for a nuptial benediction, there are two
-operations which it has appropriated, and from which
-it derives considerable advantages. One is <i>tattowing</i>,
-and the other circumcision, though neither of them
-have any connection with religion. The tattowing
-has been described already. Circumcision has been
-adopted merely from motives of cleanliness; it cannot
-indeed properly be called circumcision, because
-the <i>prepuce</i> is not mutilated by a circular wound,
-but only slit through the upper part to prevent its
-contracting over the <i>glans</i>. As neither of these can
-be performed by any but a priest, and as to be without
-either is the greatest disgrace, they may be considered
-as a claim to surplice fees like our marriages
-and christenings, which are cheerfully and liberally
-paid, not according to any settled stipend, but the
-rank and abilities of the parties or their friends.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The Morai, as has already been observed, is at
-once a burying-ground and a place of worship, and
-in this particular our churches too much resemble it.
-The Indian, however, approaches his Morai with a
-reverence and humility that disgraces the Christian,
-not because he holds any thing sacred that is there,
-but because he there worships an invisible divinity,
-for whom, though he neither hopes for reward, nor
-fears punishment at his hand, he always expresses
-the profoundest homage and most humble adoration.
-I have already given a very particular description
-both of the Morais and the altars that are placed near
-them. When an Indian is about to worship at the
-Morai, or brings his offering to the altar, he always
-uncovers his body to the waist, and his looks and attitude
-are such as sufficiently express a corresponding
-disposition of mind.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It did not appear to us that these people are, in
-any instance, guilty of idolatry; at least they do not
-worship any thing that is the work of their hands,
-nor any visible part of the creation. This island, indeed,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_239'>239</span>and the rest that lie near it, have a particular
-bird, some a heron, and others a king’s-fisher, to
-which they pay a peculiar regard, and concerning
-which they have some superstitious notions with respect
-to good and bad fortune, as we have of the
-swallow and robin-red-breast, giving them the name
-of <span class='sc'>Eatua</span>, and by no means killing or molesting them;
-yet they never address a petition to them, or approach
-them with any act of adoration.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Though I dare not assert that these people, to
-whom the art of writing, and consequently the recording
-of laws, are utterly unknown, live under a
-regular form of government; yet a subordination is
-established among them, that greatly resembles the
-early state of every nation in Europe under the feudal
-system, which secured liberty in the most licentious
-excess to a few, and entailed the most abject
-slavery upon the rest.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their orders are, <i>Earee rahie</i>, which answers to
-king; <i>Earee</i>, baron; <i>Manahouni</i>, vassal; and <i>Toutou</i>,
-villain. The Earee rahie, of which there are
-two in this island, one being the sovereign of each of
-the peninsulas of which it consists, is treated with
-great respect by all ranks, but did not appear to us
-to be invested with so much power as was exercised
-by the Earees in their own districts; nor, indeed, did
-we, as I have before observed, once see the sovereign
-of Obereonoo while we were in the island. The
-Earees are lords of one or more of the districts into
-which each of the peninsulas is divided, of which there
-may be about one hundred in the whole island; and
-they parcel out their territories to the Manahounies,
-who cultivate each his part which he holds under the
-baron. The lowest class, called Toutous, seem to
-be nearly under the same circumstances as the villains
-in feudal governments: these do all the laborious
-work; they cultivate the land under the Manahounies,
-who are only nominal cultivators for the lord, they
-fetch wood and water, and, under the direction of
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_240'>240</span>the mistress of the family, dress the victuals: they
-also catch the fish.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Each of the Earees keeps a kind of court, and has
-a great number of attendants, chiefly the younger
-brothers of their own tribe; and among these
-some hold particular offices, but of what nature
-exactly we could not tell. One was called the <i>Eowa
-no l’Earee</i>, and another the <i>Whanno no l’Earee</i>, and
-these were frequently dispatched to us with messages.
-Of all the courts of these Earees, that of
-Tootahah was the most splendid, as indeed might
-reasonably be expected, because he administered the
-government for Outou, his nephew, who was Earee
-rahie of Obereonoo, and lived upon his estate. The
-child of the baron or Earee, as well as of the sovereign
-or Earee rahie, succeeds to the title and honours of
-the father as soon as it is born: so that a baron, who
-was yesterday called Earee, and was approached with
-the <a id='cer'></a>ceremony of lowering the garments, so as to uncover
-the upper part of the body, is <a id='day'></a>to-day, if his
-wife was last night delivered of a child, reduced to
-the rank of a private man, all marks of respect being
-transferred to the child, if it is suffered to live, though
-the father still continues possessor and administrator
-of his estate: probably this custom has its share,
-among other inducements, in forming the societies
-called Arreoy.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>If a general attack happens to be made upon the
-island, every district under the command of an Earee,
-is obliged to furnish its proportion of soldiers for the
-common defence. The number furnished by the
-principal districts, which Tupia recollected, when
-added together, amounted, as I have observed before,
-to six thousand six hundred and eighty.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Upon such occasions, the united force of the
-whole island is commanded in chief by the Earee
-rahie. Private differences between two Earees are
-decided by their own people, without at all disturbing
-the general tranquillity.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_241'>241</span>Their weapons are slings, which they use with
-great dexterity, pikes headed with the stings of sting-rays,
-and clubs, of about six or seven feet long, made
-of a very hard heavy wood. Thus armed, they are
-said to fight with great obstinacy, which is the more
-likely to be true, as it is certain that they give no
-quarter to either man, woman, or child, who is so
-unfortunate as to fall into their hands during the
-battle, or for some hours afterwards, till their passion,
-which is always violent, though not lasting, has
-subsided.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The Earee rahie of Obereonoo, while we were here,
-was in perfect amity with the Earee rahie of Tiarreboo,
-the other peninsula, though he took himself the
-title of king of the whole island: this, however, produced
-no more jealousy in the other sovereign, than
-the title of king of France, assumed by our sovereign,
-does in his most Christian Majesty.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In a government so rude, it cannot be expected
-that distributive justice should be regularly administered,
-and indeed, where there is so little opposition
-of interest, in consequence of the facility with which
-every appetite and passion is gratified, there can be
-but few crimes. There is nothing like money, the
-common medium by which every want and every
-wish is supposed to be gratified by those who do not
-possess it; there is no apparently permanent good
-which either fraud or force can unlawfully obtain;
-and when all the crimes that are committed by the
-inhabitants of civilized countries, to get money, are
-set out of the account, not many will remain: add to
-this, that where the commerce with women is restrained
-by no law, men will seldom be under any
-temptation to commit adultery, especially as one
-woman is always less preferred to another, where
-they are less distinguished by personal decorations,
-and the adventitious circumstances which are produced
-by the varieties of art, and the refinements of
-sentiment. That they are thieves is true; but as
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_242'>242</span>among these people no man can be much injured or
-benefited by theft, it is not necessary to restrain it
-by such punishments, as in other countries are absolutely
-necessary to the very existence of civil society.
-Tupia, however, tells us, that adultery is sometimes
-committed as well as theft. In all cases where an
-injury has been committed, the punishment of the
-offender lies with the sufferer: adultery, if the parties
-are caught in the fact, is sometimes punished with
-death in the first ardour of resentment; but without
-circumstances of immediate provocation, the female
-sinner seldom suffers more than a beating. As punishment,
-however, is enforced by no law, nor taken into
-the hand of any magistrate, it is not often inflicted,
-except the injured party is the strongest; though
-the chiefs do sometimes punish their immediate dependents,
-for faults committed against each other,
-and even the dependents of others, if they are accused
-of any offence committed in their district.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Having now given the best description that I can
-of the island in its present state, and of the people,
-with their customs and manners, language and arts,
-I shall only add a few general observations, which
-may be of use to future navigators, if any of the
-ships of Great Britain should receive orders to visit
-it. As it produces nothing that appears to be convertible
-into an article of trade, and can be used only
-by affording refreshments to shipping in their passage
-through these seas, it might be made to answer
-this purpose in a much greater degree, by transporting
-thither sheep, goats, and horned cattle, with
-European garden-stuff, and other useful vegetables,
-which there is the greatest reason to suppose will
-flourish in so fine a climate, and so rich a soil.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Though this, and the neighbouring islands lie
-within the tropic of Capricorn, yet the heat is not
-troublesome, nor did the winds blow constantly
-from the east. We had frequently a fresh gale from
-the S. W. for two or three days, and sometimes,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_243'>243</span>though very seldom, from the N. W. Tupia reported,
-that south westerly winds prevail in October, November,
-and December, and we have no doubt of the
-fact. When the winds are variable, they are always
-accompanied by a swell from the S. W. or W. S. W.;
-there is also a swell from the same points when it is
-calm, and the atmosphere loaded with clouds, which
-is a sure indication that the winds are variable, or
-westerly out at sea, for with the settled trade-wind
-the weather is clear.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The meeting with westerly winds, within the
-general limits of the eastern trade, has induced some
-navigators to suppose that they were near some large
-track of land, of which, however, I think they are no
-indication.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It has been found, both by us and the Dolphin, that
-the trade-wind, in these parts, does not extend farther
-to the south than twenty degrees, beyond which, we
-generally found a gale from the westward; and it is
-reasonable to suppose, that when these winds blow
-strong, they will drive back the easterly wind, and
-consequently encroach upon the limits within which
-they constantly blow, and thus necessarily produce
-variable winds, as either happens to prevail, and a
-south-westerly swell. This supposition is the more
-probable, as it is well known that the trade-winds
-blow but faintly for some distance within their limits,
-and therefore may be more easily stopped or repelled
-by a wind in the contrary direction: it is also well
-known, that the limits of the trade-winds vary not
-only at different seasons of the year, but sometimes
-at the same season, in different years.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>There is therefore no reason to suppose that south-westerly
-winds, within these limits, are caused by the
-vicinity of large tracts of land, especially as they are
-always accompanied with a large swell, in the same
-direction in which they blow; and we find a much
-greater surf beating upon the shores of the south-west
-side of the islands that are situated just within
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_244'>244</span>the limits of the trade-wind, than upon any other
-part of them.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The tides about these islands are perhaps as inconsiderable
-as in any part of the world. A south
-or S. by W. moon, makes high water in the bay of
-Matavai at Otaheite; but the water very seldom rises
-perpendicularly above ten or twelve inches.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The variation of the compass I found to be 4° 46ʹ
-easterly, this being the result of a great number of
-trials made with four of Dr. Knight’s needles, adapted
-to azimuth compasses. These compasses I thought
-the best that could be procured, yet when applied to
-the meridian line, I found them to differ, not only
-one from another, sometimes a degree and an half,
-but the same needle, half a degree from itself in different
-trials made on the same day; and I do not remember
-that I have ever found two needles which
-exactly agreed at the same time and place, though I
-have often found the same needle agree with itself,
-in several trials made one after the other. This imperfection
-of the needle, however, is of no consequence
-to navigation, as the variation can always be
-found to a degree of accuracy, more than sufficient
-for all nautical purposes.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_245'>245</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. XX.<br /> <br />A DESCRIPTION OF SEVERAL OTHER ISLANDS IN THE NEIGHBOURHOOD OF OTAHEITE, WITH VARIOUS INCIDENTS; A DRAMATIC ENTERTAINMENT; AND MANY PARTICULARS RELATIVE TO THE CUSTOMS AND MANNERS OF THE INHABITANTS. </h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>After</span> parting with our friends, we made an easy
-sail, with gentle breezes and clear weather, and were
-informed by Tupia, that four of the neighbouring
-islands, which he distinguished by the names of <span class='sc'>Huaheine</span>,
-<span class='sc'>Ulietea</span>, <span class='sc'>Otaha</span>, and <span class='sc'>Bolabola</span>, lay at the
-distance of between one and two days sail from Otaheite;
-and that hogs, fowls, and other refreshments,
-with which we had of late been but sparingly supplied,
-were there to be procured in great plenty; but
-having discovered from the hills of Otaheite, an
-island lying to the northward, which he called <span class='sc'>Tethuroa</span>,
-I determined first to stand that way, to take
-a nearer view of it. It lies N. ½ W. distant eight
-leagues from the northern extremity of Otaheite,
-upon which we had observed the transit, and to which
-we had, for that reason, given the name of <span class='sc'>Point
-Venus</span>. We found it to be a small low island, and
-were told by Tupia, that it had no settled inhabitants,
-but was occasionally visited by the inhabitants of
-Otaheite, who sometimes went thither for a few days
-to fish; we therefore determined to spend no more
-time in a farther examination of it, but to go in
-search of Huaheine and Ulietea, which he described
-to be well peopled, and as large as Otaheite.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At six o’clock in the morning of the 14th, the
-westermost part of <span class='sc'>Eimeo</span>, or York Island, bore S.
-E. ½ S. and the body of Otaheite E. ½ S. At noon,
-the body of York Island bore E. by S. ½ S.; and Port-Royal
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_246'>246</span>bay, at Otaheite, S. 70° 45ʹ E. distant 61
-miles; and an island, which we took to be Saunders’s
-Island, called by the natives <span class='sc'>Tapoamanao</span>, bore S.
-S. W. We also saw land bearing N. W. ½ W. which
-Tupia said was Huaheine.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 15th, it was hazy, with light breezes and
-calms succeeding each other, so that we could see
-no land, and made but little way. Our Indian, Tupia,
-often prayed for a wind to his god Tane, and
-as often boasted of his success, which indeed he took
-a very effectual method to secure, for he never began
-his address to Tane, till he saw a breeze so near that
-he knew it must reach the ship before his oraison
-was well over.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 16th, we had a gentle breeze; and in the
-morning about eight o’clock, being close in with the
-north-west part of the island Huaheine, we sounded,
-but had no bottom with 80 fathom. Some canoes
-very soon came off, but the people seemed afraid, and
-kept at a distance till they discovered Tupia, and
-then they ventured nearer. In one of the canoes
-that came up to the ship’s side, was the king of the
-island and his wife. Upon assurances of friendship,
-frequently and earnestly repeated, their majesties
-and some others came on board. At first they were
-struck with astonishment, and wondered at every thing
-that was shewn them; yet they made no inquiries,
-and seeming to be satisfied with what was offered to
-their notice, they made no search after other objects
-of curiosity, with which it was natural to suppose a
-building of such novelty and magnitude as the ship
-must abound. After some time, they became more
-familiar. I was given to understand, that the name
-of the king was <span class='sc'>Oree</span>, and he proposed, as a mark of
-amity, that we should exchange names. To this I
-readily consented; and he was Cookee, for so he
-pronounced my name, and I was Oree, for the rest
-of the time we were together. We found these people
-to be very nearly the same with those of Otaheite, in
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_247'>247</span>person, dress, language, and every other circumstance,
-except, if Tupia might be believed, that they
-would not steal.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Soon after dinner, we came to an anchor in a
-small but excellent harbour on the west side of the
-island, which the natives call <span class='sc'>Owharre</span>, in eighteen
-fathom water, clear ground, and secure from all
-winds. I went immediately ashore, accompanied by
-Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, Mr. Monkhouse, Tupia,
-King Cookee, and some other of the natives who had
-been on board ever since the morning. The moment
-we landed, Tupia stripped himself as low as
-the waist, and desired Mr. Monkhouse to do the
-same: he then sat down before a great number of
-the natives, who were collected together in a large
-house or shed; for here, as well as at Otaheite, a
-house consists only of a roof supported upon poles;
-the rest of us, by his desire, standing behind. He
-then began a speech or prayer, which lasted about a
-quarter of an hour, the king, who stood over against
-him, every now and then answering in what appeared
-to be set responses. In the course of this harangue,
-he delivered, at different times, two handkerchiefs, a
-black silk neckcloth, some beads, two small bunches
-of feathers, and some plantains, as presents to their
-Eatua, or God. In return for these, he received for
-our Eatua, a hog, some young plantains, and two
-small bunches of feathers, which he ordered to be
-carried on board the ship. After these ceremonies,
-which we supposed to be the ratification of a treaty
-between us, every one was dismissed to go whither he
-pleased; and Tupia immediately repaired to offer his
-oblations at one of the Morais.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The next morning, we went on shore again, and
-walked up the hills, where the productions were exactly
-the same as those of Otaheite, except that the
-rocks and clay appeared to be more burnt. The
-houses were neat, and the boat-houses remarkably
-large; one that we measured was fifty paces long,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_248'>248</span>ten broad, and twenty-four feet high, the whole
-formed a pointed arch, like those of our old cathedrals,
-which was supported on one side by twenty-six,
-and on the other by thirty pillars, or rather
-posts, about two feet high, and one thick, upon most
-of which were rudely carved the heads of men, and
-several fanciful devices, not altogether unlike those
-which we sometimes see printed from wooden blocks,
-at the beginning and end of old books. The plains,
-or flat part of the country, abounded in bread-fruit,
-and cocoa-nut trees; in some places, however, there
-were salt swamps and lagoons, which would produce
-neither.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We went again a-shore on the 18th, and would
-have taken the advantage of Tupia’s company, in
-our perambulation; but he was too much engaged
-with his friends: we took, however, his boy, whose
-name was <span class='sc'>Tayeto</span>, and Mr. Banks went to take a
-farther view of what had much engaged his attention
-before; it was a kind of chest or ark, the lid of
-which was nicely sewed on, and thatched very neatly
-with palm-nut leaves: it was fixed upon two poles,
-and supported on little arches of wood, very neatly
-carved; the use of the poles seemed to be to remove
-it from place to place, in the manner of our sedan
-chairs: in one end of it was a square hole, in the
-middle of which was a ring touching the sides, and
-leaving the angles open, so as to form a round hole
-within a square one. The first time Mr. Banks saw
-this coffer, the aperture at the end was stopped with
-a piece of cloth, which, lest he should give offence,
-he left untouched; probably there was then something
-within, but now the cloth was taken away, and,
-upon looking into it, it was found empty. The
-general resemblance between this repository and the
-Ark of the Lord among the Jews is remarkable; but
-it is still more remarkable, that upon inquiring of the
-boy what it was called, he said, <i>Ewharre no Eatua</i>,
-the <i>house of the God</i>: he could however give no account
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_249'>249</span>of its signification or use. We had commenced
-a kind of trade with the natives, but it went on
-slowly; for when any thing was offered, not one of
-them would take it upon his own judgment, but collected
-the opinions of twenty or thirty people, which
-could not be done without great loss of time. We
-got, however, eleven pigs, and determined to try for
-more the next day.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The next day, therefore, we brought out some
-hatchets, for which we hoped we should have had no
-occasion, upon an island which no European had
-ever visited before. These procured us three very
-large hogs; and as we proposed to sail in the afternoon,
-King Oree and several others came on board
-to take their leave. To the king I gave a small
-plate of pewter, on which was stamped this inscription,
-“His Britannic-Majesty’s ship, Endeavour,
-Lieutenant Cook, Commander, 16th July, 1769, Huaheine.”
-I gave him also some medals or counters,
-resembling the coin of England, struck in the year
-1761, with some other presents; and he promised
-that with none of these, particularly the plate, he
-would ever part. I thought it as lasting a testimony
-of our having first discovered this island, as any we
-could leave behind; and having dismissed our visitors
-well satisfied, and in great good-humour, we set
-sail, about half an hour after two in the afternoon.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The island of Huaheine, or Huahene, is situated
-in the latitude of 16° 43ʹ S. and longitude 152° 52ʹ
-W. from Greenwich: it is distant from Otaheite about
-thirty-one leagues, in the direction of N. 58 W. and
-is about seven leagues in compass. Its surface is
-hilly and uneven, and it has a safe and commodious
-harbour. The harbour, which is called by the natives
-<span class='sc'>Owalle</span>, or <span class='sc'>Owharre</span>, lies on the west side,
-under the northernmost high land, and within the
-north end of the reef, which lies along that side of
-the island; there are two inlets or openings, by which
-it may be entered, through the reef, about a mile
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_250'>250</span>and a half distant from each other; the southernmost
-is the widest, and on the south side of it lies a very
-small sandy island.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Huaheine seems to be a month forwarder in its
-productions than Otaheite, as we found the cocoa-nuts
-full of kernel, and some of the new bread-fruit
-fit to eat. Of the cocoa-nuts the inhabitants make a
-food which they call <i>Poe</i>, by mixing them with yams;
-they scrape both fine, and having incorporated the
-powder, they put it into a wooden trough, with a
-number of hot stones, by which an oily kind of hasty-pudding
-is made, that our people relished very well,
-especially when it was fried. Mr. Banks found not
-more than eleven or twelve new plants; but he observed
-some insects, and a species of scorpion which
-he had not seen before.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The inhabitants seem to be larger made, and more
-stout, than those of Otaheite. Mr. Banks measured
-one of the men, and found him to be six feet three
-inches and an half high; yet they are so lazy, that he
-could not persuade any of them to go up the hills
-with him: they said, if they were to attempt it, the
-fatigue would kill them. The women were very fair,
-more so than those of Otaheite; and in general, we
-thought them more handsome, though none that
-were equal to some individuals. Both sexes seemed
-to be less timid, and less curious: it has been observed,
-that they made no inquiries on board the
-ship; and when we fired a gun, they were frighted
-indeed, but they did not fall down, as our friends at
-Otaheite constantly did when we first came among
-them. For this difference, however, we can easily
-account upon other principles; the people at Huaheine
-had not seen the Dolphin, those at Otaheite
-had. In one, the report of a gun was connected
-with the idea of instant destruction; to the other,
-there was nothing dreadful in it but the appearance
-and the sound, as they had never experienced its
-power of dispensing death.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_251'>251</span>While we were on shore, we found that Tupia had
-commended them beyond their merit, when he said
-that they would not steal; for one of them was detected
-in the fact. But when he was seized by the
-hair, the rest, instead of running away, as the people
-at Otaheite would have done, gathered round,
-and inquired what provocation had been given: but
-this also may be accounted for without giving them
-credit for superior courage; they had no experience
-of the consequence of European resentment, which
-the people at Otaheite had in many instances purchased
-with life. It must, however, be acknowledged,
-to their honour, that when they understood what had
-happened, they showed strong signs of disapprobation,
-and prescribed a good beating for the thief,
-which was immediately administered.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We now made sail for the island of <span class='sc'>Ulietea</span>, which
-lies S. W. by W. distant seven or eight leagues from
-Huaheine, and at half an hour after six in the evening,
-we were within three leagues of the shore, on the
-eastern side. We stood off and on all night, and
-when the day broke the next morning, we stood in
-for the shore: we soon after discovered an opening
-in the reef which lies before the island, within which
-Tupia told us there was a good harbour. I did not,
-however, implicitly take his word; but sent the master
-out in the pinnace to examine it: he soon made
-the signal for the ship to follow; we accordingly stood
-in, and anchored in two-and-twenty fathom, with
-soft ground.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The natives soon came off to us in two canoes, each
-of which brought a woman and a pig. The woman
-we supposed was a mark of confidence, and the pig
-was a present; we received both with proper acknowledgments,
-and complimented each of the ladies with
-a spike nail and some beads, much to their satisfaction.
-We were told by Tupia, who had always expressed
-much fear of the men of Bolabola, that they
-had made a conquest of this island; and that, if we
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_252'>252</span>remained here, they would certainly come down to-morrow,
-and fight us. We determined, therefore,
-to go on shore without delay, while the day was
-our own.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>I landed in company with Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander,
-and the other gentlemen, Tupia being also of
-the party. He introduced us by repeating the ceremonies
-which he had performed at Huaheine, after
-which I hoisted an English jack, and took possession
-of this and the three neighbouring islands, Huaheine,
-Otaha, and Bolabola, which were all in sight, in the
-name of his Britannic Majesty. After this, we took
-a walk to a great Morai, called Tapodeboatea. We
-found it very different from those of Otaheite; for it
-consisted only of four walls, about eight feet high,
-of coral stones, some of which were of an immense
-size, inclosing an area of about five-and-twenty yards
-square, which was filled up with smaller stones: upon
-the top of it many planks were set up on end, which
-were carved in their whole length: at a little distance
-we found an altar, or Ewhatta, upon which lay the
-last oblation or sacrifice, a hog of about eighty pounds
-weight, which had been offered whole, and very
-nicely roasted. Here were also four or five Ewharre-no-Eatua,
-or houses of God, to which carriage poles
-were fitted, like that which we had seen at Huaheine.
-One of these Mr. Banks examined by putting his
-hand into it, and found a parcel about five feet long
-and one thick, wrapped up in mats: he broke a way
-through several of these mats with his fingers, but
-at length came to one which was made of the fibres
-of the cocoa-nut, so firmly plaited together that he
-found it impossible to tear it, and therefore was
-forced to desist; especially as he perceived, that
-what he had done already gave great offence to our
-new friends. From hence we went to a long house,
-not far distant, where, among rolls of cloth, and several
-other things, we saw the model of a canoe,
-about three feet long, to which were tied eight human
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_253'>253</span>jaw-bones: we had already learnt that these,
-like scalps among the Indians of North America,
-were trophies of war. Tupia affirmed that they were
-the jaw-bones of the natives of this island: if so,
-they might have been hung up, with the model of a
-canoe, as a symbol of invasion, by the warriors of
-Bolabola, as a memorial of their conquest.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Night now came on apace, but Mr. Banks and
-Dr. Solander continued their walk along the shore,
-and at a little distance saw another Ewharre-no-Eatua,
-and a tree of the fig kind, the same as that which
-Mr. Green had seen at Otaheite, in great perfection,
-the trunk, or rather congeries of the roots of
-which was forty-two paces in circumference.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 21st, having dispatched the master in the
-long-boat to examine the coast of the south part of
-the island, and one of the mates in the yawl, to
-sound the harbour where the ship lay, I went myself
-in the pinnace, to survey that part of the island
-which lies to the north. Mr. Banks and the gentlemen
-were again on shore, trading with the natives,
-and examining the products and curiosities of the
-country; they saw nothing, however, worthy notice,
-but some more jaw-bones, of which they made no
-doubt but that the account they had heard was true.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 22d and 23d, having strong gales and hazy
-weather, I did not think it safe to put to sea; but
-on the 24th, though the wind was still variable, I got
-under sail, and plied to the northward within the
-reef, with a view to go out at a wider opening
-than that by which I had entered; in doing this,
-however, I was unexpectedly in the most imminent
-danger of striking on the rock: the master, whom
-I had ordered to keep continually sounding in the
-chains, suddenly called out “two fathom.” This
-alarmed me, for though I knew the ship drew at
-least fourteen feet, and that therefore it was impossible
-such a shoal should be under her keel; yet the
-master was either mistaken, or she went along the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_254'>254</span>edge of a coral rock, many of which, in the neighbourhood
-of these islands, are as steep as a wall.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This harbour, or bay, is called by the natives
-<span class='sc'>Oopoa</span>, and taken in its greatest extent, it is capable
-of holding any number of shipping. It extends almost
-the whole length of the east side of the island,
-and is defended from the sea by a reef of coral rocks:
-the southernmost opening in this reef, or channel into
-the harbour, by which we entered, is little more than
-a cable’s length wide; it lies off the easternmost part
-of the island, and may be known by another small
-woody island, which lies a little to the south-east of
-it, called by the people here <span class='sc'>Oatara</span>. Between three
-and four miles north west from this island, lie two other
-islets, in the same direction as the reef, of which
-they are a part, called <span class='sc'>Opururu</span> and <span class='sc'>Tamou</span>; between
-these lies the other channel into the harbour,
-through which I went out, and which is a full quarter
-of a mile wide. Still farther to the north-west
-are some other small islands, near which I am told
-there is another small channel into the harbour; but
-this I know only by report.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The principal refreshments that are to be procured
-at this part of the island are, plantains, cocoa-nuts,
-yams, hogs, and fowls; the hogs and fowls, however,
-are scarce; and the country, where we saw it, is
-neither so populous, nor so rich in produce as Otaheite,
-or even Huaheine. Wood and water may also
-be procured here; but the water cannot conveniently
-be got at.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We were now again at sea, without having received
-any interruption from the hostile inhabitants of Bolabola,
-whom, notwithstanding the fears of Tupia,
-we intended to visit. At four o’clock in the afternoon
-of the 25th, we were within a league of Otaha,
-which bore N. 77 W. To the northward of the south
-end of that island, on the east side of it, and something
-more than a mile from the shore, lie two small
-islands, called <span class='sc'>Toahoutu</span> and <span class='sc'>Whennuaia</span>; between
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_255'>255</span>which, Tupia says, there is a channel into a very good
-harbour, which lies within the reef, and appearances
-confirmed his report.</p>
-
-<div id='il1_03' class='figcenter id002'>
-<img src='images/il1_03.jpg' alt='' class='ig001' />
-<div class='ic001'>
-<p><i>The Harbour of Oopoa.</i></p>
-</div>
-</div>
-
-<p class='c000'>As I discovered a broad channel between Otaha
-and Bolabola, I determined rather to go through it,
-than run to the northward of all; but the wind being
-right a-head, I got no ground.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Between five and six in the evening of the 26th,
-as I was standing to the northward, I discovered a
-small low island, lying N. by W. or N. N. W. distant
-four or five leagues from Bolabola. We were told
-by Tupia that the name of this island is <span class='sc'>Tubai</span>; that
-it produces nothing but cocoa-nuts, and is inhabited
-only by three families; though it is visited by the inhabitants
-of the neighbouring islands, who resort thither
-to catch fish, with which the coast abounds.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 27th, about noon, the peak of Bolabola
-bore N. 25 W. and the north end of <span class='sc'>Otaha</span>, N. 80 W.
-distant three leagues. The wind continued contrary
-all this day and the night following. On the 28th,
-at six in the morning, we were near the entrance of
-the harbour on the east side of <span class='sc'>Otaha</span>, which has
-been just mentioned; and finding that it might be
-examined without losing time, I sent away the master
-in the long-boat, with orders to sound it; and, if the
-wind did not shift in our favour, to land upon the
-island, and traffic with the natives for such refreshments
-as were to be had. In this boat went Mr.
-Banks and Dr. Solander, who landed upon the island,
-and before night purchased three hogs, twenty-one
-fowls, and as many yams and plantains as the boat
-would hold. Plantains we thought a more useful refreshment
-even than pork; for they were boiled and
-served to the ship’s company as bread, and were now
-the more acceptable as our bread was so full of vermin,
-that notwithstanding all possible care, we had
-sometimes twenty of them in our mouths at a time,
-everyone of which tasted as hot as mustard. The island
-seemed to be more barren than Ulietea, but the produce
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_256'>256</span>was of the same kind. The people also exactly
-resembled those that we had seen at the other islands;
-they were not numerous, but they flocked about the
-boat wherever she went from all quarters, bringing
-with them whatever they had to sell. They paid the
-strangers, of whom they had received an account
-from Tupia, the same compliment which they used
-towards their own kings, uncovering their shoulders,
-and wrapping their garments round their breasts; and
-were so solicitous to prevent its being neglected by
-any of their people, that a man was sent with them,
-who called out to every one they met, telling him
-what they were, and what he was to do.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the mean time, I kept plying off and on, waiting
-for the boat’s return; at half an hour after five,
-not seeing any thing of her, I fired a gun, and after
-it was dark hoisted a light; at half an hour after
-eight, we heard the report of a musquet, which we
-answered with a gun, and soon after the boat came
-on board. The master reported, that the harbour
-was safe and commodious, with good anchorage
-from twenty-five to sixteen fathom water, clear
-ground.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As soon as the boat was hoisted in, I made sail to
-the northward, and at eight o’clock in the morning
-of the 29th, we were close under the Peak of Bolabola,
-which was high, rude, and craggy. As the island
-was altogether inaccessible in this part, and we
-found it impossible to weather it, we tacked and stood
-off, then tacked again, and after many trips did not
-weather the south end of it till twelve o’clock at
-night. At eight o’clock the next morning, we discovered
-an island, which bore from us N. 63° W. distant
-about eight leagues; at the same time the Peak
-of Bolabola bore N. ¼ E. distant three or four leagues.
-This island Tupia called <span class='sc'>Maurua</span>, and said that it
-was small, wholly surrounded by a reef, and without
-any harbour for shipping; but inhabited, and bearing
-the same produce as the neighbouring islands: the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_257'>257</span>middle of it rises in a high round hill, that may be seen
-at the distance of ten leagues.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When we were off Bolabola, we saw but few people
-on the shore, and were told by Tupia that many of
-the inhabitants were gone to Ulietea. In the afternoon
-we found ourselves nearly the length of the
-south end of Ulietea, and to windward of some harbours
-that lay on the west side of this island. Into
-one of these harbours, though we had before been
-ashore on the other side of the island, I intended to
-put, in order to stop a leak which we had sprung in
-the powder room, and to take in more ballast, as I
-found the ship too light to carry sail upon a wind.
-As the wind was right against us, we plied off one of
-the harbours, and about three o’clock in the afternoon
-on the 1st of August, we came to an anchor
-in the entrance of the channel leading into it, in fourteen
-fathom water, being prevented from working in,
-by a tide which set very strong out. We then carried
-out the kedge-anchor, in order to warp into the
-harbour; but when this was done, we could not trip
-the bower-anchor with all the purchase we could
-make; we were therefore obliged to lie still all night,
-and in the morning, when the tide turned, the ship
-going over the anchor, it tripped of itself, and we
-warped the ship into a proper birth with ease, and
-moored in twenty-eight fathom, with a sandy bottom.
-While this was doing, many of the natives came off
-to us with hogs, fowls, and plantains, which they
-parted with at an easy rate.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When the ship was secured, I went on shore to
-look for a proper place to get ballast and water, both
-which I found in a very convenient situation.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This day Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander spent on
-shore, very much to their satisfaction: every body
-seemed to fear and respect them, placing in them at
-the same time the utmost confidence, behaving as if
-conscious that they possessed the power of doing
-them mischief, without any propensity to make use
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_258'>258</span>of it. Men, women, and children, crowded round
-them, and followed them wherever they went; but
-none of them were guilty of the least incivility: on
-the contrary, whenever there happened to be dirt or
-water in the way, the men vied with each other to
-carry them over on their backs. They were conducted
-to the houses of the principal people, and
-were received in a manner altogether new: the people,
-who followed them while they were in their way,
-rushed forward as soon as they came to a house, and
-went hastily in before them, leaving however a lane
-sufficiently wide for them to pass. When they entered,
-they found those who had preceded them
-ranged on each side of a long matt, which was spread
-upon the ground, and at the farther end of which
-sat the family: in the first house they entered, they
-found some very young women or children, dressed
-with the utmost neatness, who kept their station, expecting
-the strangers to come up to them and make
-them presents, which they did with the greatest pleasure;
-for prettier children, or better dressed, they had
-never seen. One of them was a girl about six years
-old; her gown or upper garment was red; a large
-quantity of platted hair was wound round her head,
-the ornament to which they give the name of Tamou,
-and which they value more than any thing they possess.
-She sat at the upper end of a matt thirty feet
-long, upon which none of the spectators presumed to
-set a foot, notwithstanding the crowd; and she leaned
-upon the arm of a well-looking woman about thirty,
-who was probably her nurse. Our gentlemen walked
-up to her, and as soon as they approached, she
-stretched out her hand to receive the beads which they
-offered her, and no princess in Europe could have
-done it with a better grace.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The people were so much gratified by the presents
-which were made to these girls, that when Mr.
-Banks and Dr. Solander returned, they seemed attentive
-to nothing but how to oblige them: and in one
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_259'>259</span>of the houses, they were, by order of the master, entertained
-with a dance different from any that they
-had seen. It was performed by one man, who put
-upon his head a large cylindrical piece of wickerwork,
-or basket, about four feet long and eight inches
-in diameter, which was faced with feathers, placed
-perpendicularly, with the tops bending forwards, and
-edged round with shark’s teeth, and the tail feathers
-of tropic birds: when he had put on this head-dress,
-which is called a <i>Whow</i>, he began to dance, moving
-slowly, and often turning his head so as that the top
-of his high wicker-cap described a circle, and sometimes
-throwing it so near the faces of the spectators
-as to make them start back: this was held among
-them as a very good joke, and never failed to produce
-a peal of laughter, especially when it was played off
-upon one of the strangers.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 3d, we went along the shore to the northward,
-which was in a direction opposite to that of
-the route Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander had taken the
-day before, with a design to purchase stock, which
-we always found the people more ready to part with,
-and at a more easy price, at their houses than at the
-market. In the course of our walk, we met with a
-company of dancers, who detained us two hours,
-and during all that time afforded us great entertainment.
-The company consisted of two women dancers,
-and six men, with three drums; we were informed
-by Tupia, that they were some of the most considerable
-people of the island, and that, though they were
-continually going from place to place, they did not,
-like the little strolling companies of Otaheite, take any
-gratuity from the spectators. The women had upon
-their heads a considerable quantity of Tamou, or
-platted hair, which was brought several times round
-the head, and adorned in many parts with the flowers
-of the cape-jessamine, which were stuck in with
-much taste, and made a head-dress truly elegant.
-Their necks, shoulders, and arms, were naked; so
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_260'>260</span>were the breasts also, as low as the parting of the arm;
-below that, they were covered with black cloth, which
-set close to the body; at the side of each breast, next
-the arm, was placed a small plume of black feathers,
-much in the same manner as our ladies now wear their
-nosegays or <i>bouquets</i>; upon their hips rested a quantity
-of cloth plaited very full, which reached up to
-the breast, and fell down below into long petticoats,
-which quite concealed their feet, and which they
-managed with as much dexterity as our opera dancers
-could have done: the plaits above the waist were
-brown and white alternately, the petticoats below were
-all white.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In this dress they advanced sideways in a measured
-step, keeping excellent time to the drums, which
-beat briskly and loud; soon after they began to shake
-their hips, giving the folds of cloth that lay upon
-them a very quick motion, which was in some degree
-continued through the whole dance, though the body
-was thrown into various postures, sometimes standing,
-sometimes sitting, and sometimes resting on
-their knees and elbows, the fingers also being moved
-at the same time with a quickness scarcely to be imagined.
-Much of the dexterity of the dancers, however,
-and the entertainment of the spectators, consisted
-in the wantonness of their attitudes and gestures,
-which was, indeed, such as exceeds all description.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>One of these girls had in her ear three pearls; one
-of them was very large, but so foul that it was of
-little value; the other two were as big as a middling
-pea; these were clear, and of a good colour and
-shape, though spoiled by the drilling. Mr. Banks
-would fain have purchased them, and offered the
-owner any thing she would ask for them, but she
-could not be persuaded to part with them at any
-price: he tempted her with the value of four hogs, and
-whatever else she should choose, but without success;
-and indeed they set a value upon their pearls very nearly
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_261'>261</span>equal to what they would fetch among us, except
-they could be procured before they are drilled.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Between the dances of the women, the men performed
-a kind of dramatic interlude, in which there
-was dialogue as well as dancing; but we were not
-sufficiently acquainted with their language to understand
-the subject.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 4th, some of our gentlemen saw a much
-more regular entertainment of the dramatic kind, which
-was divided into four acts.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Tupia had often told us that he had large possessions
-in this island, which had been taken away from
-him by the inhabitants of Bolabola, and he now
-pointed them out in the very bay where the ship was
-at anchor. Upon our going on shore, this was confirmed
-by the inhabitants, who showed us several districts
-or Whennuas, which they acknowledged to be
-his right.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 5th, I received a present of three hogs,
-some fowls, several pieces of cloth, the largest we
-had seen, being fifty yards long, which they unfolded
-and displayed so as to make the greatest show possible;
-and a considerable quantity of plantains, cocoa-nuts,
-and other refreshments, from Opoony, the formidable
-king, or, in the language of the country,
-Earee rahie, of Bolabola, with a message that he was
-at this time upon the island, and that the next day
-he intended to pay me a visit.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the mean time Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander
-went upon the hills, accompanied by several of the
-Indians, who conducted them by excellent paths, to
-such a height, that they plainly saw the other side of
-the island, and the passage through which the ship
-had passed the reef between the little islands of Opururu
-and Tamou, when we landed upon it the first
-time. As they were returning, they saw the Indians
-exercising themselves at what they call <i>Erowhaw</i>,
-which is nothing more than pitching a kind of light
-lance, headed with hard wood, at a mark: in this
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_262'>262</span>amusement, though they seem very fond of it, they
-do not excel, for not above one in twelve struck the
-mark, which was the hole of a plantain tree, at about
-twenty yards distance.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 6th, we all staid at home, expecting the
-visit of the great king, but we were disappointed;
-we had, however, much more agreeable company,
-for he sent three very pretty girls to demand something
-in return for his present: perhaps he was unwilling
-to trust himself on board the ship, or perhaps
-he thought his messengers would procure a more
-valuable return for his hogs and poultry than he
-could himself; be that as it may, we did not regret
-his absence, nor his messengers their visit.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the afternoon, as the great king would not
-come to us, we determined to go to the great king.
-As he was lord of the Bolabola men, the conquerors
-of this, and the terror of all the other islands, we
-expected to see a chief young and vigorous, with an
-intelligent countenance, and an enterprising spirit: we
-found, however, a poor feeble wretch, withered and
-decrepit, half blind with age, and so sluggish and
-stupid that he appeared scarcely to have understanding
-enough left to know that it was probable we
-should be gratified either by hogs or women. He did
-not receive us sitting, or with any state or formality as
-the other chiefs had done: we made him our present,
-which he accepted, and gave a hog in return. We
-had learnt that his principal residence was at Otaha;
-and upon our telling him that we intended to go
-thither in our boats the next morning, and that we
-should be glad to have him along with us, he promised
-to be of the party.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Early in the morning, therefore, I set out both
-with the pinnace and long-boat for Otaha, having
-some of the gentlemen with me; and in our way we
-called upon Opoony, who was in his canoe, ready to
-join us. As soon as we landed at Otaha, I made him
-a present of an axe, which I thought might induce
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_263'>263</span>him to encourage his subjects to bring us such
-provision as we wanted; but in this we found ourselves
-sadly disappointed; for after staying with him
-till noon, we left him without being able to procure a
-single article. I then proceeded to the north point
-of the island, in the pinnace, having sent the long-boat
-another way. As I went along, I picked up half
-a dozen hogs, as many fowls, and some plantains and
-yams. Having viewed and sketched the harbour on
-this side of the island, I made the best of my way
-back with the long-boat, which joined me soon after
-it was dark; and about ten o’clock at night we got
-on board the ship.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In this excursion Mr. Banks was not with us: he
-spent the morning on board the ship, trading with
-the natives, who came off in their canoes, for provisions
-and curiosities; and, in the afternoon, he went
-on shore with his draughtsmen, to sketch the dresses
-of the dancers which he had seen a day or two
-before. He found the company exactly the same,
-except that another woman had been added to it:
-the dancing also of the women was the same, but the
-interludes of the men were somewhat varied; he saw
-five or six performed, which were different from each
-other, and very much resembled the drama of our
-stage dances. The next day, he went ashore again,
-with Dr. Solander, and they directed their course
-towards the dancing company, which, from the time
-of our second landing, had gradually moved about
-two leagues in their course round the island. They
-saw more dancing, and more interludes, the interludes
-still varying from each other: in one of them the
-performers, who were all men, were divided into two
-parties, which were distinguished from each other by
-the colour of their clothes, one being brown, and the
-other white. The brown party represented a master
-and servants, and the white party a company of
-thieves: the master gave a basket of meat to the rest
-of his party, with a charge to take care of it: the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_264'>264</span>dance of the white party consisted of several expedients
-to steal it, and that of the brown party in
-preventing their success. After some time, those
-who had charge of the basket placed themselves
-round it upon the ground, and, leaning upon it,
-appeared to go to sleep; the others, improving this
-opportunity, came gently upon them, and lifting them
-up from the basket, carried off their prize: the
-sleepers, soon after awaking, missed their basket, but
-presently fell a dancing, without any farther regarding
-their loss; so that the dramatic action of this dance
-was, according to the severest laws of criticism, one,
-and our lovers of simplicity would here have been
-gratified with an entertainment perfectly suited to
-the chastity of their taste.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 9th, having spent the morning in trading
-with the canoes, we took the opportunity of a breeze,
-which sprung up at east, and having stopped our leak,
-and got the fresh stock which we had purchased on
-board, we sailed out of the harbour. When we were
-sailing away, Tupia strongly urged me to fire a shot
-towards Bolabola, possibly as a mark of his resentment,
-and to show the power of his new allies: in
-this I thought proper to gratify him, though we were
-seven leagues distant.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>While we were about these islands, we expended
-very little of the ship’s provisions, and were very
-plentifully supplied with hogs, fowls, plantains and
-yams, which we hoped would have been of great use
-to us in our course to the southward; but the hogs
-would not eat European grain of any kind, pulse, or
-bread-dust, so that we could not preserve them alive;
-and the fowls were all very soon seized with a disease
-that affected the head so, that they continued to
-hold it down between their legs till they died: much
-dependence, therefore, must not be placed in live
-stock taken on board at these places, at least not till
-a discovery is made of some food that the hogs will
-eat, and some remedy for the disease of the poultry.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_265'>265</span>Having been necessarily detained at Ulietea so
-long, by the carpenters, in stopping our leak, we determined
-to give up our design of going on shore at
-Bolabola, especially as it appeared to be difficult of
-access.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>To these six islands, Ulietea, Otaha, Bolabola,
-Huaheine, Tubai, and Maurua, as they lie contiguous
-to each other, I gave the names of <span class='sc'>Society Islands</span>,
-but did not think it proper to distinguish them separately
-by any other names than those by which
-they were known to the natives.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>They are situated between the latitude of 16° 10ʹ
-and 16° 55ʹ S., and between the longitude of 150°
-57ʹ and 152° W. from the meridian of Greenwich.
-Ulietea and Otaha lie within about two miles of each
-other, and are both inclosed within one reef of coral
-rocks, so that there is no passage for shipping between
-them. This reef forms several excellent harbours;
-the entrances into them, indeed, are but narrow, yet
-when a ship is once in, nothing can hurt her. The
-harbours on the east side have been described
-already; and on the west side of Ulietea, which is
-the largest of the two, there are three. The northernmost,
-in which we lay, is called <span class='sc'>Ohamaneno</span>: the
-channel leading into it is about a quarter of a mile
-wide, and lies between two low sandy islands, which
-are the northernmost on this side; between, or just
-within the two islands, there is good anchorage in
-twenty-eight fathom, soft ground. This harbour,
-though small, is preferable to the others, because
-it is situated in the most fertile part of the island,
-and where fresh water is easily to be got. The other
-two harbours lie to the southward of this, and not far
-from the south end of the island: in both of them
-there is good anchorage, with ten, twelve, and
-fourteen fathom. They are easily known by three
-small woody islands at their entrance. The southernmost
-of these two harbours lies within, and to the
-southward of the southernmost of these islands, and
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_266'>266</span>the other lies between the two northernmost. I was
-told that there were more harbours at the south end
-of this island, but I did not examine whether the
-report was true.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Otaha affords two very good harbours, one on the
-east side, and the other on the west. That on the east
-side is called Ohamene, and has been mentioned
-already; the other is called <span class='sc'>Oherurua</span>, and lies about
-the middle of the south-west side of the island; it is
-pretty large, and affords good anchorage in twenty
-and twenty-five fathom, nor is there any want of fresh
-water. The breach in the reef, that forms a channel
-into this harbour, is about a quarter of a mile broad,
-and, like all the rest, is very steep on both sides: in
-general there is no danger here but what is visible.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The island of Bolabola lies N. W. and by W. from
-Otaha, distant about four leagues; it is surrounded by
-a reef of rocks, and several small islands, in compass
-together about eight leagues. I was told, that, on
-the south-west side of the island, there is a channel
-through the reef into a very good harbour, but I did
-not think it worth while to examine it, for the reasons
-that have been just assigned. This island is rendered
-very remarkable by a high craggy hill, which appears
-to be almost perpendicular, and terminates at the top
-in two peaks, one higher than the other.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The land of Ulietea and Otaha is hilly, broken,
-and irregular, except on the sea-coast, yet the hills
-look green and pleasant, and are, in many places,
-clothed with wood. The several particulars in which
-these islands, and their inhabitants, differ from what
-we had observed, at Otaheite, have been mentioned
-in the course of the narrative.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We pursued our course without any event worthy
-of note till the 13th, about noon, when we saw land
-bearing S. E., which Tupia told us was an island
-called <span class='sc'>Oheteroa</span>. About six in the evening, we
-were within two or three leagues of it, upon which I
-shortened sail, and stood off and on all night; the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_267'>267</span>next morning stood in for the land. We ran to leeward
-of the island, keeping close in shore, and saw
-several of the natives, though in no great numbers,
-upon the beach. At nine o’clock I sent Mr. Gore,
-one of my lieutenants, in the pinnace, to endeavour
-to land upon the island, and learn from the natives
-whether there was anchorage in a bay then in sight,
-and what land lay farther to the southward. Mr.
-Banks and Dr. Solander accompanied Mr. Gore in
-this expedition, and as they thought Tupia might be
-useful, they took him with them.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As the boat approached the shore, those on board
-perceived the natives to be armed with long lances:
-as they did not intend to land till they got round a
-point which runs out at a little distance, they stood
-along the coast, and the natives, therefore, very probably
-thought they were afraid of them. They had
-now got together to the number of about sixty, and all
-of them sat down upon the shore, except two, who were
-dispatched forward to observe the motions of those in
-the boat. These men, after walking abreast of her
-some time, at length leaped into the water, and swam
-towards her, but were soon left behind; two more then
-appeared, and attempted to board her in the same manner,
-but they also were soon left behind; a fifth man
-then ran forward alone, and having got a good way
-a-head of the boat before he took to the water, easily
-reached her. Mr. Banks urged the officer to take
-him in, thinking it a good opportunity to get the
-confidence and good-will of a people, who then
-certainly looked upon them as enemies, but he obstinately
-refused; this man, therefore, was left behind
-like the others, and so was a sixth, who followed
-him.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When the boat had got round the point, she perceived
-that all her followers had desisted from the
-pursuit: she now opened a large bay, at the bottom
-of which appeared another body of men, armed with
-long lances like the first. Here our people prepared to
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_268'>268</span>land, and pushed towards the shore, a canoe at the
-same time putting off to meet them. As soon as
-it came near them, they lay upon their oars, and
-calling out to them, told them that they were friends,
-and, that if they would come up, they would give
-them nails, which were held up for them to see:
-after some hesitation they came up to the boat’s
-stern, and took some nails that were offered them
-with great seeming satisfaction; but in less than a
-minute they appeared to have formed a design of
-boarding the boat, and making her their prize: three
-of them suddenly leaped into it, and the others
-brought up the canoe, which the motion in quitting
-her had thrown off a little, manifestly with a design
-to follow their associates, and support them in their
-attempt. The first that boarded the boat, entered
-close to Mr. Banks, and instantly snatched his
-powder-horn out of his pocket: Mr. Banks seized it,
-and with some difficulty wrenched it out of his hand,
-at the same time pressing against his breast in order
-to force him over-board, but he was too strong for
-him, and kept his place: the officer then snapped his
-piece, but it missed fire, upon which he ordered some
-of the people to fire over their heads; two pieces
-were accordingly discharged, upon which they all
-instantly leaped into the water: one of the people,
-either from cowardice or cruelty, or both, levelled a
-third piece at one of them as he was swimming away,
-and the ball grazed his forehead; happily, however,
-the wound was very slight, for he recovered the
-canoe, and stood up in her as active and vigorous
-as the rest. The canoe immediately stood in for the
-shore, where a great number of people, not less than
-two hundred, were now assembled. The boat also
-pushed in, but found the land guarded all round with
-a shoal, upon which the sea broke with a considerable
-surf; it was, therefore, thought advisable by the
-officer to proceed along shore in search of a more convenient
-landing-place: in the mean time, the people
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_269'>269</span>on board saw the canoe go on shore, and the natives
-gather eagerly round her to enquire the particulars
-of what had happened. Soon after, a single man
-ran along the shore, armed with his lance, and when
-he came a-breast of the boat, he began to dance,
-brandish his weapon, and call out in a very shrill tone,
-which Tupia said was a defiance from the people.
-The boat continued to row along the shore, and the
-champion followed it, repeating his defiance by his
-voice and his gestures; but no better landing-place
-being found than that where the canoe had put the
-natives on shore, the officer turned back with a view
-to attempt it there, hoping, that if it should not be
-practicable, the people would come to a conference
-either on the shoals or in their canoes, and that a
-treaty of peace might be concluded with them.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As the boat rowed slowly along the shore back
-again, another champion came down, shouting defiance,
-and brandishing his lance: his appearance
-was more formidable than that of the other, for he
-wore a large cap made of the tail feathers of the
-tropic bird, and his body was covered with stripes of
-different coloured cloth, yellow, red, and brown.
-This gentleman also danced, but with much more
-nimbleness and dexterity than the first; our people
-therefore, considering his agility and his dress, distinguished
-him by the name of <span class='sc'>Harlequin</span>. Soon
-after a more grave and elderly man came down to
-the beach, and hailing the people in the boat, inquired
-who they were, and from whence they came;
-Tupia answered in their own language, from Otaheite:
-the three natives then walked peaceably along
-the shore till they came to a shoal, upon which a few
-people were collected; here they stopped, and after
-a short conference, they all began to pray very loud:
-Tupia made his responses, but continued to tell us
-that they were not our friends. When their prayer,
-or, as they call it, their <i>Poorah</i>, was over, our people
-entered into a parley with them, telling them, that,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_270'>270</span>if they would lay by their lances and clubs, for some
-had one and some the other, they would come on
-shore, and trade with them for whatever they would
-bring: they agreed, but it was only upon condition
-that we would leave behind us our musquets: this
-was a condition which, however equitable it might
-appear, could not be complied with, nor indeed would
-it have put the two parties upon an equality, except
-their numbers had been equal. Here then the negotiation
-seemed to be at an end; but in a little
-time they ventured to come nearer to the boat, and
-at last came near enough to trade, which they did
-very fairly, for a small quantity of their cloth and
-some of their weapons; but as they gave our people
-no hope of provisions, nor indeed any thing else, except
-they would venture through a narrow channel
-to the shore, which, all circumstances considered,
-they did not think it prudent to do, they put off the
-boat and left them.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>With the ship and the boat we had now made the
-circuit of the island, and finding that there was
-neither harbour nor anchorage about it, and that the
-hostile disposition of the people would render landing
-impracticable, without bloodshed, I determined
-not to attempt it, having no motive that could justify
-the risk of life.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The bay which the boat entered lies on the west
-side of the island, the bottom was foul and rocky,
-but the water so clear that it could plainly be seen
-at the depth of five and twenty fathom, which is one
-hundred and fifty feet.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This island is situated in the latitude of 22° 27ʹ S.
-and in the longitude of 150° 47ʹ W. from the meridian
-of Greenwich. It is thirteen miles in circuit,
-and rather high than low, but neither populous nor
-fertile in proportion to the other islands that we had
-seen in these seas. The chief produce seems to be
-the tree of which they make their weapons, called in
-their language <i>Etoa</i>; many plantations of it were
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_271'>271</span>seen along the shore, which is not surrounded, like
-the neighbouring islands, by a reef.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The people seemed to be lusty and well made,
-rather browner than those we had left: under their
-arm-pits they had black marks about as broad as the
-hand, the edges of which formed not a straight but
-an indented line: they had also circles of the same
-colour, but not so broad, round their arms and legs,
-but were not marked on any other part of the body.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their dress was very different from any that we
-had seen before, as well as the cloth of which it was
-made. The cloth was of the same materials as that
-which is worn in the other islands, and most of that
-which was seen by our people was dyed of a bright
-but deep yellow, and covered on the outside with a
-composition like varnish, which was either red, or
-of a dark lead-colour; over this ground it was again
-painted in stripes of many different patterns, with
-wonderful regularity, in the manner of our striped
-silks in England: the cloth that was painted red was
-striped with black, and that which was painted lead-colour
-with white. Their habit was a short jacket of
-this cloth, which reached about as low as their knees;
-it was of one piece, and had no other making than a
-hole in the middle of it, stitched round with long
-stitches, in which it differed from all that we had
-seen before: through this hole the head was put, and
-what hung down was confined to their bodies by a
-piece of yellow cloth or sash, which, passing round
-the neck behind, was crossed upon the breast, and
-then collected round the waist like a belt, which
-passed over another belt of red cloth, so that they
-made a very gay and warlike appearance; some had
-caps of the feathers of the tropic bird, which have
-been before described, and some had a piece of white
-or lead-coloured cloth wound about the head like a
-small turban, which our people thought more becoming.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Their arms were long lances, made of the Etoa,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_272'>272</span>the wood of which is very hard; they were well
-polished and sharpened at one end: some were near
-twenty feet long, though not more than three fingers
-thick: they had also a weapon, which was both club
-and pike, made of the same wood, about seven feet
-long; this also was well polished, and sharpened at
-one end into a broad point. As a guard against
-these weapons, when they attack each other, they
-have matts folded up many times, which they place
-under their clothes from the neck to the waist: the
-weapons themselves indeed are capable of much less
-mischief than those of the same kind which we saw
-at the other islands, for the lances were there pointed
-with the sharp bone of the stingray that is called the
-sting, and the pikes were of much greater weight.
-The other things that we saw here were all superior
-in their kind to any we had seen before; the cloth
-was of a better colour in the dye, and painted with
-greater neatness and taste; the clubs were better cut
-and polished, and the canoe, though a small one, was
-very rich in ornament, and the carving was executed
-in a better manner: among other decorations peculiar
-to this canoe, was a line of small white feathers,
-which hung from the head and stern on the outside,
-and which, when we saw them, were thoroughly
-wetted by the spray.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Tupia told us, that there were several islands lying
-at different distances, and in different directions from
-this, between the south and the north west; and that,
-at the distance of three days’ sail to the north-east,
-there was an island called <span class='sc'>Manua</span>, Bird-island: he
-seemed, however, most desirous that we should sail
-to the westward, and described several islands in
-that direction which he said he had visited: he told
-us that he had been ten or twelve days in going
-thither, and thirty in coming back, and that the <i>Pahie</i>
-in which he had made the voyage, sailed much
-faster than the ship: reckoning his Pahie therefore
-to go at the rate of forty leagues a day, which, from
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_273'>273</span>my own observation, I have great reason to think these
-boats will do, it would make four hundred leagues
-in ten days, which I compute to be the distance of
-Boscawen and Keppel’s Islands, discovered by Captain
-Wallis, westward of Ulietea, and therefore think
-it very probable that they were the islands he had
-visited. The farthest island that he knew any thing
-of to the southward, he said, lay at the distance of
-about two days’ sail from Oteroah, and was called
-<span class='sc'>Moutou</span>; but he said that his father had told him
-there were islands to the southward of that: upon
-the whole, I was determined to stand southward in
-search of a continent, but to spend no time in searching
-for islands, if we did not happen to fall in with
-them during our course.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_274'>274</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>BOOK II.<br /> <br />CHAP. I.<br /> <br />THE PASSAGE FROM OTEROAH TO NEW ZEALAND; INCIDENTS WHICH HAPPENED ON GOING A-SHORE THERE, AND WHILE THE SHIP LAY IN POVERTY BAY. </h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>We</span> sailed from Oteroah on the 15th of August,
-and on Friday the 25th we celebrated the anniversary
-of our leaving England, by taking a Cheshire
-cheese from a locker, where it had been carefully
-treasured up for this occasion, and tapping a cask of
-porter, which proved to be very good, and in excellent
-order. On the 29th, one of the sailors got so
-drunk, that the next morning he died: we thought
-at first that he could not have come honestly by the
-liquor, but we afterwards learnt that the boatswain,
-whose mate he was, had, in mere good-nature, given
-him part of a bottle of rum.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 30th, we saw the comet; at one o’clock in
-the morning, it was a little above the horizon in the
-eastern part of the heavens; at about half an hour
-after four it passed the meridian, and its tail subtended
-an angle of forty-two degrees. Our latitude
-was 38° 20ʹ S., our longitude, by log, 147° 6ʹ W., and
-the variation of the needle, by the azimuth, 7° 9ʹ E.
-Among others that observed the comet, was Tupia,
-who instantly cried out, that as soon as it should
-be seen by the people of Bolabola, they would kill
-the inhabitants of Ulietea, who would, with the utmost
-precipitation, fly to the mountains.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 1st of September, being in the latitude of
-40° 22ʹ S., and longitude 147° 29ʹ W., and there not
-being any signs of land, with a heavy sea from
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_275'>275</span>the westward, and strong gales, I wore, and stood
-back to the northward, fearing that we might receive
-such damage in our sails and rigging, as would hinder
-the prosecution of the voyage.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the next day, there being strong gales to the
-westward, I brought to, with the ship’s head to the
-northward; but in the morning of the 3d, the wind
-being more moderate, we loosened the reef of the
-main-sail, set the top-sails, and plied to the westward.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We continued our course till the 19th, when our
-latitude being 29° and our longitude 159° 29ʹ, we
-observed the variation to be 8° 32ʹ E. On the 24th,
-being in latitude 33° 18ʹ, longitude 162° 51ʹ, we observed
-a small piece of sea-weed, and a piece of wood
-covered with barnacles: the variation here was 10°
-48ʹ E.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 27th, being in latitude 28° 59ʹ, longitude
-169° 5ʹ, we saw a seal asleep upon the water, and
-several bunches of sea-weed. The next day we saw
-more sea-weed in bunches, and on the 29th, a bird,
-which we thought a land-bird; it somewhat resembled
-a snipe, but had a short bill. On the 1st of October,
-we saw birds innumerable, and another seal
-asleep upon the water; it is a general opinion, that
-seals never go out of soundings, or far from land,
-but those that we saw in these seas prove the contrary.
-Rock-weed is, however, a certain indication
-that land is not far distant. The next day, it being
-calm, we hoisted out the boat, to try whether there
-was a current, but found none. Our latitude was
-37° 10ʹ, longitude 172° 54ʹ W. On the 3d, being in
-latitude 36° 56ʹ, longitude 173° 27ʹ, we took up more
-sea-weed, and another piece of wood covered with
-barnacles. The next day, we saw two more seals,
-and a brown bird, about as big as a raven, with some
-white feathers under the wing. Mr. Gore told us,
-that birds of this kind were seen in great numbers
-about Falkland’s Islands, and our people gave them
-the name of Port-Egmont hens.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_276'>276</span>On the 5th, we thought the water changed colour,
-but, upon casting the lead, had no ground with 180
-fathom. In the evening of this day, the variation
-was 12° 50ʹ E., and, while we were going nine leagues,
-it increased to 14° 2ʹ.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the next day, Friday, October the 6th, we saw
-land from the mast-head, bearing W. by N., and stood
-directly for it; in the evening, it could just be discerned
-from the deck, and appeared large. The
-variation this day was, by azimuth and amplitude,
-15° 4-½ʹ E., and by observation made of the sun and
-moon, the longitude of the ship appeared to be 180°
-55ʹ W., and by the medium of this and subsequent
-observations, there appeared to be an error in the
-ship’s account of longitude during her run from Otaheite
-of 3° 16ʹ, she being so much to the westward of
-the longitude resulting from the log. At midnight,
-I brought to and sounded, but had no ground with
-one hundred and seventy fathom.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 7th, it fell calm, we therefore approached
-the land slowly, and in the afternoon, when a breeze
-sprung up, we were still distant seven or eight
-leagues. It appeared still larger as it was more distinctly
-seen, with four or five ranges of hills, rising
-one over the other, and a chain of mountains above
-all, which appeared to be of an enormous height.
-This land became the subject of much eager conversation;
-but the general opinion seemed to be that we
-had found the <i>Terra australis incognita</i>. About five
-o’clock, we saw the opening of a bay, which seemed
-to run pretty far inland, upon which we hauled our
-wind and stood in for it; we also saw smoke ascending
-from different places on shore. When night came
-on, however, we kept plying off and on till day-light,
-when we found ourselves to the leeward of the bay,
-the wind being at north: we could now perceive that
-the hills were clothed with wood, and that some of
-the trees in the valleys were very large. By noon we
-fetched in with the south-west point; but not being
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_277'>277</span>able to weather it, tacked and stood off: at this time
-we saw several canoes standing cross the bay, which,
-in a little time, made to shore, without seeming to
-take the least notice of the ship; we also saw some
-houses, which appeared to be small, but neat; and
-near one of them a considerable number of the people
-collected together, who were sitting upon the beach,
-and who, we thought, were the same that we had
-seen in the canoes. Upon a small peninsula, at the
-north-east head, we could plainly perceive a pretty
-high and regular paling, which inclosed the whole
-top of a hill; this was also the subject of much speculation,
-some supposing it to be a park of deer,
-others an inclosure for oxen and sheep. About four
-o’clock in the afternoon, we anchored on the north-west
-side of the bay, before the entrance of a small
-river, in ten fathom water, with a fine sandy bottom,
-and at about half a league from the shore. The sides
-of the bay are white cliffs of a great height; the middle
-is low land, with hills gradually rising behind,
-one towering above another, and terminating in the
-chain of mountains, which appeared to be far inland.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the evening I went on shore, accompanied by
-Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, with the pinnace and
-yawl, and a party of men. We landed abreast of the
-ship, on the east side of the river, which was here
-about forty yards broad; but seeing some natives on
-the west side whom I wished to speak with, and finding
-the river not fordable, I ordered the yawl in to
-carry us over, and left the pinnace at the entrance.
-When we came near the place where the people were
-assembled, they all ran away; however, we landed,
-and leaving four boys to take care of the yawl, we
-walked up to some huts which were about two or
-three hundred yards from the water-side. When we
-had got some distance from the boat, four men, armed
-with long lances, rushed out of the woods, and running
-up to attack the boat, would certainly have cut
-her off, if the people in the pinnace had not discovered
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_278'>278</span>them, and called to the boys to drop down
-the stream: the boys instantly obeyed; but being
-closely pursued by the Indians, the Cockswain of the
-pinnace, who had the charge of the boats, fired a
-musket over their heads; at this they stopped and
-looked round them, but in a few minutes renewed
-the pursuit, brandishing their lances in a threatening
-manner: the Cockswain then fired a second musket
-over their heads, but of this they took no notice;
-and one of them lifting up his spear to dart it at the
-boat, another piece was fired, which shot him dead.
-When he fell, the other three stood motionless for
-some minutes, as if petrified with astonishment; as
-soon as they recovered, they went back, dragging
-after them the dead body, which however they soon
-left, that it might not encumber their flight. At the
-report of the first musket, we drew together, having
-straggled to a little distance from each other, and
-made the best of our way back to the boat; and
-crossing the river, we soon saw the Indian lying dead
-upon the ground. Upon examining the body, we
-found that he had been shot through the heart: he
-was a man of the middle size and stature; his complexion
-was brown, but not very dark; and one side
-of his face was tattowed in spiral lines of a very regular
-figure: he was covered with a fine cloth, of a
-manufacture altogether new to us, and it was tied on
-exactly according to the representation in Valentyn’s
-Account of Abel Tasman’s Voyage, vol. iii. part 2.
-page 50.: his hair also was tied in a knot on the top
-of his head, but had no feather in it. We returned
-immediately to the ship, where we could hear the
-people on shore talking with great earnestness, and
-in a very loud tone, probably about what had happened,
-and what should be done.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the morning, we saw several of the natives
-where they had been seen the night before, and some
-walking with a quick pace towards the place where
-we had landed, most of them unarmed; but three or
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_279'>279</span>four with long pikes in their hands. As I was desirous
-to establish an intercourse with them, I ordered
-three boats to be manned with seamen and marines,
-and proceeded towards the shore, accompanied by
-Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, the other gentlemen, and
-Tupia; about fifty of them seemed to wait for our
-<a id='our'></a>landing, on the opposite side of the river, which
-we thought a sign of fear, and seated themselves
-upon the ground: at first, therefore, myself, with only
-Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and Tupia, landed from
-the little boat, and advanced towards them; but we
-had not proceeded many paces before they all started
-up, and every man produced either a long pike, or a
-small weapon of green Talc, extremely well polished,
-about a foot long, and thick enough to weigh four or
-five pounds: Tupia called to them in the language
-of Otaheite; but they answered only by flourishing
-their weapons, and making signs to us to depart; a
-musket was then fired wide of them, and the ball
-struck the water, the river being still between us;
-they saw the effect, and desisted from their threats:
-but we thought it prudent to retreat till the marines
-could be landed. This was soon done; and they
-marched, with a jack carried before them, to a little
-bank, about fifty yards from the water-side; here
-they were drawn up, and I again advanced, with Mr.
-Banks and Dr. Solander; Tupia, Mr. Green, and
-Mr. Monkhouse, being with us. Tupia was again
-directed to speak to them, and it was with great
-pleasure that we perceived he was perfectly understood,
-he and the natives speaking only different
-dialects of the same language. He told them that
-we wanted provision and water, and would give them
-iron in exchange, the properties of which he explained
-as well as he was able. They were willing
-to trade, and desired that we would come over to
-them for that purpose: to this we consented, provided
-they would lay by their arms; which, however,
-they could by no means be persuaded to do. During
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_280'>280</span>this conversation, Tupia warned us to be upon our
-guard, for that they were not our friends: we then
-pressed them in our turn to come over to us; and at
-last one of them stripped himself, and swam over
-without his arms: he was almost immediately followed
-by two more, and soon after by most of the
-rest, to the number of twenty or thirty; but these
-brought their arms with them. We made them all
-presents of iron and beads; but they seemed to set
-little value upon either, particularly the iron, not having
-the least idea of its use; so that we got nothing
-in return but a few feathers: they offered indeed to
-exchange their arms for ours, and, when we refused,
-made many attempts to snatch them out of our
-hands. As soon as they came over, Tupia repeated
-his declaration, that they were not our friends, and
-again warned us to be upon our guard; their attempts
-to snatch our weapons, therefore, did not
-succeed; and we gave them to understand by Tupia,
-that we should be obliged to kill them, if they offered
-any farther violence. In a few minutes, however,
-Mr. Green happening to turn about, one of them
-snatched away his hanger, and retiring to a little distance,
-waved it round his head, with a shout of exultation:
-the rest now began to be extremely insolent,
-and we saw more coming to join them from the
-opposite side of the river. It was therefore become
-necessary to repress them, and Mr. Banks fired at
-the man who had taken the hanger, with small shot,
-at the distance of about fifteen yards: when the shot
-struck him, he ceased his cry; but instead of returning
-the hanger, continued to flourish it over his head,
-at the same time slowly retreating to a greater distance.
-Mr. Monkhouse seeing this, fired at him
-with ball, and he instantly dropped. Upon this the
-main body, who had retired to a rock in the middle
-of the river upon the first discharge, began to return;
-two that were near to the man who had been
-killed, ran up to the body, one seized his weapon of
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_281'>281</span>green Talc, and the other endeavoured to secure the
-hanger, which Mr. Monkhouse had but just time to
-prevent. As all that had retired to the rock were
-now advancing, three of us discharged our pieces,
-loaded only with small shot, upon which they swam
-back for the shore; and we perceived, upon their
-landing, that two or three of them were wounded.
-They retired slowly up the country, and we reimbarked
-in our boats.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As we had unhappily experienced, that nothing
-was to be done with these people at this place; and
-finding the water in the river to be salt, I proceeded
-in the boats round the head of the bay in search of
-fresh water, and with a design, if possible, to surprise
-some of the natives, and take them on board, where,
-by kind treatment and presents I might obtain their
-friendship, and by their means establish an amicable
-correspondence with their countrymen.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>To my great regret, I found no place where I
-could land, a dangerous surf every where beating
-upon the shore; but I saw two canoes coming in
-from the sea, one under sail, and the other worked
-with paddles. I thought this a favourable opportunity
-to get some of the people into my possession
-without mischief, as those in the canoe were probably
-fishermen, and without arms, and I had three
-boats full of men. I therefore disposed the boats so
-as most effectually to intercept them in their way to
-the shore; the people in the canoe that was paddled
-perceived us so soon, that, by making to the nearest
-land with their utmost strength, they escaped us; the
-other sailed on till she was in the midst of us without
-discerning what we were; but the moment she
-discovered us, the people on board struck their sail,
-and took to their paddles, which they plied so briskly
-that she out-ran the boat. They were however within
-hearing, and Tupia called out to them to come
-along-side, and promised for us that they should come
-to no hurt: they chose, however, rather to trust to
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_282'>282</span>their paddles than our promises, and continued to
-make from us with all their power. I then ordered
-a musket to be fired over their heads, as the least
-exceptionable expedient to accomplish my design,
-hoping it would either make them surrender, or leap
-into the water. Upon the discharge of the piece,
-they ceased paddling; and all of them, being seven
-in number, began to strip, as we imagined, to jump
-overboard; but it happened otherwise. They immediately
-formed a resolution not to fly, but to fight;
-and when the boat came up, they began the attack
-with their paddles, and with stones and other offensive
-weapons that were in the boat, so vigorously,
-that we were obliged to fire upon them in our own
-defence; four were unhappily killed, and the other
-three, who were boys, the eldest about nineteen, and
-the youngest about eleven, instantly leaped into the
-water; the eldest swam with great vigour, and resisted
-the attempts of our people to take him into the
-boat by every effort that he could make: he was
-however at last overpowered, and the other two were
-taken up with less difficulty. I am conscious that
-the feeling of every reader of humanity will censure
-me for having fired upon these unhappy people, and
-it is impossible that, upon a calm review, I should
-approve it myself. They certainly did not deserve
-death for not chusing to confide in my promises; or
-not consenting to come on board my boat, even if
-they had apprehended no danger; but the nature of
-my service required me to obtain a knowledge of
-their country, which I could no otherwise effect than
-by forcing my way into it in a hostile manner, or
-gaining admission through the confidence and good-will
-of the people. I had already tried the power of
-presents without effect; and I was now prompted,
-by my desire to avoid further hostilities, to get some
-of them on board, as the only method left of convincing
-them that we intended them no harm, and had
-it in our power to contribute to their gratification
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_283'>283</span>and convenience. Thus far my intentions certainly
-were not criminal; and though in the contest, which
-I had not the least reason to expect, our victory
-might have been complete without so great an expence
-of life; yet in such situations, when the command
-to fire has been given, no man can restrain its
-excess, or prescribe its effect.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As soon as the poor wretches whom we had taken
-out of the water were in the boat, they squatted
-down, expecting no doubt instantly to be put to death:
-we made haste to convince them of the contrary, by
-every method in our power; we furnished them with
-clothes, and gave them every other testimony of
-kindness that could remove their fears and engage
-their good-will. Those who are acquainted with human
-nature will not wonder, that the sudden joy of
-these young savages at being unexpectedly delivered
-from the fear of death, and kindly treated by those
-whom they supposed would have been their instant
-executioners, surmounted their concern for the friends
-they had lost, and was strongly expressed in their
-countenances and behaviour. Before we reached the
-ship, their suspicions and fears being wholly removed,
-they appeared to be not only reconciled to their situation
-but in high spirits, and upon being offered some
-bread when they came on board, they devoured it
-with a voracious appetite. They answered and asked
-many questions, with great appearance of pleasure
-and curiosity; and when our dinner came, they expressed
-an inclination to taste every thing that they
-saw: they seemed best pleased with the salt pork,
-though we had other provisions upon the table. At
-sun-set, they eat another meal with great eagerness,
-each devouring a large quantity of bread, and drinking
-above a quart of water. We then made them
-beds upon the lockers, and they went to sleep with
-great seeming content. In the night, however, the
-tumult of their minds having subsided, and given
-way to reflection, they sighed often and loud. Tupia,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_284'>284</span>who was always upon the watch to comfort them,
-got up, and by soothing and encouragement made
-them not only easy but cheerful; their cheerfulness
-was encouraged so that they sung a song with a degree
-of taste that surprised us: the tune was solemn
-and slow, like those of our Psalms, containing many
-notes and semi-tones. Their countenances were intelligent
-and expressive, and the middlemost, who
-seemed to be about fifteen, had an openness in his
-aspect, and an ease in his deportment, which were
-very striking: we found that the two eldest were
-brothers, and that their names were <span class='sc'>Taahourange</span>
-and <span class='sc'>Koikerange</span>; the name of the youngest was
-<span class='sc'>Maragovete</span>. As we were returning to the ship,
-after having taken these boys into the boat, we picked
-up a large piece of pumice-stone floating upon the
-water; a sure sign that there either is, or has been a
-volcano in this neighbourhood.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the morning, they all seemed to be cheerful,
-and ate another enormous meal; after this we dressed
-them, and adorned them with bracelets, anclets, and
-necklaces, after their own fashion, and the boat being
-hoisted out, they were told that we were going
-to set them ashore: this produced a transport of joy;
-but upon perceiving that we made towards our first
-landing-place near the river, their countenances
-changed, and they entreated with great earnestness
-that they might not be set ashore at that place, because
-they said, it was inhabited by their enemies,
-who would kill them and eat them. This was a great
-disappointment to me; because I hoped the report
-and appearance of the boys would procure a favourable
-reception for ourselves. I had already sent an
-officer on shore with the marines and a party of men
-to cut wood, and I was determined to land near the
-place; not, however, to abandon the boys, if, when
-we got ashore, they should be unwilling to leave us;
-but to send a boat with them in the evening to that
-part of the bay to which they pointed, and which
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_285'>285</span>they call their home. Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and
-Tupia, were with me, and upon our landing with the
-boys, and crossing the river, they seemed at first to
-be unwilling to leave us; but at length they suddenly
-changed their mind, and, though not without a manifest
-struggle, and some tears, they took their leave:
-when they were gone, we proceeded along a swamp,
-with a design to shoot some ducks, of which we saw
-great plenty, and four of the marines attended us,
-walking abreast of us upon a bank that overlooked
-the country. After we had advanced about a mile,
-these men called out to us and told us, that a large
-body of the Indians was in sight, and advancing at a
-great rate. Upon receiving this intelligence, we drew
-together, and resolved to make the best of our way
-to the boats; we had scarcely begun to put this into
-execution, when the three Indian boys started suddenly
-from some bushes, where they had concealed
-themselves, and again claimed our protection: we
-readily received them, and repairing to the beach as
-the clearest place, we walked briskly towards the
-boats. The Indians were in two bodies; one ran
-along the bank which had been quitted by the marines,
-the other fetched a compass by the swamp, so
-that we could not see them: when they perceived
-that we had formed into one body, they slackened their
-pace, but still followed us in a gentle walk; that they
-slackened their pace, was for us, as well as for them,
-a fortunate circumstance; for when we came to the
-side of the river, where we expected to find the boats
-that were to carry us over to the wooders, we found
-the pinnace at least a mile from her station, having
-been sent to pick up a bird which had been shot by
-the officer on shore, and the little boat was obliged
-to make three trips before we could all get over to
-the rest of the party. As soon as we were drawn up
-on the other side, the Indians came down, not in a
-body as we expected, but by two or three at a time,
-all armed, and in a short time their number increased
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_286'>286</span>to about two hundred: as we now despaired of making
-peace with them, seeing that the dread of our small
-arms did not keep them at a distance, and that the
-ship was too far off to reach the place with a shot,
-we resolved to re-imbark, lest our stay should embroil
-us in another quarrel, and cost more of the Indians
-their lives. We therefore advanced towards
-the pinnace, which was now returning, when one of
-the boys suddenly cried out, that his uncle was among
-the people who had marched down to us, and desired
-us to stay and talk with them: we complied, and a
-parley immediately commenced between them and
-Tupia; during which the boys held up every thing
-we had given them as tokens of our kindness and liberality;
-but neither would either of the boys swim
-over to them, or any of them to the boys. The body
-of the man who had been killed the day before, still
-lay exposed upon the beach; the boys seeing it lie
-very near us, went up to it, and covered it with some
-of the clothes that we had given them; and soon after
-a single man, unarmed, who proved to be the uncle
-of Maragovete, the youngest of the boys, swam over
-to us, bringing in his hand a green branch, which
-we supposed, as well here as at Otaheite, to be an
-emblem of peace. We received his branch by the
-hands of Tupia, to whom he gave it, and made him
-many presents; we also invited him to go on board
-the ship, but he declined it; we therefore left him,
-and expected that his nephew, and the two other
-young Indians would have staid with him, but to our
-great surprise, they chose rather to go with us. As
-soon as we had retired, he went and gathered another
-green branch, and with this in his hand, he approached
-the dead body which the youth had covered
-with part of his clothes, walking sideways,
-with many ceremonies, and then throwing it towards
-him. When this was done, he returned to his companions,
-who had sat down upon the sand to observe
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_287'>287</span>the issue of his negociation: they immediately gathered
-round him, and continued in a body above an
-hour, without seeming to take any farther notice of
-us. We were more curious than they, and observing
-them with our glasses from on board the ship, we
-saw some of them cross the river upon a kind of raft,
-or catamarine, and four of them carry off the dead
-body which had been covered by the boy, and over
-which his uncle had performed the ceremony of the
-branch, upon a kind of bier, between four men: the
-other body was still suffered to remain where it had
-been first left.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After dinner, I directed Tupia to ask the boys, if
-they had now any objection to going ashore, where
-we had left their uncle, the body having been carried
-off, which we understood was a ratification of
-peace: they said, they had not; and the boat being
-ordered, they went into it with great alacrity: when
-the boat, in which I had sent two midshipmen, came
-to land, they went willingly ashore; but soon after
-she put off, they returned to the rocks, and wading
-into the water, earnestly entreated to be taken on
-board again; but the people in the boat, having
-positive orders to leave them, could not comply.
-We were very attentive to what happened on shore,
-and keeping a constant watch with our glasses, we
-saw a man pass the river upon another raft, and fetch
-them to a place where forty or fifty of the natives
-were assembled, who closed round them, and continued
-in the same place till sun-set: upon looking
-again, when we saw them in motion, we could plainly
-distinguish our three prisoners, who separated themselves
-from the rest, came down to the beach, and
-having waved their hands three times towards the
-ship, ran nimbly back, and joined their companions,
-who walked leisurely away towards that part which
-the boys had pointed to as their dwelling-place; we
-had therefore the greatest reason to believe that
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_288'>288</span>no mischief would happen to them, especially as we
-perceived that they went off in the clothes we had
-given them.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After it was dark, loud voices were heard on shore
-in the bottom of the bay as usual, of which we could
-never learn the meaning.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_289'>289</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. II.<br /> <br />A DESCRIPTION OF POVERTY BAY, AND THE FACE OF THE ADJACENT COUNTRY. THE RANGE FROM THENCE TO CAPE TURNAGAIN, AND BACK TO TOLAGA, WITH SOME ACCOUNT OF THE PEOPLE AND THE COUNTRY, AND SEVERAL INCIDENTS THAT HAPPENED ON THAT PART OF THE COAST.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>The</span> next morning, at six o’clock, we weighed, and
-stood away from this unfortunate and inhospitable
-place, to which I gave the name of <span class='sc'>Poverty Bay</span>,
-and which by the natives is called <span class='sc'>Taoneroa</span>, or
-Long Sand, as it did not afford us a single article
-that we wanted, except a little wood. It lies in latitude
-38° 42ʹ S. and longitude 181° 36ʹ W.; it is in
-the form of an horse-shoe, and is known by an island
-lying close under the north-east point: the two points
-which form the entrance are high, with steep white
-cliffs, and lie a league and a half, or two leagues
-from each other, N. E. by E. and S. W. by W.; the
-depth of water in the bay is from twelve to five fathom,
-with a sandy bottom and good anchorage; but
-the situation is open to the wind between the south
-and east: boats can go in and out of the river at any
-time of the tide in fine weather; but as there is a
-bar at the entrance, no boat can go either in or out
-when the sea runs high: the best place to attempt it,
-is on the north-east side, and it is there practicable
-when it is not so in any other part. The shore of the
-bay, a little within its entrance, is a low flat sand;
-behind which, at a small distance, the face of the
-country is finely diversified by hills and valleys, all
-clothed with wood, and covered with verdure. The
-country also appears to be well inhabited, especially
-in the valleys leading up from the bay, where we
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_290'>290</span>daily saw smoke rising in clouds one behind another,
-to a great distance, till the view terminated in mountains
-of a stupendous height.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The south-west point of the bay I named <span class='sc'>Young
-Nick’s Head</span>, after Nicholas Young, the boy who
-first saw the land; at noon, it bore N. W. by W. distant
-about three or four leagues, and we were then
-about three miles from the shore. The main land
-extended from N. E. by N. to south, and I proposed
-to follow the direction of the coast to the southward
-as far as the latitude of 40 or 41; and then, if I met
-with no encouragement to proceed farther, to return
-to the northward.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the afternoon we lay becalmed, which the people
-on shore perceiving, several canoes put off, and
-came within less than a quarter of a mile of the vessel;
-but could not be persuaded to come nearer, though
-Tupia exerted all the powers of his lungs and his
-eloquence upon the occasion, shouting, and promising
-that they should not be hurt. Another canoe was
-now seen coming from Poverty Bay, with only four
-people on board, one of whom we well remembered
-to have seen in our first interview upon the rock.
-This canoe, without stopping or taking the least notice
-of the others, came directly alongside of the
-ship, and with very little persuasion, we got the Indians
-on board. Their example was soon followed
-by the rest, and we had about us seven canoes, and
-about fifty men. We made them all presents with a
-liberal hand; notwithstanding which, they were so
-desirous to have more of our commodities, that they
-sold us every thing they had, even the clothes from
-their backs, and the paddles from their boats. There
-were but two weapons among them, these were the
-instruments of green talc, which were shaped somewhat
-like a pointed battledore, with a short handle
-and sharp edges; they were called <i>Patoo-patoo</i>, and
-were well contrived for close-fighting, as they would
-certainly split the thickest skull at a single blow.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_291'>291</span>When these people had recovered from the first impressions
-of fear, which, notwithstanding their resolution
-in coming on board, had manifestly thrown
-them into some confusion, we inquired after our poor
-boys. The man who first came on board immediately
-answered, that they were unhurt and at home; adding,
-that he had been induced to venture on board
-by the account which they had given him of the
-kindness with which they had been treated, and the
-wonders which were contained in the ship.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>While they were on board they showed every sign
-of friendship, and invited us very cordially to go
-back to our old bay, or to a small cove which they
-pointed out, that was not quite so far off; but I chose
-rather to prosecute my discoveries than go back, having
-reason to hope that I should find a better harbour
-than any I had yet seen.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About an hour before sun-set, the canoes put off
-from the ship with the few paddles they had reserved,
-which were scarcely sufficient to set them on shore;
-but by some means or other three of their people
-were left behind: as soon as we discovered it, we
-hailed them; but not one of them would return to
-take them on board: this greatly surprised us; but
-we were surprised still more to observe that the deserted
-Indians did not seem at all uneasy at their
-situation, but entertained us with dancing and singing
-after their manner, eat their suppers, and went
-quietly to bed.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>A light breeze springing up soon after it was dark,
-we steered along the shore under an easy sail till midnight,
-and then brought to, soon after which it fell
-calm; we were now some leagues distant from the
-place where the canoes had left us, and at day-break,
-when the Indians perceived it, they were seized with
-consternation and terror, and lamented their situation
-in loud complaints, with gestures of despair and many
-tears. Tupia, with great difficulty, pacified them;
-and about seven o’clock in the morning, a light breeze
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_292'>292</span>springing up, we continued to stand south-west along
-the shore. Fortunately for our poor Indians, two
-canoes came off about this time, and made towards
-the ship: they stopped, however, at a little distance,
-and seemed unwilling to trust themselves nearer.
-Our Indians were greatly agitated in this state of uncertainty,
-and urged their fellows to come alongside
-of the ship, both by their voice and gestures, with
-the utmost eagerness and impatience. Tupia interpreted
-what they said, and we were much surprised
-to find, that, among other arguments, they assured
-the people in the canoes, we did not eat men. We
-now began seriously to believe that this horrid custom
-prevailed among them; for what the boys had said,
-we considered as a mere hyperbolical expression of
-their fear. One of the canoes, at length, ventured
-to come under the ship’s side; and an old man came
-on board, who seemed to be a chief from the finery
-of his garment, and the superiority of his weapon,
-which was a Patoo-patoo, made of bone, that, as he
-said, had belonged to a whale. He staid on board
-but a short time, and when he went away, he took
-with him our guests, very much to the satisfaction
-both of them and us.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At the time when we sailed, we were abreast of a
-point, from which the land trends S. S. W. and which
-on account of its figure, I called <span class='sc'>Cape Table</span>. This
-point lies seven leagues to the southward of Poverty
-Bay, in latitude 39° 7ʹ S. and longitude 181° 36ʹ W.;
-it is of a considerable height, makes a sharp angle,
-and appears to be quite flat at the top.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In steering along the shore to the southward of
-the Cape, at the distance of two or three miles, our
-soundings were from twenty to thirty fathom, having
-a chain of rocks between us and the shore, which appeared
-at different heights above the water.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At noon, Cape Table bore N. 20 E. distant about
-four leagues, and a small island, which was the southernmost
-land in sight, bore S. 70 W. at the distance
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_293'>293</span>of about three miles. This island, which the natives
-call <span class='sc'>Teahowray</span>, I named the <span class='sc'>Island of Portland</span>,
-from its very great resemblance to Portland, in the
-English Channel: it lies about a mile from a point
-on the main; but there appears to be a ridge of rocks,
-extending nearly, if not quite, from one to the other.
-N. 57 E. two miles from the south point of Portland,
-lies a sunken rock, upon which the sea breaks
-with great violence. We passed between this rock
-and the land, having from seventeen to twenty
-fathom.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In sailing along the shore, we saw the natives assembled
-in great numbers as well upon Portland island
-as the main: we could also distinguish several
-spots of ground that were cultivated; some seemed
-to be fresh turned up, and lay in furrows like ploughed
-land, and some had plants upon them in different
-stages of their growth. We saw also in two places,
-high rails upon the ridges of hills, like what we had
-seen upon the peninsula at the north-east head of Poverty
-Bay: as they were ranged in lines only, and
-not so as to inclose an area, we could not guess at
-their use, and therefore supposed they might be the
-work of superstition.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About noon another canoe appeared, in which
-were four men; she came within about a quarter of a
-mile of us, where the people on board seemed to
-perform divers ceremonies: one of them who was in
-the bow, sometimes seemed to ask and to offer peace,
-and sometimes to threaten war, by brandishing a
-weapon that he held in his hand: sometimes also he
-danced, and sometimes he sung. Tupia talked
-much to him, but could not persuade him to come to
-the ship.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Between one and two o’clock we discovered land
-to the westward of Portland, extending to the southward
-as far as we could see; and as the ship was
-hauling round the south end of the island, she suddenly
-fell into shoal water and broken ground: we
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_294'>294</span>had indeed always seven fathom or more, but the
-soundings were never twice the same, jumping at
-once from seven fathom to eleven; in a short time,
-however, we got clear of all danger, and had again
-deep water under us.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At this time the island lay within a mile of us,
-making in white cliffs, and a long spit of low land
-running from it towards the main. On the sides of
-these cliffs sat vast numbers of people, looking at us
-with a fixed attention, and it is probable that they
-perceived some appearance of hurry and confusion
-on board, and some irregularity in the working of
-the ship, while we were getting clear of the shallow
-water and broken ground, from which they might
-infer that we were alarmed or in distress: we thought
-that they wished to take advantage of our situation,
-for five canoes were put off with the utmost expedition,
-full of men, and well armed: they came so
-near, and showed so hostile a disposition by shouting,
-brandishing their lances, and using threatening
-gestures, that we were in some pain for our small
-boat, which was still employed in sounding: a musket
-was therefore fired over them, but finding it did
-them no harm, they seemed rather to be provoked
-than intimidated, and I therefore fired a four-pounder,
-charged with grape-shot, wide of them: this had a
-better effect; upon the report of the piece they all
-rose up and shouted, but instead of continuing the
-chace, drew altogether, and after a short consultation,
-went quietly away.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Having got round Portland, we hauled in for the
-land N. W. having a gentle breeze at N. E. which
-about five o’clock died away, and obliged us to anchor;
-we had one-and-twenty fathom, with a fine
-sandy bottom: the south point of Portland bore S. E.
-½ S. distant about two leagues, and a low point on
-the main bore N. ½ E. In the same direction with this
-low point, there runs a deep bay, behind the land of
-which Cape Table is the extremity, so as to make
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_295'>295</span>this land a peninsula, leaving only a low narrow neck
-between that and the main. Of this peninsula, which
-the natives call <span class='sc'>Terakaco</span>, Cape Table is the north
-point, and Portland the south.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>While we lay at anchor, two more canoes came off
-to us, one armed, and the other a small fishing boat,
-with only four men in her; they came so near that
-they entered into conversation with Tupia; they answered
-all the questions that he asked them with great
-civility, but could not be persuaded to come on board;
-they came near enough, however, to receive several
-presents that were thrown to them from the ship,
-with which they seemed much pleased, and went
-away. During the night many fires were kept upon
-shore, probably to show us that the inhabitants were
-too much upon their guard to be surprised.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About five o’clock in the morning of the 13th, a
-breeze springing up northerly, we weighed, and
-steered in for the land. The shore here forms a large
-bay, of which Portland is the north-east point, and
-the bay, that runs behind Cape Table, an arm. This
-arm I had a great inclination to examine, because
-there appeared to be safe anchorage in it, but not being
-sure of that, and the wind being right <a id='on'></a>on end, I
-was unwilling to spare the time. Four-and-twenty
-fathom was the greatest depth within Portland, but
-the ground was every where clear. The land near
-the shore is of a moderate height, with white cliffs
-and sandy beaches; within, it rises into mountains,
-and upon the whole the surface is hilly, for the most
-part covered with wood, and to appearance pleasant
-and fertile. In the morning nine canoes came after
-the ship, but whether with peaceable or hostile intentions
-we could not tell, for we soon left them behind
-us.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the evening we stood in for a place that had the
-appearance of an opening, but found no harbour;
-we therefore stood out again, and were soon followed
-by a large canoe, with eighteen or twenty men, all
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_296'>296</span>armed, who, though they could not reach us, shouted
-defiance, and brandished their weapons, with many
-gestures of menace and insult.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the morning we had a view of the mountains
-inland, upon which the snow was still lying: the
-country near the shore was low and unfit for culture,
-but in one place we perceived a patch of somewhat
-yellow, which had greatly the appearance of a cornfield,
-yet was probably nothing more than some dead
-flags, which are not uncommon in swampy places:
-at some distance we saw groves of trees, which appeared
-high and tapering, and being not above two
-leagues from the south-west cod of the great bay, in
-which we had been coasting for the two last days, I
-hoisted out the pinnace and long-boat to search for fresh
-water; but just as they were about to put off, we saw
-several boats full of people coming from the shore,
-and, therefore, I did not think it safe for them to
-leave the ship. About ten o’clock, five of these
-boats having drawn together, as if to hold a consultation,
-made towards the ship, having on board between
-eighty and ninety men, and four more followed at
-some distance, as if to sustain the attack: when the
-first five came within about a hundred yards of the
-ship, they began to sing their war-song, and brandishing
-their pikes, prepared for an engagement. We
-had now no time to lose, for if we could not prevent
-the attack, we should come under the unhappy
-necessity of using our fire-arms against them, which
-we were very desirous to avoid. Tupia, was therefore,
-ordered to acquaint them that we had weapons
-which, like thunder, would destroy them in a moment;
-that we would immediately convince them of
-their power by directing their effect so that they
-should not be hurt; but that if they persisted in any
-hostile attempt, we should be obliged to use them
-for our defence: a four-pounder, loaded with grape-shot,
-was then discharged wide of them, which produced
-the desired effect; the report, the flash, and
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_297'>297</span>above all, the shot, which spread very far in the
-water, so intimidated them, that they began to paddle
-away with all their might: Tupia, however, calling
-after them, and assuring them that if they would
-come unarmed, they should be kindly received; the
-people in one of the boats put their arms on board of
-another, and came under the ship’s stern; we made
-them several presents, and should certainly have
-prevailed upon them to come on board, if the other
-canoes had not come up, and again threatened us,
-by shouting and brandishing their weapons: at this
-the people who had come to the ship unarmed, expressed
-great displeasure, and soon after they all
-went away.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the afternoon we stood over to the south point
-of the bay, but not reaching it before it was dark,
-we stood off and on all night. At eight the next
-morning, being a-breast of the point, several fishing
-boats came off to us, and sold us some stinking fish:
-it was the best they had, and we were willing to trade
-with them upon any terms: these people behaved
-very well, and we should have parted good friends
-if it had not been for a large canoe, with two-and-twenty
-armed men on board, which came boldly up
-along-side of the ship. We soon saw that this boat
-had nothing for traffic, yet we gave them two or
-three pieces of cloth, an article which they seemed
-very fond of. I observed that one man had a black
-skin thrown over him, somewhat resembling that of
-a bear, and being desirous to know what animal was
-its first owner, I offered him for it a piece of red
-baize, and he seemed greatly pleased with the bargain,
-immediately pulling off the skin, and holding
-it up in the boat; he would not, however, part with
-it till he had the cloth in his possession, and as there
-could be no transfer of property, if with equal caution
-I had insisted upon the same condition, I ordered
-the cloth to be handed down to him, upon
-which, with amazing coolness, instead of sending up
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_298'>298</span>the skin, he began to pack up both that and the
-baize, which he had received as the purchase of it,
-in a basket, without paying the least regard to my
-demand or remonstrances, and soon after, with the
-fishing boats, put off from the ship; when they were
-at some distance, they drew together, and after a
-short consultation returned; the fishermen offered
-more fish, which, though good for nothing, was purchased,
-and trade was again renewed. Among others
-who were placed over the ship’s side to hand up
-what we bought, was little Tayeto, Tupia’s boy;
-and one of the Indians, watching his opportunity,
-suddenly seized him, and dragged him down into
-the canoe; two of them held him down in the forepart
-of it, and the others, with great activity, paddled
-her off, the rest of the canoes following as fast
-as they could; upon this the marines, who were under
-arms upon deck, were ordered to fire. The shot
-was directed to that part of the canoe which was
-farthest from the boy, and rather wide of her, being
-willing rather to miss the rowers than to hurt him:
-it happened, however, that one man dropped, upon
-which the others quitted their hold of the boy, who
-instantly leaped into the water, and swam towards
-the ship; the large canoe immediately pulled round
-and followed him, but some musquets, and a great
-gun being fired at her, she desisted from the pursuit.
-The ship being brought to, a boat was lowered, and
-the poor boy taken up unhurt, though so terrified,
-that for a time he seemed to be deprived of his
-senses. Some of the gentlemen who traced the canoes
-to shore with their glasses, said, that they saw three
-men carried up the beach, who appeared to be either
-dead, or wholly disabled by their wounds.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>To the cape off which this unhappy transaction
-happened, I gave the name of <span class='sc'>Cape Kidnappers</span>. It
-lies in latitude 39° 43ʹ, and longitude 182° 24ʹ W.,
-and is rendered remarkable by two white rocks like
-hay stacks, and the high white cliffs on each side.
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_299'>299</span>It lies S. W. by W. distant thirteen leagues from the
-isle of Portland; and between them is the bay of
-which it is the south point, and which, in honour of
-Sir Edward Hawke, then First Lord of the Admiralty,
-I called <span class='sc'>Hawke’s Bay</span>. We found in it from
-twenty-four to seven fathom, and good anchorage.
-From Cape Kidnappers the land trends S. S. W., and
-in this direction we made our run along the shore,
-keeping at about a league distance, with a steady
-breeze and clear weather.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As soon as Tayeto recovered from his fright, he
-brought a fish to Tupia, and told him that he intended
-it as an offering to his Eatua, or god, in gratitude
-for his escape; Tupia commended his piety,
-and ordered him to throw the fish into the sea, which
-was accordingly done.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About two o’clock in the afternoon, we passed a
-small but high white island lying close to the shore,
-upon which we saw many houses, boats, and people.
-The people we concluded to be fishers, because the
-island was totally barren; we saw several people also
-on shore, in a small bay upon the main, within the
-island. At eleven, we brought to till day-light, and
-then made sail to the southward, along the shore.
-About seven o’clock we passed a high point of land,
-which lies S. S. W. twelve leagues from Cape Kidnappers:
-from this point the land trends three-fourths
-of a point more to the westward; at ten, we saw
-more land open to the southward, and at noon, the
-southernmost land that was in sight, bore S. 39 W.
-distant eight or ten leagues, and a high bluff head,
-with yellowish cliffs, bore W. distant about two miles:
-the depth of water was thirty-two fathom.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the afternoon we had a fresh breeze at west,
-and during the night variable light airs and calms:
-in the morning a gentle breeze sprung up between
-the N. W. and N. E., and having till now stood to the
-southward, without seeing any probability of meeting
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_300'>300</span>with a harbour, and the country manifestly altering
-for the worse, I thought that standing farther
-in that direction would be attended with no advantage,
-but on the contrary would be a loss of time that
-might be employed with a better prospect of success
-in examining the coast to the northward; about one,
-therefore, in the afternoon, I tacked, and stood north,
-with a fresh breeze at west. The high bluff head,
-with yellowish cliffs, which we were abreast of at
-noon, I called <span class='sc'>Cape Turnagain</span>, because here we
-turned back. It lies in latitude 40° 34ʹ S. longitude
-182° 55ʹ W., distant eighteen leagues S. S. W. and
-S. S. W. ½ W. from Cape Kidnappers. The land
-between them is of a very unequal height; in some
-places it is lofty next the sea with white cliffs, in
-others low, with sandy beaches: the face of the
-country is not so well clothed with wood as it is about
-Hawke’s bay, but looks more like our high downs in
-England: it is, however, to all appearance, well inhabited;
-for as we stood along the shore, we saw
-several villages, not only in the valleys, but on the
-tops and sides of the hills, and smoke in many other
-places. The ridge of mountains which has been
-mentioned before, extends to the southward farther
-than we could see, and was then every where chequered
-with snow. At night we saw two fires, inland,
-so very large, that we concluded they must
-have been made to clear the land for tillage; but
-however that be, they are a demonstration that the
-part of the country where they appeared is inhabited.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 18th, at four o’clock in the morning, Cape
-Kidnappers bore N. 32 W. distant two leagues: in
-this situation we had sixty-two fathom, and when the
-cape bore W. by N. distant three or four leagues,
-we had forty-five fathom: in the mid-way between
-the isle of Portland and the cape we had sixty-five
-fathom. In the evening, being abreast of the peninsula,
-within Portland island, called <span class='sc'>Terakako</span>, a
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_301'>301</span>canoe came off from that shore, and with much difficulty
-overtook the ship; there were on board five
-people, two of whom appeared to be chiefs, and the
-other three servants: the chiefs, with very little invitation,
-came on board, and ordered the rest to remain
-in their canoe. We treated them with great
-kindness, and they were not backward in expressing
-their satisfaction; they went down into the cabin,
-and after a short time told us that they had determined
-not to go on shore till the next morning. As
-the sleeping on board was an honour which we neither
-expected nor desired, I remonstrated strongly against
-it, and told them, that on their account it would not
-be proper, as the ship would probably be at a great
-distance from where she was then, the next morning:
-they persisted, however, in their resolution, and as I
-found it impossible to get rid of them without turning
-them by force out of the ship, I complied: as a proper
-precaution, however, I proposed to take their
-servants also on board, and hoist their canoe into the
-ship; they made no objection, and this was accordingly
-done. The countenance of one of these chiefs
-was the most open and ingenuous of all I have ever
-seen, and I very soon gave up every suspicion of his
-having any sinister design: they both examined
-every thing they saw with great curiosity and attention,
-and received very thankfully such little presents
-as we made them; neither of them, however,
-could be persuaded either to eat or drink, but their
-servants devoured every thing they could get with
-great voracity. We found that these men had heard
-of our kindness and liberality to the natives who had
-been on board before, yet we thought the confidence
-they placed in us, an extraordinary instance of their
-fortitude. At night I brought to till day-light, and
-then made sail; at seven in the morning, I brought
-to again under Cape Table, and sent away our guests
-with their canoe, who expressed some surprise at
-seeing themselves so far from home, but landed
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_302'>302</span>abreast of the ship. At this time I saw other canoes
-putting off from the shore, but I stood away to the
-northward without waiting for their coming up.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About three, I passed a remarkable head-land,
-which I called <span class='sc'>Gable-End-Foreland</span>, from the very
-great likeness of the white cliff at the point, to the
-gable-end of a house: it is not more remarkable for
-its figure, than for a rock which rises like a spire at
-a little distance. It lies from Cape Table N. 24 E.
-distant about twelve leagues. The shore between
-them forms a bay, within which lies Poverty Bay, at
-the distance of four leagues from the head-land, and
-eight from the Cape. At this place three canoes
-came off to us, and one man came on board; we gave
-him some trifles, and he soon returned to his boat,
-which, with all the rest, dropped astern.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the morning I made sail in shore, in order to
-look into two bays, which appeared about two leagues
-to the northward of the Foreland; the southernmost
-I could not fetch, but I anchored in the other about
-eleven o’clock.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Into this bay we were invited by the people on
-board many canoes, who pointed to a place where
-they said there was plenty of fresh water: I did not
-find so good a shelter from the sea as I expected;
-but the natives who came about us, appearing to be
-of a friendly disposition, I was determined to try
-whether I could not get some knowledge of the
-country here before I proceeded farther to the northward.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In one of the canoes that came about us as soon
-as we anchored, we saw two men, who by their habits
-appeared to be chiefs: one of them was dressed
-in a jacket, which was ornamented, after their manner,
-with dog’s skin; the jacket of the other was almost
-covered with small tufts of red feathers. These
-men I invited on board, and they entered the ship
-with very little hesitation: I gave each of them about
-four yards of linen, and a spike-nail; with the linen
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_303'>303</span>they were much pleased, but seemed to set no value
-upon the nail. We perceived that they knew what
-had happened in Poverty Bay, and we had therefore
-no reason to doubt but that they would behave
-peaceably; however, for further security, Tupia was
-ordered to tell them for what purpose we came
-thither, and to assure them that we would offer them
-no injury, if they offered none to us. In the mean
-time those who remained in the canoes traded with
-our people very fairly for what they happened to have
-with them: the chiefs, who were old men, staid with
-us till we had dined, and about two o’clock I put off
-with the boats, manned and armed, in order to go on
-shore in search of water, and the two chiefs went into
-the boat with me. The afternoon was tempestuous,
-with much rain, and the surf every where ran
-so high, that although we rowed almost round the
-bay, we found no place where we could land: I determined
-therefore to return to the ship, which being
-intimated to the chiefs, they called to the people
-on shore, and ordered a canoe to be sent off for themselves;
-this was accordingly done, and they left us,
-promising to come on board again in the morning,
-and bring us some fish and sweet potatoes.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the evening, the weather having become fair
-and moderate, the boats were again ordered out, and
-I landed, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander.
-We were received with great expressions of
-friendship by the natives, who behaved with a scrupulous
-attention not to give offence. In particular,
-they took care not to appear in great bodies: one
-family, or the inhabitants of two or three houses only,
-were generally placed together, to the number of
-fifteen or twenty, consisting of men, women, and
-children. These little companies sat upon the
-ground, not advancing towards us, but inviting us to
-them, by a kind of beckon, moving one hand towards
-the breast. We made them several little presents;
-and in our walk round the bay found two small
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_304'>304</span>streams of fresh water. This convenience, and the
-friendly behaviour of the people, determined me to
-stay at least a day, that I might fill some of my empty
-casks, and give Mr. Banks an opportunity of examining
-the natural produce of the country.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the morning of, the 21st, I sent lieutenant
-Gore on shore, to superintend the watering, with a
-strong party of men; and they were soon followed
-by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, with Tupia, Tayeto,
-and four others.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The natives sat by our people, and seemed pleased
-to observe them; but did not intermix with them:
-they traded, however, chiefly for cloth, and after a
-short time applied to their ordinary occupations, as
-if no stranger had been among them. In the forenoon,
-several of their boats went out a-fishing, and at
-dinner time every one repaired to his respective
-dwelling; from which, after a certain time, he returned.
-These fair appearances encouraged Mr.
-Banks and Dr. Solander to range the bay with very
-little precaution, where they found many plants, and
-shot some birds of exquisite beauty. In their walk,
-they visited several houses of the natives, and saw
-something of their manner of life; for they showed,
-without any reserve, every thing which the gentlemen
-desired to see. They were sometimes found at
-their meals, which the approach of the strangers
-never interrupted. Their food at this season consisted
-of fish, with which, instead of bread, they eat
-the root of a kind of fern, very like that which grows
-upon our commons in England. These roots they
-scorch over the fire, and then beat with a stick, till
-the bark and dry outside fall off; what remains is a
-soft substance, somewhat clammy and sweet, not unpleasing
-to the taste, but mixed with three or four
-times its quantity of strings and fibres, which are
-very disagreeable; these were swallowed by some,
-but spit out by the far greater number, who had
-baskets under them to receive the rejected part of
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_305'>305</span>what had been chewed, which had an appearance
-very like that of tobacco in the same state, in other
-seasons they have certainly plenty of excellent vegetables;
-but no tame animals were seen among them
-except dogs, which were very small and ugly. Mr.
-Banks saw some of their plantations, where the
-ground was as well broken down and tilled as even in
-the gardens of the most curious people among us: in
-these spots were sweet potatoes, coccos or eddas,
-which are well known and much esteemed both in
-the East and West Indies, and some gourds: the
-sweet potatoes were planted in small hills, some
-ranged in rows, and others in quincunx, all laid by a
-line with the greatest regularity: the coccos were
-planted upon flat land, but none of them yet appeared
-above ground; and the gourds were set in small
-hollows, or dishes, much as in England. These
-plantations were of different extent, from one or two
-acres to ten: taken together, there appeared to be
-from 150 to 200 acres in cultivation in the whole
-bay, though we never saw an hundred people. Each
-district was fenced in, generally with reeds, which
-were placed so close together that there was scarcely
-room for a mouse to creep between.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The women were plain, and made themselves more
-so by painting their faces with red ochre and oil,
-which, being generally fresh and wet upon their
-cheeks and foreheads, was easily transferred to the
-noses of those who thought fit to salute them; and
-that they were not wholly averse to such familiarity,
-the noses of several of our people strongly testified:
-they were, however, as great coquets as any of the
-most fashionable ladies in Europe, and the young
-ones as skittish as an unbroken filly: each of them
-wore a petticoat, under which there was a girdle,
-made of the blades of grass highly perfumed, and to
-the girdle was fastened a small bunch of the leaves
-of some fragrant plant, which served their modesty
-as its innermost veil. The faces of the men were
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_306'>306</span>not so generally painted, yet we saw one whose whole
-body, and even his garments, were rubbed over with
-dry ochre, of which he kept a piece constantly in his
-hand, and was every minute renewing the decoration
-in one part or another, where he supposed it
-was become deficient. In personal delicacy they
-were not equal to our friends at Otaheite, for the
-coldness of the climate did not invite them so often
-to bathe; but we saw among them one instance of
-cleanliness in which they exceeded them, and of
-which perhaps there is no example in any other Indian
-nation. Every house, or every little cluster of
-three or four houses, was furnished with a privy, so
-that the ground was every where clean. The offals
-of their food, and other litter, were also piled up in
-regular dunghills, which probably they made use of
-at a proper time for manure.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In this decent article of civil economy they were
-beforehand with one of the most considerable nations
-of Europe; for I am credibly informed, that,
-till the year 1760, there was no such thing as a privy
-in Madrid, the metropolis of Spain, though it is plentifully
-supplied with water. Before that time it was
-the universal practice to throw the ordure out of the
-windows, during the night, into the street, where
-numbers of men were employed to remove it, with
-shovels, from the upper parts of the city to the lower,
-where it lay till it was dry, and was then carried
-away in carts, and deposited without the gates. His
-present Catholic Majesty, having determined to free
-his capital from so gross a nuisance, ordered, by proclamation,
-that the proprietor of every house should
-build a privy, and that sinks, drains, and common
-sewers should be made at the public expense. The
-Spaniards, though long accustomed to an arbitrary
-government, resented this proclamation with great
-spirit, as an infringement of the common rights of
-mankind, and made a vigorous struggle against its
-being carried into execution. Every class devised
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_307'>307</span>some objection against it, but the physicians bid the
-fairest to interest the king in the preservation of the
-ancient privileges of his people; for they remonstrated
-that if the filth was not, as usual, thrown into
-the streets, a fatal sickness would probably ensue, because
-the putrescent particles of the air, which such
-filth attracted, would then be imbibed by the human
-body. But this expedient, with every other that
-could be thought of, proved unsuccessful, and the
-popular discontent then ran so high that it was very
-near producing an insurrection; his Majesty, however,
-at length prevailed, and Madrid is now as clear
-as most of the considerable cities in Europe. But
-many of the citizens, probably upon the principles
-advanced by their physicians, that heaps of filth prevent
-deleterious particles of air from fixing upon
-neighbouring substances, have, to keep their food
-wholesome, constructed their privies by the kitchen
-fire.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the evening, all our boats being employed in
-carrying the water on board, and Mr. Banks and his
-company finding it probable that they should be left
-on shore after it was dark, by which much time
-would be lost, which they were impatient to employ
-in putting the plants they had gathered in order,
-they applied to the Indians for a passage in one of
-their canoes: they immediately consented, and a
-canoe was launched for their use. They went all on
-board, being eight in number, but not being used to
-a vessel that required so even a balance, they unfortunately
-overset her in the surf: no life, however,
-was lost, but it was thought advisable that half of
-them should wait for another turn. Mr. Banks,
-Dr. Solander, Tupia, and Tayeto embarked again,
-and without any further accident arrived safely at
-the ship, well pleased with the good nature of their
-Indian friends, who cheerfully undertook to carry
-them a second time, after having experienced how
-unfit a freight they were for such a vessel.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_308'>308</span>While these gentlemen were on shore, several of
-the natives went off to the ship, and trafficked, by
-exchanging their cloth for that of Otaheite: of this
-barter they were for some time very fond, preferring
-the Indian cloth to that of Europe: but before night
-it decreased in its value five hundred per cent.
-Many of these Indians I took on board, and showed
-them the ship and her apparatus, at which they
-expressed equal satisfaction and astonishment.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As I found it exceedingly difficult to get water on
-board on account of the surf, I determined to stay
-no longer at this place; on the next morning, therefore,
-about five o’clock, I weighed anchor, and put
-to sea.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This bay, which is called by the natives <span class='sc'>Tegadoo</span>,
-lies in the latitude of 38° 10ʹ S.; but as it has nothing
-to recommend it, a description of it is unnecessary.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>From this bay I intended to stand on to the northward,
-but the wind being right against me, I could
-make no way. While I was beating about to windward,
-some of the natives came on board, and told
-me, that in a bay which lay a little to the southward,
-being the same that I could not fetch the day I put
-into Tegadoo, there was excellent water, where the
-boats might land without a surf. I thought it better,
-therefore, to put into this bay, where I might complete
-my water, and form farther connections with
-the Indians, than to keep the sea. With this view I
-bore up for it, and sent in two boats, manned and
-armed, to examine the watering-place, who confirming
-the report of the Indians at their return, I came to an
-anchor about one o’clock, in eleven fathom water, with
-a fine sandy bottom, the north point of the bay N. by E.,
-and the south point S. E. The watering-place, which
-was in a small cove a little within the south point
-of the bay, bore S. by E., distant about a mile. Many
-canoes came immediately off from the shore, and all
-traded very honestly for Otaheite cloth and glass-bottles,
-of which they were immoderately fond.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_309'>309</span>In the afternoon of the 23d, as soon as the ship
-was moored, I went on shore to examine the watering-place,
-accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander:
-the boat landed in the cove, without the least surf;
-the water was excellent, and conveniently situated;
-there was plenty of wood close to high-water mark,
-and the disposition of the people was in every respect
-such as we could wish.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Having, with Mr. Green, taken several observations
-of the sun and moon, the mean result of them gave
-180° 47ʹ W. longitude; but, as all the observations
-made before exceeded these, I have laid down the
-coast from the mean of the whole. At noon, I took
-the sun’s <a id='mer'></a>meridian altitude with an astronomical
-quadrant, which was set up at the watering-place,
-and found the latitude to be 38° 22ʹ 24ʺ.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 24th, early in the morning, I sent Lieutenant
-Gore on shore, to superintend the cutting of
-wood and filling of water, with a sufficient number of
-men for both purposes, and all the marines as a
-guard. After breakfast, I went on shore myself, and
-continued there the whole day.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander also went on shore
-to gather plants, and in their walks saw several things
-worthy of notice. They met with many houses in
-the valleys that seemed to be wholly deserted, the
-people living on the ridges of the hills in a kind of
-sheds very slightly built. As they were advancing
-in one of these valleys, the hills on each side of which
-were very steep, they were suddenly struck with the
-sight of a very extraordinary natural curiosity. It
-was a rock, perforated through its whole substance,
-so as to form a rude but stupendous arch or cavern,
-opening directly to the sea: this aperture was seventy-five
-feet long, twenty-seven broad, and five-and-forty
-high, commanding a view of the bay and the hills on
-the other side, which were seen through it, and,
-opening at once upon the view, produced an effect
-far superior to any of the contrivances of art.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_310'>310</span>As they were returning to the watering-place in
-the evening, they met an old man, who detained
-them some time by showing them the military exercises
-of the country with the lance and patoo-patoo,
-which are all the weapons in use. The lance is from
-ten to fourteen feet long, made of a very hard wood,
-and sharp at both ends: the patoo-patoo has been
-described already: it is about a foot long, made of
-talc or bone, with sharp edges, and used as a battle-axe.
-A post or stake was set up as his enemy, to
-which he advanced with a most furious aspect,
-brandishing his lance, which he grasped with great
-firmness; when it was supposed to have been pierced
-by his lance, he ran at it with his patoo-patoo, and
-falling upon the upper end of it, which was to represent
-his adversary’s head, he laid on with great vehemence,
-striking many blows, any one of which would
-probably have split the skull of an ox. From our
-champion’s falling upon his mock enemy with the
-patoo-patoo, after he was supposed to have been
-pierced with the lance, our gentlemen inferred, that
-in the battles of this country <a id='there'></a>there is no quarter.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This afternoon, we set up the armourer’s forge, to
-repair the braces of the tiller, which had been broken,
-and went on getting our wood and water, without
-suffering the least molestation from the natives; who
-came down with different sorts of fish, which we
-purchased with cloth, beads, and glass-bottles, as
-usual.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 25th, Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander went
-again on shore; and while they were searching for
-plants, Tupia staid with the waterers: among other
-Indians who came down to them, was a priest, with
-whom Tupia entered into a very learned conversation.
-In their notions of religion they seemed to
-agree very well, which is not often the case between
-learned divines on our side of the ocean: Tupia,
-however, seemed to have the most knowledge, and
-he was listened to with great deference and attention
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_311'>311</span>by the other. In the course of this conversation,
-after the important points of divinity had been settled,
-Tupia enquired if it was their practice to eat men,
-to which they answered in the affirmative; but said,
-that they eat only their enemies who were slain in
-battle.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 26th, it rained all day, so that none of us
-could go ashore; and very few of the Indians came
-either to the watering-place or the ship.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 27th, I went with Dr. Solander to examine
-the bottom of the bay; but though we went ashore
-at two places we met with little worth notice. The
-people behaved very civilly, showing us every thing
-that we expressed a desire to see. Among other
-trifling curiosities which Dr. Solander purchased of
-them, was a boy’s top, shaped exactly like those
-which children play with in England; and they made
-signs that to make it spin it was to be whipped.
-Mr. Banks in the mean time went ashore at the
-watering-place, and climbed a hill which stood at a
-little distant to see a fence of poles, which we had
-observed from the ship, and which had been much the
-subject of speculation. The hill was extremely steep,
-and rendered almost inaccessible by wood; yet he
-reached the place, near which he found many houses
-that for some reason had been deserted by their inhabitants.
-The poles appeared to be about sixteen
-feet high; they were placed in two rows, with a space
-of about six feet between them, and the poles in each
-row were about ten feet distant from each other.
-The lane between them was covered by sticks, that
-were set up sloping towards each other from the top
-of the poles on each side, like the roof of a house.
-This rail-work, with a ditch that was parallel to it, was
-carried about a hundred yards down the hill in a kind
-of curve; but for what purpose we could not guess.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The Indians, at the watering-place, at our request,
-entertained us with their war-song, in which the
-women joined, with the most horrid distortions of
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_312'>312</span>countenance, rolling their eyes, thrusting out their
-tongues, and often heaving loud and deep sighs;
-though all was done in very good time.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 28th, we went ashore upon an island that
-lies to the left hand of the entrance of the bay, where
-we saw the largest canoe that we had yet met with:
-she was sixty-eight feet and a half long, five broad, and
-three feet six high; she had a sharp bottom, consisting
-of three trunks of trees hollowed, of which
-that in the middle was the longest: the side planks
-were sixty-two feet long, in one piece, and were not
-despicably carved in bas-relief; the head also was
-adorned with carving still more richly. Upon this
-island there was a larger house than any we had yet
-seen; but it seemed unfinished, and was full of chips.
-The wood-work was squared so even and smooth, that
-we made no doubt of their having among them very
-sharp tools. The sides of the posts were carved in
-a masterly style, though after their whimsical taste,
-which seems to prefer spiril lines and distorted faces:
-as these carved posts appeared to have been brought
-from some other place, such work is probably of
-great value among them.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At four o’clock in the morning of the 29th, having
-got on board our wood and water, and a large supply
-of excellent celery, with which the country abounds,
-and which proved a powerful antiscorbutic, I unmoored
-and put to sea.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This bay is called by the natives <span class='sc'>Tolaga</span>; it is
-moderately large, and has from seven to thirteen
-fathom, with a clean sandy bottom and good anchorage;
-and is sheltered from all winds except the
-north-east. It lies in latitude 38° 22ʹ S. and four
-leagues and a half to the north of Gable-end Foreland.
-On the south point lies a small but high island,
-so near the main as not to be distinguished from it.
-Close to the north end of the island, at the entrance
-into the bay, are two high rocks; one is round, like
-a corn-stack, but the other is long, and perforated in
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_313'>313</span>several places, so that the openings appear like the
-arches of a bridge. Within these rocks is the cove
-where we cut wood, and filled our water-casks. Off
-the north point of the bay is a pretty high rocky
-island; and about a mile without it are some rocks
-and breakers. The variation of the compass here is
-14° 31ʹ E., and the tide flows at the full and change
-of the moon, about six o’clock, and rises and falls
-perpendicularly from five to six feet: whether the
-flood comes from the southward or the northward I
-have not been able to determine.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We got nothing here by traffic but a few fish, and
-some sweet potatoes, except a few trifles, which we
-considered merely as curiosities. We saw no four-footed
-animals, nor the appearance of any, either tame
-or wild, except dogs and rats, and these were very
-scarce: the people eat the dogs, like our friends at
-Otaheite; and adorn their garments with the skins,
-as we do ours with fur and ermine. I climbed many
-of the hills, hoping to get a view of the country, but
-I could see nothing from the top except higher hills,
-in a boundless succession. The ridges of these hills
-produce little besides fern; but the sides are most
-luxuriantly clothed with wood, and verdure of various
-kinds, with little plantations intermixed. In the
-woods, we found trees of above twenty different sorts,
-and carried specimens of each on board; but there
-was nobody among us to whom they were not
-altogether unknown. The tree which we cut for
-firing was somewhat like our maple, and yielded a
-whitish gum. We found another sort of it of a deep
-yellow, which we thought might be useful in dyeing.
-We found also one cabbage-tree, which we cut down
-for the cabbages. The country abounds with plants,
-and the woods with birds, in an endless variety,
-exquisitely beautiful, and of which none of us had
-the least knowledge. The soil both of the hills and
-valleys is light and sandy, and very fit for the production
-of all kinds of roots; though we saw none
-except sweet potatoes and yams.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_314'>314</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. III.<br /> <br />THE RANGE FROM TOLAGA TO MERCURY BAY, WITH AN ACCOUNT OF MANY INCIDENTS THAT HAPPENED BOTH ON BOARD AND ASHORE: A DESCRIPTION OF SEVERAL VIEWS EXHIBITED BY THE COUNTRY, AND OF THE HEPPAHS, OR FORTIFIED VILLAGES OF THE INHABITANTS.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'>On Monday, the 30th, about half an hour after one
-o’clock, having made sail again to the northward for
-about ten hours, with a light breeze, I hauled round
-a small island which lay east one mile from the north-east
-point of the land: from this place I found the
-land trend away N. W. by W. and W. N. W. as far as
-I could see, this point being the easternmost land on
-the whole coast. I gave it the name of <span class='sc'>East Cape</span>,
-and I called the island that lies off it <span class='sc'>East Island</span>;
-it is of a small circuit, high and round, and appears
-white and barren: the cape is high, with white cliffs,
-and lies in latitude 37° 42ʹ 30ʺ S. and longitude
-181° W. The land from Tolaga Bay to East Cape
-is of a moderate but unequal height, forming several
-small bays, in which are sandy beaches: of the inland
-country we could not see much, the weather being
-cloudy and hazy. The soundings were from twenty to
-thirty fathom, at the distance of about a league from
-the shore. After we had rounded the Cape, we saw
-in our run along the shore a great number of villages,
-and much cultivated land; the country in general
-appeared more fertile than before, and was low near
-the sea, but hilly within. At six in the evening,
-being four leagues to the westward of East Cape,
-we passed a bay which was first discovered by Lieutenant
-Hicks, and which, therefore, I called <span class='sc'>Hicks’s
-Bay</span>. At eight in the evening, being eight leagues to
-the westward of the Cape, and three or four miles
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_315'>315</span>from the shore, I shortened sail, and brought to for
-the night, having at this time a fresh gale at S. S. E.
-and squally; but it soon became moderate, and at
-two in the morning we made sail again to the S. W.
-as the land now trended; and at eight o’clock in
-the morning saw land, which made like an island,
-bearing west, the south-westernmost part of the main
-bearing south-west; and about nine no less than five
-canoes came off, in which were more than forty
-men, all armed with their country pikes and battle-axes,
-shouting, and threatening an attack; this gave
-us great uneasiness, and was, indeed, what we did
-not expect; for we hoped, that the report both of
-our power and clemency had spread to a greater
-extent. When one of these canoes had almost
-reached the ship, another of an immense size, the
-largest we had yet seen, crowded with people who
-were also armed, put off from the shore, and came
-up at a great rate: as it approached it received
-signals from the canoe that was nearest to the ship;
-and we could see that it had sixteen paddles on a
-side, beside people that sat, and others that stood in
-a row from stem to stern, being in all about sixty
-men: as they made directly to the ship, we were
-desirous of preventing an attack, by showing what
-we could do; and, therefore, fired a gun, loaded
-with grape-shot, a-head of them: this made them
-stop, but not retreat; a round-shot was then fired
-over them, and upon seeing it fall, they seized their
-paddles and made towards the shore with such precipitation
-that they seemed scarcely to allow themselves
-time to breathe. In the evening, three or four
-more canoes came off unarmed; but they would not
-venture within a musket-shot of the vessel. The
-Cape off which we had been threatened with hostilities
-I called, from the hasty retreat of the enemy,
-<span class='sc'>Cape Runaway</span>. It lies in latitude 37° 32ʹ; longitude
-181° 48ʹ. In this day’s run, we found that the
-land, which made like an island in the morning,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_316'>316</span>bearing west, was so; and we gave it the name of
-<span class='sc'>White Island</span>.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At day-break, on the 1st of November, we counted
-no less than five-and-forty canoes that were coming
-from the shore towards the ship: seven of them came
-up with us, and after some conversation with Tupia,
-sold us some lobsters and <a id='muss'></a>mussels, and two conger
-eels. These people traded pretty fairly; but when
-they were gone, some others came off from another
-place, who began also to trade fairly: but after some
-time they took what was handed down to them,
-without making any return; one of them who had
-done so, upon being threatened, began to laugh, and
-with many marks of derision set us at defiance, at
-the same time putting off the canoe from the ship:
-a musket was then fired over his head, which brought
-him back in a more serious mood, and trade went on
-with great regularity. At length, when the cabin
-and gun-room had got as much as they wanted, the
-men were allowed to come to the gangway, and
-trade for themselves. Unhappily the same care was
-not taken to prevent frauds as had been taken before,
-so that the Indians, finding that they could cheat
-with impunity, grew insolent again, and proceeded to
-take greater liberties. One of the canoes, having
-sold every thing on board, pulled forward, and the
-people that were in her seeing some linen hang over
-the ship’s side to dry, one of them, without any
-ceremony, untied it, and put it up in his bundle: he
-was immediately called to, and required to return it;
-instead of which, he let his canoe drop astern, and
-laughed at us: a musket was fired over his head,
-which did not put a stop to his mirth; another was
-then fired at him with small shot, which struck him
-upon the back; he shrunk a little when the shot hit
-him, but did not regard it more than one of our men
-would have done the stroke of a rattan: he continued
-with great composure to pack up the linen that he
-had stolen. All the canoes now dropped astern about
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_317'>317</span>a hundred yards, and all set up their song of defiance,
-which they continued till the ship was distant from
-them about four hundred yards. As they seemed
-to have no design to attack us, I was not willing
-to do them any hurt; yet I thought their going off
-in a bravado might have a bad effect when it should
-be reported ashore. To show them, therefore,
-that they were still in our power, though very much
-beyond the reach of any missile weapon with which
-they were acquainted, I gave the ship a yaw, and
-fired a four-pounder so as to pass near them. The
-shot happened to strike the water and rise several
-times at a great distance beyond the canoes: this
-struck them with terror, and they paddled away
-without once looking behind them.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About two in the afternoon, we saw a pretty high
-island bearing west from us; and at five, saw more
-islands and rocks to the westward of that. We
-hauled our wind in order to go without them, but
-could not weather them before it was dark. I, therefore,
-bore up, and ran between them and the main.
-At seven, I was close under the first, from which a
-large double canoe, or rather two canoes lashed
-together at the distance of about a foot, and covered
-with boards so as to make a deck, put off, and made
-sail for the ship: this was the first vessel of the kind
-that we had seen since we left the South Sea islands.
-When she came near, the people on board entered very
-freely into conversation with Tupia, and we thought
-showed a friendly disposition; but when it was just
-dark, they ran their canoe close to the ship’s side,
-and threw in a volley of stones, after which they
-paddled away.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We learnt from Tupia, that the people in the canoe
-called the island which we were under <span class='sc'>Mowtohora</span>;
-it is but of a small circuit, though high, and lies six
-miles from the main; on the south side is anchorage in
-fourteen fathom water. Upon the main land S. W. by
-W. of this island, and apparently at no great distance
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_318'>318</span>from the sea, is a high round mountain, which I
-called <span class='sc'>Mount Edgecumbe</span>: it stands in the middle
-of a large plain, and is, therefore, the more conspicuous;
-latitude 37° 59ʹ, longitude 183° 7ʹ.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In standing westward, we suddenly shoaled our
-water from seventeen to ten fathom; and knowing
-that we were not far from the small islands and rocks
-which we had seen before dark, and which I intended
-to have passed before I brought to for the night, I
-thought it more prudent to tack, and spend the night
-under Mowtohora, where I knew there was no danger.
-It was, indeed, happy for us that we did so; for in
-the morning, after we had made sail to the westward,
-we discovered ahead of us several rocks, some of
-which were level with the surface of the water, and
-some below it: they lay N. N. E. from Mount Edgecumbe,
-one league and a half distant from the island
-Mowtohora, and about nine miles from the main.
-We passed between these rocks and the main, having
-from ten to seven fathom water.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This morning, many canoes and much people were
-seen along the shore: several of the canoes followed
-us, but none of them could reach us, except one with a
-sail, which proved to be the same that had pelted us
-the night before. The people on board again entered
-into conversation with Tupia; but we expected another
-volley of their ammunition, which was not, indeed,
-dangerous to any thing but the cabin windows. They
-continued abreast of the ship about an hour, and
-behaved very peaceably; but at last the salute which
-we expected was given: we returned it by firing a
-musket over them, and they immediately dropped
-astern and left us, perhaps rather satisfied with having
-given a test of their courage by twice insulting a
-vessel so much superior to their own, than intimidated
-by the shot.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At half an hour after ten, we passed between a
-low flat island and the main: the distance from one
-to the other was about four miles, and the depth of
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_319'>319</span>water from ten to twelve fathom. The main land
-between this flat island and Mowtohora is of a moderate
-height, but level, pretty clear of wood, and
-full of plantations and villages. The villages, which
-were larger than any we had yet seen, were built
-upon eminences near the sea, and fortified on the
-land side by a bank and ditch, with a high paling
-within it, which was carried all round: beside a
-bank, ditch, and pallisadoes, some of them appeared
-to have outworks. Tupia had a notion that the
-small inclosure of pallisadoes, and a ditch that we
-had seen before, were morais or places of worship;
-but we were of opinion that they were forts, and concluded
-that these people had neighbouring enemies,
-and were always exposed to hostile attacks.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At two o’clock we passed a small high island, lying
-four miles from a high round head upon the main.
-From this head the land trends N. W. as far as can
-be seen, and has a rugged and hilly appearance. As
-the weather was hazy, and the wind blew fresh on
-the shore, we hauled off for the weathermost island
-in sight, which bore from us N. N. E., distant about
-six or seven leagues.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Under this island, which I have called the <span class='sc'>Mayor</span>,
-we spent the night. At seven in the morning it bore
-S. 47 E., distant six leagues, and a cluster of small
-islands and rocks bore N. ½ E., distant one league, to
-which I gave the name of the <span class='sc'>Court of Aldermen</span>.
-They lie in the compass of about half a league every
-way, and five leagues from the main, between which
-and them lie other islands, most of them barren rocks,
-of which there is great variety: some of them are as
-small in compass as the Monument of London, but
-rise to a much greater height, and some of them are
-inhabited. They lie in latitude 36° 57ʹ, and at
-noon bore S. 60 E., distant three or four leagues;
-and a rock like a castle, lying not far from the main,
-bore N. 40 W., at the distance of one league. The
-country that we passed the night before appeared to
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_320'>320</span>be well inhabited, many towns were in sight, and
-some hundreds of large canoes lay under them upon
-the beach; but this day, after having sailed about
-fifteen leagues, it appeared to be barren and desolate.
-As far as we had yet coasted this country from Cape
-Turnagain, the people acknowledged one chief,
-whom they called <span class='sc'>Teratu</span>, and to whose residence
-they pointed, in a direction that we thought to be
-very far inland, but afterwards found to be otherwise.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About one o’clock, three canoes came off to us
-from the main, with one-and-twenty men on board.
-The construction of these vessels appeared to be
-more simple than that of any we had seen, they being
-nothing more than trunks of a single tree hollowed by
-fire, without any convenience or ornament. The
-people on board were almost naked, and appeared to
-be of a browner complexion; yet naked and despicable
-as they were, they sung their song of defiance,
-and seemed to denounce against us inevitable destruction:
-they remained, however, some time out
-of stone’s throw, and then venturing nearer, with less
-appearance of hostility, one of our men went to the
-ship’s side, and was about to hand them a rope; this
-courtesy, however, they thought fit to return by
-throwing a lance at him, which having missed him,
-they immediately threw another into the ship: upon
-this a musket was fired over them, which at once sent
-them away.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About two, we saw a large opening, or inlet, for
-which we bore up; we had now forty-one fathom
-water, which gradually decreased to nine, at which
-time we were one mile and a half distant from a high
-towered rock which lay near the south point of the
-inlet: this rock, and the <a id='north'></a>northernmost of the Court
-of Alderman being in one, bearing S. 61 E.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About seven in the evening we anchored in seven
-fathom, a little within the south entrance of the bay:
-to this place we were accompanied by several canoes
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_321'>321</span>and people like those we had seen last, and for some
-time they behaved very civilly. While they were
-hovering about us, a bird was shot from the ship, as
-it was swimming upon the water: at this they showed
-less surprise than we expected, and taking up the
-bird, they tied it to a fishing line that was towing
-astern; as an acknowledgment for this favour, we gave
-them a piece of cloth: but notwithstanding this effect
-of our fire-arms, and this interchange of civilities, as
-soon as it grew dark, they sung their war-song, and
-attempted to tow away the buoy of the anchor. Two
-or three muskets were then fired over them, but this
-seemed rather to make them angry than afraid, and
-they went away, threatening that to-morrow they
-would return with more force, and be the death of
-us all; at the same time sending off a boat, which
-they told us was going to another part of the bay for
-assistance.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>There was some appearance of generosity, as well
-as courage, in acquainting us with the time when
-they intended to make their attack, but they forfeited
-all credit which this procured them, by coming
-secretly upon us in the night, when they certainly
-hoped to find us asleep: upon approaching the ship,
-they found themselves mistaken, and therefore retired
-without speaking a word, supposing that they
-were too early; after some time, they came a second
-time, and being again disappointed, they retired as
-silently as before.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the morning, at day-break, they prepared to
-effect by force what they had in vain attempted by
-stealth and artifice: no less than twelve canoes came
-against us with about a hundred and fifty men, all
-armed with pikes, lances, and stones. As they could
-do nothing till they came very near the ship, Tupia
-was ordered to expostulate with them, and if possible
-divert them from their purpose: during the conversation,
-they appeared to be sometimes friendly and
-sometimes otherwise; at length, however, they began
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_322'>322</span>to trade, and we offered to purchase their weapons,
-which some of them consented to sell: they sold two
-very fairly, but having received what had been agreed
-upon for the purchase of a third, they refused to send
-it up, but offered it for a second price; a second was
-sent down, but the weapon was still detained, and a
-demand made of a third; this being refused with
-some expressions of displeasure and resentment, the
-offender, with many ludicrous tokens of contempt
-and defiance, paddled his canoe off a few yards from
-the ship. As I intended to continue in this place
-five or six days, in order to make an observation of
-the transit of Mercury, it was absolutely necessary,
-in order to prevent future mischief, to show these
-people that we were not to be treated ill with impunity;
-some small shot were therefore fired at the
-thief, and a musket ball through the bottom of his
-boat: upon this it was paddled to about a hundred
-yards’ distance, and to our great surprise the people
-in the other canoes took not the least notice of their
-wounded companion, though he bled very much,
-but returned to the ship, and continued to trade with
-the most perfect indifference and unconcern. They
-sold us many more of their weapons, without making
-any other attempt to defraud us, for a considerable
-time; at last, however, one of them thought fit to
-paddle away with two different pieces of cloth which
-had been given for the same weapon: when he had
-got about an hundred yards’ distance, and thought
-himself secure of his prize, a musket was fired after
-him, which fortunately struck the boat just at the
-water’s edge, and made two holes in her side; this
-only incited them to ply their paddles with greater
-activity, and the rest of the canoes also made off with
-the utmost expedition. As the last proof of our
-superiority, therefore, we fired a round shot over them,
-and not a boat stopped till they got on shore.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About ten o’clock, I went with two boats to sound
-the bay, and look out for a more convenient anchoring-place,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_323'>323</span>the master being in one boat and myself
-in the other. We pulled first over to the north shore,
-from which some canoes came out to meet us; as we
-advanced, however, they retired, inviting us to follow
-them; but seeing them all armed, I did not think it proper
-to comply, but went towards the head of the bay,
-where I observed a village upon a very high point,
-fortified in the manner that has been already described,
-and having fixed upon an anchoring-place
-not far from where the ship lay, I returned on board.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At three o’clock in the afternoon, I weighed, run
-in nearer to the shore, and anchored in four fathom
-and an half water, with a soft sandy bottom, the south
-point of the bay bearing E. distant one mile, and a
-river which the boats can enter at low water S. S. E.,
-distant a mile and an half.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the morning, the natives came off again to the
-ship, and we had the satisfaction to observe that their
-behaviour was very different from what it had been
-yesterday: among them was an old man, whom we
-had before remarked for his prudence and honesty:
-his name was <span class='sc'>Toiava</span>, and he seemed to be a person
-of a superior rank; in the transactions of yesterday
-morning he had behaved with great propriety and
-good sense, lying in a small canoe, always near the
-ship, and treating those on board as if he neither intended
-a fraud, nor suspected an injury: with some
-persuasion this man and another came on board, and
-ventured into the cabin, where I presented each of
-them with a piece of English cloth and some spike
-nails. They told us that the Indians were now very
-much afraid of us, and on our part we promised
-friendship, if they would behave peaceably, desiring
-only to purchase what they had to sell upon their
-own terms.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After the natives had left us, I went with the pinnace
-and long boat into the river with a design to
-haul the seine, and sent the master in the yawl to
-sound the bay and dredge for fish. The Indians, who
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_324'>324</span>were on one side of the river, expressed their friendship
-by all the signs they could devise, beckoning us
-to land among them; but we chose to go ashore on
-the other side, as the situation was more convenient
-for hauling the seine and shooting birds, of which we
-saw great numbers of various kinds: the Indians,
-with much persuasion, about noon, ventured over to
-us. With the seine we had very little success, catching
-only a few mullets, neither did we get any thing
-by the trawl or the dredge, except a few shells; but
-we shot several birds, most of them resembling sea-pies,
-except that they had black plumage, and red
-bills and feet. While we were absent with our guns,
-the people who staid by the boats saw two of the Indians
-quarrel and fight: they began the battle with
-their lances, but some old men interposed and took
-them away, leaving them to decide the difference,
-like Englishmen, with their fists: they boxed with
-great vigour and obstinacy for some time, but by degrees
-all retired behind a little hill, so that our people
-could not see the event of the combat.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the morning the long-boat was sent again to
-traul in the bay, and an officer, with the marines, and
-a party of men, to cut wood and haul the seine. The
-Indians on shore appeared very peaceable and submissive,
-and we had reason to believe that their habitations
-were at a considerable distance, for we saw
-no houses, and found that they slept under the bushes:
-the bay is probably a place to which they frequently
-resort in parties to gather shell-fish, of which it affords
-incredible plenty; for wherever we went, whether
-upon the hills or in the valleys, the woods or the
-plains, we saw vast heaps of shells, often many waggon-loads
-together, some appearing to be very old,
-and others recent. We saw no cultivation in this
-place, which had a desolate and barren appearance;
-the tops of the hills were green, but nothing grew
-there, except a large kind of fern, the roots of which
-the natives had got together in large quantities, in
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_325'>325</span>order to carry away with them. In the evening Mr.
-Banks walked up the river, which, at the mouth, looked
-fine and broad, but at the distance of about two miles
-was not deep enough to cover the foot; and the
-country inland was still more barren than at the sea
-side. The seine and dredge were not more successful
-to-day than yesterday, but the Indians in some
-measure compensated for the disappointment by
-bringing us several baskets of fish, some dry, and
-some fresh dressed; it was not indeed of the best,
-but I ordered it all to be bought for the encouragement
-of trade.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 7th, the weather was so bad that none of
-us left the ship, nor did any of the Indians come on
-board.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 8th, I sent a party of men on shore to wood
-and water; and in the mean time many canoes came
-off, in one of which was our friend Toiava; soon after
-he was alongside of the ship, he saw two canoes coming
-from the opposite side of the bay, upon which he
-hasted back again to the shore with all his canoes,
-telling us that he was afraid of the people who were
-coming: this was a farther proof that the people of
-this country were perpetually committing hostilities
-against each other. In a short time, however, he returned,
-having discovered that the people who had
-alarmed him were not the same that he had supposed.
-The natives that came to the ship this morning sold
-us, for a few pieces of cloth, as much fish of the
-mackerel kind as served the whole ship’s company,
-and they were as good as ever were eaten. At noon,
-this day, I observed the sun’s meridional zenith distance
-by an astronomical quadrant, which gave the
-latitude 36° 47ʹ 43ʺ within the south entrance of the
-bay.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander went on shore and
-collected a great variety of plants, altogether unknown,
-and not returning till the evening, had an
-opportunity of observing in what manner the Indians
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_326'>326</span>disposed themselves to pass the night. They had no
-shelter but a few shrubs; the women and the children
-were ranged innermost, or farthest from the sea; the
-men lay in a kind of half circle round them, and their
-arms were set up against the trees close by them, in
-a manner which showed that they were afraid of an
-attack by some enemy not far distant. It was also
-discovered that they acknowledged neither Teratu,
-nor any other person as their king: as in this particular
-they differed from all the people that we had seen
-upon other parts of the coast, we thought it possible
-that they might be a set of outlaws, in a state of rebellion
-against Teratu, and in that case they might
-have no settled habitations, or cultivated land in any
-part of the country.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 9th, at day-break, a great number of canoes
-came on board, loaded with mackerel of two sorts,
-one exactly the same with those caught in England,
-and the other somewhat different: we imagined the
-people had taken a large shoal, and brought us an
-overplus which they could not consume; for they
-sold them at a very low rate. They were, however,
-very welcome to us; at eight o’clock, the ship had
-more fish on board than all her people could eat in
-three days; and before night, the quantity was so
-much increased, that every man who could get salt,
-cured as many as would last him a month.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After an early breakfast, I went ashore, with Mr.
-Green and proper instruments, to observe the transit
-of Mercury, Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander being of
-the party; the weather had for some time been very
-thick, with much rain, but this day was so favourable
-that not a cloud intervened during the whole transit.
-The observation of the ingress was made by Mr.
-Green alone, while I was employed in taking the
-sun’s altitude to ascertain the time. It came on at
-7<sup>h</sup> 20ʹ 58ʺ apparent time: according to Mr. Green’s
-observation, the internal contact was at 12<sup>h</sup> 8ʹ 58ʺ,
-the external at 12<sup>h</sup> 9ʹ 55ʺ P. M. And according to
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_327'>327</span>mine, the internal contact was at 12<sup>h</sup> 8ʹ 54ʺ, and the
-external 12<sup>h</sup> 9ʹ 48ʺ; the latitude of the place of
-observation was 30° 48ʹ 5-½ʺ. The latitude observed
-at noon was 36° 48ʹ 28ʺ. The mean of this and
-yesterday’s observation gives 36° 48ʹ 5-½ʺ S. the latitude
-of the place of observation; the variation of
-the compass was 11° 9ʹ E.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About noon, we were alarmed by the firing of a
-great gun from the ship; Mr. Gore, my second
-lieutenant, was at this time commanding officer on
-board, and the account that he gave was this. While
-some small canoes were trading with the people, two
-very large ones came up, full of men, one of them
-having on board forty-seven, all armed with pikes,
-darts, and stones, and apparently with a hostile intention:
-they appeared to be strangers, and to be
-rather conscious of superiority over us by their
-numbers, than afraid of any weapons which could
-give us the superiority over them: no attack however
-was made; probably because they learnt from
-the people in the other canoes, with whom they immediately
-entered into conference, what kind of an
-enemy they had to deal with: after a little time, they
-began to trade, some of them offering their arms,
-and one of them a square piece of cloth, which makes
-a part of their dress, called a <i>Haahow</i>; several of the
-weapons were purchased, and Mr. Gore having
-agreed for a Haahow, sent down the price, which
-was a piece of British cloth, and expected his purchase:
-but the Indian, as soon as he had got Mr.
-Gore’s cloth in his possession, refused to part with
-his own, and put off the canoe: upon being threatened
-for this fraud, he and his companions began to sing
-their war-song in defiance, and shook their paddles:
-still however they began no attack, only defying Mr.
-Gore to take any remedy in his power, which so provoked
-him that he levelled a musket loaded with
-ball at the offender, while he was holding the cloth
-in his hand, and shot him dead. It would have been
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_328'>328</span>happy, if the effect of a few small shot had been
-tried upon this occasion, which, upon some others,
-had been successful.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When the Indian dropped, all the canoes put off
-to some distance; but as they did not go away, it
-was thought they might still meditate an attack. To
-secure therefore a safe passage for the boat, which it
-was necessary to send on shore, a round shot was
-fired over their heads, which effectually answered the
-purpose, and put them all to flight. When an account
-of what had happened was brought ashore, our
-Indians were alarmed, and drawing all together, retreated
-in a body. After a short time, however, they
-returned, having heard a more particular account of
-the affair; and intimated that they thought the man
-who had been killed deserved his fate.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>A little before sunset the Indians retired to eat
-their supper, and we went with them to be spectators
-of the repast; it consisted of fish of different kinds,
-among which were lobsters, and some birds, of a
-species unknown to us: these were either roasted or
-baked; to roast them, they fastened them upon a
-small stick, which was stuck up in the ground inclining
-towards their fire; and to bake them, they put
-them into a hole in the ground, with hot stones, in
-the same manner as the people of Otaheite.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Among the natives that were assembled upon this
-occasion, we saw a woman, who, after their manner,
-was mourning for the death of her relation: she sat
-upon the ground near the rest, who, one only excepted,
-seemed not at all to regard her: the tears
-constantly trickled down her cheeks, and she repeated
-in a low, but very mournful voice, words,
-which even Tupia did not at all understand: at the
-end of every sentence she cut her arms, her face, or
-her breast with a shell that she held in her hand, so
-that she was almost covered with blood, and was
-indeed one of the most affecting spectacles that can
-be conceived. The cuts, however, did not appear
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_329'>329</span>to be so deep as are sometimes made upon similar
-occasions, if we may judge by the scars which we
-saw upon the arms, thighs, breasts, and cheeks of
-many of them, which we were told were the remains
-of wounds which they had inflicted upon themselves
-as testimonies of their affection and sorrow.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The next day, I went with two boats, accompanied
-by Mr. Banks and the other gentlemen, to examine
-a large river that empties itself into the head of the
-bay. We rowed about four or five miles up, and
-could have gone much farther, if the weather had been
-favourable. It was here wider than at the mouth,
-and divided into many streams by small flat islands,
-which are covered with mangroves, and overflowed
-at high water. From these trees exudes a viscous
-substance which very much resembles resin: we
-found it first in small lumps upon the sea-beach, and
-now saw it sticking to the trees, by which we knew
-whence it came. We landed on the east side of the
-river, where we saw a tree upon which several shags
-had built their nests, and here therefore we determined
-to dine; twenty of the shags were soon
-killed, and being broiled upon the spot, afforded us
-an excellent meal. We then went upon the hills
-from whence I thought I saw the head of the river.
-The shore on each side, as well as the islands in the
-middle, were covered with mangroves; and the sandbanks
-abounded in cockles and clams: in many places
-there were rock-oysters, and every where plenty of
-wild fowl, principally shags, ducks, curlieus, and the
-sea-pie, that has been described before. We also
-saw fish in the river, but of what kind we could not
-discover: the country on the east side of this river is
-for the most part barren, and destitute of wood; but
-on the west it has a better aspect, and in some
-places is adorned with trees, but has in no part the
-appearance of cultivation. In the entrance of the
-river, and for two or three miles up, there is good
-anchoring in four and five fathom water, and places
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_330'>330</span>very convenient for laying a vessel on shore, where
-the tide rises and falls seven feet at the full and
-change of the moon. We could not determine,
-whether any considerable stream of fresh water came
-into this river out of the country; but we saw a
-number of small rivulets issue from the adjacent hills.
-Near the mouth of this river, on the east side, we
-found a little Indian village, consisting of small
-temporary sheds, where we landed, and were received
-by the people with the utmost kindness and
-hospitality: they treated us with a flat shell fish of a
-most delicious taste, somewhat like a cockle, which
-we eat hot from the coals. Near this place is a high
-point or peninsula, projecting into the river, and
-upon it are the remains of a fort, which they call
-<i>Eppah</i>, or <i>Heppah</i>. The best engineer in Europe
-could not have chosen a situation better adapted to
-enable a small number to defend themselves against
-a greater. The steepness of the cliffs renders it
-wholly inaccessible from the water which incloses it
-on three sides; and, to the land, it is fortified by a
-ditch, and a bank raised on the inside: from the top
-of the bank to the bottom of the ditch, is two and
-twenty feet; the ditch on the outside is fourteen feet
-deep, and its breadth is in proportion. The whole
-seemed to have been executed with great judgment;
-and there had been a row of pickets or pallisadoes,
-both on the top of the bank and along the brink of the
-ditch on the outside; those on the outside had been
-driven very deep into the ground, and were inclined
-towards the ditch, so as to project over it; but of
-these the thickest posts only were left, and upon
-them there were evident marks of fire, so that the
-place had probably been taken and destroyed by an
-enemy. If any occasion should make it necessary
-for a ship to winter here, or stay any time, tents
-might be built in this place, which is sufficiently
-spacious, with great convenience, and might easily
-be made impregnable to the whole country.</p>
-
-<div id='il1_04' class='figcenter id002'>
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_331'>331</span>
-<img src='images/il1_04.jpg' alt='' class='ig001' />
-<div class='ic001'>
-<p><i>A Fortified Town or Village, called a Hippah at Tolaga.</i></p>
-</div>
-</div>
-
-<div id='il1_05' class='figcenter id002'>
-<img src='images/il1_05.jpg' alt='' class='ig001' />
-<div class='ic001'>
-<p><i>A Natural Arch or Perforated Rock.</i></p>
-</div>
-</div>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the eleventh, there was so much wind and
-rain that no canoe came off; but the long-boat was
-sent to fetch oysters from one of the beds which had
-been discovered the day before: the boat soon returned,
-deeply laden, and the oysters, which were
-as good as ever came from Colchester, and about the
-same size, were laid down under the booms, and the
-ship’s company did nothing but eat them from the
-time they came on board till night, when, as may
-reasonably be supposed, great part of them were expended;
-this, however, gave us no concern, as we
-knew that not the boat only, but the ship, might
-have been loaded, almost in one tide, as the beds are
-dry at half ebb.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the morning of Sunday the 12th, two canoes
-came off full of people whom we had never seen before,
-but who appeared to have heard of us by the
-caution which they used in approaching us. As we
-invited them to come alongside with all the tokens of
-friendship that we could show, they ventured up,
-and two of them came on board; the rest traded very
-fairly for what they had: a small canoe also came
-from the other side of the bay, and sold us some very
-large fish, which they gave us to understand they
-would have brought yesterday, having caught them
-the day before, but that the wind was so high they
-could not venture to sea.</p>
-
-<div id='il1_06' class='figcenter id002'>
-<img src='images/il1_06.jpg' alt='' class='ig001' />
-<div class='ic001'>
-<p><i>The Inside of a Hippah in New Zealand.</i></p>
-</div>
-</div>
-
-<p class='c000'>After breakfast, I went with the pinnace and
-yawl, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander,
-over to the north side of the bay, to take a view of
-the country, and two fortified villages which we had
-discovered at a distance. We landed near the smallest
-of them, the situation of which was the most beautifully
-romantic that can be imagined; it was built
-upon a small rock, detached from the main, and
-surrounded at high water. The whole body of this
-rock was perforated by an hollow or arch, which possessed
-much the largest part of it; the top of the
-arch was above sixty feet perpendicular above the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_332'>332</span>sea, which at high water flowed through the bottom
-of it: the whole summit of the rock above the arch
-was fenced round after their manner; but the area
-was not large enough to contain more than five or six
-houses: it was accessible only by one very narrow
-and steep path, by which the inhabitants, at our
-approach, came down, and invited us into the place;
-but we refused, intending to visit a much more considerable
-fort of the same kind at about a mile’s
-distance. We made some presents however to the
-women, and in the mean time we saw the inhabitants
-of the town which we were going to, coming towards
-us in a body, men, women, and children, to the
-number of about one hundred: when they came near
-enough to be heard, they waved their hands and
-called out <i>Horomai</i>; after which they sat down among
-the bushes near the beach; these ceremonies we were
-told were certain signs of their friendly disposition.
-We advanced to the place where they were sitting,
-and when we came up, made them a few presents,
-and asked leave to visit their Heppah; they consented
-with joy in their countenances, and immediately
-led the way. It is called <span class='sc'>Wharretouwa</span>, and
-is situated upon a high promontory or point, which
-projects into the sea, on the north side, and near the
-head of the bay: two sides of it are washed by the
-sea, and these are altogether inaccessible; two other
-sides are to the land: up one of them, which is very
-steep, lies the avenue from the beach; the other is
-flat and open to the country upon the hill, which is
-a narrow ridge: the whole is inclosed by a pallisade
-about ten feet high, consisting of strong pales bound
-together with withes. The weak side next the land
-is also defended by a double ditch, the innermost of
-which has a bank and an additional pallisade: the
-inner pallisades are upon the bank next the town, but
-at such a distance from the top of the bank as to leave
-room for men to walk and use their arms, between them
-and the inner ditch; the outermost pallisades are between
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_333'>333</span>the two ditches, and driven obliquely into the
-ground, so that their upper ends incline over the inner
-ditch: the depth of this ditch, from the <a id='bottom'></a>bottom to the
-top or crown of the bank, is four-and-twenty feet. Close
-within the innermost pallisade is a stage, twenty feet
-high, forty feet long, and six broad; it is supported
-by strong posts, and is intended as a station for those
-who defend the place, from which they may annoy the
-assailants by darts and stones, heaps of which lay
-ready for use. Another stage of the same kind commands
-the steep avenue from the beach, and stands
-also within the pallisade; on this side of the hill, there
-are some little outworks and huts, not intended as
-advanced posts, but as the habitations of people who,
-for want of room, could not be accommodated within
-the works, but who were, notwithstanding, desirous
-of placing themselves under their protection. The
-pallisades, as has been observed already, run round
-the whole brow of the hill, as well towards the sea
-as towards the land; but the ground within having
-originally been a mount, they have reduced it not to
-one level, but to several, rising in stages one above
-the other, like an amphitheatre, each of which is inclosed
-within its separate pallisade; they communicate
-with each other by narrow lanes, which might
-easily be stopt up, so that if an enemy should force
-the outward pallisade, he would have others to carry
-before the place could be wholly reduced, supposing
-these places to be obstinately defended one after the
-other. The only entrance is by a narrow passage,
-about twelve feet long, communicating with the steep
-ascent from the beach: it passes under one of the
-fighting stages, and though we saw nothing like a
-door or gateway, it may be easily barricaded in a
-manner that will make the forcing it a very dangerous
-and difficult undertaking. Upon the whole, this
-must be considered as a place of great strength, in
-which a small number of resolute men may defend
-themselves against all the force which a people with
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_334'>334</span>no other arms than those that are in use here could
-bring against it. It seemed to be well furnished for
-a siege with every thing but water; we saw great
-quantities of fern root, which they eat as bread, and
-dried fish piled up in heaps; but we could not perceive
-that they had any fresh water nearer than a
-brook, which runs close under the foot of the hill:
-whether they have any means of getting it from this
-place during a siege, or whether they have any method
-of storing it within the works in gourds or other
-vessels, we could not learn; some resource they
-certainly have with respect to this article, an indispensable
-necessary of life, for otherwise the laying up
-dry provisions could answer no purpose. Upon our
-expressing a desire to see their method of attack and
-defence, one of the young men mounted a fighting
-stage, which they call <i>Porava</i>, and another went
-into the ditch: both he that was to defend the
-place, and he that was to assault it, sung the war-song,
-and danced with the same frightful gesticulations
-that we had seen used in more serious circumstances,
-to work themselves up into a degree of
-that mechanical fury, which, among all uncivilized
-nations, is the necessary prelude to a battle; for dispassionate
-courage, a strength of mind that can surmount
-the sense of danger, without a flow of animal
-spirits by which it is extinguished, seems to be the
-prerogative of those who have projects of more lasting
-importance, and a keener sense of honour and disgrace,
-than can be formed or felt by men who have
-few pains or pleasures besides those of mere animal
-life, and scarcely any purpose but to provide for the
-day that is passing over them, to obtain plunder, or
-revenge an insult: they will march against each other
-indeed in cool blood, though they find it necessary
-to work themselves into passion before they engage;
-as among us there have been many instances
-of people who have deliberately made themselves
-drunk, that they might execute a project which they
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_335'>335</span>formed when they were sober, but which, while
-they continued so, they did not dare to undertake.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the side of the hill, near this inclosure, we saw
-about half an acre planted with gourds and sweet
-potatoes, which was the only cultivation in the bay:
-under the foot of the point upon which this fortification
-stands, are two rocks, one just broken off from
-the main, and the other not perfectly detached from
-it: they are both small, and seem more proper for
-the habitations of birds than men; yet there are
-houses and places of defence upon each of them.
-And we saw many other works of the same kind
-upon small islands, rocks, and ridges of hills, on different
-parts of the coast, besides many fortified
-towns, which appeared to be much superior to this.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The perpetual hostility in which these poor savages,
-who have made every village a fort, must
-necessarily live, will account for there being so little
-of their land in a state of cultivation; and, as mischiefs
-very often reciprocally produce each other, it
-may perhaps appear, that there being so little land
-in a state of cultivation, will account for their living
-in perpetual hostility. But it is very strange, that
-the same invention and diligence which have been
-used in the construction of places so admirably
-adapted to defence, almost without tools, should not,
-when urged by the same necessity, have furnished
-them with a single missile weapon except the lance,
-which is thrown by hand; they have no contrivance
-like a bow to discharge a dart, nor any thing like a
-sling to assist them in throwing a stone; which is
-the more surprising, as the invention of slings, and
-bows and arrows, is much more obvious than of the
-works which these people construct, and both these
-weapons are found among much ruder nations, and
-in almost every other part of the world. Besides the
-long lance and Patoo-patoo, which have been mentioned
-already, they have a staff about five feet long,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_336'>336</span>sometimes pointed like a Serjeant’s halberd, sometimes
-only tapering to a point at one end, and having
-the other end broad, and shaped somewhat like the
-blade of an oar. They have also another weapon,
-about a foot shorter than these, pointed at one end,
-and at the other shaped like an axe. The points of
-their long lances are barbed, and they handle them
-with such strength and agility, that we can match
-them with no weapon but a loaded musquet.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After taking a slight view of the country, and
-loading both the boats with celery, which we found
-in great plenty near the beach, we returned from our
-excursion, and about five o’clock in the evening got
-on board the ship.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 15th, I sailed out of the bay, and at the
-same time had several canoes on board, in one of
-which was our friend Toiava, who said, that as soon
-as we were gone he must repair to his Heppah or fort,
-because the friends of the man who had been shot
-by Mr. Gore on the 9th, had threatened to revenge
-his death upon him, whom they had reproached as
-being our friend. Off the north point of the bay, I
-saw a great number of islands, of various extent,
-which lay scattered to the north-west, in a direction
-parallel with the main as far as I could see. I steered
-north-east for the north-easternmost of these islands,
-but the wind coming to the north-west, I was obliged
-to stand out to sea.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>To the bay which we had now left I gave the
-name of <span class='sc'>Mercury Bay</span>, on account of the observation
-which we had made there of the transit of that
-planet over the sun. It lies in latitude 36° 47ʹ S.;
-and in the longitude of 184° 4ʹ W.: there are several
-islands lying both to the southward and northward
-of it, and a small island or rock in the middle of the
-entrance: within this island the depth of water no
-where exceeds nine fathom; the best anchoring is
-in a sandy bay, which lies just within the south head,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_337'>337</span>in five and four fathom, bringing a high tower or
-rock, which lies without the head, in one with the
-head, or just shut in behind it. This place is very
-convenient both for wooding and watering, and in
-the river there is an immense quantity of oysters and
-other shell-fish: I have for this reason given it the
-name of <span class='sc'>Oyster River</span>. But for a ship that wants
-to stay here any time, the best and safest place is in
-the river at the head of the bay; which, from the
-number of mangrove trees about it, I have called
-<span class='sc'>Mangrove River</span>. To sail into this river, the south
-shore must be kept all the way on board. The
-country on the east side of the river and bay, is very
-barren, its only produce being fern, and a few other
-plants that will grow in a poor soil. The land on the
-north-west side is covered with wood, and the soil
-being much more fertile would doubtless produce
-all the necessaries of life with proper cultivation: it
-is not however so fertile as the lands that we have
-seen to the southward, nor do the inhabitants, though
-numerous, make so good an appearance: they have
-no plantations; their canoes are mean, and without
-ornament; they sleep in the open air; and say, that
-Teratu, whose sovereignty they do not acknowledge,
-if he was to come among them, would kill them.
-This favoured our opinion of their being out-laws;
-yet they told us, that they had Heppahs, or strongholds,
-to which they retired in time of imminent
-danger.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We found, thrown upon the shore, in several parts
-of this bay, great quantities of iron sand, which is
-brought down by every little rivulet of fresh water
-that finds its way from the country; which is a demonstration
-that there is ore of that metal not far
-inland: yet neither the inhabitants of this place, or
-any other part of the coast that we have seen, know
-the use of iron, or set the least value upon it; all of
-them preferring the most worthless and useless trifle,
-not only to a nail, but to any tool of that metal.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_338'>338</span>Before we left the bay, we cut upon one of the
-trees near the watering-place the ship’s name, and
-that of the commander, with the date of the year
-and month when we were there; and after displaying
-the English colours, I took a formal possession
-of it in the name of his Britannic Majesty King
-George the Third.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_339'>339</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. IV.<br /> <br />THE RANGE FROM MERCURY BAY TO THE BAY OF ISLANDS; AN EXPEDITION UP THE RIVER THAMES: SOME ACCOUNT OF THE INDIANS WHO INHABIT ITS BANKS, AND THE FINE TIMBER THAT GROWS THERE: SEVERAL INTERVIEWS WITH THE NATIVES ON DIFFERENT PARTS OF THE COAST, AND A SKIRMISH WITH THEM UPON AN ISLAND.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_0 c014'>I continued plying to windward two days to get
-under the land, and on the 18th, about seven in the
-morning, we were abreast of a very conspicuous promontory,
-being then in latitude 36° 26ʹ, and in the
-direction of N. 48 W. from the north head of Mercury
-Bay, or Point Mercury, which was distant nine
-leagues: upon this point stood many people, who
-seemed to take little notice of us, but talked together
-with great earnestness. In about half an hour, several
-canoes put off from different places, and came
-towards the ship; upon which the people on the
-point also launched a canoe, and about twenty of
-them came in her up with the others. When two of
-these canoes, in which there might be about sixty
-men, came near enough to make themselves heard,
-they sung their war-song; but seeing that we took
-little notice of it, they threw a few stones at us, and
-then rowed off towards the shore. We hoped that
-we had now done with them, but in a short time
-they returned, as if with a fixed resolution to provoke
-us into a battle, animating themselves by their song
-as they had done before. Tupia, without any directions
-from us, went to the poop, and began to expostulate:
-he told them, that we had weapons which
-would destroy them in a moment; and that, if they
-ventured to attack us, we should be obliged to use
-them. Upon this, they flourished their weapons, and
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_340'>340</span>cried out, in their language, “Come on shore, and
-we will kill you all:” Well, said Tupia, but why
-should you molest us while we are at sea? as we do
-not wish to fight, we shall not accept your challenge
-to come on shore; and here there is no pretence for
-quarrel, the sea being no more your property than
-the ship. This eloquence of Tupia, though it greatly
-surprised us, having given him no hints for the arguments
-he used, had no effect upon our enemies, who
-very soon renewed their battery: a musket was then
-fired through one of their boats, and this was an argument
-of sufficient weight, for they immediately
-fell astern and left us.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>From the point, of which we were now abreast,
-the land trends W. ½ S. near a league, and then
-S. S. E. as far as we could see; and, besides the
-islands that lay without us, we could see land round
-by the S. W. as far as N. W.; but whether this was
-the main or islands, we could not then determine:
-the fear of losing the main, however, made me resolve
-to follow its direction. With this view, I hauled
-round the point, and steered to the southward, but
-there being light airs all round the compass, we made
-but little progress.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About one o’clock, a breeze sprung up at east,
-which afterwards came to N. E. and we steered along
-the shore S. by E. and S. S. E. having from twenty-five
-to eighteen fathom.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At about half an hour after seven in the evening,
-having run seven or eight leagues since noon, I anchored
-in twenty-three fathom, not choosing to run
-any farther in the dark, as I had now land on both
-sides, forming the entrance of a straight, bay, or
-river, lying S. by E. for on that point we could see
-no land.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At day-break, on the 19th, the wind being still
-favourable, we weighed and stood with an easy sail
-up the inlet, keeping nearest to the east side. In a
-short time, two large canoes came off to us from the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_341'>341</span>shore; the people on board said, that they knew
-Toiava very well, and called Tupia by his name. I
-invited some of them on board; and as they knew
-they had nothing to fear from us, while they behaved
-honestly and peaceably, they immediately complied:
-I made each of them some presents, and dismissed
-them much gratified. Other canoes afterwards came
-up to us from a different side of the bay; and the
-people on board of these also mentioned the name of
-Toiava, and sent a young man into the ship, who
-told us he was his grandson, and he also was dismissed
-with a present.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After having run about five leagues from the place
-where we had anchored the night before, our depth
-of water gradually decreased to six fathom; and not
-choosing to go into less, as it was tide of flood, and
-the wind blew right up the inlet, I came to an anchor
-about the middle of the channel, which is near
-eleven miles over; after which I sent two boats out
-to sound, one on one side, and the other on the
-other.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The boats not having found above three feet more
-water than we were now in, I determined to go no
-farther with the ship, but to examine the head of the
-bay in the boats; for, as it appeared to run a good
-way inland, I thought this a favourable opportunity
-to examine the interior part of the country, and its
-produce.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At day-break, therefore, I set out in the pinnace
-and long-boat, accompanied by Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander,
-and Tupia; and we found the inlet end in a
-river, about nine miles above the ship: into this
-river we entered with the first of the flood, and within
-three miles found the water perfectly fresh. Before
-we had proceeded more than one third of that distance,
-we found an Indian town, which was built
-upon a small bank of dry sand, but entirely surrounded
-by a deep mud, which possibly the inhabitants
-might consider as a defence. These people, as
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_342'>342</span>soon as they saw us, thronged to the banks, and invited
-us on shore. We accepted the invitation, and
-made them a visit notwithstanding the mud. They
-received us with open arms, having heard of us from
-our good old friend Toiava; but our stay could not
-be long, as we had other objects of curiosity in view.
-We proceeded up the river till near noon, when we
-were fourteen miles within its entrance; and then,
-finding the face of the country to continue nearly
-the same, without any alteration in the course of the
-stream, which we had no hope of tracing to its
-source, we landed on the west side, to take a view
-of the lofty trees which every where adorned its
-banks. They were of a kind that we had seen before,
-though only at a distance, both in Poverty Bay and
-Hawke’s Bay. Before we had walked an hundred
-yards into the wood, we met with one of them which
-was nineteen feet eight inches in the girt, at the
-height of six feet above the ground: having a quadrant
-with me, I measured its height from the root to
-the first branch, and found it to be eighty-nine feet:
-it was as straight as an arrow, and tapered but very
-little in proportion to its height; so that I judged
-there were three hundred and fifty-six feet of solid
-timber in it, exclusive of the branches. As we advanced,
-we saw many others that were still larger;
-we cut down a young one, and the wood proved
-heavy and solid, not fit for masts, but such as would
-make the finest plank in the world. Our carpenter,
-who was with us, said that the timber resembled that
-of the pitch-pine, which is lightened by tapping; and
-possibly some such method might be found to lighten
-these, and they would then be such masts as no
-country in Europe can produce. As the wood was
-swampy, we could not range far; but we found
-many stout trees of other kinds, all of them utterly
-unknown to us, specimens of which we brought
-away.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The river at this height is as broad as the Thames
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_343'>343</span>at Greenwich, and the tide of flood as strong; it is
-not indeed quite so deep, but has water enough for
-vessels of more than a middle size, and a bottom of
-mud so soft, that nothing could take damage by running
-ashore.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About three o’clock, we reimbarked, in order to
-return with the first of the ebb, and named the river
-the <span class='sc'>Thames</span>, it having some resemblance to our own
-river of that name. In our return, the inhabitants
-of the village where we had been ashore, seeing us
-take another channel, came off to us in their canoes,
-and trafficked with us in the most friendly manner,
-till they had disposed of the few trifles they had.
-The tide of ebb just carried us out of the narrow
-part of the river, into the channel that run up from
-the sea before it was dark; and we pulled hard to
-reach the ship, but meeting the flood, and a strong
-breeze at N. N. W. with showers of rain, we were
-obliged to desist; and about midnight, we run under
-the land, and came to a grappling, where we took
-such rest as our situation would admit. At break of
-day, we set forward again, and it was past seven
-o’clock before we reached the ship. We were all
-extremely tired, but thought ourselves happy to be
-on board; for before nine it blew so hard that the
-boat could not have rowed ahead, and must therefore
-either have gone ashore, or taken shelter under it.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About three o’clock, having the tide of ebb, we
-took up our anchor, made sail, and plied down the
-river till eight in the evening, when we came to an
-anchor again: early in the morning, we made sail
-with the first ebb, and kept plying till the flood
-obliged us once more to come to an anchor. As we
-had now only a light breeze, I went in the pinnace,
-accompanied by Dr. Solander, to the western shore,
-but I saw nothing worthy of notice.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When I left the ship, many canoes were about it;
-Mr. Banks therefore chose to stay on board and
-traffic with the natives; they bartered their clothes
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_344'>344</span>and arms, chiefly for paper, and behaved with great
-friendship and honesty. But while some of them
-were below with Mr. Banks, a young man who was
-upon the deck stole a half minute glass which was
-in the binnacle, and was detected just as he was carrying
-it off. Mr. Hicks, who was commanding-officer
-on board, took it into his head to punish him, by
-giving him twelve lashes with a cat-o’nine-tails; and
-accordingly ordered him to be taken to the gangway,
-and tied up to the shrouds. When the other
-Indians who were on board saw him seized, they
-attempted to rescue him; and being resisted called
-for their arms, which were handed up from the
-canoes, and the people of one of them attempted to
-come up the ship’s side. The tumult was heard by
-Mr. Banks, who, with Tupia, came hastily upon the
-deck to see what had happened. The Indians immediately
-ran to Tupia, who, finding Mr. Hicks inexorable,
-could only assure them, that nothing was
-intended against the life of their companion; but
-that it was necessary he should suffer some punishment
-for his offence; which being explained to them,
-they seemed to be satisfied. The punishment was
-then inflicted, and as soon as the criminal was unbound,
-an old man among the spectators, who was
-supposed to be his father, gave him a hearty beating,
-and sent him down into his canoe. All the canoes
-then dropped a-stern, and the people said that they
-were afraid to come any more near the ship: after
-much persuasion, however, they ventured back again,
-but their cheerful confidence was at an end, and
-their stay was short; they promised indeed, at their
-departure, to return with some fish, but we saw no
-more of them.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 23d, the wind being contrary, we kept
-plying down the river, and at seven in the evening,
-got without the N. W. point of the islands lying on
-the west side of it. The weather being bad, night
-coming on, and having land on every side of us, I
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_345'>345</span>thought it most advisable to tack, and stretch in
-under the point, where we anchored in nineteen
-fathom. At five in the morning of the 24th, we
-weighed, and made sail to the N. W. under our
-courses and double reefed topsails, the wind being
-at S. W. by W. and W. S. W. a strong gale and
-squally. As the gale would not permit us to come
-near the land, we had but a slight and distant view
-of it from the time when we got under sail till noon,
-during a run of twelve leagues, but we never once
-lost sight of it. At this time, our latitude by observation
-was 36° 15ʹ 20ʺ, we were not above two miles
-from a point of land on the main, and three leagues
-and an half from a very high island, which bore N. E.
-by E.: in this situation we had twenty-six fathom
-water: the farthest point on the main that we could
-see bore N. W. but we could perceive several small
-islands lying to the north of that direction. The
-point of land of which we were now a-breast, and
-which I called <span class='sc'>Point Rodney</span>, is the N. W. extremity
-of the river Thames; for under that name I
-comprehend the deep bay, which terminates in the
-fresh water stream, and the N. E. extremity is the
-promontory which we passed when we entered it,
-and which I called <span class='sc'>Cape Colville</span>, in honour of the
-Right Honourable Lord Colville.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Cape Colville lies in latitude 36° 26ʹ, longitude
-184° 27ʹ; it rises directly from the sea, to a considerable
-height, and is remarkable for a lofty rock,
-which stands to the pitch of the point, and may be
-distinguished at a very great distance. From the
-south point of this cape, the river runs in a direct
-line S. by E., and is no where less than three leagues
-broad for the distance of fourteen leagues above the
-cape, and there it is contracted to a narrow stream,
-but continues the same course through a low flat
-country, or broad valley, which lies parallel with the
-sea coast, and the end of which we could not see.
-On the east side of the broad part of this river, the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_346'>346</span>land is tolerably high and hilly; on the west side, it
-is rather low, but the whole is covered with verdure
-and wood, and has the appearance of great fertility,
-though there were but a few small spots which had
-been cultivated. At the entrance of the narrow part
-of the river, the land is covered with mangroves and
-other shrubs; but farther, there are immense woods
-of perhaps the finest timber in the world, of which
-some account has already been given: in several
-places, the wood extends to the very edge of the
-water, and where it is at a little distance, the intermediate
-space is marshy, like some parts of the banks
-of the Thames in England: it is probable that the
-river contains plenty of fish, for we saw poles stuck
-up in many places to set nets for catching them, but
-of what kinds I do not know. The greatest depth
-of water that we found in this river was six-and-twenty
-fathom, which gradually decreased to one
-fathom and an half: in the mouth of the fresh-water
-stream, it is from four to three fathom, but there are
-large flats and sand banks lying before it. A ship of
-moderate draught may, notwithstanding, go a long
-way up this river with a flowing tide, for it rises perpendicularly
-near ten feet, and at the full and change
-of the moon, it is high water about nine o’clock.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Six leagues within Cape Colville, under the eastern
-shore, are several small islands, which, together with
-the main, seem to form good harbours; and opposite
-to these islands, under the western shore, lie other
-islands, by which it is also probable that good harbours
-may be formed: but if there are no harbours
-about this river, there is good anchoring in every
-part of it where the depth of water is sufficient, for
-it is defended from the sea by a chain of islands of
-different extent, which lie cross the mouth of it, and
-which I have, for that reason, called <span class='sc'>Barrier Islands</span>:
-they stretch N. W. and S. E. ten leagues. The south
-end of the chain lies N. E. between two and three
-leagues from Cape Colville; and the north end lies
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_347'>347</span>N. E. four leagues and an half from Point Rodney.
-Point Rodney lies W. N. W. nine leagues from Cape
-Colville, in latitude 36° 15ʹ S. longitude 184° 53ʹ W.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The natives residing about this river do not appear
-to be numerous, considering the great extent of the
-country. But they are strong, well-made, and active
-people, and all of them paint their bodies with red
-oker and oil from head to foot, which we had not
-seen before. Their canoes were large and well built,
-and adorned with carving, in as good a taste as any
-that we had seen upon the coast.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We continued to stand along the shore till night,
-with the main land on one side, and islands on the
-other, and then anchored in a bay, with fourteen
-fathom, and a sandy bottom. We had no sooner
-come to an anchor, than we tried our lines, and in a
-short time caught near one hundred fish, which the
-people called Sea-bream; they weighed from six to
-eight pounds a-piece, and consequently would supply
-the whole ship’s company with food for two days.
-From the success of our lines here, we called the
-place <span class='sc'>Bream Bay</span>: the two points that form it lie
-north and south, five leagues from each other; it is
-every where of a good breadth, and between three
-and four leagues deep: at the bottom of it there
-appears to be a river of fresh water. The north head
-of the bay, called <span class='sc'>Bream Head</span>, is high land, and
-remarkable for several pointed rocks, which stand in
-a range upon the top of it: it may also be known
-by some small islands which lie before it, called the
-<span class='sc'>Hen and Chickens</span>, one of which is high, and terminates
-in two peaks. It lies in latitude 35° 46ʹ S.,
-and at the distance of seventeen leagues and an half
-from Cape Colville, in the direction of N. 41 W.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The land between Point Rodney and Bream Head,
-an extent of ten leagues, is low, and wooded in tufts,
-with white sand banks between the sea and the firm
-lands. We saw no inhabitants, but many fires in
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_348'>348</span>the night; and where there are fires, there are always
-people.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At day-break, on the 25th, we left the bay, and
-steered along shore to the northward: we found the
-variation of the compass to be 12° 42ʹ E. At noon,
-our latitude was 35° 36ʹ S., Bream Head bore south,
-distant ten miles; and we saw some small islands, to
-which I gave the name of the <span class='sc'>Poor Knights</span>, at N.
-E. by N. distant three leagues; the northernmost
-land in sight bore N. N. W.: we were in this place
-at the distance of two miles from the shore, and had
-twenty-six fathom water.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The country appeared low, but well covered with
-wood: we saw some straggling houses, three or four
-fortified towns, and near them a large quantity of
-cultivated land.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the evening, seven large canoes came off to us,
-with about two hundred men: some of them came
-on board, and said that they had heard of us. To
-two of them, who appeared to be chiefs, I gave
-presents; but when these were gone out of the ship,
-the others became exceedingly troublesome. Some
-of those in the canoes began to trade, and, according
-to their custom, to cheat, by refusing to deliver what
-had been bought, after they had received the price:
-among these was one who had received an old pair
-of black breeches, which, upon a few small shot being
-fired at him, he threw into the sea. All the boats
-soon after paddled off to some distance, and when they
-thought they were out of reach, they began to defy
-us, by singing their song, and brandishing their weapons.
-We thought it advisable to intimidate them,
-as well for their sakes as our own, and therefore fired
-first some small arms, and then round shot over their
-heads; the last put them in a terrible fright, though
-they received no damage, except by over-heating
-themselves in paddling away, which they did with
-astonishing expedition.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'><span class='pageno' id='Page_349'>349</span>In the night we had variable light airs; but towards
-the morning, a breeze sprung up at S. and
-afterwards at S. E. with which we proceeded slowly
-to the northward, along the shore.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Between six and seven o’clock, two canoes came
-off, and told us that they had heard of yesterday’s
-adventure, notwithstanding which the people came
-on board, and traded very quietly and honestly for
-whatever they had: soon after two canoes came off
-from a more distant part of the shore; these were of
-a much larger, size and full of people: when they
-came near, they called off the other canoes which
-were along side of the ship, and after a short conference
-they all came up together. The strangers appeared
-to be persons of a superior rank; their canoes
-were well carved with many ornaments, and they
-had with them a great variety of weapons: they had
-patoo-patoos both of stone and whalebone, upon which
-they appeared to set a great value; they had also
-ribs of whale, of which we had before seen imitations
-in wood, carved and adorned with tufts of dog’s hair.
-Their complexions were browner than those of the
-people we had seen to the southward, and their
-bodies and faces were more marked with the black
-stains which they call Amoco: they had a broad
-spiral on each buttock; and the thighs of many of
-them were almost entirely black, some narrow lines
-only being left untouched, so that at first sight they
-appeared to wear striped breeches. With respect to
-the Amoco, every different tribe seemed to have a
-different custom; for all the men, in some canoes,
-seemed to be almost covered with it, and those in
-others had scarcely a stain, except on the lips,
-which were black in all of them, without a single exception.
-These gentlemen, for a long time, refused
-to part with any of their weapons, whatever was
-offered for them; at last, however, one of them produced
-a piece of talc, wrought into the shape of an
-axe, and agreed to sell it for a piece of cloth: the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_350'>350</span>cloth was handed over the ship’s side, but his honour
-immediately put off his canoe with the axe. We had
-recourse to our usual expedient, and fired a musket
-ball over the canoe, upon which it put back to the
-ship, and the piece of cloth was returned; all the
-boats then went ashore, without offering any further
-intercourse.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At noon, the main land extended from S. by E. to
-N. W. by W. a remarkable point of land bearing W.
-distant four or five miles; at three we passed it, and
-I gave it the name of <span class='sc'>Cape Bret</span>, in honour of Sir
-Piercy. The land of this cape is considerably higher
-than any part of the adjacent coast: at the point of
-it, is a high round hillock, and N. E. by N. at the
-distance of about a mile, is a small high island or
-rock, which, like several that have already been described,
-was perforated quite through, so as to appear
-like the arch of a bridge. This cape, or at least
-some part of it, is by the natives called <span class='sc'>Motugogogo</span>,
-and it lies in latitude 35° 10ʹ 30ʺ S. longitude 185°
-25ʹ W. On the west side of it is a large and pretty
-deep bay, lying in S. W. by W. in which there appeared
-to be several small islands: the point that
-forms the N. W. entrance, lies W. ¼ N. at the distance
-of three or four leagues from Cape Bret, and I
-distinguished it by the name of <span class='sc'>Point Pococke</span>. On
-the west side of the bay, we saw several villages, both
-upon islands and the main, and several very large
-canoes came off to us, full of people, who made a
-better appearance than any we had seen yet: they
-were all stout and well-made; their hair, which was
-black, was tied up in a bunch on the crown of their
-heads, and stuck with white feathers. In each of
-the canoes, were two or three chiefs, whose habits
-were of the best sort of cloth, and covered with dog’s
-skin, so as to make an agreeable appearance: most
-of these people were marked with the Amoco, like
-those who had been alongside of us before: their
-manner of trading was also equally fraudulent; and
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_351'>351</span>the officers neglecting either to punish or fright them,
-one of the midshipmen who had been defrauded in
-his bargain, had recourse, for revenge, to an expedient
-which was equally ludicrous and severe: he
-got a fishing line, and when the man who had cheated
-him was close under the ship’s side in his canoe, he
-heaved the lead with so good an aim, that the hook
-caught him by the backside; he then pulled the
-line, and the man holding back, the hook broke
-in the shank, and the beard was left sticking in
-the flesh.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>During the course of this day, though we did not
-range more than six or eight leagues of the coast, we
-had alongside and on board the ship between four
-and five hundred of the natives, which is a proof that
-this part of the country is well inhabited.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At eight o’clock the next morning, we were within
-a mile of a group of islands which lie close under the
-main, at the distance of two-and-twenty miles from
-Cape Bret, in the direction of N. W. by W. ½ W.
-At this place, having but little wind, we lay about
-two hours, during which time several canoes came
-off, and sold us some fish, which we called Cavalles,
-and for that reason I gave the same name to the
-islands. These people were very insolent, frequently
-threatening us, even while they were selling their
-fish; and when some more canoes came up, they
-began to pelt us with stones. Some small shot were
-then fired, and hit one of them while he had a stone
-in his hand, in the very action of throwing it into
-the ship: they did not, however, desist, till some
-others had been wounded, and then they went away,
-and we stood off to sea.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The wind being directly against us, we kept plying
-to windward till the 29th, when we had rather
-lost than gained ground; I therefore bore up for a
-bay which lies to the westward of Cape Bret; at this
-time it was about two leagues to leeward of us; and
-at about eleven o’clock we anchored under the south
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_352'>352</span>west side of one of the many islands which line it on
-the south-east, in four fathom and an half water; we
-shoaled our water to this depth all at once, and if
-this had not happened, I should not have come to an
-anchor so soon. The master was immediately sent
-out with two boats to sound, and he soon discovered
-that we had got upon a bank, which runs out from
-the north-west end of the island, and that on the
-outside of it there was from eight to ten fathom.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the mean time the natives, to the number of
-near four hundred, crowded upon us in their canoes,
-and some of them were admitted on board: to one,
-who seemed to be a chief, I gave a piece of broad
-cloth, and distributed some trifling presents among
-the rest. I perceived that some of these people had
-been about the ship when she was off at sea, and that
-they knew the power of our fire-arms, for the very
-sight of a gun threw them into manifest confusion:
-under this impression, they traded very fairly; but
-the people in one of the canoes took the opportunity
-of our being at dinner to tow away our buoy: a
-musket was fired over them without effect, we then
-endeavoured to reach them with some small shot, but
-they were too far off: by this time they had got the
-buoy into their canoe, and we were obliged to fire a
-musket at them with ball: this hit one of them, and
-they immediately threw the buoy over board: a
-round shot was then fired over them, which struck
-the water and went ashore. Two or three of the
-canoes immediately landed their people, who ran
-about the beach, as we imagined, in search of the
-ball. Tupia called to them, and assured them that,
-while they were honest, they should be safe, and with
-a little persuasion many of them returned to the ship,
-and their behaviour was such as left us no reason to
-suspect that they intended to give us any farther
-trouble.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After the ship was removed into deeper water, and
-properly secured, I went with the pinnace and yawl,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_353'>353</span>manned and armed, accompanied by Mr. Banks and
-Dr. Solander, and landed upon the island, which
-was about three quarters of a mile distant: we observed
-that the canoes which were about the ship,
-did not follow us upon our leaving her, which we
-thought a good sign; but we had no sooner landed
-than they crowded to different parts of the island and
-came on shore. We were in a little cove, and in a
-few minutes were surrounded by two or three hundred
-people, some rushing from behind the heads of the
-cove, and others appearing on the tops of the hills:
-they were all armed, but they came on in so confused
-and straggling a manner that we scarcely
-suspected they meant us any harm, and we were
-determined that hostilities should not begin on our
-part. We marched towards them, and then drew a
-line upon the sand between them and us, which we
-gave them to understand they were not to pass: at
-first they continued quiet, but their weapons were held
-ready to strike, and they seemed to be rather irresolute
-than peaceable. While we remained in this state of
-suspense, another party of Indians came up, and
-now growing more bold as their number increased,
-they began the dance and song, which are their preludes
-to a battle: still, however, they delayed the
-attack, but a party ran to each of our boats, and attempted
-to draw them on shore; this seemed to be
-the signal, for the people about us at the same time
-began to press in upon our line: our situation was
-now become too critical for us to remain longer inactive,
-I therefore discharged my musket, which was
-loaded with small shot, at one of the forwardest, and
-Mr. Banks and two of the men fired immediately
-afterwards: this made them fall back in some confusion,
-but one of the chiefs, who was at the distance
-of about twenty yards, rallied them, and running
-forward, weaving his patoo-patoo, and calling loudly
-to his companions, led them to the charge. Dr.
-Solander, whose piece was not yet discharged, fired
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_354'>354</span>at this champion, who stopped short upon feeling the
-shot, and then ran away with the rest: they did not
-however disperse, but got together upon a rising
-ground, and seemed only to want some leader of resolution
-to renew their attack. As they were now
-beyond the reach of small shot, we fired with ball,
-but as none of them took place, they still continued
-in a body, and in this situation we remained about a
-quarter of an hour: in the mean time the ship, from
-whence a much greater number of Indians were seen
-than could be discovered in our situation, brought
-her broad-side to bear, and entirely dispersed them,
-by firing a few shot over their heads. In this skirmish
-only two of the Indians were hurt with the small
-shot, and not a single life was lost, which would not
-have been the case, if I had not restrained the men,
-who, either from fear or the love of mischief,
-showed as much impatience to destroy them as a
-sportsman to kill his game. When we were in quiet
-possession of our cove, we laid down our arms and
-began to gather celery, which grew here in great
-plenty: after a little time we recollected to have seen
-some of the people hide themselves in a cave of one
-of the rocks, we therefore went towards the place,
-when an old Indian, who proved to be the chief that
-I had presented with a piece of broad cloth in the
-morning, came out with his wife and his brother, and
-in a supplicating posture put themselves under our
-protection. We spoke kindly to them, and the old
-man then told us that he had another brother, who
-was one of those that had been wounded by the small
-shot, and enquired, with much solicitude and concern,
-if he would die. We assured him that he would not,
-and at the same time put into his hand both a musket-ball
-and some small shot, telling him, that those only
-who were wounded with the ball would die, and that
-the others would recover; at the same time assuring
-him, that if we were attacked again, we should
-certainly defend ourselves with the ball, which would
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_355'>355</span>wound them mortally. Having now taken courage,
-they came and sat down by us, and as tokens of our
-perfect amity, we made them presents of such trifles
-as we happened to have about us.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Soon after we re-embarked in our boats, and having
-rowed to another cove in the same island, climbed
-a neighbouring hill, which commanded the country
-to a considerable distance. The prospect was very
-uncommon and romantic, consisting of innumerable
-islands, which formed as many harbours, where the
-water was as smooth as a mill-pool: we saw also many
-towns, scattered houses, and plantations, the country
-being much more populous than any we had seen.
-One of the towns was very near us, from which many
-of the Indians advanced, taking great pains to show
-us that they were unarmed, and in their gestures
-and countenances expressing great meekness and
-humility. In the mean time some of our people,
-who, when the Indians were to be punished for a
-fraud, assumed the inexorable justice of a Lycurgus,
-thought fit to break into one of their plantations, and
-dig up some potatoes: for this offence I ordered each
-of them to be punished with twelve lashes, after
-which two of them were discharged; but the third,
-insisting that it was no crime in an Englishman to
-plunder an Indian plantation, though it was a crime
-in an Indian to defraud an Englishman of a nail, I
-ordered him back into his confinement, from which
-I would not release him till he had received six lashes
-more.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 30th, there being a dead calm, and no
-probability of our getting to sea, I sent the master,
-with two boats, to sound the harbour; and all the
-forenoon had several canoes about the ship, who
-traded in a very fair and friendly manner. In the
-evening we went ashore upon the main, where the
-people received us very cordially; but we found
-nothing worthy of notice.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In this bay we were detained by contrary winds
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_356'>356</span>and calms several days, during which time our intercourse
-with the natives was continued in the most
-peaceable and friendly manner, they being frequently
-about the ship, and we ashore, both upon the islands
-and the main. In one of our visits to the continent,
-an old man showed us the instrument they use in the
-staining their bodies, which exactly resembled those
-that were employed for the same purpose at Otaheite.
-We saw also the man who was wounded in attempting
-to steal our buoy: the ball had passed through the
-fleshy part of his arm, and grazed his breast; but the
-wound, under the care of Nature, the best surgeon,
-and a simple diet, the best nurse, was in a good state,
-and seemed to give the patient neither pain nor apprehension.
-We saw also the brother of our old
-chief, who had been wounded with small shot in our
-skirmish: they had struck his thigh obliquely, and
-though several of them were still in the flesh, the
-wound seemed to be attended with neither danger
-nor pain. We found among their plantations the
-<i>morus papyrifera</i>, of which these people, as well as
-those of Otaheite, make cloth; but here the plant
-seems to be rare, and we saw no pieces of the cloth
-large enough for any use but to wear by way of ornament
-in their ears.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Having one day landed in a very distant part of
-the bay, the people immediately fled, except one old
-man, who accompanied us wherever we went, and
-seemed much pleased with the little presents we made
-him. We came at last to a little fort, built upon a
-small rock, which at high water was surrounded by
-the sea, and accessible only by a ladder: we perceived
-that he eyed us with a kind of restless solicitude as
-we approached it, and upon our expressing a desire
-to enter it, he told us that his wife was there: he
-saw that our curiosity was not diminished by this intelligence,
-and after some hesitation, he said, if we
-would promise to offer no indecency, he would accompany
-us: our promise was readily given, and he
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_357'>357</span>immediately led the way. The ladder consisted of
-steps fastened to a pole, but we found the ascent both
-difficult and dangerous. When we entered we found
-three women, who, the moment they saw us, burst
-into tears of terror and surprise: some kind words
-and a few presents soon removed their apprehensions,
-and put them into good humour. We examined the
-house of our old friend, and by his interest two
-others, which were all that the fortification contained,
-and having distributed a few more presents, we parted
-with mutual satisfaction.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At four o’clock in the morning of the 5th of December,
-we weighed, with a light breeze, but it
-being variable with frequent calms, we made little
-way. We kept turning out of the bay till the afternoon,
-and about ten o’clock we were suddenly becalmed,
-so that the ship would neither wear nor stay,
-and the tide or current setting strong, she drove towards
-land so fast, that before any measures could
-be taken for her security, she was within a cable’s
-length of the breakers: we had thirteen fathom water,
-but the ground was so foul that we did not dare to
-drop our anchor; the pinnace therefore was immediately
-hoisted out to take the ship in tow, and the
-men, sensible of their danger, exerting themselves
-to the utmost, and a faint breeze springing up off the
-land, we perceived, with unspeakable joy, that she
-made head-way, after having been so near the shore
-that Tupia, who was not sensible of our hair’s breadth
-escape, was at this very time conversing with the
-people upon the beach, whose voices were distinctly
-heard, notwithstanding the roar of the breakers. We
-now thought all danger was over, but about an hour
-afterwards, just as the man in the chains had cried
-“seventeen fathom,” the ship struck. The shock
-threw us all into the utmost consternation; Mr.
-Banks, who had undressed himself and was stepping
-into bed, ran hastily up to the deck, and the man
-in the chains called out “five fathom;” by this time,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_358'>358</span>the rock on which we had struck being to windward,
-the ship went off without having received the least
-damage, and the water very soon deepened to twenty
-fathom.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This rock lies half a mile W. N. W. of the northernmost
-or outermost island on the south-east side of
-the bay. We had light airs from the land, with
-calms, till nine o’clock the next morning, when we
-got out of the bay, and a breeze springing up at N.
-N. W. we stood out to sea.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This bay, as I have before observed, lies on the
-west side of Cape Bret, and I named it the <span class='sc'>Bay of
-Islands</span>, from the great number of islands which line
-its shores, and from several harbours equally safe
-and commodious, where there is room and depth for
-any number of shipping. That in which we lay is
-on the south-west side of the south westernmost island,
-called <span class='sc'>Maturaro</span>, on the south-east side of the bay.
-I have made no accurate survey of this bay, being
-discouraged by the time it would cost me; I thought
-also that it was sufficient to be able to affirm that it
-afforded us good anchorage, and refreshment of every
-kind. It was not the season for roots, but we had
-plenty of fish, most of which, however, we purchased
-of the natives, for we could catch very little ourselves
-either with net or line. When we showed the natives
-our seine, which is such as the King’s ships are
-generally furnished with, they laughed at it, and in
-triumph produced their own, which, was indeed of
-an enormous size, and made of a kind of grass, which
-is very strong: it was five fathom deep, and by the
-room it took up, it could not be less than three or
-four hundred fathom long. Fishing seems indeed to
-be the chief business of life in this part of the country;
-we saw about all their towns a great number of nets,
-laid in heaps like hay-cocks, and covered with a
-thatch to keep them from the weather, and we
-scarcely entered a house where some of the people
-were not employed in making them. The fish we
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_359'>359</span>procured here were sharks, sting-rays, sea-bream,
-mullet, mackerel, and some others.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The inhabitants in this bay are far more numerous
-than in any other part of the country that we had
-before visited; it did not appear to us that they were
-united under one head, and though their towns were
-fortified, they seemed to live together in perfect
-amity.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>It is high water in this bay at the full and change
-of the moon, about eight o’clock, and the tide then
-rises from six to eight feet perpendicularly. It appears,
-from such observations as I was able to make
-of the tides upon the sea-coast, that the flood comes
-from the southward; and I have reason to think that
-there is a current which comes from the westward,
-and sets along the shore to the S. E. or S. S. E. as the
-land happens to lie.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_360'>360</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. V.<br /> <br />RANGE FROM THE BAY OF ISLANDS ROUND NORTH CAPE TO QUEEN CHARLOTTE’S SOUND; AND A DESCRIPTION OF THAT PART OF THE COAST.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>On</span> Thursday the 7th of December, at noon, Cape
-Bret bore S. S. E. ½ E. distant ten miles, and our latitude,
-by observation, was 34° 59ʹ S.; soon after we
-made several observations of the sun and moon, the
-result of which made our longitude 185° 36ʹ W. The
-wind being against us, we had made but little way.
-In the afternoon, we stood in shore, and fetched
-close under the Cavalles, from which islands the main
-trends W. by N.: several canoes put off and followed
-us, but a light breeze springing up, I did not choose
-to wait for them. I kept standing to the W. N. W.
-and N. W. till the next morning ten o’clock, when I
-tacked and stood in for the shore, from which we were
-about five leagues distant. At noon, the westernmost
-land in sight bore W. by S. and was about four leagues
-distant. In the afternoon, we had a gentle breeze
-to the west, which in the evening came to the south,
-and continuing so all night, by day-light brought us
-pretty well in with the land, seven leagues to the
-westward of the Cavalles, where we found a deep bay
-running in S. W. by W. and W. S. W. the bottom of
-which we could but just see, and there the land appeared
-to be low and level. To this bay, which I
-called <span class='sc'>Doubtless Bay</span>, the entrance is formed by
-two points, which lie W. N. W. and E. S. E. and are
-five miles distant from each other. The wind not
-permitting us to look in here, we steered for the
-westernmost land in sight, which bore from us W. N.
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_361'>361</span>W. about three leagues, but before we got the length
-of it, it fell calm.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>While we lay becalmed, several canoes came off to
-us, but the people having heard of our guns, it was
-not without great difficulty that they were persuaded
-to come under our stern: after having bought some
-of their cloaths, as well as their fish, we began to
-make inquiries concerning their country, and learnt,
-by the help of Tupia, that, at the distance of three
-days’ rowing in their canoes, at a place called <span class='sc'>Moorewennua</span>,
-the land would take a short turn to the
-southward, and from thence extend no more to the
-west. This place we concluded to be the land discovered
-by <a id='tasman'></a>Tasman, which he called <span class='sc'>Cape Maria
-van Diemen</span>, and finding these people so intelligent,
-we inquired farther, if they knew of any country besides
-their own: they answered, that they never had
-visited any other, but that their ancestors had told
-them, that to the N. W. by N. or N. N. W. there was
-a country of great extent, called <span class='sc'>Ulimaroa</span>, to which
-some people had sailed in a very large canoe; that
-only part of them returned, and reported, that after
-a passage of a month they had seen a country where
-the people eat hogs. Tupia then inquired whether
-these adventurers brought any hogs with them when
-they returned; they said, No: Then, replied Tupia,
-your story is certainly false, for it cannot be believed
-that men who came back from an expedition without
-hogs, had ever visited a country where hogs were to
-be procured. It is however remarkable, notwithstanding
-the shrewdness of Tupia’s objection, that
-when they mentioned hogs, it was not by description
-but by name; calling them <i>Booah</i>, the name which
-is given them in the South-sea islands; but if the
-animal had been wholly unknown to them, and they
-had had no communication with people to whom it
-was known, they could not possibly have been acquainted
-with the name.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About ten o’clock at night, a breeze sprung up at
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_362'>362</span>W. N. W. with which we stood off north; and at noon
-the next day, the Cavalles bore S. E. by E. distant
-eight leagues; the entrance of Doubtless Bay S. by
-W., distant three leagues; and the north-west extremity
-of the land in sight, which we judged to be
-the main, bore N. W. by W.: our latitude by observation
-was 34° 44ʹ S. In the evening, we found the
-variation to be 12° 41ʹ E. by the azimuth, and 12°
-40ʹ by the amplitude.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Early in the morning, we stood in with the land,
-seven leagues to the westward of Doubtless Bay, the
-bottom of which is not far distant from the bottom
-of another large bay, which the shore forms at this
-place, being separated only by a low neck of land,
-which juts out into a peninsula that I have called
-<span class='sc'>Knuckle Point</span>. About the middle of this bay,
-which we called <span class='sc'>Sandy Bay</span>, is a high mountain,
-standing upon a distant shore, to which I gave the
-name of <span class='sc'>Mount Camel</span>. The latitude here is 34°
-51ʹ S. and longitude 186° 50ʹ. We had twenty-four
-and twenty-five fathom water, with a good bottom;
-but there seems to be nothing in this bay that can
-induce a ship to put into it; for the land about it is
-utterly barren and desolate, and, except Mount
-Camel, the situation is low: the soil appears to be
-nothing but white sand, thrown up in low irregular
-hills and narrow ridges, lying parallel with the shore.
-But barren and desolate as this place is, it is not
-without inhabitants: we saw one village on the west
-side of Mount Camel, and another on the east side;
-we saw also five canoes full of people, who pulled
-after the ship, but could not come up with us. At
-nine o’clock, we tacked and stood to the northward;
-and at noon, the Cavalles bore S. E. by E., distant
-thirteen leagues; the north extremity of the land in
-sight, making like an island, bore N. W. ¼ N. distant
-nine leagues; and Mount Camel bore S. W. by S.,
-distance six leagues.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The wind being contrary, we kept plying northward
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_363'>363</span>till five o’clock in the evening of the 12th,
-when, having made very little way, we tacked and
-stood to the N. E. being two leagues to the northward
-of Mount Camel, and about a mile and a half
-from the shore, in which situation we had two-and-twenty
-fathom water.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At ten it began to blow and rain, which brought
-us under double reefed topsails; at twelve we tacked
-and stood to the westward till seven the next morning,
-when we tacked and stood again to the N. E.,
-being about a mile to windward of the place where
-we tacked last night. Soon after it blew very hard
-at N. N. W. with heavy squalls and much rain, which
-brought us under our courses, and split the maintopsail;
-so that we were obliged to unbend it and bend
-another: at ten, it became more moderate, and we
-set the topsails, double reefed: at noon, having
-strong gales and heavy weather, we tacked and stood
-to the westward, and had no land in sight for the
-first time since we had been upon this coast.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We had now strong gales at W. and W. S. W.;
-and at half an hour past three we tacked and stood
-to the northward. Soon after, a small island lying
-off Knuckle Point bore S. ½ W., distant half a league.
-In the evening, having split the fore and mizen
-topsails, we brought the ship under her courses; and
-at midnight, we wore, and stood to the southward
-till five in the morning; when we tacked and stood
-to the N. W., and saw land bearing south, at the distance
-of eight or nine leagues; by this we discovered
-that we had fallen much to the leeward since yesterday
-morning. At noon our latitude by observation
-was 34° 6ʹ S.; and the same land which we had seen
-before to the N. W. now bore S. W., and appeared to
-be the northern extremity of the country. We had a
-large swell rolling in from the westward, and, therefore,
-concluded that we were not covered by any
-land in that quarter. At eight in the evening, we
-tacked and stood to the westward, with as much sail
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_364'>364</span>as we could bear; and at noon the next day, we
-were in latitude 34° 10ʹ, longitude 185° 45ʹ W., and
-by estimation about seventeen leagues from the land,
-notwithstanding our utmost endeavours to keep in
-with it.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 16th, at six in the morning, we saw land
-from the mast-head, bearing S. S. W.; and at noon it
-bore S. by W. distant fourteen leagues: while we were
-standing in for the shore, we sounded several times,
-but had no ground with ninety fathom. At eight,
-we tacked in a hundred and eight fathom, at about
-three or four miles from the shore, which was the
-same point of land that we had to the N. W. before
-we were blown off. At noon, it bore S. W., distant
-about three miles; Mount Camel bore S. by E., distant
-about eleven leagues, and the westernmost land
-in sight bore S. 75 W.; the latitude by observation
-was 34° 20ʹ S. At four o’clock, we tacked and stood
-in shore, in doing which, we met with a strong rippling,
-and the ship fell fast to leeward, which we
-imputed to a current setting east. At eight, we
-tacked and stood off till eight the next morning;
-when we tacked and stood in, being about ten leagues
-from the land: at noon, the point of land which we
-were near the day before, bore S. S. W. distant five
-leagues. The wind still continued at west; and at
-seven o’clock, we tacked in thirty-five fathom, when
-the point of land which has been mentioned before,
-bore N. W. by N., distant four or five miles; so
-that we had not gained one inch to windward the
-last twenty-four hours, which confirmed our opinion
-that there was a current to the eastward. The point
-of land I called <span class='sc'>North Cape</span>, it being the northern
-extremity of this country. It lies in latitude 34° 22ʹ S.,
-longitude 186° 55ʹ W., and thirty-one leagues distant
-from Cape Bret, in the direction of N. 63 W. It
-forms the north point of Sandy Bay, and is a peninsula
-jutting out N. E. about two miles, and terminating
-in a bluff head that is flat at the top. The isthmus
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_365'>365</span>which joins this head to the main land is very low,
-and for that reason the land of the cape, from several
-situations, has the appearance of an island. It is still
-more remarkable when it is seen from the southward,
-by the appearance of a high round island at the S. E.
-point of the cape; but this also is a deception; for
-what appears to be an island is a round hill, joined
-to the cape by a low narrow neck of land. Upon
-the cape we saw a Hippah or village, and a few
-inhabitants; and on the south-east side of it, there
-appears to be anchorage, and good shelter from the
-south-west and north-west winds.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We continued to stand off and on, making N. W.
-till noon on the 21st, when North Cape bore S. 39 E.
-distant thirty-eight leagues. Our situation varied
-only a few leagues till the 23d, when, about seven
-o’clock in the evening, we saw land from the mast-head,
-bearing S. ½ E. At eleven the next morning,
-we saw it again, bearing S. S. E. at the distance of eight
-leagues: we now stood to the S. W.; and at four
-o’clock, the land bore S. E. by S. distant four leagues,
-and proved to be a small island, with other islands or
-rocks, still smaller, lying off the south-west end of it,
-and another lying off the north-east end, which were
-discovered by Tasman, and called the Three Kings.
-The principal island lies in latitude 34° 12ʹ S., longitude
-187° 48ʹ W., and distant fourteen or fifteen
-leagues from North Cape, in the direction of W. 14 N.
-At midnight, we tacked and stood to the N. E. till
-six the next morning, which was Christmas-day,
-when we tacked and stood to the southward. At
-noon, the Three Kings bore E. 8 N. distant five or
-six leagues. The variation this morning by the
-azimuth was 11° 25ʹ E.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 26th, we stood to the southward close
-upon a wind; and at noon, were in latitude 35° 10ʹ S.,
-longitude 188° 20ʹ W., the Three Kings bearing
-N. 26 W. distant twenty-two leagues. In this situation
-we had no land in sight; and yet, by <a id='obs'></a>observation,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_366'>366</span>we were in the latitude of the Bay of Islands; and
-by my reckoning but twenty leagues to the westward
-of North Cape: from whence it appears, that the
-northern part of this island is very narrow; for
-otherwise we must have seen some part of the west
-side of it. We stood to the southward till twelve at
-night, and then tacked and stood to the northward.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At four o’clock in the morning, the wind freshened,
-and at nine, blew a storm; so that we were obliged
-to bring the ship to under her mainsail. Our course
-made good between noon this day and yesterday was
-S. S. W. ½ W., distance eleven miles. The Three
-Kings bore N. 27 E. distant seventy-seven miles.
-The gale continued all this day, and till two the
-next morning, when it fell, and began to veer to the
-southward and S. W., where it fixed about four,
-when we made sail and steered east in for the land,
-under the fore-sail and main-sail; but the wind then
-rising, and by eight o’clock being increased to a hurricane,
-with a prodigious sea, we were obliged to take
-in the main-sail; we then wore the ship, and brought
-her to with her head to the north-west. At noon
-the gale was somewhat abated, but we had still heavy
-squalls. Our course made good this day, was north,
-a little easterly, twenty-nine miles; latitude by account
-34° 50ʹ S., longitude 188° 27ʹ W.; the Three
-Kings bore N. 41 E. distant fifty-two miles. At
-seven o’clock in the evening, the wind being at S. W.
-and S. W. by W., with hard squalls, we wore and lay on
-the other tack; and at six the next morning spread
-more sail. Our course and distance since yesterday
-was E. by N. twenty-nine miles. In the afternoon, we
-had hard squalls at S. W.; and at eight in the evening,
-wore and stood to the N. W. till five the next morning;
-and then wore and stood to the S. E. At six, we
-saw the land bearing N. E., distant about six leagues,
-which we judged to be Cape <i>Maria Van Diemen</i>,
-and which corresponded with the account that had
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_367'>367</span>been given of it by the Indians. At midnight we
-wore and stood to the S. E. And on the next day
-at noon, Cape Maria Van Diemen bore N. E. by N.,
-distant about five leagues. At seven in the evening,
-we tacked and stood to the westward, with a moderate
-breeze at S. W. by S. and S. W. Mount
-Camel then bore N. 83 E., and the northernmost
-land, or Cape Maria Van Diemen, N. by W.; we
-were now distant from the nearest land about three
-leagues, where we had something more than forty
-fathom water; and it must be remarked, that Mount
-Camel, which when seen on the other side did not
-seem to be more than one mile from the sea, seemed
-to be but little more when seen from this side; which
-is a demonstration that the land here cannot be more
-than two or three miles broad, or from sea to sea.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At six o’clock in the morning of January the 1st,
-1770, being New-year’s day, we tacked and stood to the
-eastward, the Three Kings bearing N. W. by N. At
-noon, we tacked again, and stood to the westward,
-being in latitude 34° 37ʹ S.; the Three Kings bearing
-N. W. by N. at the distance of ten or eleven leagues;
-and Cape Maria Van Diemen N. 31 E. distant about
-four leagues and a half: in this situation we had fifty-four
-fathom water.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>During this part of our navigation two particulars
-are very remarkable; in latitude 35° S., and in the
-midst of summer, I met with a gale of wind, which
-for its strength and continuance was such as I had
-scarcely ever been in before, and we were three
-weeks in getting ten leagues to the westward, and
-five week in getting fifty leagues, for at this time it
-was so long since we passed Cape Bret. During the
-gale, we were happily at a considerable distance from
-the land, otherwise it is highly probable that we
-should never have returned to relate our adventures.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At five o’clock in the evening, having a fresh
-breeze to the westward, we tacked and stood to the
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_368'>368</span>southward: at this time North Cape bore E. ¾ N.,
-and just open of a point that lies three leagues
-W. by N. from it.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This cape, as I have observed before, is the
-northernmost extremity of this country, and the
-easternmost point of a peninsula, which runs out
-N. W. and N. W. by N. seventeen or eighteen leagues,
-and of which Cape Maria Van Diemen is the westernmost
-point. Cape Maria lies in latitude 34° 30ʹ S.,
-longitude 187° 18ʹ W.; and from this point the land
-trends away S. E. by S. and S. E. beyond Mount
-Camel, and is every where a barren shore, consisting
-of banks of white sand.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 2d, at noon, we were in latitude 35° 17ʹ S.,
-and Cape Maria bore north, distant about sixteen
-leagues, as near as we could guess; for we had no
-land in sight, and did not dare to go nearer, as a fresh
-gale blew right on shore, with a rolling sea. The
-wind continued at W. S. W. and S. W. with frequent
-squalls; in the evening we shortened sail, and at
-midnight tacked, and made a trip to the N. W. till
-two in the morning, when we wore and stood to the
-southward. At break of day, we made sail, and
-edged away, in order to make land; and at ten o’clock,
-we saw it, bearing N. W. It appeared to be high, and
-at noon extended from N. to E. N. E. distant by estimation
-eight or ten leagues. Cape Maria then bore
-N. 2° 30ʹ W. distant thirty-three leagues; our latitude
-by observation was 36° 2ʹ S. About seven o’clock
-in the evening, we were within six leagues of it;
-but having a fresh gale upon it, with a rolling sea,
-we hauled our wind to the S. E., and kept on that
-course close upon the wind all night, sounding several
-times, but having no ground with one hundred, and
-one hundred and ten fathom.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At eight o’clock the next morning, we were about
-five leagues from the land, and off a place which lies
-in latitude 36° 25ʹ, and had the appearance of a bay
-or inlet. It bore east; and in order to see more of
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_369'>369</span>it, we kept on our course till eleven o’clock, when
-we were not more than three leagues from it, and
-then discovered that it was neither inlet nor bay, but a
-tract of low land, bounded by higher lands on each
-side, which produced the deception. At this time, we
-tacked and stood to the N. W.; and at noon, the land
-was not distant more than three or four leagues. We
-were now in latitude 36° 31ʹ S., longitude 185° 50ʹ W.
-Cape Maria bore N. 25 W. distant forty-four leagues
-and a half; so that the coast must be almost straight in
-the direction of S. S. E. ¾ E. and N. N. W. ¾ W. nearly.
-In about latitude 35° 45ʹ is some high land adjoining
-to the sea; to the southward of which the shore is
-also high, and has the most desolate and inhospitable
-appearance that can be imagined. Nothing is to be
-seen but hills of sand, on which there is scarcely a
-blade of verdure; and a vast sea, impelled by the
-westerly winds breaking upon it in a dreadful surf,
-renders it not only forlorn, but frightful; complicating
-the idea of danger with desolation, and impressing
-the mind at once with a sense of misery and
-death. From this place I steered to the northward,
-resolving never more to come within the same distance
-of the coast, except the wind should be very
-favourable indeed. I stood under a fresh sail all the
-day, hoping to get an offing by the next noon, and
-we made good a course of a hundred and two miles
-N. 38 W. Our latitude by observation was 35° 10ʹ S.;
-and Cape Maria bore N. 10 E., distance forty-one
-miles. In the night, the wind shifted from S. W. by
-S. to S., and blew fresh. Our course to the noon of
-the 5th, was N. 75 W., distance eight miles.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At day-break on the 6th, we saw the land, which
-we took to be Cape Maria, bearing N. N. E., distant
-eight or nine leagues: and on the 7th, in the afternoon,
-the land bore east: and some time after, we
-discovered a turtle upon the water; but being awake,
-it dived instantly, so that we could not take it. At
-noon, the high land, which has just been mentioned,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_370'>370</span>extended from N. to E. at the distance of five or six
-leagues; and in two places, a flat gave it the appearance
-of a bay or inlet. The course that we made
-good the last four-and-twenty hours was S. 33 E.
-fifty-three miles; Cape Maria bearing N. 25 W., distant
-thirty leagues.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We sailed within sight of land all this day, with
-gentle gales between the N. E. and N. W.; and by the
-next noon had sailed sixty-nine miles, in the direction
-of S. 37 E.; our latitude by observation was 36° 39ʹ S.
-The land which on the 4th we had taken for a bay,
-now bore N. E. by N., distant five leagues and a half;
-and Cape Maria N. 29 W., forty-seven leagues.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 9th, we continued a south-east course till
-eight o’clock in the evening, having run seven leagues
-since noon, with the wind at N. N. E. and N., and
-being within three or four leagues of the land, which
-appeared to be low and sandy. I then steered S. E.
-by S. in a direction parallel with the coast, having
-from forty-eight to thirty-four fathom water, with a
-black sandy bottom. At day-break the next morning,
-we found ourselves between two and three leagues
-from the land, which began to have a better appearance,
-rising in gentle slopes, and being covered with
-trees and herbage. We saw a smoke and a few
-houses, but it appeared to be but thinly inhabited.
-At seven o’clock, we steered S. by E., and afterwards
-S. by W., the land lying in that direction. At nine, we
-were a-breast of a point which rises with an easy ascent
-from the sea to a considerable height: this point,
-which lies in latitude 37° 43ʹ, I named <span class='sc'>Woody Head</span>.
-About eleven miles from this Head, in the direction
-of S. W. ½ W. lies a very small island, upon which we
-saw a great number of gannets, and which we, therefore,
-called <span class='sc'>Gannet Island</span>. At noon, a high craggy
-point bore E. N. E. distant about a league and a half,
-to which I gave the name of <span class='sc'>Albatross Point</span>: it lies
-in latitude 38° 4ʹ S., longitude 184° 42ʹ W.; and is
-distant seven leagues in the direction of S. 17 W.
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_371'>371</span>from Woody Head. On the north-side of this point
-the shore forms a bay, in which there appears to be
-anchorage and shelter for shipping. Our course and
-distance for the last twenty-four hours was S. 37 E.
-sixty-nine miles; and at noon this day Cape Maria
-bore N. 30 W. distant eighty-two leagues. Between
-twelve and one, the wind shifted at once from
-N. N. E. to S. S. W. with which we stood to the
-westward till four o’clock in the afternoon; and then
-tacked, and stood again in shore till seven; when we
-tacked again and stood to the westward, having but
-little wind. At this time Albatross Point bore N. E.,
-distant near two leagues, and the southernmost land
-in sight bore S. S. W. ½ W. being a very high mountain,
-and in appearance greatly resembling the Peak
-of Teneriffe. In this situation we had thirty fathom
-water, and having but little wind all night, we tacked
-about four in the morning, and stood in for the
-shore. Soon after, it fell calm; and being in forty-two
-fathom water, the people caught a few sea-bream.
-At eleven, a light breeze sprung up from
-the west, and we made sail to the southward. We
-continued to steer S. by W. and S. S. W. along
-the shore, at the distance of about four leagues, with
-gentle breezes from between N. W. and N. N. E.
-At seven in the evening, we saw the top of the peak
-to the southward, above the clouds, which concealed
-it below. And at this time, the southernmost land
-in sight bore S. by W.; the variation, by several
-azimuths which were taken both in the morning and
-the evening, appeared to be 14° 15ʹ easterly.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At noon on the 12th, we were distant about three
-leagues from the shore which lies under the peak,
-but the peak itself was wholly concealed by clouds:
-we judged it to bear about S. S. E.; and some very
-remarkable peaked islands, which lay under the shore,
-bore E. S. E., distant three or four leagues. At seven
-in the evening we sounded, and had forty-two fathom,
-being distant from the shore between two and three
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_372'>372</span>leagues: we judged the peak to bear east; and after
-it was dark, we saw fires upon the shore.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At five o’clock in the morning we saw, for a few
-minutes, the summit of the peak, towering above
-the clouds, and covered with snow. It now bore
-N. E.; it lies in latitude 39° 16ʹ S., longitude 185°
-15ʹ W.; and I named it <span class='sc'>Mount Egmont</span>, in honour
-of the earl. It seems to have a large base, and to
-rise with a gradual ascent; it lies near the sea, and
-is surrounded by a flat country, of a pleasant appearance,
-being clothed with verdure and wood,
-which renders it the more conspicuous, and the shore
-under it forms a large cape, which I have named
-<span class='sc'>Cape Egmont</span>. It lies S. S. W. ½ W. twenty-seven
-leagues distant from Albatross Point, and on the
-north-side of it are two small islands, which lie near
-a remarkable point on the main, that rises to a considerable
-height in the form of a sugar-loaf. To the
-southward of the cape, the land trends away S. E.
-by E. and S. S. E., and seems to be every where a
-bold shore. At noon, Cape Egmont bore about N. E.;
-and in this direction, at about four leagues from the
-shore, we had forty fathom of water. The wind
-during the rest of the day was from W. to N. W. by
-W., and we continued to steer along the shore S. S. E.
-and S. E. by E., keeping at the distance of between
-two or three leagues. At half an hour after seven,
-we had another transient view of Mount Edgcombe,
-which bore N. 17 W., distant about ten leagues.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At five the next morning, we steered S. E. by S.,
-the coast inclining more southerly; and in about half
-an hour we saw land, bearing S. W. by S., for which
-we hauled up. At noon, the north-west extremity of
-the land in sight bore S. 63 W., and some high land,
-which had the appearance of an island lying under
-the main, bore S. S. E., distant five leagues. We
-were now in a bay, the bottom of which bearing
-south, we could not see, though it was clear in that
-quarter. Our latitude by observation was 40° 27ʹ S.,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_373'>373</span>longitude 184° 39ʹ W. At eight in the evening, we
-were within two leagues of the land which we had
-discovered in the morning, having run ten leagues since
-noon: the land which then bore S. 63 W., now bore
-N. 59 W., at the distance of seven or eight leagues,
-and had the appearance of an island. Between this
-land and <span class='sc'>Cape Egmont</span> lies the bay, the west-side
-of which was our situation at this time, and the land
-here is of a considerable height, and diversified by
-hill and valley.</p>
-
-<div class='chapter'>
- <span class='pageno' id='Page_374'>374</span>
- <h2 class='c004'>CHAP. VI.<br /> <br />TRANSACTIONS IN QUEEN CHARLOTTE’S SOUND: PASSAGE THROUGH THE STRAIGHT WHICH DIVIDES THE TWO ISLANDS, AND BACK TO CAPE TURNAGAIN: HORRID CUSTOM OF THE INHABITANTS: REMARKABLE MELODY OF BIRDS: A VISIT TO A HEPPAH, AND MANY OTHER PARTICULARS.</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class='drop-capa0_2_0 c014'><span class='sc'>The</span> shore at this place seemed to form several bays,
-into one of which I proposed to carry the ship, which
-was become very foul, in order to careen her, and at
-the same time repair some defects, and recruit our
-wood and water.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>With this view, I kept plying on and off all night,
-having from eighty to sixty-three fathom. At day-break
-the next morning, I stood for an inlet which runs
-in S. W.; and at eight I got within the entrance which
-may be known by a reef of rocks, stretching from
-the north-west point, and some rocky islands which
-lie off the south-east point. At nine o’clock, there
-being little wind, and what there was being variable,
-we were carried by the tide or current within two
-cables’ length of the north-west shore, where we had
-fifty-four fathom water, but by the help of our boats
-we got clear. Just at this time we saw a sea-lion rise
-twice near the shore, the head of which exactly resembled
-that of the male which has been described in
-the Account of Lord Anson’s Voyage. We also saw
-some of the natives in a canoe cross the bay, and a
-village situated upon the point of an island which
-lies seven or eight miles within the entrance. At
-noon, we were the length of this island, but there
-being little wind, the boats were ordered a-head to
-tow. About one o’clock, we hauled close round
-the south-west end of the island; and the inhabitants
-of the village which was built upon it, were
-immediately up in arms. About two, we anchored
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_375'>375</span>in a very safe and convenient cove, on the north-west-side
-of the bay, and facing the south-west end of
-the island, in eleven fathom water, with soft ground,
-and moored with the stream anchor.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We were about four long cannon shot distant from
-the village or Heppah, from which four canoes were
-immediately dispatched, as we imagined, to reconnoitre,
-and, if they should find themselves able, to
-take us. The men were all well armed, and dressed
-nearly as they are represented in the figure published
-by Tasman; two corners of the cloth which they
-wrapped round the body were passed over the shoulders
-from behind, and being brought down to the
-upper edge of it before, were made fast to it just
-under the breast; but few, or none, had feathers in
-their hair.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>They rowed round the ship several times, with
-their usual tokens of menace and defiance, and at
-last began the assault by throwing some stones: Tupia
-expostulated with them, but apparently to very little
-purpose; and we began to fear that they would
-oblige us to fire at them, when a very old man in one
-of the boats expressed a desire of coming on board.
-We gladly encouraged him in his design, a rope was
-thrown into his canoe, and she was immediately along
-side of the ship: the old man rose up, and prepared
-to come up the ship’s side, upon which all the rest
-expostulated with great vehemence against the attempt,
-and at last laid hold of him, and held him
-back: he adhered however to his purpose with a calm
-but steady perseverance, and having at length disengaged
-himself, he came on board. We received him
-with all possible expressions of friendship and kindness,
-and after some time dismissed him, with many
-presents, to his companions. As soon as he was returned
-on board his canoe, the people in all the rest
-began to dance, but whether as a token of enmity or
-friendship we could not certainly determine, for we
-had seen them dance in a disposition both for peace
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_376'>376</span>and war. In a short time, however, they retired to
-their fort, and soon after I went on shore, with most
-of the gentlemen, at the bottom of the cove, a-breast
-of the ship.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>We found a fine stream of excellent water, and
-wood in the greatest plenty, for the land here was
-one forest, of vast extent. As we brought the seine
-with us, we hauled it once or twice, and with such
-success that we caught near three hundred weight
-of fish of different sorts, which was equally distributed
-among the ship’s company.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At day-break, while we were busy in careening
-the ship, three canoes came off to us, having on
-board above a hundred men, besides several of their
-women, which we were pleased to see, as in general
-it is a sign of peace; but they soon afterwards became
-very troublesome, and gave us reason to apprehend
-some mischief from them to the people that
-were in our boats alongside the ship. While we
-were in this situation, the long-boat was sent ashore
-with some water casks, and some of the canoes attempting
-to follow her, we found it necessary to intimidate
-them by firing some small-shot: we were at
-such a distance that it was impossible to hurt them,
-yet our reproof had its effect, and they desisted from
-the pursuit. They had some fish in their canoes
-which they now offered to sell, and which, though it
-stunk, we consented to buy: for this purpose a man
-in a small boat was sent among them, and they traded
-for some time very fairly. At length, however, one
-of them watching his opportunity, snatched at some
-paper which our market-man held in his hand, and
-missing it, immediately put himself in a posture
-of defence, flourished his patoo-patoo, and making
-show as if he was about to strike; some small shot
-were then fired at him from the ship, a few of which
-struck him upon the knee: this put an end to our
-trade, but the Indians still continued near the ship,
-rowing round her many times, and conversing with
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_377'>377</span>Tupia, chiefly concerning the traditions they had
-among them with respect to the antiquities of their
-country. To this subject they were led by the inquiries
-which Tupia had been directed to make,
-whether they had ever seen such a vessel as ours, or
-had ever heard that any such had been upon their
-coast. These inquiries were all answered in the
-negative, so that tradition has preserved among them
-no memorial of Tasman; though, by an observation
-made this day, we find that we are only fifteen miles
-south of Murderer’s Bay, our latitude being 41°
-5ʹ 32ʺ, and Murderer’s Bay, according to his account,
-being 40° 50ʹ.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The women in these canoes, and some of the men,
-had a head-dress which we had not before seen. It
-consisted of a bunch of black feathers, made up in a
-round form, and tied upon the top of the head,
-which it entirely covered, and made it twice as high,
-to appearance, as it was in reality.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After dinner I went in the pinnace with Mr.
-Banks, Dr. Solander, Tupia, and some others, into
-another cove, about two miles distant from that in
-which the ship lay: in our way we saw something
-floating upon the water, which we took for a dead
-seal, but upon rowing up to it, found it to be the
-body of a woman, which, to all appearance, had been
-dead some days. We proceeded to our cove, where
-we went on shore, and found a small family of
-Indians, who appeared to be greatly terrified at our
-approach, and all ran away except one. A conversation
-between this person and Tupia soon brought
-back the rest, except an old man and a child, who
-still kept aloof, but stood peeping at us from the
-woods. Of these people, our curiosity naturally led
-us to enquire after the body of the woman, which we
-had seen floating upon the water: and they acquainted
-us, by Tupia, that she was a relation, who
-had died a natural death; and that, according to
-their custom, they had tied a stone to the body,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_378'>378</span>and thrown it into the sea, which stone, they supposed,
-had, by some accident, been disengaged.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This family, when we came on shore, was employed
-in dressing some provisions: the body of a
-dog was at this time buried in their oven, and many
-provision-baskets stood near it. Having cast our
-eyes carelessly into one of these, as we passed it, we
-saw two bones pretty cleanly picked, which did not
-seem to be the bones of a dog, and which, upon a
-nearer examination, we discovered to be those of a
-human body. At this sight we were struck with
-horror, though it was only a confirmation of what we
-had heard many times since we arrived upon this
-coast. As we could have no doubt but the bones
-were human, neither could we have any doubt but
-that the flesh which covered them had been eaten.
-They were found in a provision basket; the flesh
-that remained appeared manifestly to have been
-dressed by fire, and in the gristles at the end, were
-the marks of the teeth which had gnawed them: to
-put an end, however, to conjecture, founded upon
-circumstances and appearances, we directed Tupia
-to ask what bones they were; and the Indians, without
-the least hesitation, answered, the bones of a
-man: they were then asked what was become of the
-flesh, and they replied that they had eaten it; but, said
-Tupia, why did you not eat the body of the woman
-which we saw floating upon the water: the woman,
-said they, died of disease; besides, she was our relation,
-and we eat only the bodies of our enemies, who
-are killed in battle. Upon enquiry who the man was
-whose bones we had found, they told us, that about
-five days before, a boat belonging to their enemies
-came into the bay, with many persons on board, and
-that this man was of the seven whom they had
-killed. Though stronger evidence of this horrid
-practice prevailing among the inhabitants of this
-coast will scarcely be required, we have still stronger
-to give. One of us asked if they had any human
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_379'>379</span>bones with the flesh remaining upon them, and upon
-their answering us that all had been eaten, we affected
-to disbelieve that the bones were human, and said that
-they were the bones of a dog; upon which one of the
-Indians, with some eagerness, took hold of his own
-fore-arm, and thrusting it towards us, said, that the
-bone which Mr. Banks held in his hand had belonged
-to that part of the human body; at the same time, to
-convince us that the flesh had been eaten, he took
-hold of his own arm with his teeth, and made show
-of eating: he also bit and gnawed the bone which
-Mr. Banks had taken, drawing it through his mouth,
-and showing, by signs, that it had afforded a delicious
-repast; the bone was then returned to Mr.
-Banks, and he brought it away with him. Among
-the persons of this family, there was a woman who
-had her arms, legs, and thighs, frightfully cut in
-several places; and we were told that she had inflicted
-the wounds upon herself, in token of her grief for
-the loss of her husband, who had been lately killed
-and eaten by their enemies, who had come from
-some place to the eastward, towards which the
-Indians pointed.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The ship lay at the distance of somewhat less
-than a quarter of a mile from the shore, and in the
-morning we were awakened by the singing of the
-birds: the number was incredible, and they seemed
-to strain their throats in emulation of each other.
-This wild melody was infinitely superior to any that
-we had ever heard of the same kind; it seemed to
-be like small bells, most exquisitely tuned, and perhaps
-the distance, and the water between, might be
-no small advantage to the sound. Upon inquiry, we
-were informed that the birds here always began to
-sing about two hours after midnight, and continuing
-their music till sunrise, were, like our nightingales,
-silent the rest of the day. In the forenoon, a small
-canoe came off from the Indian village to the ship,
-and among those that were in it, was the old man
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_380'>380</span>who had first come on board at our arrival in the
-bay. As soon as it came alongside, Tupia renewed
-the conversation that had passed the day before,
-concerning their practice of eating human flesh,
-during which they repeated what they had told us
-already; but, said Tupia, where are the heads? do
-you eat them too? Of the heads, said the old man,
-we eat only the brains, and the next time I come I will
-bring some of them to convince you that what we
-have told you is truth. After some farther conversation
-between these people and Tupia, they told him
-that they expected their enemies to come very
-shortly, to revenge the death of the seven men whom
-they had killed and eaten.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 18th, the Indians were more quiet than
-usual, no canoe came near the ship, nor did we see
-one of them moving on the shore, their fishing, and
-other usual occupations being totally suspended. We
-thought they expected an attack on this day, and,
-therefore, attended more diligently to what passed on
-shore; but we saw nothing to gratify our curiosity.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>After breakfast, we went out in the pinnace, to
-take a view of the bay, which was of vast extent,
-and consisted of numberless small harbours and coves,
-in every direction: we confined our excursion, however,
-to the western side, and the country being an
-impenetrable forest where we landed, we could see
-nothing worthy of notice: we killed, however, a
-good number of shags, which we saw sitting upon
-their nests in the trees, and which, whether roasted
-or stewed, we considered as very good provision. As
-we were returning, we saw a single man in a canoe
-fishing; we rowed up to him, and, to our great surprise,
-he took not the least notice of us, but even
-when we were alongside of him, continued to <a id='follow'></a>follow
-his occupation, without adverting to us any more
-than if we had been invisible. He did not, however,
-appear to be either sullen or stupid: we requested
-him to draw up his net, that we might examine it,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_381'>381</span>and he readily complied: it was of a circular form,
-extended by two hoops, and about seven or eight feet
-in diameter: the top was open, and sea-ears were fastened
-to the bottom as a bait: this he let down so as
-to lie upon the ground, and when he thought fish
-enough were assembled over it, he drew it up by a
-very gentle and even motion, so that the fish rose
-with it, scarcely sensible that they were lifted, till
-they came very near the surface of the water, and
-then were brought out in the net by a sudden jerk.
-By this simple method, he had caught abundance of
-fish, and, indeed, they are so plenty in this bay,
-that the catching them requires neither much labour
-nor art.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>This day, some of our people found in the skirts
-of the wood, near a hole or oven, three human hipbones,
-which they brought on board; a farther proof
-that these people eat human flesh: Mr. Monkhouse,
-our surgeon, also brought on board, from a place
-where he saw many deserted houses, the hair of a
-man’s head, which he had found, among many other
-things, tied up to the branches of trees.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the morning of the 19th, we set up the armourer’s
-forge to repair the braces of the tiller, and
-other iron-work, all hands on board being still busy
-in careening, and other necessary operations about
-the vessel: this day, some Indians came on board
-from another part of the bay, where they said there
-was a town which we had not seen: they brought
-plenty of fish, which they sold for nails, having now
-acquired some notion of their use; and in this traffic
-no unfair practice was attempted.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the morning of the 20th, our old man kept his
-promise, and brought on board four of the heads of
-the seven people who had been so much the subject
-of our inquiries: the hair and flesh were entire, but
-we perceived that the brains had been extracted; the
-flesh was soft, but had by some method been preserved
-from putrefaction, for it had no disagreeable
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_382'>382</span>smell. Mr. Banks purchased one of them, but they
-sold it with great reluctance, and could not by any
-means be prevailed upon to part with a second; probably
-they may be preserved as trophies, like the
-scalps in America, and the jaw-bones in the islands
-of the South Seas. Upon examining the head which
-had been bought by Mr. Banks, we perceived that it
-had received a blow upon the temples, which had
-fractured the skull. This day we made another excursion
-in the pinnace, to survey the bay, but we
-found no flat large enough for a potatoe garden, nor
-could we discover the least appearance of cultivation:
-we met not a single Indian, but found an excellent
-harbour; and about eight o’clock in the evening returned
-on board the ship.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 21st, Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander went a
-fishing with hook and line, and caught an immense
-quantity every where upon the rocks, in between
-four and five fathom water: the seine was hauled
-every night, and seldom failed to supply the whole
-ship’s company with as much fish as they could eat.
-This day all the people had leave to go on shore at
-the watering-place, and divert themselves as they
-should think proper.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the morning of the 22d, I set out again in the
-pinnace, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander,
-with a design to examine the head of the inlet, but,
-after rowing about four or five leagues without so
-much as coming in sight of it, the wind being contrary,
-and the day half spent, we went on shore on
-the south-east side, to try what might be discovered
-from the hills.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander immediately employed
-themselves in botanizing near the beach, and I, taking
-a seaman with me, ascended one of the hills: when
-I reached the summit, I found a view of the inlet
-intercepted by hills, which in that direction rose still
-higher, and which were rendered inaccessible by impenetrable
-woods; I was, however, abundantly compensated
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_383'>383</span>for my labour, for I saw the sea on the
-eastern side of the country, and a passage leading
-from it to that on the west, a little to the eastward
-of the entrance of the inlet where the ship now lay.
-The main land, which lay on the south-east of this
-inlet, appeared to be a narrow ridge of very high
-hills, and to form part of the south-west side of the
-straight; the land on the opposite side appeared to
-trend away east as far as the eye could reach; and to
-the south-east there appeared to be an opening to the
-sea, which washed the eastern coast: on the east
-side of the inlet also I saw some islands which I had
-before taken to be part of the main land. Having
-made this discovery, I descended the hill, and as
-soon as we had taken some refreshment, we set out
-on our return to the ship. In our way, we examined
-the harbours and coves which lie behind the islands
-that I had discovered from the hill; and in this route
-we saw an old village, in which there were many
-houses that seemed to have been long deserted: we
-also saw another village which was inhabited, but the
-day was too far spent for us to visit it, and we therefore
-made the best of our way to the ship, which we
-reached between eight and nine o’clock at night.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The 23d I employed in carrying on a survey of the
-place; and upon one of the islands where I landed,
-I saw many houses which seemed to have been long
-deserted, and no appearance of any inhabitant.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 24th, we went to visit our friends at the
-Hippah or village on the point of the island near the
-ship’s station, who had come off to us on our first
-arrival in the bay. They received us with the utmost
-confidence and civility, showing us every part
-of their habitations, which were commodious and
-neat. The island or rock on which this town is
-situated, is divided from the main by a breach or
-fissure so narrow, that a man might almost leap from
-one to the other: the sides of it are every where so
-steep as to render the artificial fortification of these
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_384'>384</span>people almost unnecessary: there was, however, one
-slight pallisade, and one small fighting-stage, towards
-that part of the rock where access was least difficult.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The people here brought us out several human
-bones, the flesh of which they had eaten, and offered
-them to sale; for the curiosity of those among us
-who had purchased them as memorials of the horrid
-practice which many, notwithstanding the reports of
-travellers, have professed not to believe, had rendered
-them a kind of article of trade. In one part of this
-village, we observed, not without some surprise, a
-cross exactly like that of a crucifix; it was adorned
-with feathers, and upon our inquiring for what purpose
-it had been set up, we were told that it was a
-monument for a man who was dead: we had before
-understood that their dead were not buried, but
-thrown into the sea; but to our inquiry how the body
-of the man had been disposed of, to whose memory
-this cross had been erected, they refused to answer.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>When we left these people, we went to the other
-end of the island, and there taking water, crossed
-over to the main, where we saw several houses, but
-no inhabitants, except a few in some straggling
-canoes, that seemed to be fishing. After viewing
-this place, we returned on board the ship to dinner.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>During our visit to the Indians this day, Tupia
-being always of our party, they had been observed
-to be continually talking of guns, and shooting
-people: for this subject of their conversation we
-could not at all account; and it had so much engaged
-our attention, that we talked of it all the way
-back, and even after we got on board the ship: we
-had perplexed ourselves with various conjectures,
-which were all given up in their turn; but now we
-learnt, that on the 21st one of our officers, upon
-pretence of going out to fish, had rowed up to the
-Hippah, and that two or three canoes coming off
-towards his boat, his fears suggested that an attack
-was intended, in consequence of which three muskets
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_385'>385</span>were fired, one with small shot and two with ball, at
-the Indians, who retired with the utmost precipitation,
-having probably come out with friendly intentions;
-for such their behaviour both before and afterwards
-expressed; and having no reason to expect
-such treatment from people who had always behaved
-to them not only with humanity but kindness, and
-to whom they were not conscious of having given
-offence.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 25th, I made another excursion along
-the coast, in the pinnace, towards the mouth of the
-inlet, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander,
-and going on shore at a little cove, to shoot shags,
-we fell in with a large family of Indians, whose custom
-it is to disperse themselves among the different
-creeks and coves, where fish is to be procured in the
-greatest plenty, leaving a few only in the hippah, to
-which the rest repair in times of danger. Some of
-these people came out a good way to meet us, and
-gave us an invitation to go with them to the rest of
-their party, which we readily accepted. We found a
-company of about thirty, men, women, and children,
-who received us with all possible demonstrations of
-friendship: we distributed among them a few ribands
-and beads, and, in return, received the kisses and embraces
-of both sexes, both young and old: they gave
-us also some fish, and after a little time we returned,
-much pleased with our new acquaintance.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>In the morning of the 26th, I went again out in
-the boat, with Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, and entered
-one of the bays, which lie on the east side of
-the inlet, in order to get another sight of the streight,
-which passed between the eastern and western seas.
-For this purpose, having landed at a convenient
-place, we climbed a hill of a very considerable
-height, from which we had a full view of it, with the
-land on the opposite shore, which we judged to be
-about four leagues distant; but as it was hazy in the
-horizon, we could not see far to the south-east: I
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_386'>386</span>resolved, however, to search the passage with the
-ship, as soon as I should put to sea. Upon the top
-of this hill we found a parcel of loose stones, with
-which we erected a pyramid, and left in it some
-musket balls, small shot, beads, and other things,
-which we happened to have about us, that were
-likely to stand the test of time, and, not being of
-Indian workmanship, would convince any European
-who should come to the place and pull it down, that
-other natives of Europe had been there before him.
-When this was done, we descended the hill, and
-made a comfortable meal of the shags and fish
-which our guns and lines had procured us, and which
-were dressed by the boat’s crew in a place that we
-had appointed: in this place we found another
-Indian family, who received us, as usual, with strong
-expressions of kindness and pleasure, showing us
-where to procure water, and doing us such other
-good offices as were in their power. From this place
-we went to the town of which the Indians had told
-us, who visited us on the 19th; this, like that which
-we had seen before, was built upon a small island or
-rock, so difficult of access, that we gratified our
-curiosity at the risk of our necks. The Indians here
-also received us with open arms, carried us to every
-part of the place, and showed us all that it contained:
-this town, like the other, consisted of between eighty
-and an hundred houses, and had only one fighting-stage.
-We happened to have with us a few nails
-and ribands, and some paper, with which our guests
-were so gratified, that at our coming away they filled
-our boat with dried fish, of which we perceived they
-had laid up great quantities.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The 27th and 28th were spent in refitting the
-ship for the sea, fixing a transom for the tiller,
-getting stones on board to put into the bottom of
-the bread-room, to bring the ship more by the stern,
-in repairing the casks, and catching fish.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 29th, we received a visit from our old
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_387'>387</span>man, whose name we found to be <span class='sc'>Topāa</span>, and three
-other natives, with whom Tupia had much conversation.
-The old man told us, that one of the men
-who had been fired upon by the officer who had
-visited their hippah, under pretence of fishing, was
-dead; but to my great comfort I afterwards discovered
-that this report was not true, and that if
-Topāa’s discourses were taken literally, they would
-frequently lead us into mistakes. Mr. Banks and
-Dr. Solander were several times on shore during
-the last two or three days, not without success, but
-greatly circumscribed in their walks, by climbers of
-a most luxuriant growth, which were so interwoven
-together as to fill up the space between the trees
-about which they grew, and render the woods altogether
-impassable. This day, also, I went on shore
-again myself, upon the western point of the inlet,
-and from a hill of considerable height I had a view
-of the coast to the N. W. The farthest land I could
-see in that quarter was an island which has been
-mentioned before, at the distance of about ten leagues,
-lying not far from the main: between this island and
-the place where I stood, I discovered, close under
-the shore, several other islands, forming many bays,
-in which there appeared to be good anchorage for
-shipping. After I had set off the different points for
-my survey, I erected another pile of stones, in which
-I left a piece of silver coin, with some musket balls
-and beads, and a piece of an old pendant flying on
-the top. In my return to the ship, I made a visit to
-several of the natives, whom I saw along the shore,
-and purchased a small quantity of fish.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 30th, early in the morning, I sent a boat
-to one of the islands for celery, and while the people
-were gathering it, about twenty of the natives, men,
-women, and children, landed near some empty huts:
-as soon as they were on shore, five or six of the
-women sat down upon the ground together, and
-began to cut their legs, arms, and faces, with shells,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_388'>388</span>and sharp pieces of talc or jaspar, in a terrible manner.
-Our people understood that their husbands
-had lately been killed by their enemies: but, while
-they were performing this horrid ceremony, the men
-set about repairing the huts, with the utmost negligence
-and unconcern.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The carpenter having prepared two posts to be
-left as memorials of our having visited this place, I
-ordered them to be inscribed with the ship’s name,
-and the year and month: one of them I set up at
-the watering-place, hoisting the Union-flag upon the
-top of it; and the other I carried over to the island
-that lies nearest to the sea, called by the natives
-<span class='sc'>Motuara</span>. I went first to the village or hippah,
-accompanied by Mr. Monkhouse and Tupia, where
-I met with our old man, and told him and several
-others, by means of Tupia, that we were come to set
-up a mark upon the island, in order to show to any
-other ship which should happen to come thither, that
-we had been there before. To this they readily consented,
-and promised that they never would pull it
-down: I then gave something to every one present;
-and to the old man I gave a silver three-pence, dated
-1736, and some spike-nails, with the king’s broad
-arrow cut deep upon them; things which I thought
-most likely to remain long among them: I then took
-the post to the highest part of the island, and, after
-fixing it firmly in the ground, I hoisted upon it the
-Union-flag, and honoured this inlet with the name
-of <span class='sc'>Queen Charlotte’s Sound</span>; at the same time taking
-formal possession of this and the adjacent country,
-in the name and for the use of his Majesty King
-George the Third. We then drank a bottle of wine
-to her Majesty’s health, and gave the bottle to the
-old man who had attended us up the hill, and who
-was mightily delighted with his present.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>While the post was setting up, we enquired of the
-old man concerning the passage into the eastern sea,
-the existence of which he confirmed; and then asked
-him about the land to the S. W. of the streight, where
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_389'>389</span>we were then situated: this land, he said, consisted
-of two whennuas or islands, which may be circumnavigated
-in a few days, and which he called <span class='sc'>Tovy
-Poenammoo</span>: the literal translation of this word is,
-“the water of green talc;” and probably if we had
-understood him better, we should have found that
-Tovy Poenammoo was the name of some particular
-place where they got the green talc or stone of which
-they make their ornaments and tools, and not a general
-name for the whole southern district: he said
-there was also a third whennua, on the east side of
-the streight, the circumnavigation of which would
-take up many moons: this he called <span class='sc'>Eaheinomauwe</span>;
-and to the land on the borders of the streight he
-gave the name of <span class='sc'>Tiera Witte</span>. Having set up our
-post, and procured this intelligence, we returned on
-board the ship, and brought the old man with us,
-who was attended by his canoe, in which, after dinner,
-he returned home.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 31st, having completed our wooding, and
-filled all our water-casks, I sent out two parties, one
-to cut and make brooms, and another to catch fish.
-In the evening we had a strong gale from the N. W.,
-with such a heavy rain, that our little wild musicians
-on shore suspended their song, which till now we had
-constantly heard during the night, with a pleasure
-which it was impossible to lose without regret.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 1st, the gale increased to a storm, with
-heavy gusts from the high land, one of which broke
-the hawser that we had fastened to the shore, and
-obliged us to let go another anchor. Towards midnight,
-the gale became more moderate, but the rain
-continued with such violence, that the brook which
-had supplied us with water overflowed its banks, and
-carried away ten small casks which had been left
-there full of water, and, notwithstanding we searched
-the whole cove, we could never recover one of them.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 3d, as I intended to sail the first opportunity,
-I went over to the hippah on the east side of
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_390'>390</span>the Sound, and purchased a considerable quantity of
-split and half-dried fish, for sea-stores. The people
-here confirmed all that the old man had told us
-concerning the streight and the country, and about
-noon I took leave of them: some of them seemed to
-be sorry, and others glad, that we were going: the
-fish which I had bought they sold freely, but there
-were some who showed manifest signs of disapprobation.
-As we returned to the ship, some of us made
-an excursion along the shore to the northward, to
-traffic with the natives for a farther supply of fish;
-in which, however, they had no great success. In
-the evening we got every thing off from the shore,
-as I intended to sail in the morning, but the wind
-would not permit.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 4th, while we were waiting for a wind, we
-amused ourselves by fishing, and gathering shells and
-seeds of various kinds; and early in the morning of
-the 5th, we cast off the hawser, hove short on the
-bower, and carried the kedge-anchor out, in order to
-warp the ship out of the cove, which having done,
-about two o’clock in the afternoon, we hove up the
-anchor and got under sail; but the wind soon failing,
-we were obliged to come to an anchor again a little
-above Motuara. When we were under sail, our old
-man, Topāa, came on board to take his leave of us;
-and as we were still desirous of making farther enquiries
-whether any memory of Tasman had been
-preserved among these people, Tupia was directed
-to ask him whether he had ever heard that such a
-vessel as ours had before visited the country. To
-this he replied in the negative; but said that his ancestors
-had told him there had once come to this
-place a small vessel, from a distant country, called
-<span class='sc'>Ulimaroa</span>, in which were four men, who, upon their
-coming on shore, were all killed: upon being asked
-where this distant land lay, he pointed to the northward.
-Of Ulimaroa we had heard something before,
-from the people about the Bay of Islands, who said
-that their ancestors had visited it; and Tupia had
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_391'>391</span>also talked to us of Ulimaroa, concerning which he
-had some confused traditionary notions, not very
-different from those of our old man, so that we could
-draw no certain conclusion from the accounts of either.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>Soon after the ship came to an anchor the second
-time, Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander went on shore, to
-see if any gleanings of natural knowledge remained;
-and by accident fell in with the most agreeable
-Indian family they had seen, which afforded them a
-better opportunity of remarking the personal subordination
-among these people than had before offered.
-The principal persons were a widow, and a pretty
-boy about ten years old: the widow was mourning
-for her husband with tears of blood, according to
-their custom, and the child, by the death of its
-father, was become proprietor of the land where we
-had cut our wood. The mother and the son were
-sitting upon mats, and the rest of the family, to the
-number of sixteen or seventeen, of both sexes, sat
-round them in the open air, for they did not appear
-to have any house, or other shelter from the weather,
-the inclemencies of which custom has probably enabled
-them to endure without any lasting inconvenience.
-Their whole behaviour was affable, obliging,
-and unsuspicious: they presented each person with
-fish, and a brand of fire to dress it, and pressed them
-many times to stay till the morning, which they
-would certainly have done if they had not expected
-the ship to sail, greatly regretting that they had not
-become acquainted with them sooner, as they made
-no doubt but that more knowledge of the manners
-and disposition of the inhabitants of this country
-would have been obtained from them in a day than
-they had yet been able to acquire during our whole
-stay upon the coast.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the 6th, about six o’clock in the morning, a
-light breeze sprung up at north, and we again got
-under sail; but the wind proving variable, we reached
-no farther than just without Motuara; in the afternoon,
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_392'>392</span>however, a more steady gale at N. by W. set
-us clear of the Sound, which I shall now describe.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The entrance of Queen Charlotte’s Sound is situated
-in latitude 41° S., longitude 184° 45ʹ W., and
-near the middle of the south-west side of the streight
-in which it lies. The land of the south-east head of
-the Sound, called by the natives <span class='sc'>Koamaroo</span>, off
-which lie two small islands and some rocks, makes
-the narrowest part of the streight. From the north-west
-head a reef of rocks runs out about two miles, in
-the direction of N. E. by N.; part of which is above
-the water, and part below. By this account of the
-heads, the Sound will be sufficiently known: at the
-entrance it is three leagues broad, and lies in S. W.
-by S. S. W. and W. S. W. at least ten leagues, and is
-a collection of some of the finest harbours in the
-world, as will appear from the plan, which is laid
-down with all the accuracy that time and circumstances
-would admit. The land forming the harbour
-or cove in which we lay, is called by the natives
-<span class='sc'>Totarranue</span>: the harbour itself, which I called <span class='sc'>Ship
-Cove</span>, is not inferior to any in the Sound, either for
-convenience or safety: it lies on the west side of the
-Sound, and is the southernmost of three coves, that
-are situated within the island of Motuara, which
-bears east of it. Ship Cove may be entered, either
-between Motuara and a long island, called by the
-natives <span class='sc'>Hamote</span>, or between Motuara and the western
-shore. In the last of these channels are two ledges
-of rocks, three fathom under water, which may easily
-be known by the sea-weed that grows upon them.
-In sailing either in or out of the Sound, with little
-wind, attention must be had to the tides, which flow
-about nine or ten o’clock at the full and change of
-the moon, and rise and fall between seven and eight
-feet perpendicularly. The flood comes in through
-the streight from the S. E. and sets strongly over
-upon the north-west head, and the reef that lies off
-it: the ebb sets with still greater rapidity to the S. E.
-over upon the rocks and islands that lie off the south-east
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_393'>393</span>head. The variation of the compass we found,
-from good observation, to be 13° 5ʹ E.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The land about this Sound, which is of such a
-height that we saw it at the distance of twenty-leagues,
-consists wholly of high hills and deep valleys,
-well stored with a variety of excellent timber,
-fit for all purposes except masts, for which it is too
-hard and heavy. The sea abounds with a variety of
-fish, so that, without going out of the cove where we
-lay, we caught every day, with the seine and hooks
-and lines, a quantity sufficient to serve the whole
-ship’s company; and along the shore we found
-plenty of shags, and a few other species of wild-fowl,
-which those who have long lived upon salt provisions
-will not think despicable food.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The number of inhabitants scarcely exceeds four
-hundred, and they live dispersed along the shores,
-where their food, consisting of fish and fern roots, is
-most easily procured; for we saw no cultivated
-ground. Upon any appearance of danger, they retire
-to their hippahs, or forts: in this situation we
-found them, and in this situation they continued for
-some time after our arrival. In comparison of the
-inhabitants of other parts of this country, they are
-poor, and their canoes are without ornament: the
-little traffic we had with them was wholly for fish;
-and indeed they had scarcely any thing else to dispose
-of. They seemed, however, to have some
-knowledge of iron, which the inhabitants of some
-other parts had not; for they willingly took nails for
-their fish, and sometimes seemed to prefer it to every
-thing else that we could offer, which had not always
-been the case. They were at first very fond of paper;
-but when they found that it was spoiled by being
-wet, they would not take it: neither did they set
-much value upon the cloth of Otaheite; but English
-broad cloth and red kersey were in high estimation;
-which showed that they had sense enough to appreciate
-the commodities which we offered by their use,
-which is more than could be said of some of their
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_394'>394</span>neighbours, who made a much better appearance.
-Their dress has been mentioned already, particularly
-their large round head-dresses of feathers, which
-were far from being unbecoming.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>As soon as we got out of the Sound, I stood over
-to the eastward, in order to get the streight well
-open before the tide of ebb came on. At seven in
-the evening, the two small islands which lie off Cape
-Koamaroo, the south-east head of Queen Charlotte’s
-Sound, bore east, distant about four miles: at this
-time it was nearly calm, and the tide of ebb setting out,
-we were, in a very short time, carried by the
-rapidity of the stream close upon one of the islands,
-which was a rock rising almost perpendicularly out
-of the sea: we perceived our danger increase every
-moment, and had but one expedient to prevent our
-being dashed to pieces, the success of which a few
-minutes would determine. We were now within little
-more than a cable’s length of the rock, and had more
-than seventy-five fathom water; but upon dropping an
-anchor, and veering about one hundred and fifty
-fathom of cable, the ship was happily brought up:
-this, however, would not have saved us, if the tide
-which set S. by E. had not, upon meeting with the
-island, changed its direction to S. E. and carried us
-beyond the first point. In this situation, we were
-not above two cables’ length from the rocks; and
-here we remained in the strength of the tide, which
-set to the S. E. after the rate of at least five miles an
-hour, from a little after seven till near midnight,
-when the tide abated, and we began to heave. By
-three in the morning the anchor was at the bows,
-and having a light breeze at N. W. we made sail for
-the eastern shore; but the tide being against us, we
-made but little way: the wind, however, afterwards
-freshened, and came to N. and N. E. with which,
-and the tide of ebb, we were in a short time hurried
-through the narrowest part of the streight, and then
-stood away for the southernmost land we had in sight,
-which bore from us S. by W. Over this land appeared
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_395'>395</span>a mountain of stupendous height, which was
-covered with snow.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>The narrowest part of the streight, through which
-we had been driven with such rapidity, lies between
-Cape Tierawitte, on the coast of Eaheinomauwe,
-and Cape Koamaroo: the distance between them I
-judged to be between four or five leagues, and, notwithstanding
-the tide, now its strength is known, may
-be passed without much danger. It is, however,
-safest to keep on the north-east shore, for on that side
-there appeared to be nothing to fear; but on the other
-shore there are not only the islands and rocks which
-lie off Cape Koamaroo, but a reef of rocks stretching
-from these islands six or seven miles to the southward,
-at the distance of two or three miles from the shore,
-which I had discovered from the hill when I took my
-second view of the streight from the east to the western
-sea. The length of the streight we had passed, I
-shall not pretend to assign, but some judgment may
-be formed of it from a view of the chart.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About nine leagues north from Cape Tierawitte,
-and under the same shore, is a high and remarkable
-island which may be distinctly seen from Queen Charlotte’s
-Sound, from which it is distant about six or
-seven leagues. This island, which was noticed when
-we passed it on the 14th of January, I have called
-<span class='sc'>Entry Isle</span>.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>On the east side of Cape Tierawitte, the land
-trends away S. E. by E. about eight leagues, where
-it ends in a point, and is the southernmost land on
-Eaheinomauwe. To this point I have given the name
-of <span class='sc'>Cape Palliser</span>, in honour of my worthy friend
-Captain Palliser. It lies in latitude 41° 34ʹ S., longitude
-183° 58ʹ W., and bore from us this day at
-noon S. 79 E. distant about thirteen leagues, the
-ship being then in the latitude of 41° 27ʹ S.; Koamaroo
-at the same time bearing N. ½ E. distant seven
-or eight leagues. The southernmost land in sight
-bore S. 16 W. and the snowy mountain S. W. At
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_396'>396</span>this time we were about three leagues from the shore,
-and abreast of a deep bay or inlet, to which I gave
-the name of <span class='sc'>Cloudy Bay</span>, and at the bottom of
-which there appeared low land covered with tall
-trees.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>At three o’clock in the afternoon we were abreast
-of the southernmost point of land that we had seen at
-noon, which I called <span class='sc'>Cape Campbell</span>: it lies S.
-by W. distant between twelve and thirteen leagues
-from Cape Koamaroo, in latitude 41° 44ʹ S., longitude
-183° 45ʹ W.; and with Cape Palliser forms the southern
-entrance of the straight, the distance between
-them being between thirteen and fourteen leagues
-W. by S. and E. by N.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>From this Cape we steered along the shore S. W.
-by S. till eight o’clock in the evening, when the wind
-died away. About half an hour afterwards, however,
-afresh breeze sprung up at S. W., and I put the ship
-right before it. My reason for this was a notion which
-some of the officers had just started, that Eaheinomauwe
-was not an island, and that the land might stretch away
-to the S. E. from between Cape Turnagain and Cape
-Palliser, there being a space of between twelve and
-fifteen leagues that we had not seen. I had, indeed,
-the strongest conviction that they were mistaken,
-not only from what I had seen the first time I discovered
-the straight, but from many other concurrent
-testimonies, that the land in question was an island;
-but being resolved to leave no possibility of doubt
-with respect to an object of such importance, I took
-the opportunity of the wind’s shifting, to stand eastward,
-and accordingly steered N. E. by E. all the
-night. At nine o’clock in the morning we were
-abreast of Cape Palliser, and found the land trend
-away N. E. towards Cape Turnagain, which I
-reckoned to be distant about twenty-six leagues:
-however, as the weather was hazy, so as to prevent
-our seeing above four or five leagues, I still kept
-standing to the N. E. with a light breeze at south;
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_397'>397</span>and at noon Cape Palliser bore N. 72 W. distant
-about three leagues.</p>
-
-<p class='c000'>About three o’clock in the afternoon three canoes
-came up to the ship with between thirty and forty
-people on board, who had been pulling after us with
-great labour and perseverance for some time: they
-appeared to be more cleanly, and a better class, than
-any we had met with since we left the Bay of Islands;
-and their canoes were also distinguished by the same
-ornaments which we had seen upon the northernly part
-of the coast. They came on board with very little
-invitation; and their behaviour was courteous and
-friendly. Upon receiving presents from us, they made
-us presents in return, which had not been done by
-any of the natives that we had seen before. We soon
-perceived that our guests had heard of us, for as soon
-as they came on board, they <a id='ask'></a>asked for <i>Whow</i>, the
-name by which nails were known among the people
-with whom we had trafficked: but though they had
-heard of nails, it was plain they had seen none; for
-when nails were given them, they asked Tupia what
-they were. The term <i>Whow</i>, indeed, conveyed to
-them the idea not of their quality, but only of their
-use; for it is the same by which they distinguish a tool,
-commonly made of bone, which they use both as an
-auger and a chisel. However, their knowing that we
-had <i>whow</i> to sell, was a proof that their connections
-extended as far north as Cape Kidnappers, which was
-distant no less than forty-five leagues; for that was
-the southernmost place on this side the coast where
-we had had any traffic with the natives. It is also probable,
-that the little knowledge which the inhabitants
-of Queen Charlotte’s Sound had of iron, they obtained
-from their neighbours at Tierawitte; for we
-had no reason to think that the inhabitants of any
-part of this coast had the least knowledge of iron or
-its use before we came among them, especially as,
-when it was first offered, they seemed to disregard it
-as of no value. We thought it probable, that we
-<span class='pageno' id='Page_398'>398</span>were now once more in the territories of Teratu; but
-upon enquiring of these people, they said that he was
-not their king. After a short time, they went away,
-much gratified with the presents that we had made
-them; and we pursued our course along the shore to
-the N. E. till eleven o’clock the next morning. About
-this time, the weather happening to clear up, we saw
-Cape Turnagain, bearing N. by E. ½ E. at the distance
-of about seven leagues: I then called the
-officers upon deck, and asked them, whether they
-were not now satisfied that Eahienomauwe was an
-island: they readily answered in the affirmative; and
-all doubts being now removed, we hauled our wind
-to the eastward.</p>
-
-<div class='nf-center-c0'>
-<div class='nf-center c013'>
- <div>END OF THE FIRST VOLUME.</div>
- <div class='c013'>Printed by A. and R. Spottiswoode,</div>
- <div>Printers-Street, London.</div>
- </div>
-</div>
-
-<div class='footnote' id='f1'>
-<p class='c000'><a href='#r1'>1</a>. The celebrated navigator who discovered this streight was a
-native of Portugal, and his name, in the language of his country,
-was <i>Fernando de Magalhaens</i>; the Spaniards call him <i>Hernando
-Magalhanes</i>, and the French <i>Magellan</i>, which is the orthography
-that has been generally adopted: a gentleman, the fifth in descent
-from this great adventurer, is now living in or near London, and
-communicated the true name of his ancestor to Mr. Banks, with a
-request that it might be inserted in this work.</p>
-</div>
-
-<div class='nf-center-c0'>
-<div class='nf-center c012'>
- <div>Transcriber’s Note</div>
- </div>
-</div>
-
-<p class='c019'>This book uses inconsistent spelling and hyphenation, which were retained
-in the ebook version. Some corrections have been made to the text, including
-such as normalizing punctuation.
-Further corrections are noted below:</p>
-
-<div class='lg-container-b'>
- <div class='linegroup'>
- <div class='group'>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#the'>9</a>: appearance; the the sides -> appearance; the sides</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#where'>26</a>: whereever I went -> wherever I went</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#doubts'>29</a>: some doubs whether -> some doubts whether</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#to'>36</a>: as to to declare -> as to declare</div>
- <div class='line'><a href='#il1_02'>Caption to illustration facing p. 84</a>: Otahiete -> Otaheite</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#aa'>174</a>: by a a succession -> by a succession</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#tell'>178</a>: tellting us, that they -> telling us, that they</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#stra'>190</a>: not sraight lines -> not straight lines</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#mouth'>200</a>: sucks it into his month -> sucks it into his mouth</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#inhab'>222</a>: inhabiants of Otaheite -> inhabitants of Otaheite</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#cer'>240</a>: the cermony of lowering -> the ceremony of lowering</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#day'>240</a>: to day -> to-day</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#our'>279</a>: for our our landing -> for our landing</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#on'>295</a>: wind being right an end -> wind being right on end</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#mer'>309</a>: the sun’s meridan -> the sun’s meridian</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#there'>310</a>: their is no quarter -> there is no quarter</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#muss'>316</a>: lobsters and muscles -> lobsters and mussels</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#north'>320</a>: the nothernmost of the Court -> the northernmost of the Court</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#bottom'>333</a>: the botton to the top -> the bottom to the top</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#tasman'>361</a>: discovered by Tafman -> discovered by Tasman</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#obs'>365</a>: by obervation -> by observation</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#follow'>380</a>: continued to folllow -> continued to follow</div>
- <div class='line'>p. <a href='#ask'>397</a>: they aked for -> they asked for</div>
- </div>
- </div>
-</div>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-<pre>
-
-
-
-
-
-End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of The Three Voyages of Captain Cook
-Round the World. Vol. I. Being th, by James Cook and Joseph Banks and Dr. Hawkesworth
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THREE VOYAGES OF CAPTAIN COOK, VOL 1 ***
-
-***** This file should be named 56196-h.htm or 56196-h.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/5/6/1/9/56196/
-
-Produced by Sonya Schermann and the Online Distributed
-Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was
-produced from images generously made available by The
-Internet Archive)
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
-be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
-States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks, unless you receive
-specific permission. If you do not charge anything for copies of this
-eBook, complying with the rules is very easy. You may use this eBook
-for nearly any purpose such as creation of derivative works, reports,
-performances and research. They may be modified and printed and given
-away--you may do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks
-not protected by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the
-trademark license, especially commercial redistribution.
-
-START: FULL LICENSE
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
-person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
-1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
-Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country outside the United States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
-on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
- most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
- restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
- under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
- eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
- United States, you'll have to check the laws of the country where you
- are located before using this ebook.
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
-other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
-Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-provided that
-
-* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
- works.
-
-* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
-
-* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and The
-Project Gutenberg Trademark LLC, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark. Contact the Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
-www.gutenberg.org
-
-
-
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is in Fairbanks, Alaska, with the
-mailing address: PO Box 750175, Fairbanks, AK 99775, but its
-volunteers and employees are scattered throughout numerous
-locations. Its business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt
-Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up to
-date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and
-official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-For additional contact information:
-
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
-state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
-facility: www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
- </body>
- <!-- created with ppgen.py 3.56n on 2017-11-12 14:16:57 GMT -->
-</html>
diff --git a/old/56196-h/images/cover.jpg b/old/56196-h/images/cover.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index bbd6815..0000000
--- a/old/56196-h/images/cover.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/56196-h/images/frontis.jpg b/old/56196-h/images/frontis.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index af5eb89..0000000
--- a/old/56196-h/images/frontis.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/56196-h/images/il1_01.jpg b/old/56196-h/images/il1_01.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 8f1fc22..0000000
--- a/old/56196-h/images/il1_01.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/56196-h/images/il1_01l.jpg b/old/56196-h/images/il1_01l.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 8dc5558..0000000
--- a/old/56196-h/images/il1_01l.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/56196-h/images/il1_02.jpg b/old/56196-h/images/il1_02.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index c43bbd1..0000000
--- a/old/56196-h/images/il1_02.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/56196-h/images/il1_03.jpg b/old/56196-h/images/il1_03.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index df2e7e4..0000000
--- a/old/56196-h/images/il1_03.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/56196-h/images/il1_04.jpg b/old/56196-h/images/il1_04.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 6f4044f..0000000
--- a/old/56196-h/images/il1_04.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/56196-h/images/il1_05.jpg b/old/56196-h/images/il1_05.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index e66774c..0000000
--- a/old/56196-h/images/il1_05.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/56196-h/images/il1_06.jpg b/old/56196-h/images/il1_06.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 6fda04c..0000000
--- a/old/56196-h/images/il1_06.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/56196-h/images/il222.jpg b/old/56196-h/images/il222.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 6897832..0000000
--- a/old/56196-h/images/il222.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ